summaryrefslogtreecommitdiff
diff options
context:
space:
mode:
-rw-r--r--.gitattributes3
-rw-r--r--33559-8.txt7882
-rw-r--r--33559-8.zipbin0 -> 122746 bytes
-rw-r--r--33559-h.zipbin0 -> 188789 bytes
-rw-r--r--33559-h/33559-h.htm8176
-rw-r--r--33559-h/images/frontis1.jpgbin0 -> 55509 bytes
-rw-r--r--33559-h/images/logo2a.jpgbin0 -> 4990 bytes
-rw-r--r--33559.txt7882
-rw-r--r--33559.zipbin0 -> 122750 bytes
-rw-r--r--LICENSE.txt11
-rw-r--r--README.md2
11 files changed, 23956 insertions, 0 deletions
diff --git a/.gitattributes b/.gitattributes
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..6833f05
--- /dev/null
+++ b/.gitattributes
@@ -0,0 +1,3 @@
+* text=auto
+*.txt text
+*.md text
diff --git a/33559-8.txt b/33559-8.txt
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..c68bcda
--- /dev/null
+++ b/33559-8.txt
@@ -0,0 +1,7882 @@
+The Project Gutenberg eBook, At the Fall of Port Arthur, by Edward
+Stratemeyer, Illustrated by A. B. Shute
+
+
+This eBook is for the use of anyone anywhere at no cost and with
+almost no restrictions whatsoever. You may copy it, give it away or
+re-use it under the terms of the Project Gutenberg License included
+with this eBook or online at www.gutenberg.org
+
+
+
+
+
+Title: At the Fall of Port Arthur
+ Or, A Young American in the Japanese Navy
+
+
+Author: Edward Stratemeyer
+
+
+
+Release Date: August 28, 2010 [eBook #33559]
+
+Language: English
+
+Character set encoding: ISO-8859-1
+
+
+***START OF THE PROJECT GUTENBERG EBOOK AT THE FALL OF PORT ARTHUR***
+
+
+E-text prepared by Carol Brown, Curtis Weyant, and the Project Gutenberg
+Online Distributed Proofreading Team (http://www.pgdp.net) from page
+images generously made available by Internet Archive/American Libraries
+(http://www.archive.org/details/americana)
+
+
+
+Note: Project Gutenberg also has an HTML version of this
+ file which includes the original illustration.
+ See 33559-h.htm or 33559-h.zip:
+ (http://www.gutenberg.org/files/33559/33559-h/33559-h.htm)
+ or
+ (http://www.gutenberg.org/files/33559/33559-h.zip)
+
+
+ Images of the original pages are available through
+ Internet Archive/American Libraries. See
+ http://www.archive.org/details/atfallofportarth00straiala
+
+
+
+
+
+Soldiers of Fortune Series
+
+AT THE FALL OF PORT ARTHUR
+
+Or
+
+A Young American in the Japanese Navy
+
+by
+
+EDWARD STRATEMEYER
+
+Author of "Under the Mikado's Flag," "On to Pekin," "Two Young
+Lumbermen," "Old Glory Series," "Colonial Series,"
+"Pan-American Series," etc.
+
+Illustrated by A. B. Shute
+
+
+[Illustration: "It is coming this way!" yelled Larry.----_Page 84._]
+
+
+
+
+
+
+
+[Illustration: Printer's logo]
+
+Boston:
+Lothrop, Lee & Shepard Co.
+1930
+
+Copyright, 1905, by Lothrop, Lee & Shepard Company
+
+All rights reserved
+
+AT THE FALL OF PORT ARTHUR
+
+Printed in U.S.A.
+
+
+
+
+ PREFACE
+
+
+"AT THE FALL OF PORT ARTHUR" is a complete tale in itself, but forms the
+third volume in a line issued under the general title of "Soldiers of
+Fortune Series."
+
+The story relates primarily the adventures of Larry Russell and his
+old-time sea chum, Luke Striker, already well known to the readers of my
+"Old Glory Series." Larry and Luke are aboard of their old ship, the
+_Columbia_, bound from Manila to Nagasaki, with a cargo designed for the
+Japanese Government. This is during the war between Russia and Japan,
+and when close to the Japanese coast the schooner is sighted by a
+Russian warship and made a prize of war.
+
+As prisoners both Larry and Luke see something of life in the Russian
+navy. When close to Vladivostok, the Russian warship falls in with
+several ships of the Japanese fleet, and after a thrilling sea-fight
+surrenders with her prize. This brings Larry and Luke before Admiral
+Togo, and as Larry's brother Ben, with their mutual friend, Gilbert
+Pennington, is already in the Japanese army, Larry enters the Japanese
+navy and Luke follows suit. The siege and bombardment of Port Arthur are
+at their height; and the particulars are given of many battles both on
+the sea and on land, leading up to the ultimate surrender of that brave
+Russian commander, General Stoessel, and the fall of the city. By this
+surrender the Japanese obtained many thousands of prisoners of war,
+hundreds of cannon, with large quantities of ammunition, and several
+scores of vessels, useful for either fighting purposes or as transports.
+Moreover, this victory placed the entire southern portion of Manchuria
+under Japanese control, giving the army untrammeled use of the railroad
+running from Port Arthur to Liao-Yang, a city on the road to Mukden,
+captured some time before, as already related in another volume of this
+series, entitled "Under the Mikado's Flag."
+
+As I have mentioned in a previous work, it is as yet impossible to state
+what the outcome of this terrific conflict will be. So far victory has
+perched largely upon the standard of Japan. The Russian navy has been
+practically shattered and its army fought to a standstill. The cost of
+the war has been tremendous to both countries. Countless thousands of
+lives have already been sacrificed. Would that peace were soon at hand!
+
+Again I thank my young friends for their appreciation of my former
+stories. May the present tale fulfill every reasonable expectation.
+
+ EDWARD STRATEMEYER.
+
+
+ CONTENTS
+
+
+ CHAPTER PAGE
+
+ I. LARRY AND HIS FRIENDS 1
+
+ II. A STORM ON THE PACIFIC 10
+
+ III. LARRY LEARNS SOMETHING 20
+
+ IV. THE RUSSIAN SAILOR'S PLOT 29
+
+ V. SIGNS OF A MUTINY 38
+
+ VI. THE FIGHT FOR THE SHIP 47
+
+ VII. THE MUTINEERS IN POSSESSION 56
+
+ VIII. TURNING THE TABLES 66
+
+ IX. CLOSE TO A WATERSPOUT 76
+
+ X. SOMETHING ABOUT WAR AND FIGHTING SHIPS 86
+
+ XI. AN ORDER TO LAY-TO 95
+
+ XII. TAKEN AS A PRIZE OF WAR 103
+
+ XIII. PRISONERS ON THE _Pocastra_ 113
+
+ XIV. PROGRESS OF THE WAR 122
+
+ XV. A SHARP NAVAL BATTLE 132
+
+ XVI. ABOARD A JAPANESE WARSHIP 140
+
+ XVII. THE RETAKING OF THE _Columbia_ 148
+
+ XVIII. A CLEVER RUSE 156
+
+ XIX. THE DISAPPEARANCE OF THE ENEMY 164
+
+ XX. LARRY BEFORE ADMIRAL TOGO 171
+
+ XXI. LETTERS OF INTEREST 180
+
+ XXII. A MEETING AND A PLOT 189
+
+ XXIII. THE ATTACK IN THE DARK 198
+
+ XXIV. THE DEFENSE OF THE POWDER TRAIN 206
+
+ XXV. BOMBARDING A PORT ARTHUR FORT 215
+
+ XXVI. BEN MEETS CAPTAIN BARUSKY 223
+
+ XXVII. A FIERCE BATTLE AT SEA 232
+
+ XXVIII. THE SIEGE OF PORT ARTHUR 240
+
+ XXIX. FROM ONE DIFFICULTY TO ANOTHER 248
+
+ XXX. A SURPRISE FOR LARRY 258
+
+ XXXI. A CALL TO REPEL BOARDERS 266
+
+ XXXII. FALL OF PORT ARTHUR--CONCLUSION 274
+
+
+AT THE FALL OF PORT ARTHUR
+
+
+AT THE FALL OF PORT
+ARTHUR
+
+
+
+
+CHAPTER I
+
+LARRY AND HIS FRIENDS
+
+
+"Unless I miss my guess, Luke, we are going to have a storm."
+
+"Jest what I was thinking, Larry. And when it comes I allow as how it
+will be putty heavy," replied Luke Striker, casting an eye to the
+westward, where a small dark cloud was beginning to show above the
+horizon.
+
+"Well, we can't expect fine weather all the time," went on Larry
+Russell, inspecting the cloud with equal interest. "We want some wind
+anyway," he added. "We are not making this return trip to Nagasaki
+nearly as fast as we made the trip to Manila."
+
+Luke Striker, a bronzed and weather-beaten Yankee sailor, rubbed his
+chin reflectively. "I was jest thinking o' the day I spied the old
+_Columbia_ in Manila harbor," he said, meditatively. "Tell ye, Larry,
+the sight 'most struck me dumb. 'The _Columbia_,' sez I to myself. An'
+then I thought I must be a-dreamin'. I wanted to find this ship ag'in in
+the worst way."
+
+"The ship certainly seems like a home to me, Luke--and I reckon she
+always will seem that way. I've traveled a good many miles in her, since
+I first struck her at Honolulu in the Hawaiian Islands," responded Larry
+Russell.
+
+"Yes--both of us have. But we never took no trip like this
+afore--carryin' a cargo for the Japanese Government, with that
+government at war with Russia." Luke Striker lowered his voice. "What's
+the outlook? Does the old man reckon to fall in with a Russian warship
+afore we can reach Nagasaki?"
+
+"Hush, Luke; you mustn't mention our cargo," came from Larry Russell,
+hastily.
+
+"I ain't mentionin' it to anybody but you."
+
+"Captain Ponsberry is in hopes that we shall not meet any Russian
+warships."
+
+"But what if we do?"
+
+"Then we shall have to show our heels as best we can."
+
+"A sailing vessel can't show much o' a pair o' heels to a man-o'-war."
+
+"That is true."
+
+"I suppose, if the _Columbia_ was overhauled by a Russian warship,
+they'd consider us a prize of war; wouldn't they?" continued the old
+Yankee sailor.
+
+"They would, unless Captain Ponsberry could get out of it in some way."
+
+"How do you think he might get out of it?"
+
+"Well, you must remember that our cargo doesn't belong to the Japanese
+Government yet. We are carrying it from Manila to Nagasaki for the
+Richmond Importing Company. The Russians would have to prove their case
+against us before they could claim the schooner as a legitimate prize of
+war."
+
+"I see. Well, I reckon as how them Russians would do 'most anything to
+square accounts with the Japs. So far, accordin' to my notions, they
+have been losin' ground right along in this war."
+
+"Yes, and they'll lose more before the Japs are through with 'em, Luke.
+But that storm is coming up fast," went on Larry Russell, with another
+examination of the black cloud. "I'll have to tell the captain. If we
+don't shorten sail it may do us some damage."
+
+With the last-mentioned remark Larry Russell walked aft, toward the
+companionway of the _Columbia_, a staunch three-masted schooner that
+hailed from Gloucester. He was second mate of the craft and as such it
+was now his duty to inform Captain Nat Ponsberry that a storm was
+approaching.
+
+To those of my young friends who have read "Under Dewey at Manila" and
+other volumes of the "Old Glory Series" Larry Russell needs no
+introduction. He was one of three brothers, who, left in the charge of a
+miserly step-uncle, had thought it best to go away from home and seek
+fortune in various parts of the globe. Larry had drifted to San
+Francisco and then to Honolulu, where he had fallen in with Captain Nat
+Ponsberry and the _Columbia_, as already mentioned. He, with his sailor
+friend, Luke Striker, had been cast away, and while adrift on the
+Pacific had been picked up by the Asiatic Squadron under Commodore
+(afterward Admiral) Dewey, to serve with honor during the memorable
+battle of Manila Bay.
+
+Since those days a great many things had occurred to the Russell boys.
+Ben, the oldest of the three, had served as a young volunteer in Cuba
+during the advance on Santiago, and as an officer with the army in the
+Philippines, and Walter, the third brother, had served in the navy in
+Cuban waters and elsewhere. In the meantime the miserly step-uncle had
+reformed, and now thought "his three boys," as he called them, "the best
+young fellers in all America, barrin' none!"
+
+Larry Russell was a natural sailor, and when his term in the navy came
+to an end he could not bear to think of giving up the sea. He heard that
+his old ship was bound for a trip to Japan and other ports, and at once
+communicated with Captain Ponsberry, with the result that he became
+second mate of the schooner, the first mate being, as of old, Tom
+Grandon, a personal friend of Captain Ponsberry.
+
+At this time Walter Russell had gone into business, and was doing
+remarkably well. But Ben was doing nothing, and Larry persuaded his
+oldest brother to come aboard the ship at Manila, for the trip to
+Nagasaki and Port Arthur. This was just at the outbreak of the war
+between Russia and Japan, but the brothers at that time knew nothing
+about the tremendous conflict so close at hand.
+
+The _Columbia_ was carrying a cargo for the Richmond Importing Company,
+represented in Japan and China by Gilbert Pennington, who had served
+with Ben Russell in our army in Cuba and the Philippines. From Manila
+Gilbert had gone to China, to fight the Boxers, as already described in
+"On to Pekin," the first volume of this "Soldiers of Fortune Series."
+With the end of the Boxer conflict, Lieutenant Pennington, as he had
+then become, turned from war to business, and soon made a number of
+business transactions which were highly gratifying to the company that
+he represented.
+
+When the _Columbia_ arrived at Nagasaki, Captain Ponsberry learned that
+the war had begun and that to get to Port Arthur--a Russian stronghold
+in Manchuria--was out of the question. While he was awaiting orders
+Gilbert Pennington appeared on the scene. Gilbert had had great
+difficulties in getting away from Port Arthur, having been suspected by
+the Russian officials of being a spy. He wished to know at once if the
+ship's cargo was safe.
+
+"As safe as when we left home," had been Captain Ponsberry's reply.
+
+"Good!" answered the young agent, and then he wished to know if anything
+had been done about selling the goods. Captain Ponsberry replied that he
+had been ordered to do nothing until he received word from Gilbert. This
+suited the young representative; and the upshot of the matter was that
+the cargo, instead of going to a Russian port, was sold to the Japanese
+Government at a price considerably above the ordinary market value.
+
+Gilbert Pennington was enthusiastic about joining the Japanese army for
+a campaign in Manchuria and he imparted a large share of this enthusiasm
+to Ben Russell. As a result both enlisted and became captains in a
+special command, under a Major Okopa, who could speak very good English.
+The part of the army to which they were assigned landed at Chinampo, in
+Korea, and in the second volume of this series, called "Under the
+Mikado's Flag," I related the particulars of the crossing of the Yalu
+River and of the many skirmishes and battles leading up to the terrific
+ten-days' contest before Liao Yang. During these fights Ben and Gilbert
+did their full duty as officers, and when the Russians retreated to the
+North both were well content to take a much-needed rest. But additional
+struggles were still in store for them, as will be learned in the pages
+which follow.
+
+At first Larry Russell had been inclined to follow his brother and his
+friend Gilbert into the Japanese army. But Captain Ponsberry did not
+wish to lose his services as a second mate, and when it was decided that
+the _Columbia_ should make a quick run to Manila and back, for another
+cargo for the Japanese Government, he made up his mind to stick to the
+ship.
+
+The run to Manila from Nagasaki was made without special incident, and,
+once at the main seaport of the Philippines, Captain Ponsberry lost no
+time in getting on board the cargo the Richmond Importing Company had
+ready for him. The cargo was a valuable one and it was calculated that
+if rightly sold it would yield the company a profit of five or six
+thousand dollars.
+
+"You have got to take care and not run into any Russian warship," said
+the agent of the company at Manila. "If you do you may have a whole lot
+of trouble in explaining matters to the Russian commander's
+satisfaction. I see by the reports that the Russians have already held
+up several English and South American ships."
+
+"I shall keep a sharp lookout for 'em," was Captain Ponsberry's reply.
+
+"And another thing, Captain," went on the agent, in a lower tone; "you
+want to watch your crew."
+
+"What do you mean?"
+
+"I don't like the looks of two or three of them. For all you know they
+may be more than willing to expose you--if you fall in with the
+Russians. Can you trust your first and second mates?"
+
+"I can! They are as honest as myself."
+
+"Then caution them to keep an eye on the hands. One of those fellows
+looks like a Russian to me--the chap with the heavy black beard."
+
+"You mean Semmel. He says he is a Pole and that he hates the Russians."
+
+"Humph! Well, I saw him talking to a lot of Russians night before last.
+And when they passed a Jap the whole crowd jeered at the little brown
+man."
+
+"Semmel, too?"
+
+"Yes."
+
+"Then I shall watch him," answered Captain Ponsberry, decidedly.
+
+"Do, but don't let him know it. Some of these foreign sailors are ugly
+when they find out they are being suspected."
+
+"Trust me to manage him," returned the commander of the _Columbia_; and
+there the talk on the subject came to an end.
+
+
+
+
+CHAPTER II
+
+A STORM ON THE PACIFIC
+
+
+Larry found Captain Ponsberry working over a chart on the cabin table,
+laying out the course of the ship. The commander of the _Columbia_ was a
+bluff, hearty individual and he and the young second mate thought a
+great deal of each other.
+
+"Well, what is it?" asked the captain, looking up quickly.
+
+"I came to report that a storm is coming up from the west," answered
+Larry.
+
+"Humph! I was afraid we'd catch it sooner or later. Is it close up yet?"
+
+"It's coming up pretty fast."
+
+Captain Ponsberry said no more, but threw down his parallel rulers and
+his pencil. Catching up his cap, he mounted to the deck, and the young
+second mate followed at his heels. The captain gave a long look to the
+westward and then a gaze around the remainder of the horizon.
+
+"Tell Cal Vincent to call all hands to shorten sail!" he called out to
+Larry. "Tell 'em to tumble up quick, too--thet storm ain't none too far
+off for comfort!"
+
+Larry passed the word to Cal Vincent, who was the boatswain of the
+_Columbia_, and soon the whistle piped up shrilly, and those who were
+below or in the forecastle, came on deck in a hurry. Already the wind
+was freshening, ruffling up the whitecaps in all directions. The sky,
+that had been so blue a short while before, became leaden, and the
+depths of the ocean took on a somber hue. The barometer indicated a
+great and immediate change.
+
+"Lay aloft there, men!" cried Captain Ponsberry. "Our sails are mostly
+new and we don't want them ripped up if we can help it. Skip along
+there, Peterson!" The latter words to a big sailor who was moving across
+the deck at a snail's pace.
+
+The sailor addressed, scowled. It was not his watch on deck and he hated
+to have his midday nap disturbed.
+
+"Got a nail in ma boot," he said.
+
+"Well, haul it out--after the sails are trimmed," returned the captain,
+and then turned to another hand: "Semmel, what's the matter with you?"
+This to the suspicious-looking sailor with the heavy black beard.
+
+"Nodding," grumbled Semmel, and turned away sulkily.
+
+"Then get a move on, or we may lose a stick as well as a sail," and
+there followed a perfect volley of orders in a tone that none of the
+sailors misunderstood. Up to the yards they crawled like so many
+monkeys, and soon the creaking of halyard blocks was heard, as the
+topsails came down. The jib and flying jib were also taken in, and a
+little later the main-course and the mizzen-course.
+
+"Reckon we can stand the fore-course for a little while longer," said
+Captain Ponsberry to Tom Grandon. "What do you think?"
+
+"We can, unless it comes quicker nor it is coming now," returned the
+first mate.
+
+"Well, keep an eye on the wind and reef her as soon as it begins to look
+nasty," said Captain Ponsberry, and returned to the cabin, to finish his
+nautical calculations.
+
+The _Columbia_ had left the last of the Philippines behind and was
+headed north through the China Sea toward the lower extremity of
+Formosa. She was not as new a ship as when Larry had first boarded her
+at Honolulu, for since that time she had seen half a dozen years of hard
+service. But Captain Ponsberry was a careful man and believed in making
+repairs as soon as they were needed, so there was small danger of her
+opening her seams or going to pieces even in the stiffest of blows. She
+leaked a little--the best of ships do that--but a short pumping every
+morning kept the water at the bottom of the well.
+
+As second mate, it was Larry's duty to see that everything on the deck
+was "ship-shape," and this was especially necessary when a storm was
+coming up. He made a tour of the ship, his keen eyes taking in every
+detail.
+
+As it happened, an hour before he had set the sailor Semmel to work
+stowing away some odds and ends of rope. He had supposed that this task
+was long since finished, but now he found the ropes scattered about as
+before.
+
+"See here, Semmel," he called out, "why didn't you stow away those ropes
+as I told you?"
+
+"Stow dem avay in a leetle vile," answered the sailor with the heavy
+beard.
+
+"You'll stow them away now," returned Larry, sharply. He did not at all
+fancy the manner of the hand he was addressing. "I told you to do it an
+hour ago. We don't want anything loose on deck when this storm hits us."
+
+"Vincent kicked de ropes out dare," growled Semmel. "I had nodding to do
+mit 'em."
+
+"That isn't here or there. I told you to stow them away, and I want you
+to do it. If you don't, I'll have to report you to the captain."
+
+"Oh, I do him!" grumbled Semmel, but he glared at Larry as if he wished
+to chew the young second mate up. "You put all dare vork on me, hey?" he
+added, after a pause.
+
+"You've got to do your share of it."
+
+"Humph!" Semmel seemed on the point of saying more, but shut his teeth
+and began to arrange the ropes in proper order. Larry watched him for a
+moment and then walked away. As soon as his back was turned the sailor
+shook his fist at the young second mate.
+
+"You vait!" he muttered. "Chust vait, you Jankee rat!"
+
+The sky kept growing darker, and soon came a puff of wind much heavier
+than any that had gone before. The _Columbia_ had been moving over the
+waves on an even keel, but now she gave a sudden lurch to starboard.
+
+"Reckon it's time to take them reefs in the fore-course," said Grandon to
+Larry, and soon the sailors were at work on the sheets, leaving just
+sufficient canvas up to make the schooner mind her helm. It was hard
+work, for the sudden gusts made the sail snap and crack like a whip.
+
+So far it had not rained a drop, but now came a sudden downpour, the
+drops "as big as hen's eggs," to use Luke Striker's manner of describing
+them. Then came a flash of lightning out of the western sky, followed by
+a rumble of thunder.
+
+"This is going to be an old-time storm," was Larry's comment, as he met
+Luke Striker near the forecastle. "I'll have to get my oilskin out."
+
+Luke already had his raincoat on and soon the young mate was similarly
+provided. Wind and rain were increasing, and presently there came a
+flash of lightning and a clap of thunder that made everybody jump. The
+thunder brought Captain Ponsberry to the deck in a hurry.
+
+"Did that hit us?" he questioned, looking around anxiously.
+
+"No, sir, but it was pretty close," replied Grandon.
+
+"Is everything secure?" went on the commander, to Larry.
+
+"Yes, sir."
+
+It was difficult to converse further, for the wind was now whistling
+through the rigging, driving the rain in sheets across the deck. All had
+to hold fast for fear of being swept overboard. On every side the sea
+was lashing itself into a foam and the waves were growing higher and
+higher. At one instant the _Columbia_ would seem to be riding on top of
+a mountain, the next she would sink down and down into the trough of the
+sea.
+
+"Well, Larry, how do you like this?" questioned Captain Ponsberry, as he
+took a position beside the second mate.
+
+"Oh, I don't mind it at all," was the cheery answer. "I used to mind the
+storms, but I've got used to them."
+
+"This isn't a plaything we are getting."
+
+"Oh, I know that--you can see it by the way the wind is driving us. But
+we are not near any land, are we?"
+
+"No."
+
+"Then we'll be sure to outride it. I feel I can bank on the old
+_Columbia_ for almost anything."
+
+At this Captain Ponsberry laid an affectionate hand on his second mate's
+shoulder.
+
+"Reckon you love the old craft about as well as I do," he said.
+
+"I don't know about that--you've been on board so many more years than
+myself. But to me she is a second home."
+
+"I see. Well, let us hope we get through with this trip in safety."
+
+"Don't you imagine we'll do it?" questioned Larry, quickly.
+
+"Certainly. But you must remember that we may have trouble if we fall in
+with any Russian warship." Captain Ponsberry lowered his voice. "Did you
+have trouble with Semmel?"
+
+"A little. I ordered him to coil up some ropes and he didn't obey me
+right away. But he stowed them away afterwards."
+
+Captain Ponsberry drew a long breath. "The more I see of that chap the
+less I like him."
+
+"I never liked him from the start," answered Larry, frankly. "But you'll
+have to give him credit for being a good all-round sailor."
+
+"There is no doubt but what he is that, Larry. But he has a bad eye."
+
+"What do you think he could do to harm us?"
+
+"Nothing--unless we fell in with a Russian warship. In that case, if he
+was a Russian sympathizer, he might expose the fact that while we are
+carrying a cargo for the Richmond Importing Company the goods are really
+meant for the Japanese Government."
+
+"Does he know that?"
+
+"I'm not sure, one way or the other. What I am afraid of is, that he may
+know a good bit more nor we suspect."
+
+"I see." The young second mate mused for a moment. "I'll tell you what
+I'd do, if I thought he was going to play me foul--and we fell in with a
+Russian warship. I'd clap him below decks, out of sight until the
+warship went on her way again."
+
+"That's easily said; but I can't make him a prisoner unless I can prove
+something against him."
+
+"You can lock him up if he is sulky and won't obey orders."
+
+"Yes, that is true. Still----Phew!"
+
+The captain broke off short, for a vivid streak of lightning flared all
+over the upper masts of the ship. The thunder-clap was as sharp as it
+was deafening, and for the moment all on board thought the _Columbia_
+had surely been struck. Then came a downpour which made even the boldest
+of the sailors seek shelter.
+
+"That was closer than I like," was Larry's comment, after it was
+ascertained that the ship was unharmed.
+
+"'Most knocked me overboard," came from Luke Striker. "Gosh! reckon my
+hair's singed," and he put up his hand and ran his fingers through his
+grayish locks. "Don't want another like thet nohow!"
+
+A few minutes later came another flash of lightning, but this was to the
+eastward, showing that the center of the storm had passed them. The wind
+was apparently going down, but the sea was as angry as ever and would be
+for hours to come.
+
+Luke had retired to the forecastle with several other sailors. Larry's
+watch on deck was also at an end, and he was just on the point of going
+below, when from the west came a curious humming sound which made the
+young second mate pause. The humming increased, and then of a sudden the
+_Columbia_ was caught in a hurricane blast that threw her far over on
+her side.
+
+"Help!" Larry heard, in the voice of Captain Ponsberry. "Somebody help
+me, quick, or I'll go overboard!"
+
+
+
+
+CHAPTER III
+
+LARRY LEARNS SOMETHING
+
+
+The accident which had happened to Captain Nat Ponsberry was certainly a
+curious one, although similar to that which once cost the life of a
+young officer in our navy.
+
+When the hurricane blast reached the _Columbia_, the captain was in the
+act of slipping on a lined raincoat,--a big affair, with long sleeves
+and an extra high collar. One arm was in the coat and the other was
+going down the sleeve when it caught in the lining. At that instant the
+shock threw the captain across the deck and almost over the railing. He
+caught at the railing with his free hand, but his other hand remained a
+prisoner in the coat sleeve, while the garment itself stuck in a bunch
+across his shoulders.
+
+"Help!" he roared again. He tried to pull himself up, and to free the
+hand in the sleeve, but found both impossible.
+
+Larry did not wait for a second cry for assistance. He knew the captain
+so well that he felt the officer would only call when in dire peril. He
+ran out on the slippery deck in double-quick order.
+
+"Hullo, where are you?" he yelled.
+
+"Here! Help!"
+
+The young second mate caught sight of the captain not a moment too soon.
+Another lurch of the _Columbia_ had thrown him completely over the rail,
+and there he clung with one hand, while the spray was flying all over
+him.
+
+Not waiting to count the possible cost, Larry slid rather than ran to
+the rail. Years before he had learned a trick which now stood him in
+good stead. He wound his legs around the under rail, catching the upper
+one with his left hand. Then he clutched Captain Ponsberry by the
+tangled-up arm.
+
+"On deck there!" he yelled. "Throw a rope this way, and hurry up about
+it!"
+
+"What's the trouble?" came from Tom Grandon, who had been in another
+part of the ship and had not heard the captain's cry.
+
+"The captain is almost overboard. Throw us a rope."
+
+Tom Grandon was quick to act. The rope came whizzing toward Larry, and
+in a twinkling he had it around his body and also around the captain.
+
+"Haul in!" he called, and Grandon and two sailors did so. Over the rail
+came Captain Ponsberry, still fighting to release the tangled-up arm. In
+a moment more all danger was past.
+
+"Well, how in the world did this happen?" questioned Grandon.
+
+"Tell ye--soon as I can git free o' this consarned coat!" spluttered
+Captain Ponsberry, and he gave the garment a jerk that ripped one of the
+sleeves completely in half. "Did ye ever see sech foolishness?" he
+added. And then he told how the lurch of the ship had carried him over
+the rail just when he could use but one hand. "After this I reckon I'll
+put on my coat afore I go on deck," he concluded.
+
+"It was a lucky thing that Larry heard you cry out," said the first
+mate. "I was at the wheel, helping Groot."
+
+"That's right, Tom." The captain turned to the youth. "Larry, you're a
+brave one, and always was. I ain't going to forget this!"
+
+"Oh, don't say anything about it," came from the young second mate,
+modestly. "I know you'd do as much for me, if I needed it."
+
+"Well, I would, an' there's my hand on it," cried Captain Ponsberry,
+heartily, and gave Larry a grip that made him wince.
+
+The storm kept up for the remainder of the day. But its worst fury was
+spent, and during the night the wind went down to nothing more than a
+stiff breeze, which was just what was wanted. All of the sails were
+again set; and the schooner resumed her course as before.
+
+Before leaving Manila Larry had purchased a number of newspapers printed
+in that city in English. So far he had had no chance to look the sheets
+over, but now came two days in which there was little to do, and he
+spent several hours in devouring the news, while he also let his friend
+Luke do some reading.
+
+"Tell ye what, this 'ere war between Russia and Japan is goin' to be a
+big thing," said Luke, after reading an account of the first fights on
+land and on sea. "It ain't goin' to be no such short affair as our
+little rumpus in Cuby."
+
+"You are right, Luke; this war is going to be a long and bitter one."
+
+"Who is goin' to win, do you think?"
+
+"I'm sure I don't know. Russia is a vast country, with millions of
+people and with an immense army and navy. I suppose she can put five
+times as many men in the field as Japan can."
+
+"But them Japs know how to fight."
+
+"Indeed they do--they have proved that already. And what is to their
+advantage, they are closer to Korea and Manchuria than Russia is. They
+can get on the fighting ground quicker,--which counts for a good deal."
+
+"How those Russians must have been astonished when the Japanese warships
+sailed into 'em at Port Arthur last February. I don't believe they were
+expecting an attack."
+
+"Hardly, for war had just been declared. But you wouldn't have caught
+Uncle Sam napping like that, Luke."
+
+"Right ye are, lad; it ain't his style. An' then to see how them Japs
+have been a-blowin' up the Russian warships ever since. They must have a
+fine navy."
+
+"Yes, and good gunners, too. I was told in Nagasaki that quite a few
+American gunners were on their ships--fellows who served under Dewey at
+Manila and under Sampson and Schley off Cuba."
+
+"I believe you, lad. When a feller gits it in his bones to fight on a
+warship there ain't no life on a merchantman goin' to satisfy him. Some
+jackies would rather fight nor eat--you know thet as well as I do."
+
+"Well, I shouldn't mind doing some fighting myself. You know I was on a
+stand about going with Ben and Gilbert Pennington."
+
+"Where do you reckon they are now?"
+
+"In Manchuria, I suppose, fighting as hard as they can. I thought I
+would get a letter from them before we left Manila, but nothing came."
+
+"I suppose the mails are all upset, on account of the war," put in Cal
+Vincent, who sat nearby, sewing a button on his shirt. "If you'll
+remember, Nagasaki was in a big state of excitement while we were there
+last."
+
+"Did they say anything about any Russian warships bein' in these parts?"
+questioned Luke.
+
+"No."
+
+"It would be strange if we did fall in with them."
+
+"Which puts me in mind," came from the boatswain, and then he gazed
+around to see if any other persons were near. "Semmel says he ain't no
+Russian, but it's dollars to doughnuts he is," he continued, in a
+lowered tone.
+
+"Have you discovered anything new?" demanded Larry.
+
+"Yes and no. Last night I overheard him and Peterson talking in a
+suspicious kind of a way. I didn't catch much, for they talked partly in
+English and partly in a foreign language. But I am sure they are
+favoring Russia, and Semmel said something about doing something to harm
+Japan."
+
+"I don't see how they could do anything on board of this ship," came
+from Luke.
+
+"You didn't hear anything definite?"
+
+"Can't say that I did," answered the boatswain.
+
+"We had better watch them closer than ever."
+
+"All right; I'll do my share," responded Vincent, and Luke Striker said
+the same.
+
+That very afternoon Larry had another quarrel with the sailor with the
+long beard. Semmel had a bucket of dirty water which he was carrying to
+the ship's side. As Larry passed he pretended to stub his toe and
+allowed some of the dirty water to flow over the young second mate's
+foot.
+
+"Semmel, what did you do that for?" cried Larry, indignantly.
+
+"Canno help dat," said the sailor. "I slip."
+
+"You did it on purpose!"
+
+"Oh, no!" And the sailor grinned wickedly.
+
+"I say you did. If you try anything like that again, I'll make it warm
+for you. Get a swab and clean the deck up at once!"
+
+As Semmel sauntered off, and while Larry was stamping the water from his
+shoe, Captain Ponsberry came up. He had seen the trick played from a
+distance.
+
+"What did you tell Semmel?" he questioned, sharply.
+
+"Told him to swab the deck up. I think he slopped the dirty water over
+me on purpose."
+
+"Just my idea of it. I'll tell him what I think of it." And striding
+after the bearded sailor Captain Ponsberry gave him a lecture not to be
+readily forgotten.
+
+"I won't have any of your dirty underhanded work aboard of my ship," he
+concluded. "Either you'll behave yourself, or I'll put you in irons."
+
+"In irons!" ejaculated Semmel, scowling viciously.
+
+"That is what I said and that is what I mean. Ever since you came on
+board you have been acting in this same dirty fashion and I want it
+stopped. Now swab up that deck, and see that you make a first-class job
+of it. For two pins I'd make you black Russell's shoes."
+
+"No black nobody's shoes," growled Semmel, but in such a low tone that
+Captain Ponsberry could not hear him. He cleaned the deck in his own
+ugly, independent manner, muttering imprecations against both Larry and
+the captain in the meantime.
+
+As a matter of fact, even though he had denied it to Captain Ponsberry
+and others, Ostag Semmel was really a Russian by birth, having been born
+and raised in the seaport of Kolaska. He had been drafted into the army,
+but not wishing to serve under a military rule which is unusually
+severe, he had run away to sea and become a sailor.
+
+Life on the ocean suited Semmel very well and he would have remained
+away from Russia had it not been for the fact that a rich uncle had died
+leaving him a property valued at two thousand dollars--a small fortune
+in the eyes of a man of this Russian's standing. He wished to go back to
+claim his inheritance, but feared to do so, for he knew that once on
+Russian soil he would be arrested for desertion, and might be sent to a
+military prison for a great number of years.
+
+From a friend in Manila he had heard of something which interested him
+greatly. This was the news that another deserter from the Russian army
+had been pardoned for his offense because he had taken home with him
+important news concerning the movements of a certain Japanese warship.
+
+"If I could only do as well," he told himself, over and over again, and
+then, when he signed articles for the _Columbia's_ trip, he listened
+eagerly to some talk he overheard about the ship's cargo. When he began
+to suspect the truth--that the cargo was meant for the Japanese
+Government--his eyes glistened cunningly.
+
+"If I can only let Russia know of this!" he reasoned. "All will go well
+with me. If I can only let Russia know!"
+
+
+
+
+CHAPTER IV
+
+THE RUSSIAN SAILOR'S PLOT
+
+
+Captain Ponsberry's stern manner made Ostag Semmel wild with hatred, and
+when he went back to the forecastle after swabbing up the deck he was in
+a fit mental condition for almost any dark deed.
+
+For a good half-hour he lay in his bunk in a corner, brooding over his
+ill-luck and wondering what he could do to revenge himself upon both the
+master of the schooner and Larry. Larry he especially disliked--the very
+open-heartedness of the young second mate made him long to do the lad
+harm.
+
+At the end of the half-hour another sailor came in. It was Carl
+Peterson, his close friend. Peterson was a burly tar who had visited
+nearly every quarter of the globe. He loved to drink and carouse, and
+was ever ready to lend a hand in any excitement that offered. There was
+a rumor that he had once led a mutiny on a Danish merchant vessel, but
+this he denied, laying the blame entirely on others.
+
+"Is that you, Peterson?" demanded Semmel, in his native tongue, for he
+knew that the other could speak Russian fluently.
+
+"Yes," came in a rough voice from Peterson. He gave a coarse laugh. "A
+fine job you made of it, to pour dirty water over Russell and then have
+to swab up the deck for it."
+
+"Who told you of that?"
+
+"Didn't I see it with my own eyes--and heard what the captain said,
+too."
+
+"Bah! It makes me sick!" growled Semmel. "I am sick of the ship--the
+crew--everything!"
+
+Peterson gave a short toss of his head, which was covered with a shock
+of fiery red hair. "What are you going to do about it? Even if the
+captain treats you like a dog, what shall you do, Ostag Semmel? He
+thinks we are all curs--door mats to wipe feet on!"
+
+"He shall find out that I am neither a dog nor a door mat!" muttered the
+bearded Russian. "By my right hand I promise you that!"
+
+"Talk is cheap--it takes wind to make the mill go," answered Peterson.
+To an outsider it would have been plain to see that he was leading
+Semmel on, in an endeavor to find out what was in his companion's mind.
+
+"It will not end in talk."
+
+"Bah! I have heard that before."
+
+"I have been thinking," went on Ostag Semmel, slowly. "Can I trust you?"
+
+"You know you can."
+
+"You do not love the captain--do not love that Russell?"
+
+"Do I act as if I did?"
+
+"Good! Now, how many on board of this ship?"
+
+"Fourteen men, counting in ourselves."
+
+"You count fairly. Fourteen, how many are our friends?"
+
+"Postnak and Conroy, at least."
+
+"Then we are four, so far. Now, what of Groot and Shamhaven and Jack
+Wilbur?"
+
+"Groot is a good fellow and a man who wishes to make money."
+
+"And Shamhaven will do almost anything for money--he once told me so. He
+took a sailor suit from a store in Manila without paying for it."
+
+"I know that too. The tailor was rich and didn't need the money," and
+Peterson gave another coarse laugh.
+
+"Then we are six--to stand up for our rights. And Jack Wilbur will make
+seven--just half the number on the ship."
+
+"How can we count that Wilbur in? He is a Yankee."
+
+"He is a weakling and we can manage him,--and I think we can manage some
+others, too--when we get that far."
+
+"How far do you mean?" demanded Peterson, although he knew about what
+was coming.
+
+"Is anybody else near here?"
+
+"No," and Peterson took a careful look around.
+
+"Supposing we seize the ship--in the name of the Russian Government?
+They have a Japanese cargo on board, the captain cannot deny it. We can
+take the ship, sail her to some Russian port, and win both prize money
+and glory. Is it not a grand scheme?"
+
+"Ha, that is fine!" Carl Peterson's eyes glowed voraciously. "Ostag, you
+are a man after my own heart! We might become rich!"
+
+"Then you like the plan?"
+
+"Yes--providing we can make it work. But it is a big undertaking. If we
+were caught we might swing from a yardarm for it."
+
+"We can make it work--I have another plan for that. I have thought it
+out completely. We can--but more later," and Ostag Semmel broke off
+abruptly, as several sailors entered the forecastle. A little later he
+began to complain in broken English to a sailor named Jack Wilbur that
+he was suffering from a severe stomach ache.
+
+"Sorry to hear on it," said Wilbur, who was a very mild foremast hand.
+"Anything I can do for you?"
+
+"I dink not," answered Semmel. "I dink de poor grub ve git mak me feel
+pad."
+
+"Didn't notice that the grub was poor," answered Wilbur.
+
+"Very poor--not so goot as py my las' ship," answered Semmel. "Some grub
+here not fit to eat."
+
+It was soon noised around that Semmel was not feeling well and that he
+had complained that the food dealt out at noontime had made him sick. As
+soon as Captain Ponsberry heard of this he went to interview Jeff, the
+colored cook, who, as of old, was singing gayly to himself among the
+pots and pans of the ship's galley.
+
+"Wasn't nuffin de mattah wid dat grub, Cap'n Ponsberry," exclaimed Jeff,
+after hearing what the commander of the ship had to say. "It was jess as
+good as we always has."
+
+"Was it thoroughly cooked?"
+
+"Yes, sah--I don't 'low nuffin to go from dis yere galley 'less it am
+well cooked."
+
+"Are your pots and kettles clean?"
+
+"Yes, sah--yo' can see fo' yourself, sah."
+
+The captain did see, and moreover he knew that Jeff was usually a
+careful and conscientious culinary artist who always gave the men the
+best his stock afforded.
+
+"Well, be careful of what you cook and how you cook it after this," said
+Captain Ponsberry.
+
+"Would yo' mind tellin' me, sah, who is kicking, sah?" asked Jeff,
+respectfully.
+
+"Semmel says he was made sick by what he ate."
+
+"Huh, dat scab!" grunted Jeff. "He ain't no 'count at all, he ain't!"
+And the cook turned away in disgust.
+
+"It looks to me as if Semmel was trying to make trouble all around,"
+said Tom Grandon, when he and the captain and Larry talked the matter
+over.
+
+"I never liked that man from the first time I clapped eyes on him," came
+from Larry. "He's a sneak--and worse."
+
+"I shall watch him pretty closely after this," said Captain Ponsberry.
+"One discontented fellow like him can upset the whole ship if he sets
+out to do it."
+
+"They can't complain of the grub," went on the first mate. "It's as good
+as on any merchantman, and better than the law requires."
+
+"I guess it was the deck-swabbing that gave him the stomach ache," said
+Larry, and this made the captain and Grandon smile.
+
+The next day when the sailors sat down to their dinner two or three of
+them sniffed suspiciously at the food they were eating.
+
+"This don't taste just right to me," said Shamhaven. "The meat tastes
+decayed."
+
+"And the vegetables ain't much better," put in Conroy,--a sturdy
+Irish-American, who was one of the best seamen on the schooner.
+
+"Dat dinner am fust-class," cried Jeff. "I ain't gwine to stand yere an'
+see you growlin' at it."
+
+"It certainly tastes a bit off, Jeff," put in Jack Wilbur. "Taste it
+yourself."
+
+The cook did so, and his face looked doubtful for a moment.
+
+"Guess dat needs a little salt an' pepper," he said, slowly. It did not
+taste nearly as good as he had anticipated.
+
+As there was nothing else to do, and they were hungry, the men ate the
+meal, grumbling to themselves as they did so. Luke said but little and
+ate sparingly, and his example was followed by Cal Vincent.
+
+The captain, Grandon, and Larry ate in the cabin and the dinner served
+to them was first-class in every particular.
+
+"Guess Jeff is spreading himself, just to show what he can do," remarked
+Larry to the first mate, after he had finished his repast.
+
+"It's very good, Larry," answered Tom Grandon.
+
+By the middle of the afternoon three of the men were complaining of
+feeling sick and all attributed their ailments to what they had eaten
+for dinner.
+
+"Ha! vat I tole you?" cried Semmel. "Didn't I say de grub vos pad? Not
+maybe you belief me, hey?"
+
+"I shan't stand for any more poor grub," came from Shamhaven. "If I
+can't get good stuff I'm going to the captain about it."
+
+The sickness of the hands worried Captain Ponsberry greatly and he
+opened up his medicine chest and gave them such remedies as he thought
+were best.
+
+At supper time Jeff was extra cautious in selecting and preparing the
+food. Nevertheless, the men who ate of it were suspicious and more than
+half the meal went to waste. The captain was very thoughtful, but said
+little or nothing.
+
+On the following day the wind died down utterly and it was exceedingly
+warm. With nothing to do, the majority of the hands gathered at the bow
+to talk of matters in general, and the food in particular. Semmel and
+Peterson were of the number, and both did all in their power to magnify
+the outrage, as they termed it.
+
+"Der captain don't haf any right to gif us such grub," said Semmel. "It
+vos against der law."
+
+"On some ships there would be a mutiny over this," added Peterson.
+
+Larry overheard a part of the conversation and it set him thinking. Luke
+Striker also grew suspicious.
+
+"Unless I am mistaken, this is some of Semmel's work," said Larry to the
+old tar. "He is doing his level best to make trouble on the ship."
+
+"Well, he better mind his business," grumbled Luke. "I don't reckon the
+captain will stand fer any underhanded work."
+
+Without appearing to do so, Larry continued to keep his eyes on Semmel,
+and about an hour before dinner he saw the bearded sailor approach the
+cook's galley and look inside. Jeff was below, getting a case of canned
+goods. With a swift movement, Semmel stepped into the galley, raised the
+lid of a big pot full of stew that was on the stove, and sprinkled
+something over the food. Then he hurried out and sneaked forward once
+more.
+
+"The rascal!" murmured Larry. "So this is his game. I wonder what he put
+into that pot?"
+
+For the moment the young second mate thought to confront Semmel and
+demand an explanation. Then he changed his mind and hurried for the
+cabin, to tell the news to Captain Ponsberry.
+
+
+
+
+CHAPTER V
+
+SIGNS OF A MUTINY
+
+
+"I've found out something important, Captain Ponsberry," said Larry, as
+he entered the cabin. "I now know what's the matter with the grub." To
+all salt-water sailors food is grub and nothing else.
+
+"Well, what is the matter with it?" questioned the master of the
+_Columbia_, quickly.
+
+"It's being doctored, that's what's the matter."
+
+"Doctored?"
+
+"Yes, sir,--doctored by Semmel, too."
+
+"Will you explain what you mean, Larry?" demanded the captain, intensely
+interested.
+
+"I just saw that rascal go into the cook's galley. Jeff wasn't there,
+and Semmel took the lid off of a big pot on the stove and sprinkled
+something inside."
+
+"What!" Captain Ponsberry leaped to his feet "Are you certain of this?"
+he demanded.
+
+"I am--for I saw it with my own eyes."
+
+"What was that stuff he put into the pot?"
+
+"I don't know."
+
+"Did he touch anything else?"
+
+"No. He was in a tremendous hurry and wasn't in the galley more than a
+minute at the most."
+
+"The scoundrel!" Captain Ponsberry clenched his fists. "Larry, you are
+positive you are making no mistake?"
+
+"I saw the thing done just as I told you. The stuff was in a bit of
+white paper. When he went forward he threw the paper overboard."
+
+"Did anybody else see this?"
+
+"I don't think so. But----"
+
+At that moment came a knock on the cabin door and Luke Striker appeared.
+
+"Excuse me, sir," he said, touching his cap. "But I've got something
+important to report."
+
+"What is it, Striker?"
+
+"I jess see that air Semmel go in and out o' the cook's galley."
+
+"That is just what I am reporting!" cried Larry. "Did you see what he
+did, Luke?"
+
+"No. He wasn't in there only a minit. It looked suspicious to me,
+though--with all hands gittin' sick from the grub."
+
+"This is all the evidence I want," said Captain Ponsberry. "We'll soon
+make an end of this. Larry, send Semmel to me."
+
+The young second mate left the cabin with Luke and both hurried toward
+the bow, where Semmel and Peterson were conversing in low tones.
+
+"The captain wants to see you at once," said Larry to the bearded
+sailor.
+
+His tone was so sharp it made Semmel start.
+
+"Vat he vants?" he queried.
+
+"Go and find out for yourself."
+
+"Maybe you git me in droubles, hey?" and the bearded sailor scowled.
+
+"I reckon as how you're gittin' yourself into trouble," drawled Luke,
+dryly.
+
+"You keep your mouf shut!" cried Semmel. "I no talk to you, no!"
+
+"The captain wants you to report; are you going to do so or not?"
+demanded Larry.
+
+"Sure I go," answered Semmel, with a toss of his head, and he slouched
+toward the stern. His manner was so aggressive that Larry picked up a
+belaying pin before following him.
+
+Captain Ponsberry had just appeared on deck. He had armed himself with a
+short club,--a sure sign to those who knew him that something unusual
+was in the wind. His face was stern and forbidding, and all hands
+gathered around to see what was the trouble.
+
+"Semmel, I want to have a talk with you," he said, in a loud voice, as
+the bearded sailor came up.
+
+To this the sailor nodded but did not answer.
+
+"I want to know what you were doing in the cook's galley a short while
+ago."
+
+"De cook's galley?" The sailor acted as if he was puzzled. "I no go by
+de galley, captain."
+
+"You were in the galley and you put something into the stew-pot. What
+was it?" thundered Captain Ponsberry. "Tell me the truth, or I may take
+it into my head to break every bone in your body!" And he shook his club
+in the sailor's face.
+
+"I put noddings in de pot," cried Semmel. "I no go in de galley--I no
+been in de galley two, tree days. It is a lie!"
+
+"I saw you go in," came from Luke.
+
+"And so did I," added Larry. "And I saw you sprinkle something into the
+pot."
+
+"What, did dat good-fo'-nuffin furiner put somet'ing in ma eatin'?"
+shrieked Jeff, who had come up. "Oh,--yo'--yo'----"
+
+"Never mind, Jeff, I'll attend to this," interrupted the captain.
+
+"Yes, sah, but dat monkey-faced----"
+
+"Never mind now--fall back there," added the captain, and the cook fell
+back, but shook his fist at Semmel.
+
+"I not in de galley," reiterated the bearded sailor. "Russell an'
+Striker no tell de truth."
+
+"It is true," cried Larry.
+
+"Thet's so, an' you can't squirm out o' it," broke in Luke. "I saw ye as
+plain as day."
+
+"I want to know what you put into that stew-pot?" continued Captain
+Ponsberry.
+
+"I no go near de galley. I----"
+
+"I know you went into the galley and I know you put something into the
+stew. For the last time I ask you, what was it?"
+
+For reply Ostag Semmel simply shrugged his shoulders.
+
+"Are you going to tell me the truth?"
+
+"I reckon the truth ain't in him," grumbled Luke, under his breath.
+
+"I say noddings more," came sourly from the bearded sailor.
+
+"Put that man in irons," commanded Captain Ponsberry, turning quickly to
+Larry and Grandon. "If he won't talk now, perhaps he'll talk after he
+has spent a day in the brig."
+
+"Vat! you put me in irons!" shrieked Semmel. "You no got right to do
+dat, no!"
+
+"Haven't I?" answered Captain Ponsberry, in a voice that cut like a
+whip. "I'd like to see anybody dispute over it. Larry, Tom, do as I
+command."
+
+"Yes, sir," answered Larry, and ran off to get a pair of handcuffs while
+Tom Grandon stationed himself beside Ostag Semmel, belaying pin in hand.
+
+"You no mak me a prisoner!" fumed the bearded sailor. "You got no
+right!"
+
+He continued to rave, saying that it was a plot against him, because he
+had been the first to complain about the vile food served to the hands;
+that he had not been near the galley and that the captain, Grandon, and
+Larry knew it. He even appealed to the other sailors to stand by him,
+and several came forward to argue with Captain Ponsberry. But the master
+of the schooner was obstinate and would not listen.
+
+"I know what I am doing, men," he said, quickly but firmly. "He is a
+scoundrel and a spell in the brig will do him good. After this I reckon
+you'll find the grub all right."
+
+"I no like--" began Peterson, once more.
+
+"You shut up, Peterson, or I'll put you in the brig with Semmel," cut in
+the captain, and Peterson fell back with the rest, but with a brow that
+was dark and distrustful.
+
+By this time Larry had returned with the handcuffs and despite the
+resistance he offered, Ostag Semmel was made a prisoner. Then the first
+and the second mates led him to the schooner's brig,--a narrow, V-shaped
+room in the bow of the boat, usually used for storing lanterns and oil.
+The smell in the closet--for it was nothing else--was far from pleasant,
+and a day in the brig usually made a prisoner repent and promise to do
+better.
+
+"I mak trouble for dis!" growled Semmel, as the door was closed and
+bolted on him. "I mak trouble, yes! You got no right to do dis, no!"
+
+"And you haven't any right to doctor the grub," answered Larry, and then
+he and Grandon walked away.
+
+"That fellow is a first-class villain, to my way of reasoning," was the
+first mate's comment. "I believe he'd do almost anything to get square
+for this."
+
+After Ostag Semmel had been placed in the brig Captain Ponsberry called
+all hands to him once more and related what Luke and Larry had seen. The
+stew was inspected, but nothing suspicious could be seen about it.
+
+"If any of you want to try that stew you may do so," said the captain.
+"Of course, if Semmel didn't touch it there can be nothing in it that
+can hurt you." But all, even to Peterson, declined to even taste the
+food. It was one thing to think Semmel innocent but quite another to run
+the risk of being made sick or poisoned. In the end the stew was dumped
+overboard and Jeff prepared an entirely new dinner for all hands.
+
+"You must keep close watch on all of the men," said the captain to Larry
+and Grandon, when quietness had been restored. "Semmel was the worst of
+the lot, but I do not like the way Peterson and one or two others are
+acting."
+
+"I don't see what they can do," answered Larry.
+
+"They might start a mutiny," came from the first mate.
+
+"Would they dare go as far as that?"
+
+"Sometimes sailors get strange notions, and the old Harry himself can't
+stop them," said Captain Ponsberry. "A thing that in itself doesn't
+amount to much will start them off, and they'll imagine that everything
+is going wrong. When I was a lad, on board the _Mary Eliza_, Captain
+Snapper, we had a mutiny just because the coffee wasn't right."
+
+"Yes, and I can remember that they had a mutiny on the old brig
+_Chesterfield_ because Captain Roe's wife brought a cross-eyed yellow
+cat on board," added Grandon. "Not a man would hoist a sail until that
+feline was put ashore. And when, two months later, the brig lost her
+foremast in a gale, the sailors said it was on account of that same cat,
+she having scratched the mast before she was taken away!"
+
+"Well, I hope we don't have a mutiny," said Larry. "I'd like to suggest
+something, Captain Ponsberry," he went on, to the master of the
+_Columbia_.
+
+"Fire ahead, Larry."
+
+"You know we can trust Luke Striker. Why not have him report just what
+the other hands are doing?"
+
+"That's an idea, and I will act on it. Yes, I'd trust Striker as quick
+as I'd trust you. If there is to be trouble we certainly want to know of
+it as soon as possible," concluded the captain.
+
+
+
+
+CHAPTER VI
+
+THE FIGHT FOR THE SHIP
+
+
+The day to follow was Sunday, and contrary to expectations, it passed
+quietly. As there was hardly any wind, the old _Columbia_ made slow
+progress, and the sailors had little or nothing to do. As was his usual
+habit, Larry read his Bible, and Captain Ponsberry held a short church
+service, which less than half the crew attended.
+
+"It's plain to see that the men are sulky," said Tom Grandon, towards
+evening. "We are certain to hear something from them shortly."
+
+Luke had been told to report anything unusual, but it was not until
+after dark that he sought out Captain Ponsberry.
+
+"I ain't got much to say," said the old tar. "But to my mind Peterson,
+Groot, and Shamhaven are doin' a powerful lot of confabbin'. More'n
+that, I saw Peterson cleaning up a pistol he's got."
+
+"Are any of the other hands armed?"
+
+"I ain't seen no other shootin'-irons," answered Luke.
+
+The captain had expected to interview Semmel once more, but found the
+fellow so surly he gave up the attempt. As the brig was so hot and
+uncomfortable, the master of the schooner had the door fixed so it could
+be left open several inches, with a chain at the bolt to keep it from
+going further.
+
+At four o'clock Monday morning Peterson came on duty, followed by
+Shamhaven and some others. All made their way to the bow and began to
+talk in a low but earnest fashion. Then Peterson went below, to where
+Semmel was still confined in the brig.
+
+"We are ready to move now," said he, in Russian. "What do you think?"
+
+"Let me out and I will show you what I think," growled Ostag Semmel.
+"The captain is a dog--and Grandon and Russell are dogs, too!"
+
+Peterson was prepared to unlock the chain which held the brig door and
+did so. Then he handed a pistol to the Russian.
+
+"The captain and Russell are in their staterooms," said Peterson. "Only
+Grandon is on deck, with Vincent and with the men we can trust to help
+us."
+
+"We can't trust Vincent."
+
+"I know that."
+
+"Where is Striker?"
+
+"Asleep in his berth."
+
+But on this score Carl Peterson was mistaken. Luke had pretended to go
+to sleep, but he was now in a corner on deck, watching with keen eyes
+all that was occurring. Presently he saw Semmel in company with Peterson
+hurry towards the bow, and he felt that the time for action had arrived.
+
+"Hi, Mr. Grandon!" he called out, running up to the first mate.
+
+"What is it, Striker?"
+
+"They've released Semmel and they are arming themselves."
+
+"You don't say!" Tom Grandon was stunned for the instant. "Tell the
+captain and Russell of this at once!"
+
+"Aye, aye, sir!"
+
+Rushing down the companionway, Luke entered the cabin and knocked on the
+door of Captain Ponsberry's stateroom.
+
+"Wake up, captain!" he called, loudly. "Wake up! There is going to be
+trouble putty quick, to my way o' thinkin'!"
+
+"What has gone wrong now?" demanded the master of the _Columbia_, as he
+hurried into his clothes and armed himself. "Where is Grandon?"
+
+"On deck; he sent me to tell you. They have set Semmel free and some of
+'em are arming themselves."
+
+"A mutiny!" roared Captain Ponsberry. "Striker, you'll stand by me, of
+course?"
+
+"That I will, sir--to the end."
+
+"Good. I know Vincent will do the same. Do you know anything about the
+others?"
+
+"I think you can count on Jeff the cook."
+
+"What of Wilbur?"
+
+"He's so weak-kneed I don't know what he'll do," answered Striker.
+
+By this time Larry was out of his stateroom. With his door ajar he had
+heard all that had been said.
+
+"Oh, Luke, do you think they'll try to seize the ship?" he gasped.
+
+"Don't know what they'll do. They're a plumb crazy lot," growled the old
+tar. "It was a mistake to take such fellers as Semmel and Peterson and
+Shamhaven aboard."
+
+"That is true, but when Devine and Larson got sick and went to the
+hospital at Manila I had to get somebody," answered Captain Ponsberry.
+He brought out several pistols. "Here, Larry, take one of these, and a
+cutlass, too, and you, Striker, can arm yourself likewise."
+
+There was no time to answer, for the master of the schooner was already
+striding through the cabin in the direction of the companionway. An
+instant later came a yell from the deck, followed by heavy footsteps and
+then the report of a pistol.
+
+"Drive dem to de cabin!" came in the voice of Semmel. "Drive dem along,
+kvick!" And then followed another yell and the sounds of half a dozen
+blows.
+
+"Below there!" came in Tom Grandon's voice. "Help! help!"
+
+"I'm coming!" called up Captain Ponsberry.
+
+"Don't you dare to step on deck, captain!" yelled down the voice of
+Shamhaven. "Don't you dare to do it!" And the sailor appeared, pistol in
+hand, at the top of the companionway.
+
+"Shamhaven, what does this mean?" demanded the master of the _Columbia_.
+
+"It means that we have taken possession of the ship, that's what it
+means," came from Groot.
+
+"Of you come up here, you maybe git killed," put in Ostag Semmel. "You
+stay down dare, you hear?" And then, as the captain started to mount the
+stairs, he threw down a belaying pin. In the semi-darkness the captain
+did not see the object, and it struck him on the top of the head,
+rendering him partly unconscious.
+
+Larry and Luke were close behind their leader and both were alarmed to
+see him go down, uttering a deep groan as he did so.
+
+"Is he killed?" questioned the young second mate.
+
+"I don't know," was the old tar's response. "Shall we go up?"
+
+"Keep back there!" was the call from above. "Put a step on those stairs
+and it will be the worse for you!"
+
+At that moment came a cry from Cal Vincent. The boatswain had been
+attacked from behind and was given no chance to defend himself. Then
+came a roar from Jeff, who came rushing toward the companionway as if
+all the demons of the deep were behind him.
+
+"Sabe me! sabe me!" he screamed. "Da is gwine to pirate de ship! Sabe
+me!" And then he came plunging down headlong, directly on top of Larry,
+Luke, and the prostrate captain.
+
+This unexpected coming of Jeff sent the young second mate and the old
+tar flat on Captain Ponsberry, and for the moment there was a struggle
+all around. In the meantime some sailors on the deck began to drag a
+heavy hatch toward the stairs. Soon this was placed in position, and
+then those below were virtually prisoners.
+
+"Oh my, sabe me!" groaned Jeff once more, as he managed to get on his
+feet in the cabin, followed by Larry and Luke. "Don't you let dem swing
+me from de yardarm!"
+
+"Jeff, where are Grandon and Vincent?" demanded Larry.
+
+"I dunno, sah--dead, I guess," answered the cook. "Oh, dis am de
+awfulest t'ing wot I eber heard tell ob!" he added, woefully, and wrung
+his hands.
+
+The lantern in the cabin was turned up and Larry gave his attention once
+more to Captain Ponsberry, who was now opening his eyes.
+
+"Oh, my head!" came with a shiver. "My head!"
+
+"I'm glad they didn't kill you," said Larry, kindly. "Luke, help me
+carry him into the cabin. We'll put him on the couch."
+
+This was done, and they did what they could to make the master of the
+schooner comfortable. But it was a good half-hour before Captain
+Ponsberry could sit up and do any rational thinking.
+
+On deck all had become suddenly quiet. Occasionally those below could
+hear a footstep near the companionway, showing that one or more of the
+mutineers were on guard. The hatch shut off the view on deck, and the
+windows in the ceiling of the cabin were also boarded over from the
+outside.
+
+"They have us like rats in a trap," said Larry, bitterly.
+
+"And for all we know Vincent and Grandon are both dead," returned Luke
+Striker, soberly. "I must say, lad, we seem to be in a bad way and no
+mistake."
+
+"Dey'll throw us overboard, I know dey will!" groaned Jeff, who was
+almost white with terror. "I neber see sech goin's-on in all ma life!"
+
+To fight the mutineers further was, just then, out of the question, and
+Larry turned his attention again to Captain Ponsberry. At last the
+captain seemed fully to comprehend what had occurred. He once more moved
+toward the companionway, pistol in hand.
+
+"You can't get out that way, sir," said Larry. "They have placed the
+fore hatch over the stairs."
+
+"And they are armed, too," put in Luke. "Be careful, sir, or they'll
+shoot you down."
+
+"And this on my own ship!" came bitterly from the master of the
+_Columbia_. "That is what I get for treating the dogs better than they
+deserve. Where are Grandon and Vincent?"
+
+"Either shot down or taken prisoners. They called for help, and that was
+the last we heard of them."
+
+"And are all the others in this dastardly plot?"
+
+"I reckon they are," answered Luke. "Them foreigners, Semmel an'
+Peterson, must have stirred 'em up powerfully."
+
+Still weak from the blow received, Captain Ponsberry sank down once more
+on the cabin couch. There was a lump as big as a walnut on the top of
+his head, and he had Jeff bathe it with water and then with witch-hazel,
+which made it a trifle more comfortable.
+
+A short while later came a sudden wild song from the deck of the
+schooner, followed by a clinking of glasses.
+
+"They are treating themselves to grog," said Luke. "I suppose, now they
+have the run of things, they'll drink all they want of the stuff."
+
+"More than likely," returned the captain. "Well, it is their turn just
+now--perhaps before long it will be my turn!" And he smiled
+significantly.
+
+
+
+
+CHAPTER VII
+
+THE MUTINEERS IN POSSESSION
+
+
+As my old readers know, both Captain Ponsberry and Luke Striker were
+Yankees to the backbone, and it galled them exceedingly to see the
+schooner in the hands of a number of mutineers, and especially
+foreigners.
+
+"We've got to git the ship back, no two ways on it," growled the old
+tar. "Captain, I'm willin' to fight to the end, if ye give the word."
+
+"And I'll fight, too," said Larry, promptly.
+
+"Don't you go fo' to fight dem rascallions!" whined Jeff. "Yo' will all
+be killed suah!"
+
+"I would like to know what has become of Grandon and Vincent," came from
+Captain Ponsberry. "As we stand now, we are but four to seven or eight.
+If we could get Grandon and Vincent to aid us we would be six against
+them."
+
+"Perhaps all the hands are not in the mutiny," suggested Larry. "Why not
+try to sound them?"
+
+"I was thinking of doing that."
+
+A little later Captain Ponsberry called up the companionway. At first
+nobody paid any attention to him, but presently the hatch was shoved
+aside a few inches and Ostag Semmel looked down. Behind him was
+Shamhaven.
+
+"Semmel, what does this mean?" asked the captain, as calmly as he could.
+
+"It means dat ve haf de ship," replied the Russian, with a grin.
+
+"You are carrying matters with a very high hand. Where are Grandon and
+Vincent?"
+
+"I not tell you dat."
+
+"We had a right to mutiny," said Shamhaven. "The grub wasn't fit to eat
+and was getting worse every day."
+
+"That's a tale gotten up for the occasion, Shamhaven, and you know it.
+Semmel doctored the food to make you dissatisfied."
+
+"Well, we don't think so," grumbled the sailor. "I don't think so, and
+Groot and the others don't either."
+
+"Has Jack Wilbur joined you?"
+
+"Certainly he has," was Shamhaven's ready reply, but his look belied his
+words.
+
+"Ve are all pount to stick togedder," said Semmel. "You might as vell
+gif up--der sooner der petter for you!"
+
+"I don't propose to give up, you rascal."
+
+"Ton't you call me a rascals, no!" shouted Ostag Semmel. "I vos now der
+captains, yes, do you hear? Captain Semmel!"
+
+"Bosh!" put in Luke Striker, in disgust. "Why ye ain't fit to be the
+skipper 'f a canal-boat!"
+
+"If you try to navigate the ship you'll sink her on the rocks," put in
+Larry.
+
+"You had better consider what you are doing, Shamhaven," went on the
+master of the _Columbia_. "Remember, if I regain possession of the
+schooner I can make it go hard with you."
+
+"You no get dare schooner again, not much!" came from Peterson, who had
+just come up, followed by Jack Wilbur.
+
+"Wilbur, are you in this?" demanded the captain. "If you are, I must
+confess I didn't think it of you."
+
+"I ain't goin' to eat poor grub," answered Wilbur, lamely.
+
+"The grub is all right and you know it. It was doctored up by Semmel,
+and I----"
+
+"You stop dat talk!" roared Semmel, and then he added: "Maybe you gif in
+after you are goot an' hungry, hey?"
+
+"What, do you want to starve us out?" cried Larry.
+
+"You see--chust vait!" answered the Russian, and with this the hatch was
+again put in place and the conference came to an end.
+
+Captain Ponsberry was fairly boiling with wrath, but even so he realized
+that prudence is often the better part of valor.
+
+"There is no use of trying a rush to the deck," he said. "Those rascals
+would surely shoot us down. Just now some of them are in the humor for
+anything."
+
+"Perhaps we can do something to-night," suggested Larry.
+
+"They talk about starving us out," said Luke. "Ain't there nothin' to
+eat here?"
+
+An inspection was made of the cabin pantry, which brought to light some
+preserves, some pickles, a pot of cheese, and a tin of fancy crackers.
+
+"About enough for one meal," said Captain Ponsberry, grimly.
+
+"And a pretty slim one at that," added Larry. "But I say, captain," he
+added, suddenly, "isn't there a door leading from the back of the pantry
+down into the hold?"
+
+"There was once--but I had it nailed up years ago, for we never used
+it."
+
+"If we can open that, we might get something from the hold."
+
+"Going to eat machinery?" demanded Luke.
+
+"No--canned goods, Luke; I know Jeff had some placed there, for he
+didn't have room in his store-room."
+
+"Dat am a fac'," put in the cook. "I'se got lots ob t'ings in dat dar
+hold."
+
+"Then that settles the starving question," said Captain Ponsberry. "I've
+got a small saw and a hammer down here somewhere. We can use them on the
+door."
+
+"And that gives me another idea," went on Larry. "The hatch covering
+over the companionway belongs to the fore hatch. If we can reach that
+opening from here, why can't we steal on deck when we get the chance and
+try to make the mutineers prisoners?"
+
+"Eureka!" shouted Luke. "That's the talk, Larry. Fer your years you've
+got a wonderfully long head on ye. We'll make 'em prisoners or chuck 'em
+overboard!"
+
+"The idea is worth considering," said the captain. "But we must be
+careful."
+
+A search was made and the hammer, small saw, and also a chisel were
+found. Then they cleaned out the pantry, took down several shelves, and
+thus uncovered the small door which had been nailed up.
+
+"Don't make any noise, or they'll suspect that we are up to something,"
+said Captain Ponsberry.
+
+"Let Jeff rattle some dishes," said Larry, and while he and Luke worked
+on the door, the cook began to handle the dishes in such a rough manner
+that several were broken. He also tried to sing a couple of verses of
+his favorite song, "My Gal Susannah!" but his voice was so shaky that
+the effort was, artistically, a failure, although it added to the noise,
+which was all that was desired.
+
+"They're pretty happy down there," said Wilbur to Shamhaven, as he
+listened to the sounds.
+
+"Oh, they're putting on a front," growled Shamhaven. "They'll sing a
+different tune when their stomachs are empty."
+
+"I don't know about this mutiny," went on the weak-kneed sailor,
+nervously.
+
+"Oh, it's all right and you needn't to worry, Wilbur. If we stick
+together we'll make a couple of thousand apiece out of this game."
+
+"But what shall we do if we fall in with a Russian warship?"
+
+"Semmel has that all fixed. He'll expose the captain and state that the
+_Columbia_ is carrying a cargo for the Japanese Government, and that he
+took possession in the name of the Czar. With this war on they won't ask
+too many questions so long as they can give the Japs a black eye."
+
+"I see. But supposing we fall in with a Japanese warship?"
+
+"Then Semmel is going to turn the command over to me and I'll tell them
+that the cargo was really meant for the Japanese Government but that
+Captain Ponsberry, just before we left Manila, sold out to the Russian
+agents and was going to Vladivostok. I'll add that we refused to go to
+the Russian port after signing for Nagasaki, and all of the men can back
+me up. That will put the captain and his friends in limbo and give us
+some prize money. Oh, we'll come out ahead, don't you worry," concluded
+Shamhaven, confidently.
+
+The day passed slowly and the mutineers held several meetings, to settle
+upon just what they were going to do. But all had been drinking more
+than was good for them and the conferences ended in nothing but talk.
+Semmel was the accepted leader, but it was plain to see that Shamhaven
+objected strongly to playing a secondary part, and Peterson also wanted
+a large "finger in the pie."
+
+As they worked with care, it was a good hour and a half before Larry and
+Luke managed to take down the door leading into the hold. Even when this
+was done they found on the other side several heavy cases of machinery
+almost impossible to budge.
+
+"We can pry those out of the way," said the captain.
+
+"A foot or so will do it," returned Larry. "Then I think I can crawl
+over the top."
+
+They continued the work, and a little later the young second mate was
+able to squeeze his way to the top of the cargo in that vicinity.
+
+"Be careful, Larry," warned the captain. "If a case should shift with
+the ship you might get a crushed leg. You had better take a candle
+along."
+
+"I will, sir."
+
+Luke was as anxious to get into the hold as the young second mate, and
+he too squeezed his tall, lank form through the opening. Guided by the
+faint light of the candle, they crawled over a number of cases of
+machinery and war goods until they drew close to the middle of the ship.
+
+"Here we are!" cried Larry, in a low voice, and pointed to some cases of
+canned goods. "Beans, corn, tomatoes, salt pork, condensed milk--we
+won't starve just yet, Luke."
+
+"An' here are some barrels o' flour," added the old tar. "No, they can't
+starve us nohow now."
+
+They had brought the chisel and hammer along, and with extra caution
+opened some of the cases. Taking with them all the goods they could
+carry, they returned to the cabin.
+
+"This is splendid!" cried Captain Ponsberry. "With this stuff on hand we
+can hold the cabin indefinitely."
+
+"How is I gwine to cook?" questioned Jeff.
+
+"Over the two lanterns, Jeff. It will be slow work, but our time is our
+own. Luckily there are pots and tins in the pantry."
+
+"All right, sah."
+
+"Of course, I am hoping that we shall not have to stay here long," went
+on the captain. "But it is best to be prepared."
+
+That those on deck might not see the cooking going on, one of the
+staterooms was cleaned out and Jeff went to work in this. In the
+meantime Semmel called down the companionway once more.
+
+"Are you gettin' hungry?" he asked.
+
+"Tell him yes," whispered Larry.
+
+"Why?" questioned the captain, in an equally low tone.
+
+"Then he'll think we are getting ready to come to terms and he won't
+watch us so closely."
+
+"I see." Captain Ponsberry raised his voice. "Yes, we are hungry," he
+called up. "What are you going to send us, something good?"
+
+"Ve send noddings. Maybe you talk business soon, hey?" continued the
+rascally Russian.
+
+"Perhaps."
+
+"How soon?"
+
+"Well, perhaps to-morrow morning."
+
+"Not before dot, hey?"
+
+"No."
+
+"All right den; you can go on an' starve so long!" growled Ostag Semmel,
+and went away. A moment later he met Shamhaven.
+
+"What did he say?" asked the latter, anxiously.
+
+"He comes to terms to-morrow!" answered the Russian, triumphantly.
+
+
+
+
+CHAPTER VIII
+
+TURNING THE TABLES
+
+
+The meal which Jeff prepared put all in the cabin in better humor, and
+as soon as it was over a council of war was held.
+
+It was decided to wait until darkness had set in, and then try to gain
+the deck of the ship by way of the fore hatch. In the meantime the door
+to the companionway was to be locked and barred, so that the mutineers
+could not attack them very well from that direction, should a running
+fight ensue.
+
+As Jeff would be of no use in a struggle he was delegated to remain in
+the cabin, to make as much noise as possible, singing and talking to
+himself, so that the mutineers might not suspect what was taking place.
+
+Each member of the party armed himself both with a pistol and a cutlass,
+and Larry led the way as before, candle in hand. It was easy for Luke to
+follow him, but rather difficult for the captain, who was more portly.
+
+"Reckon as how ye shouldn't have eaten so much, captain," chuckled the
+old tar, as he helped Captain Ponsberry through a particularly narrow
+place.
+
+"True, Striker," was the answer. "But you be careful that you don't slip
+into some slit between the cases and go out of sight."
+
+They soon gained the spot where the canned goods had been found. They
+had now to climb over some machinery that reached nearly to the top of
+the hold, and then over a varied collection of boxes and barrels and
+bags. On the bags lay some of the old sails of the ship and several
+coils of discarded rope.
+
+They were just approaching the open fore hatch when they saw a rope
+ladder let down. Instantly Larry uttered a warning and put out the
+light.
+
+"Somebody is coming down," he whispered.
+
+It was the sailor Wilbur, who had been sent to get some canned goods for
+cooking purposes. He came down the rope ladder with a lantern slung over
+one arm.
+
+"We'll make him a prisoner!" cried Captain Ponsberry. "And let us do it
+as quietly as we can, so as not to disturb those on deck."
+
+The others understood and crouched back in the darkness. Then, as Wilbur
+passed them, the captain caught him from the back and Larry clapped a
+hand over the fellow's mouth.
+
+"Oh!" spluttered Wilbur, but that was as far as he got.
+
+"Not a word! Not a sound, Wilbur!" said Captain Ponsberry, earnestly.
+
+The sailor understood, and being a craven at heart he almost collapsed.
+It was an easy matter to take one of the old ropes and tie his hands
+behind him. Then Captain Ponsberry confronted the mutineer, making a
+liberal exhibition of his pistol as he did so.
+
+"Wilbur, answer me truthfully," said the master of the _Columbia_. "Are
+you all in this mutiny or not? Don't speak above a whisper."
+
+"I ain't in it!" whined Wilbur. "They dragged me in, they did. I ain't
+kicking about grub, or nothing!"
+
+"Are all the others in it?"
+
+"Kind of, yes. Groot didn't care much to go in. Guess he wish he was out
+of it now."
+
+"What has become of Grandon and Vincent?"
+
+"Both of 'em are prisoners in the brig."
+
+"Are they wounded?"
+
+"Not much. Grandon had his thumb cut and Vincent got a kick in the back
+that lamed him."
+
+"Is anybody guarding them?"
+
+"I guess not. All of 'em have got to drinking again. Say, captain, let
+me out of this fix and I'll never go against you again, never,"
+continued Wilbur, earnestly.
+
+"We'll see about that later," was the grim reply.
+
+"Captain Ponsberry, I have a scheme," put in Larry, and he drew the
+master of the ship to one side. "Wilbur is about the same build as
+myself. Let me take his coat and cap and go on deck and down to the
+brig. If I can release Grandon and Vincent we'll be sure to knock out
+the mutiny in no time."
+
+"It's a dangerous game, Larry."
+
+"Oh, please let me do it!" pleaded the young second mate. The hazard was
+one which appealed to him strongly.
+
+The matter was talked over for a few minutes and it was decided to let
+Larry have his way. Wilbur was soon stripped of his coat and the young
+second mate donned the garment. Then he took the mutineer's cap and
+pulled it as far over his brow as possible and turned up the coat
+collar.
+
+"I'll leave the lantern here," he said, and a second later was mounting
+the rope ladder slowly and cautiously.
+
+With his head on a level with the deck Larry paused to reconnoiter the
+situation. He knew exactly how dangerous his mission was and that he was
+running the risk of being shot. But his life in our navy had made him
+bold, and seeing nobody in sight, he leaped out on deck, and hurried
+with all speed to the ladder leading to the brig. Soon he was in front
+of the barred door.
+
+"Grandon! Vincent!" he called, softly.
+
+"Hullo, who's that?" came in the voice of the first mate.
+
+"It is I, Larry. Is Vincent there?"
+
+"Yes. Where did you come from?"
+
+"The cabin." Larry unbarred the door. "Are you hurt?"
+
+"Not much. How are you?"
+
+"I am all right, and so are the captain and Luke Striker. They are in
+the hold, ready to come on deck. We have made Wilbur a prisoner."
+
+"Good enough," came from the boatswain. "The rascals! They ought all to
+walk the plank!" he added, vehemently.
+
+The two men had their hands tied behind them, but it was an easy matter
+for Larry to liberate them. Then each provided himself with a belaying
+pin, and all three of the party stole to the deck.
+
+From the forecastle and the cook's galley came loud talking, showing
+that the mutineers were making themselves at home. One man was trying to
+do some cooking.
+
+"What's keeping Wilbur so long?" he demanded of the others.
+
+Nobody knew, and one of the crowd, the sailor named Groot, volunteered
+to look the missing one up.
+
+"Let us follow him to the hatch," whispered Larry. "Perhaps we can make
+him a prisoner."
+
+"Right you are," answered Tom Grandon.
+
+With caution they came up behind the man, and just as Groot leaned over
+the open hatchway, they caught him tightly.
+
+"Keep silent, Groot!" said Grandon. "Keep silent, or we'll throw you
+overboard."
+
+"Stop!" roared the mutineer. "Help! hel----"
+
+He got no further, for raising his belaying pin, Vincent brought it down
+on the mutineer's head. Groot had been the one to lame the boatswain's
+back and the latter had not forgotten it. Over went the fellow and sank
+down as if dead.
+
+"Drop him into the hold," ordered Grandon, and this was done just as
+Captain Ponsberry and Luke Striker appeared at the foot of the rope
+ladder.
+
+"Another, eh?" said the master of the _Columbia_. "Good enough! How are
+you, Tom? How are you, Vincent?"
+
+"We're ready to fight 'em," answered the first mate. "Come on! They've
+got so much liquor aboard they can't do much to us!"
+
+"Be careful, I don't want anybody shot if it can be avoided," responded
+Captain Ponsberry.
+
+"I think it would be a good plan to dump them all into the hold," said
+Larry. "Then we could nail up that pantry door, put the hatch into
+place, and keep them at our mercy."
+
+"If the plan will work, it's a good one," answered the captain.
+
+One after another they came out on deck, leaving Wilbur and Groot in the
+hold. They found the mutineers equally divided between the galley and
+the forecastle. The only man in charge of the schooner was Conroy, who
+was at the wheel.
+
+As they advanced upon the forecastle they saw Semmel come out,
+accompanied by Peterson.
+
+"There are the ringleaders!" cried Captain Ponsberry, and rushing up to
+them he exclaimed: "Surrender, you rascals!" And he aimed his pistol,
+while the others also raised their weapons.
+
+The Russian and his companion were taken completely by surprise, and
+before they could draw any weapons of their own it was too late. Grandon
+tripped one up and fell upon him, and then Vincent and Larry tripped up
+the other. There was a brief scuffle, the exchange of several blows
+which did little damage, and in a trice Semmel and Peterson were thrown
+down into the hold bodily, and the ladder was hauled up out of their
+reach.
+
+"Put that hatch over the opening," cried Captain Ponsberry to Larry.
+"And then go into the cabin pantry and nail up that door. Be quick about
+it, or they may get out!"
+
+"Aye, aye, sir!" cried the young second mate, and ran off with all
+speed. The hatch was large and heavy, but the excitement lent him
+strength and he dragged it forward and threw it over the hatchway.
+
+"Stop dat!" roared Semmel, in a drunken voice, but Larry paid no
+attention. His next movement was toward the cabin.
+
+"Don't yo' tech me!" roared Jeff, in alarm. "Oh, it am yo'!" he added,
+as he recognized Larry. "How am de battle gwine?"
+
+"We've got 'em on the run--four are prisoners in the hold," was Larry's
+reply. "Get me that box of nails, Jeff--I must put that door back as it
+was!"
+
+"Yes, sah; yes, sah!" answered the cook, eagerly, and brought forth the
+nails in question. Then he helped to put the door into place, and held
+it while Larry nailed the barrier. The job was just completed when the
+young second mate heard voices from the hold.
+
+"Hi, dare, you let us out," came from Peterson. "Ve vill mak it right,
+yes!"
+
+"You keep quiet," ordered Larry, and would say no more. Against the door
+he and Jeff placed several trunks and boxes taken from the staterooms
+opening off of the cabin.
+
+During this time the party led by Captain Ponsberry had attacked the
+balance of the mutineers. There was a brief fight and Shamhaven got a
+cutlass cut on the knee. But then the men surrendered, and one after
+another was made to drop down into the hold, and the hatch was shut and
+battened down.
+
+The only man who was not thus made a prisoner was Conroy, who begged at
+once to be forgiven.
+
+"They got me to drink, captain," he pleaded. "I didn't know what I was
+doing. Forgive it, and I'll be the best man you ever had on board."
+
+"Can I depend upon you, Conroy?" asked Captain Ponsberry, sternly.
+
+"You can, sir--I give you my word on it."
+
+"You won't try to help the mutineers?"
+
+"No, sir; no, sir!"
+
+"Very well then, I'll try you. But, remember, if you try any dirty work
+it will go hard with you. Now tell me, was Wilbur in favor of this
+mutiny?"
+
+"No, sir, he was not. Semmel forced him into it."
+
+"What of the others. Who were the ringleaders?"
+
+"Semmel and Peterson and Shamhaven. The others didn't want to do
+anything but complain about the grub," answered Conroy, and then told
+the particulars of the mutiny from beginning to end.
+
+
+
+
+CHAPTER IX
+
+CLOSE TO A WATERSPOUT
+
+
+It was decided to leave the mutineers in the hold undisturbed until
+morning. This done, those who had been hurt in the scrimmage had their
+wounds attended to, and then Jeff was set to work to prepare a good meal
+for all the loyal party. The galley was in a state of disorder, but this
+counted for nothing, and Jeff soon had matters straightened out.
+
+After so much excitement nobody thought of retiring. Luke was stationed
+over the fore hatch, to give warning of any attempt on the part of the
+mutineers to regain their liberty. He was armed and he threatened to
+"blow the hull head off" of anybody who dared to show himself or make a
+noise. As a consequence the mutineers did nothing. Two made their way to
+the nailed-up door, but finding they could not open it, gave up the
+attempt as a bad job.
+
+As a punishment for his misdeeds Conroy was kept at the wheel during the
+whole of the night. He was willing enough to do the extra work if only
+the captain would forgive him for his actions. The master of the ship
+questioned him closely, and in the end reached the conclusion that only
+Semmel, Peterson, and Shamhaven were the leaders in the attempt to seize
+the ship and that the others had followed after them like so many sheep.
+
+"I am glad to hear this," he said to Grandon and Larry. "I think after I
+read them a strong lecture they'll behave themselves."
+
+"But we shall have to watch 'em closely," said the first mate.
+
+"What will you do with Semmel, Peterson, and Shamhaven?" asked Larry.
+
+"Put them in irons and keep them there until the end of the trip. When
+we reach Nagasaki they can take their choice of leaving or of being
+kicked off the ship. If they raise a row I'll hand them over to the
+authorities."
+
+"You ought to have them locked up."
+
+"True, lad; but with this war on hand the courts won't want to bother
+with such a case."
+
+It was not until nine o'clock in the morning that Captain Ponsberry had
+the forward hatch raised once more. Those below were almost dying for
+fresh air and water.
+
+"I want Wilbur to come up," he said.
+
+"Can't we have some water?" demanded Shamhaven.
+
+"Yes, if you'll behave yourselves," was the short answer.
+
+There was a babble of voices, but the master of the ship paid no
+attention. Each man who had been thrown below was unarmed, so there was
+no danger of any shooting. Presently Wilbur came up the rope ladder
+thrown to him, looking sheepish enough.
+
+"What have you to say for yourself?" demanded the captain, when Wilbur
+threw himself on his knees.
+
+"Don't count it against me, cap'!" he groaned. "I didn't want to go into
+it, I tell you! I didn't want to go in!"
+
+"If I forgive you, will you give me your word to behave yourself?"
+
+"Yes, sir!"
+
+"You won't do any more underhanded work?"
+
+"You can shoot me if I do, captain."
+
+"Very well; I'll remember that. Now go forward and help put the ship in
+good order. Larry, set him to work, and see that he does just what you
+tell him." And Wilbur went off, with the young second mate following,
+thanking his stars that he had not been swung to the yardarm, for mutiny
+on the high seas is a capital offense.
+
+One by one the mutineers were allowed to come on deck, until only
+Semmel, Peterson, and Shamhaven remained below. Those to come up pleaded
+to be forgiven and promised to obey orders in the future and let the
+captain run the ship to suit himself.
+
+During the night, Groot had had a bitter quarrel with Semmel, and the
+Russian appeared presently with a black eye and two of his front teeth
+loose. He was promptly put in irons, and the handcuffing of Peterson and
+Shamhaven followed.
+
+"I have allowed the other men their liberty because you three led them
+into this affair," said Captain Ponsberry to the trio of rascals. "I
+intend to keep you in irons until the end of the trip."
+
+At this there was a loud complaint, and the three made all manner of
+protestations, but the master of the _Columbia_ was obdurate, and at
+last threatened to throw them into the hold again. This quieted them for
+the time being, and after being given a square meal and a drink of
+water, they were marched off to the brig, which was cleaned of
+everything else for their accommodation.
+
+Fortunately for the _Columbia_ the weather remained fair, so that the
+loss of the prisoners was not felt when it came to handling the
+schooner. Those who had mutinied were only too glad to get back into
+Captain Ponsberry's good graces and they did whatever was required with
+an alacrity which was as astonishing as it was gratifying. They ate
+whatever was set before them, and soon reached the conclusion that the
+food was really better than they deserved.
+
+"We were fools to follow Semmel," said Wilbur; and Conroy and some
+others fully agreed with him.
+
+But though it now looked as if the men could be trusted, Captain
+Ponsberry determined to keep his eyes on them. Vincent was placed at the
+head of one watch and Luke at the head of the other, so that, with one
+or the other of the mates, the deck was always guarded by at least two
+persons that could be depended upon.
+
+The captain had hoped for favorable breezes following the heavy storm,
+but these did not come, and day after day passed with the old _Columbia_
+making slow progress toward Nagasaki. Formosa was passed during a bit of
+thick weather, so that nothing was seen of that island. Then the sun
+came out again, hotter than ever, so that Larry was glad to keep in the
+shade as much as possible.
+
+"It's not so exciting as it was a few days ago," remarked Luke to Larry
+one day, when both were seated in the shade of the forecastle.
+
+"I am glad that mutiny is at an end," answered Larry. "It's a great
+wonder that somebody wasn't killed or seriously wounded."
+
+"The men didn't have their hearts in the rumpus, thet's why, Larry. If
+they had really meant business--well, I reckon some of us wouldn't be
+here now to tell the tale."
+
+"I think Semmel meant business."
+
+"Yes, he's a heap sight worse nor any o' the others."
+
+"It was a mistake to take him on board. I tell you, a captain can't be
+too careful who he puts in his forecastle."
+
+"Well, you know the reason--those other hands gettin' sick at Manila.
+But I can tell you, I'd rather have a crew of Americans any day."
+
+"They are hard to get."
+
+"True fer you." The old Yankee tar heaved a sigh. "The old days are
+gone, sure enough. My! my! what times we used to have, when we'd go out,
+every man a-knowin' every other man on the ship, an' all about him, too!
+Then it was like a big family settin' sail. Now, if you go on a new ship
+ye don't know nobody an' nobody knows nobody else."
+
+"I guess you expect to live and die a sailor, don't you, Luke?"
+
+"Don't know but what I do, unless somebody leaves me money enough to
+live like a millionaire," and the old tar grinned.
+
+Day after day passed and the _Columbia_ kept on her course, making as
+straight a passage for Nagasaki as possible. One day there would be a
+fair breeze and the next a dead calm.
+
+"This is unusual weather for this quarter of the globe," said Captain
+Ponsberry to Larry. "Like as not it will end in another hurricane."
+
+"In that case what will you do, release Semmel and the others?"
+
+"I may release Peterson and Shamhaven, but not Semmel, for he was the
+real ringleader."
+
+There were strong signs of a storm in the air that night, but they
+brought forth nothing, and on the following morning the sun came up as
+full and bright as before. The breeze came by fits and starts, from
+first one direction and then another, and the man at the wheel had all
+he could do to keep the schooner to her course. Sails were shifted half
+a dozen times, but without making any improvement.
+
+"The weather is certainly queer," said Grandon. "Puts me in mind of the
+time I was caught in a tidal wave in the South Seas. Before the wave
+struck us we had just such cuttings-up."
+
+"I trust we don't strike a tidal wave," answered Larry. "If it was high
+enough it might swamp us."
+
+"True; but when you're on the deep blue sea, lad, you've got to take
+whatever comes," replied the first mate, solemnly.
+
+Dinner was a quiet affair for all on board, and shortly after the repast
+Larry went to the forward deck, to have another chat with Luke. While
+the two were talking they were joined by Captain Ponsberry; and soon the
+three were conversing about old times once more.
+
+"Do you remember the swim we once took in the Pacific?" said Larry to
+Luke. "The time the sawfish smashed the boat and came after us?"
+
+"Reckon I do," was the Yankee tar's response. "We had a lively swim fer
+it, didn't we?"
+
+"And the time we visited the island and you turned the turtles?" went on
+Larry. "And do you remember that snake that chased us into the water?"
+
+"I do, Larry. Tell you what, we've had our share of adventures. When
+Admiral Dewey----What is it, captain?"
+
+Luke broke off short and looked at Captain Ponsberry inquiringly. The
+master of the _Columbia_ was gazing over the port bow in an earnest,
+puzzled fashion.
+
+"Do you see that little black cloud, Striker?"
+
+"I do, sir!" And now Luke became all attention and so did Larry. "Kind
+o' funny lookin', ain't it?"
+
+"It is odd," answered the captain. "Do you see how it seems to be
+dancing around in the sky?"
+
+"Is it a cloud?" questioned Larry. "If so, I never saw its like before."
+
+"I'll take a look at it through my glass," went on the captain, and sent
+a sailor for the article.
+
+The cloud came swiftly closer and they heard a most unusual roaring and
+hissing. Then of a sudden the cloud seemed to dip down into the sea.
+When it came up, the waters of the ocean followed, and there loomed up
+before those on the ship a waterspout ten or fifteen feet thick.
+
+"A waterspout!" cried half a dozen in concert.
+
+"And a mighty powerful one, too," said the captain. "I trust it don't
+come this way."
+
+"It is coming this way!" yelled Larry. "Look! look!"
+
+The young second mate was right, the waterspout appeared to be headed
+directly for the schooner. But then it shot off to the westward,
+churning the water into a foam behind it.
+
+"It's going away," murmured Luke, when once more the waterspout made a
+curve and then shot directly toward them. It was off the port bow and
+less than a hundred feet away. It looked as if the old _Columbia_ was
+surely doomed!
+
+
+
+
+CHAPTER X
+
+SOMETHING ABOUT WAR AND FIGHTING SHIPS
+
+
+"It's going to strike the ship!"
+
+"It will cut us to pieces!"
+
+"Throw the schooner over on the other tack!"
+
+These and several other cries rang out on the deck of the _Columbia_.
+All felt their hearts come up into their throats as the roaring,
+swirling mass of water came closer and closer, until the spray drenched
+them completely. The ocean was churned into a white foam and the wind
+seemed to suck and blow in all directions at once.
+
+But, just as it looked as if the schooner would be buried beneath a
+veritable mountain of water, the waterspout took another curve and slid
+away, along the side of the ship and off the stern. The man at the wheel
+came close to being carried overboard by the deluge he received and the
+_Columbia_ bobbed up and down like a cork. But in another moment the
+waterspout was an eighth of a mile distant.
+
+"What a--a narrow escape," faltered Larry, when he felt able to speak.
+"I thought we were bound for the bottom sure!"
+
+"Thet's the closest I ever was to any waterspout," came from Luke, as he
+wiped his wet brow. "Reckon we can thank Providence we ain't in Davy
+Jones' locker this minit!"
+
+Captain Ponsberry did not say much, but kept his eyes fixed on the
+waterspout, which was making fantastic curves across the bosom of the
+Pacific. At times it was close by and then it would go half a mile or
+more away. It was a fascinating scene, full of dread, and gave more than
+one onlooker a chill down his backbone.
+
+"I wish it would go away completely," went on Larry.
+
+But this was not to be. The waterspout kept within sight for a good
+half-hour, although it did not come near them again. At last it grew
+less and less, off to the southwestward, and finally vanished
+altogether. The glass was used in that direction, but nothing save a
+clear horizon could be located.
+
+"We are clear of it at last," said Captain Ponsberry, and breathed a
+long sigh of relief.
+
+"Waterspouts are mighty dangerous things," said Grandon, after the scare
+was over. "When I was on board of the brig _Ben Franklin_ we ran into a
+spout off the coast of Brazil, and it knocked off the bow and the
+forward rail and nearly sank us."
+
+"I met one once, off the coast of Cuba," said the captain. "That went
+ashore and tore up the trees like so many weeds for a hundred feet
+around. A waterspout is nothing to be fooled with, I can tell you."
+
+On the day following the appearance of the waterspout the weather
+changed. There was a slight storm and then a stiff breeze sprang up
+which was cheering to all on board. Every stitch of canvas on the
+_Columbia_ was spread and the schooner bowled along right merrily.
+
+"I'd like to know how this war is going on, and how Ben and Gilbert are
+faring," said Larry to Captain Ponsberry. "A whole lot may have happened
+since we left Manila."
+
+"Well, you'll probably get word from your brother when you reach
+Nagasaki, lad; and we'll get word from Captain Pennington, too."
+
+"I hope neither of them has been wounded."
+
+"So do I; but when one goes to the front he has got to put up with the
+fortunes of war. Being a soldier of fortune, as it is called, is no baby
+business."
+
+"Do you suppose the Japs are continuing to bombard Port Arthur?"
+
+"More than likely--if the place hasn't fallen into their hands. They
+want to make sure of their footing in lower Manchuria, and they can
+never do that so long as the Russians hold a single seaport down there."
+
+"I suppose Russia has a pretty good-sized navy as well as an army?"
+
+"Yes, Larry, one of the largest navies in the world. But their fighting
+ships are no better than the ships of Japan. You see, the Japanese navy
+is not near as old as the navy of Russia. Almost all of the ships are of
+the up-to-date types. Most of them have been built since the war between
+Japan and China in 1894 and 1895."
+
+"That would make them only about ten years old."
+
+"Exactly, and I've been told that some of the ships in the Russian navy
+are twenty and thirty years old. More than this, all of the Japanese
+guns are of the latest pattern--just as they are on our new warships."
+
+"I'd like to go aboard of a Japanese warship," cried the young second
+mate, enthusiastically.
+
+"Want to see if it's as good as it was aboard of the _Olympia_, eh?"
+
+"Yes, sir. Of course the _Olympia_ was old, especially alongside of the
+_Brooklyn_, on which my brother Walter served in Cuban waters, but even
+so she was a bang-up fighting machine. If she hadn't been she wouldn't
+have done her share in sinking that Spanish fleet in Manila Bay."
+
+"Well, you may have a chance to go aboard of a Japanese ship while we
+stop at Nagasaki. There must be a number of them at that port, coaling
+up and taking war supplies aboard."
+
+"How long do you think it will be before we reach that port?"
+
+"That will depend entirely upon the wind, as you know. If we get just
+what we need we may reach there inside of four or five days," answered
+Captain Ponsberry.
+
+As Peterson and Shamhaven were now behaving themselves they were allowed
+to come out of the brig and do some work on the deck every morning and
+afternoon. Both begged the captain to forgive them, but the master of
+the _Columbia_ would promise nothing.
+
+"You went into this with your eyes wide open," he said. "Now you can
+line up and take your medicine."
+
+Semmel was exceedingly bitter at not being allowed his liberty for at
+least a few hours a day and said he would denounce the captain at the
+first opportunity. But Captain Ponsberry soon cut him short.
+
+"You keep a civil tongue in your head," he said, sternly. "Unless you
+do, I'll put you down on hard-tack and water." And thereupon Semmel
+became sullenly silent.
+
+Towards evening of the day upon which Larry had the conversation about
+warships with Captain Ponsberry a Chinese junk, heavily laden with
+grass-covered boxes, was passed. Nobody on board could speak English, so
+the hail that was sent over the water brought no results.
+
+"We are getting closer to the coast shipping," said the master of the
+_Columbia_. "I suppose we'll meet quite a few vessels from now on."
+
+During the night an unexpected gale came up and the schooner was blown
+far out of her course. The gale came from the westward, so the vessel
+was blown to the east.
+
+"This will make the trip a day or two longer," grumbled Grandon, after
+the gale had spent itself.
+
+"Yes, but as we didn't lose a spar or a rag of canvas we can be thankful
+that it is no worse," responded Larry, who was always ready to look on
+the bright side.
+
+The gale subsided after a blow of twenty-four hours and then the bow of
+the _Columbia_ was once more set towards her destination. Only a few
+knots had been covered when the lookout reported a vessel in sight.
+
+"It's a steamer!" cried Larry, for the smoke from the craft's funnels
+was plainly to be seen.
+
+"Maybe she's a warship," returned Tom Grandon, who was beside him. "If
+so, I hope she's a Japanese."
+
+The steamer was coming along at a good rate of speed and soon they made
+her out to be a British vessel. She was a "tramp," that is, a vessel
+going from port to port, picking up whatever cargo can be found.
+
+"Ahoy, there!" cried Captain Ponsberry, as the tramp slowed up. "What
+ship is that?"
+
+"The _Lord Duffield_," was the answer. "What ship is that?"
+
+"The _Columbia_."
+
+"Where are you bound?"
+
+"For Nagasaki. And you?"
+
+"For Hong-Kong."
+
+A little more talk followed, and the captain of the _Lord Duffield_
+vouchsafed the information that he had sighted a Russian warship the day
+before.
+
+"A warship!" murmured Larry.
+
+"Which way was she bound?" asked Captain Ponsberry, anxiously.
+
+"I can't tell you. She stopped us and asked a few questions and then
+slipped away in the darkness."
+
+"What warship was she?"
+
+"The _Pocastra_, from Vladivostok. I think she used to be in the
+merchant service and was built over for the navy."
+
+The captain of the British steamer could give no further information,
+and so resumed his course, and the master of the _Columbia_ did
+likewise.
+
+"Ain't very nice news, is it?" said Tom Grandon.
+
+"It's very unpleasant news," returned Captain Ponsberry, with a shrug of
+his shoulders.
+
+"What are you going to do about it?"
+
+"What can we do, Tom? Trust to luck that we get into Nagasaki harbor, or
+some other port, in safety."
+
+"We'll have to keep a sharp lookout for anything that looks like a
+warship, unless, of course, she flies a Japanese flag."
+
+Word was passed around to those who could be trusted, and all day long
+one of the mates and a foremast hand were kept on the lookout, taking
+turns at looking through the best glass the schooner possessed.
+
+"This is almost as exciting as being in a war," said Larry, when he was
+on duty with Luke. "Don't you know how we looked for the Spanish ships?"
+
+"Yes, lad; but if we sight a Russian warship it will be small fighting
+we'll do, to my way of thinking."
+
+"Oh, we won't be able to fight at all. We'll simply have to rely on our
+wits to keep us out of being gobbled up as a prize of war," responded
+the young second mate.
+
+
+
+
+CHAPTER XI
+
+AN ORDER TO LAY-TO
+
+
+When taking on his cargo at Manila, Captain Ponsberry had considered the
+possibility of being captured by a Russian warship, and had talked the
+matter over with the agents of the Richmond Importing Company and with a
+Japanese official who was doing business on the sly in the Philippines.
+
+The Japanese Government was willing to pay for the cargo, whether it was
+delivered or not--presuming it was "gobbled up" by the Russians, but was
+not willing to pay for the ship if the vessel was taken as a prize of
+war.
+
+"That is a risk you must take yourself," said the Japanese official. "We
+are willing to pay a high price for the cargo--we cannot do more." And
+so the risk--so far as the schooner went--was divided equally between
+the Richmond Importing Company and Captain Ponsberry and the other
+owners of the _Columbia_.
+
+As nearly the captain's whole wealth was tied up in his share of the
+schooner, he was naturally anxious to make a safe trip, and he often
+came on deck to aid the lookouts in watching for the possible appearance
+of an enemy.
+
+"If you see the least thing that looks suspicious, tell me at once," was
+his order, and it was strictly obeyed. As a consequence they ran away
+from two steamers that afternoon and another steamer the next
+morning--all too far off to show exactly what they were.
+
+"This isn't bringing us much nearer to port," said Larry to Cal Vincent,
+who was using the glass at the time. "I don't believe we have made a
+dozen knots since yesterday."
+
+"Well, the old man is a bit nervous," responded the boatswain, in a low
+voice. "And I don't blame him. It's no small matter to lose your craft
+and be thrown into prison in the bargain."
+
+"Would they dare to throw us into prison?"
+
+"To be sure,--if they could prove that we were aiding the Japs."
+
+"Well, they'll have hard work proving that."
+
+An hour went by and it began to grow misty. Then came a call from the
+bow.
+
+"Sail in sight!"
+
+"What is it?" demanded the captain instantly.
+
+"A big steamer o' some sort."
+
+Captain Ponsberry ran forward and took the glass. For fully two minutes
+he did not speak and then he drew a long breath and put down the glass.
+
+"I'm afraid she's a warship," he exclaimed, and his voice sounded
+unnatural.
+
+"A warship!" echoed Larry. "Will you let me look?"
+
+He did so, and it was not long before he could make out the approaching
+craft quite clearly.
+
+"Well?" demanded Grandon, who knew that Larry's eyes were unusually
+strong.
+
+"I reckon the captain is right."
+
+"A warship?"
+
+"Yes, not a very large affair, but still a warship. I shouldn't be
+surprised if she was the converted vessel the _Lord Duffield_ sighted."
+
+"Just what I think," put in Captain Ponsberry. "We've got to do our best
+to show her a clean pair of heels."
+
+"The mist may help us to run away," suggested Grandon.
+
+"Let us hope so."
+
+Necessary orders were given, and soon the _Columbia_ swung around on
+another tack, so that she had the large vessel on her starboard quarter.
+But this movement was evidently noted by the stranger, and the latter
+headed directly for the schooner once more.
+
+"She is after us, that is positive," said Captain Ponsberry.
+
+"There is a bank of mist over to the northward," returned Larry. "Why
+not run into that?"
+
+"Well spoken, lad; we'll do it, and as soon as the mist hides us we can
+go over on the other tack and throw her off the scent."
+
+The mist the young second mate had mentioned was nearly a quarter of a
+mile away and it was a question whether they could reach it before the
+stranger came up. But fortune favored those on the schooner. The mist
+rolled toward them, and in less than two minutes they were hidden as
+completely as could be desired.
+
+"Now to get entirely out of the way," exclaimed Captain Ponsberry, and
+lost not a moment in having the sails shifted and a new course set.
+Through the mist they heard the other vessel steaming around noisily and
+did their best to keep as far away as possible from the sound.
+
+All during that evening and the night to follow the _Columbia_ kept to
+her new course. This was taking her away from Nagasaki, but this could
+not be helped. The captain said if it became absolutely necessary he
+would run into some other Japanese port.
+
+When daybreak came the mist was as thick as ever. But there were signs
+that it would not last much longer, and by nine o'clock the sun was
+struggling to come through the clouds. Nearly everybody was on deck, for
+they realized that a fatal moment might be at hand.
+
+"There she is!"
+
+The cry came from half a dozen throats simultaneously. There, on the
+port bow, loomed up the stranger, not an eighth of a mile away. That she
+was a warship there was no longer any doubt, for her forward guns were
+plainly to be seen.
+
+"We're caught now!" muttered Tom Grandon.
+
+"Not yet!" cried the captain, and gave orders to throw the _Columbia_
+over on a new course. But scarcely had this movement been made when
+there was a puff of smoke from the warship, a report, and a shot flew in
+front of the schooner's bow.
+
+"There's our order to lay-to!" ejaculated Larry. "Whoever she is, she
+means business."
+
+As the _Columbia_ did not stop, another shot was fired, this time just
+grazing the bow. Seeing there was no help for it, Captain Ponsberry gave
+the necessary orders, and down came one sail after another.
+
+As this was done the warship swung around and then those on the schooner
+saw that she flew the flag of Russia.
+
+"A Russian warship!" ejaculated half a dozen.
+
+"This looks to me as if the jig was up," murmured Tom Grandon.
+
+As quickly as it could be done, Captain Ponsberry assembled his men on
+deck.
+
+"Men," he said, briefly, "the officers on board of that warship wish to
+find out what they can about us. If you are asked questions say nothing
+more than that you shipped for the voyage to Nagasaki and San Francisco,
+and that you know nothing about the cargo. Do you understand?"
+
+"Aye, aye, sir," came from those who were listening.
+
+"I must depend upon you to help save the ship. If the _Columbia_ is
+suspected of being in the employ of the Japanese Government, or of
+carrying a cargo for that nation, she will be taken as a prize of war
+and we'll go to a Russian prison most likely."
+
+"I don't want to go to no Russian prison!" cried out Wilbur, his face
+turning pale. "I ain't done nothing wrong!"
+
+"Then keep your tongue from wagging too much, Wilbur," answered the
+master of the schooner, grimly.
+
+"There ain't no use o' fighting, is there?" asked Groot.
+
+"Fighting?" came from Tom Grandon. "What could the old _Columbia_ do
+against a man-o'-war? Why, they'd blow us sky high in no time!"
+
+"No, there is absolutely no use of attempting to fight," answered
+Captain Ponsberry. "Our only hope lays in convincing them that they have
+no right to stop us."
+
+The hands were dismissed and sent forward, and Captain Ponsberry hurried
+below, to burn certain papers and secrete others. This was in accordance
+with the orders received from the agents of the Richmond Importing
+Company at Manila.
+
+In the meantime the Russian warship had come to a stop in mid-ocean and
+now a small boat was lowered, containing a small crew, a coxswain, and a
+Russian naval officer. At the same time a signal was hoisted which meant
+that the officer was coming on board of the schooner.
+
+"Unless I miss my guess, this looks rather black for us," said Larry, to
+Tom Grandon.
+
+"I agree with you, Larry," responded the first mate. "But we've got to
+take our medicine, no matter how bitter it is."
+
+"If only that mist had held on to-day! We might have slipped by that
+warship nicely."
+
+"I only hope the old man fixes up his papers so that he can show a clean
+bill of health," went on Grandon. "You see, if they can't actually prove
+something against us, they won't dare to touch us. They know what Old
+Glory means, and Russia has no desire just now to get into trouble with
+Uncle Sam."
+
+"The worst of it is, our cargo may look too suspicious to them. Under
+ordinary circumstances they know that the _Columbia_ wouldn't be
+carrying such a line of goods in these waters."
+
+"That's true, too."
+
+"Besides that, they may have had an agent at Nagasaki and at Manila
+spying on us. They may know just what is being done. The Czar's
+followers are mighty slick, I can tell you."
+
+Captain Ponsberry now came on deck and gave quick orders that the
+sailors should be lined up, to receive the visitor in a befitting
+manner.
+
+"A little goose grease may help," he drawled, with a knowing glance at
+Grandon and Larry.
+
+The foremast hands did not know much about lining up, but took the
+places assigned to them, on the forward deck. Over the side a rope
+ladder was thrown, and then Captain Ponsberry, Tom Grandon, and Larry
+awaited the arrival of the Russian naval officer with keen interest.
+
+
+
+
+CHAPTER XII
+
+TAKEN AS A PRIZE OF WAR
+
+
+Slowly but surely the small boat came closer to the schooner. She rode
+the long swells of the Pacific with full grace, and Larry could not help
+but admire the long, sturdy strokes of the jackies, as they bent to
+their task.
+
+"I don't know but that they can handle a small boat as well as our own
+jackies," said Larry.
+
+"Why shouldn't they? Russian naval training ought to be first-class,"
+answered Tom Grandon. "They have been at it longer than Uncle Sam."
+
+"True, but that doesn't always count. Spain had been at it longer than
+we had, too, but when it came to war we beat her in double-quick order."
+
+As the small boat came closer they saw that the jackies were mostly men
+of middle age. But the coxswain was younger and so was the naval
+officer, who was gazing rather anxiously toward the schooner, as if
+wondering what the result of his mission would be.
+
+"Wonder if that chap can talk English?" queried the first mate. "If he
+can't the old man will be up a tree, for none of us can talk Russian."
+
+"I reckon Peterson and Semmel can talk it," answered Larry. "But we
+don't want either of those rascals to open his mouth."
+
+At last the small boat came up alongside of the _Columbia_. It was no
+easy matter to catch the rope ladder without getting bumped, but it was
+successfully accomplished, and then the Russian officer lost no time in
+coming on board. He at once saluted, and Captain Ponsberry and his mates
+did the same, and the sailors in the background did likewise.
+
+"What ship is this?" asked the Russian naval officer, after a few
+necessary formalities were at an end.
+
+"The American schooner _Columbia_," answered Captain Ponsberry.
+
+"Would you mind telling me for what port you are bound?" went on the
+naval officer, who could speak fairly good English.
+
+"We are bound for San Francisco, with a stopover at Nagasaki."
+
+"Ah! What sort of a cargo are you carrying to Nagasaki?"
+
+"One belonging to the firm for which the _Columbia_ is in commission."
+
+"The name of the firm, please?"
+
+"The Richmond Importing Company."
+
+"Ah!" said the naval officer again, and looked slightly displeased. As
+it happened he had a brother in the army at Port Arthur, and had heard
+of the doings of Gilbert Pennington at that place, and of how the young
+American had accused certain Russians of trying to cheat the company he
+represented.
+
+"What warship do you come from?" demanded Captain Ponsberry, feeling
+that he had an equal right to ask questions.
+
+"The auxiliary cruiser, _Pocastra_, of the Russian navy," answered the
+naval officer, politely.
+
+"And where are you bound?" went on Captain Ponsberry, bluntly.
+
+"That, sir, is a question only our commander, Captain Titorsky, can
+answer."
+
+"It's queer you are steaming around in Japanese waters."
+
+"Perhaps so." The Russian naval officer smiled in a knowing way.
+"Captain Ponsberry, I am sorry, but I think I shall have to inspect your
+papers."
+
+Captain Ponsberry drew himself up, resolved to put on as bold a front as
+possible.
+
+"This is an American ship, sir."
+
+"Granted, but I have my orders," returned the naval officer, coldly.
+
+"If I refuse to let you inspect the papers?"
+
+The young Russian officer shrugged his shoulders.
+
+"We shall be under the painful necessity of compelling you to show
+them."
+
+"You threaten me--an American captain!"
+
+"There is no help for it--I am simply obeying orders. We inspect all
+ships that we find in this vicinity."
+
+"Do you know I can make you pay dearly for this outrage?"
+
+"You cannot call it an outrage. You are in Japanese waters, Japan and
+Russia are at war. You knew that before you came into these waters. Am I
+to see the papers or not?"
+
+The commander of the _Columbia_ knew that the Russian naval officer
+spoke the truth. Yet he made one more effort.
+
+"Very well; I will show my papers, but I shall insist upon you signing a
+paper that your ship held us up."
+
+"You can send the paper to my ship for such a signature from my
+captain," said the Russian, evasively.
+
+By this time four of the jackies of the small boat had come on board.
+All were armed and they lined up at the rail, close to the rope ladder.
+They were good-natured sailors and grinned broadly at the hands on the
+_Columbia_. Not one could speak a word of English, so conversation with
+them was impossible.
+
+Captain Ponsberry led the way to the cabin of the _Columbia_ and the
+young Russian officer followed. Getting out such papers as had been
+prepared for the occasion, the master of the schooner passed them over.
+
+"These are correct so far as they go," said the Russian, after an
+examination lasting ten minutes had been made. "But----" he paused. "You
+have no further papers?"
+
+"Those are my papers, sir," answered Captain Ponsberry, briefly.
+
+"Then I will look at a specified list of your cargo."
+
+"I haven't such a list," was the answer, which was true, as the list had
+been burnt up just a short while before.
+
+At this statement the young Russian frowned. "Every ship carries such a
+list."
+
+"Still, I haven't any."
+
+"In that case, I shall have to order an inspection of the cargo."
+
+"Sir, you are going too far!" said Captain Ponsberry, sternly, yet he
+knew he had no right to expect anything else.
+
+"If I am going too far, I am able to take the consequences," returned
+the Russian, who was acting strictly under orders.
+
+"Very well, sir; you can look the cargo over," answered Captain
+Ponsberry. "But I shall hold Russia accountable for the outrage."
+
+The Russian naval officer bowed and hastened up to the deck. He spoke in
+his native tongue to one of the jackies who carried several small flags
+under his arm. At once the Jackie began to wig-wag to the warship for
+further instructions.
+
+"Search the ship," came back the order, and in a few minutes more
+another small boat left the side of the _Pocastra_, containing an
+officer and a crew of eight.
+
+"We are in for it now, that is certain," observed Larry. "They are not
+going to let us go until they are sure we are O. K."
+
+The second boat was soon alongside of the schooner, and the officer in
+charge and four men came up on the deck and joined the other Russians
+already there. An earnest conversation was held between the two
+officers.
+
+"We'll take a general look at the cargo," said the one who had just
+arrived. "It will not do to go too far--in case we find everything as it
+should be. We want no trouble with the Yankee government."
+
+Captain Ponsberry was asked to have the mizzen hatch opened, and this
+work was done by Luke Striker and several others. Then two of the
+Russian sailors were sent below, and one of the officers went along.
+
+In the meantime, Peterson, unknown to anybody on board, had slipped off
+to the brig. Here he found Ostag Semmel in solitary confinement.
+
+"Semmel, a Russian warship is close at hand," he said, hurriedly. "An
+officer and some men have just boarded us."
+
+"Release me, Peterson!" returned the Russian sailor. "Release me and I
+will show Captain Ponsberry what I can do!"
+
+"You will not get me into trouble?" questioned Peterson, anxiously.
+
+"No. Quick--I am sure we can make money out of this."
+
+With an iron bar, Peterson pried off the lock which had been put on the
+door of the brig, and drew back the bolt. Then Semmel came out of his
+prison, with his hands linked together.
+
+As he was making his way to the stern deck Larry caught sight of him.
+
+"Stop!" he called out, in alarm, realizing what Semmel might do. "Stop,
+Semmel!" and he ran to capture the rascal.
+
+"Get out da vay!" roared the Russian and aimed a blow at Larry's head.
+But the young second mate dodged and then caught the Russian by the
+legs, hurling him flat on his breast. But now Peterson came behind and
+gave Larry a vicious kick in the side, which made the youth let go his
+hold.
+
+"What's the row there?" called out Captain Ponsberry, and looked much
+disturbed to see the escaped prisoner. "Put him back where he came
+from!"
+
+"Help!" yelled Semmel, in Russian. "Help, in the name of the Czar! I am
+a Russian subject! This ship is in the employ of the Japanese
+Government!"
+
+"He speaks the truth!" called out Peterson, also in Russian. "Help us
+and protect us and we will prove it!" And he ran forward to where the
+Russian officer on deck was standing.
+
+"You are Russians?" asked the officer, quickly.
+
+"We are."
+
+"Then I shall certainly assist you." He raised his voice. "Let that man
+go!" And he pointed at Semmel, now surrounded by Larry, Luke, and Cal
+Vincent.
+
+The latter words were uttered in English, so all of our friends
+understood them. The two sailors looked inquiringly at the young second
+mate.
+
+"He is nothing but a mutineer," said Larry. "We locked him up for it. He
+ought to have been strung up on the yardarm," he added, bitterly.
+
+By this time Captain Ponsberry was on the scene, and those who had gone
+below were summoned on deck once more. The captain glared at Semmel, who
+lost no time in shrinking behind the Russian officers for protection.
+
+"I can prove the cargo on this ship belongs to the Japanese Government,"
+said Ostag Semmel. "My friend can prove it, too," he added, pointing to
+Peterson. "It is true we tried to seize the ship--to take her to
+Vladivostok, or some other Russian port, as a prize."
+
+"This is assuredly interesting," said the leading Russian officer. "Tell
+me your tale in full."
+
+Despite Captain Ponsberry's protests Semmel told his story in his own
+way, and Peterson corroborated it in every detail. Then Shamhaven,
+thinking to curry favor, came forward.
+
+"They tell the strict truth," he said. "I worked with them. We did what
+we could for the benefit of the Russian Government. Every bit of cargo
+on this ship belongs to the Japanese Government and was to be taken
+ashore at Nagasaki. The last cargo of the _Columbia_ was also sold at
+Nagasaki to the Japanese Government."
+
+"When was this?"
+
+"About two months ago."
+
+More questions were put to Semmel, Peterson, and Shamhaven, and at last
+the Russian naval officer turned grimly to Captain Ponsberry.
+
+"I have heard their story, and it will be unnecessary to make an
+inspection of your cargo, since they have told me of what it consists.
+In the name of Russia I claim this ship as a prize of war, and you and
+your crew must consider yourselves prisoners."
+
+
+
+
+CHAPTER XIII
+
+PRISONERS ON THE "POCASTRA"
+
+
+Captain Ponsberry had feared the result ever since the unexpected
+appearance of Ostag Semmel, so he was not very much surprised when the
+Russian naval officer stated that he should consider the _Columbia_ as a
+war prize and place those on board under arrest as prisoners of war.
+
+"This is a high-handed proceeding," said he, as calmly as possible,
+although his mind was in a whirl.
+
+"I do not think so," answered the Russian officer. "Do you submit or
+not?"
+
+"Since it would be useless to fight, we shall have to submit," answered
+the master of the schooner. "But, remember, I shall hold you and the
+Russian Government responsible for all you do."
+
+"As you have said that before, there is no use of repeating it, Captain
+Ponsberry. We will take command of the vessel at once."
+
+"What are we going to do?" whispered Larry to Tom Grandon.
+
+"I don't know--follow the old man, I reckon," answered the first mate.
+
+"We shall place a prize crew on this ship," went on the Russian officer.
+"These men"--pointing to Semmel, Peterson, and Shamhaven--"can remain on
+board. The remainder of the crew and the officers, will be transferred
+to the _Pocastra_. I will give you a quarter of an hour in which to
+attend to your luggage. Please take no more along than is necessary."
+
+"This is certainly high-handed!" cried Larry.
+
+"So we've got to go over to that old coal box, eh?" grumbled Luke, when
+he heard the news. "It's hard luck, Larry."
+
+"You're right, Luke, but it can't be helped."
+
+"What will they do with us?"
+
+"I haven't the least idea."
+
+"Will they take us to Russia?"
+
+"I suppose so--or stow us away in one of those cold and dirty Siberian
+prisons until we can get Uncle Sam to make them release us."
+
+When it came time to depart from the _Columbia_ Larry was allowed to
+take only a bundle of clothing along, and Grandon and the common sailors
+were treated no better. The captain was allowed a trunk and a suit case.
+In the meantime Semmel was questioned once more, and what he had to tell
+made the Russians look darkly at our friends.
+
+"He is pumping all sorts of falsehoods into them, I suppose," said Larry
+to Luke, and he was right. Semmel made it appear that Captain Ponsberry
+was really an agent of the Japanese Government and that he (Semmel) had
+done his best to gain possession of the ship wholly for the benefit of
+his own country.
+
+"If you really did this, it is very worthy of you," said one of the
+officers. "But we shall have to investigate before we accept your story
+in full." This was not so encouraging, but with it Ostag Semmel had to
+be content.
+
+Fearing that a Japanese warship might put in an appearance at any
+moment, the Russians lost no time in transferring the officers and men
+of the _Columbia_ to the _Pocastra_ and at the same time a prize crew of
+two officers and ten men were taken from the warship to the schooner.
+Then the sails of the _Columbia_ were hoisted and off she set to the
+eastward, and the warship moved in the same direction.
+
+When placed aboard the _Pocastra_ Captain Ponsberry was treated politely
+and given a small room of his own. But the mates and the ordinary seamen
+were not so fortunate. Grandon, Larry, and Luke Striker were hustled off
+to a prison pen on one deck of the auxiliary cruiser, and the others to
+another pen below, which was even worse.
+
+"This is certainly hard luck," said Larry, as he threw his bundle into a
+corner and sat down on an iron bench, while Grandon and Luke did the
+same. "And after we had almost reached Nagasaki, too!"
+
+"Well, there ain't no use to cry over spilt milk," came from Luke.
+"We're prisoners o' war, an' I reckon as how we have got to make the
+best o' it. Ain't the first time we've been in sech a fix."
+
+"That is true, Luke, but it doesn't help the matter any. I guess we have
+seen the last of the old _Columbia_."
+
+"I was afraid of this sort of thing happening ever since we left
+Manila," came from Grandon. "I told the old man to be careful, that----"
+
+"Hush!" whispered Larry. "They may be listening--to make sure that they
+have caught the right parties."
+
+"True for you, Larry; I won't say another word about that. But it looks
+dismal, no two ways on't," and the first mate drew a mountainous sigh.
+
+The prison pen into which they had been placed was an iron structure,
+reaching from floor to ceiling, and was not over ten feet square. It had
+a solid back and the remaining three sides were built up of stout iron
+bars, only a couple of inches apart. There was a door which was doubly
+locked, the key being held by a petty officer who could speak broken
+English and who rejoiced in the simple name of Rosenvischpoff. For short
+Luke nicknamed him Rosey and this name stuck to him.
+
+"Doesn't look as if a fellow could break out of here very easily," said
+Larry, after an inspection of their prison. "This is a regular bank
+vault."
+
+"Wouldn't do you any good to break out," returned Grandon. "As we are on
+the ocean, where would you go to?"
+
+"We might hide until the vessel made a landing."
+
+"Humph, and that would be in some Russian port, so you'd be just as bad
+off."
+
+"Well, I'm not trying to escape just now. I want to get the lay of the
+land first, and try to find out what they are going to do with us."
+
+From Rosenvischpoff they learned that the _Pocastra_ was one of a large
+number of steamers of various Russian lines which had been lately
+pressed into the service of the national navy. She had been rushed
+through at one of the Russian navy yards and provided with a battery of
+four small and four large guns, none, however, over eight inches. She
+carried a crew of one hundred and eighty men, drafted principally from
+other warships. She had an advertised speed of twenty knots an hour but
+rarely made over seventeen or eighteen. She was old and her engines were
+constantly in need of repair, much to the disgust of Captain Titorsky,
+her commander.
+
+"Well, Rosey, how goes this war?" asked Luke, pleasantly, as the petty
+officer came around to give them something to eat.
+
+"Big fight all der dime," answered Rosenvischpoff. "Russians kill all
+der Japs--sink all der Jap ships, yes!"
+
+"You're winning right along, eh?"
+
+"Yes, Russians win--Japs no do noddings, no!" And the petty officer left
+the food on the bench and hurried away again.
+
+"Do you believe that?" asked Larry.
+
+"No, I don't," came from Grandon. "He told us that simply to scare us,
+or else he doesn't know the real truth."
+
+"Exactly what I think."
+
+"These Russians are a lot of blowers," growled Luke. "Just look at
+Semmel. He was forever tooting his horn, and yet he couldn't do much of
+anything."
+
+"He got us into trouble," said Larry, quickly.
+
+"That's true, but he had to have this warship with all on board to help
+him."
+
+The food which had been brought to them consisted of a big bowl of stew,
+with three spoons, and three chunks of black bread.
+
+"They are going to treat us to the best," said Grandon, sarcastically.
+He lifted one of the spoons and tasted the stew. "Phew, it's hot enough!
+Pepper, garlic, and hot water!"
+
+"Does beat all how these fureigners do love their garlic," grumbled
+Luke. "'Twas the same way with them Spaniards in the Philippines."
+
+"Garlic and grease," added Larry. "And this bread is hard enough to
+build a wall with," he continued. "However, we have got to eat or go
+hungry." And he partook of just enough to stay his stomach. Luke and
+Grandon were not so particular and despite their grumbling managed to
+make away with all that remained.
+
+They saw nothing of the captain, or of the sailors who had been taken
+below, and the time hung heavily on their hands. At night they were
+given three hammocks and these they slung from one side of the prison to
+the other and rested as well as could be expected. The Russian sailors
+often came to the pen to gaze at them, but they had been warned not to
+attempt to converse with the prisoners, so nothing was said.
+
+On the afternoon of the third day aboard of the _Pocastra_, those in the
+pen heard a loud shouting on deck, followed by a rush of feet. Larry,
+who was resting in the corner for the want of something better to do,
+leaped up.
+
+"Something is doing!" he cried to his companions.
+
+"Here comes Captain Ponsberry," ejaculated Tom Grandon.
+
+He was right, the captain was coming up in company with Rosenvischpoff
+and two sailors. The Russian petty officer opened the door of the pen
+and Captain Ponsberry was thrust inside. Then the door was locked as
+before.
+
+"How are you, boys?" cried the captain, cordially. "All well, I hope."
+
+"We are," answered Grandon. "And you?"
+
+"I'm well enough, but still angry to think that we lost the _Columbia_."
+
+"So are we angry," said Larry. "But we've got to stand it. What's that
+noise?"
+
+"They have sighted a Chinese junk, and I reckon they are going to treat
+her as they did our vessel," answered the captain.
+
+The noise on deck continued, followed by quarter of an hour of silence.
+Then came a shot, followed by a second and a third.
+
+"Another order to lay-to," said Larry. "Wonder if the Chinamen will give
+in as we did?"
+
+"They will if they are wise," said Grandon.
+
+But the Chinamen did not believe in surrendering thus easily. They were
+carrying rice for the Japanese army, and thought that this was known to
+the enemy. Consequently they did their best to sail away.
+
+Hardly had the craft started on a new course when the _Pocastra_ opened
+a direct fire upon her. The noise below decks was deafening and fairly
+shook the iron pen in which our friends were confined.
+
+"Hullo, that sounds like real war!" cried Larry. "They mean business
+now."
+
+One broadside was followed by another, and the Chinese junk was raked
+from end to end with such a deadly fire that more than a sixth of the
+sailors and officers were killed. Then the captain flung a white flag to
+the breeze in token of surrender.
+
+"We have won!" cried those on the _Pocastra_, and it was not long before
+our friends understood. Small boats were put out, and presently half a
+dozen Chinese officers from the junk were brought on board as prisoners.
+A fire that had started on the prize ship was put out after some hard
+work; and then a temporary crew was put on board, and the junk followed
+in the wake of the old _Columbia_, with the warship keeping guard over
+both.
+
+
+
+
+CHAPTER XIV
+
+PROGRESS OF THE WAR
+
+
+An hour after the capture of the Chinese junk one of the officers of the
+ill-fated craft was thrust into the prison pen with our friends.
+
+He was a small sallow-eyed Celestial rejoicing in the name of Won Lung,
+and it was soon learned that he could speak a little English, he having
+once paid a visit to San Francisco.
+
+"All go up spout!" said he, referring to his own ship. "T'ink we safe
+when Russian gunboat come, den all up spout!"
+
+"Did they sink your ship?" asked Captain Ponsberry.
+
+"No sink--shoot holes, back, front, side--all up spout. No fightee no
+more den--all up spout!" The latter was his pet phrase and he used it
+over and over again.
+
+"You were in the Japanese trade?"
+
+"Yes--carry rice. Now Russians got rice, got junk--all Won Lung's money
+gone up spout!" And the Celestial made an odd little grimace.
+
+"Well, they took my ship, too."
+
+"Big schooner your shipee?"
+
+"Yes."
+
+"Won Lung weep for you--all ship gone up spout, samee like Won Lung's
+ship gone up spout!"
+
+"Well, we haven't gone up the spout yet," put in Larry, with a laugh.
+"Let us thank fortune that we are alive and well."
+
+"Dat so--Won Lung lose fliends on junk--six, seven, ten--don't know how
+many yet," and the Chinese officer shook his head sadly. "Bad war, bad!"
+
+"Can you tell us how the war is going?" asked Tom Grandon. "These
+Russians say everything is a Russian victory."
+
+"Russians sayee dat?"
+
+"Yes--they pretend to say they have the Japs about beaten."
+
+At this Won Lung screwed up his eyes into mere slits.
+
+"Big lie dat. Japanese win everyt'ing allee timee. Russian warships gone
+up spout--Russian army run like--like--up spout!"
+
+After that Won Lung told them all he knew. It was hard to understand
+him, yet they gathered that there had been another sea fight in the
+vicinity of Port Arthur, in which the Russian navy had come off second
+best, and that the Japanese army that had landed in Korea had driven the
+enemy to the northwestward, over the Yalu River, and was now forcing
+them back upon Liao-Yang.
+
+"If this news about the army is true, Ben and Gilbert must be having a
+hot time of it," was Larry's comment. "I must say, I am mighty glad they
+are on the winning side."
+
+"Didn't I tell ye them Russians are a lot o' blowers?" came from Luke.
+"The truth ain't in 'em half the time."
+
+"Perhaps they do not get the correct news from the front," came from
+Captain Ponsberry. "The censors may keep the bad news back, for fear of
+disheartening the rest of the men in the army and navy."
+
+"They tell me the Russians are very strict about sending out news,"
+rejoined Larry.
+
+"It is true, Larry; no country on the globe is stricter. No telegram can
+be sent without it is inspected, and the newspapers cannot print a
+single scrap of news, or a single editorial, until after the press
+censor has passed upon it."
+
+"If that's the case, I don't wonder that some of the people want to be
+free."
+
+"Russia is more free to-day than she ever was before, and freedom is
+bound to come sooner or later--that is, I mean, not such freedom as we
+have in the United States, but such freedom as they have in England and
+Germany--where, at least, a man can call his soul his own."
+
+"It's a wonder the Russians will fight for their country, if they are so
+ground down."
+
+"They know nothing better, and besides, they are really patriotic. If
+the Czar would only treat them a little better, and give them a little
+more liberty, they would be the most faithful of subjects. But when a
+man can't do at all as he wants to do, and can't open his mouth about it
+either, he is apt to grow sullen and ugly."
+
+As day after day went by life on the Russian warship became almost
+unendurable for Larry and the others. They suffered greatly for the want
+of fresh air, and at last made a vigorous protest to the captain of the
+ship, when he happened to be passing the pen. As a result orders were
+given that they should be allowed three hours on deck each day, one in
+the morning and two after dinner.
+
+"This is a little like," said Larry, when coming on deck for the first
+time. "Oh, how good it feels to breathe fresh air once more!" And he
+filled his lungs to their fullest capacity.
+
+For their daily exercise Larry and Luke were chained together, and the
+pair inspected with great curiosity as much of the warship as was
+allowed.
+
+"It's not so very different from some of our own auxiliary cruisers,"
+said Larry. "But, after all, I like ours better."
+
+"That's right, lad; stick up fer your own country every trip."
+
+"Well, what do you say, Luke?"
+
+"I say I'd rather be on one of Uncle Sam's ships than on any other in
+the world."
+
+While allowed to roam around on deck, Larry often looked eagerly for the
+_Columbia_, but the schooner and the Chinese junk were too far off to be
+distinguished with the naked eye.
+
+"We'd give a good deal to be back on her deck, wouldn't we, Luke?" said
+he.
+
+"Don't mention it, lad; it makes me sick," grumbled the Yankee tar.
+
+"I wish I knew just what was being done on land, don't you? Perhaps this
+war will end soon, and then we'll be set free."
+
+"It won't end yet awhile, Larry, mark my words on that," answered Luke.
+
+The old Yankee sailor was right--the war was far from ended, and here it
+may be well to note briefly what was taking place on the sea between
+Russia and Japan, while the army of the Mikado was pushing through
+Manchuria in the direction of Liao-Yang.
+
+The loss of the great battleship _Petropavlovsk_ has already been
+recorded in "Under the Mikado's Flag." This vessel was sunk by a mine in
+Port Arthur harbor, April 13, 1904, and carried down with her Admiral
+Makaroff and about five hundred officers and men. At the same time the
+battleship _Pobieda_ was also injured by a mine.
+
+The loss of the admiral's flag-ship was a great blow to Russia, and
+while she was trying to recover, Port Arthur was vigorously shelled by
+the Japanese fleet, and many buildings were more or less damaged. Some
+warehouses were set on fire, but the local fire department, aided by the
+Russian garrison, succeeded in putting out the conflagration.
+
+While the Japanese fleet was hammering at the city and the ships from
+beyond the harbor, the Japanese army encircled Port Arthur on land,
+taking possession of every available hill beyond the Russian line of
+defenses. As a consequence, by the middle of May the city was in a
+complete state of siege, nearly all communication with the outside world
+being cut off.
+
+But now came a turn in affairs which, for a short while, made matters
+look favorable for Russia. While the fleet of Admiral Togo was
+patrolling the whole of the southeastern coast of Manchuria and
+protecting the Japanese transports which were pouring troops into the
+country, occurred a catastrophe as appalling as it was unexpected.
+
+On the same day, May 15, the magnificent battleship _Hatsuse_, of the
+Japanese navy, was blown up by mines and sunk, and the protected
+cruiser, _Yoshino_, also of Admiral Togo's fleet, collided in the fog
+with a sister ship, and was a total loss. It is estimated that by these
+two disasters seven hundred men were lost. Among the officers who met
+their fate were men of marked ability which Japan at this crisis could
+ill afford to lose.
+
+The loss of the _Hatsuse_ is worth relating in detail. She had been
+along the coast during a heavy fog, but this had cleared off and the sun
+was shining brightly. Not an enemy was in sight, and all was quiet on
+the great battleship when, without warning, a terrific explosion was
+felt near the stern and a portion of the steering gear was damaged.
+
+"We have struck a mine!" cried some one on board, and without delay
+signals were hoisted for the other vessels in sight to stand by. The
+battleship was drifting and the locality was full of mines. It was a
+moment of terrible suspense. Then came another explosion, greater than
+the first, which ripped large holes through her heavy plates. At once
+the battleship began to fill, and presently she sank like a stone to the
+bottom of the sea. The other warships put out their small boats with all
+speed, and succeeded in rescuing about three hundred officers and men
+out of a total of nearly eight hundred. Among those lost were
+Rear-Admiral Nashiba and Captain Nakao, the commander of the warship.
+
+The _Yoshino_ was lost while steaming slowly southward, after a night's
+vigil near the entrance to Port Arthur harbor. Other vessels of the
+blockading fleet were close by, so each ship had to advance with extreme
+caution. But the fog, instead of lifting, became thicker, and at a
+little before two o'clock in the afternoon the cruiser was rammed by the
+_Kasuga_, another vessel of the fleet. A large hole was torn in the hull
+of the _Yoshino_.
+
+"Out with the collision mats!" cried the commander of the cruiser, and
+the mats were brought out without delay and placed over the side. But
+the hole was too great to be stopped in that manner. Then the captain
+called the entire crew on deck, and ordered the small boats to be
+lowered, five on the starboard side and one on the port. Before the
+boats could be gotten away, the _Yoshino_ listed heavily to starboard
+and went down, smashing the five small boats under her. The other boat
+managed to get away, with only a handful of jackies and a couple of
+officers. The captain remained on the bridge and went down with his
+ship. As soon as possible the _Kasuga_ put out her boats and succeeded
+in rescuing about ninety men, out of a total of over two hundred and
+fifty.
+
+It was a great blow to Japan and the Russians were correspondingly
+elated. Feeling that Admiral Togo's grip on the sea was now weakened,
+the Russian squadron at Vladivostok sailed forth and did much damage to
+the shipping on the northern coast of Japan, sinking several merchantmen
+and taking a number of others as prizes. The Russian squadron also met
+the Japanese transport _Kinshiu Maru_, having on board the 37th regiment
+of Japanese infantry.
+
+"Surrender, or we will sink you!" signaled the Russian commander. The
+Japanese refused, and were given exactly an hour in which to think it
+over. As they still refused, a torpedo was discharged against the doomed
+ship. As she began to sink the Japanese soldiers opened fire with their
+rifles, and then the Russians answered with their machine guns, mowing
+down the Mikado's men by the score. But the Japanese were brave to the
+last, and sank beneath the waves with the cry of _Banzai_! (hurrah!) on
+their lips.
+
+It was an auxiliary cruiser of the Vladivostok squadron which had taken
+the _Columbia_ and the Chinese junk as prizes of war. The captain of the
+cruiser was now looking for the rest of the squadron, but so far none of
+the warships had been sighted.
+
+"They must have returned to Vladivostok," he reasoned, and then turned
+in that direction with the _Pocastra_, never dreaming of what the near
+future held in store for himself, his ship, and his crew.
+
+
+
+
+CHAPTER XV
+
+A SHARP NAVAL BATTLE
+
+
+So far the weather had been good, but following the conversation
+recorded in the last chapter there came up a dense fog, and for
+twenty-four hours the Russian warship did nothing but creep along in the
+gloom.
+
+During that time, for some unknown reason, Larry and the others were
+allowed greater freedom than before. Each had his hands chained behind
+him, but all were separate, which allowed each to roam around as he
+pleased.
+
+"This is better than being linked to somebody else," said the youth to
+his old sailor friend. "Not but that we got along well enough together,"
+he added, hastily.
+
+"You're right--there wasn't no sense in joinin' us together," answered
+Luke. "We can't git away if we want to."
+
+"We might, if we didn't have our hands chained, Luke."
+
+"How?"
+
+"If we all got together some night--providing we could keep out of the
+pen--and stole one of the small boats."
+
+"Easier said nor done. The guard would ketch ye an' shoot ye down like a
+dog."
+
+"Oh, I know there would be a great risk. But I hate to think of going to
+a Siberian prison, or aboard a Russian prison ship."
+
+"So do I, Larry. But even if we stole the boat and got away, where would
+we go to,--especially if we didn't have much provisions an' water?"
+
+Larry could not answer that question, since he did not know the location
+of the _Pocastra_. It might be that they were hundreds of miles from
+land. If so, to take to a small boat with a scarcity of water and
+provisions would certainly be foolhardy.
+
+The fog continued during the night, but swept away as if by magic about
+nine o'clock in the morning. At that time the prisoners had had their
+breakfast and Larry and Luke were between decks, looking at some
+gunners' assistants cleaning out one of the large guns.
+
+Suddenly came a call from the lookout, followed by half a dozen
+commands. As everything said was in Russian, our friends did not
+understand a word, but they soon realized that something unusual was in
+the air. A shrill whistle sounded out and drums began to beat to
+quarters.
+
+"I'll wager a new hat they have sighted a Japanese ship!" cried Larry,
+and scarcely had he spoken when there came a dull booming over the
+water.
+
+"Let us go to the deck an' see what's doing," returned Luke, and both
+started for the stairs. But scarcely had they appeared on the deck when
+they were ordered below again.
+
+Larry was right; a Japanese warship had been sighted, and this vessel
+had lost no time in discharging a signal gun to a sister ship only a few
+miles away.
+
+Hardly had the youth and his friend reached the lower deck once more
+than the Japanese cruiser opened fire on the Russian vessel. The latter
+retaliated, and the booming of cannon shook the _Pocastra_ from stem to
+stern.
+
+"This is a fight for fair!" ejaculated Luke, with a broad smile on his
+face.
+
+"I hope the Japs win, Luke!"
+
+"So do I, lad. But where do we come in, that's what I want to know?"
+
+"If we could only drop overboard and swim to that other ship!"
+
+"No use of trying--some of the fellows in the tops would pick us off in
+no time. No, we've got to stay right where we are an' take what comes."
+
+"Where are the others?"
+
+They looked around, but could see nothing of Captain Ponsberry or Tom
+Grandon. They saw Cal Vincent run past, but he was out of sight before
+they could stop him.
+
+Suddenly a crash above them told that a solid shot had struck the upper
+works of the Russian cruiser. Then came another crash at the bow.
+
+"Those Japs know how to fire," came from the Yankee sailor. "Reckon as
+how they're going to do their best to blow this ship sky-high. I'd give
+'most a dollar to be somewhere else just about now!" And he shook his
+head anxiously.
+
+The Russian gunners were working with a will, and so were their numerous
+assistants. The _Pocastra_ was swung around, and now both ships were
+broadside to each other. The thunder of the guns was terrific and the
+smoke rolled around in all directions.
+
+"Puts me in mind o' the battle o' Manila Bay, eh?" remarked Luke, as he
+and Larry stood at a distance, watching the Russians work one of the
+guns.
+
+"You are right, Luke, only----"
+
+Larry got no further, for at that moment came another crash on deck. The
+_Pocastra_ shivered and heaved, and to those below it was as if she
+would surely sink.
+
+"They're pumping it into us, sure as you're born!" sang out the old
+Yankee tar. "Hullo, what's this?"
+
+There was a rush of several gunners across the deck. "Beware of that
+gun!" yelled one in Russian, and then a stampede followed.
+
+In the midst of the confusion came a fearful explosion from below. A
+portion of the flooring was ripped apart and one of the gunners was
+instantly killed and several wounded. A great volume of smoke rolled up,
+and splinters and bits of iron and steel flew in all directions.
+
+Both Larry and Luke were almost stunned by the explosion and for the
+moment could do nothing but clutch each other in terror. Both were
+struck by the flying splinters, but neither was seriously wounded. They
+staggered back and began to cough, for the dense smoke was strangling.
+
+"Must have been a torpedo----" gasped Luke.
+
+"Or else a magazine!" spluttered Larry. "Let--let us get--get out of
+here. I'm--choking--to--to--death!"
+
+It was really a magazine which had exploded. This tore a good-sized hole
+in the _Pocastra's_ side, in a spot impossible to get at in the
+confusion. In the meantime a solid eight-inch shell struck the Russian
+ship squarely in the stern, doing additional damage and killing and
+wounding two officers and nine men.
+
+Almost choked to death, Larry and Luke crawled to where the ladder ran
+to the deck. The Russian jackies and gunners were swarming up, along
+with all the prisoners.
+
+"Larry, are you safe?" came in the voice of Captain Ponsberry, and he
+loomed up, with Tom Grandon, Cal Vincent, and the Chinese petty officer
+beside him.
+
+"So far I am," answered Larry. "But I--I--must have air!" and he began
+to cough.
+
+The jam on the ladder was terrific, and in the midst of the _mêlée_ a
+Russian gunner and the Chinese petty officer got into a quarrel. The
+gunner threw the Celestial down, but he bounced up like a ball, and in a
+twinkling the Russian received a blow in the stomach which sent him
+staggering back into the crowd and the deadly smoke.
+
+"No knock me up the spout!" sang out the Celestial. "Ship go down I go
+uppee!" And soon he was out on the upper deck.
+
+Fighting, surging, pushing, and yelling the Russians and our friends got
+to the deck at last. Captain Ponsberry had his coat literally ripped
+from his back, and Cal Vincent had an arm almost torn from its socket.
+For this he gave a Russian gunner a rap in the mouth which knocked loose
+several teeth. It was a case of each man for himself, and many fought
+like wild beasts.
+
+At last Larry found himself free of the crowd, with Luke still beside
+him. Captain Ponsberry and Cal Vincent were not far away, but between
+surged a great number of Russians. The _Pocastra_ was listing heavily to
+port and had evidently taken a large quantity of water into her hull.
+
+Two Japanese warships were now at hand and both were firing upon the
+doomed Russian cruiser with deadly accuracy. From the fighting tops of
+the Mikado's ships came a perfect hail of small bullets which sent the
+Russians to the deck by the score. By this fire one of the _Columbia's_
+sailors was killed and Cal Vincent was seriously wounded. A bullet
+likewise grazed Luke Striker's thigh, drawing some blood, but the Yankee
+tar did not know of this until the conflict was at an end and he saw the
+crimson stain on his shoe top.
+
+At last the Russian captain saw that to fight further would be useless.
+The _Pocastra_ was in danger of going down at any moment. The guns could
+no longer be used, and he ordered the colors lowered and put up a signal
+of surrender.
+
+A wild cheer came from the two Japanese warships when it was realized
+that the battle was won. "_Banzai! Banzai!_" rent the air over and over
+again. "Hurrah for the Mikado! Down with the Russians!"
+
+A little while after the fighting came to an end, several small boats
+put off from the two Japanese warships and half a dozen of the Mikado's
+naval officers presented themselves at the _Pocastra's_ side. The
+Russian ship still listed heavily, but after the smoke below had cleared
+away it was ascertained that the damage done was not as great as had
+been imagined. One of the magazines which had been in danger of blowing
+up had been flooded, and the rush of sea water had likewise put out a
+fire that had started in the stern.
+
+As soon as order could be restored on board of the _Pocastra_ a complete
+surrender was made to the Japanese, the Russian captain giving up his
+sword. Then a general conference was had lasting over an hour. At the
+end of that time, much to their surprise, the Americans were asked to go
+over to one of the Japanese warships.
+
+"We'll go, and glad of the chance," said Captain Ponsberry; and soon the
+transfer was made.
+
+
+
+
+CHAPTER XVI
+
+ABOARD A JAPANESE WARSHIP
+
+
+"What a beauty of a ship!"
+
+Such was Larry's exclamation as he stepped aboard of the Japanese
+warship. The vessel was, like the Russian prize, an auxiliary cruiser
+and named the _Mimora Juri_. She was but three years old and had been
+used for passenger service between Japan and China. For such a small
+cruiser she carried an unusually heavy battery, and everything was
+shined up to the last degree,--the work having been undertaken directly
+after the battle was over. The _Mimora Juri_ had suffered but little
+damage during the contest and only a handful of men had been killed and
+wounded.
+
+"This looks more like Uncle Sam's navy than anything I have seen yet,"
+said Luke.
+
+"Well, I don't know that the decorations aboard our ships are quite so
+fine," returned the youth. "But then this isn't an ordinary fighting
+ship. Some of the auxiliary cruisers we used during the war with
+Spain--those that used to be trans-Atlantic steamers--were just as fine
+as this and finer."
+
+As soon as those from the _Columbia_ reached the Japanese warship the
+wounded were taken in charge by the surgeons and placed in the sick bay,
+as the hospital on a naval vessel is called. This was also in the best
+of order, with nice, swinging cots, and appliances of the latest
+designs.
+
+As there were many things to be arranged between the two Japanese
+vessels and the Russian prize, our friends were not interviewed until
+late in the evening. In the meantime, some of the Russians were made
+prisoners, and a prize crew was placed aboard of the _Pocastra_. Then
+the two Japanese warships moved away, with the captured cruiser between
+them.
+
+"Those Russians must feel sick," was Larry's comment. "It's worse for
+them, in a way, than if their ship had gone down."
+
+"Well, we all thought she was sinking," returned Captain Ponsberry. "If
+she had sunk I reckon some of us wouldn't be here to tell the tale."
+
+When evening came, a guard who could speak a little English conducted
+Captain Ponsberry, Larry, and Tom Grandon to the commander's cabin. Here
+they were met by Captain Tonkaka, who, being a graduate of the Japanese
+naval school, could speak not only English but also several other
+foreign languages. It may be mentioned here that the Japanese naval
+academy of to-day is one of the foremost institutions of its kind in the
+world.
+
+"I will hear your story, Captain Ponsberry," said the Japanese captain,
+politely, as he motioned his visitors to be seated.
+
+In a plain, direct manner the master of the _Columbia_ told his tale,
+starting from the time the schooner left Manila with a cargo intended
+for the Japanese Government. He told of the trouble with Semmel and of
+the mutiny, and then of the capture by the _Pocastra_.
+
+"You have assuredly been unfortunate," said Captain Tonkaka. "Have you
+any idea where your schooner is now?"
+
+"I have not, but I thought she must be close to the Russian ship--she
+and that Chinese junk, too. The _Pocastra_ was taking them to
+Vladivostok as prizes."
+
+"Ah!" The Japanese captain mused for a moment. "I dare say you would
+like to gain back your ship?" he continued.
+
+"Indeed I would!" cried Captain Ponsberry. "I'd give a pretty dollar to
+do so!"
+
+"I shall interview the captain of the Russian warship again to-morrow.
+It may be that he will tell us where she is--although I doubt it."
+
+After this a few questions were put to Larry and Tom Grandon and both
+corroborated what Captain Ponsberry had said. They were also questioned
+concerning the treatment they had received while on the _Pocastra_.
+
+"You may be thankful that the treatment was no worse," said Captain
+Tonkaka. "Of late some of the Russians have treated their prisoners in a
+most brutal fashion."
+
+"We are thankful," replied the master of the _Columbia_.
+
+The majority of the staterooms aboard of the _Mimora Juri_ were occupied
+by the officers of the cruiser, but one small room was turned over to
+Captain Ponsberry, and a larger apartment was turned over to Tom Grandon
+and Larry. At Larry's solicitation Luke Striker was allowed to "bunk in"
+with the first and second mates.
+
+"This 'ere ship is jest about next to a palace," was Luke's comment.
+"Ain't seen nothing so fancy in a long time."
+
+The Japanese warships were bound for the nearest naval station with
+their prize. They could readily have made eighteen knots an hour, but
+the crippled Russian cruiser could not make over ten, and so this was
+the rate of speed set for all three.
+
+The Americans were allowed the freedom of the ship and Larry and Luke
+spent many hours in inspecting the guns and other equipments, and in
+watching the Japanese jackies in the gun and cutlass drills, their
+physical exercises, and in their drills to fight fire and to lower the
+small boats. Everything on board ran as smoothly as clockwork, much to
+their delight.
+
+"I can tell you what, Luke!" cried Larry, enthusiastically, "this beats
+the Russians all hollow! I never saw anything so well done!"
+
+"Almost beats our own navy, doesn't it?"
+
+"Well, I don't know about that. But it is certainly just as good. That
+drill to fight fire is immense, and their physical exercises ought to
+make each man's muscles like iron."
+
+"They are a sturdy lot, lad, no two ways about that,--and they
+understand just how to keep themselves in the pink of condition." Luke
+rubbed his chin reflectively. "Do ye know what I have in mind to do?"
+
+"I think I can make a pretty good guess," came quickly from Larry.
+
+"Well?"
+
+"You're thinking that you'd like to join the Japanese navy, just to have
+a mix-up or two with the Russians."
+
+"You've struck the nail on the head, lad. And why not, seeing as how we
+are out here in fighting waters, and with no ship of our own to go
+aboard?"
+
+"Well, I feel a good bit that way myself. Ben is in the army, and so is
+Gilbert Pennington. If they can make a record for themselves why
+shouldn't I do the same? As it was I came close to joining the army with
+Ben."
+
+"So you told me before. But you're a born sailor, Larry, not a soldier."
+
+"I don't deny it. I'd rather be on board of a ship than on land any
+day."
+
+"Yes, to a fellow as gets used to the sea the land seems a strange
+place."
+
+From the Japanese on the warship who could speak English our friends
+learned much concerning the war. They were told that Admiral Togo's
+fleet was keeping a strict guard over the harbor approach to Port
+Arthur, and that a portion of the Japanese army was hemming in the city
+on the land side and had lately captured several hills of importance.
+
+From Captain Tonkaka the Americans obtained permission to station
+themselves in one of the fighting tops, and here they spent hour after
+hour, on the lookout for the _Columbia_. Captain Ponsberry was
+particularly anxious to find his vessel, and kept scanning the Japan Sea
+through a fine spyglass the Japanese captain loaned him.
+
+"If I can gain possession of that ship, I am going to fix Semmel and
+Peterson," said the master of the _Columbia_.
+
+"Both of them declared that they took possession of the ship for the
+sake of the Russian Government," said Larry. "That being the case, they
+should be treated as prisoners of war."
+
+"Exactly my idea, Larry."
+
+"Semmel is a thoroughly bad egg," came from Tom Grandon. "He will lie
+out of his troubles if he can possibly do so."
+
+"It will be a shame if we don't find the _Columbia_ again," went on
+Larry. "Think of those rascals taking her to Vladivostok and getting
+their share of the prize money! It makes me sick!"
+
+"Captain Tonkaka tells me that other Japanese warships are in this
+vicinity," said Captain Ponsberry. "They may fall in with the schooner
+even if we don't. But what they will do with her, in that case, there is
+no telling. They might claim her as a prize also, and if they did, I'd
+have some trouble in getting my property back."
+
+What the Japanese captain had said was true. In order to counteract the
+doings of the Russian squadron which was raiding the northern and
+eastern coasts of Japan, the Mikado had sent out a flying squadron of
+six or seven vessels, all of which, though not large, had good sailing
+powers.
+
+Owing to the heavy mists, the flying squadron became separated, and two
+of the vessels fell in with the _Pocastra_, as already described. Of the
+other ships some proceeded up the coast to Korea and caught two Russian
+colliers loaded with coal and another ship carrying steel rails for the
+Manchuria railroad. The remainder of the squadron put further to sea,
+and on the fourth day out caught sight of two Russian steamers loaded
+with munitions of war. A chase ensued, lasting three days, and several
+shots were exchanged at long range. But a mist, coming up one night, put
+an end to the chase, and chagrined to think that the enemy had given
+them the slip after all, the Japanese turned back once more, to look for
+the other vessels of the flying squadron.
+
+
+
+
+CHAPTER XVII
+
+THE RETAKING OF THE "COLUMBIA"
+
+
+"We are in for another storm!"
+
+It was Larry who made the remark. He was in one of the tops with Luke,
+gazing anxiously to the westward, where the black clouds were beginning
+to pile up.
+
+"Right you are, lad--and it's going to be a heavy one, unless I miss my
+guess."
+
+The storm broke half an hour later, and the wind and rain were so
+furious that our friends were glad to leave the top and go below. But
+some of the Japanese sailors did not appear to mind the lashing of the
+elements and remained on deck as if nothing out of the ordinary was
+occurring.
+
+"These chaps beat me!" said Larry. "They are certainly as tough as pine
+knots. I never saw their equal."
+
+"I'm beginning to think that the Japanese are a wonderful nation," put
+in Tom Grandon, seriously. "I used to look at them as something like the
+Chinese. But there is a wide difference between them and the Chinks."
+
+"A Chinaman isn't in it alongside of a Japanese," came from Captain
+Ponsberry. "The Japanese are up-to-date and very progressive; the
+Chinese are about a hundred years behind the times."
+
+The storm continued for the best part of half a day. There was but
+little thunder and lightning, but the wind blew a perfect gale. Yet even
+the _Pocastra_ did not seem to mind the wind, and all three of the
+warships proceeded on their way at only a slightly reduced rate of
+speed.
+
+"Such a gale as this will play havoc with the sailing vessels," said
+Larry. "I wonder how the old _Columbia_ is making out?"
+
+"I was thinking that same," rejoined Captain Ponsberry. "To tell the
+truth, I'd rather have her go to the bottom than see her taken to a
+Russian port as a prize."
+
+When the storm cleared away, Larry was one of the first to go on deck,
+to get a whiff of "washed air," as he called it. The others followed.
+
+"I see a sail!" cried the youth, a moment later, and at that instant
+came a cry from the lookout. Far to the eastward was a sailing vessel
+flying a signal of distress.
+
+"She looks familiar to me!" ejaculated Captain Ponsberry, and ran to get
+Captain Tonkaka's glass. One glance through the instrument was enough.
+
+"The _Columbia_!"
+
+"Are you sure?" cried Larry.
+
+"She certainly is the _Columbia_," said Tom Grandon, after a look
+through the glass. "She has lost her fore topmast and part of her
+bowsprit."
+
+"And a part of the stern rail is gone," added Larry, after he too had
+used the glass. "Let us tell Captain Tonkaka," he added, starting to go
+below.
+
+The news that the _Columbia_ was in sight was soon circulated throughout
+the ship, and Captain Tonkaka at once signaled to the other warships
+that he was going to her assistance. Then the _Mimora Juri_ steamed away
+on her new course.
+
+As they drew closer to the schooner they could see that the storm had
+treated the gallant old ship roughly enough. Many of the sails were in
+ribbons, and not only the fore topmast but also half a dozen of the
+spars were gone. One end of the forecastle was stove in, and a part of
+the stern was a wreck.
+
+"This is the worst yet!" cried Larry. "They must have caught more of the
+gale than we did."
+
+"They didn't know how to handle her, that's the reason of it," came from
+Captain Ponsberry. "We have taken her through a worse blow than that;
+eh, Tom?"
+
+"I think so," answered the second mate.
+
+As soon as the Japanese warship was close enough a boat was lowered and
+an officer went aboard of the schooner, followed by several of his crew
+and Captain Ponsberry, Grandon, and Larry.
+
+The Russians having the schooner in charge were meek enough. As a matter
+of fact the gale had terrorized them, and all had imagined they were
+surely going to the bottom of the sea. They did not like it to find
+themselves in the hands of the enemy and were astonished when they
+learned that the _Pocastra_ had been captured.
+
+"It was a fearful storm," said the Russian officer who was in charge.
+"Several times I fancied the masts would all go by the board. I shall
+never want another such experience. One man was washed overboard and
+several were badly hurt by the wrecking of the forecastle."
+
+"Were any of my former men injured?" asked Captain Ponsberry.
+
+"It was my fellow countryman, Ostag Semmel, who was swept overboard and
+drowned," answered the Russian officer.
+
+"Semmel!" ejaculated Larry. He drew a long breath and his hatred of the
+man died all in an instant. "Poor chap! That was rough on him!"
+
+"It certainly was rough," answered Captain Ponsberry. "And what of the
+others?"
+
+"Both Peterson and Shamhaven were hurt, but not seriously. They are
+below resting," was the answer.
+
+It was found that some of the seams of the schooner had opened but that
+no alarming quantity of water was running into the well. The Russians
+were asked to surrender as prisoners of war and this they did willingly,
+and were transferred to the Japanese warship. Then Captain Ponsberry was
+asked if he wished to take charge of the _Columbia_ again.
+
+"Will a duck swim!" he cried. "Of course I want to take charge. Hasn't
+she always been my ship? And my crew will want to go with me, I know."
+
+"But the wreckage----" began Captain Tonkaka.
+
+"I'll attend to that, sir,--don't you worry. Only give me back my ship,
+that's all I ask."
+
+"It shall be as you say, Captain Ponsberry. But when you get to Nagasaki
+you will have to settle matters with the Japanese Government. It is, all
+told, a rather peculiar case. In one way, she is now a Japanese prize of
+war, and in another way she is not."
+
+"I understand, and the courts will have to settle the tangle, sir. I'll
+do what is fair, and I know the Richmond Importing Company will do the
+same."
+
+"Then you can go aboard of the ship as soon as you please."
+
+"Thank you very much."
+
+Captain Ponsberry had returned to the warship for just this talk, and
+now he lost no time in getting back to the _Columbia_, taking with him
+all his crew, including Cal Vincent, who was just about able to get
+around once more.
+
+"Hurrah!" cried Larry, "this seems like home once more, doesn't it?"
+
+"That's what it does," answered Luke. "But there is plenty of work
+ahead, I can tell you that, lad."
+
+"I don't care--work will help to pass the time."
+
+When Peterson and Shamhaven saw Captain Ponsberry they did not know what
+to say. The loss of their leader, Semmel, had humbled them greatly.
+
+"I'm not going to say much to you, seeing as how both of you are hurt,"
+said the master of the _Columbia_, briefly. "But understand, I want no
+nonsense from either of you."
+
+"I'll do all I can to assist you, captain," said Shamhaven, humbly. "All
+I want is another chance."
+
+"Which you'll not get from me," was the quick rejoinder. "I know you
+thoroughly, Shamhaven, and I am done with you. You and Peterson aided
+the Russians and you can now consider yourselves under arrest. When we
+get into port I'm going to hand you over to the Japanese authorities."
+
+Both of the culprits wanted to argue, but the captain would not listen.
+Their hurts were inspected and they were told that they would be allowed
+three days in which to recuperate, after which they would have to do
+their share of duty.
+
+"I don't like this," growled Shamhaven, after the interview was over.
+"Peterson, we are in it deeper than ever."
+
+"Dat is so," was the answer, with a scowl. "Vell, ve not put up mit him,
+hey? Maybe, ven we git near shore, we run avay, Shamhaven."
+
+"Yes, if we can get the chance. But I don't know where you are going to
+run to--especially if you haven't any money."
+
+"Ve git money."
+
+"From where?"
+
+"I ton't know dot yet, no, but ve git him, yes. Captain Ponsberry must
+haf some, and dot Larry Russell, too. Vonce I see Russell mit a money
+pelt vot haf some gold in him, yes."
+
+"A money belt with gold? You must be dreaming."
+
+"No, I see him mit mine two eyes. He count der gold. He haf more as
+dirty pieces."
+
+"That is worth remembering," answered Shamhaven. And he began to
+speculate upon what he could do in Japan if he was free and had a money
+belt full of gold.
+
+That Larry had a money belt was true. He had purchased it several years
+before, while on shore duty in the Philippines. He was a saving fellow
+and found the belt useful in which to place his wages and the money
+which he occasionally received from home. Strange as it may seem, the
+belt had not been taken away from him by the Russians, and it now
+contained nearly three hundred dollars. The money was mostly in
+gold,--for he had found that gold could be used no matter where he went.
+
+
+
+
+CHAPTER XVIII
+
+A CLEVER RUSE
+
+
+As soon as Captain Ponsberry was in charge of the _Columbia_ once more
+he set about without delay to put the schooner in proper condition for
+the run to Nagasaki. The broken-off foremast was allowed to remain as it
+was, but a temporary bowsprit was set into place, and the damage to the
+forecastle and to the stern repaired. A temporary rail was also nailed
+up, so that there might be no danger of anybody slipping overboard.
+
+In all this work the sailors and the ship's carpenter did their best,
+and the captain and his mates helped. Sails were also sewed up, or
+replaced, and inside of forty-eight hours the old _Columbia_ was once
+more on her way. The water taken aboard was pumped out, and the pumps
+were kept going two hours each morning and two hours each afternoon.
+
+"She will do now," said the captain, after the heaviest of the work was
+over. "But when we reach Nagasaki I'll have to put her in the dock for
+regular repairs. I shouldn't dare to take her to Manila or to San
+Francisco in such a condition."
+
+"It will take a long time to have the repairs made in Japan," said
+Larry. "All the shipyards are busy on government work."
+
+"True, lad, but that cannot be helped. The law would not allow me to
+sign a crew with a ship that was not seaworthy."
+
+"Then we'll have a long lay-off when we reach Nagasaki."
+
+"Exactly, Larry. But I shan't keep you. If you want to go elsewhere----"
+
+"Not on another sailing vessel, Captain Ponsberry. But you know how it
+is with Luke Striker and myself. Ever since we were in our own navy we
+have had a hankering after warships, and----"
+
+"And you think of joining the Japanese navy?" put in the master of the
+schooner, quickly.
+
+"That's it. You know how I spoke of joining the army with Ben and
+Gilbert."
+
+"To be sure--and I told you I couldn't spare you."
+
+"But now, if you haven't any use for me any longer----"
+
+"Why, Larry, if you want to fight for Japan, go ahead and fight!"
+ejaculated Captain Ponsberry. "I don't blame you. I'd fight myself if I
+was a younger man and hadn't any obligations on my shoulders. I suppose
+Ben is doing great things in the army and you'd like to match him in the
+navy, eh?"
+
+"If I join the navy I'll do my best."
+
+"Will Striker go with you?"
+
+"Oh, yes, Luke and I always go together, if we can. He was my chum when
+we fought under Dewey and he has been my chum ever since."
+
+"And a good fellow, too, Larry--a man with a heart of gold. If it wasn't
+that you and Tom Grandon were with me, I should have made him a mate
+long ago."
+
+"I don't doubt that, sir--and he is worthy of it." Larry paused for a
+moment. "Of course, I don't know if they want any of us in the navy."
+
+"Didn't you tell me before that they had several men you had met while
+under Dewey and some your brother Walter had met while fighting in Cuban
+waters?"
+
+"Yes, but that was some time ago."
+
+"If they took those chaps then it's likely they will take you
+now--unless, of course, they have all the men they want--which I doubt."
+
+"We shall not go as ordinary jackies. Ben got a commission as a captain,
+and Luke thinks he might go as a gunner and I might go as an assistant
+gunner. We occupied those positions before we left our navy."
+
+"Then I should certainly strike for the positions. They may need gunners
+even if they don't need common seamen," responded Captain Ponsberry.
+
+As fortune would have it, the run to Nagasaki was made without incident
+worthy of special mention. Once there was a scare on board, as the water
+in the well hole increased with alarming rapidity. But the new leak was
+discovered in time, and the ship's carpenter had little difficulty in
+repairing it. They also sighted a vessel they thought might be a Russian
+warship, but she proved instead to be a Japanese coastwise freighter,
+carrying lumber from one port to another on the northern coast of Japan.
+
+As the _Columbia_ drew closer to Nagasaki both Peterson and Shamhaven
+grew more anxious over what was to become of them. Neither desired a
+term in a Japanese prison, and both wondered what sort of a charge
+Captain Ponsberry and the captain of the Japanese warship would prefer
+against them.
+
+So far Captain Ponsberry had allowed them their liberty, but through the
+talk of a couple of sailors they presently learned that they were to be
+cast into the ship's brig and placed under guard as soon as the schooner
+dropped anchor.
+
+"This looks black for us," said Shamhaven, moodily. "I wish we were out
+of it."
+
+"I haf a plan got, yes," answered Peterson.
+
+"To get away?"
+
+The other nodded.
+
+"Then let me hear the plan by all means, Peterson."
+
+"It vos--vot you call him--risky, yes. Maype ve get shot--you no like
+him, no?"
+
+"Of course I don't want to get shot. But what is your plan?"
+
+"So soon like de ship come up by der harbor we vatch our chances an'
+trop oferpoard, yes."
+
+"And swim ashore?"
+
+"Maype ve schwim by some udder poat, yes. Of ve got money we go to
+leetle poat--gif Jap mans money to take us avay, you see now?"
+
+"You mean to watch for some small Japanese boat--a bumboat, eh? And
+bribe the boatman to take us to some place of safety?"
+
+"You got him now, yes."
+
+"That's good enough if we can find the bumboat and get the money with
+which to do the bribing."
+
+"Captain Ponsberry got money--an' Russell he got money pelt, like I told
+you."
+
+"Oh, I haven't forgotten about that money belt," returned Shamhaven.
+"And I wouldn't mind taking it if I could get my hands on it. But
+Russell must wear it most of the time."
+
+"I t'ink he not put him on by der night dime, no."
+
+"What do you know about Captain Ponsberry's money?"
+
+"He got money in a leetle pag--I see him vonce."
+
+"How much do you think?"
+
+At this Peterson shrugged his shoulders.
+
+"No can tell dat--maype a thousand dollars."
+
+There was a pause, and Shamhaven drew a long breath.
+
+"One thing is certain," he resumed. "I don't intend to go to a Japanese
+prison, or an American prison either, if I can help it, and if we cut
+loose here in a strange country we are bound to need more or less money
+with which to get along. Without money a fellow can't do a thing in a
+strange country."
+
+"We git money--chust you vait," said Peterson.
+
+At last the _Columbia_ came into sight of the shipping of Nagasaki. But
+it was now dark, and a heavy fog was hanging over the harbor, so it was
+impossible to make the proper landing before the next day. They came to
+anchor and the necessary lights were hung out.
+
+"This is our chance," said Shamhaven. "It is now or never!"
+
+He had heard that Peterson and himself were to be made close prisoners
+directly after supper. He watched his chance and when nobody was looking
+motioned his confederate to leave the forecastle and steal silently
+toward the stern of the ship. Each carried a block of wood, to which was
+attached a bit of iron, to make it sink from sight.
+
+"Now then!" whispered Shamhaven, and threw the block he carried
+overboard. It struck the water with a loud splash, and the block carried
+by Peterson immediately followed.
+
+"Hullo, what's that?" came in the voice of Tom Grandon. "Who threw
+something overboard?"
+
+"Sounded like somebody jumping into the water," replied Captain
+Ponsberry, who was on deck with the first mate.
+
+An examination was made, but in the fog and darkness nothing could be
+discovered.
+
+"It was mighty queer," was Grandon's comment. "Somebody must have done
+it."
+
+"Where are Shamhaven and Peterson?"
+
+"In the forecastle, I suppose. Do you think----"
+
+"I don't know what to think. See if they are there."
+
+At once Tom Grandon ran off, and made a tour not only of the forecastle
+but also of the forward deck. He called the men's names several times,
+and others quickly joined in the hunt.
+
+"They are gone!" he ejaculated, running back to where Captain Ponsberry
+stood.
+
+"Gone? Then it must have been them jumping overboard that we heard!"
+
+"Like as not--and they are a good bit away from the schooner by this
+time."
+
+"Bring a lantern and we'll take a look around."
+
+A lantern was brought, and a few minutes later a small boat was lowered,
+manned by Luke and three other sailors. Captain Ponsberry went with
+them, and the searchers remained out the best part of an hour.
+
+"They've given us the slip clean and clear," declared the master of the
+_Columbia_, on returning. "It was a risky thing to undertake in such
+weather as this."
+
+"Yes, and for all we know they may be at the bottom of the harbor,"
+answered Tom Grandon.
+
+"Which place might be jest what they deserve," grumbled Luke Striker, as
+he helped to stow away the small boat once more.
+
+
+
+
+CHAPTER XIX
+
+THE DISAPPEARANCE OF THE ENEMY
+
+
+As soon as Peterson and Shamhaven threw the blocks of wood overboard
+they darted for the companionway of the schooner and crept noiselessly
+down to the cabin.
+
+The apartment was deserted, and the swinging lamp over the center table
+was turned low. On the table rested several charts which Captain
+Ponsberry had been consulting before joining Tom Grandon on deck.
+
+It was Larry's watch below and he was improving the time by taking a
+much-needed nap. He lay on the berth in his stateroom, with the door
+wide open to admit the fresh air.
+
+"Make no noise!" whispered Shamhaven. "If we are discovered the jig is
+up with us."
+
+"Russell is here, yes?" came from Peterson.
+
+"Sh-sh! Yes--over in yonder stateroom."
+
+They closed the door leading to the companionway and then tiptoed their
+way to where Larry lay.
+
+"More than likely he keeps his money belt under his pillow when he
+sleeps," said Shamhaven. "Wait till I find out."
+
+He shoved his hand under the headrest with caution and presently his
+fingers came into contact with a strip of leather and chamois. He pulled
+on it gently, but it refused to budge.
+
+"Lift his head a little," he said, and Peterson started to do as
+requested. But the movement, gentle as it was, caused Larry to open his
+eyes.
+
+"Wha--what are you doing here?" stammered the young second mate, when,
+waiting for no more words, Peterson clapped a dirty hand over his mouth.
+
+"Keep still, you! If you no keep still I hit you good, yes!"
+
+"Confound the luck," muttered Shamhaven. "I didn't want him to know what
+we were up to."
+
+Larry began to struggle and with an effort threw aside the hand over his
+mouth.
+
+"Le--let up!" he spluttered. "I want you----Help!"
+
+"Shut up!" cried Shamhaven, fiercely, and struck him a swinging blow in
+the temple. Another blow from Peterson followed, and then, with flashing
+lights darting through his brain, Larry lost consciousness.
+
+Both men bent over him to see if he would move. When he lay as still as
+if dead they looked at each other with satisfaction.
+
+"He won't bother us any more--at least, not for awhile," was Shamhaven's
+comment.
+
+"Quick, de money belt!" came from Peterson, and as he raised up Larry's
+head, Shamhaven secured it and stowed it away in the bosom of his shirt.
+"You no keep him!" he went on, in alarm, showing that he did not trust
+his companion in crime.
+
+"We'll divide up afterwards," said Shamhaven, briefly. "Now to locate
+the captain's little pile."
+
+Both tiptoed their way into Captain Ponsberry's stateroom. Here there
+was a small safe, with the door closed.
+
+"A safe, eh?" said Shamhaven. "Wonder if we can open it?"
+
+He knelt down and tried to work the combination lock. The safe was old
+and out of order and the captain had had the combination lock made as
+simple as possible in consequence. Soon there came a click, followed by
+another, and the bolts shot back.
+
+"Luck is with us!" cried Shamhaven.
+
+"Dare is de leetle pag," came from Peterson, and reaching into the safe
+he drew the article forth. There was a slip string at the top which he
+pulled apart.
+
+"Gold!" he cried. "See--dirty--forty bieces of gold!" And then he shut
+the bag again, and placed it into his own shirt bosom.
+
+"Remember, half of that is mine," came sharply from Shamhaven. He
+fancied there might be more in the bag than in the money belt.
+
+"Yes,--an' haf de money-pelt money ist mine, yes," returned Peterson.
+
+"Right you are, Peterson. Now to get away from the ship."
+
+"Let us lock Russell in de stateroom first."
+
+"A good idea!"
+
+The door was closed and locked. Larry still lay unconscious and there
+was no telling how soon he would come to his senses.
+
+They heard the tramping on the deck and the departure of the small boat.
+Now those in the boat came back and the search for the missing men came
+to an end.
+
+With the slyness of a pair of cats, the evildoers crept up the
+companionway once more. Nobody was in sight, and they crawled rather
+than walked to the rail of the schooner. Both were good swimmers and not
+afraid to trust themselves to reach some other shipping in the harbor.
+Yet as an extra precaution each provided himself with a life-preserver.
+
+"Are you ready, Peterson?"
+
+"Yes."
+
+"Then over we go."
+
+A small rope was handy, and lowering this, each slid along it into the
+waters of the harbor. Then they struck out swiftly but silently; and in
+a few minutes the fog and darkness hid them completely from view.
+
+It was the best part of an hour before Larry returned to his senses. His
+head ached as if ready to split open and for several minutes he could
+not remember where he was or what had occurred.
+
+"Oh, my head!" he groaned. "Oh!" And he turned over and tried to sit up,
+with the result that he pitched out on the floor of the stateroom. This
+aroused him and he got up as quickly as he could.
+
+"Those rascals attacked me!" he muttered. "They struck me over the head!
+I remember now! Oh, how my head spins,--just as if I was in a
+merry-go-round! I wonder----"
+
+He dropped on the berth and snatched away the pillow. One glance was
+sufficient to show him how he had been robbed.
+
+"That's why they attacked me!" he cried. "Wonder where they are now?
+Perhaps they ran away from the ship!"
+
+Leaping up again he stepped to the door, and finding it locked, began to
+pound away lustily, at the same time yelling at the top of his lungs. In
+a few minutes this brought down Captain Ponsberry, followed by Luke, who
+had been told to come along, the captain fearing that something had gone
+wrong.
+
+"What's up here?" demanded Captain Ponsberry as he flung open the door.
+
+"Where are they?" came the counter-question from Larry.
+
+"They? Who?"
+
+"Peterson and Shamhaven?"
+
+"Gone--slid away in the fog."
+
+"They have robbed me!"
+
+"You don't say!" ejaculated the master of the _Columbia_. "You are
+sure?" he went on.
+
+"Yes. My money belt is gone. They came while I was asleep, and when I
+woke up both hit me,--and I don't know what happened after that. I just
+came to my senses and found myself locked in."
+
+"The villains!" burst in Luke. "Those chaps ought to be swung up to a
+yardarm!"
+
+The captain listened to Larry's story and then was prompted to take a
+look around the other staterooms. As a result he speedily discovered
+that the safe had been tampered with and that his own money was gone.
+
+"They are worse rascals than I thought them," said Captain Ponsberry,
+bitterly. "I am sorry that I did not make an example of them from the
+start."
+
+There was a good deal of speculation concerning what had become of
+Shamhaven and Peterson, and another search was instituted, lasting until
+the following day, but not a single trace of the evildoers could be
+found.
+
+"Well, I am out the whole of my savings," said Larry to Luke.
+
+"It's a shame, lad," replied the Yankee tar. "But if you need ready cash
+don't fail to draw on me. As long as I have a shot in the locker half on
+it is yours."
+
+"Thank you, Luke; I know you'd say that. You're the proper kind of a
+friend to have."
+
+"Avast, Larry, with your compliments. Wouldn't you do the same fer me?"
+
+"Indeed I would!"
+
+"Then it ain't worth talkin' about. Jest the same, I hope we run into
+them rascals some day; don't you?"
+
+"I do. But more than likely they'll give the _Columbia_ and us a wide
+berth after this," returned Larry.
+
+
+
+
+CHAPTER XX
+
+LARRY BEFORE ADMIRAL TOGO
+
+
+As soon as the _Columbia_ could make the proper landing, Captain
+Ponsberry went ashore and reported his arrival to the authorities, and
+also reported the escape of Shamhaven and Peterson. The authorities had
+already heard of the capture of the _Columbia_ from the Russians, and
+said that the schooner would have to remain at Nagasaki until the whole
+case could be adjusted. The Japanese were inclined to favor both the
+Richmond Importing Company and the owners of the vessel, so it was not
+likely that our friends would lose much in the end. In the meantime the
+_Columbia_ could be put in a dry-dock and given the overhauling that she
+needed.
+
+"We shall do all we can to locate Shamhaven and Peterson and get back
+your money," said an official of the secret service department. But his
+hands were so full with other matters of greater importance that little
+attention was paid to the disappearance of the two rascals.
+
+"Well, this will tie me up at Nagasaki for some time to come," said
+Captain Ponsberry to Larry, on the third day after arriving at the
+Japanese port.
+
+"Which means, I suppose, that I can join the Japanese navy if I wish,"
+returned the young second mate, quickly.
+
+"I don't want to force you to leave the ship, lad. But you said----"
+
+"I know, Captain Ponsberry, and I am glad of the chance to get away.
+Luke and I have talked it over once more, and yesterday we met a gunner
+named Steve Colton--he served on the _Brooklyn_ at the time Walter did.
+He is now a gun captain on board of Admiral Togo's flagship, and he is
+almost certain he can get us good positions. He says gunners and
+gunners' assistants are just now badly needed."
+
+"Then go by all means, Larry, and make even a bigger record for yourself
+than your brother Ben is making in the army. Perhaps, when this war is
+over, you'll come back to the old _Columbia_, eh?"
+
+"More than likely, and I guess Luke Striker will come, too."
+
+What Larry had said about meeting Steve Colton was true. As readers of a
+story of mine entitled "Fighting in Cuban Waters" know, Colton had been
+a gun captain under Commodore Schley, and as such had become fairly well
+acquainted with Walter Russell and had also heard of Larry, who was at
+that time serving under Admiral Dewey at Manila.
+
+A detail from Admiral Togo's flagship had been sent ashore at Nagasaki,
+and Larry and Luke, as they walked through the streets, had met several
+of these men. Hearing two of them speaking English they had halted the
+pair; and introductions had followed.
+
+"So you are Larry Russell," said Steve Colton. "Any relation to Walter
+Russell that once served on the U. S. Cruiser _Brooklyn_?"
+
+"Walter is my brother," replied Larry, quickly.
+
+"Oh, so you are the chap that was cast away in the Pacific and picked up
+by Admiral Dewey's flagship, eh?"
+
+"The same, and this is the friend who was with me, Luke Striker."
+
+"Glad to know ye both." Steve Colton shook hands. "This is my friend,
+Bob Stanford--he hails from San Francisco and is a gunner's mate with
+me. What are you doing in this corner of the earth?"
+
+A long talk followed, in which Larry and Luke told their story, and
+Steve Colton and his friend related how they had come to join the
+Japanese navy.
+
+"It's this way," said Colton. "I've got the fighting blood in my veins
+and it won't come out. As soon as this war broke out, I cut sticks from
+'Frisco with Bob and we comes to Tokio. There I met another American who
+was in the navy here, and it wasn't two days before we were booked for
+Admiral Togo's flagship. We've been down to Port Arthur twice, and I
+reckon we'll go again before long."
+
+"Perhaps we'll go up to Vladivostok next time," came from Bob Stanford.
+"I've heard something of bombarding that Russian port."
+
+Colton and Stanford had a couple of hours to themselves and Larry and
+Luke invited them over to the _Columbia_. In return they were asked to
+come over to Admiral Togo's flagship, the gunners having the privilege
+of bringing their friends aboard during the brief stay in Nagasaki
+harbor.
+
+"You can come aboard to-morrow," said Steve Colton. "They have an
+inspection and drill, and you can see how they do it in the Japanese
+navy--not but what it's a good bit like it's done on Uncle Sam's
+warships."
+
+Larry and Luke were very willing to go aboard of the Japanese warship,
+and were taken out by Colton the next day, and introduced to several
+gunners and others who could speak a little English. They were also
+taken before the head gunner, who took them to the commander of the
+warship.
+
+"They both served under Admiral Dewey at Manila," said the head gunner,
+and this made the commander smile quietly as he shook hands and told
+them to make themselves at home.
+
+"Everything is as clean as a whistle," was Larry's comment, as they
+walked around the forward part of the warship and through the gun decks.
+"The Japs certainly know how to take care of things. Luke, just look at
+how the brasswork shines!"
+
+"That's the way it ought to be," was the Yankee tar's reply. "No
+slackness, an' I'm glad on it. I love a clean ship above all things."
+
+Steve Colton and Bob Stanford were enthusiastic over the gun they
+commanded and explained how it worked. It was certainly an effective
+weapon and Larry and Luke were thoroughly interested.
+
+"I could handle sech a gun myself," said Luke. "An' do some damage, too;
+eh, Larry?"
+
+"Anyway, I'd like to try it," returned the youth.
+
+Orders were now being issued for the inspection and drill, and presently
+nearly all on board of the flagship hurried to the main deck. Here the
+marines were drawn up in long lines, with the officers in their proper
+places. The sailors and gunners were also at hand, each togged out in
+his best, for inspection by an admiral on any warship means a great
+deal.
+
+Presently Admiral Togo appeared, followed by several other naval
+officers of lesser rank. He was in full dress, with many decorations on
+his breast, and carried his sword. He proved to be a man well along in
+years, with a round face, and small mustache and goatee.
+
+"He looks like a fighter!" whispered Larry.
+
+"True for you, lad," returned Luke. "An' I reckon he knows how to handle
+men."
+
+What our friends said about Admiral Togo was true. He was a fighter and
+a born leader of men. When the Naval Academy of Japan was inaugurated he
+was one of the first graduates, and he was sent by the government to
+complete his nautical education in England, where, during 1873 and 1874,
+he served on the training ship _Worcester_, making a record for himself
+as a first-class pupil in every respect.
+
+On returning home Togo Heihachiro--to use his full name--found a great
+task confronting his people. They were becoming civilized as we term
+civilization and needed a modern navy. He set to work with vim and
+vigor, and then and there laid the foundation of that navy which is
+to-day known as one of the most effective in the world.
+
+The navy had scarcely come into existence when there came rumors of war
+with China. The rumors grew, and China became more and more hateful
+toward the Japanese. To the outside world it looked as if China, with
+her vast territory and her immense number of people, would swallow up
+the sons of Nippon bodily.
+
+At last it was discovered that China was transporting troops with which
+to begin the war. Togo waited for no instructions from his home
+government. He went at the Chinese with vigor. The war followed, and
+after a number of thrilling contests the Japanese were victorious, and
+Admiral Togo emerged from the struggle covered with glory.
+
+"He is the man to lead us to victory against the Russians!" was the cry
+throughout the navy, when war was declared between Russia and Japan, and
+how he sent his ships to Port Arthur and other places, and what
+effective work was done by them, has already been related. In the whole
+of the Japanese navy, to serve on the admiral's flagship, the _Mikasa_,
+was considered a great honor.
+
+The inspection and drill were exceedingly interesting to Larry and Luke,
+and they watched both with close attention. After it was over Admiral
+Togo addressed the men briefly and then turned to the commander of the
+ship.
+
+"See, he is pointing to us!" whispered Luke. "Hang me if I don't think
+he is talking about us to the captain!"
+
+"An officer is coming," replied Larry, and a moment later one of the
+admiral's staff came hurrying to them.
+
+"Are you the two Americans who served under Admiral Dewey at Manila?"
+questioned the staff officer.
+
+"We are," answered Larry.
+
+"Admiral Togo wishes you to come to him."
+
+"Oh, Luke, we are going to be presented to the admiral!" cried Larry.
+
+"Great pewter!" groaned the Yankee tar. "I didn't expect this nohow. But
+I don't care," he added, bracing up. "He ain't no bigger nor Dewey. Come
+along."
+
+He followed the staff officer and Larry did the same. They felt that the
+eyes of many of the sailors and marines were on them, and stepped out as
+firmly as possible. Coming up to the admiral, they took off their caps
+and saluted.
+
+Admiral Togo surveyed the two Americans with interest. He had heard how
+they had come to serve under Dewey at Manila and he smiled pleasantly as
+he held out his hand, first to Larry and then to Luke.
+
+"Let me give you a welcome, my men," said he. "I have been told your
+story. I hope this visit to my ship has interested you."
+
+"Very much, sir," answered Luke.
+
+"I liked the drill, sir," answered Larry, with a smile. "It was fine.
+And everything is so clean! Really, I don't think it could be cleaner!"
+
+At this Admiral Togo smiled again. "That is a compliment,--since it
+comes from one who has served in the American navy."
+
+He then asked them to remain where they were, while some of the men went
+through an exercise with their cutlasses. There was also a gun drill,
+and they were asked to show how they had handled a gun during the battle
+of Manila Bay.
+
+"You are well drilled, I can see that," said the admiral, on dismissing
+them. "They tell me you think of entering our navy. If you wish to do so
+I think likely we can find suitable openings for you."
+
+
+
+
+CHAPTER XXI
+
+LETTERS OF INTEREST
+
+
+The enlistment of Larry and Luke Striker into the Japanese navy came
+sooner than anticipated. A new warship was being fitted out at a harbor
+some forty miles from Nagasaki, and Steve Colton and Bob Stanford were
+transferred to this. Two new gun crews were badly needed on the new
+ship, and inside of forty-eight hours our friends had signed the muster
+roll and were put into training, under Colton. The positions occupied
+were those of gunner and gunner's mate.
+
+"Hurrah for Nippon!" cried Larry, enthusiastically. "Luke, after this we
+have got to learn to yell _Banzai!_ in true Japanese style."
+
+"This gun is a beauty," replied the Yankee tar, as he looked the piece
+over. "I reckon as I can make her do considerable damage if I get the
+chance."
+
+"And I'll help all I can," said Larry. "Won't Ben and Gilbert be
+surprised when they hear of this?" he added.
+
+"They might know you'd do something of the sort."
+
+"That's so, too. By the way, I'm going up to the post-office to-day and
+see if there are any letters."
+
+Much to the satisfaction of our friends they found over a score of men
+on the warship who could speak English. Some, of course, could speak but
+little, yet they could make themselves understood. On the other hand,
+both Larry and Luke began to pick up the Japanese language remarkably
+fast.
+
+"If we keep at this for six months we'll be regular Japanese," said the
+youth. "It's not so hard as I thought it would be."
+
+They found the discipline on the warship very strict and were called on
+to "toe the mark" continually. Yet all the officers were as considerate
+as they were firm, so there was little of hardship.
+
+When Larry called at the post-office for letters he found two good-sized
+epistles awaiting him. One was from his brother Walter, and ran, in
+part, as follows:
+
+ "There is nothing particularly new in this part of the
+ globe. I am doing very well in my new business and it looks
+ now as if I should make a big thing of it. I rather think I
+ am more cut out for work on land than for life on shipboard,
+ although I don't regret the time I spent in the navy.
+
+ "Uncle Job is feeling very well these days and is building a
+ new wing to the old house--going to put in a library of good
+ books he tells me. He is as dear an old chap now as anybody
+ would want for an uncle.
+
+ "I suppose you will hear from Ben and Gilbert. I am
+ expecting a letter every day. It's queer you didn't go with
+ them, but I suppose the old _Columbia_ with her crew suits
+ you better."
+
+"I am glad everything is all right at home," thought Larry, as he
+finished reading the communication. "A new wing to the house, eh? Uncle
+Job must be spreading himself. Reckon he has found out there is
+something more to live for in this world than mere money."
+
+The second letter was from Ben, as he could tell by the handwriting. It
+had been on the way a long time and had been sent to half a dozen
+places, including Manila. There was a great deal about life in the
+Japanese army, and also a full description of the capture of Liao-Yang.
+Ben then continued:
+
+ "We are now on guard a few miles outside of the city. Our
+ camp stretches for many miles, and we are doing all in our
+ power to strengthen our position. What the next move will be
+ there is no telling. One report is, that our particular
+ command will help to chase the Russians to Mukden, while
+ another report has it that we are to march southward, to aid
+ in the attempt to take Port Arthur.
+
+ "I have already told you what trouble Gilbert had with that
+ rascally Russian merchant, Ivan Snokoff, and with Snokoff's
+ confederate, Captain Barusky, of the Russian army. Well, at
+ Liao-Yang we found Snokoff disguised as a Chinaman, and
+ Gilbert made the fellow pay over all that was coming to him
+ for the Richmond Importing Company. In the attempt to
+ capture Snokoff, Gilbert shot him in the leg. It was only a
+ slight wound, but the Russian was as mad as a hornet, and he
+ vowed he would get square some time. He is now in the
+ hospital here, but they expect to let him leave in a few
+ days. He really ought to be put under arrest, but as he has
+ paid up the money he owed, there doesn't seem to be any way
+ of holding him. It's out of the question to go to court with
+ the case. I helped Gilbert to put Snokoff under guard, and
+ he is as angry at me as he is at Gilbert. I don't know if he
+ will dare to do anything or not, but both of us are keeping
+ our eyes open."
+
+Larry read this letter twice before he stowed it away. He was always
+interested in war news and he thought the description of the great
+battle of Liao-Yang very realistic. He shook his curly head when he
+thought of Ivan Snokoff.
+
+"He must be an underhanded rascal if ever there was one," he mused. "And
+to think he disguised himself as a Chinaman! I'll wager Gilbert thought
+it a fine thing to expose him and make him pay up. But he and Ben had
+better look out, or Snokoff and that Captain Barusky may cause them a
+lot of trouble."
+
+Larry had an hour to himself, and he spent the time in answering both
+letters, telling briefly what had happened to him since the trip to
+Manila and how he and Luke were now in service on board of the Japanese
+warship _Shohirika_. He added that he liked the position of gunner's
+mate very much, and that he meant to make a record for himself if given
+the opportunity to do so. He also told about the doings of Shamhaven and
+Peterson, and said he hoped to bring them to justice, although he
+realized that looking for them was as bad as "looking for a pearl on the
+ocean bottom."
+
+The letters finished, he addressed and posted them, and then he and Luke
+took a short stroll through Nagasaki, past the many curious shops, and
+the fine residences. Some of the shop windows displayed flaring war
+pictures, done in glaring colors,--all telling of tremendous Japanese
+victories on land and sea.
+
+"They certainly believe in tooting their own horn," said Larry, with a
+laugh over one of the pictures. "Just see this one, Luke--one Japanese
+officer mowing down three Russians with his sword!"
+
+"They ain't no worse nor we had at home during the Spanish war, lad. I
+know one picture I see o' a Rough Rider riding down half a dozen Spanish
+soldiers. An' the truth o' the matter is, them Rough Riders didn't have
+no horses at all but fought on foot!"
+
+"You're right, Luke. We'll have to put all such pictures down as freaks
+of the artist's imagination. But I guess I know why some of them are put
+out--to draw the young fellows into the army and navy."
+
+"Right ye are. Some fellers seeing a picture like that want to march to
+glory right off,--an' so they go an' enlist. When it comes to hardtack
+an' black coffee----"
+
+"Hold on, Luke. Remember you are in Japan. Here it is rice and tea."
+
+"So it is, Larry. Say, but I had to laugh yesterday, when I see some of
+them jackies on board o' our ship gettin' out their teapots with tea."
+
+"It did look funny. But they do the same thing in the army, so I have
+been told. They can make the Japanese soldier and sailor do everything
+as we do it but give up his tea."
+
+"Well, I reckon tea is better nor rum."
+
+"Certainly it is,--and if I were an officer I'd let them have all the
+tea they wanted--if they would fight any better for it."
+
+"Those Russian sailors and soldiers drink an awful lot of _vodka_. I
+should think they would try to stop that. A half-drunken sailor or
+soldier isn't of any account."
+
+"They are so used to having it, I've been told, that to stop it would
+bring on a regular mutiny. It's hard to break off using a thing when you
+are used to it."
+
+"Right ye are, lad; a habit if it ain't proper is something awful."
+
+All was bustle throughout Nagasaki, for several regiments of soldiers
+had come in, bound for some transports which were to take them to
+Manchuria. Banners were flying everywhere, and from a distance came the
+music of a band.
+
+"Wonder how soon we will leave," said Larry, when he and his old friend
+were returning to the warship. "Now that we have enlisted, I'd like to
+see some fighting."
+
+"Maybe we'll get more fighting than we want, lad. But I'd like to get
+into it myself," continued the Yankee gunner, with a grin.
+
+Two days more were spent at Nagasaki, and then, on a clear morning, the
+_Shohirika_ left the harbor and steamed off in company with two sister
+ships. They were to join a squadron bound for the western coast of
+Korea, but where they were to go after that there was no telling.
+
+Captain Ponsberry came to see Larry and Luke off. "Take good care of
+yourselves," said the master of the _Columbia_. "An' teach them Russians
+the lesson they deserve."
+
+"We expect to do our duty," answered Larry.
+
+Life on the Japanese warship proved to be very much like life in the
+American navy. There were hours set apart for various drills and
+exercises. Each day they had to go through the movements of handling the
+gun, fighting with cutlasses, putting out a fire, and manning the small
+boats. They also had to keep their ditty bags and grass hammocks in good
+order, also their eating utensils, and each had to do his share of
+cleaning up. Twice a week the ship's surgeon examined each man, to see
+that he was perfectly healthy.
+
+"I like this keeping things clean," said Larry. "It is bound to make for
+good health."
+
+"They tell me that Japanese sailors and soldiers are among the
+healthiest in the world," answered Luke.
+
+In a few days the southern point of Korea was passed and the bow of the
+warship was pointed toward the eastern coast of Manchuria. They were now
+getting close to the battleground and the lookout was constantly
+watching for the appearance of the ships of the enemy.
+
+"We'll have a fight before very long--I can feel it in my bones,"
+declared Larry. And he was right; but before telling of that contest,
+and what surprising results it led to, we shall have to tell of
+something else which occurred, to delight Larry exceedingly.
+
+
+
+
+CHAPTER XXII
+
+A MEETING AND A PLOT
+
+
+"Some Japanese transports are coming up," said Larry, two days later.
+"Six of them, and they are crowded to the rails with soldiers."
+
+"I reckon we are to act as an escort to them," replied Luke. "They would
+need an escort, if they fell in with a Russian cruiser or two."
+
+The Japanese transports were bound for the coast of Manchuria, to land
+near the village of Petaka. Soon they fell in behind the _Shohirika_;
+and then those on the warship knew that they were going to go close to
+shore, if not to make an actual landing.
+
+A fog came up that night, which made the transports hold off. But the
+next day was as bright and clear as before, and about noon land was
+sighted to the westward. A patrol boat was sent ahead and came back
+stating that all was clear for a landing. Then the warships went closer
+and the transports followed.
+
+On the following day Larry found himself on shore--having been taken
+along by one of the officers of the ship to interview an English
+merchant who wished to sell some goods to the Japanese. The officer
+could speak some English, but wanted somebody along who could help him
+out in case he could not make himself clearly understood.
+
+The landing was at a small Chinese town which was partly in ashes--the
+Russians having tried to burn it down before leaving. There were a dozen
+shops, but all were closed and with the windows boarded up. Many of the
+Chinese had fled to the country beyond; and a Japanese regiment was on
+guard to preserve order and to keep the Chunchuses, (Chinese brigands)
+from looting the place.
+
+"This shows what war will do," thought Larry, as he walked along beside
+the Japanese naval officer. "I suppose some of the Chinese have lost all
+they possessed--and through no fault of their own either."
+
+The business with the English merchant was transacted quicker than
+anticipated, and, not caring to go back to his ship at once, the naval
+officer visited the camp of the Japanese regiment, taking Larry with
+him.
+
+"We expect another detachment here this afternoon," said one of the
+regimental commanders to the naval officer. "They are to escort a powder
+train through the mountains."
+
+A little while later the detachment came in on foot, looking somewhat
+tired and dusty from a long tramp through an exceedingly rough country.
+As the soldiers came to a halt in the public square of the seaport
+village, Larry uttered a cry of amazement:
+
+"Ben!"
+
+"Why, Larry, can it be you?" came in a tone of astonishment, and on the
+instant Ben Russell rushed forward and caught his brother by the hands.
+"I must be dreaming!"
+
+"I guess I'm dreaming myself!" said Larry, and gave his brother a warm
+hug. "This beats the Dutch! I thought you were at Liao-Yang. How are you
+and how did you get here?"
+
+"One question at a time, please," returned Ben, with a happy smile. "I'm
+pretty well, although I had a little dose of fever a couple of weeks
+ago. Our Japanese doctor fixed me up in double-quick time. Our command
+was ordered down here to look after a powder train. There was a report
+that either the Russians or the Chunchuses were going to try to capture
+it or blow it up. Now, how have you been, and what are you doing here? I
+thought the old _Columbia_ was at Nagasaki."
+
+"You want to know as much as I do, Ben." There was a pause and both
+laughed merrily, they felt so happy. "I'm as sound as a fiddle. The
+_Columbia_ is at Nagasaki and likely to stay there for some time. Allow
+me to introduce myself, Lawrence Russell, gunner's mate aboard of the
+Mikado's cruiser _Shohirika_. My head gunner is Luke Striker, Esquire."
+
+"Never!" burst from Ben. "Well, this certainly is news. So you and Luke
+enlisted? Have you had any fighting?"
+
+"Not exactly. But we have seen some rough times," answered Larry, and
+then, as soon as Ben could get away for a quiet half-hour, he related
+his story in detail, just as I have set it down in these pages.
+
+"You are assuredly a lucky chap, Larry, not to be in a Russian prison
+this minute," said his brother, after the young sailor had finished.
+
+"Perhaps I am lucky, Ben. But it wasn't much of luck to have that
+Shamhaven and Peterson walk off with my money belt."
+
+"That is so, but as the amount taken wasn't a fortune I shouldn't worry
+about it. I can let you have any money you need."
+
+"I don't need any, and, besides, Luke is acting as my banker. But now
+tell me about yourself."
+
+"There isn't very much to tell, outside of what I put down in that
+letter you received. As you know, Gilbert and I are both attached to
+this command of Major Okopa."
+
+"Where is Gilbert now?"
+
+"His company was to bring up the rear. They'll be here very shortly.
+Since the battle of Liao-Yang we have been on special duty, looking
+after the pack and powder trains, and have seen very little of fighting.
+We are reinforcing our lines daily, and I think the Russians must be
+doing the same. I expect some more heavy fighting soon, unless winter
+steps in and puts a stop to everything. The nights are already rather
+cool," added Ben.
+
+It was half an hour later that the company under Gilbert came in, having
+in their custody two Chinese bandits that had tried to steal four horses
+belonging to two Japanese army carts.
+
+"So it's really you, Larry!" cried the young Southerner, as he shook
+hands. "I'm mightily glad to see you and see you looking so well. I
+suppose Ben has told you all the news."
+
+"Yes, and Larry has been telling some too," put in Ben. "He has seen
+almost as much of the Russians as we have." And then Larry's story had
+to be told again.
+
+"I don't know where we shall go after we leave here," said the young
+sailor. "Are you going back to Liao-Yang?"
+
+"We don't know that either. Our orders are to escort the powder train
+wherever it may be sent," said Ben.
+
+For two days the Japanese warship remained in the harbor of the seaport
+village and during that time Larry managed to see quite a good deal of
+Ben and Gilbert. He wished he could take them on board of the cruiser,
+but this was not permitted.
+
+On the third day the _Shohirika_ received orders from a dispatch boat
+which steamed into the harbor, and an hour later the anchors were hove
+apeak and she steamed away, carrying Larry and his old Yankee friend
+along. Ben and Gilbert stood on a dock watching her departure. They
+waved their handkerchiefs at Larry and he waved his own in return.
+
+"I wonder when I'll see Larry again," mused Ben. He felt rather sober at
+the parting from his younger brother.
+
+"Oh, you'll see him again before long," answered Gilbert, trying to be
+cheerful.
+
+"Maybe not. It all depends upon where that cruiser sails to. She may go
+half around the world."
+
+"More than likely she has been sent to take part in the bombardment of
+Port Arthur."
+
+"Do you really think we'll be sent to Port Arthur, Gilbert?"
+
+"It is not unlikely, Ben."
+
+The pair watched the cruiser fade away in the distance, and then
+returned to that part of the village in which Major Okopa's command had
+been located.
+
+"By the way," said Gilbert, as they hurried along. "There is one thing I
+forgot to tell you. Meeting Larry drove it completely out of my mind. On
+the way to this village we stopped at a place called Wikelipe, and there
+I met, whom do you suppose?"
+
+"I don't know, I'm sure."
+
+"That rascal Ivan Snokoff. He was at his same old tricks--selling things
+to the inhabitants at exorbitant prices. When he saw me he shook his
+fist at me and my men and then ran away and hid."
+
+"Why didn't you root him out, Gilbert?"
+
+"What good would it have done? Besides, I didn't have time. The fight
+with the brigands made us lose three hours. But do you know, I think
+Snokoff has it in for me."
+
+"Yes, and in for me, too," added Ben. "He hasn't forgotten how I brought
+along the guard that placed him under temporary arrest."
+
+There was no time to say more, for the command was to move in half an
+hour and both of the young captains had to round up their men for that
+purpose. The powder train was at rest outside of the village and the men
+were scattered here, there, and everywhere.
+
+Evening found the command to which Ben and Gilbert belonged ten miles on
+their way through the mountains. Only the officer in charge of the
+powder train knew the destination of the precious stores. The train
+consisted of eighteen carts, each pulled by four horses.
+
+Although none in Major Okopa's command knew it, the train was followed
+by a Chinaman named Kee Lung, who lived in Wikelipe, the place where
+Gilbert had seen Ivan Snokoff. Kee Lung was well known to Ivan Snokoff
+and had been asked by the rascally Russian to keep his eyes on Gilbert
+and on Ben and to report their movements. He had watched Gilbert's
+meeting with Ben and Larry and heard something of what was said and had
+thus managed to make out that two of the party were brothers.
+
+As the powder train approached Wikelipe, Kee Lung went ahead to find
+Ivan Snokoff. This was not difficult, as he knew exactly where the
+latter was hiding. A conference lasting an hour ensued.
+
+"Do as you have promised and you shall have fifty _yen_," said Ivan
+Snokoff.
+
+"You will not fail to pay?" queried Kee Lung.
+
+"By the heads of my ancestors I promise it," was the rascally Russian's
+answer.
+
+"'Tis enough. I shall do as I have promised," returned the Chinaman. And
+he bowed himself from Ivan Snokoff's presence. Left to himself, the
+rascally Russian rubbed his hands gleefully.
+
+"Ha, I trust he is successful!" he muttered to himself. "Once Pennington
+and Russell are in the power of us Russians I shall show them what it
+means to insult and degrade a Snokoff!"
+
+
+
+
+CHAPTER XXIII
+
+THE ATTACK IN THE DARK
+
+
+Two days later Gilbert and Ben were seated in their tent talking about
+the meeting with Larry when one of the guards came in and saluted.
+
+"A messenger to see Captain Russell and Captain Pennington," said the
+guard.
+
+"Show him in," returned Ben, briefly, thinking it was a simple message
+about camp duties. He was rather surprised when a Chinaman entered,
+bowing low as he did so.
+
+"Dis Clabtain Lussell?" asked the newcomer.
+
+"That is my name."
+
+"Dis Clabtain Plennington?"
+
+"Yes," answered Gilbert.
+
+"Sailor man send Chung Wow," went on the Chinaman. "Sailor man want see
+bloth." He pointed to the two young captains. "Sailor man say he blother
+you." And now he pointed at Ben alone.
+
+"Said he was my brother?" cried the young captain.
+
+The messenger nodded. "Name allee same Larry Lussell."
+
+"Gracious me!" ejaculated Ben. "Gilbert, what can this mean? I thought
+Larry sailed away on that warship."
+
+"So did I. But she may be back in port."
+
+"Sailor man hurt." The Chinaman pointed to his side. "Sick--he shot--say
+you clome to-night."
+
+"Sick? shot?" repeated Ben, and a cold chill went down his backbone.
+"That is the worst yet. Where is he?"
+
+"Big walk down by the sea. Chung Wow show. But must pay--Chung Wow poor
+people."
+
+"Oh, I'll pay you," answered Ben, hurriedly. "Gilbert, do you think I
+can get away?"
+
+"Sailor man say bloth clome," put in the messenger.
+
+"Something is wrong, that is certain," came from Gilbert. He eyed the
+Chinaman closely. "There is no mistake about this?"
+
+At this Chung Wow shrugged his lean shoulders and looked blank.
+
+"No see mistakee. See sailor mans."
+
+"I guess he is all right," put in Ben. "Something has happened to poor
+Larry. I wonder if I can get away at once?"
+
+"Let us see the major about this."
+
+Ben hurried off and caught Major Okopa in his own tent. As the command
+was not to move until noon of the next day both readily obtained
+permission to absent themselves until that time.
+
+"But be careful," said the major. "This may be some Chinese trick."
+
+"We'll be on our guard," answered Ben.
+
+The Chinese messenger had come in on foot. He said he was hungry and was
+given something to eat. Then the three set off, the messenger carrying a
+knapsack filled with rations, and each of the young captains carrying
+his sword and his pistol. They tried to learn from Chung Wow how far
+they would have to travel, but the Chinaman either could not or would
+not inform them.
+
+"Perhaps it might have been as well to have taken a detachment of one
+company along," suggested Gilbert. "I must say, I don't like the looks
+of this." They were now a good mile away from camp, and in a location
+that appeared lonely enough.
+
+"Well, we are moving down to the seacoast," returned Ben. He was taking
+careful note of the direction they were pursuing.
+
+After that they journeyed along for a good two hours without saying
+much. They stepped along briskly, for Ben wanted to learn just what had
+happened to his brother. For all he knew to the contrary, Larry might be
+mortally wounded.
+
+Presently they came to a spot in the road where there were a number of
+dense trees. Chung Wow began to cough loudly.
+
+"What's the matter?" demanded Gilbert. For some reason he did not trust
+the Chinaman.
+
+"Slomthing fly in float," was the answer, and Chung Wow coughed again.
+Then he walked on, and they came behind him. But Gilbert drew his pistol
+and motioned for Ben to do the same.
+
+"I may be mistaken, but we may be walking into a trap," he whispered.
+
+"Why, Gilbert, I don't----" began Ben, when without warning a heavy
+object dropped upon his head from the limb of one of the trees and bore
+him to the ground. Another object dropped on Gilbert, but he squirmed
+from under,--to find himself confronted by several Chunchuses. A cry
+went up, and a crashing was heard in the bushes back of the trees.
+
+"A trick, Ben, just as I suspected!" ejaculated the young Southerner,
+and he discharged his pistol point-blank at the Chinese bandit in front
+of him. This done he made a leap to one side, hurling over Chung Wow as
+he did so, and darted forward into some bushes. A shot was aimed at him,
+but did no injury, and he kept on, running as hard as he could.
+
+In the meantime Ben did his best to get up. But one man was on his
+shoulders and another had him by the legs, so to move was next to
+impossible. Then, as he continued to struggle, he received a heavy kick
+from a wooden shoe which stretched him out like a log.
+
+"He is out of the fight now," said one of the Chunchuses, as he bent
+over Ben. "Go after the other. Do not let him escape if you can help it.
+Americans are worth a good deal to us in these days!"
+
+Three of the brigands remained to guard Ben and the others made after
+Gilbert. But they could not catch the young Southerner, and after a long
+chase they came back.
+
+"He has gone back to his camp," said one of the Chunchuses to his chief.
+"He will have his friends about our ears very shortly."
+
+As soon as this news was received, Ben's hands and feet were bound, and
+four of the Chinamen caught him up as if he were a dead animal and
+hoisted him on their shoulders. Off they set at a dog-trot, with the
+remaining brigands around them.
+
+It was the jogging over the rough mountainous road which finally brought
+the young captain to his senses. At first he did not realize that he was
+on the move.
+
+"Gilbert!" he called faintly. "Gilbert!"
+
+Nobody answered him, and now he essayed to sit up. He could not budge
+and consequently began to struggle.
+
+"Be still!" cried one of the Chunchuses, in Chinese.
+
+"Where am I? What are you doing to me?" queried Ben.
+
+For answer he received a good shaking and was then dumped on the ground.
+His feet were liberated, and the chief of the Chinese brigands ordered
+him to move along, pointing the end of his sword at the prisoner as he
+did so.
+
+"Where is my friend?" asked Ben.
+
+"He is dead," said the chief, laconically.
+
+"Dead!" burst out the young captain. His heart seemed to become like a
+lump of lead. Gilbert, his own true chum, dead! It was too horrible to
+believe.
+
+"Yes, and you will be unless you walk on," added the chief of the
+Chunchuses.
+
+There was no help for it, and, bruised and bleeding, the young captain
+took up the march, with his enemies on all sides of him. The gait was a
+rapid one, and before they came to a halt once more he was all but
+exhausted.
+
+"Where are you taking me?" he asked.
+
+"Wait and see." The chief of the Chunchuses grinned wickedly. "I shall
+have to trouble you for your valuables," he went on, in his native
+tongue, and without further ado stripped Ben of his possessions,
+including his watch, money, ring, and sword.
+
+There was no use protesting, and therefore the young captain did not
+attempt it. He was marched along a marshy path, and presently came in
+sight of the ocean and a small bay, where two sailing ships and a small
+steamer lay at anchor.
+
+A shrill whistle sounded out, and this was answered by somebody on the
+steamer. Then a small boat put in to shore, carrying four sailors and an
+officer. As soon as the officer landed, he was called aside by the chief
+of the Chunchuses, and a conference lasting several minutes followed.
+
+"It shall be as you say, Ching Fee," said the officer, in Russian. "It
+is too bad you did not get the other, too. I know Ivan Snokoff, and
+Captain Barusky too, and there will be money in this. Yes, I'll take him
+on board at once. You had better watch out that the soldiers do not get
+after you."
+
+"Trust Ching Fee to take care of himself," said the chief of the
+Chunchuses.
+
+With scant ceremony Ben was conducted to the small boat and told to get
+in. He asked where they were going to take him, but could get no
+satisfaction. As soon as the steamer was reached, he was conducted to an
+empty stateroom and locked in.
+
+"This is the worst yet!" he muttered, as he sat down. "I suppose they
+intend to carry me miles and miles away. Poor Gilbert! I never thought
+he would be killed in such a fashion as this! What cutthroats these
+Chinese brigands are! It's a wonder they didn't kill me too! Can that
+story about Larry be true?"
+
+There was a little water in the stateroom, and as his hands had been
+released, Ben bathed his wounds and bound them up as best he could. He
+heard the steamer move away from the shore, and soon the steady pounding
+of the engines proved that she was forging ahead at her best rate of
+speed.
+
+He was a prisoner of the enemy, and what they were going to do with him
+was a question still to be answered.
+
+
+
+
+CHAPTER XXIV
+
+THE DEFENSE OF THE POWDER TRAIN
+
+
+After firing on the Chinese brigands as already described, Gilbert
+plunged into the brushwood which was not over half a dozen yards
+distant. He heard the shots discharged at him in return, but fortunately
+every one went wide of its mark.
+
+Once in the brushwood he did not stop, but continued on his way for
+several rods. Then he paused, wondering if Ben was anywhere in the
+vicinity.
+
+"I hope they didn't kill him," he murmured. "What a trap that was, and
+how easily we walked into it!"
+
+He waited and listened, but nobody came near him. Then, with caution, he
+pushed ahead, until he gained once more the road leading back to the
+temporary camp occupied by the powder train and the detachment guarding
+it. Following this, he ran on at full speed until the welcome camp-fires
+greeted him.
+
+"Major Okopa, we have been attacked by Chunchuses!" he exclaimed, as he
+rushed up to the officer's quarters. And in a brief manner he explained
+the situation so far as he knew it.
+
+The Japanese major had taken a strong liking to Gilbert and Ben, and he
+lost no time in ordering out a company to round up the Chinese brigands
+if they could be located. It was Gilbert's own command and he was given
+permission to remain out the whole night and the next day if necessary.
+
+The young Southerner went at the task with vigor, for he realized that
+every moment was precious. He explained the situation to his men, and
+they set off at double-quick to where the attack had been made.
+
+As was to be expected, the spot was deserted. By torchlight they saw the
+evidences of the struggle which had taken place. In one spot was a pool
+of blood, left by the brigand whom Gilbert had shot in the shoulder.
+
+"They went off in this direction," said one of the soldiers, who was
+good at tracing footsteps. He pointed to a side road, and along this
+they ran, keeping eyes and ears on the alert, so as to avoid anything in
+the nature of a surprise.
+
+Two hours later the company found itself on the seashore. But Chunchuses
+and vessels were gone and to where it was impossible to find out. But on
+the beach Gilbert picked up an empty pocketbook which he knew was Ben's
+property.
+
+"They brought him here most likely," he said. "See, here are the marks
+of a rowboat, and of many feet. They have gone off on the water."
+
+"Then the hunt is at a standstill," returned his second in command.
+
+The young captain was unwilling to believe this, and the remainder of
+the night, and the next forenoon, were spent in an eager search after
+the enemy. But it was useless; and at last Gilbert, sick at heart,
+ordered his men to return to the camp.
+
+On the following day the powder train moved onward once more. The first
+lieutenant of Ben's company took command of the body, and Ben was marked
+"missing" on the roll.
+
+"It is certainly too bad, and I sympathize with you, Captain
+Pennington," said Major Okopa. "Captain Russell is a fine fellow."
+
+"It takes all the vigor out of me," replied Gilbert. "Ben and I were
+like two brothers."
+
+But Gilbert was given no time in which to grieve over Ben's
+disappearance. Two days later, the powder train was attacked by a
+detachment of the Russians, who seemed to spring out of the very ground.
+One of the wagons loaded with powder was blown to atoms, killing two
+horses and three soldiers.
+
+"_Banzai!_" cried the Japanese, and when the order was given they
+attacked the enemy with vigor. It was a hot fight, lasting half an hour,
+and the Russians were driven among some high hills, backed up by several
+mountains.
+
+As the powder train had to go through one of the mountain passes so
+close at hand, the soldiers were sent ahead, to clear the way of all
+Russians that might appear. This was dangerous work, for the enemy had
+the advantage of the higher position. But the Japanese were undaunted,
+and rushed up one slope after another with a vigor and animation that
+was surprising.
+
+"Can't hold them back, when once they get started," said Gilbert, to the
+major. "They are like our Southern bloodhounds, when once they strike
+the scent."
+
+"And that is the way to win victory," answered Major Okopa.
+
+Not long after this Gilbert found himself at the foot of a steep hill
+with his company. At the top of the hill were a number of great bowlders
+and behind these some of the Russians were in hiding, sending down a
+spiteful fire whenever the opportunity presented itself.
+
+"We must dislodge those fellows," said Major Okopa. "It is very
+dangerous work. Do you think you can accomplish it, Captain Pennington?"
+
+"I can try," answered Gilbert, modestly, and ordered his company
+forward. He turned them slightly to the left, for here a fringe of thin
+brushwood offered a shelter that was not great, but much better than
+none.
+
+"Major Okopa expects us to take this hill," he said, in the best
+Japanese he could muster. "Let us do our best!"
+
+"_Banzai!_" came the rallying cry from the men, and up the slope they
+rushed, with Gilbert at their side. Crack! crack! went the rifles of the
+Russians, and then, without warning, several shells were sent up. One
+man of Gilbert's company was killed and two wounded, but they did not
+waver. Passing the brushwood, they ran out boldly on the slope above
+them.
+
+Many of the rocks at the top of the hill were loose, and as the Japanese
+came closer, the enemy began to send them down in a shower which was
+highly dangerous to those below.
+
+"Beware of the stones!" cried Gilbert.
+
+He had hardly spoken when he saw that he would have to look after his
+own safety. The Russians were working over a rock that weighed several
+hundreds of pounds.
+
+All at once the mass broke loose. There was a yell of delight from
+above, and then the big bowlder came rolling straight for Gilbert. Had
+it touched him he must surely have been crushed to death.
+
+But the young Southerner was as cool as he was quick. Pausing to make
+certain which way the big stone was coming down, he made a quick leap in
+the opposite direction. Then the bowlder went bounding past him, to
+crash into some small trees at the bottom of the hill.
+
+"Are you hurt, captain?" asked his lieutenant.
+
+"No," answered Gilbert. Then he leaped to the front once more. "Come!"
+he cried. "_Banzai!_ Forward for the Mikado!" And on the whole company
+went as before, firing rapidly as they did so. The Russians clung to the
+hilltop a few minutes longer, and then, as the first of the Japanese
+gained a footing there, they broke and fled in wild disorder down the
+other side of the hill, and into the woods to the northward. The
+Japanese pursued them for two hours but could not catch them, and at
+last the chase was abandoned. In this skirmish, called the battle of
+Po-yang-ling, the Japanese lost in killed and wounded four men, and the
+Russians seven. Three of the Czar's soldiers were also taken prisoners.
+
+After that the powder train had no more difficulty, and four days later
+reached its destination, which was the village of Fanshen, where the
+Japanese had established something of a base of supplies for that
+portion of the army which was moving southward to join in the siege of
+Port Arthur. At Fanshen, Major Okopa's command received orders to go
+into camp instead of returning to the vicinity of Liao-Yang.
+
+"This looks to me as if we were to be transferred to the army in the
+south," said the major, after communicating the news to Gilbert.
+
+"Well, I shouldn't mind helping to take Port Arthur," returned the young
+Southerner. "If you will remember, it was my treatment by the Russians
+at that place which caused me to take up arms against them."
+
+"So you said before, Captain Pennington. But do not imagine that the
+taking of Port Arthur will be easy. The Russians have fortified it in
+every possible manner."
+
+"Yes,--they were doing that before I came away from there."
+
+"For months they have been strengthening their fortifications, and
+getting in ammunition and supplies in secret. Their chain of forts
+extend, so I have been told, for twenty miles and more outside of the
+city, and being in a mountainous country, they will be hard to reduce."
+
+"Don't you think we can capture the place?" demanded Gilbert.
+
+"Capture it? Most assuredly, captain. But it will mean a great
+destruction of life," returned Major Okopa, gravely.
+
+What the major said about the Russians fortifying Port Arthur was true.
+Lieutenant-General Stoessel, the Russian commander at that place, had
+under him sixty thousand men, the very flower of the Russian army. On
+the side of the sea the town was fortified at a dozen points, only three
+of which had been thus far captured under the Japanese army led by
+General Nogi. To the northward and the westward were some twenty
+defenses, set among the mountains where they were next to impossible to
+reach.
+
+In a work of this kind, it is impossible to relate in detail all of the
+many battles fought over the possession of Port Arthur. The first
+assault was made in February by Admiral Togo's fleet, and the naval
+conflict was kept up for almost three months after that. In the meantime
+a Japanese army under General Oku landed at Pitsewo, and after several
+battles at Kinchow and Nanshan Hill, drove the Russians back to their
+mountain defenses and took possession of the railroad running to
+Liao-Yang and Mukden. Thus Port Arthur was cut off from almost all
+communication with the outside world.
+
+
+
+
+CHAPTER XXV
+
+BOMBARDING A PORT ARTHUR FORT
+
+
+Larry felt very happy after having met Ben and Gilbert. He had been
+afraid he should find that his brother or his friend was wounded, even
+though no mention of such an occurrence had been made in the letter he
+had received. He knew from experience that Ben was in the habit of
+making light of things that went wrong.
+
+"I suppose it did your heart good to meet 'em both," said Luke, after
+the warship was on the way.
+
+"You're right, Luke; it was a regular touch of old times."
+
+"Wish I had seen 'em myself."
+
+"Both wanted to be remembered to you." Larry paused for a moment. "By
+the way, I wonder where we are bound now?"
+
+"Can't say as to that, lad--secret orders, I reckon," answered the old
+tar.
+
+The order to sail was evidently an important one, for scarcely was the
+_Shohirika_ out of sight of land than all steam was crowded on. The
+lookouts were also doubled, and when night came the strictest watch
+possible was maintained.
+
+Yet, with it all, several days passed without anything out of the
+ordinary happening. Drills and exercises went on as before, and both
+Larry and Luke made themselves familiar with all parts of the warship.
+Both spent much time in familiarizing themselves with such orders as
+were given to them in Japanese, so that they might not be too "green,"
+as Larry termed it, if put to the test.
+
+During those days spent on shipboard matters concerning the great war
+were moving forward steadily. In the vicinity of Liao-Yang both the
+Japanese and the Russians made several movements to better their
+positions. This brought on a few skirmishes and one heavy battle, in
+which the losses were several hundreds on each side. There was also an
+advance on the outer forts of Port Arthur, and a fair-sized hill was
+captured by the Mikado's men, who, however held the place only at an
+enormous loss of life. In moving on the port the Japanese found they
+would have to do a great amount of tunneling and entrenching, all of
+which consumed time.
+
+On the ocean the two nations were equally active. Both took several
+prizes of war, and in an encounter with the Vladivostok squadron a
+Russian warship was hopelessly disabled and a Japanese cruiser was all
+but sunk. Another ship belonging to Admiral Togo's fleet struck a mine
+outside of Port Arthur and had to be sent back to Japan for repairs.
+
+So far the weather had been warm, but autumn was now at hand and before
+long the nights became cold and raw.
+
+"This war won't be finished this winter," said more than one. "We are in
+for another year of it, sure."
+
+The _Shohirika_ had been summoned to join the fleet patrolling before
+Port Arthur. Two days before that station was reached they fell in with
+a sister ship which brought the news of an encounter with a Russian
+battleship carrying some troops from Siberia. Both warships had suffered
+and become separated in the darkness.
+
+"This war is certainly warming up," said Larry. "I hope we see some
+fighting before it is over."
+
+"Maybe we'll see more of it than you wish," said Luke, grimly.
+
+"Don't you worry--we'll see a whole lot," put in Steve Colton, who was
+sitting on a ditty chest, playing checkers with Bob Stanford. "Just wait
+till we get under Admiral Togo's eye--he'll make us be up and doing."
+
+The chance to see some of the war came the next day, when they were
+ordered to bombard one of the forts to the north of Port Arthur proper.
+As soon as they came within four miles of the fort they received a
+reception which was as warm as it was exciting.
+
+"Now, here is where we show what we can do!" cried Luke, as the orders
+came to begin firing, and the whole gun company jumped in to assist him.
+The magazines were opened up, the windlasses set to work, and soon the
+first real shell--not a mere blank for practicing--came up and was run
+into the gun. Then the breech-block was swung to and locked, the
+electric connection set, and Luke sighted the piece with care, after
+having first received the proper distance from the range-finders in the
+tops. As soon as the "sight" was "covered" the button was pressed, and
+_bang!_ went the gun with a concussion that shook the whole ship. Other
+guns followed in rapid succession, until Larry had to stuff cotton in
+his ears to keep himself from becoming deaf. As soon as the gun was
+discharged, it was opened to let the gases out and then cleaned with wet
+swabs and flushed with running water to cool the barrel.
+
+The bombardment lasted for an hour, and during that time the fort was
+hit in a dozen places. Sand, dirt, and rocks flew in all directions, and
+once there came a flash which told of an explosion of a quantity of
+powder.
+
+"If we could only hit the magazine it would be good-by to that fort,"
+said Larry, but this was not to be.
+
+After the first few shots the fort had remained silent, but now, when
+the _Shohirika_ was about to retire, the gunners opened up once more,
+and a rain of shot and shell flew all around the warship. One struck the
+bow of the vessel, tearing off a few feet of the forward deck and
+another entered the forward turret, killing one of the gunner's
+assistants.
+
+"We can be thankful we weren't in that turret," said Luke, when he
+received the latter news.
+
+"Yes, indeed!" murmured Larry, and could not repress a shiver. "I can
+tell you, it's mighty risky work after all!" he added, soberly.
+
+"Well, we've got one advantage over those fellows," put in Colton, after
+the firing had come to an end, and the warship was fast getting out of
+range. "We can run away, while they have got to stay right where they
+are."
+
+"Oh, they can run away too," said Larry.
+
+"Not unless they abandon their fort,--and that would be just as if we
+should abandon our ship."
+
+The work at the gun had been severe, and after the bombardment was over
+Larry was glad to clean up and take a rest. The perspiration, grime, and
+smoke had made him look like a negro, and he used up several buckets of
+water before he got himself into as cleanly a condition as was habitual
+with him. Luke also took a "scrubbing down," as he called it, and so did
+the others.
+
+What amazed Larry more than anything was the quietness of the Japanese
+sailors. Now that the bombardment was ended they said scarcely a word
+about it, but went on exactly as before.
+
+"They are the most matter-of-fact chaps I ever saw!" he declared. "I
+believe if the ship blew up they would say 'Very sorry' and swim away.
+Now on one of Uncle Sam's ships the men would be all woke up and out for
+a jollification. Ben says it's the same way in the army. If they get
+excited at all they always seem to be sorry for it afterwards!"
+
+"That's what ye call a characteristic o' the race, I reckon," returned
+Luke. "They're taught to act that way from babyhood. It ain't polite nor
+high-toned to git excited. The only thing they kin yell is _Banzai!_ an'
+they let thet out loud enough, goodness knows!"
+
+"I can't understand why we didn't keep at that fort," came from Colton.
+"I was just getting the range beautifully when orders came to shut
+down."
+
+"Well, there must be a reason for it, Steve," answered Luke.
+
+There was a reason for it. Admiral Togo had just received word that
+certain ships of the Port Arthur squadron were going to make an attempt
+to break out of the harbor, either that night or the next day.
+Consequently the _Shohirika_ was needed further down the coast, and
+steamed away in that direction as rapidly as her somewhat limited supply
+of coal permitted.
+
+"I don't think the navy will ever find its way into Port Arthur harbor,"
+said Larry, later on, after studying a map of that locality. "There are
+too many forts on the hills outside of the town. They could smash our
+ships to smithereens if we got too close."
+
+"Trust Admiral Togo to know what he is doing," answered Steve Colton.
+"He won't go too close. At the same time he ain't going to let the
+Russian ships get away any more than Schley and Sampson let Admiral
+Cervera get away from Santiago Harbor in Cuba."
+
+"It's the army that will make Port Arthur a hot place to live in," came
+from Bob Stanford. "They can entrench and thus gain a little ground day
+by day, and as soon as they win some high point, like say 203-Meter
+Hill, it will be all up with General Stoessel, mark my words."
+
+The night to follow proved to be misty, and so cold that the majority of
+the sailors were glad to don their heavy peajackets. Fearing that the
+enemy would try to take advantage of the weather, Admiral Togo turned on
+all the searchlights his fleet possessed, and these were flashed in all
+directions.
+
+"False alarm," said Luke, after midnight had sounded out on the ship's
+bell. "Reckon the Russians don't dare to come out."
+
+But the old Yankee tar was mistaken. The enemy were on the alert, and at
+three o'clock, when the mist was extra heavy, the movement to steal out
+of Port Arthur harbor was begun, two torpedo destroyers taking the lead,
+and several cruisers following. This brought on a heavy sea-fight
+lasting far into the next day, and one which came close to cost Larry
+his life.
+
+
+
+
+CHAPTER XXVI
+
+BEN MEETS CAPTAIN BARUSKY
+
+
+For several days poor Ben remained a prisoner aboard of the small
+steamer. During that time only two men came near him--an under officer
+and the sailor who supplied him with food and water. Neither would
+answer his questions, so he could not learn where he was being taken or
+what was to be done with him.
+
+One evening there was a slight commotion on the deck, and the course of
+the steamer was changed. Then came a blowing of steam whistles lasting
+several minutes. Finally the steamer came to a standstill.
+
+"You are to leave this vessel at once," said the under officer, as he
+opened the door of the young captain's temporary prison. "Come, we have
+no time to spare."
+
+"Where am I to go?" questioned Ben.
+
+"You will soon learn. Hurry!"
+
+There was no help for it, and soon Ben was on deck. He was made to enter
+a small boat and was thus transferred to another steamer--one which had
+formerly been in the East Indian trade but which was now acting as a
+Russian supply boat.
+
+"What a dirty craft!" was his mental comment, after having been thrust
+into a pen which was little better than a horse stall. The supply boat
+was loaded to its fullest capacity, so quarters for all on board were
+limited.
+
+Two days passed and he received food which was scarcely fit to eat. When
+he protested he was threatened with a flogging. The air was foul and he
+began to fear that he would become sick.
+
+"I won't be able to stand this much longer," he thought, dismally. "If
+they want to kill me why don't they do it at once and have done with
+it?"
+
+On the following morning a surprise awaited him. He heard two Russian
+officers pause in front of his pen and one said to the other:
+
+"Here is the prisoner, Captain Barusky."
+
+"Is it the fellow named Russell?" was the question from Captain Barusky,
+the rascal who had aided Ivan Snokoff to make so much trouble for
+Gilbert Pennington.
+
+"The same."
+
+"They did not capture his friend?"
+
+"No--in the struggle he slipped away."
+
+"I am sorry for that. We wanted Pennington more than we did this fellow.
+But I am glad we got at least one of them. As I understand it they work
+hand-in-glove with each other;" and then the two Russian officers passed
+on.
+
+Like a flash Ben realized the truth of the situation. His taking off had
+been a trap set by Snokoff and this Captain Barusky, who had hired the
+Chunchuses to help work out their plot. He was now in the hands of the
+enemy in more ways than one.
+
+"They won't treat me as an ordinary prisoner," he reasoned. "This
+Captain Barusky will make it as hard as possible for me--more especially
+so as Gilbert managed to escape his clutches. Well, I am glad Gilbert
+got away."
+
+Resolved to "take the bull by the horns," Ben asked the prison guard if
+he might speak to Captain Barusky.
+
+"I will see about it," answered the sailor, and went off to find out. On
+his return he stated that the captain would visit the pen some time
+during the day.
+
+The Russian officer came late in the afternoon, when nobody else was
+near the pen. There was a sarcastic look on his face when he gazed at
+the young captain.
+
+"So you want to talk to me," he said, abruptly.
+
+"I do, Captain Barusky. I want to know why this plot was laid against
+me."
+
+"I know of no plot. You are an American in the employ of the Japanese
+Government as a spy. Russia captures all the Japanese spies she can."
+
+"I am no spy."
+
+The Russian shrugged his shoulders. "That is what your friend, Captain
+Pennington, once told me, too. Yet as soon as he got out of Port Arthur
+he was made a captain in the Mikado's army."
+
+"He applied for the position because the Russians had mistreated him and
+because he loves active service."
+
+"Have it as you please, Russell; both of you are spies, and you will
+have to suffer as one."
+
+"Where are you taking me?"
+
+"Since you seem so anxious to know, I will tell you, for I do not think
+you will be able to take the news to the Japanese. This boat is carrying
+supplies to Port Arthur."
+
+"Port Arthur!"
+
+"That is what I said. When we arrive there you will be placed in one of
+the strongest of our prisons at the port. Do you not admire the
+prospect?"
+
+"Well, if you take me to Port Arthur, perhaps I shan't be a prisoner
+long," replied Ben, resolved to put on as bold a front as possible.
+
+"And why not?" demanded Captain Barusky, curiously.
+
+"Because our army and our navy are bound to capture the place."
+
+"Bah! The Japanese will never take Port Arthur. It is absurd to think of
+it."
+
+"It may not come right away--but it will come sooner or later."
+
+"Never! But if it should, you will not be there to enjoy our downfall.
+Remember that spies are tried, and if found guilty they are taken out
+and shot."
+
+"You cannot prove that I am a spy."
+
+"That remains to be seen."
+
+"If you bring me before the court I'll have something to say about your
+underhanded work with Ivan Snokoff. I can prove that he is a swindler
+and that you are his accomplice."
+
+"Ha! you threaten me!" roared Captain Barusky, in a rage. "Have a care!
+I come from a most respectable family and I have great influence."
+
+"Nevertheless, I think those who are higher in authority than yourself
+will listen to my story. The Russian army officers are as a rule
+gentlemen and strictly honest."
+
+"Which means to say that I am not a gentleman and not honest!" bellowed
+Captain Barusky. "That, for your opinion!" And reaching out he gave Ben
+a ringing box on the ear.
+
+It was the last straw. With no fresh air and no food fit to eat, the
+young captain was desperate, and leaping forward he struck at the
+Russian captain's nose. His fist went true, and as Barusky staggered
+back against the pen door the blood spurted from his nasal organ.
+
+"Don't you dare to hit me again!" panted Ben, standing before the
+Russian with both hands clenched. "Don't you dare--or you'll get the
+worst of it!"
+
+His manner made Captain Barusky cower back, and he glared at Ben with
+the ferocity of a wild beast. Then he called to the guard.
+
+"Run for aid, Petrovitch," he said. "The prisoner has attacked me. He is
+a beast, and must be chained up."
+
+The man addressed summoned three other sailors and the captain of the
+ship's guard. All came into the pen and forced Ben into a corner.
+
+"The Yankee dog!" said the captain of the guard. "To dare to strike a
+Russian officer! Bring the chains at once!"
+
+Chains were brought, and soon Ben was bound hands and feet, with links
+that weighed several pounds. Then a large staple was driven into one of
+the uprights of the pen and he was fastened to this with a padlock.
+
+"Now place him on half-rations," said Captain Barusky. "It is the only
+way to tame him." And then he hurried away to bathe his nose, which was
+swelling rapidly.
+
+If Ben had been miserable before he was doubly so now. The chains were
+cumbersome and cut into his flesh, and being fastened to the upright he
+could scarcely move a foot either way. To add to his misery the front of
+the pen was boarded over, so that what little light had been admitted to
+his prison was cut off.
+
+In this wretched condition he passed a full week. In that time Captain
+Barusky came to peep in at him three times, and on each occasion tried
+to say something to make him still more dispirited. The food was so bad
+he could not eat and the air often made his head ache as if it would
+crack open.
+
+"If this is a sample of Russian prison life it's a wonder all the
+prisoners don't go mad," he reasoned. "A few months of this would surely
+kill me."
+
+At the end of the week Ben heard firing at a distance. The supply boat
+was now trying to steal into Port Arthur and had been discovered by a
+Japanese patrol boat. The craft was struck twice and the prisoner below
+heard a wild commotion on the deck, as one of the funnels was carried
+away. But darkness favored the Russians, and inside of two hours the
+supply boat passed into Port Arthur harbor without sustaining further
+damage. She was then directed to a proper anchorage by the harbor
+master; and on the following day the transfer of her cargo to the
+storehouses on shore was begun.
+
+For several days longer Ben was kept on the boat. Then, one wet and cold
+morning, he was liberated and told to march on deck. From the vessel he
+was taken to a big stone building which was being used as one of the
+garrison quarters. Here he was given a scant hearing in the presence of
+Captain Barusky, who appeared against him.
+
+"We have no time to investigate your case at present, Captain Russell,"
+said the officer who conducted the examination. "But from reports I
+should surmise that you are a dangerous young man. You must remain a
+prisoner." And then the young captain was taken away. Later on, he was
+marched a distance of half a mile and blindfolded. When the bandage was
+removed from his eyes, he found himself in an old stone building, dirty
+and neglected. He was taken to a small room, having a grated window, and
+thrust inside. Six other prisoners were put into the apartment with him,
+one man with a hacking cough, dreadful to hear. The door was closed and
+barred; and all were left to take care of themselves as best they could.
+
+
+
+
+CHAPTER XXVII
+
+A FIERCE BATTLE AT SEA
+
+
+Larry was taking a nap when the call came to clear the ship for action.
+It had been discovered that the Russian fleet was trying to escape from
+Port Arthur harbor, and the news was flashed from vessel to vessel of
+Admiral Togo's fleet, and all were ordered to prevent the movement at
+any cost.
+
+"Now I reckon we are in fer it!" ejaculated Luke, as he and the youth
+rushed over to their gun. "Larry, it's in my mind we have some tall work
+cut out fer us this trip!"
+
+"Let it come--I am in just the humor for fighting!" cried Larry. "I hope
+we can smash them just as we smashed the Spanish ships in Manila Bay."
+
+Sailors and gunners were hurrying in all directions, and orders were
+coming in rapid succession. At first the Russian ships had turned in one
+direction, now they were turning in another, and, later still, they
+separated. A distant firing could already be heard, but where it came
+from those on the _Shohirika_ could not tell.
+
+So far no ships of the enemy could be seen with the naked eye. The
+lookouts kept a close watch, and the flashlights continued to play all
+over the bosom of the rolling sea.
+
+It was almost daylight when a distant explosion was heard. A Russian
+torpedo boat had run into a mine and was so badly damaged that she sank
+inside of ten minutes, carrying a large part of her crew with her.
+
+This disaster proved a warning to the other Russian ships and they
+proceeded on their courses with added caution. The Japanese warships
+were equally on the alert, yet, just as the sun came up, one brushed
+against a mine and received such damage that she was practically put out
+of the contest.
+
+"There is one of the enemy's ships!" was the cry, as the mist swept away
+as if by magic and the sun came out strongly. "Now is our chance.
+_Banzai!_"
+
+"And there is another ship!" came a moment later, "and one of our own
+pounding her as if she was a witch!"
+
+Guns were now booming over the water constantly, and from the forts on
+shore came shots and shells in rapid succession. Soon the _Shohirika_
+was in the midst of the battle, and then Luke and Larry worked over the
+gun as never before, doing their full share towards disabling the ship
+that was trying to escape up the Manchurian coast.
+
+For over an hour the running fire kept up. Neither ship dared to put on
+full speed, for fear of running into a mine. Solid shot was hurled in
+all directions, and the _Shohirika_ received one below the water line
+which for the moment looked as if it might sink the craft. But the
+ship's carpenter and his crew got at the leak immediately, driving in a
+wedge which quickly stopped the flow of water.
+
+It was hard, exhausting work between decks, and at the end of an hour
+Larry felt he must have some fresh air. Both he and Luke applied for
+permission to go on deck, and this permission was readily granted, for
+the guns on their side of the warship were not then in use.
+
+On the deck of the _Shohirika_ they could see what this battle really
+meant. Dirt and debris were to be seen in many places, and half a dozen
+sailors and marines had been killed or wounded. Everybody was bathed in
+perspiration and grime, and some of those who worked the big guns were
+panting like dogs after a chase.
+
+"It's work, that's what it is," said Luke, running the perspiration from
+his begrimed forehead with his finger. "Ain't no child's play about it!"
+
+"And dangerous work at that," added Larry. He gave a look toward the
+enemy's ships. "I declare, Luke, I believe they are running back to Port
+Arthur harbor!"
+
+"I think the same, lad," responded the Yankee gunner. "Reckon they are
+findin' it is goin' to cost too much to get away. As soon as they get
+away from them land batteries we can pound 'em for keeps and they know
+it."
+
+"And get away from the mines. That's the worst with fighting around
+here--you don't know how soon you'll hit a mine and be blown up."
+
+"Oh, I reckon our captain is watching out fer them pesky things."
+
+Larry was interested in watching the sharpshooters and range-finders in
+the tops, and he walked across the deck to get a better look at them.
+Luke followed, and as he did so, one of the nearest of the Russian ships
+sent out a roaring broadside at the _Shohirika_ which raked her fore and
+aft and sent another hole through her side, but this time above the
+water line where it did scant damage.
+
+"Gee Christopher!" began Luke, when he chanced to glance upward. "Larry,
+look out!" he screamed. "The top's coming down on ye!"
+
+Luke was right. One of the shots from the enemy had struck the foremast,
+above the fighting top, and it was crashing down, carrying a portion of
+the ship's flag with it. One end struck the gun turret, and then the
+wreckage hit Larry on the shoulder, hurling him on his back.
+
+The foremast was heavy and had it struck the youth before landing on the
+turret and the surrounding works it might have killed the young gunner's
+mate on the spot. As it was, Larry lay like a log where he had fallen
+and when Luke raised him up the old tar found him unconscious.
+
+"If he ain't got his shoulder broke then I miss my guess," muttered the
+Yankee gunner. "Larry! Larry! Can't ye speak to me?"
+
+"That was a nasty one," came from one of the officers of the deck.
+"Better carry him below." And then the officer gave orders to remove the
+wreckage and hoist the flag once more.
+
+With the unconscious youth in his arms, Luke hurried below and to the
+sick bay of the warship. Here the surgeon got to work immediately and
+examined Larry thoroughly.
+
+"No bones broken," he announced. "But the bruise is severe and he is
+suffering from shock. He will soon come to his senses."
+
+Luke had to return to his gun, for duty is duty in the navy, regardless
+of what is happening around one. It was true, the Russian warships were
+now doing their best to sneak back into Port Arthur harbor and Admiral
+Togo wanted to do all the damage possible before the forts made it
+impossible to follow them further. All of the warships' guns were worked
+to their utmost, and when the Russian vessels did get back they were so
+badly crippled that they were of small consequence for future fighting
+until undergoing repairs.
+
+When Larry opened his eyes again he found himself lying on a clean white
+cot in the ship's hospital with an attendant standing over him bathing
+his face.
+
+"Oh!" he murmured and stared around him. "Oh, my shoulder! That was a
+fearful crack I got!"
+
+The attendant did not understand, but smiled blandly and continued to
+bathe his face and also his head. Soon the full realization of what had
+happened came to the young gunner's mate. Then he asked about Luke.
+
+The fighting was at an end and presently Luke came to him, to find Larry
+sitting up in a chair.
+
+"I feel stiff and sore all over, Luke," said the youth. "It was just as
+if a house came down on me."
+
+"Thank fortune you wasn't killed, or didn't have your bones broken,"
+returned the Yankee gunner.
+
+"I am thankful. Were you hurt?"
+
+"Not in the least."
+
+"What about the fight?"
+
+"The Russians have sneaked back into the harbor like a lot of whipped
+dogs."
+
+"What is our ship doing?"
+
+"Putting up the coast. I don't know where we are going," answered Luke.
+
+Larry remained in the ship's hospital for three days and then resumed
+his duties as before. His shoulder still felt stiff and sore and lifting
+anything was a good deal of labor. But Luke favored him, so he got along
+very well.
+
+A week passed and the _Shohirika_ remained at sea, moving in a wide
+circle, on the lookout for Russian warships or supply boats. But none
+were encountered, and then the cruiser was ordered to escort a transport
+filled with soldiers bound for the front.
+
+The transport landed at a point some miles north of Dalny and the troops
+went ashore without delay. They were bound for the railroad, and were to
+participate in the advance upon Port Arthur from that point.
+
+As the warship remained in the harbor several days, both Luke and Larry
+were allowed a short run on shore. They enjoyed this trip very much,
+until, much to their surprise, they learned that Major Okopa's command
+was in the vicinity. Then they hunted this up, to learn the sad news
+from Gilbert that Ben was missing.
+
+"Missing!" ejaculated Larry, in horror. "Taken by Chunchuses! Oh,
+Gilbert, this is dreadful!"
+
+"Well, I don't know as you feel any worse than I do, Larry," answered
+Gilbert. "It makes me wild to think of it."
+
+"But couldn't you find any trace of him at all?"
+
+"Not the slightest, although I think he was carried off in a boat."
+
+"But why should the Chinese brigands make him a prisoner?"
+
+"I'm sure I don't know, excepting to hold him for a ransom. But if they
+intended to do that it is likely we should have heard from them before
+this."
+
+The matter was discussed as long as Larry and Luke could remain on
+shore. But nothing came of it, and with a heavy heart the young gunner's
+mate returned to his place on the warship.
+
+
+
+
+CHAPTER XXVIII
+
+THE SIEGE OF PORT ARTHUR
+
+
+After the fruitless effort to escape from Port Arthur harbor the Russian
+warships "bottled up" there remained where they were for a long time to
+come. Occasionally one or another attempted to run the blockade, but
+results were usually disastrous, and at last the risk became so great
+nothing more was done in that direction. The Japanese continued to put
+down mines and sank several boats loaded with stone in or near the
+winding channel, and this made getting in as hard as getting out--thus
+putting a stop to the arrival of more supply boats, such as brought Ben
+to the seaport.
+
+In the meantime the campaign on land was pushed forward with increased
+activity. The headquarters of the Japanese army investing Port Arthur
+was not far from the railroad, but the lines stretched many miles to the
+east and the west. Troops were hurried both from Japan and from the
+divisions near Liao-Yang, and heavy siege guns were mounted on every
+available hilltop. The Japanese were, at the start, at a great
+disadvantage--they could not see the enemy at which they were firing.
+Hills and mountains cut them off from every view of the port. But they
+kept hammering away, day after day, week after week, and month after
+month, gaining steadily, throwing up new intrenchments, digging new
+tunnels, and hauling their heavy guns forward to more advantageous
+positions. The labor was body racking and the sacrifice of life
+enormous. But the Mikado's soldiers did not appear to care. They had set
+out to capture Port Arthur and they were going to do it.
+
+For the foot-soldiers and for the cavalry there was at the start but
+little to do in the way of fighting. Most of the time was spent in
+digging trenches and tunnels, and in keeping out of the way of shells
+that whistled and screamed in all directions--shells weighing hundreds
+of pounds, which, when they struck, tore up the ground for yards around
+and smashed the rocks as if the latter were passing through a quartz
+crusher. Such is war of modern times, when carried on at a distance of
+miles.
+
+But as the months went by, and Japanese and Russians came closer to each
+other, hand-to-hand conflicts became numerous. The Russians contested
+every foot of the ground, fighting with a courage that was truly heroic,
+and sacrificing themselves freely for the Czar and the country they
+loved. The hand-to-hand conflicts became bloody in the extreme,
+thousands upon thousands being slaughtered between the rising and the
+setting of the sun.
+
+From the seacoast the command to which Gilbert was attached moved to a
+small place called Fugi Klan. Here they went into camp for several weeks
+and while there were joined by a number of other commands, including
+that containing those old soldiers of fortune, Dan Casey and Carl
+Stummer, who had served with Gilbert and Ben in Cuba and in the
+Philippines.
+
+"Py chiminy, of it ton't done mine heart goot to see you, cabtain!"
+exclaimed Carl Stummer, rushing up and giving Gilbert a handshake. "How
+you peen, annavay?"
+
+"First rate, Stummer. And how are you, Casey?"
+
+"Sure an' it's meself is as foine as a fiddle," answered the Irishman,
+with a broad grin on his freckled face. "It's a great war, ain't it now?
+Both soides is fightin' like a pair o' Kilkenny cats, so they are! An'
+where is me ould friend, Captain Russell?"
+
+"He was captured by Chunchuses."
+
+"No!" came from both Stummer and Casey, and then they poured in a volley
+of questions which were bewildering. Gilbert answered them as best he
+could.
+
+"Dot's der vorst ding vot I hear yet alretty!" said Carl Stummer, with a
+sad shake of his head. "I vish I got dem Chunchusers--or vot you call
+dem--here. I fix 'em, eh, Tan?"
+
+Dan Casey nodded vigorously. "Sure an' we'd be after puttin' a ball
+through ivery mother's son of 'em, so we would! Poor Ben Russell! I
+loiked him loike a brother!" And the honest Irish sharp-shooter heaved a
+long sigh.
+
+Both Casey and Stummer had been having easy times of it for several
+weeks, but now they were called upon to go forth with pick and shovel,
+to do their share of work in digging intrenchments. This was not so
+nice, but they went at the labor without a murmur.
+
+"Sure an' we might as well git into practice," observed Casey, as he
+started in with vigor. "Whin the war's over an' we git back to the
+States, it may be ourselves as will be workin' fer the corporation in
+New York or ilsewhere!"
+
+"Yah, udder puttin' town railroad dracks alretty in der Vest," answered
+Carl Stummer. "Dot is," he added, "of I ton't got money enough to puy a
+farm."
+
+"'Tis a stock farm I'm wantin'," came from Casey. "Wid horses galore.
+There's money for ye, Carl!" And he went to work with added vigor--as if
+he expected to turn up the stock farm from the soil beneath him.
+
+To Gilbert, even though he occasionally saw Stummer and Casey, the days
+were very lonely. He missed Ben greatly, and each day wondered if he
+would ever see his old war chum again. Major Okopa saw this and did what
+he could to cheer up the young officer.
+
+"He may turn up before you realize it," said the major. "I don't think
+he was killed."
+
+"If he is alive, it is very strange that we do not hear from him."
+
+Two days later came a batch of letters into camp, written, or rather
+painted, for the most part, on thin Japanese paper. Among the
+communications were two for Gilbert, one from Captain Ponsberry
+concerning the _Columbia_ and her cargo, and the other from a stranger
+in Pekin, China.
+
+"Who can be writing to me from Pekin, China?" mused the young captain,
+and began to read the communication with interest. It was from a Chinese
+merchant, and ran in part as follows:
+
+ "You will be mystified to receive this from an utter
+ stranger, but I deem it my duty, kind sir, to send this word
+ to you.
+
+ "Know, then, that one Ken Gow, a servant of my family, was
+ in Port Arthur up to sixteen days ago--first a servant in an
+ American family there, and next a prisoner in the vilest
+ prison man ever saw, guarded by dogs of Russians unworthy to
+ be used as door mats. Ken Gow is a faithful man, the flower
+ of all my help.
+
+ "It is needless to explain to you why my servant was thus
+ ill-treated. But you must know that when in prison he met
+ your great friend Captain Benjamin Russell, and it was the
+ captain who saved Ken Gow from many hard blows from the
+ other prisoners, who wanted not a Chinaman amongst them.
+
+ "Ken Gow was grateful, even as I am grateful, and he
+ promised to get word to you of this matter if the Russians
+ granted him his liberty. Finding no fault in my servant he
+ was, after a time, liberated, and watching his chance, left
+ Port Arthur and came home.
+
+ "Kind sir, he is grateful to Captain Russell and would do
+ much for him if he could. Yet his most is to send this
+ letter to you, telling you that Captain Russell is alive and
+ held in a Port Arthur prison as a spy. One Russian hates
+ him--his name, Captain Barusky,--and it would appear that
+ this Russian is also your enemy, so beware of him.
+
+ "I can tell no more. Ken Gow is sick from his treatment at
+ the hands of the Russian dogs. Accept this miserable
+ assurance of my eternal friendship, and esteem for one I
+ know must be high and illustrious."
+
+ "CHENG MO."
+
+Gilbert read the letter several times and showed it to Major Okopa. It
+was written in true Chinese style, with a big Chinese seal attached, and
+was, beyond all doubt, genuine.
+
+"I can't understand one thing," said the young captain. "How did Ben get
+to Port Arthur?"
+
+"It may be that this Captain Barusky had him taken there, Captain
+Pennington."
+
+"I thought Captain Barusky was at Mukden."
+
+"The Russians have been taking in some troops at Port Arthur on the sly.
+Despite Admiral Togo's efforts, some supply boats and transports have
+passed his ships."
+
+"If Barusky is there he will do what he can to make Ben miserable. He is
+down on both of us--for he knows we are down on him and Ivan Snokoff."
+
+"Do you think Snokoff could have anything to do with this?"
+
+"I'm sure I don't know. Anything is possible. Snokoff would be glad to
+make trouble for Ben--since he helped me to make him settle up at
+Liao-Yang. Those Chunchuses tried to capture both of us."
+
+The matter was talked over for half an hour, but brought forth no
+satisfaction. To Gilbert's mind, being held by the Russians as a spy was
+as bad as being in the hands of the Chinese brigands.
+
+"I wish we could get into Port Arthur at once," he said, finally. "I
+shouldn't like anything better than to capture this Captain Barusky and
+liberate Ben."
+
+"We are bound to get into the port sooner or later," answered Major
+Okopa. "They are bringing up more siege guns every day. If the Russians
+won't give up we'll batter the whole town down over their heads."
+
+"Which will be a bad thing for Ben," rejoined Gilbert. "I don't want him
+killed in the attempt to rescue him."
+
+
+
+
+CHAPTER XXIX
+
+FROM ONE DIFFICULTY TO ANOTHER
+
+
+"Where is this going to end?"
+
+It was Ben who asked himself the question, as he walked up and down the
+narrow cell in which he had been confined in the prison at Port Arthur.
+
+What had been written to Gilbert in the letter from Pekin had been
+substantially correct. Ben had aided Ken Gow in numerous ways, and for
+this the Chinaman had been extremely grateful and had promised to do all
+he could for the young captain should he manage to escape from the
+blockaded seaport. Then Ken Gow had disappeared one night, and that was
+the last Ben saw of him.
+
+Three days later a guard entered the prison and announced that the
+prisoners were to be transferred to other quarters. With his hands bound
+behind him, Ben was marched forth through a side street of Port Arthur,
+where stood an old building which had formerly been used as a market.
+Cells had been built in this structure, and into one of these he was
+thrust, the guard sarcastically telling him to make himself as
+comfortable as possible.
+
+The young captain was sick in both body and mind and fast reaching that
+point where one becomes desperate and fit for any deed of daring. More
+than once he was tempted to throw himself on the guard in an endeavor to
+overpower the fellow and escape. But he realized that if caught at this
+he would be immediately shot down.
+
+Day after day passed, and from outside the prisoner heard the dull
+booming of cannon. Occasionally a shell would explode close to the
+prison, causing a wild yell of alarm and a general rush by those
+outside. There were flags over the prisons and over the hospitals,
+showing what manner of places they were, but, as said before, the
+Japanese were at a loss to see what they were firing at, so many shots
+and shells went where they were not intended. These mishaps were what
+caused the report to circulate that the Mikado's men were not fighting
+according to the rules of modern warfare, but were doing their best to
+shatter the hospitals in which lay their own and the Russian wounded.
+
+It was a cold, raw day, with a touch of snow in the air, and Ben felt
+one of his desperate moods coming over him. His hands and feet were free
+and he peered forth from the one narrow window that the cell contained.
+All he could see beyond was a courtyard, surrounded by a stone wall.
+
+"I wish I was out there--I'd get over that wall somehow!" he muttered to
+himself.
+
+The cell window was not over fifteen or sixteen inches wide and twice
+that in height. The bars were of iron, but set in wooden frames but a
+few inches in thickness.
+
+"A fellow might smash out those bars with the bench end," he thought.
+"But after that what? I reckon the guard in the courtyard would shoot me
+on sight. I might try it at night."
+
+Still in a desperate mood, Ben picked up the bench, a solid affair
+several feet long. He made an imaginary lunge at the window bars with
+it.
+
+"I'll wager I could knock them out with one blow. They----"
+
+Ben got no further, for at the moment a fearful explosion sounded
+somewhere overhead. The explosion was followed by a crash and a wild
+yell of alarm. A Japanese shell had struck the top of the building,
+tearing away fully a quarter of the roof and sending the bricks and
+timbers flying in all directions.
+
+"Now is my chance!" he muttered, and without stopping to think twice he
+rammed the window bars as hard as he could with the bench. A second and
+third blow followed, and down went the irons, carrying a portion of the
+window frame with them. Then through the opening leaped the young
+captain. As he landed in the courtyard, he picked up a small log of wood
+lying handy.
+
+A glance around told him that the guard was nowhere in sight, the
+Russian having run to the other side of the building to note the damage
+done by the shell. Log in hand, Ben leaped quickly across the courtyard
+and placed the bit of wood up against the wall. This gave him a footing,
+and in a twinkling he was on top of the wall.
+
+But though he acted quickly a guard from the prison building saw him and
+ran forth gun in hand.
+
+"Halt!" came the command, in Russian, and then, raising his weapon, the
+guard fired at Ben.
+
+The bullet whistled over the young captain's head, and without looking
+back to see who had fired it, he dropped on the other side of the wall.
+Then he sprinted up the street and around a corner.
+
+Ben knew not where to go, but his one thought was to put distance
+between himself and the prison, and he hurried on and on, until he came
+to a barn which stood open. Into this he darted, to find the building
+empty of occupants.
+
+The Japanese had begun a general bombardment of Port Arthur and shot and
+shells were flying in all directions. This being the case, the majority
+of the troops and the inhabitants were out of sight,--hid away in
+cellars and dugouts. Nobody paid any attention to him and he was thus
+given ample time in which to think matters over and decide upon his next
+movement.
+
+From the barn Ben moved to the building next door--which was a sort of
+dwelling and storehouse combined. Here, from the wide open doorway, he
+gazed at the scene of destruction before him. It was full of horror and
+made him shiver.
+
+"War is certainly a terrible thing," he thought. He saw some people
+running for their lives, and beheld one man go down struck in the back
+by a shell. Then he turned away to shut out the sight.
+
+In one room of the warehouse he found an old overcoat and a slouch hat,
+and lost no time in donning these, both as a disguise and to keep
+himself warm. Then he hunted around for something to eat, but could not
+find a mouthful.
+
+"I might have known there would be no food squandered," he told himself.
+"Didn't they say at the prison that they were slaughtering the horses
+just for the meat, and that butter and eggs were worth their weight in
+gold? I'll be lucky to get bread and soup--especially as I haven't a
+dollar with which to pay for a meal."
+
+Ben was about to leave the warehouse when he saw a file of Russian
+soldiers approaching. With the soldiers were two officers, and as they
+came closer he recognized one as Captain Barusky.
+
+"It was a bad thing to let that American escape," said the captain to
+the other officer. "If you catch sight of him, shoot him on the spot."
+
+"Which we shall do with pleasure," was the ready answer; and then
+officers and soldiers passed on.
+
+"I've got to keep out of sight, that's all there is to that," reasoned
+Ben, grimly. "If they catch me again it's all up with me. I wonder if it
+would be possible to get out of Port Arthur? Gilbert got out, but things
+weren't half so closely guarded as they are now."
+
+Ben waited until nightfall before leaving the warehouse. Then, keeping a
+constant lookout for Russian soldiers, he sneaked along one street after
+another. Where to go he did not know, but he realized that he must have
+something to eat or he would starve.
+
+Presently he came to a small garden in the center of which was a
+neat-looking residence. On the doorplate was the name Nathan Chase.
+
+"Nathan Chase!" Ben cried, half aloud. "I wonder if that can be the
+gentleman Gilbert knew? If it is perhaps he will aid me."
+
+At first the young captain thought to ring the doorbell, but fearful of
+meeting the wrong person he resolved to investigate in a more private
+manner. The side windows of the residence were curtained, but the
+curtains were only partly down. Going to one of the windows he peered
+inside.
+
+In a neatly furnished sitting room sat a young lady and a Russian
+soldier. They were arguing about something--money matters as far as Ben
+could make out. The young lady did not wish to give the soldier the
+money and he insisted upon having it. While Ben gazed at the scene, the
+Russian soldier leaped up, grasped the young lady by the shoulders and
+shook her roughly.
+
+"Don't!" screamed the young lady, in English. "Let me go!"
+
+"I want the money!" answered the soldier, in his native tongue. He was a
+Cossack and of brutal features.
+
+The young lady was pretty and she was helpless, and this combination was
+more than the young captain could resist. Regardless of consequences, he
+shoved up the window and leaped inside the apartment.
+
+"Keep your hands off of that young lady!" he cried, and catching the
+Cossack by the shoulder he threw him backward. "Don't you know how to
+treat a lady when you meet her, you big brute?"
+
+The Cossack was startled, first because he had not expected the
+interruption and secondly because he had no business to be in the
+mansion. He gave one look at Ben and then rushed out into the hallway
+and left the premises with all possible speed.
+
+As soon as the Cossack was gone the young lady and Ben stared at each
+other. She started to speak, but stopped suddenly.
+
+"Excuse me for coming in as I did, but I thought it was necessary," said
+the young captain. "I guess that fellow had no business here."
+
+"You are right, sir. Papa is away, and he wanted me to give him money.
+He must have known I was alone in the house."
+
+"Are you Miss Chase?"
+
+"I am. But you have the advantage of me."
+
+"I know it. I am Captain Benjamin Russell. Perhaps you know an old
+friend of mine, Gilbert Pennington. He knows your father, I believe."
+
+"Oh, yes, I have met Captain Pennington. They tell me he is now in the
+Japanese army."
+
+"He is." Ben paused and looked at the young lady keenly. "Miss Chase,
+can I trust you?" he asked, abruptly.
+
+"What do you mean?"
+
+"I will tell you," and in a few brief words he related his story, to
+which Grace Chase listened with close attention.
+
+"You were lucky to escape from that prison!" she cried, when he had
+finished. "To be sure I will assist you as far as I can. Papa is away on
+business, but I expect him back in two or three hours. We haven't much
+on hand to eat, but such as there is you are welcome to."
+
+"I'm hungry enough to eat anything," said Ben, with a little smile.
+
+"Then come with me to the dining room, Captain Russell, and I will
+prepare supper."
+
+"You haven't any servants now, I suppose?"
+
+"No; every one of them has deserted us."
+
+They entered the dining room, and the young lady asked Ben to close the
+shutters. While he was doing this she prepared such a meal as the larder
+of the house afforded. It was not much, but he did not complain, and he
+thanked her warmly for giving what he felt she could ill afford to set
+before him.
+
+The meal finished, they sat down to await the coming of Mr. Chase. While
+doing this Ben related some of his experiences in the army and the young
+lady told of the horrors of the siege.
+
+"One cannot understand it unless you are in the midst of it," she said.
+"Papa says business is at a standstill, the hospitals are filled with
+the sick and the wounded, and we are in constant dread that the next
+moment will be our last. The suspense is so great that in one or two
+cases the inhabitants have gone crazy."
+
+"I can well believe that, Miss Chase. During the war in the Philippines
+I saw----"
+
+Ben paused, as a heavy footstep sounded on the porch of the residence.
+Other footsteps followed, and then came a loud knock on the door.
+
+"Open here!" demanded a voice in Russian. "Open, in the name of the
+Czar!"
+
+
+
+
+CHAPTER XXX
+
+A SURPRISE FOR LARRY
+
+
+As the days passed, the watch upon Port Arthur from the sea became
+closer and closer. Admiral Togo gave strict orders that no ships should
+be allowed to enter or come from the harbor under any circumstances, and
+each commander of a warship was on his mettle, knowing full well that if
+he was derelict in his duty he would speedily hear from his superior in
+a manner far from pleasant.
+
+Blockading became something of a monotony to Larry and Luke, and after
+several weeks had passed both wished something would happen.
+
+"I'd rather put up with a stiff sea fight than this," declared the young
+gunner's mate.
+
+"Right ye are, lad," replied the old Yankee tar. "Ain't no use o' bein'
+ready for a tussle if it ain't comin'. As it now is, life in the navy
+ain't no more excitin' nor life on the old _Columbia_."
+
+During that time Larry received a letter from Captain Ponsberry, similar
+in contents to that sent to Gilbert. The Japanese Government had
+released the cargo of the schooner and then bought the same at a good
+round price. The ship had also been released, Captain Ponsberry having
+to pay a nominal sum for this action.
+
+"I think the captain is lucky to get off so easily," said Larry. "I
+suppose the Japanese Government might have scooped in everything."
+
+"Well, the Japs think it best to remain friendly to the United States,"
+answered Luke, and it is likely that the old sailor was more than half
+right.
+
+Cold weather had come in earnest and work on deck was far from pleasant.
+Yet each man on the _Shohirika_ had to do his full duty as before, and,
+be it said to their credit, not a sailor or marine did any shirking. Gun
+drills and various exercises were kept up constantly.
+
+One day the warship ran close to a big trading brig bound for Hong-Kong.
+As was the custom, the brig stopped to allow the commander of the
+_Shohirika_ to make certain that she was not carrying contrabands of war
+for Russia or had no intentions of running the blockade.
+
+While this examination was going on, Larry and Luke chanced to come on
+deck, curious to have a look at the stranger.
+
+"About as big a brig as I ever see in these parts," was the Yankee tar's
+comment. "She must carry a whopping cargo."
+
+"Yes, and a lot of men to man her," answered Larry. "Think of hoisting
+and furling such sails as she carries!"
+
+The two vessels had come fairly close to each other, and our friends
+continued to survey the brig with interest. Then Larry gave a cry.
+
+"Oh, Luke, I wish I had a glass!"
+
+"Why?"
+
+"Unless I am mistaken, there is Shamhaven on the deck of that ship!"
+
+"No!"
+
+Larry pointed with his hand. "Doesn't that look like him?" he continued.
+
+"Keelhaul me, if I don't think you're right, lad. Wait, I'll get a glass
+an' make certain!"
+
+The old tar knew where he could borrow a glass, and in a minute more he
+returned, and both took a brief look through the instrument.
+
+"It is Shamhaven!" ejaculated Larry. "And look, there is Peterson coming
+from the fo'castle!"
+
+"That's so. What ye goin' to do about it?"
+
+"Tell the officer of the deck. They shan't get off with my money if I
+can help it."
+
+Rushing away, Larry soon acquainted the proper officer with what he had
+discovered--telling as much about the robbery as seemed necessary. The
+officer was interested, and, what was even more to the point, liked the
+young American.
+
+"Do you wish to go to yonder ship and confront the men?" he asked.
+
+"Try me and see!" answered Larry, excitedly. "I mean, yes, sir," he
+stammered. "And will you let Luke Striker go, too?"
+
+The officer agreed, and soon another small boat put off from the
+warship, and Larry and Luke, with the officer, were speedily landed on
+the deck of the brig.
+
+"You're a fine rascal, to rob me!" cried Larry, rushing up to Shamhaven.
+"And to rob Captain Ponsberry, too!"
+
+Shamhaven had not expected this encounter, and for the moment he was
+dumbstruck. He gazed from Larry to Luke as if they were ghosts.
+
+"I--I--who are you, anyway?" he stammered. "I don't know you," he added,
+striving to regain his composure.
+
+"Yes, you do know me, and you know Luke Striker, too," answered the
+young gunner's mate.
+
+"What does this mean?" asked the captain of the brig, while a number of
+others looked on with interest.
+
+"I'll tell you what it means, sir," said Larry, and did so. "He has got
+to give up my money belt and my money, and give up Captain Ponsberry's
+money, too."
+
+At this moment Peterson came up and was promptly collared by Luke.
+
+"Stop! Don't you vos touch me!" cried Peterson. "I ain't noddings done,
+no."
+
+"You helped Shamhaven to rob me," came from Larry.
+
+"No, he done it all alone! I no touch noddings!"
+
+"Oh, shut up!" roared Shamhaven, in disgust. "I never robbed anybody. If
+you lost your money Peterson must have taken it."
+
+A quarrel ensued between the evildoers, in the midst of which came a cry
+from the _Shohirika_.
+
+"An enemy is in sight!"
+
+At once all attention was turned to the warship. Scarcely a minute
+elapsed when a signal was displayed:
+
+"A battleship, and she is trying to escape up the coast!"
+
+"To the boats!" roared the Japanese officer on the deck of the brig. "To
+the boats at once! This investigation will have to be postponed. We
+shall expect you to remain as you are"--the latter words to the captain
+of the big brig.
+
+"As you will," was the smooth answer.
+
+A rush was made for the two small boats, Larry and Luke being hustled
+along with the crowd. Soon they put off for the warship, which was
+already preparing to follow the Russian battleship that had been seen.
+
+"I didn't get my money, after all," grumbled the youth. "But perhaps
+I'll get it later--if that ship of the enemy doesn't sink us," he added.
+
+As soon as they were on board of the _Shohirika_ again, the cruiser
+started after the battleship. But the enemy had a good lead, and it was
+some time before the Japanese warship could command a full head of
+steam, which meant everything to her. Then, when steam was to be had in
+plenty, there came a breakdown in the engine room, causing a delay of
+twenty minutes.
+
+"We'll never catch her,--at least, not to-day," said Luke, and he was
+right. Darkness found the battleship still three miles away. Half a
+dozen shots were fired at her, but none took effect. Then night ended
+the pursuit.
+
+In the morning nothing was to be seen of the enemy and those on the
+Japanese warship were much depressed, for they had fancied that an
+encounter might add greatly to their laurels. But shortly before noon
+the lookout announced the approach of another ship.
+
+"A Russian cruiser!" was the cry.
+
+This was correct--the vessel was the auxiliary cruiser, _Pontomuk_,
+formerly a steamer in the Siberian trade. She was manned by a fierce and
+swarthy-looking body of sailors and marines, and carried a first and
+second battery of no mean proportions.
+
+"I'll wager we have got some work cut out for us now," said Larry, and
+he was right. Finding she could not run away from the _Shohirika_ the
+Russian auxiliary cruiser came steaming up and let drive at close
+range,--a broadside that raked the Japanese warship from end to end with
+deadly effect. The _Shohirika_ answered immediately, and both the
+steering wheel and the rudder were smashed on the enemy's ship.
+
+"Phew! but this is hot work!" panted Larry, as all those around the gun
+worked like Trojans.
+
+"An' it's going to be hotter!" ejaculated Luke. He sighted the piece
+with care. "There, Sally Jane, let her go!" And he pressed the electric
+button. _Bang!_ went the gun with a roar that was deafening. Then the
+breech was thrown open and the smoke rolled out, filling the air with a
+smell that made them cough and sneeze. But nobody stopped work. In a
+trice the gun was cleaned and cooled and another shell pushed into
+place, and then the firing was repeated.
+
+"She's coming alongside!" was the announcement from on deck. "All hands
+to repel boarders!"
+
+"A hand-to-hand fight!" cried Larry, and scarcely had the words been
+uttered when there came a bump that hurled half the sailors flat. Up
+they sprang, and as order after order was delivered the marines and
+others ran for their guns and cutlasses, while the officers saw to it
+that their pistols were ready for use.
+
+A wild, maddening yell came from the deck of the Russian ship, as
+marines and sailors poured over the side. An answering _Banzai_ issued
+from the Japanese, and they met the first onslaught with vigor. Then
+came a fierce tramping over the deck, as the two conflicting parties
+moved first to one side and then the other.
+
+"We are ordered up!" cried Larry, a few minutes later. "Here is where we
+have got to fight for it, Luke!"
+
+"Right you are, lad. Do your best, and trust to Heaven for the rest!"
+was the Yankee tar's reply. And then, cutlasses in hand, both mounted to
+the deck, to engage in the fiercest hand-to-hand encounter either of
+them had ever experienced.
+
+
+
+
+CHAPTER XXXI
+
+A CALL TO REPEL BOARDERS
+
+
+It was a battle royal from the start and for some time neither side had
+an advantage. Pistol shot was met by pistol shot, and a rifle gun placed
+on the upper deck of the Russian warship was balanced in execution by a
+similar gun mounted on the _Shohirika_. The slaughter created by both
+weapons was frightful, a dozen or more going down on either side each
+time a gun was discharged.
+
+When Larry and Luke came out on desk the spectacle was enough to make
+the blood of the youth run cold, and it was only his previous experience
+in warfare which rendered him capable of doing what he knew was his
+duty.
+
+"Charge on them!" came the cry in Japanese. "Kill them, or drive them
+back to their ship! _Banzai!_"
+
+"_Banzai! Banzai Nippon!_" was the yell. "Hurrah for Japan!"
+
+The Japanese had not expected a hand-to-hand fight and the closing in of
+the enemy aroused them as they had never been aroused before. For the
+first time Larry saw the sailors and marines awakened to their full
+fighting fury--a fury in which every Japanese scorns death and thinks
+that to die is glory for himself, his family, and his emperor. They
+leaped on the Russians with a ferocity that was appalling, and that
+first shock sent the Czar's men back to the deck from which they had
+come.
+
+But the Russians were likewise aroused, and with cheers and yells they
+came on once more, leaping over the bodies of those who had fallen, and
+meeting shot with shot and cutlass stroke with cutlass stroke. Officers
+and men fought side by side, and many went down to a common death.
+
+By instinct Larry and Luke kept close together, with the others from
+Luke's gun near at hand, and Steve Colton and Bob Stanford not far away.
+Each used his cutlass as best he could, warding off the blows of the
+enemy and dealing cuts whenever a chance appeared. Larry was glad that
+he had learned to use a cutlass so well, and soon found himself the
+match of almost any Russian who challenged him.
+
+The fighting was now spread over the decks of both vessels, which were
+hooked together tightly and pounding broadside at every swell of the
+ocean. To attempt to blow up either ship would have been fatal probably
+to both--one dragging down the other--so no such attempt was made.
+
+While the fighting was at its height, Larry suddenly found himself face
+to face with a Russian lieutenant of marines. The fellow had a pistol in
+his hand, and as Larry raised his cutlass to strike, he dropped the
+weapon on a level with the youth's head and pulled the trigger.
+
+Had the bullet sped as intended it is likely Larry would have been
+killed. But just as the trigger fell, Luke, who was at Larry's side,
+knocked the pistol to one side with his cutlass and the bullet merely
+grazed Larry's hair. Then Larry leaped forward and gave the Russian
+lieutenant a thrust in the side which put the fellow out of the fight
+instantly.
+
+For fully fifteen minutes the battle had now raged and it was growing
+hotter each instant. All of the available men on each ship were in the
+fray, and the cries and yells which resounded were deafening.
+
+"We certainly can't keep this fight up much longer!" panted Larry. He
+had a cut on his left hand and one in the shoulder, but kept on with
+dogged determination.
+
+"Well, we ain't goin' to surrender!" grunted Luke. "It's fight or die, I
+guess!" And he leaped forward once more.
+
+Two tall Russians were directly in front of the old Yankee gunner, and
+both fell upon him with their cutlasses at the same instant. Luke was
+capable of warding off the weapon of one, but he was no match for the
+pair, and it speedily looked as if they would surely kill him.
+
+"Back with ye!" he yelled, and swung his cutlass as rapidly as he could,
+but they crowded him still closer and then one made a thrust at his face
+and another at his body.
+
+It was at this critical moment that Larry, who had been engaged with
+somebody else, saw his old war chum's predicament. With a leap he gained
+Luke's side, and down came his cutlass with a sweeping blow on the wrist
+of one of the enemy. The Russian dropped his cutlass to the deck and
+staggered back, his hand almost severed from his arm. Then Luke slashed
+the other Russian across the cheek, and both of the enemy hurried back
+behind the other fighters.
+
+"Good fer you, Larry!" panted Luke, when he could speak. "They had me
+about cornered!"
+
+"These fellows certainly know how to put up a stiff fight."
+
+"You're wounded yourself. Better go below."
+
+"No, I'm going to see it out. Why don't you go down yourself?"
+
+"It ain't in me, thet's why," answered the old Yankee gunner.
+
+Again came a fierce onslaught from the Russians. But the Japanese now
+had another rifle gun in place, and sharpshooters were crowding the
+fighting tops. The latter picked off the Russian officers, and this
+created a momentary confusion. Then came a sudden order to unlock the
+two ships and this was done.
+
+"The Russian ship is going down!" was the yell, and the news proved
+true. An explosion below decks had torn a hole in the Russian warship's
+bottom and she began to sink rapidly.
+
+The scene was now indescribable. Both the Russians and the Japanese on
+the doomed vessel endeavored to reach the deck of the _Shohirika_. In
+this struggle the majority of the Russians received the worst of it, and
+fully fifty of them, including not a few wounded, remained on board when
+the doomed warship took her final plunge beneath the waters of the sea.
+Eighteen Japanese were likewise drowned, including two under officers.
+
+"Surrender, or we will drive you over the side!" was the command from
+the Japanese, and utterly disheartened by the loss of their ship, the
+Russians threw down their arms; and the fierce and bloody contest was at
+an end. The common sailors were driven forward and chained together or
+bound with ropes, and the officers were grouped near the stern, where a
+formal surrender was made by the captain of the lost ship giving up his
+sword. This formality over, the Japanese set to work at once, cleaning
+up the deck and caring for the wounded as well as the hospital
+accommodations of the _Shohirika_ would permit.
+
+"I never wish to see another fight like that," was Larry's comment, when
+he had washed up and had his wounds dressed. "It was simply a
+slaughter!"
+
+"Right you are, lad," answered Luke. "An' I reckon I'm a-goin' to carry
+the scars o' it down to my grave." The old Yankee gunner had received
+several severe wounds, and he was glad enough to have Larry swing his
+hammock for him and lie down to rest.
+
+The battle over, the captain of the _Shohirika_ sailed away, to look for
+the big brig once more and to report to the flagship of the fleet. But
+the brig had taken time by the forelock and left for parts unknown.
+
+"I suppose that is the last of Shamhaven and Peterson and my money,"
+said Larry, when this news reached him. "I wish we had met that brig a
+week ago."
+
+"Oh, it's possible we may see her again," said Luke, cheerfully. "But it
+gets me that she ran away, unless she had something to run for."
+
+"She must have been carrying some contraband of war, Luke."
+
+"It ain't unlikely, lad. Well, she's gone, an' it ain't no use to cry
+over spilt milk. When you write to Captain Ponsberry you can tell him ye
+saw them two rascals an' thet's all the good it did."
+
+"Do you know what I'm thinking?"
+
+"Well?"
+
+"I'm thinking that brig was bound for Port Arthur, and she'll slip into
+that port some dark and misty night."
+
+"It's a risky piece o' business. Either our ships or the mines are
+likely to blow her up."
+
+"That is true. But the Russians at the port must be getting desperate,
+and they'll most likely pay any kind of a price for supplies. A captain
+who ran the blockade successfully could make a fortune," returned Larry.
+
+The young gunner's mate was right in his surmise. The big brig was a
+Russian vessel in disguise and loaded to her fullest capacity with
+supplies for the blockaded seaport. She had been fitted out at
+Vladivostok, but had taken a wide sea course, so as to pretend to have
+set sail from Nagasaki. Several Russian shipping merchants were
+interested in the venture, which was a private one, and among the number
+was Ivan Snokoff. From Captain Barusky, Snokoff had heard that fabulous
+prices could be obtained for needed commodities at Port Arthur, and he
+had invested nearly every _ruble_ he possessed in the enterprise. If the
+vessel succeeded in reaching Port Arthur, Captain Barusky was to
+undertake the disposal of the goods shipped in Snokoff's name, and then
+the two were to divide the profits.
+
+The big brig had come close to being wrecked off the coast of Japan and
+during a gale had run down a fishing smack containing Shamhaven,
+Peterson, and two Japanese. One Japanese had been drowned, and the three
+others from the smack had been made to join the crew of the big brig.
+This was agreeable to Shamhaven and Peterson, who did not wish to remain
+near Nagasaki or at any place where Captain Ponsberry or Larry would be
+likely to discover them.
+
+
+
+
+CHAPTER XXXII
+
+FALL OF PORT ARTHUR--CONCLUSION
+
+
+"Open, in the name of the Czar!"
+
+Such was the command which startled both Ben and Grace Chase, and for
+the moment each gazed at the other in horror, not knowing what to say or
+do.
+
+"I must get away from here!" whispered the young captain, but scarcely
+had he spoken when there came a crash, and the front door of the
+residence swung in. Then half a dozen Russians poured into the house.
+
+"There he is, as I suspected!" said one, an officer from the prison.
+"We'll see that you do not escape again," he added to Ben, grimly.
+
+In the midst of the excitement Nathan Chase arrived. But he could do
+nothing for the young captain, and was glad that he was left to protect
+his daughter.
+
+"We ought also to take her," said the prison official. "She did wrong to
+harbor this prisoner." And then, without further ado, Ben was marched
+back to the place from which he had escaped such a short while before.
+
+After that the time passed dismally enough for the young American. For
+having run away he was put on the most miserable fare the prison
+afforded, the food being often so vile he could not touch it. Whenever
+he attempted to protest he was met with kicks and blows.
+
+"They might as well kill me and be done with it," he thought. "Oh, how I
+wish the Japs would take the city and give me back my liberty!"
+
+In those days Port Arthur became a most uncomfortable place for all
+living there. The Japanese army was pressing forward steadily, and army
+and navy did everything possible to destroy the shipping in the harbor
+and make the various forts untenable. Shots and shells were hurled into
+the city at all hours of the day and night, until living there became
+worse than a nightmare. Among the soldiers scurvy became prevalent,
+until the hospitals could not accommodate the sick and the dying.
+Nothing was done to clean up the streets, and the rubbish lay many feet
+deep over the sidewalks. Practically all of the shops were closed, for
+they had next to nothing to sell. The main article of food was rice, and
+to cook this many old buildings had to be razed in order to procure
+necessary firewood. As winter approached the suffering of the poor
+became so intense that riots broke out and to maintain order not a few
+were shot down.
+
+Such was the condition in the city. Outside, to the northward, the
+fighting went on week after week. So many soldiers were killed upon both
+sides that to bury the dead became impossible, and thousands were left
+where they had fallen, to become the prey of vultures, or to putrefy and
+fill the locality with a stench that was as nauseating as it was deadly!
+Such are the horrors of modern warfare. The demands for universal peace
+cannot come any too quickly.
+
+In the advance on Port Arthur, Gilbert did his full share of the
+fighting. The Japanese were now struggling for the possession of what
+was known as 203-Meter Hill, a rocky elevation which was not fortified
+but which was in the direct line of Russian fire. The top of 203-Meter
+Hill commanded a fine view of Port Arthur and its harbor, and it was
+this view the Japanese needed, in order to make their shell fire most
+effective.
+
+The battle for 203-Meter Hill is one which will be long remembered. The
+Japanese fought with a desperation impossible to describe, and when the
+hill was captured, General Stoessel sent out nearly all his available
+men to retake it. But this could not be accomplished, and late in
+December the Japanese stormed the inner defenses of the Russian chain of
+forts, killing nearly all of the brave defenders who dared to oppose
+them. Then tons upon tons of shot and shell were sent into Port Arthur
+and over the harbor once again, until the locality became little short
+of an inferno. Nearly all the shipping was destroyed, and so many
+buildings were set on fire that to stem the conflagration became all but
+impossible. The end came on New Year's Day, 1905--ten months after the
+famous siege began. To hold out longer seemed impossible, and to avoid
+further carnage General Stoessel called a council of war and sent a
+message to General Nogi offering to capitulate.
+
+"Port Arthur has surrendered!" The news flew from one Japanese regiment
+to another, and soon the warships were sending the message from vessel
+to vessel. For once the Japanese showed their real feelings, and "_Banzai!
+Banzai!_" rent the air again and again. "Long life to the Mikado! Port
+Arthur is ours once more!"
+
+"It is a well-earned victory!" cried Larry, when he heard the news.
+
+"Yes, lad, and I trust it brings this bloody war to a close," came from
+Luke.
+
+"They say General Stoessel blew up the warships remaining in the
+harbor."
+
+"He couldn't have had many left," returned the old Yankee gunner. "The
+army and the navy have about battered everything to bits." And in this
+surmise Luke was correct.
+
+The fall of Port Arthur caused widespread consternation in Russia, while
+the people of Japan were correspondingly elated. Because of the gallant
+defense of the place, the Japanese made generous terms with those who
+had surrendered, much to the satisfaction of the world at large. Many
+had predicted a universal butchery, but nothing of the sort occurred,
+and the Russian sick and wounded were given every possible attention.
+
+After the fall of the port Larry was permitted to go ashore some miles
+above the town, and he managed to locate Gilbert, and then learned for
+the first time that Ben was a prisoner in the captured place.
+
+"A prisoner!" he ejaculated. "Oh, Gilbert, we must find him and have him
+released!"
+
+"That is just what I have been thinking, but I don't know exactly how to
+go at it, Larry."
+
+"There ought to be some way of doing these things. We might interview
+one of the generals and----Who is that coming this way?"
+
+"Why, it's Ben himself!" cried Gilbert.
+
+"Ben!" screamed Larry, and ran forward to meet his brother. Soon they
+were in each other's arms, and then Gilbert received an equally warm
+greeting.
+
+"We were released this morning," said Ben. "I can tell you I was mighty
+glad of it. I haven't had a meal fit to eat in weeks."
+
+"Well, you shall have the best our larder affords," said Gilbert. "My,
+but you're a sight for sore eyes!" he continued.
+
+"Don't say a word!" came from Larry. Two tears were glistening in his
+honest eyes. "It's almost too good to be true!"
+
+* * * * *
+
+Here let me add a few words more and then bring to a close this tale of
+the naval and military adventures "At the Fall of Port Arthur."
+
+After the surrender of the city the army in that vicinity, and also the
+fleet near the harbor, had but little to do outside of caring for the
+sick and wounded and disposing of the thousands of prisoners. The
+Russian officers were allowed to go on parole and the prisoners were
+transported to Japan. Many of the mines in the harbor were taken up, so
+that ships might come and go in safety.
+
+Larry was anxious to learn what had become of Shamhaven and Peterson,
+and through the Japanese guards stationed in Port Arthur located the
+rascally sailors at a cheap boarding-house. Both were made prisoners,
+and Larry got back a portion of the money stolen from Captain Ponsberry
+and himself. It was learned that the big brig had been destroyed by the
+Japanese shell fire, so that Ivan Snokoff lost everything he placed in
+the venture.
+
+"Well, it served him right," said Gilbert, when he heard of this. "He is
+responsible for the time Ben spent in prison."
+
+What had become of Captain Barusky was at first a mystery. But at last
+it was learned that he had sneaked aboard of a transport filled with
+wounded soldiers and bound for Chefoo. He pretended to be wounded
+himself, and was given medical attention until the trick was discovered,
+when he was treated as a coward. As soon as Chefoo was reached he
+disappeared, and that was the last seen or heard of him for some time.
+
+"We are well rid of that fellow," said Ben. "I hope the Russians read
+him out of their army. He isn't fit to hold a commission."
+
+"What do you imagine will be the next move in this war?" questioned
+Gilbert.
+
+"It is hard to tell. I think they will try to take Mukden, for one
+thing."
+
+"Russia is going to send out more warships," put in Larry. "If they come
+this way, it may mean more fighting for me."
+
+"Well, I reckon you'll do your duty, if you are put to it," answered
+Gilbert, with a smile.
+
+"And so will you do yours," came from Larry.
+
+"We'll all try to do our duty," broke in Ben. "We didn't join the army
+and the navy to hang back. Just the same, I'd enjoy a bit of a rest just
+now."
+
+The others agreed that the rest would be beneficial all around. It was
+given to them; and here, for the present at least, we will leave them,
+wishing them the best of good luck in the future.
+
+
+
+
+* * * * *
+
+
+
+
+Transcriber's note:
+
+Obvious punctuation errors were corrected.
+
+Additional corrections:
+ CH X: Changed "on" to "of" ...I reckon some of us...
+ CH XII: Changed "he" to "be" ...but this could not be helped...
+ CH XXII: Deleted "t" from "fittted" ...warship was being fitted...
+ CH XXVII: Changed 'threatended' to 'threatened' ...he was threatened
+ with a flogging...
+ CH XXXII: Capitalized 'And' beginning of sentence: ...the Yankee tar's
+ reply. And then, cutlasses in hand,...
+ Added comma: ...just as the trigger fell,...
+ Changed 'located' to 'locate' ...he managed to locate Gilbert...
+
+
+
+***END OF THE PROJECT GUTENBERG EBOOK AT THE FALL OF PORT ARTHUR***
+
+
+******* This file should be named 33559-8.txt or 33559-8.zip *******
+
+
+This and all associated files of various formats will be found in:
+http://www.gutenberg.org/dirs/3/3/5/5/33559
+
+
+
+Updated editions will replace the previous one--the old editions
+will be renamed.
+
+Creating the works from public domain print editions means that no
+one owns a United States copyright in these works, so the Foundation
+(and you!) can copy and distribute it in the United States without
+permission and without paying copyright royalties. Special rules,
+set forth in the General Terms of Use part of this license, apply to
+copying and distributing Project Gutenberg-tm electronic works to
+protect the PROJECT GUTENBERG-tm concept and trademark. Project
+Gutenberg is a registered trademark, and may not be used if you
+charge for the eBooks, unless you receive specific permission. If you
+do not charge anything for copies of this eBook, complying with the
+rules is very easy. You may use this eBook for nearly any purpose
+such as creation of derivative works, reports, performances and
+research. They may be modified and printed and given away--you may do
+practically ANYTHING with public domain eBooks. Redistribution is
+subject to the trademark license, especially commercial
+redistribution.
+
+
+
+*** START: FULL LICENSE ***
+
+THE FULL PROJECT GUTENBERG LICENSE
+PLEASE READ THIS BEFORE YOU DISTRIBUTE OR USE THIS WORK
+
+To protect the Project Gutenberg-tm mission of promoting the free
+distribution of electronic works, by using or distributing this work
+(or any other work associated in any way with the phrase "Project
+Gutenberg"), you agree to comply with all the terms of the Full Project
+Gutenberg-tm License (available with this file or online at
+http://www.gutenberg.org/license).
+
+
+Section 1. General Terms of Use and Redistributing Project Gutenberg-tm
+electronic works
+
+1.A. By reading or using any part of this Project Gutenberg-tm
+electronic work, you indicate that you have read, understand, agree to
+and accept all the terms of this license and intellectual property
+(trademark/copyright) agreement. If you do not agree to abide by all
+the terms of this agreement, you must cease using and return or destroy
+all copies of Project Gutenberg-tm electronic works in your possession.
+If you paid a fee for obtaining a copy of or access to a Project
+Gutenberg-tm electronic work and you do not agree to be bound by the
+terms of this agreement, you may obtain a refund from the person or
+entity to whom you paid the fee as set forth in paragraph 1.E.8.
+
+1.B. "Project Gutenberg" is a registered trademark. It may only be
+used on or associated in any way with an electronic work by people who
+agree to be bound by the terms of this agreement. There are a few
+things that you can do with most Project Gutenberg-tm electronic works
+even without complying with the full terms of this agreement. See
+paragraph 1.C below. There are a lot of things you can do with Project
+Gutenberg-tm electronic works if you follow the terms of this agreement
+and help preserve free future access to Project Gutenberg-tm electronic
+works. See paragraph 1.E below.
+
+1.C. The Project Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation ("the Foundation"
+or PGLAF), owns a compilation copyright in the collection of Project
+Gutenberg-tm electronic works. Nearly all the individual works in the
+collection are in the public domain in the United States. If an
+individual work is in the public domain in the United States and you are
+located in the United States, we do not claim a right to prevent you from
+copying, distributing, performing, displaying or creating derivative
+works based on the work as long as all references to Project Gutenberg
+are removed. Of course, we hope that you will support the Project
+Gutenberg-tm mission of promoting free access to electronic works by
+freely sharing Project Gutenberg-tm works in compliance with the terms of
+this agreement for keeping the Project Gutenberg-tm name associated with
+the work. You can easily comply with the terms of this agreement by
+keeping this work in the same format with its attached full Project
+Gutenberg-tm License when you share it without charge with others.
+
+1.D. The copyright laws of the place where you are located also govern
+what you can do with this work. Copyright laws in most countries are in
+a constant state of change. If you are outside the United States, check
+the laws of your country in addition to the terms of this agreement
+before downloading, copying, displaying, performing, distributing or
+creating derivative works based on this work or any other Project
+Gutenberg-tm work. The Foundation makes no representations concerning
+the copyright status of any work in any country outside the United
+States.
+
+1.E. Unless you have removed all references to Project Gutenberg:
+
+1.E.1. The following sentence, with active links to, or other immediate
+access to, the full Project Gutenberg-tm License must appear prominently
+whenever any copy of a Project Gutenberg-tm work (any work on which the
+phrase "Project Gutenberg" appears, or with which the phrase "Project
+Gutenberg" is associated) is accessed, displayed, performed, viewed,
+copied or distributed:
+
+This eBook is for the use of anyone anywhere at no cost and with
+almost no restrictions whatsoever. You may copy it, give it away or
+re-use it under the terms of the Project Gutenberg License included
+with this eBook or online at www.gutenberg.org
+
+1.E.2. If an individual Project Gutenberg-tm electronic work is derived
+from the public domain (does not contain a notice indicating that it is
+posted with permission of the copyright holder), the work can be copied
+and distributed to anyone in the United States without paying any fees
+or charges. If you are redistributing or providing access to a work
+with the phrase "Project Gutenberg" associated with or appearing on the
+work, you must comply either with the requirements of paragraphs 1.E.1
+through 1.E.7 or obtain permission for the use of the work and the
+Project Gutenberg-tm trademark as set forth in paragraphs 1.E.8 or
+1.E.9.
+
+1.E.3. If an individual Project Gutenberg-tm electronic work is posted
+with the permission of the copyright holder, your use and distribution
+must comply with both paragraphs 1.E.1 through 1.E.7 and any additional
+terms imposed by the copyright holder. Additional terms will be linked
+to the Project Gutenberg-tm License for all works posted with the
+permission of the copyright holder found at the beginning of this work.
+
+1.E.4. Do not unlink or detach or remove the full Project Gutenberg-tm
+License terms from this work, or any files containing a part of this
+work or any other work associated with Project Gutenberg-tm.
+
+1.E.5. Do not copy, display, perform, distribute or redistribute this
+electronic work, or any part of this electronic work, without
+prominently displaying the sentence set forth in paragraph 1.E.1 with
+active links or immediate access to the full terms of the Project
+Gutenberg-tm License.
+
+1.E.6. You may convert to and distribute this work in any binary,
+compressed, marked up, nonproprietary or proprietary form, including any
+word processing or hypertext form. However, if you provide access to or
+distribute copies of a Project Gutenberg-tm work in a format other than
+"Plain Vanilla ASCII" or other format used in the official version
+posted on the official Project Gutenberg-tm web site (www.gutenberg.org),
+you must, at no additional cost, fee or expense to the user, provide a
+copy, a means of exporting a copy, or a means of obtaining a copy upon
+request, of the work in its original "Plain Vanilla ASCII" or other
+form. Any alternate format must include the full Project Gutenberg-tm
+License as specified in paragraph 1.E.1.
+
+1.E.7. Do not charge a fee for access to, viewing, displaying,
+performing, copying or distributing any Project Gutenberg-tm works
+unless you comply with paragraph 1.E.8 or 1.E.9.
+
+1.E.8. You may charge a reasonable fee for copies of or providing
+access to or distributing Project Gutenberg-tm electronic works provided
+that
+
+- You pay a royalty fee of 20% of the gross profits you derive from
+ the use of Project Gutenberg-tm works calculated using the method
+ you already use to calculate your applicable taxes. The fee is
+ owed to the owner of the Project Gutenberg-tm trademark, but he
+ has agreed to donate royalties under this paragraph to the
+ Project Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation. Royalty payments
+ must be paid within 60 days following each date on which you
+ prepare (or are legally required to prepare) your periodic tax
+ returns. Royalty payments should be clearly marked as such and
+ sent to the Project Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation at the
+ address specified in Section 4, "Information about donations to
+ the Project Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation."
+
+- You provide a full refund of any money paid by a user who notifies
+ you in writing (or by e-mail) within 30 days of receipt that s/he
+ does not agree to the terms of the full Project Gutenberg-tm
+ License. You must require such a user to return or
+ destroy all copies of the works possessed in a physical medium
+ and discontinue all use of and all access to other copies of
+ Project Gutenberg-tm works.
+
+- You provide, in accordance with paragraph 1.F.3, a full refund of any
+ money paid for a work or a replacement copy, if a defect in the
+ electronic work is discovered and reported to you within 90 days
+ of receipt of the work.
+
+- You comply with all other terms of this agreement for free
+ distribution of Project Gutenberg-tm works.
+
+1.E.9. If you wish to charge a fee or distribute a Project Gutenberg-tm
+electronic work or group of works on different terms than are set
+forth in this agreement, you must obtain permission in writing from
+both the Project Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation and Michael
+Hart, the owner of the Project Gutenberg-tm trademark. Contact the
+Foundation as set forth in Section 3 below.
+
+1.F.
+
+1.F.1. Project Gutenberg volunteers and employees expend considerable
+effort to identify, do copyright research on, transcribe and proofread
+public domain works in creating the Project Gutenberg-tm
+collection. Despite these efforts, Project Gutenberg-tm electronic
+works, and the medium on which they may be stored, may contain
+"Defects," such as, but not limited to, incomplete, inaccurate or
+corrupt data, transcription errors, a copyright or other intellectual
+property infringement, a defective or damaged disk or other medium, a
+computer virus, or computer codes that damage or cannot be read by
+your equipment.
+
+1.F.2. LIMITED WARRANTY, DISCLAIMER OF DAMAGES - Except for the "Right
+of Replacement or Refund" described in paragraph 1.F.3, the Project
+Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation, the owner of the Project
+Gutenberg-tm trademark, and any other party distributing a Project
+Gutenberg-tm electronic work under this agreement, disclaim all
+liability to you for damages, costs and expenses, including legal
+fees. YOU AGREE THAT YOU HAVE NO REMEDIES FOR NEGLIGENCE, STRICT
+LIABILITY, BREACH OF WARRANTY OR BREACH OF CONTRACT EXCEPT THOSE
+PROVIDED IN PARAGRAPH 1.F.3. YOU AGREE THAT THE FOUNDATION, THE
+TRADEMARK OWNER, AND ANY DISTRIBUTOR UNDER THIS AGREEMENT WILL NOT BE
+LIABLE TO YOU FOR ACTUAL, DIRECT, INDIRECT, CONSEQUENTIAL, PUNITIVE OR
+INCIDENTAL DAMAGES EVEN IF YOU GIVE NOTICE OF THE POSSIBILITY OF SUCH
+DAMAGE.
+
+1.F.3. LIMITED RIGHT OF REPLACEMENT OR REFUND - If you discover a
+defect in this electronic work within 90 days of receiving it, you can
+receive a refund of the money (if any) you paid for it by sending a
+written explanation to the person you received the work from. If you
+received the work on a physical medium, you must return the medium with
+your written explanation. The person or entity that provided you with
+the defective work may elect to provide a replacement copy in lieu of a
+refund. If you received the work electronically, the person or entity
+providing it to you may choose to give you a second opportunity to
+receive the work electronically in lieu of a refund. If the second copy
+is also defective, you may demand a refund in writing without further
+opportunities to fix the problem.
+
+1.F.4. Except for the limited right of replacement or refund set forth
+in paragraph 1.F.3, this work is provided to you 'AS-IS', WITH NO OTHER
+WARRANTIES OF ANY KIND, EXPRESS OR IMPLIED, INCLUDING BUT NOT LIMITED TO
+WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTIBILITY OR FITNESS FOR ANY PURPOSE.
+
+1.F.5. Some states do not allow disclaimers of certain implied
+warranties or the exclusion or limitation of certain types of damages.
+If any disclaimer or limitation set forth in this agreement violates the
+law of the state applicable to this agreement, the agreement shall be
+interpreted to make the maximum disclaimer or limitation permitted by
+the applicable state law. The invalidity or unenforceability of any
+provision of this agreement shall not void the remaining provisions.
+
+1.F.6. INDEMNITY - You agree to indemnify and hold the Foundation, the
+trademark owner, any agent or employee of the Foundation, anyone
+providing copies of Project Gutenberg-tm electronic works in accordance
+with this agreement, and any volunteers associated with the production,
+promotion and distribution of Project Gutenberg-tm electronic works,
+harmless from all liability, costs and expenses, including legal fees,
+that arise directly or indirectly from any of the following which you do
+or cause to occur: (a) distribution of this or any Project Gutenberg-tm
+work, (b) alteration, modification, or additions or deletions to any
+Project Gutenberg-tm work, and (c) any Defect you cause.
+
+
+Section 2. Information about the Mission of Project Gutenberg-tm
+
+Project Gutenberg-tm is synonymous with the free distribution of
+electronic works in formats readable by the widest variety of computers
+including obsolete, old, middle-aged and new computers. It exists
+because of the efforts of hundreds of volunteers and donations from
+people in all walks of life.
+
+Volunteers and financial support to provide volunteers with the
+assistance they need are critical to reaching Project Gutenberg-tm's
+goals and ensuring that the Project Gutenberg-tm collection will
+remain freely available for generations to come. In 2001, the Project
+Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation was created to provide a secure
+and permanent future for Project Gutenberg-tm and future generations.
+To learn more about the Project Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation
+and how your efforts and donations can help, see Sections 3 and 4
+and the Foundation web page at http://www.gutenberg.org/fundraising/pglaf.
+
+
+Section 3. Information about the Project Gutenberg Literary Archive
+Foundation
+
+The Project Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation is a non profit
+501(c)(3) educational corporation organized under the laws of the
+state of Mississippi and granted tax exempt status by the Internal
+Revenue Service. The Foundation's EIN or federal tax identification
+number is 64-6221541. Contributions to the Project Gutenberg
+Literary Archive Foundation are tax deductible to the full extent
+permitted by U.S. federal laws and your state's laws.
+
+The Foundation's principal office is located at 4557 Melan Dr. S.
+Fairbanks, AK, 99712., but its volunteers and employees are scattered
+throughout numerous locations. Its business office is located at
+809 North 1500 West, Salt Lake City, UT 84116, (801) 596-1887, email
+business@pglaf.org. Email contact links and up to date contact
+information can be found at the Foundation's web site and official
+page at http://www.gutenberg.org/about/contact
+
+For additional contact information:
+ Dr. Gregory B. Newby
+ Chief Executive and Director
+ gbnewby@pglaf.org
+
+Section 4. Information about Donations to the Project Gutenberg
+Literary Archive Foundation
+
+Project Gutenberg-tm depends upon and cannot survive without wide
+spread public support and donations to carry out its mission of
+increasing the number of public domain and licensed works that can be
+freely distributed in machine readable form accessible by the widest
+array of equipment including outdated equipment. Many small donations
+($1 to $5,000) are particularly important to maintaining tax exempt
+status with the IRS.
+
+The Foundation is committed to complying with the laws regulating
+charities and charitable donations in all 50 states of the United
+States. Compliance requirements are not uniform and it takes a
+considerable effort, much paperwork and many fees to meet and keep up
+with these requirements. We do not solicit donations in locations
+where we have not received written confirmation of compliance. To
+SEND DONATIONS or determine the status of compliance for any
+particular state visit http://www.gutenberg.org/fundraising/donate
+
+While we cannot and do not solicit contributions from states where we
+have not met the solicitation requirements, we know of no prohibition
+against accepting unsolicited donations from donors in such states who
+approach us with offers to donate.
+
+International donations are gratefully accepted, but we cannot make
+any statements concerning tax treatment of donations received from
+outside the United States. U.S. laws alone swamp our small staff.
+
+Please check the Project Gutenberg Web pages for current donation
+methods and addresses. Donations are accepted in a number of other
+ways including checks, online payments and credit card donations.
+To donate, please visit:
+http://www.gutenberg.org/fundraising/donate
+
+
+Section 5. General Information About Project Gutenberg-tm electronic
+works.
+
+Professor Michael S. Hart is the originator of the Project Gutenberg-tm
+concept of a library of electronic works that could be freely shared
+with anyone. For thirty years, he produced and distributed Project
+Gutenberg-tm eBooks with only a loose network of volunteer support.
+
+Project Gutenberg-tm eBooks are often created from several printed
+editions, all of which are confirmed as Public Domain in the U.S.
+unless a copyright notice is included. Thus, we do not necessarily
+keep eBooks in compliance with any particular paper edition.
+
+Most people start at our Web site which has the main PG search facility:
+
+ http://www.gutenberg.org
+
+This Web site includes information about Project Gutenberg-tm,
+including how to make donations to the Project Gutenberg Literary
+Archive Foundation, how to help produce our new eBooks, and how to
+subscribe to our email newsletter to hear about new eBooks.
+
diff --git a/33559-8.zip b/33559-8.zip
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..cf80b20
--- /dev/null
+++ b/33559-8.zip
Binary files differ
diff --git a/33559-h.zip b/33559-h.zip
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..82f7f7c
--- /dev/null
+++ b/33559-h.zip
Binary files differ
diff --git a/33559-h/33559-h.htm b/33559-h/33559-h.htm
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..ed91244
--- /dev/null
+++ b/33559-h/33559-h.htm
@@ -0,0 +1,8176 @@
+<!DOCTYPE html PUBLIC "-//W3C//DTD XHTML 1.0 Strict//EN"
+ "http://www.w3.org/TR/xhtml1/DTD/xhtml1-strict.dtd">
+<html xmlns="http://www.w3.org/1999/xhtml">
+<head>
+<meta http-equiv="Content-Type" content="text/html; charset=ISO-8859-1" />
+<title>The Project Gutenberg eBook of At the Fall of Port Arthur, by Edward Stratemeyer</title>
+ <style type="text/css">
+
+body {
+ margin-left: 12%;
+ margin-right: 12%;
+}
+
+ h1,h2,h3,h4,h5 {
+ text-align: center; /* all headings centered */
+ clear: both;
+}
+
+p {
+ margin-top: .75em;
+ text-align: justify;
+ margin-bottom: .75em;
+}
+
+.p2 {margin-top: 2em;}
+.p4 {margin-top: 4em;}
+
+hr.c33 {width: 33%; margin-top: 1em; margin-bottom: 2em}
+hr.c10 {width: 10%; margin-top: 1em; margin-bottom: 4em}
+hr.c5 {width: 5%; margin-top: .5em; margin-bottom: .5em}
+
+table {
+ margin-left: auto;
+ margin-right: auto;
+}
+
+.blockquot {
+ margin-left: 5%;
+ margin-right: 5%;
+ text-align: justify;
+}
+
+.quotsig {
+ margin-left: 35%;
+ margin-top: 0em;
+ }
+
+.center {text-align: center;}
+
+.smcap {font-variant: small-caps;}
+
+.caption {text-align: center;}
+
+/* Images */
+.figcenter {
+ margin: auto;
+ text-align: center;
+}
+
+/* Transcriber notes */
+ins {text-decoration:none;
+ border-bottom: thin dotted gray;}
+
+.tnote {border: dashed 1px;
+ margin-left: 10%;
+ margin-right: 10%;
+ padding-bottom: .5em;
+ padding-top: .5em;
+ padding-left: .5em; padding-right: .5em;}
+
+ hr.full { width: 100%;
+ margin-top: 3em;
+ margin-bottom: 0em;
+ margin-left: auto;
+ margin-right: auto;
+ height: 4px;
+ border-width: 4px 0 0 0; /* remove all borders except the top one */
+ border-style: solid;
+ border-color: #000000;
+ clear: both; }
+ pre {font-size: 85%;}
+ </style>
+</head>
+<body>
+<h1>The Project Gutenberg eBook, At the Fall of Port Arthur, by Edward
+Stratemeyer, Illustrated by A. B. Shute</h1>
+<pre>
+This eBook is for the use of anyone anywhere at no cost and with
+almost no restrictions whatsoever. You may copy it, give it away or
+re-use it under the terms of the Project Gutenberg License included
+with this eBook or online at <a href = "http://www.gutenberg.org">www.gutenberg.org</a></pre>
+<p>Title: At the Fall of Port Arthur</p>
+<p> Or, A Young American in the Japanese Navy</p>
+<p>Author: Edward Stratemeyer</p>
+<p>Release Date: August 28, 2010 [eBook #33559]</p>
+<p>Language: English</p>
+<p>Character set encoding: ISO-8859-1</p>
+<p>***START OF THE PROJECT GUTENBERG EBOOK AT THE FALL OF PORT ARTHUR***</p>
+<p>&nbsp;</p>
+<h4>E-text prepared by Carol Brown, Curtis Weyant,<br />
+ and the Project Gutenberg Online Distributed Proofreading Team<br />
+ (<a href="http://www.pgdp.net/c/">http://www.pgdp.net</a>)<br />
+ from page images generously made available by<br />
+ Internet Archive/American Libraries<br />
+ (<a href="http://www.archive.org/details/americana">http://www.archive.org/details/americana</a>)</h4>
+<p>&nbsp;</p>
+<table border="0" style="background-color: #ccccff;" cellpadding="10">
+ <tr>
+ <td valign="top">
+ Note:
+ </td>
+ <td>
+ Images of the original pages are available through
+ Internet Archive/American Libraries. See
+ <a href="http://www.archive.org/details/atfallofportarth00straiala">
+ http://www.archive.org/details/atfallofportarth00straiala</a>
+ </td>
+ </tr>
+</table>
+<p>&nbsp;</p>
+<hr class="full" />
+<p>&nbsp;</p>
+
+<div class="figcenter">
+<img src="images/frontis1.jpg" width="336" height="500"
+ alt="Illustration: It is coming this way! yelled Larry.&mdash;Page 84."
+ title="It is coming this way! yelled Larry.&mdash;Page 84." />
+<p class="caption">"It is coming this way!" yelled Larry.&mdash;
+<a href="#33"><i>Page 84.</i></a></p>
+</div>
+
+<h4 class="p4">Soldiers of Fortune Series</h4>
+
+<hr class="c33" />
+
+<h1>AT THE FALL OF PORT ARTHUR</h1>
+
+<h5>OR</h5>
+
+<h2>A YOUNG AMERICAN IN THE<br />
+JAPANESE NAVY</h2>
+
+<h5>BY</h5>
+
+<h2>EDWARD STRATEMEYER</h2>
+
+<p class="center">Author of "Under the Mikado's Flag," "On to Pekin,"
+"Two Young<br />
+Lumbermen," "Old Glory Series," "Colonial Series,"<br />
+"Pan-American Series," etc.</p>
+
+<h4 class="p2"><i>ILLUSTRATED BY A. B. SHUTE</i></h4>
+
+<div class="figcenter">
+ <img src="images/logo2a.jpg"
+ width="107" height="165" alt="Illustration: Title"
+ title="printer's logo" />
+</div>
+
+<h4>BOSTON:<br />
+LOTHROP, LEE &amp; SHEPARD CO.<br />
+1930</h4>
+
+<h5 class="p4"><span class="smcap">Copyright, 1905, by Lothrop, Lee &amp;
+Shepard Company</span></h5>
+
+<hr class="c5" />
+
+<h5><i>All rights reserved</i></h5>
+
+<hr class="c5" />
+
+<h4><span class="smcap">At the Fall of Port Arthur</span></h4>
+
+<h5 class="p4">PRINTED IN U.S.A.</h5>
+
+<p class="p4 center">PREFACE</p>
+
+<p class="p2">"<span class="smcap">At the Fall of Port Arthur</span>" is
+a complete tale in itself, but forms the third volume in a line issued
+under the general title of "Soldiers of Fortune Series."</p>
+
+<p>The story relates primarily the adventures of Larry Russell and his
+old-time sea chum, Luke Striker, already well known to the readers of my
+"Old Glory Series." Larry and Luke are aboard of their old ship, the
+<i>Columbia</i>, bound from Manila to Nagasaki, with a cargo designed
+for the Japanese Government. This is during the war between Russia and
+Japan, and when close to the Japanese coast the schooner is sighted by a
+Russian warship and made a prize of war.</p>
+
+<p>As prisoners both Larry and Luke see something of life in the Russian
+navy. When close to Vladivostok, the Russian warship falls in with
+several ships of the Japanese fleet, and after a thrilling sea-fight
+surrenders with her prize. This brings Larry and Luke before Admiral
+Togo, and as Larry's brother Ben, with their mutual friend, Gilbert
+Pennington, is already in the Japanese army, Larry enters the Japanese
+navy and Luke follows suit. The siege and bombardment of Port Arthur are
+at their height; and the particulars are given of many battles both on
+the sea and on land, leading up to the ultimate surrender of that brave
+Russian commander, General Stoessel, and the fall of the city. By this
+surrender the Japanese obtained many thousands of prisoners of war,
+hundreds of cannon, with large quantities of ammunition, and several
+scores of vessels, useful for either fighting purposes or as transports.
+Moreover, this victory placed the entire southern portion of Manchuria
+under Japanese control, giving the army untrammeled use of the railroad
+running from Port Arthur to Liao-Yang, a city on the road to Mukden,
+captured some time before, as already related in another volume of this
+series, entitled "Under the Mikado's Flag."</p>
+
+<p>As I have mentioned in a previous work, it is as yet impossible to
+state what the outcome of this terrific conflict will be. So far victory
+has perched largely upon the standard of Japan. The Russian navy has
+been practically shattered and its army fought to a standstill. The cost
+of the war has been tremendous to both countries. Countless thousands of
+lives have already been sacrificed. Would that peace were soon at
+hand!</p>
+
+<p>Again I thank my young friends for their appreciation of my former
+stories. May the present tale fulfill every reasonable expectation.</p>
+
+<p class="quotsig"><span class="smcap">Edward Stratemeyer.</span></p>
+
+<h4 class="p4">CONTENTS</h4>
+
+<div>
+<table class="bold" cellpadding="6" cellspacing="10" summary="Table of
+Contents">
+
+<tr><td align='center'><span class="smcap">chapter</span></td>
+ <td> </td><td><span class="smcap">page</span></td></tr>
+
+<tr><td align='right'><span class="smcap"><a href="#1">I.</a></span>
+</td>
+ <td><span class="smcap">Larry and His Friends</span></td>
+ <td align='right'>1</td></tr>
+
+<tr><td align='right'><span class="smcap"><a href="#2">II.</a></span>
+</td>
+ <td><span class="smcap">A Storm on the Pacific</span></td>
+ <td align='right'>10</td></tr>
+
+<tr><td align='right'><span class="smcap"><a href="#3">III.</a></span>
+</td>
+ <td><span class="smcap">Larry Learns Something</span></td>
+ <td align='right'>20</td></tr>
+
+<tr><td align='right'><span class="smcap"><a href="#4">IV.</a></span>
+</td>
+ <td><span class="smcap">The Russian Sailor's Plot</span></td>
+ <td align='right'>29</td></tr>
+
+<tr><td align='right'><span class="smcap"><a href="#5">V.</a></span>
+</td>
+ <td><span class="smcap">Signs of a Mutiny</span></td>
+ <td align='right'>38</td></tr>
+
+<tr><td align='right'><span class="smcap"><a href="#6">VI.</a></span>
+</td>
+ <td><span class="smcap">The Fight for the Ship</span></td>
+ <td align='right'>47</td></tr>
+
+<tr><td align='right'><span class="smcap"><a href="#7">VII.</a></span>
+</td>
+ <td><span class="smcap">The Mutineers in Possession</span></td>
+ <td align='right'>56</td></tr>
+
+<tr><td align='right'><span class="smcap"><a href="#8">VIII.</a></span>
+</td>
+ <td><span class="smcap">Turning the Tables</span></td>
+ <td align='right'>66</td></tr>
+
+<tr><td align='right'><span class="smcap"><a href="#9">IX.</a></span>
+</td>
+ <td><span class="smcap">Close to a Waterspout</span></td>
+ <td align='right'>76</td></tr>
+
+<tr><td align='right'><span class="smcap"><a href="#10">X.</a></span>
+</td>
+ <td><span class="smcap">Something about War and Fighting Ships</span>
+ </td>
+ <td align='right'>86</td></tr>
+
+<tr><td align='right'><span class="smcap"><a href="#11">XI.</a></span>
+</td>
+ <td><span class="smcap">An Order to Lay-to</span></td>
+ <td align='right'>95</td></tr>
+
+<tr><td align='right'><span class="smcap"><a href="#12">XII.</a></span>
+</td>
+ <td><span class="smcap">Taken as a Prize of War</span></td>
+ <td align='right'>103</td></tr>
+
+<tr><td align='right'><span class="smcap"><a href="#13">XIII.</a></span>
+</td>
+ <td><span class="smcap">Prisoners on the</span> <i>Pocastra</i>
+ </td>
+ <td align='right'>113</td></tr>
+
+<tr><td align='right'><span class="smcap"><a href="#14">XIV.</a></span>
+</td>
+ <td><span class="smcap">Progress of the War</span></td>
+ <td align='right'>122</td></tr>
+
+<tr><td align='right'><span class="smcap"><a href="#15">XV.</a></span>
+</td>
+ <td><span class="smcap">A Sharp Naval Battle</span></td>
+ <td align='right'>132</td></tr>
+
+<tr><td align='right'><span class="smcap"><a href="#16">XVI.</a></span>
+</td>
+ <td><span class="smcap">Aboard a Japanese Warship</span></td>
+ <td align='right'>140</td></tr>
+
+<tr><td align='right'><span class="smcap"><a href="#17">XVII.</a></span>
+</td>
+ <td><span class="smcap">The Retaking of the</span> <i>Columbia</i>
+ </td>
+ <td align='right'>148</td></tr>
+
+<tr><td align='right'><span class="smcap"><a href="#18">XVIII.</a></span>
+</td>
+ <td><span class="smcap">A Clever Ruse</span></td>
+ <td align='right'>156</td></tr>
+
+<tr><td align='right'><span class="smcap"><a href="#19">XIX.</a></span>
+</td>
+ <td><span class="smcap">The Disappearance of the Enemy</span></td>
+ <td align='right'>164</td></tr>
+
+<tr><td align='right'><span class="smcap"><a href="#20">XX.</a></span>
+</td>
+ <td><span class="smcap">Larry before Admiral Togo</span></td>
+ <td align='right'>171</td></tr>
+
+<tr><td align='right'><span class="smcap"><a href="#21">XXI.</a></span>
+</td>
+ <td><span class="smcap">Letters of Interest</span></td>
+ <td align='right'>180</td></tr>
+
+<tr><td align='right'><span class="smcap"><a href="#22">XXII.</a></span>
+</td>
+ <td><span class="smcap">A Meeting and a Plot</span></td>
+ <td align='right'>189</td></tr>
+
+<tr><td align='right'><span class="smcap"><a href="#23">XXIII.</a></span>
+</td>
+ <td><span class="smcap">The Attack in the Dark</span></td>
+ <td align='right'>198</td></tr>
+
+<tr><td align='right'><span class="smcap"><a href="#24">XXIV.</a></span>
+</td>
+ <td><span class="smcap">The Defense of the Powder Train</span></td>
+ <td align='right'>206</td></tr>
+
+<tr><td align='right'><span class="smcap"><a href="#25">XXV.</a></span>
+</td>
+ <td><span class="smcap">Bombarding a Port Arthur Fort</span></td>
+ <td align='right'>215</td></tr>
+
+<tr><td align='right'><span class="smcap"><a href="#26">XXVI.</a></span>
+</td>
+ <td><span class="smcap">Ben Meets Captain Barusky</span></td>
+ <td align='right'>223</td></tr>
+
+<tr><td align='right'><span class="smcap"><a href="#27">XXVII.</a></span>
+</td>
+ <td><span class="smcap">A Fierce Battle at Sea</span></td>
+ <td align='right'>232</td></tr>
+
+<tr><td align='right'><span class="smcap"><a href="#28">XXVIII.</a></span>
+</td>
+ <td><span class="smcap">The Siege of Port Arthur</span></td>
+ <td align='right'>240</td></tr>
+
+<tr><td align='right'><span class="smcap"><a href="#29">XXIX.</a></span>
+</td>
+ <td><span class="smcap">From One Difficulty to Another</span></td>
+ <td align='right'>248</td></tr>
+
+<tr><td align='right'><span class="smcap"><a href="#30">XXX.</a></span>
+</td>
+ <td><span class="smcap">A Surprise for Larry</span></td>
+ <td align='right'>258</td></tr>
+
+<tr><td align='right'><span class="smcap"><a href="#31">XXXI.</a></span>
+</td>
+ <td><span class="smcap">A Call to Repel Boarders</span></td>
+ <td align='right'>266</td></tr>
+
+<tr><td align='right'><span class="smcap"><a href="#32">XXXII.</a></span>
+</td>
+ <td><span class="smcap">Fall of Port Arthur&mdash;Conclusion</span></td>
+ <td align='right'>274</td></tr>
+
+</table>
+</div>
+
+<h3 class="p4">AT THE FALL OF PORT ARTHUR</h3>
+
+<h3 class="p4">AT THE FALL OF PORT<br />ARTHUR</h3>
+
+<h3 class="p4"><a name="1">CHAPTER I</a></h3>
+
+<h4>LARRY AND HIS FRIENDS</h4>
+
+<p class="p2">"Unless I miss my guess, Luke, we are going to have a
+storm."</p>
+
+<p>"Jest what I was thinking, Larry. And when it comes I allow as how it
+will be putty heavy," replied Luke Striker, casting an eye to the
+westward, where a small dark cloud was beginning to show above the
+horizon.</p>
+
+<p>"Well, we can't expect fine weather all the time," went on Larry
+Russell, inspecting the cloud with equal interest. "We want some wind
+anyway," he added. "We are not making this return trip to Nagasaki
+nearly as fast as we made the trip to Manila."</p>
+
+<p>Luke Striker, a bronzed and weather-beaten Yankee sailor, rubbed his
+chin reflectively. "I was jest thinking o' the day I spied the old
+<i>Columbia</i> in Manila harbor," he said, meditatively. "Tell ye,
+Larry, the sight 'most struck me dumb. 'The <i>Columbia</i>,' sez I to
+myself. An' then I thought I must be a-dreamin'. I wanted to find this
+ship ag'in in the worst way."</p>
+
+<p>"The ship certainly seems like a home to me, Luke&mdash;and I reckon
+she always will seem that way. I've traveled a good many miles in her,
+since I first struck her at Honolulu in the Hawaiian Islands," responded
+Larry Russell.</p>
+
+<p>"Yes&mdash;both of us have. But we never took no trip like this
+afore&mdash;carryin' a cargo for the Japanese Government, with that
+government at war with Russia." Luke Striker lowered his voice. "What's
+the outlook? Does the old man reckon to fall in with a Russian warship
+afore we can reach Nagasaki?"</p>
+
+<p>"Hush, Luke; you mustn't mention our cargo," came from Larry Russell,
+hastily.</p>
+
+<p>"I ain't mentionin' it to anybody but you."</p>
+
+<p>"Captain Ponsberry is in hopes that we shall not meet any Russian
+warships."</p>
+
+<p>"But what if we do?"</p>
+
+<p>"Then we shall have to show our heels as best we can."</p>
+
+<p>"A sailing vessel can't show much o' a pair o' heels to a
+man-o'-war."</p>
+
+<p>"That is true."</p>
+
+<p>"I suppose, if the <i>Columbia</i> was overhauled by a Russian
+warship, they'd consider us a prize of war; wouldn't they?" continued
+the old Yankee sailor.</p>
+
+<p>"They would, unless Captain Ponsberry could get out of it in some
+way."</p>
+
+<p>"How do you think he might get out of it?"</p>
+
+<p>"Well, you must remember that our cargo doesn't belong to the
+Japanese Government yet. We are carrying it from Manila to Nagasaki for
+the Richmond Importing Company. The Russians would have to prove their
+case against us before they could claim the schooner as a legitimate
+prize of war."</p>
+
+<p>"I see. Well, I reckon as how them Russians would do 'most anything
+to square accounts with the Japs. So far, accordin' to my notions, they
+have been losin' ground right along in this war."</p>
+
+<p>"Yes, and they'll lose more before the Japs are through with 'em,
+Luke. But that storm is coming up fast," went on Larry Russell, with
+another examination of the black cloud. "I'll have to tell the captain.
+If we don't shorten sail it may do us some damage."</p>
+
+<p>With the last-mentioned remark Larry Russell walked aft, toward the
+companionway of the <i>Columbia</i>, a staunch three-masted schooner
+that hailed from Gloucester. He was second mate of the craft and as such
+it was now his duty to inform Captain Nat Ponsberry that a storm was
+approaching.</p>
+
+<p>To those of my young friends who have read "Under Dewey at Manila"
+and other volumes of the "Old Glory Series" Larry Russell needs no
+introduction. He was one of three brothers, who, left in the charge of a
+miserly step-uncle, had thought it best to go away from home and seek
+fortune in various parts of the globe. Larry had drifted to San
+Francisco and then to Honolulu, where he had fallen in with Captain Nat
+Ponsberry and the <i>Columbia</i>, as already mentioned. He, with his
+sailor friend, Luke Striker, had been cast away, and while adrift on the
+Pacific had been picked up by the Asiatic Squadron under Commodore
+(afterward Admiral) Dewey, to serve with honor during the memorable
+battle of Manila Bay.</p>
+
+<p>Since those days a great many things had occurred to the Russell
+boys. Ben, the oldest of the three, had served as a young volunteer in
+Cuba during the advance on Santiago, and as an officer with the army in
+the Philippines, and Walter, the third brother, had served in the navy
+in Cuban waters and elsewhere. In the meantime the miserly step-uncle
+had reformed, and now thought "his three boys," as he called them, "the
+best young fellers in all America, barrin' none!"</p>
+
+<p>Larry Russell was a natural sailor, and when his term in the navy
+came to an end he could not bear to think of giving up the sea. He heard
+that his old ship was bound for a trip to Japan and other ports, and at
+once communicated with Captain Ponsberry, with the result that he became
+second mate of the schooner, the first mate being, as of old, Tom
+Grandon, a personal friend of Captain Ponsberry.</p>
+
+<p>At this time Walter Russell had gone into business, and was doing
+remarkably well. But Ben was doing nothing, and Larry persuaded his
+oldest brother to come aboard the ship at Manila, for the trip to
+Nagasaki and Port Arthur. This was just at the outbreak of the war
+between Russia and Japan, but the brothers at that time knew nothing
+about the tremendous conflict so close at hand.</p>
+
+<p>The <i>Columbia</i> was carrying a cargo for the Richmond Importing
+Company, represented in Japan and China by Gilbert Pennington, who had
+served with Ben Russell in our army in Cuba and the Philippines. From
+Manila Gilbert had gone to China, to fight the Boxers, as already
+described in "On to Pekin," the first volume of this "Soldiers of
+Fortune Series." With the end of the Boxer conflict, Lieutenant
+Pennington, as he had then become, turned from war to business, and soon
+made a number of business transactions which were highly gratifying to
+the company that he represented.</p>
+
+<p>When the <i>Columbia</i> arrived at Nagasaki, Captain Ponsberry
+learned that the war had begun and that to get to Port Arthur&mdash;a
+Russian stronghold in Manchuria&mdash;was out of the question. While he
+was awaiting orders Gilbert Pennington appeared on the scene. Gilbert
+had had great difficulties in getting away from Port Arthur, having been
+suspected by the Russian officials of being a spy. He wished to know at
+once if the ship's cargo was safe.</p>
+
+<p>"As safe as when we left home," had been Captain Ponsberry's
+reply.</p>
+
+<p>"Good!" answered the young agent, and then he wished to know if
+anything had been done about selling the goods. Captain Ponsberry
+replied that he had been ordered to do nothing until he received word
+from Gilbert. This suited the young representative; and the upshot of
+the matter was that the cargo, instead of going to a Russian port, was
+sold to the Japanese Government at a price considerably above the
+ordinary market value.</p>
+
+<p>Gilbert Pennington was enthusiastic about joining the Japanese army
+for a campaign in Manchuria and he imparted a large share of this
+enthusiasm to Ben Russell. As a result both enlisted and became captains
+in a special command, under a Major Okopa, who could speak very good
+English. The part of the army to which they were assigned landed at
+Chinampo, in Korea, and in the second volume of this series, called
+"Under the Mikado's Flag," I related the particulars of the crossing of
+the Yalu River and of the many skirmishes and battles leading up to the
+terrific ten-days' contest before Liao Yang. During these fights Ben and
+Gilbert did their full duty as officers, and when the Russians retreated
+to the North both were well content to take a much-needed rest. But
+additional struggles were still in store for them, as will be learned in
+the pages which follow.</p>
+
+<p>At first Larry Russell had been inclined to follow his brother and
+his friend Gilbert into the Japanese army. But Captain Ponsberry did not
+wish to lose his services as a second mate, and when it was decided that
+the <i>Columbia</i> should make a quick run to Manila and back, for
+another cargo for the Japanese Government, he made up his mind to stick
+to the ship.</p>
+
+<p>The run to Manila from Nagasaki was made without special incident,
+and, once at the main seaport of the Philippines, Captain Ponsberry lost
+no time in getting on board the cargo the Richmond Importing Company had
+ready for him. The cargo was a valuable one and it was calculated that
+if rightly sold it would yield the company a profit of five or six
+thousand dollars.</p>
+
+<p>"You have got to take care and not run into any Russian warship,"
+said the agent of the company at Manila. "If you do you may have a whole
+lot of trouble in explaining matters to the Russian commander's
+satisfaction. I see by the reports that the Russians have already held
+up several English and South American ships."</p>
+
+<p>"I shall keep a sharp lookout for 'em," was Captain Ponsberry's
+reply.</p>
+
+<p>"And another thing, Captain," went on the agent, in a lower tone;
+"you want to watch your crew."</p>
+
+<p>"What do you mean?"</p>
+
+<p>"I don't like the looks of two or three of them. For all you know
+they may be more than willing to expose you&mdash;if you fall in with
+the Russians. Can you trust your first and second mates?"</p>
+
+<p>"I can! They are as honest as myself."</p>
+
+<p>"Then caution them to keep an eye on the hands. One of those fellows
+looks like a Russian to me&mdash;the chap with the heavy black
+beard."</p>
+
+<p>"You mean Semmel. He says he is a Pole and that he hates the
+Russians."</p>
+
+<p>"Humph! Well, I saw him talking to a lot of Russians night before
+last. And when they passed a Jap the whole crowd jeered at the little
+brown man."</p>
+
+<p>"Semmel, too?"</p>
+
+<p>"Yes."</p>
+
+<p>"Then I shall watch him," answered Captain Ponsberry, decidedly.</p>
+
+<p>"Do, but don't let him know it. Some of these foreign sailors are
+ugly when they find out they are being suspected."</p>
+
+<p>"Trust me to manage him," returned the commander of the
+<i>Columbia</i>; and there the talk on the subject came to an end.</p>
+
+<h3 class="p4"><a name="2">CHAPTER II</a></h3>
+
+<h4>A STORM ON THE PACIFIC</h4>
+
+<p class="p2">Larry found Captain Ponsberry working over a chart on the
+cabin table, laying out the course of the ship. The commander of the
+<i>Columbia</i> was a bluff, hearty individual and he and the young
+second mate thought a great deal of each other.</p>
+
+<p>"Well, what is it?" asked the captain, looking up quickly.</p>
+
+<p>"I came to report that a storm is coming up from the west," answered
+Larry.</p>
+
+<p>"Humph! I was afraid we'd catch it sooner or later. Is it close up
+yet?"</p>
+
+<p>"It's coming up pretty fast."</p>
+
+<p>Captain Ponsberry said no more, but threw down his parallel rulers
+and his pencil. Catching up his cap, he mounted to the deck, and the
+young second mate followed at his heels. The captain gave a long look to
+the westward and then a gaze around the remainder of the horizon.</p>
+
+<p>"Tell Cal Vincent to call all hands to shorten sail!" he called out
+to Larry. "Tell 'em to tumble up quick, too&mdash;thet storm ain't none
+too far off for comfort!"</p>
+
+<p>Larry passed the word to Cal Vincent, who was the boatswain of the
+<i>Columbia</i>, and soon the whistle piped up shrilly, and those who
+were below or in the forecastle, came on deck in a hurry. Already the
+wind was freshening, ruffling up the whitecaps in all directions. The
+sky, that had been so blue a short while before, became leaden, and the
+depths of the ocean took on a somber hue. The barometer indicated a
+great and immediate change.</p>
+
+<p>"Lay aloft there, men!" cried Captain Ponsberry. "Our sails are
+mostly new and we don't want them ripped up if we can help it. Skip
+along there, Peterson!" The latter words to a big sailor who was moving
+across the deck at a snail's pace.</p>
+
+<p>The sailor addressed, scowled. It was not his watch on deck and he
+hated to have his midday nap disturbed.</p>
+
+<p>"Got a nail in ma boot," he said.</p>
+
+<p>"Well, haul it out&mdash;after the sails are trimmed," returned the
+captain, and then turned to another hand: "Semmel, what's the matter
+with you?" This to the suspicious-looking sailor with the heavy black
+beard.</p>
+
+<p>"Nodding," grumbled Semmel, and turned away sulkily.</p>
+
+<p>"Then get a move on, or we may lose a stick as well as a sail," and
+there followed a perfect volley of orders in a tone that none of the
+sailors misunderstood. Up to the yards they crawled like so many
+monkeys, and soon the creaking of halyard blocks was heard, as the
+topsails came down. The jib and flying jib were also taken in, and a
+little later the main-course and the mizzen-course.</p>
+
+<p>"Reckon we can stand the fore-course for a little while longer," said
+Captain Ponsberry to Tom Grandon. "What do you think?"</p>
+
+<p>"We can, unless it comes quicker nor it is coming now," returned the
+first mate.</p>
+
+<p>"Well, keep an eye on the wind and reef her as soon as it begins to
+look nasty," said Captain Ponsberry, and returned to the cabin, to
+finish his nautical calculations.</p>
+
+<p>The <i>Columbia</i> had left the last of the Philippines behind and
+was headed north through the China Sea toward the lower extremity of
+Formosa. She was not as new a ship as when Larry had first boarded her
+at Honolulu, for since that time she had seen half a dozen years of hard
+service. But Captain Ponsberry was a careful man and believed in making
+repairs as soon as they were needed, so there was small danger of her
+opening her seams or going to pieces even in the stiffest of blows. She
+leaked a little&mdash;the best of ships do that&mdash;but a short
+pumping every morning kept the water at the bottom of the well.</p>
+
+<p>As second mate, it was Larry's duty to see that everything on the
+deck was "ship-shape," and this was especially necessary when a storm
+was coming up. He made a tour of the ship, his keen eyes taking in every
+detail.</p>
+
+<p>As it happened, an hour before he had set the sailor Semmel to work
+stowing away some odds and ends of rope. He had supposed that this task
+was long since finished, but now he found the ropes scattered about as
+before.</p>
+
+<p>"See here, Semmel," he called out, "why didn't you stow away those
+ropes as I told you?"</p>
+
+<p>"Stow dem avay in a leetle vile," answered the sailor with the heavy
+beard.</p>
+
+<p>"You'll stow them away now," returned Larry, sharply. He did not at
+all fancy the manner of the hand he was addressing. "I told you to do it
+an hour ago. We don't want anything loose on deck when this storm hits
+us."</p>
+
+<p>"Vincent kicked de ropes out dare," growled Semmel. "I had nodding to
+do mit 'em."</p>
+
+<p>"That isn't here or there. I told you to stow them away, and I want
+you to do it. If you don't, I'll have to report you to the captain."</p>
+
+<p>"Oh, I do him!" grumbled Semmel, but he glared at Larry as if he
+wished to chew the young second mate up. "You put all dare vork on me,
+hey?" he added, after a pause.</p>
+
+<p>"You've got to do your share of it."</p>
+
+<p>"Humph!" Semmel seemed on the point of saying more, but shut his
+teeth and began to arrange the ropes in proper order. Larry watched him
+for a moment and then walked away. As soon as his back was turned the
+sailor shook his fist at the young second mate.</p>
+
+<p>"You vait!" he muttered. "Chust vait, you Jankee rat!"</p>
+
+<p>The sky kept growing darker, and soon came a puff of wind much
+heavier than any that had gone before. The <i>Columbia</i> had been
+moving over the waves on an even keel, but now she gave a sudden lurch
+to starboard.</p>
+
+<p>"Reckon it's time to take them reefs in the fore-course," said Grandon
+to Larry, and soon the sailors were at work on the sheets, leaving just
+sufficient canvas up to make the schooner mind her helm. It was hard
+work, for the sudden gusts made the sail snap and crack like a whip.</p>
+
+<p>So far it had not rained a drop, but now came a sudden downpour, the
+drops "as big as hen's eggs," to use Luke Striker's manner of describing
+them. Then came a flash of lightning out of the western sky, followed by
+a rumble of thunder.</p>
+
+<p>"This is going to be an old-time storm," was Larry's comment, as he
+met Luke Striker near the forecastle. "I'll have to get my oilskin
+out."</p>
+
+<p>Luke already had his raincoat on and soon the young mate was
+similarly provided. Wind and rain were increasing, and presently there
+came a flash of lightning and a clap of thunder that made everybody
+jump. The thunder brought Captain Ponsberry to the deck in a hurry.</p>
+
+<p>"Did that hit us?" he questioned, looking around anxiously.</p>
+
+<p>"No, sir, but it was pretty close," replied Grandon.</p>
+
+<p>"Is everything secure?" went on the commander, to Larry.</p>
+
+<p>"Yes, sir."</p>
+
+<p>It was difficult to converse further, for the wind was now whistling
+through the rigging, driving the rain in sheets across the deck. All had
+to hold fast for fear of being swept overboard. On every side the sea
+was lashing itself into a foam and the waves were growing higher and
+higher. At one instant the <i>Columbia</i> would seem to be riding on
+top of a mountain, the next she would sink down and down into the trough
+of the sea.</p>
+
+<p>"Well, Larry, how do you like this?" questioned Captain Ponsberry, as
+he took a position beside the second mate.</p>
+
+<p>"Oh, I don't mind it at all," was the cheery answer. "I used to mind
+the storms, but I've got used to them."</p>
+
+<p>"This isn't a plaything we are getting."</p>
+
+<p>"Oh, I know that&mdash;you can see it by the way the wind is driving
+us. But we are not near any land, are we?"</p>
+
+<p>"No."</p>
+
+<p>"Then we'll be sure to outride it. I feel I can bank on the old
+<i>Columbia</i> for almost anything."</p>
+
+<p>At this Captain Ponsberry laid an affectionate hand on his second
+mate's shoulder.</p>
+
+<p>"Reckon you love the old craft about as well as I do," he said.</p>
+
+<p>"I don't know about that&mdash;you've been on board so many more
+years than myself. But to me she is a second home."</p>
+
+<p>"I see. Well, let us hope we get through with this trip in
+safety."</p>
+
+<p>"Don't you imagine we'll do it?" questioned Larry, quickly.</p>
+
+<p>"Certainly. But you must remember that we may have trouble if we fall
+in with any Russian warship." Captain Ponsberry lowered his voice. "Did
+you have trouble with Semmel?"</p>
+
+<p>"A little. I ordered him to coil up some ropes and he didn't obey me
+right away. But he stowed them away afterwards."</p>
+
+<p>Captain Ponsberry drew a long breath. "The more I see of that chap
+the less I like him."</p>
+
+<p>"I never liked him from the start," answered Larry, frankly. "But
+you'll have to give him credit for being a good all-round sailor."</p>
+
+<p>"There is no doubt but what he is that, Larry. But he has a bad
+eye."</p>
+
+<p>"What do you think he could do to harm us?"</p>
+
+<p>"Nothing&mdash;unless we fell in with a Russian warship. In that
+case, if he was a Russian sympathizer, he might expose the fact that
+while we are carrying a cargo for the Richmond Importing Company the
+goods are really meant for the Japanese Government."</p>
+
+<p>"Does he know that?"</p>
+
+<p>"I'm not sure, one way or the other. What I am afraid of is, that he
+may know a good bit more nor we suspect."</p>
+
+<p>"I see." The young second mate mused for a moment. "I'll tell you
+what I'd do, if I thought he was going to play me foul&mdash;and we fell
+in with a Russian warship. I'd clap him below decks, out of sight until
+the warship went on her way again."</p>
+
+<p>"That's easily said; but I can't make him a prisoner unless I can
+prove something against him."</p>
+
+<p>"You can lock him up if he is sulky and won't obey orders."</p>
+
+<p>"Yes, that is true. Still&mdash;&mdash;Phew!"</p>
+
+<p>The captain broke off short, for a vivid streak of lightning flared
+all over the upper masts of the ship. The thunder-clap was as sharp as
+it was deafening, and for the moment all on board thought the
+<i>Columbia</i> had surely been struck. Then came a downpour which made
+even the boldest of the sailors seek shelter.</p>
+
+<p>"That was closer than I like," was Larry's comment, after it was
+ascertained that the ship was unharmed.</p>
+
+<p>"'Most knocked me overboard," came from Luke Striker. "Gosh! reckon
+my hair's singed," and he put up his hand and ran his fingers through
+his grayish locks. "Don't want another like thet nohow!"</p>
+
+<p>A few minutes later came another flash of lightning, but this was to
+the eastward, showing that the center of the storm had passed them. The
+wind was apparently going down, but the sea was as angry as ever and
+would be for hours to come.</p>
+
+<p>Luke had retired to the forecastle with several other sailors.
+Larry's watch on deck was also at an end, and he was just on the point
+of going below, when from the west came a curious humming sound which
+made the young second mate pause. The humming increased, and then of a
+sudden the <i>Columbia</i> was caught in a hurricane blast that threw
+her far over on her side.</p>
+
+<p>"Help!" Larry heard, in the voice of Captain Ponsberry. "Somebody
+help me, quick, or I'll go overboard!"</p>
+
+<h3 class="p4"><a name="3">CHAPTER III</a></h3>
+
+<h4>LARRY LEARNS SOMETHING</h4>
+
+<p class="p2">The accident which had happened to Captain Nat Ponsberry
+was certainly a curious one, although similar to that which once cost
+the life of a young officer in our navy.</p>
+
+<p>When the hurricane blast reached the <i>Columbia</i>, the captain was
+in the act of slipping on a lined raincoat,&mdash;a big affair, with
+long sleeves and an extra high collar. One arm was in the coat and the
+other was going down the sleeve when it caught in the lining. At that
+instant the shock threw the captain across the deck and almost over the
+railing. He caught at the railing with his free hand, but his other hand
+remained a prisoner in the coat sleeve, while the garment itself stuck
+in a bunch across his shoulders.</p>
+
+<p>"Help!" he roared again. He tried to pull himself up, and to free the
+hand in the sleeve, but found both impossible.</p>
+
+<p>Larry did not wait for a second cry for assistance. He knew the
+captain so well that he felt the officer would only call when in dire
+peril. He ran out on the slippery deck in double-quick order.</p>
+
+<p>"Hullo, where are you?" he yelled.</p>
+
+<p>"Here! Help!"</p>
+
+<p>The young second mate caught sight of the captain not a moment too
+soon. Another lurch of the <i>Columbia</i> had thrown him completely
+over the rail, and there he clung with one hand, while the spray was
+flying all over him.</p>
+
+<p>Not waiting to count the possible cost, Larry slid rather than ran to
+the rail. Years before he had learned a trick which now stood him in
+good stead. He wound his legs around the under rail, catching the upper
+one with his left hand. Then he clutched Captain Ponsberry by the
+tangled-up arm.</p>
+
+<p>"On deck there!" he yelled. "Throw a rope this way, and hurry up
+about it!"</p>
+
+<p>"What's the trouble?" came from Tom Grandon, who had been in another
+part of the ship and had not heard the captain's cry.</p>
+
+<p>"The captain is almost overboard. Throw us a rope."</p>
+
+<p>Tom Grandon was quick to act. The rope came whizzing toward Larry,
+and in a twinkling he had it around his body and also around the
+captain.</p>
+
+<p>"Haul in!" he called, and Grandon and two sailors did so. Over the
+rail came Captain Ponsberry, still fighting to release the tangled-up
+arm. In a moment more all danger was past.</p>
+
+<p>"Well, how in the world did this happen?" questioned Grandon.</p>
+
+<p>"Tell ye&mdash;soon as I can git free o' this consarned coat!"
+spluttered Captain Ponsberry, and he gave the garment a jerk that ripped
+one of the sleeves completely in half. "Did ye ever see sech
+foolishness?" he added. And then he told how the lurch of the ship had
+carried him over the rail just when he could use but one hand. "After
+this I reckon I'll put on my coat afore I go on deck," he concluded.</p>
+
+<p>"It was a lucky thing that Larry heard you cry out," said the first
+mate. "I was at the wheel, helping Groot."</p>
+
+<p>"That's right, Tom." The captain turned to the youth. "Larry, you're
+a brave one, and always was. I ain't going to forget this!"</p>
+
+<p>"Oh, don't say anything about it," came from the young second mate,
+modestly. "I know you'd do as much for me, if I needed it."</p>
+
+<p>"Well, I would, an' there's my hand on it," cried Captain Ponsberry,
+heartily, and gave Larry a grip that made him wince.</p>
+
+<p>The storm kept up for the remainder of the day. But its worst fury
+was spent, and during the night the wind went down to nothing more than
+a stiff breeze, which was just what was wanted. All of the sails were
+again set; and the schooner resumed her course as before.</p>
+
+<p>Before leaving Manila Larry had purchased a number of newspapers
+printed in that city in English. So far he had had no chance to look the
+sheets over, but now came two days in which there was little to do, and
+he spent several hours in devouring the news, while he also let his
+friend Luke do some reading.</p>
+
+<p>"Tell ye what, this 'ere war between Russia and Japan is goin' to be
+a big thing," said Luke, after reading an account of the first fights on
+land and on sea. "It ain't goin' to be no such short affair as our
+little rumpus in Cuby."</p>
+
+<p>"You are right, Luke; this war is going to be a long and bitter
+one."</p>
+
+<p>"Who is goin' to win, do you think?"</p>
+
+<p>"I'm sure I don't know. Russia is a vast country, with millions of
+people and with an immense army and navy. I suppose she can put five
+times as many men in the field as Japan can."</p>
+
+<p>"But them Japs know how to fight."</p>
+
+<p>"Indeed they do&mdash;they have proved that already. And what is to
+their advantage, they are closer to Korea and Manchuria than Russia is.
+They can get on the fighting ground quicker,&mdash;which counts for a
+good deal."</p>
+
+<p>"How those Russians must have been astonished when the Japanese
+warships sailed into 'em at Port Arthur last February. I don't believe
+they were expecting an attack."</p>
+
+<p>"Hardly, for war had just been declared. But you wouldn't have caught
+Uncle Sam napping like that, Luke."</p>
+
+<p>"Right ye are, lad; it ain't his style. An' then to see how them Japs
+have been a-blowin' up the Russian warships ever since. They must have a
+fine navy."</p>
+
+<p>"Yes, and good gunners, too. I was told in Nagasaki that quite a few
+American gunners were on their ships&mdash;fellows who served under
+Dewey at Manila and under Sampson and Schley off Cuba."</p>
+
+<p>"I believe you, lad. When a feller gits it in his bones to fight on a
+warship there ain't no life on a merchantman goin' to satisfy him. Some
+jackies would rather fight nor eat&mdash;you know thet as well as I
+do."</p>
+
+<p>"Well, I shouldn't mind doing some fighting myself. You know I was on
+a stand about going with Ben and Gilbert Pennington."</p>
+
+<p>"Where do you reckon they are now?"</p>
+
+<p>"In Manchuria, I suppose, fighting as hard as they can. I thought I
+would get a letter from them before we left Manila, but nothing
+came."</p>
+
+<p>"I suppose the mails are all upset, on account of the war," put in
+Cal Vincent, who sat nearby, sewing a button on his shirt. "If you'll
+remember, Nagasaki was in a big state of excitement while we were there
+last."</p>
+
+<p>"Did they say anything about any Russian warships bein' in these
+parts?" questioned Luke.</p>
+
+<p>"No."</p>
+
+<p>"It would be strange if we did fall in with them."</p>
+
+<p>"Which puts me in mind," came from the boatswain, and then he gazed
+around to see if any other persons were near. "Semmel says he ain't no
+Russian, but it's dollars to doughnuts he is," he continued, in a
+lowered tone.</p>
+
+<p>"Have you discovered anything new?" demanded Larry.</p>
+
+<p>"Yes and no. Last night I overheard him and Peterson talking in a
+suspicious kind of a way. I didn't catch much, for they talked partly in
+English and partly in a foreign language. But I am sure they are
+favoring Russia, and Semmel said something about doing something to harm
+Japan."</p>
+
+<p>"I don't see how they could do anything on board of this ship," came
+from Luke.</p>
+
+<p>"You didn't hear anything definite?"</p>
+
+<p>"Can't say that I did," answered the boatswain.</p>
+
+<p>"We had better watch them closer than ever."</p>
+
+<p>"All right; I'll do my share," responded Vincent, and Luke Striker
+said the same.</p>
+
+<p>That very afternoon Larry had another quarrel with the sailor with
+the long beard. Semmel had a bucket of dirty water which he was carrying
+to the ship's side. As Larry passed he pretended to stub his toe and
+allowed some of the dirty water to flow over the young second mate's
+foot.</p>
+
+<p>"Semmel, what did you do that for?" cried Larry, indignantly.</p>
+
+<p>"Canno help dat," said the sailor. "I slip."</p>
+
+<p>"You did it on purpose!"</p>
+
+<p>"Oh, no!" And the sailor grinned wickedly.</p>
+
+<p>"I say you did. If you try anything like that again, I'll make it
+warm for you. Get a swab and clean the deck up at once!"</p>
+
+<p>As Semmel sauntered off, and while Larry was stamping the water from
+his shoe, Captain Ponsberry came up. He had seen the trick played from a
+distance.</p>
+
+<p>"What did you tell Semmel?" he questioned, sharply.</p>
+
+<p>"Told him to swab the deck up. I think he slopped the dirty water
+over me on purpose."</p>
+
+<p>"Just my idea of it. I'll tell him what I think of it." And striding
+after the bearded sailor Captain Ponsberry gave him a lecture not to be
+readily forgotten.</p>
+
+<p>"I won't have any of your dirty underhanded work aboard of my ship,"
+he concluded. "Either you'll behave yourself, or I'll put you in
+irons."</p>
+
+<p>"In irons!" ejaculated Semmel, scowling viciously.</p>
+
+<p>"That is what I said and that is what I mean. Ever since you came on
+board you have been acting in this same dirty fashion and I want it
+stopped. Now swab up that deck, and see that you make a first-class job
+of it. For two pins I'd make you black Russell's shoes."</p>
+
+<p>"No black nobody's shoes," growled Semmel, but in such a low tone
+that Captain Ponsberry could not hear him. He cleaned the deck in his
+own ugly, independent manner, muttering imprecations against both Larry
+and the captain in the meantime.</p>
+
+<p>As a matter of fact, even though he had denied it to Captain
+Ponsberry and others, Ostag Semmel was really a Russian by birth, having
+been born and raised in the seaport of Kolaska. He had been drafted into
+the army, but not wishing to serve under a military rule which is
+unusually severe, he had run away to sea and become a sailor.</p>
+
+<p>Life on the ocean suited Semmel very well and he would have remained
+away from Russia had it not been for the fact that a rich uncle had died
+leaving him a property valued at two thousand dollars&mdash;a small
+fortune in the eyes of a man of this Russian's standing. He wished to go
+back to claim his inheritance, but feared to do so, for he knew that
+once on Russian soil he would be arrested for desertion, and might be
+sent to a military prison for a great number of years.</p>
+
+<p>From a friend in Manila he had heard of something which interested
+him greatly. This was the news that another deserter from the Russian
+army had been pardoned for his offense because he had taken home with
+him important news concerning the movements of a certain Japanese
+warship.</p>
+
+<p>"If I could only do as well," he told himself, over and over again,
+and then, when he signed articles for the <i>Columbia's</i> trip, he
+listened eagerly to some talk he overheard about the ship's cargo. When
+he began to suspect the truth&mdash;that the cargo was meant for the
+Japanese Government&mdash;his eyes glistened cunningly.</p>
+
+<p>"If I can only let Russia know of this!" he reasoned. "All will go
+well with me. If I can only let Russia know!"</p>
+
+<h3 class="p4"><a name="4">CHAPTER IV</a></h3>
+
+<h4>THE RUSSIAN SAILOR'S PLOT</h4>
+
+<p class="p2">Captain Ponsberry's stern manner made Ostag Semmel wild
+with hatred, and when he went back to the forecastle after swabbing up
+the deck he was in a fit mental condition for almost any dark deed.</p>
+
+<p>For a good half-hour he lay in his bunk in a corner, brooding over
+his ill-luck and wondering what he could do to revenge himself upon both
+the master of the schooner and Larry. Larry he especially
+disliked&mdash;the very open-heartedness of the young second mate made
+him long to do the lad harm.</p>
+
+<p>At the end of the half-hour another sailor came in. It was Carl
+Peterson, his close friend. Peterson was a burly tar who had visited
+nearly every quarter of the globe. He loved to drink and carouse, and
+was ever ready to lend a hand in any excitement that offered. There was
+a rumor that he had once led a mutiny on a Danish merchant vessel, but
+this he denied, laying the blame entirely on others.</p>
+
+<p>"Is that you, Peterson?" demanded Semmel, in his native tongue, for
+he knew that the other could speak Russian fluently.</p>
+
+<p>"Yes," came in a rough voice from Peterson. He gave a coarse laugh.
+"A fine job you made of it, to pour dirty water over Russell and then
+have to swab up the deck for it."</p>
+
+<p>"Who told you of that?"</p>
+
+<p>"Didn't I see it with my own eyes&mdash;and heard what the captain
+said, too."</p>
+
+<p>"Bah! It makes me sick!" growled Semmel. "I am sick of the
+ship&mdash;the crew&mdash;everything!"</p>
+
+<p>Peterson gave a short toss of his head, which was covered with a
+shock of fiery red hair. "What are you going to do about it? Even if the
+captain treats you like a dog, what shall you do, Ostag Semmel? He
+thinks we are all curs&mdash;door mats to wipe feet on!"</p>
+
+<p>"He shall find out that I am neither a dog nor a door mat!" muttered
+the bearded Russian. "By my right hand I promise you that!"</p>
+
+<p>"Talk is cheap&mdash;it takes wind to make the mill go," answered
+Peterson. To an outsider it would have been plain to see that he was
+leading Semmel on, in an endeavor to find out what was in his
+companion's mind.</p>
+
+<p>"It will not end in talk."</p>
+
+<p>"Bah! I have heard that before."</p>
+
+<p>"I have been thinking," went on Ostag Semmel, slowly. "Can I trust
+you?"</p>
+
+<p>"You know you can."</p>
+
+<p>"You do not love the captain&mdash;do not love that Russell?"</p>
+
+<p>"Do I act as if I did?"</p>
+
+<p>"Good! Now, how many on board of this ship?"</p>
+
+<p>"Fourteen men, counting in ourselves."</p>
+
+<p>"You count fairly. Fourteen, how many are our friends?"</p>
+
+<p>"Postnak and Conroy, at least."</p>
+
+<p>"Then we are four, so far. Now, what of Groot and Shamhaven and Jack
+Wilbur?"</p>
+
+<p>"Groot is a good fellow and a man who wishes to make money."</p>
+
+<p>"And Shamhaven will do almost anything for money&mdash;he once told
+me so. He took a sailor suit from a store in Manila without paying for
+it."</p>
+
+<p>"I know that too. The tailor was rich and didn't need the money," and
+Peterson gave another coarse laugh.</p>
+
+<p>"Then we are six&mdash;to stand up for our rights. And Jack Wilbur
+will make seven&mdash;just half the number on the ship."</p>
+
+<p>"How can we count that Wilbur in? He is a Yankee."</p>
+
+<p>"He is a weakling and we can manage him,&mdash;and I think we can
+manage some others, too&mdash;when we get that far."</p>
+
+<p>"How far do you mean?" demanded Peterson, although he knew about what
+was coming.</p>
+
+<p>"Is anybody else near here?"</p>
+
+<p>"No," and Peterson took a careful look around.</p>
+
+<p>"Supposing we seize the ship&mdash;in the name of the Russian
+Government? They have a Japanese cargo on board, the captain cannot deny
+it. We can take the ship, sail her to some Russian port, and win both
+prize money and glory. Is it not a grand scheme?"</p>
+
+<p>"Ha, that is fine!" Carl Peterson's eyes glowed voraciously. "Ostag,
+you are a man after my own heart! We might become rich!"</p>
+
+<p>"Then you like the plan?"</p>
+
+<p>"Yes&mdash;providing we can make it work. But it is a big
+undertaking. If we were caught we might swing from a yardarm for
+it."</p>
+
+<p>"We can make it work&mdash;I have another plan for that. I have
+thought it out completely. We can&mdash;but more later," and Ostag
+Semmel broke off abruptly, as several sailors entered the forecastle. A
+little later he began to complain in broken English to a sailor named
+Jack Wilbur that he was suffering from a severe stomach ache.</p>
+
+<p>"Sorry to hear on it," said Wilbur, who was a very mild foremast
+hand. "Anything I can do for you?"</p>
+
+<p>"I dink not," answered Semmel. "I dink de poor grub ve git mak me
+feel pad."</p>
+
+<p>"Didn't notice that the grub was poor," answered Wilbur.</p>
+
+<p>"Very poor&mdash;not so goot as py my las' ship," answered Semmel.
+"Some grub here not fit to eat."</p>
+
+<p>It was soon noised around that Semmel was not feeling well and that
+he had complained that the food dealt out at noontime had made him sick.
+As soon as Captain Ponsberry heard of this he went to interview Jeff,
+the colored cook, who, as of old, was singing gayly to himself among the
+pots and pans of the ship's galley.</p>
+
+<p>"Wasn't nuffin de mattah wid dat grub, Cap'n Ponsberry," exclaimed
+Jeff, after hearing what the commander of the ship had to say. "It was
+jess as good as we always has."</p>
+
+<p>"Was it thoroughly cooked?"</p>
+
+<p>"Yes, sah&mdash;I don't 'low nuffin to go from dis yere galley 'less
+it am well cooked."</p>
+
+<p>"Are your pots and kettles clean?"</p>
+
+<p>"Yes, sah&mdash;yo' can see fo' yourself, sah."</p>
+
+<p>The captain did see, and moreover he knew that Jeff was usually a
+careful and conscientious culinary artist who always gave the men the
+best his stock afforded.</p>
+
+<p>"Well, be careful of what you cook and how you cook it after this,"
+said Captain Ponsberry.</p>
+
+<p>"Would yo' mind tellin' me, sah, who is kicking, sah?" asked Jeff,
+respectfully.</p>
+
+<p>"Semmel says he was made sick by what he ate."</p>
+
+<p>"Huh, dat scab!" grunted Jeff. "He ain't no 'count at all, he ain't!"
+And the cook turned away in disgust.</p>
+
+<p>"It looks to me as if Semmel was trying to make trouble all around,"
+said Tom Grandon, when he and the captain and Larry talked the matter
+over.</p>
+
+<p>"I never liked that man from the first time I clapped eyes on him,"
+came from Larry. "He's a sneak&mdash;and worse."</p>
+
+<p>"I shall watch him pretty closely after this," said Captain
+Ponsberry. "One discontented fellow like him can upset the whole ship if
+he sets out to do it."</p>
+
+<p>"They can't complain of the grub," went on the first mate. "It's as
+good as on any merchantman, and better than the law requires."</p>
+
+<p>"I guess it was the deck-swabbing that gave him the stomach ache,"
+said Larry, and this made the captain and Grandon smile.</p>
+
+<p>The next day when the sailors sat down to their dinner two or three
+of them sniffed suspiciously at the food they were eating.</p>
+
+<p>"This don't taste just right to me," said Shamhaven. "The meat tastes
+decayed."</p>
+
+<p>"And the vegetables ain't much better," put in Conroy,&mdash;a sturdy
+Irish-American, who was one of the best seamen on the schooner.</p>
+
+<p>"Dat dinner am fust-class," cried Jeff. "I ain't gwine to stand yere
+an' see you growlin' at it."</p>
+
+<p>"It certainly tastes a bit off, Jeff," put in Jack Wilbur. "Taste it
+yourself."</p>
+
+<p>The cook did so, and his face looked doubtful for a moment.</p>
+
+<p>"Guess dat needs a little salt an' pepper," he said, slowly. It did
+not taste nearly as good as he had anticipated.</p>
+
+<p>As there was nothing else to do, and they were hungry, the men ate
+the meal, grumbling to themselves as they did so. Luke said but little
+and ate sparingly, and his example was followed by Cal Vincent.</p>
+
+<p>The captain, Grandon, and Larry ate in the cabin and the dinner
+served to them was first-class in every particular.</p>
+
+<p>"Guess Jeff is spreading himself, just to show what he can do,"
+remarked Larry to the first mate, after he had finished his repast.</p>
+
+<p>"It's very good, Larry," answered Tom Grandon.</p>
+
+<p>By the middle of the afternoon three of the men were complaining of
+feeling sick and all attributed their ailments to what they had eaten
+for dinner.</p>
+
+<p>"Ha! vat I tole you?" cried Semmel. "Didn't I say de grub vos pad?
+Not maybe you belief me, hey?"</p>
+
+<p>"I shan't stand for any more poor grub," came from Shamhaven. "If I
+can't get good stuff I'm going to the captain about it."</p>
+
+<p>The sickness of the hands worried Captain Ponsberry greatly and he
+opened up his medicine chest and gave them such remedies as he thought
+were best.</p>
+
+<p>At supper time Jeff was extra cautious in selecting and preparing the
+food. Nevertheless, the men who ate of it were suspicious and more than
+half the meal went to waste. The captain was very thoughtful, but said
+little or nothing.</p>
+
+<p>On the following day the wind died down utterly and it was
+exceedingly warm. With nothing to do, the majority of the hands gathered
+at the bow to talk of matters in general, and the food in particular.
+Semmel and Peterson were of the number, and both did all in their power
+to magnify the outrage, as they termed it.</p>
+
+<p>"Der captain don't haf any right to gif us such grub," said Semmel.
+"It vos against der law."</p>
+
+<p>"On some ships there would be a mutiny over this," added
+Peterson.</p>
+
+<p>Larry overheard a part of the conversation and it set him thinking.
+Luke Striker also grew suspicious.</p>
+
+<p>"Unless I am mistaken, this is some of Semmel's work," said Larry to
+the old tar. "He is doing his level best to make trouble on the
+ship."</p>
+
+<p>"Well, he better mind his business," grumbled Luke. "I don't reckon
+the captain will stand fer any underhanded work."</p>
+
+<p>Without appearing to do so, Larry continued to keep his eyes on
+Semmel, and about an hour before dinner he saw the bearded sailor
+approach the cook's galley and look inside. Jeff was below, getting a
+case of canned goods. With a swift movement, Semmel stepped into the
+galley, raised the lid of a big pot full of stew that was on the stove,
+and sprinkled something over the food. Then he hurried out and sneaked
+forward once more.</p>
+
+<p>"The rascal!" murmured Larry. "So this is his game. I wonder what he
+put into that pot?"</p>
+
+<p>For the moment the young second mate thought to confront Semmel and
+demand an explanation. Then he changed his mind and hurried for the
+cabin, to tell the news to Captain Ponsberry.</p>
+
+<h3 class="p4"><a name="5">CHAPTER V</a></h3>
+
+<h4>SIGNS OF A MUTINY</h4>
+
+<p class="p2">"I've found out something important, Captain Ponsberry,"
+said Larry, as he entered the cabin. "I now know what's the matter with
+the grub." To all salt-water sailors food is grub and nothing else.</p>
+
+<p>"Well, what is the matter with it?" questioned the master of the
+<i>Columbia</i>, quickly.</p>
+
+<p>"It's being doctored, that's what's the matter."</p>
+
+<p>"Doctored?"</p>
+
+<p>"Yes, sir,&mdash;doctored by Semmel, too."</p>
+
+<p>"Will you explain what you mean, Larry?" demanded the captain,
+intensely interested.</p>
+
+<p>"I just saw that rascal go into the cook's galley. Jeff wasn't there,
+and Semmel took the lid off of a big pot on the stove and sprinkled
+something inside."</p>
+
+<p>"What!" Captain Ponsberry leaped to his feet "Are you certain of
+this?" he demanded.</p>
+
+<p>"I am&mdash;for I saw it with my own eyes."</p>
+
+<p>"What was that stuff he put into the pot?"</p>
+
+<p>"I don't know."</p>
+
+<p>"Did he touch anything else?"</p>
+
+<p>"No. He was in a tremendous hurry and wasn't in the galley more than
+a minute at the most."</p>
+
+<p>"The scoundrel!" Captain Ponsberry clenched his fists. "Larry, you
+are positive you are making no mistake?"</p>
+
+<p>"I saw the thing done just as I told you. The stuff was in a bit of
+white paper. When he went forward he threw the paper overboard."</p>
+
+<p>"Did anybody else see this?"</p>
+
+<p>"I don't think so. But&mdash;&mdash;"</p>
+
+<p>At that moment came a knock on the cabin door and Luke Striker
+appeared.</p>
+
+<p>"Excuse me, sir," he said, touching his cap. "But I've got something
+important to report."</p>
+
+<p>"What is it, Striker?"</p>
+
+<p>"I jess see that air Semmel go in and out o' the cook's galley."</p>
+
+<p>"That is just what I am reporting!" cried Larry. "Did you see what he
+did, Luke?"</p>
+
+<p>"No. He wasn't in there only a minit. It looked suspicious to me,
+though&mdash;with all hands gittin' sick from the grub."</p>
+
+<p>"This is all the evidence I want," said Captain Ponsberry. "We'll
+soon make an end of this. Larry, send Semmel to me."</p>
+
+<p>The young second mate left the cabin with Luke and both hurried
+toward the bow, where Semmel and Peterson were conversing in low
+tones.</p>
+
+<p>"The captain wants to see you at once," said Larry to the bearded
+sailor.</p>
+
+<p>His tone was so sharp it made Semmel start.</p>
+
+<p>"Vat he vants?" he queried.</p>
+
+<p>"Go and find out for yourself."</p>
+
+<p>"Maybe you git me in droubles, hey?" and the bearded sailor
+scowled.</p>
+
+<p>"I reckon as how you're gittin' yourself into trouble," drawled Luke,
+dryly.</p>
+
+<p>"You keep your mouf shut!" cried Semmel. "I no talk to you, no!"</p>
+
+<p>"The captain wants you to report; are you going to do so or not?"
+demanded Larry.</p>
+
+<p>"Sure I go," answered Semmel, with a toss of his head, and he
+slouched toward the stern. His manner was so aggressive that Larry
+picked up a belaying pin before following him.</p>
+
+<p>Captain Ponsberry had just appeared on deck. He had armed himself
+with a short club,&mdash;a sure sign to those who knew him that
+something unusual was in the wind. His face was stern and forbidding,
+and all hands gathered around to see what was the trouble.</p>
+
+<p>"Semmel, I want to have a talk with you," he said, in a loud voice,
+as the bearded sailor came up.</p>
+
+<p>To this the sailor nodded but did not answer.</p>
+
+<p>"I want to know what you were doing in the cook's galley a short
+while ago."</p>
+
+<p>"De cook's galley?" The sailor acted as if he was puzzled. "I no go
+by de galley, captain."</p>
+
+<p>"You were in the galley and you put something into the stew-pot. What
+was it?" thundered Captain Ponsberry. "Tell me the truth, or I may take
+it into my head to break every bone in your body!" And he shook his club
+in the sailor's face.</p>
+
+<p>"I put noddings in de pot," cried Semmel. "I no go in de
+galley&mdash;I no been in de galley two, tree days. It is a lie!"</p>
+
+<p>"I saw you go in," came from Luke.</p>
+
+<p>"And so did I," added Larry. "And I saw you sprinkle something into
+the pot."</p>
+
+<p>"What, did dat good-fo'-nuffin furiner put somet'ing in ma eatin'?"
+shrieked Jeff, who had come up. "Oh,&mdash;yo'&mdash;yo'&mdash;&mdash;"</p>
+
+<p>"Never mind, Jeff, I'll attend to this," interrupted the captain.</p>
+
+<p>"Yes, sah, but dat monkey-faced&mdash;&mdash;"</p>
+
+<p>"Never mind now&mdash;fall back there," added the captain, and the
+cook fell back, but shook his fist at Semmel.</p>
+
+<p>"I not in de galley," reiterated the bearded sailor. "Russell an'
+Striker no tell de truth."</p>
+
+<p>"It is true," cried Larry.</p>
+
+<p>"Thet's so, an' you can't squirm out o' it," broke in Luke. "I saw ye
+as plain as day."</p>
+
+<p>"I want to know what you put into that stew-pot?" continued Captain
+Ponsberry.</p>
+
+<p>"I no go near de galley. I&mdash;&mdash;"</p>
+
+<p>"I know you went into the galley and I know you put something into
+the stew. For the last time I ask you, what was it?"</p>
+
+<p>For reply Ostag Semmel simply shrugged his shoulders.</p>
+
+<p>"Are you going to tell me the truth?"</p>
+
+<p>"I reckon the truth ain't in him," grumbled Luke, under his
+breath.</p>
+
+<p>"I say noddings more," came sourly from the bearded sailor.</p>
+
+<p>"Put that man in irons," commanded Captain Ponsberry, turning quickly
+to Larry and Grandon. "If he won't talk now, perhaps he'll talk after he
+has spent a day in the brig."</p>
+
+<p>"Vat! you put me in irons!" shrieked Semmel. "You no got right to do
+dat, no!"</p>
+
+<p>"Haven't I?" answered Captain Ponsberry, in a voice that cut like a
+whip. "I'd like to see anybody dispute over it. Larry, Tom, do as I
+command."</p>
+
+<p>"Yes, sir," answered Larry, and ran off to get a pair of handcuffs
+while Tom Grandon stationed himself beside Ostag Semmel, belaying pin in
+hand.</p>
+
+<p>"You no mak me a prisoner!" fumed the bearded sailor. "You got no
+right!"</p>
+
+<p>He continued to rave, saying that it was a plot against him, because
+he had been the first to complain about the vile food served to the
+hands; that he had not been near the galley and that the captain,
+Grandon, and Larry knew it. He even appealed to the other sailors to
+stand by him, and several came forward to argue with Captain Ponsberry.
+But the master of the schooner was obstinate and would not listen.</p>
+
+<p>"I know what I am doing, men," he said, quickly but firmly. "He is a
+scoundrel and a spell in the brig will do him good. After this I reckon
+you'll find the grub all right."</p>
+
+<p>"I no like&mdash;" began Peterson, once more.</p>
+
+<p>"You shut up, Peterson, or I'll put you in the brig with Semmel," cut
+in the captain, and Peterson fell back with the rest, but with a brow
+that was dark and distrustful.</p>
+
+<p>By this time Larry had returned with the handcuffs and despite the
+resistance he offered, Ostag Semmel was made a prisoner. Then the first
+and the second mates led him to the schooner's brig,&mdash;a narrow,
+V-shaped room in the bow of the boat, usually used for storing lanterns
+and oil. The smell in the closet&mdash;for it was nothing else&mdash;was
+far from pleasant, and a day in the brig usually made a prisoner repent
+and promise to do better.</p>
+
+<p>"I mak trouble for dis!" growled Semmel, as the door was closed and
+bolted on him. "I mak trouble, yes! You got no right to do dis, no!"</p>
+
+<p>"And you haven't any right to doctor the grub," answered Larry, and
+then he and Grandon walked away.</p>
+
+<p>"That fellow is a first-class villain, to my way of reasoning," was
+the first mate's comment. "I believe he'd do almost anything to get
+square for this."</p>
+
+<p>After Ostag Semmel had been placed in the brig Captain Ponsberry
+called all hands to him once more and related what Luke and Larry had
+seen. The stew was inspected, but nothing suspicious could be seen about
+it.</p>
+
+<p>"If any of you want to try that stew you may do so," said the
+captain. "Of course, if Semmel didn't touch it there can be nothing in
+it that can hurt you." But all, even to Peterson, declined to even taste
+the food. It was one thing to think Semmel innocent but quite another to
+run the risk of being made sick or poisoned. In the end the stew was
+dumped overboard and Jeff prepared an entirely new dinner for all
+hands.</p>
+
+<p>"You must keep close watch on all of the men," said the captain to
+Larry and Grandon, when quietness had been restored. "Semmel was the
+worst of the lot, but I do not like the way Peterson and one or two
+others are acting."</p>
+
+<p>"I don't see what they can do," answered Larry.</p>
+
+<p>"They might start a mutiny," came from the first mate.</p>
+
+<p>"Would they dare go as far as that?"</p>
+
+<p>"Sometimes sailors get strange notions, and the old Harry himself
+can't stop them," said Captain Ponsberry. "A thing that in itself
+doesn't amount to much will start them off, and they'll imagine that
+everything is going wrong. When I was a lad, on board the <i>Mary
+Eliza</i>, Captain Snapper, we had a mutiny just because the coffee
+wasn't right."</p>
+
+<p>"Yes, and I can remember that they had a mutiny on the old brig
+<i>Chesterfield</i> because Captain Roe's wife brought a cross-eyed
+yellow cat on board," added Grandon. "Not a man would hoist a sail until
+that feline was put ashore. And when, two months later, the brig lost
+her foremast in a gale, the sailors said it was on account of that same
+cat, she having scratched the mast before she was taken away!"</p>
+
+<p>"Well, I hope we don't have a mutiny," said Larry. "I'd like to
+suggest something, Captain Ponsberry," he went on, to the master of the
+<i>Columbia</i>.</p>
+
+<p>"Fire ahead, Larry."</p>
+
+<p>"You know we can trust Luke Striker. Why not have him report just
+what the other hands are doing?"</p>
+
+<p>"That's an idea, and I will act on it. Yes, I'd trust Striker as
+quick as I'd trust you. If there is to be trouble we certainly want to
+know of it as soon as possible," concluded the captain.</p>
+
+<h3 class="p4"><a name="6">CHAPTER VI</a></h3>
+
+<h4>THE FIGHT FOR THE SHIP</h4>
+
+<p class="p2">The day to follow was Sunday, and contrary to
+expectations, it passed quietly. As there was hardly any wind, the old
+<i>Columbia</i> made slow progress, and the sailors had little or
+nothing to do. As was his usual habit, Larry read his Bible, and Captain
+Ponsberry held a short church service, which less than half the crew
+attended.</p>
+
+<p>"It's plain to see that the men are sulky," said Tom Grandon, towards
+evening. "We are certain to hear something from them shortly."</p>
+
+<p>Luke had been told to report anything unusual, but it was not until
+after dark that he sought out Captain Ponsberry.</p>
+
+<p>"I ain't got much to say," said the old tar. "But to my mind
+Peterson, Groot, and Shamhaven are doin' a powerful lot of confabbin'.
+More'n that, I saw Peterson cleaning up a pistol he's got."</p>
+
+<p>"Are any of the other hands armed?"</p>
+
+<p>"I ain't seen no other shootin'-irons," answered Luke.</p>
+
+<p>The captain had expected to interview Semmel once more, but found the
+fellow so surly he gave up the attempt. As the brig was so hot and
+uncomfortable, the master of the schooner had the door fixed so it could
+be left open several inches, with a chain at the bolt to keep it from
+going further.</p>
+
+<p>At four o'clock Monday morning Peterson came on duty, followed by
+Shamhaven and some others. All made their way to the bow and began to
+talk in a low but earnest fashion. Then Peterson went below, to where
+Semmel was still confined in the brig.</p>
+
+<p>"We are ready to move now," said he, in Russian. "What do you
+think?"</p>
+
+<p>"Let me out and I will show you what I think," growled Ostag Semmel.
+"The captain is a dog&mdash;and Grandon and Russell are dogs, too!"</p>
+
+<p>Peterson was prepared to unlock the chain which held the brig door
+and did so. Then he handed a pistol to the Russian.</p>
+
+<p>"The captain and Russell are in their staterooms," said Peterson.
+"Only Grandon is on deck, with Vincent and with the men we can trust to
+help us."</p>
+
+<p>"We can't trust Vincent."</p>
+
+<p>"I know that."</p>
+
+<p>"Where is Striker?"</p>
+
+<p>"Asleep in his berth."</p>
+
+<p>But on this score Carl Peterson was mistaken. Luke had pretended to
+go to sleep, but he was now in a corner on deck, watching with keen eyes
+all that was occurring. Presently he saw Semmel in company with Peterson
+hurry towards the bow, and he felt that the time for action had
+arrived.</p>
+
+<p>"Hi, Mr. Grandon!" he called out, running up to the first mate.</p>
+
+<p>"What is it, Striker?"</p>
+
+<p>"They've released Semmel and they are arming themselves."</p>
+
+<p>"You don't say!" Tom Grandon was stunned for the instant. "Tell the
+captain and Russell of this at once!"</p>
+
+<p>"Aye, aye, sir!"</p>
+
+<p>Rushing down the companionway, Luke entered the cabin and knocked on
+the door of Captain Ponsberry's stateroom.</p>
+
+<p>"Wake up, captain!" he called, loudly. "Wake up! There is going to be
+trouble putty quick, to my way o' thinkin'!"</p>
+
+<p>"What has gone wrong now?" demanded the master of the
+<i>Columbia</i>, as he hurried into his clothes and armed himself.
+"Where is Grandon?"</p>
+
+<p>"On deck; he sent me to tell you. They have set Semmel free and some
+of 'em are arming themselves."</p>
+
+<p>"A mutiny!" roared Captain Ponsberry. "Striker, you'll stand by me,
+of course?"</p>
+
+<p>"That I will, sir&mdash;to the end."</p>
+
+<p>"Good. I know Vincent will do the same. Do you know anything about
+the others?"</p>
+
+<p>"I think you can count on Jeff the cook."</p>
+
+<p>"What of Wilbur?"</p>
+
+<p>"He's so weak-kneed I don't know what he'll do," answered
+Striker.</p>
+
+<p>By this time Larry was out of his stateroom. With his door ajar he
+had heard all that had been said.</p>
+
+<p>"Oh, Luke, do you think they'll try to seize the ship?" he
+gasped.</p>
+
+<p>"Don't know what they'll do. They're a plumb crazy lot," growled the
+old tar. "It was a mistake to take such fellers as Semmel and Peterson
+and Shamhaven aboard."</p>
+
+<p>"That is true, but when Devine and Larson got sick and went to the
+hospital at Manila I had to get somebody," answered Captain Ponsberry.
+He brought out several pistols. "Here, Larry, take one of these, and a
+cutlass, too, and you, Striker, can arm yourself likewise."</p>
+
+<p>There was no time to answer, for the master of the schooner was
+already striding through the cabin in the direction of the companionway.
+An instant later came a yell from the deck, followed by heavy footsteps
+and then the report of a pistol.</p>
+
+<p>"Drive dem to de cabin!" came in the voice of Semmel. "Drive dem
+along, kvick!" And then followed another yell and the sounds of half a
+dozen blows.</p>
+
+<p>"Below there!" came in Tom Grandon's voice. "Help! help!"</p>
+
+<p>"I'm coming!" called up Captain Ponsberry.</p>
+
+<p>"Don't you dare to step on deck, captain!" yelled down the voice of
+Shamhaven. "Don't you dare to do it!" And the sailor appeared, pistol in
+hand, at the top of the companionway.</p>
+
+<p>"Shamhaven, what does this mean?" demanded the master of the
+<i>Columbia</i>.</p>
+
+<p>"It means that we have taken possession of the ship, that's what it
+means," came from Groot.</p>
+
+<p>"Of you come up here, you maybe git killed," put in Ostag Semmel.
+"You stay down dare, you hear?" And then, as the captain started to
+mount the stairs, he threw down a belaying pin. In the semi-darkness the
+captain did not see the object, and it struck him on the top of the
+head, rendering him partly unconscious.</p>
+
+<p>Larry and Luke were close behind their leader and both were alarmed
+to see him go down, uttering a deep groan as he did so.</p>
+
+<p>"Is he killed?" questioned the young second mate.</p>
+
+<p>"I don't know," was the old tar's response. "Shall we go up?"</p>
+
+<p>"Keep back there!" was the call from above. "Put a step on those
+stairs and it will be the worse for you!"</p>
+
+<p>At that moment came a cry from Cal Vincent. The boatswain had been
+attacked from behind and was given no chance to defend himself. Then
+came a roar from Jeff, who came rushing toward the companionway as if
+all the demons of the deep were behind him.</p>
+
+<p>"Sabe me! sabe me!" he screamed. "Da is gwine to pirate de ship! Sabe
+me!" And then he came plunging down headlong, directly on top of Larry,
+Luke, and the prostrate captain.</p>
+
+<p>This unexpected coming of Jeff sent the young second mate and the old
+tar flat on Captain Ponsberry, and for the moment there was a struggle
+all around. In the meantime some sailors on the deck began to drag a
+heavy hatch toward the stairs. Soon this was placed in position, and
+then those below were virtually prisoners.</p>
+
+<p>"Oh my, sabe me!" groaned Jeff once more, as he managed to get on his
+feet in the cabin, followed by Larry and Luke. "Don't you let dem swing
+me from de yardarm!"</p>
+
+<p>"Jeff, where are Grandon and Vincent?" demanded Larry.</p>
+
+<p>"I dunno, sah&mdash;dead, I guess," answered the cook. "Oh, dis am de
+awfulest t'ing wot I eber heard tell ob!" he added, woefully, and wrung
+his hands.</p>
+
+<p>The lantern in the cabin was turned up and Larry gave his attention
+once more to Captain Ponsberry, who was now opening his eyes.</p>
+
+<p>"Oh, my head!" came with a shiver. "My head!"</p>
+
+<p>"I'm glad they didn't kill you," said Larry, kindly. "Luke, help me
+carry him into the cabin. We'll put him on the couch."</p>
+
+<p>This was done, and they did what they could to make the master of the
+schooner comfortable. But it was a good half-hour before Captain
+Ponsberry could sit up and do any rational thinking.</p>
+
+<p>On deck all had become suddenly quiet. Occasionally those below could
+hear a footstep near the companionway, showing that one or more of the
+mutineers were on guard. The hatch shut off the view on deck, and the
+windows in the ceiling of the cabin were also boarded over from the
+outside.</p>
+
+<p>"They have us like rats in a trap," said Larry, bitterly.</p>
+
+<p>"And for all we know Vincent and Grandon are both dead," returned
+Luke Striker, soberly. "I must say, lad, we seem to be in a bad way and
+no mistake."</p>
+
+<p>"Dey'll throw us overboard, I know dey will!" groaned Jeff, who was
+almost white with terror. "I neber see sech goin's-on in all ma
+life!"</p>
+
+<p>To fight the mutineers further was, just then, out of the question,
+and Larry turned his attention again to Captain Ponsberry. At last the
+captain seemed fully to comprehend what had occurred. He once more moved
+toward the companionway, pistol in hand.</p>
+
+<p>"You can't get out that way, sir," said Larry. "They have placed the
+fore hatch over the stairs."</p>
+
+<p>"And they are armed, too," put in Luke. "Be careful, sir, or they'll
+shoot you down."</p>
+
+<p>"And this on my own ship!" came bitterly from the master of the
+<i>Columbia</i>. "That is what I get for treating the dogs better than
+they deserve. Where are Grandon and Vincent?"</p>
+
+<p>"Either shot down or taken prisoners. They called for help, and that
+was the last we heard of them."</p>
+
+<p>"And are all the others in this dastardly plot?"</p>
+
+<p>"I reckon they are," answered Luke. "Them foreigners, Semmel an'
+Peterson, must have stirred 'em up powerfully."</p>
+
+<p>Still weak from the blow received, Captain Ponsberry sank down once
+more on the cabin couch. There was a lump as big as a walnut on the top
+of his head, and he had Jeff bathe it with water and then with
+witch-hazel, which made it a trifle more comfortable.</p>
+
+<p>A short while later came a sudden wild song from the deck of the
+schooner, followed by a clinking of glasses.</p>
+
+<p>"They are treating themselves to grog," said Luke. "I suppose, now
+they have the run of things, they'll drink all they want of the
+stuff."</p>
+
+<p>"More than likely," returned the captain. "Well, it is their turn
+just now&mdash;perhaps before long it will be my turn!" And he smiled
+significantly.</p>
+
+<h3 class="p4"><a name="7">CHAPTER VII</a></h3>
+
+<h4>THE MUTINEERS IN POSSESSION</h4>
+
+<p class="p2">As my old readers know, both Captain Ponsberry and Luke
+Striker were Yankees to the backbone, and it galled them exceedingly to
+see the schooner in the hands of a number of mutineers, and especially
+foreigners.</p>
+
+<p>"We've got to git the ship back, no two ways on it," growled the old
+tar. "Captain, I'm willin' to fight to the end, if ye give the
+word."</p>
+
+<p>"And I'll fight, too," said Larry, promptly.</p>
+
+<p>"Don't you go fo' to fight dem rascallions!" whined Jeff. "Yo' will
+all be killed suah!"</p>
+
+<p>"I would like to know what has become of Grandon and Vincent," came
+from Captain Ponsberry. "As we stand now, we are but four to seven or
+eight. If we could get Grandon and Vincent to aid us we would be six
+against them."</p>
+
+<p>"Perhaps all the hands are not in the mutiny," suggested Larry. "Why
+not try to sound them?"</p>
+
+<p>"I was thinking of doing that."</p>
+
+<p>A little later Captain Ponsberry called up the companionway. At first
+nobody paid any attention to him, but presently the hatch was shoved
+aside a few inches and Ostag Semmel looked down. Behind him was
+Shamhaven.</p>
+
+<p>"Semmel, what does this mean?" asked the captain, as calmly as he
+could.</p>
+
+<p>"It means dat ve haf de ship," replied the Russian, with a grin.</p>
+
+<p>"You are carrying matters with a very high hand. Where are Grandon
+and Vincent?"</p>
+
+<p>"I not tell you dat."</p>
+
+<p>"We had a right to mutiny," said Shamhaven. "The grub wasn't fit to
+eat and was getting worse every day."</p>
+
+<p>"That's a tale gotten up for the occasion, Shamhaven, and you know
+it. Semmel doctored the food to make you dissatisfied."</p>
+
+<p>"Well, we don't think so," grumbled the sailor. "I don't think so,
+and Groot and the others don't either."</p>
+
+<p>"Has Jack Wilbur joined you?"</p>
+
+<p>"Certainly he has," was Shamhaven's ready reply, but his look belied
+his words.</p>
+
+<p>"Ve are all pount to stick togedder," said Semmel. "You might as vell
+gif up&mdash;der sooner der petter for you!"</p>
+
+<p>"I don't propose to give up, you rascal."</p>
+
+<p>"Ton't you call me a rascals, no!" shouted Ostag Semmel. "I vos now
+der captains, yes, do you hear? Captain Semmel!"</p>
+
+<p>"Bosh!" put in Luke Striker, in disgust. "Why ye ain't fit to be the
+skipper 'f a canal-boat!"</p>
+
+<p>"If you try to navigate the ship you'll sink her on the rocks," put
+in Larry.</p>
+
+<p>"You had better consider what you are doing, Shamhaven," went on the
+master of the <i>Columbia</i>. "Remember, if I regain possession of the
+schooner I can make it go hard with you."</p>
+
+<p>"You no get dare schooner again, not much!" came from Peterson, who
+had just come up, followed by Jack Wilbur.</p>
+
+<p>"Wilbur, are you in this?" demanded the captain. "If you are, I must
+confess I didn't think it of you."</p>
+
+<p>"I ain't goin' to eat poor grub," answered Wilbur, lamely.</p>
+
+<p>"The grub is all right and you know it. It was doctored up by Semmel,
+and I&mdash;&mdash;"</p>
+
+<p>"You stop dat talk!" roared Semmel, and then he added: "Maybe you gif
+in after you are goot an' hungry, hey?"</p>
+
+<p>"What, do you want to starve us out?" cried Larry.</p>
+
+<p>"You see&mdash;chust vait!" answered the Russian, and with this the
+hatch was again put in place and the conference came to an end.</p>
+
+<p>Captain Ponsberry was fairly boiling with wrath, but even so he
+realized that prudence is often the better part of valor.</p>
+
+<p>"There is no use of trying a rush to the deck," he said. "Those
+rascals would surely shoot us down. Just now some of them are in the
+humor for anything."</p>
+
+<p>"Perhaps we can do something to-night," suggested Larry.</p>
+
+<p>"They talk about starving us out," said Luke. "Ain't there nothin' to
+eat here?"</p>
+
+<p>An inspection was made of the cabin pantry, which brought to light
+some preserves, some pickles, a pot of cheese, and a tin of fancy
+crackers.</p>
+
+<p>"About enough for one meal," said Captain Ponsberry, grimly.</p>
+
+<p>"And a pretty slim one at that," added Larry. "But I say, captain,"
+he added, suddenly, "isn't there a door leading from the back of the
+pantry down into the hold?"</p>
+
+<p>"There was once&mdash;but I had it nailed up years ago, for we never
+used it."</p>
+
+<p>"If we can open that, we might get something from the hold."</p>
+
+<p>"Going to eat machinery?" demanded Luke.</p>
+
+<p>"No&mdash;canned goods, Luke; I know Jeff had some placed there, for
+he didn't have room in his store-room."</p>
+
+<p>"Dat am a fac'," put in the cook. "I'se got lots ob t'ings in dat dar
+hold."</p>
+
+<p>"Then that settles the starving question," said Captain Ponsberry.
+"I've got a small saw and a hammer down here somewhere. We can use them
+on the door."</p>
+
+<p>"And that gives me another idea," went on Larry. "The hatch covering
+over the companionway belongs to the fore hatch. If we can reach that
+opening from here, why can't we steal on deck when we get the chance and
+try to make the mutineers prisoners?"</p>
+
+<p>"Eureka!" shouted Luke. "That's the talk, Larry. Fer your years
+you've got a wonderfully long head on ye. We'll make 'em prisoners or
+chuck 'em overboard!"</p>
+
+<p>"The idea is worth considering," said the captain. "But we must be
+careful."</p>
+
+<p>A search was made and the hammer, small saw, and also a chisel were
+found. Then they cleaned out the pantry, took down several shelves, and
+thus uncovered the small door which had been nailed up.</p>
+
+<p>"Don't make any noise, or they'll suspect that we are up to
+something," said Captain Ponsberry.</p>
+
+<p>"Let Jeff rattle some dishes," said Larry, and while he and Luke
+worked on the door, the cook began to handle the dishes in such a rough
+manner that several were broken. He also tried to sing a couple of
+verses of his favorite song, "My Gal Susannah!" but his voice was so
+shaky that the effort was, artistically, a failure, although it added to
+the noise, which was all that was desired.</p>
+
+<p>"They're pretty happy down there," said Wilbur to Shamhaven, as he
+listened to the sounds.</p>
+
+<p>"Oh, they're putting on a front," growled Shamhaven. "They'll sing a
+different tune when their stomachs are empty."</p>
+
+<p>"I don't know about this mutiny," went on the weak-kneed sailor,
+nervously.</p>
+
+<p>"Oh, it's all right and you needn't to worry, Wilbur. If we stick
+together we'll make a couple of thousand apiece out of this game."</p>
+
+<p>"But what shall we do if we fall in with a Russian warship?"</p>
+
+<p>"Semmel has that all fixed. He'll expose the captain and state that
+the <i>Columbia</i> is carrying a cargo for the Japanese Government, and
+that he took possession in the name of the Czar. With this war on they
+won't ask too many questions so long as they can give the Japs a black
+eye."</p>
+
+<p>"I see. But supposing we fall in with a Japanese warship?"</p>
+
+<p>"Then Semmel is going to turn the command over to me and I'll tell
+them that the cargo was really meant for the Japanese Government but
+that Captain Ponsberry, just before we left Manila, sold out to the
+Russian agents and was going to Vladivostok. I'll add that we refused to
+go to the Russian port after signing for Nagasaki, and all of the men
+can back me up. That will put the captain and his friends in limbo and
+give us some prize money. Oh, we'll come out ahead, don't you worry,"
+concluded Shamhaven, confidently.</p>
+
+<p>The day passed slowly and the mutineers held several meetings, to
+settle upon just what they were going to do. But all had been drinking
+more than was good for them and the conferences ended in nothing but
+talk. Semmel was the accepted leader, but it was plain to see that
+Shamhaven objected strongly to playing a secondary part, and Peterson
+also wanted a large "finger in the pie."</p>
+
+<p>As they worked with care, it was a good hour and a half before Larry
+and Luke managed to take down the door leading into the hold. Even when
+this was done they found on the other side several heavy cases of
+machinery almost impossible to budge.</p>
+
+<p>"We can pry those out of the way," said the captain.</p>
+
+<p>"A foot or so will do it," returned Larry. "Then I think I can crawl
+over the top."</p>
+
+<p>They continued the work, and a little later the young second mate was
+able to squeeze his way to the top of the cargo in that vicinity.</p>
+
+<p>"Be careful, Larry," warned the captain. "If a case should shift with
+the ship you might get a crushed leg. You had better take a candle
+along."</p>
+
+<p>"I will, sir."</p>
+
+<p>Luke was as anxious to get into the hold as the young second mate,
+and he too squeezed his tall, lank form through the opening. Guided by
+the faint light of the candle, they crawled over a number of cases of
+machinery and war goods until they drew close to the middle of the
+ship.</p>
+
+<p>"Here we are!" cried Larry, in a low voice, and pointed to some cases
+of canned goods. "Beans, corn, tomatoes, salt pork, condensed
+milk&mdash;we won't starve just yet, Luke."</p>
+
+<p>"An' here are some barrels o' flour," added the old tar. "No, they
+can't starve us nohow now."</p>
+
+<p>They had brought the chisel and hammer along, and with extra caution
+opened some of the cases. Taking with them all the goods they could
+carry, they returned to the cabin.</p>
+
+<p>"This is splendid!" cried Captain Ponsberry. "With this stuff on hand
+we can hold the cabin indefinitely."</p>
+
+<p>"How is I gwine to cook?" questioned Jeff.</p>
+
+<p>"Over the two lanterns, Jeff. It will be slow work, but our time is
+our own. Luckily there are pots and tins in the pantry."</p>
+
+<p>"All right, sah."</p>
+
+<p>"Of course, I am hoping that we shall not have to stay here long,"
+went on the captain. "But it is best to be prepared."</p>
+
+<p>That those on deck might not see the cooking going on, one of the
+staterooms was cleaned out and Jeff went to work in this. In the
+meantime Semmel called down the companionway once more.</p>
+
+<p>"Are you gettin' hungry?" he asked.</p>
+
+<p>"Tell him yes," whispered Larry.</p>
+
+<p>"Why?" questioned the captain, in an equally low tone.</p>
+
+<p>"Then he'll think we are getting ready to come to terms and he won't
+watch us so closely."</p>
+
+<p>"I see." Captain Ponsberry raised his voice. "Yes, we are hungry," he
+called up. "What are you going to send us, something good?"</p>
+
+<p>"Ve send noddings. Maybe you talk business soon, hey?" continued the
+rascally Russian.</p>
+
+<p>"Perhaps."</p>
+
+<p>"How soon?"</p>
+
+<p>"Well, perhaps to-morrow morning."</p>
+
+<p>"Not before dot, hey?"</p>
+
+<p>"No."</p>
+
+<p>"All right den; you can go on an' starve so long!" growled Ostag
+Semmel, and went away. A moment later he met Shamhaven.</p>
+
+<p>"What did he say?" asked the latter, anxiously.</p>
+
+<p>"He comes to terms to-morrow!" answered the Russian, triumphantly.</p>
+
+<h3 class="p4"><a name="8">CHAPTER VIII</a></h3>
+
+<h4>TURNING THE TABLES</h4>
+
+<p class="p2">The meal which Jeff prepared put all in the cabin in
+better humor, and as soon as it was over a council of war was held.</p>
+
+<p>It was decided to wait until darkness had set in, and then try to
+gain the deck of the ship by way of the fore hatch. In the meantime the
+door to the companionway was to be locked and barred, so that the
+mutineers could not attack them very well from that direction, should a
+running fight ensue.</p>
+
+<p>As Jeff would be of no use in a struggle he was delegated to remain
+in the cabin, to make as much noise as possible, singing and talking to
+himself, so that the mutineers might not suspect what was taking
+place.</p>
+
+<p>Each member of the party armed himself both with a pistol and a
+cutlass, and Larry led the way as before, candle in hand. It was easy
+for Luke to follow him, but rather difficult for the captain, who was
+more portly.</p>
+
+<p>"Reckon as how ye shouldn't have eaten so much, captain," chuckled
+the old tar, as he helped Captain Ponsberry through a particularly
+narrow place.</p>
+
+<p>"True, Striker," was the answer. "But you be careful that you don't
+slip into some slit between the cases and go out of sight."</p>
+
+<p>They soon gained the spot where the canned goods had been found. They
+had now to climb over some machinery that reached nearly to the top of
+the hold, and then over a varied collection of boxes and barrels and
+bags. On the bags lay some of the old sails of the ship and several
+coils of discarded rope.</p>
+
+<p>They were just approaching the open fore hatch when they saw a rope
+ladder let down. Instantly Larry uttered a warning and put out the
+light.</p>
+
+<p>"Somebody is coming down," he whispered.</p>
+
+<p>It was the sailor Wilbur, who had been sent to get some canned goods
+for cooking purposes. He came down the rope ladder with a lantern slung
+over one arm.</p>
+
+<p>"We'll make him a prisoner!" cried Captain Ponsberry. "And let us do
+it as quietly as we can, so as not to disturb those on deck."</p>
+
+<p>The others understood and crouched back in the darkness. Then, as
+Wilbur passed them, the captain caught him from the back and Larry
+clapped a hand over the fellow's mouth.</p>
+
+<p>"Oh!" spluttered Wilbur, but that was as far as he got.</p>
+
+<p>"Not a word! Not a sound, Wilbur!" said Captain Ponsberry,
+earnestly.</p>
+
+<p>The sailor understood, and being a craven at heart he almost
+collapsed. It was an easy matter to take one of the old ropes and tie
+his hands behind him. Then Captain Ponsberry confronted the mutineer,
+making a liberal exhibition of his pistol as he did so.</p>
+
+<p>"Wilbur, answer me truthfully," said the master of the
+<i>Columbia</i>. "Are you all in this mutiny or not? Don't speak above a
+whisper."</p>
+
+<p>"I ain't in it!" whined Wilbur. "They dragged me in, they did. I
+ain't kicking about grub, or nothing!"</p>
+
+<p>"Are all the others in it?"</p>
+
+<p>"Kind of, yes. Groot didn't care much to go in. Guess he wish he was
+out of it now."</p>
+
+<p>"What has become of Grandon and Vincent?"</p>
+
+<p>"Both of 'em are prisoners in the brig."</p>
+
+<p>"Are they wounded?"</p>
+
+<p>"Not much. Grandon had his thumb cut and Vincent got a kick in the
+back that lamed him."</p>
+
+<p>"Is anybody guarding them?"</p>
+
+<p>"I guess not. All of 'em have got to drinking again. Say, captain,
+let me out of this fix and I'll never go against you again, never,"
+continued Wilbur, earnestly.</p>
+
+<p>"We'll see about that later," was the grim reply.</p>
+
+<p>"Captain Ponsberry, I have a scheme," put in Larry, and he drew the
+master of the ship to one side. "Wilbur is about the same build as
+myself. Let me take his coat and cap and go on deck and down to the
+brig. If I can release Grandon and Vincent we'll be sure to knock out
+the mutiny in no time."</p>
+
+<p>"It's a dangerous game, Larry."</p>
+
+<p>"Oh, please let me do it!" pleaded the young second mate. The hazard
+was one which appealed to him strongly.</p>
+
+<p>The matter was talked over for a few minutes and it was decided to
+let Larry have his way. Wilbur was soon stripped of his coat and the
+young second mate donned the garment. Then he took the mutineer's cap
+and pulled it as far over his brow as possible and turned up the coat
+collar.</p>
+
+<p>"I'll leave the lantern here," he said, and a second later was
+mounting the rope ladder slowly and cautiously.</p>
+
+<p>With his head on a level with the deck Larry paused to reconnoiter
+the situation. He knew exactly how dangerous his mission was and that he
+was running the risk of being shot. But his life in our navy had made
+him bold, and seeing nobody in sight, he leaped out on deck, and hurried
+with all speed to the ladder leading to the brig. Soon he was in front
+of the barred door.</p>
+
+<p>"Grandon! Vincent!" he called, softly.</p>
+
+<p>"Hullo, who's that?" came in the voice of the first mate.</p>
+
+<p>"It is I, Larry. Is Vincent there?"</p>
+
+<p>"Yes. Where did you come from?"</p>
+
+<p>"The cabin." Larry unbarred the door. "Are you hurt?"</p>
+
+<p>"Not much. How are you?"</p>
+
+<p>"I am all right, and so are the captain and Luke Striker. They are in
+the hold, ready to come on deck. We have made Wilbur a prisoner."</p>
+
+<p>"Good enough," came from the boatswain. "The rascals! They ought all
+to walk the plank!" he added, vehemently.</p>
+
+<p>The two men had their hands tied behind them, but it was an easy
+matter for Larry to liberate them. Then each provided himself with a
+belaying pin, and all three of the party stole to the deck.</p>
+
+<p>From the forecastle and the cook's galley came loud talking, showing
+that the mutineers were making themselves at home. One man was trying to
+do some cooking.</p>
+
+<p>"What's keeping Wilbur so long?" he demanded of the others.</p>
+
+<p>Nobody knew, and one of the crowd, the sailor named Groot,
+volunteered to look the missing one up.</p>
+
+<p>"Let us follow him to the hatch," whispered Larry. "Perhaps we can
+make him a prisoner."</p>
+
+<p>"Right you are," answered Tom Grandon.</p>
+
+<p>With caution they came up behind the man, and just as Groot leaned
+over the open hatchway, they caught him tightly.</p>
+
+<p>"Keep silent, Groot!" said Grandon. "Keep silent, or we'll throw you
+overboard."</p>
+
+<p>"Stop!" roared the mutineer. "Help! hel&mdash;&mdash;"</p>
+
+<p>He got no further, for raising his belaying pin, Vincent brought it
+down on the mutineer's head. Groot had been the one to lame the
+boatswain's back and the latter had not forgotten it. Over went the
+fellow and sank down as if dead.</p>
+
+<p>"Drop him into the hold," ordered Grandon, and this was done just as
+Captain Ponsberry and Luke Striker appeared at the foot of the rope
+ladder.</p>
+
+<p>"Another, eh?" said the master of the <i>Columbia</i>. "Good enough!
+How are you, Tom? How are you, Vincent?"</p>
+
+<p>"We're ready to fight 'em," answered the first mate. "Come on!
+They've got so much liquor aboard they can't do much to us!"</p>
+
+<p>"Be careful, I don't want anybody shot if it can be avoided,"
+responded Captain Ponsberry.</p>
+
+<p>"I think it would be a good plan to dump them all into the hold,"
+said Larry. "Then we could nail up that pantry door, put the hatch into
+place, and keep them at our mercy."</p>
+
+<p>"If the plan will work, it's a good one," answered the captain.</p>
+
+<p>One after another they came out on deck, leaving Wilbur and Groot in
+the hold. They found the mutineers equally divided between the galley
+and the forecastle. The only man in charge of the schooner was Conroy,
+who was at the wheel.</p>
+
+<p>As they advanced upon the forecastle they saw Semmel come out,
+accompanied by Peterson.</p>
+
+<p>"There are the ringleaders!" cried Captain Ponsberry, and rushing up
+to them he exclaimed: "Surrender, you rascals!" And he aimed his pistol,
+while the others also raised their weapons.</p>
+
+<p>The Russian and his companion were taken completely by surprise, and
+before they could draw any weapons of their own it was too late. Grandon
+tripped one up and fell upon him, and then Vincent and Larry tripped up
+the other. There was a brief scuffle, the exchange of several blows
+which did little damage, and in a trice Semmel and Peterson were thrown
+down into the hold bodily, and the ladder was hauled up out of their
+reach.</p>
+
+<p>"Put that hatch over the opening," cried Captain Ponsberry to Larry.
+"And then go into the cabin pantry and nail up that door. Be quick about
+it, or they may get out!"</p>
+
+<p>"Aye, aye, sir!" cried the young second mate, and ran off with all
+speed. The hatch was large and heavy, but the excitement lent him
+strength and he dragged it forward and threw it over the hatchway.</p>
+
+<p>"Stop dat!" roared Semmel, in a drunken voice, but Larry paid no
+attention. His next movement was toward the cabin.</p>
+
+<p>"Don't yo' tech me!" roared Jeff, in alarm. "Oh, it am yo'!" he
+added, as he recognized Larry. "How am de battle gwine?"</p>
+
+<p>"We've got 'em on the run&mdash;four are prisoners in the hold," was
+Larry's reply. "Get me that box of nails, Jeff&mdash;I must put that
+door back as it was!"</p>
+
+<p>"Yes, sah; yes, sah!" answered the cook, eagerly, and brought forth
+the nails in question. Then he helped to put the door into place, and
+held it while Larry nailed the barrier. The job was just completed when
+the young second mate heard voices from the hold.</p>
+
+<p>"Hi, dare, you let us out," came from Peterson. "Ve vill mak it
+right, yes!"</p>
+
+<p>"You keep quiet," ordered Larry, and would say no more. Against the
+door he and Jeff placed several trunks and boxes taken from the
+staterooms opening off of the cabin.</p>
+
+<p>During this time the party led by Captain Ponsberry had attacked the
+balance of the mutineers. There was a brief fight and Shamhaven got a
+cutlass cut on the knee. But then the men surrendered, and one after
+another was made to drop down into the hold, and the hatch was shut and
+battened down.</p>
+
+<p>The only man who was not thus made a prisoner was Conroy, who begged
+at once to be forgiven.</p>
+
+<p>"They got me to drink, captain," he pleaded. "I didn't know what I
+was doing. Forgive it, and I'll be the best man you ever had on
+board."</p>
+
+<p>"Can I depend upon you, Conroy?" asked Captain Ponsberry,
+sternly.</p>
+
+<p>"You can, sir&mdash;I give you my word on it."</p>
+
+<p>"You won't try to help the mutineers?"</p>
+
+<p>"No, sir; no, sir!"</p>
+
+<p>"Very well then, I'll try you. But, remember, if you try any dirty
+work it will go hard with you. Now tell me, was Wilbur in favor of this
+mutiny?"</p>
+
+<p>"No, sir, he was not. Semmel forced him into it."</p>
+
+<p>"What of the others. Who were the ringleaders?"</p>
+
+<p>"Semmel and Peterson and Shamhaven. The others didn't want to do
+anything but complain about the grub," answered Conroy, and then told
+the particulars of the mutiny from beginning to end.</p>
+
+<h3 class="p4"><a name="9">CHAPTER IX</a></h3>
+
+<h4>CLOSE TO A WATERSPOUT</h4>
+
+<p class="p2">It was decided to leave the mutineers in the hold
+undisturbed until morning. This done, those who had been hurt in the
+scrimmage had their wounds attended to, and then Jeff was set to work to
+prepare a good meal for all the loyal party. The galley was in a state
+of disorder, but this counted for nothing, and Jeff soon had matters
+straightened out.</p>
+
+<p>After so much excitement nobody thought of retiring. Luke was
+stationed over the fore hatch, to give warning of any attempt on the
+part of the mutineers to regain their liberty. He was armed and he
+threatened to "blow the hull head off" of anybody who dared to show
+himself or make a noise. As a consequence the mutineers did nothing. Two
+made their way to the nailed-up door, but finding they could not open
+it, gave up the attempt as a bad job.</p>
+
+<p>As a punishment for his misdeeds Conroy was kept at the wheel during
+the whole of the night. He was willing enough to do the extra work if
+only the captain would forgive him for his actions. The master of the
+ship questioned him closely, and in the end reached the conclusion that
+only Semmel, Peterson, and Shamhaven were the leaders in the attempt to
+seize the ship and that the others had followed after them like so many
+sheep.</p>
+
+<p>"I am glad to hear this," he said to Grandon and Larry. "I think
+after I read them a strong lecture they'll behave themselves."</p>
+
+<p>"But we shall have to watch 'em closely," said the first mate.</p>
+
+<p>"What will you do with Semmel, Peterson, and Shamhaven?" asked
+Larry.</p>
+
+<p>"Put them in irons and keep them there until the end of the trip.
+When we reach Nagasaki they can take their choice of leaving or of being
+kicked off the ship. If they raise a row I'll hand them over to the
+authorities."</p>
+
+<p>"You ought to have them locked up."</p>
+
+<p>"True, lad; but with this war on hand the courts won't want to bother
+with such a case."</p>
+
+<p>It was not until nine o'clock in the morning that Captain Ponsberry
+had the forward hatch raised once more. Those below were almost dying
+for fresh air and water.</p>
+
+<p>"I want Wilbur to come up," he said.</p>
+
+<p>"Can't we have some water?" demanded Shamhaven.</p>
+
+<p>"Yes, if you'll behave yourselves," was the short answer.</p>
+
+<p>There was a babble of voices, but the master of the ship paid no
+attention. Each man who had been thrown below was unarmed, so there was
+no danger of any shooting. Presently Wilbur came up the rope ladder
+thrown to him, looking sheepish enough.</p>
+
+<p>"What have you to say for yourself?" demanded the captain, when
+Wilbur threw himself on his knees.</p>
+
+<p>"Don't count it against me, cap'!" he groaned. "I didn't want to go
+into it, I tell you! I didn't want to go in!"</p>
+
+<p>"If I forgive you, will you give me your word to behave
+yourself?"</p>
+
+<p>"Yes, sir!"</p>
+
+<p>"You won't do any more underhanded work?"</p>
+
+<p>"You can shoot me if I do, captain."</p>
+
+<p>"Very well; I'll remember that. Now go forward and help put the ship
+in good order. Larry, set him to work, and see that he does just what
+you tell him." And Wilbur went off, with the young second mate
+following, thanking his stars that he had not been swung to the yardarm,
+for mutiny on the high seas is a capital offense.</p>
+
+<p>One by one the mutineers were allowed to come on deck, until only
+Semmel, Peterson, and Shamhaven remained below. Those to come up pleaded
+to be forgiven and promised to obey orders in the future and let the
+captain run the ship to suit himself.</p>
+
+<p>During the night, Groot had had a bitter quarrel with Semmel, and the
+Russian appeared presently with a black eye and two of his front teeth
+loose. He was promptly put in irons, and the handcuffing of Peterson and
+Shamhaven followed.</p>
+
+<p>"I have allowed the other men their liberty because you three led
+them into this affair," said Captain Ponsberry to the trio of rascals.
+"I intend to keep you in irons until the end of the trip."</p>
+
+<p>At this there was a loud complaint, and the three made all manner of
+protestations, but the master of the <i>Columbia</i> was obdurate, and
+at last threatened to throw them into the hold again. This quieted them
+for the time being, and after being given a square meal and a drink of
+water, they were marched off to the brig, which was cleaned of
+everything else for their accommodation.</p>
+
+<p>Fortunately for the <i>Columbia</i> the weather remained fair, so
+that the loss of the prisoners was not felt when it came to handling the
+schooner. Those who had mutinied were only too glad to get back into
+Captain Ponsberry's good graces and they did whatever was required with
+an alacrity which was as astonishing as it was gratifying. They ate
+whatever was set before them, and soon reached the conclusion that the
+food was really better than they deserved.</p>
+
+<p>"We were fools to follow Semmel," said Wilbur; and Conroy and some
+others fully agreed with him.</p>
+
+<p>But though it now looked as if the men could be trusted, Captain
+Ponsberry determined to keep his eyes on them. Vincent was placed at the
+head of one watch and Luke at the head of the other, so that, with one
+or the other of the mates, the deck was always guarded by at least two
+persons that could be depended upon.</p>
+
+<p>The captain had hoped for favorable breezes following the heavy
+storm, but these did not come, and day after day passed with the old
+<i>Columbia</i> making slow progress toward Nagasaki. Formosa was passed
+during a bit of thick weather, so that nothing was seen of that island.
+Then the sun came out again, hotter than ever, so that Larry was glad to
+keep in the shade as much as possible.</p>
+
+<p>"It's not so exciting as it was a few days ago," remarked Luke to
+Larry one day, when both were seated in the shade of the forecastle.</p>
+
+<p>"I am glad that mutiny is at an end," answered Larry. "It's a great
+wonder that somebody wasn't killed or seriously wounded."</p>
+
+<p>"The men didn't have their hearts in the rumpus, thet's why, Larry.
+If they had really meant business&mdash;well, I reckon some <ins
+title="Transcriber's Note: Original reads 'on'">of</ins> us wouldn't be
+here now to tell the tale."</p>
+
+<p>"I think Semmel meant business."</p>
+
+<p>"Yes, he's a heap sight worse nor any o' the others."</p>
+
+<p>"It was a mistake to take him on board. I tell you, a captain can't
+be too careful who he puts in his forecastle."</p>
+
+<p>"Well, you know the reason&mdash;those other hands gettin' sick at
+Manila. But I can tell you, I'd rather have a crew of Americans any
+day."</p>
+
+<p>"They are hard to get."</p>
+
+<p>"True fer you." The old Yankee tar heaved a sigh. "The old days are
+gone, sure enough. My! my! what times we used to have, when we'd go out,
+every man a-knowin' every other man on the ship, an' all about him, too!
+Then it was like a big family settin' sail. Now, if you go on a new ship
+ye don't know nobody an' nobody knows nobody else."</p>
+
+<p>"I guess you expect to live and die a sailor, don't you, Luke?"</p>
+
+<p>"Don't know but what I do, unless somebody leaves me money enough to
+live like a millionaire," and the old tar grinned.</p>
+
+<p>Day after day passed and the <i>Columbia</i> kept on her course,
+making as straight a passage for Nagasaki as possible. One day there
+would be a fair breeze and the next a dead calm.</p>
+
+<p>"This is unusual weather for this quarter of the globe," said Captain
+Ponsberry to Larry. "Like as not it will end in another hurricane."</p>
+
+<p>"In that case what will you do, release Semmel and the others?"</p>
+
+<p>"I may release Peterson and Shamhaven, but not Semmel, for he was the
+real ringleader."</p>
+
+<p>There were strong signs of a storm in the air that night, but they
+brought forth nothing, and on the following morning the sun came up as
+full and bright as before. The breeze came by fits and starts, from
+first one direction and then another, and the man at the wheel had all
+he could do to keep the schooner to her course. Sails were shifted half
+a dozen times, but without making any improvement.</p>
+
+<p>"The weather is certainly queer," said Grandon. "Puts me in mind of
+the time I was caught in a tidal wave in the South Seas. Before the wave
+struck us we had just such cuttings-up."</p>
+
+<p>"I trust we don't strike a tidal wave," answered Larry. "If it was
+high enough it might swamp us."</p>
+
+<p>"True; but when you're on the deep blue sea, lad, you've got to take
+whatever comes," replied the first mate, solemnly.</p>
+
+<p>Dinner was a quiet affair for all on board, and shortly after the
+repast Larry went to the forward deck, to have another chat with Luke.
+While the two were talking they were joined by Captain Ponsberry; and
+soon the three were conversing about old times once more.</p>
+
+<p>"Do you remember the swim we once took in the Pacific?" said Larry to
+Luke. "The time the sawfish smashed the boat and came after us?"</p>
+
+<p>"Reckon I do," was the Yankee tar's response. "We had a lively swim
+fer it, didn't we?"</p>
+
+<p>"And the time we visited the island and you turned the turtles?" went
+on Larry. "And do you remember that snake that chased us into the
+water?"</p>
+
+<p>"I do, Larry. Tell you what, we've had our share of adventures. When
+Admiral Dewey&mdash;&mdash;What is it, captain?"</p>
+
+<p>Luke broke off short and looked at Captain Ponsberry inquiringly. The
+master of the <i>Columbia</i> was gazing over the port bow in an
+earnest, puzzled fashion.</p>
+
+<p>"Do you see that little black cloud, Striker?"</p>
+
+<p>"I do, sir!" And now Luke became all attention and so did Larry.
+"Kind o' funny lookin', ain't it?"</p>
+
+<p>"It is odd," answered the captain. "Do you see how it seems to be
+dancing around in the sky?"</p>
+
+<p>"Is it a cloud?" questioned Larry. "If so, I never saw its like
+before."</p>
+
+<p>"I'll take a look at it through my glass," went on the captain, and
+sent a sailor for the article.</p>
+
+<p>The cloud came swiftly closer and they heard a most unusual roaring
+and hissing. Then of a sudden the cloud seemed to dip down into the sea.
+When it came up, the waters of the ocean followed, and there loomed up
+before those on the ship a waterspout ten or fifteen feet thick.</p>
+
+<p>"A waterspout!" cried half a dozen in concert.</p>
+
+<p>"And a mighty powerful one, too," said the captain. "I trust it don't
+come this way."</p>
+
+<p><a name="33"></a>"It is coming this way!" yelled Larry. "Look! look!"
+</p>
+
+<p>The young second mate was right, the waterspout appeared to be headed
+directly for the schooner. But then it shot off to the westward,
+churning the water into a foam behind it.</p>
+
+<p>"It's going away," murmured Luke, when once more the waterspout made
+a curve and then shot directly toward them. It was off the port bow and
+less than a hundred feet away. It looked as if the old <i>Columbia</i>
+was surely doomed!</p>
+
+<h3 class="p4"><a name="10">CHAPTER X</a></h3>
+
+<h4>SOMETHING ABOUT WAR AND FIGHTING SHIPS</h4>
+
+<p class="p2">"It's going to strike the ship!"</p>
+
+<p>"It will cut us to pieces!"</p>
+
+<p>"Throw the schooner over on the other tack!"</p>
+
+<p>These and several other cries rang out on the deck of the
+<i>Columbia</i>. All felt their hearts come up into their throats as the
+roaring, swirling mass of water came closer and closer, until the spray
+drenched them completely. The ocean was churned into a white foam and
+the wind seemed to suck and blow in all directions at once.</p>
+
+<p>But, just as it looked as if the schooner would be buried beneath a
+veritable mountain of water, the waterspout took another curve and slid
+away, along the side of the ship and off the stern. The man at the wheel
+came close to being carried overboard by the deluge he received and the
+<i>Columbia</i> bobbed up and down like a cork. But in another moment
+the waterspout was an eighth of a mile distant.</p>
+
+<p>"What a&mdash;a narrow escape," faltered Larry, when he felt able to
+speak. "I thought we were bound for the bottom sure!"</p>
+
+<p>"Thet's the closest I ever was to any waterspout," came from Luke, as
+he wiped his wet brow. "Reckon we can thank Providence we ain't in Davy
+Jones' locker this minit!"</p>
+
+<p>Captain Ponsberry did not say much, but kept his eyes fixed on the
+waterspout, which was making fantastic curves across the bosom of the
+Pacific. At times it was close by and then it would go half a mile or
+more away. It was a fascinating scene, full of dread, and gave more than
+one onlooker a chill down his backbone.</p>
+
+<p>"I wish it would go away completely," went on Larry.</p>
+
+<p>But this was not to be. The waterspout kept within sight for a good
+half-hour, although it did not come near them again. At last it grew
+less and less, off to the southwestward, and finally vanished
+altogether. The glass was used in that direction, but nothing save a
+clear horizon could be located.</p>
+
+<p>"We are clear of it at last," said Captain Ponsberry, and breathed a
+long sigh of relief.</p>
+
+<p>"Waterspouts are mighty dangerous things," said Grandon, after the
+scare was over. "When I was on board of the brig <i>Ben Franklin</i> we
+ran into a spout off the coast of Brazil, and it knocked off the bow and
+the forward rail and nearly sank us."</p>
+
+<p>"I met one once, off the coast of Cuba," said the captain. "That went
+ashore and tore up the trees like so many weeds for a hundred feet
+around. A waterspout is nothing to be fooled with, I can tell you."</p>
+
+<p>On the day following the appearance of the waterspout the weather
+changed. There was a slight storm and then a stiff breeze sprang up
+which was cheering to all on board. Every stitch of canvas on the
+<i>Columbia</i> was spread and the schooner bowled along right
+merrily.</p>
+
+<p>"I'd like to know how this war is going on, and how Ben and Gilbert
+are faring," said Larry to Captain Ponsberry. "A whole lot may have
+happened since we left Manila."</p>
+
+<p>"Well, you'll probably get word from your brother when you reach
+Nagasaki, lad; and we'll get word from Captain Pennington, too."</p>
+
+<p>"I hope neither of them has been wounded."</p>
+
+<p>"So do I; but when one goes to the front he has got to put up with
+the fortunes of war. Being a soldier of fortune, as it is called, is no
+baby business."</p>
+
+<p>"Do you suppose the Japs are continuing to bombard Port Arthur?"</p>
+
+<p>"More than likely&mdash;if the place hasn't fallen into their hands.
+They want to make sure of their footing in lower Manchuria, and they can
+never do that so long as the Russians hold a single seaport down
+there."</p>
+
+<p>"I suppose Russia has a pretty good-sized navy as well as an
+army?"</p>
+
+<p>"Yes, Larry, one of the largest navies in the world. But their
+fighting ships are no better than the ships of Japan. You see, the
+Japanese navy is not near as old as the navy of Russia. Almost all of
+the ships are of the up-to-date types. Most of them have been built
+since the war between Japan and China in 1894 and 1895."</p>
+
+<p>"That would make them only about ten years old."</p>
+
+<p>"Exactly, and I've been told that some of the ships in the Russian
+navy are twenty and thirty years old. More than this, all of the
+Japanese guns are of the latest pattern&mdash;just as they are on our
+new warships."</p>
+
+<p>"I'd like to go aboard of a Japanese warship," cried the young second
+mate, enthusiastically.</p>
+
+<p>"Want to see if it's as good as it was aboard of the <i>Olympia</i>,
+eh?"</p>
+
+<p>"Yes, sir. Of course the <i>Olympia</i> was old, especially alongside
+of the <i>Brooklyn</i>, on which my brother Walter served in Cuban
+waters, but even so she was a bang-up fighting machine. If she hadn't
+been she wouldn't have done her share in sinking that Spanish fleet in
+Manila Bay."</p>
+
+<p>"Well, you may have a chance to go aboard of a Japanese ship while we
+stop at Nagasaki. There must be a number of them at that port, coaling
+up and taking war supplies aboard."</p>
+
+<p>"How long do you think it will be before we reach that port?"</p>
+
+<p>"That will depend entirely upon the wind, as you know. If we get just
+what we need we may reach there inside of four or five days," answered
+Captain Ponsberry.</p>
+
+<p>As Peterson and Shamhaven were now behaving themselves they were
+allowed to come out of the brig and do some work on the deck every
+morning and afternoon. Both begged the captain to forgive them, but the
+master of the <i>Columbia</i> would promise nothing.</p>
+
+<p>"You went into this with your eyes wide open," he said. "Now you can
+line up and take your medicine."</p>
+
+<p>Semmel was exceedingly bitter at not being allowed his liberty for at
+least a few hours a day and said he would denounce the captain at the
+first opportunity. But Captain Ponsberry soon cut him short.</p>
+
+<p>"You keep a civil tongue in your head," he said, sternly. "Unless you
+do, I'll put you down on hard-tack and water." And thereupon Semmel
+became sullenly silent.</p>
+
+<p>Towards evening of the day upon which Larry had the conversation
+about warships with Captain Ponsberry a Chinese junk, heavily laden with
+grass-covered boxes, was passed. Nobody on board could speak English, so
+the hail that was sent over the water brought no results.</p>
+
+<p>"We are getting closer to the coast shipping," said the master of the
+<i>Columbia</i>. "I suppose we'll meet quite a few vessels from now
+on."</p>
+
+<p>During the night an unexpected gale came up and the schooner was
+blown far out of her course. The gale came from the westward, so the
+vessel was blown to the east.</p>
+
+<p>"This will make the trip a day or two longer," grumbled Grandon,
+after the gale had spent itself.</p>
+
+<p>"Yes, but as we didn't lose a spar or a rag of canvas we can be
+thankful that it is no worse," responded Larry, who was always ready to
+look on the bright side.</p>
+
+<p>The gale subsided after a blow of twenty-four hours and then the bow
+of the <i>Columbia</i> was once more set towards her destination. Only a
+few knots had been covered when the lookout reported a vessel in
+sight.</p>
+
+<p>"It's a steamer!" cried Larry, for the smoke from the craft's funnels
+was plainly to be seen.</p>
+
+<p>"Maybe she's a warship," returned Tom Grandon, who was beside him.
+"If so, I hope she's a Japanese."</p>
+
+<p>The steamer was coming along at a good rate of speed and soon they
+made her out to be a British vessel. She was a "tramp," that is, a
+vessel going from port to port, picking up whatever cargo can be
+found.</p>
+
+<p>"Ahoy, there!" cried Captain Ponsberry, as the tramp slowed up. "What
+ship is that?"</p>
+
+<p>"The <i>Lord Duffield</i>," was the answer. "What ship is that?"</p>
+
+<p>"The <i>Columbia</i>."</p>
+
+<p>"Where are you bound?"</p>
+
+<p>"For Nagasaki. And you?"</p>
+
+<p>"For Hong-Kong."</p>
+
+<p>A little more talk followed, and the captain of the <i>Lord
+Duffield</i> vouchsafed the information that he had sighted a Russian
+warship the day before.</p>
+
+<p>"A warship!" murmured Larry.</p>
+
+<p>"Which way was she bound?" asked Captain Ponsberry, anxiously.</p>
+
+<p>"I can't tell you. She stopped us and asked a few questions and then
+slipped away in the darkness."</p>
+
+<p>"What warship was she?"</p>
+
+<p>"The <i>Pocastra</i>, from Vladivostok. I think she used to be in the
+merchant service and was built over for the navy."</p>
+
+<p>The captain of the British steamer could give no further information,
+and so resumed his course, and the master of the <i>Columbia</i> did
+likewise.</p>
+
+<p>"Ain't very nice news, is it?" said Tom Grandon.</p>
+
+<p>"It's very unpleasant news," returned Captain Ponsberry, with a shrug
+of his shoulders.</p>
+
+<p>"What are you going to do about it?"</p>
+
+<p>"What can we do, Tom? Trust to luck that we get into Nagasaki harbor,
+or some other port, in safety."</p>
+
+<p>"We'll have to keep a sharp lookout for anything that looks like a
+warship, unless, of course, she flies a Japanese flag."</p>
+
+<p>Word was passed around to those who could be trusted, and all day
+long one of the mates and a foremast hand were kept on the lookout,
+taking turns at looking through the best glass the schooner
+possessed.</p>
+
+<p>"This is almost as exciting as being in a war," said Larry, when he
+was on duty with Luke. "Don't you know how we looked for the Spanish
+ships?"</p>
+
+<p>"Yes, lad; but if we sight a Russian warship it will be small
+fighting we'll do, to my way of thinking."</p>
+
+<p>"Oh, we won't be able to fight at all. We'll simply have to rely on
+our wits to keep us out of being gobbled up as a prize of war,"
+responded the young second mate.</p>
+
+<h3 class="p4"><a name="11">CHAPTER XI</a></h3>
+
+<h4>AN ORDER TO LAY-TO</h4>
+
+<p class="p2">When taking on his cargo at Manila, Captain Ponsberry had
+considered the possibility of being captured by a Russian warship, and
+had talked the matter over with the agents of the Richmond Importing
+Company and with a Japanese official who was doing business on the sly
+in the Philippines.</p>
+
+<p>The Japanese Government was willing to pay for the cargo, whether it
+was delivered or not&mdash;presuming it was "gobbled up" by the
+Russians, but was not willing to pay for the ship if the vessel was
+taken as a prize of war.</p>
+
+<p>"That is a risk you must take yourself," said the Japanese official.
+"We are willing to pay a high price for the cargo&mdash;we cannot do
+more." And so the risk&mdash;so far as the schooner went&mdash;was
+divided equally between the Richmond Importing Company and Captain
+Ponsberry and the other owners of the <i>Columbia</i>.</p>
+
+<p>As nearly the captain's whole wealth was tied up in his share of the
+schooner, he was naturally anxious to make a safe trip, and he often
+came on deck to aid the lookouts in watching for the possible appearance
+of an enemy.</p>
+
+<p>"If you see the least thing that looks suspicious, tell me at once,"
+was his order, and it was strictly obeyed. As a consequence they ran
+away from two steamers that afternoon and another steamer the next
+morning&mdash;all too far off to show exactly what they were.</p>
+
+<p>"This isn't bringing us much nearer to port," said Larry to Cal
+Vincent, who was using the glass at the time. "I don't believe we have
+made a dozen knots since yesterday."</p>
+
+<p>"Well, the old man is a bit nervous," responded the boatswain, in a
+low voice. "And I don't blame him. It's no small matter to lose your
+craft and be thrown into prison in the bargain."</p>
+
+<p>"Would they dare to throw us into prison?"</p>
+
+<p>"To be sure,&mdash;if they could prove that we were aiding the
+Japs."</p>
+
+<p>"Well, they'll have hard work proving that."</p>
+
+<p>An hour went by and it began to grow misty. Then came a call from the
+bow.</p>
+
+<p>"Sail in sight!"</p>
+
+<p>"What is it?" demanded the captain instantly.</p>
+
+<p>"A big steamer o' some sort."</p>
+
+<p>Captain Ponsberry ran forward and took the glass. For fully two
+minutes he did not speak and then he drew a long breath and put down the
+glass.</p>
+
+<p>"I'm afraid she's a warship," he exclaimed, and his voice sounded
+unnatural.</p>
+
+<p>"A warship!" echoed Larry. "Will you let me look?"</p>
+
+<p>He did so, and it was not long before he could make out the
+approaching craft quite clearly.</p>
+
+<p>"Well?" demanded Grandon, who knew that Larry's eyes were unusually
+strong.</p>
+
+<p>"I reckon the captain is right."</p>
+
+<p>"A warship?"</p>
+
+<p>"Yes, not a very large affair, but still a warship. I shouldn't be
+surprised if she was the converted vessel the <i>Lord Duffield</i>
+sighted."</p>
+
+<p>"Just what I think," put in Captain Ponsberry. "We've got to do our
+best to show her a clean pair of heels."</p>
+
+<p>"The mist may help us to run away," suggested Grandon.</p>
+
+<p>"Let us hope so."</p>
+
+<p>Necessary orders were given, and soon the <i>Columbia</i> swung
+around on another tack, so that she had the large vessel on her
+starboard quarter. But this movement was evidently noted by the
+stranger, and the latter headed directly for the schooner once more.</p>
+
+<p>"She is after us, that is positive," said Captain Ponsberry.</p>
+
+<p>"There is a bank of mist over to the northward," returned Larry. "Why
+not run into that?"</p>
+
+<p>"Well spoken, lad; we'll do it, and as soon as the mist hides us we
+can go over on the other tack and throw her off the scent."</p>
+
+<p>The mist the young second mate had mentioned was nearly a quarter of
+a mile away and it was a question whether they could reach it before the
+stranger came up. But fortune favored those on the schooner. The mist
+rolled toward them, and in less than two minutes they were hidden as
+completely as could be desired.</p>
+
+<p>"Now to get entirely out of the way," exclaimed Captain Ponsberry,
+and lost not a moment in having the sails shifted and a new course set.
+Through the mist they heard the other vessel steaming around noisily and
+did their best to keep as far away as possible from the sound.</p>
+
+<p>All during that evening and the night to follow the <i>Columbia</i>
+kept to her new course. This was taking her away from Nagasaki, but this
+could not <ins title="Transcriber's Note: Original reads 'he'">be</ins>
+helped. The captain said if it became absolutely necessary he would run
+into some other Japanese port.</p>
+
+<p>When daybreak came the mist was as thick as ever. But there were
+signs that it would not last much longer, and by nine o'clock the sun
+was struggling to come through the clouds. Nearly everybody was on deck,
+for they realized that a fatal moment might be at hand.</p>
+
+<p>"There she is!"</p>
+
+<p>The cry came from half a dozen throats simultaneously. There, on the
+port bow, loomed up the stranger, not an eighth of a mile away. That she
+was a warship there was no longer any doubt, for her forward guns were
+plainly to be seen.</p>
+
+<p>"We're caught now!" muttered Tom Grandon.</p>
+
+<p>"Not yet!" cried the captain, and gave orders to throw the
+<i>Columbia</i> over on a new course. But scarcely had this movement
+been made when there was a puff of smoke from the warship, a report, and
+a shot flew in front of the schooner's bow.</p>
+
+<p>"There's our order to lay-to!" ejaculated Larry. "Whoever she is, she
+means business."</p>
+
+<p>As the <i>Columbia</i> did not stop, another shot was fired, this
+time just grazing the bow. Seeing there was no help for it, Captain
+Ponsberry gave the necessary orders, and down came one sail after
+another.</p>
+
+<p>As this was done the warship swung around and then those on the
+schooner saw that she flew the flag of Russia.</p>
+
+<p>"A Russian warship!" ejaculated half a dozen.</p>
+
+<p>"This looks to me as if the jig was up," murmured Tom Grandon.</p>
+
+<p>As quickly as it could be done, Captain Ponsberry assembled his men
+on deck.</p>
+
+<p>"Men," he said, briefly, "the officers on board of that warship wish
+to find out what they can about us. If you are asked questions say
+nothing more than that you shipped for the voyage to Nagasaki and San
+Francisco, and that you know nothing about the cargo. Do you
+understand?"</p>
+
+<p>"Aye, aye, sir," came from those who were listening.</p>
+
+<p>"I must depend upon you to help save the ship. If the <i>Columbia</i>
+is suspected of being in the employ of the Japanese Government, or of
+carrying a cargo for that nation, she will be taken as a prize of war
+and we'll go to a Russian prison most likely."</p>
+
+<p>"I don't want to go to no Russian prison!" cried out Wilbur, his face
+turning pale. "I ain't done nothing wrong!"</p>
+
+<p>"Then keep your tongue from wagging too much, Wilbur," answered the
+master of the schooner, grimly.</p>
+
+<p>"There ain't no use o' fighting, is there?" asked Groot.</p>
+
+<p>"Fighting?" came from Tom Grandon. "What could the old
+<i>Columbia</i> do against a man-o'-war? Why, they'd blow us sky high in
+no time!"</p>
+
+<p>"No, there is absolutely no use of attempting to fight," answered
+Captain Ponsberry. "Our only hope lays in convincing them that they have
+no right to stop us."</p>
+
+<p>The hands were dismissed and sent forward, and Captain Ponsberry
+hurried below, to burn certain papers and secrete others. This was in
+accordance with the orders received from the agents of the Richmond
+Importing Company at Manila.</p>
+
+<p>In the meantime the Russian warship had come to a stop in mid-ocean
+and now a small boat was lowered, containing a small crew, a coxswain,
+and a Russian naval officer. At the same time a signal was hoisted which
+meant that the officer was coming on board of the schooner.</p>
+
+<p>"Unless I miss my guess, this looks rather black for us," said Larry,
+to Tom Grandon.</p>
+
+<p>"I agree with you, Larry," responded the first mate. "But we've got
+to take our medicine, no matter how bitter it is."</p>
+
+<p>"If only that mist had held on to-day! We might have slipped by that
+warship nicely."</p>
+
+<p>"I only hope the old man fixes up his papers so that he can show a
+clean bill of health," went on Grandon. "You see, if they can't actually
+prove something against us, they won't dare to touch us. They know what
+Old Glory means, and Russia has no desire just now to get into trouble
+with Uncle Sam."</p>
+
+<p>"The worst of it is, our cargo may look too suspicious to them. Under
+ordinary circumstances they know that the <i>Columbia</i> wouldn't be
+carrying such a line of goods in these waters."</p>
+
+<p>"That's true, too."</p>
+
+<p>"Besides that, they may have had an agent at Nagasaki and at Manila
+spying on us. They may know just what is being done. The Czar's
+followers are mighty slick, I can tell you."</p>
+
+<p>Captain Ponsberry now came on deck and gave quick orders that the
+sailors should be lined up, to receive the visitor in a befitting
+manner.</p>
+
+<p>"A little goose grease may help," he drawled, with a knowing glance
+at Grandon and Larry.</p>
+
+<p>The foremast hands did not know much about lining up, but took the
+places assigned to them, on the forward deck. Over the side a rope
+ladder was thrown, and then Captain Ponsberry, Tom Grandon, and Larry
+awaited the arrival of the Russian naval officer with keen interest.</p>
+
+<h3 class="p4"><a name="12">CHAPTER XII</a></h3>
+
+<h4>TAKEN AS A PRIZE OF WAR</h4>
+
+<p class="p2">Slowly but surely the small boat came closer to the schooner. She
+rode the long swells of the Pacific with full grace, and Larry could not
+help but admire the long, sturdy strokes of the jackies, as they bent to
+their task.</p>
+
+<p>"I don't know but that they can handle a small boat as well as our
+own jackies," said Larry.</p>
+
+<p>"Why shouldn't they? Russian naval training ought to be first-class,"
+answered Tom Grandon. "They have been at it longer than Uncle Sam."</p>
+
+<p>"True, but that doesn't always count. Spain had been at it longer
+than we had, too, but when it came to war we beat her in double-quick
+order."</p>
+
+<p>As the small boat came closer they saw that the jackies were mostly
+men of middle age. But the coxswain was younger and so was the naval
+officer, who was gazing rather anxiously toward the schooner, as if
+wondering what the result of his mission would be.</p>
+
+<p>"Wonder if that chap can talk English?" queried the first mate. "If
+he can't the old man will be up a tree, for none of us can talk
+Russian."</p>
+
+<p>"I reckon Peterson and Semmel can talk it," answered Larry. "But we
+don't want either of those rascals to open his mouth."</p>
+
+<p>At last the small boat came up alongside of the <i>Columbia</i>. It
+was no easy matter to catch the rope ladder without getting bumped, but
+it was successfully accomplished, and then the Russian officer lost no
+time in coming on board. He at once saluted, and Captain Ponsberry and
+his mates did the same, and the sailors in the background did
+likewise.</p>
+
+<p>"What ship is this?" asked the Russian naval officer, after a few
+necessary formalities were at an end.</p>
+
+<p>"The American schooner <i>Columbia</i>," answered Captain
+Ponsberry.</p>
+
+<p>"Would you mind telling me for what port you are bound?" went on the
+naval officer, who could speak fairly good English.</p>
+
+<p>"We are bound for San Francisco, with a stopover at Nagasaki."</p>
+
+<p>"Ah! What sort of a cargo are you carrying to Nagasaki?"</p>
+
+<p>"One belonging to the firm for which the <i>Columbia</i> is in
+commission."</p>
+
+<p>"The name of the firm, please?"</p>
+
+<p>"The Richmond Importing Company."</p>
+
+<p>"Ah!" said the naval officer again, and looked slightly displeased.
+As it happened he had a brother in the army at Port Arthur, and had
+heard of the doings of Gilbert Pennington at that place, and of how the
+young American had accused certain Russians of trying to cheat the
+company he represented.</p>
+
+<p>"What warship do you come from?" demanded Captain Ponsberry, feeling
+that he had an equal right to ask questions.</p>
+
+<p>"The auxiliary cruiser, <i>Pocastra</i>, of the Russian navy,"
+answered the naval officer, politely.</p>
+
+<p>"And where are you bound?" went on Captain Ponsberry, bluntly.</p>
+
+<p>"That, sir, is a question only our commander, Captain Titorsky, can
+answer."</p>
+
+<p>"It's queer you are steaming around in Japanese waters."</p>
+
+<p>"Perhaps so." The Russian naval officer smiled in a knowing way.
+"Captain Ponsberry, I am sorry, but I think I shall have to inspect your
+papers."</p>
+
+<p>Captain Ponsberry drew himself up, resolved to put on as bold a front
+as possible.</p>
+
+<p>"This is an American ship, sir."</p>
+
+<p>"Granted, but I have my orders," returned the naval officer, coldly.</p>
+
+<p>"If I refuse to let you inspect the papers?"</p>
+
+<p>The young Russian officer shrugged his shoulders.</p>
+
+<p>"We shall be under the painful necessity of compelling you to show
+them."</p>
+
+<p>"You threaten me&mdash;an American captain!"</p>
+
+<p>"There is no help for it&mdash;I am simply obeying orders. We inspect
+all ships that we find in this vicinity."</p>
+
+<p>"Do you know I can make you pay dearly for this outrage?"</p>
+
+<p>"You cannot call it an outrage. You are in Japanese waters, Japan and
+Russia are at war. You knew that before you came into these waters. Am I
+to see the papers or not?"</p>
+
+<p>The commander of the <i>Columbia</i> knew that the Russian naval
+officer spoke the truth. Yet he made one more effort.</p>
+
+<p>"Very well; I will show my papers, but I shall insist upon you
+signing a paper that your ship held us up."</p>
+
+<p>"You can send the paper to my ship for such a signature from my
+captain," said the Russian, evasively.</p>
+
+<p>By this time four of the jackies of the small boat had come on board.
+All were armed and they lined up at the rail, close to the rope ladder.
+They were good-natured sailors and grinned broadly at the hands on the
+<i>Columbia</i>. Not one could speak a word of English, so conversation
+with them was impossible.</p>
+
+<p>Captain Ponsberry led the way to the cabin of the <i>Columbia</i> and
+the young Russian officer followed. Getting out such papers as had been
+prepared for the occasion, the master of the schooner passed them
+over.</p>
+
+<p>"These are correct so far as they go," said the Russian, after an
+examination lasting ten minutes had been made. "But&mdash;&mdash;" he
+paused. "You have no further papers?"</p>
+
+<p>"Those are my papers, sir," answered Captain Ponsberry, briefly.</p>
+
+<p>"Then I will look at a specified list of your cargo."</p>
+
+<p>"I haven't such a list," was the answer, which was true, as the list
+had been burnt up just a short while before.</p>
+
+<p>At this statement the young Russian frowned. "Every ship carries such
+a list."</p>
+
+<p>"Still, I haven't any."</p>
+
+<p>"In that case, I shall have to order an inspection of the cargo."</p>
+
+<p>"Sir, you are going too far!" said Captain Ponsberry, sternly, yet he
+knew he had no right to expect anything else.</p>
+
+<p>"If I am going too far, I am able to take the consequences," returned
+the Russian, who was acting strictly under orders.</p>
+
+<p>"Very well, sir; you can look the cargo over," answered Captain
+Ponsberry. "But I shall hold Russia accountable for the outrage."</p>
+
+<p>The Russian naval officer bowed and hastened up to the deck. He spoke
+in his native tongue to one of the jackies who carried several small
+flags under his arm. At once the Jackie began to wig-wag to the warship
+for further instructions.</p>
+
+<p>"Search the ship," came back the order, and in a few minutes more
+another small boat left the side of the <i>Pocastra</i>, containing an
+officer and a crew of eight.</p>
+
+<p>"We are in for it now, that is certain," observed Larry. "They are
+not going to let us go until they are sure we are O. K."</p>
+
+<p>The second boat was soon alongside of the schooner, and the officer
+in charge and four men came up on the deck and joined the other Russians
+already there. An earnest conversation was held between the two
+officers.</p>
+
+<p>"We'll take a general look at the cargo," said the one who had just
+arrived. "It will not do to go too far&mdash;in case we find everything
+as it should be. We want no trouble with the Yankee government."</p>
+
+<p>Captain Ponsberry was asked to have the mizzen hatch opened, and this
+work was done by Luke Striker and several others. Then two of the
+Russian sailors were sent below, and one of the officers went along.</p>
+
+<p>In the meantime, Peterson, unknown to anybody on board, had slipped
+off to the brig. Here he found Ostag Semmel in solitary confinement.</p>
+
+<p>"Semmel, a Russian warship is close at hand," he said, hurriedly. "An
+officer and some men have just boarded us."</p>
+
+<p>"Release me, Peterson!" returned the Russian sailor. "Release me and
+I will show Captain Ponsberry what I can do!"</p>
+
+<p>"You will not get me into trouble?" questioned Peterson,
+anxiously.</p>
+
+<p>"No. Quick&mdash;I am sure we can make money out of this."</p>
+
+<p>With an iron bar, Peterson pried off the lock which had been put on
+the door of the brig, and drew back the bolt. Then Semmel came out of
+his prison, with his hands linked together.</p>
+
+<p>As he was making his way to the stern deck Larry caught sight of
+him.</p>
+
+<p>"Stop!" he called out, in alarm, realizing what Semmel might do.
+"Stop, Semmel!" and he ran to capture the rascal.</p>
+
+<p>"Get out da vay!" roared the Russian and aimed a blow at Larry's
+head. But the young second mate dodged and then caught the Russian by
+the legs, hurling him flat on his breast. But now Peterson came behind
+and gave Larry a vicious kick in the side, which made the youth let go
+his hold.</p>
+
+<p>"What's the row there?" called out Captain Ponsberry, and looked much
+disturbed to see the escaped prisoner. "Put him back where he came
+from!"</p>
+
+<p>"Help!" yelled Semmel, in Russian. "Help, in the name of the Czar! I
+am a Russian subject! This ship is in the employ of the Japanese
+Government!"</p>
+
+<p>"He speaks the truth!" called out Peterson, also in Russian. "Help us
+and protect us and we will prove it!" And he ran forward to where the
+Russian officer on deck was standing.</p>
+
+<p>"You are Russians?" asked the officer, quickly.</p>
+
+<p>"We are."</p>
+
+<p>"Then I shall certainly assist you." He raised his voice. "Let that
+man go!" And he pointed at Semmel, now surrounded by Larry, Luke, and
+Cal Vincent.</p>
+
+<p>The latter words were uttered in English, so all of our friends
+understood them. The two sailors looked inquiringly at the young second
+mate.</p>
+
+<p>"He is nothing but a mutineer," said Larry. "We locked him up for it.
+He ought to have been strung up on the yardarm," he added, bitterly.</p>
+
+<p>By this time Captain Ponsberry was on the scene, and those who had
+gone below were summoned on deck once more. The captain glared at
+Semmel, who lost no time in shrinking behind the Russian officers for
+protection.</p>
+
+<p>"I can prove the cargo on this ship belongs to the Japanese
+Government," said Ostag Semmel. "My friend can prove it, too," he added,
+pointing to Peterson. "It is true we tried to seize the ship&mdash;to
+take her to Vladivostok, or some other Russian port, as a prize."</p>
+
+<p>"This is assuredly interesting," said the leading Russian officer.
+"Tell me your tale in full."</p>
+
+<p>Despite Captain Ponsberry's protests Semmel told his story in his own
+way, and Peterson corroborated it in every detail. Then Shamhaven,
+thinking to curry favor, came forward.</p>
+
+<p>"They tell the strict truth," he said. "I worked with them. We did
+what we could for the benefit of the Russian Government. Every bit of
+cargo on this ship belongs to the Japanese Government and was to be
+taken ashore at Nagasaki. The last cargo of the <i>Columbia</i> was also
+sold at Nagasaki to the Japanese Government."</p>
+
+<p>"When was this?"</p>
+
+<p>"About two months ago."</p>
+
+<p>More questions were put to Semmel, Peterson, and Shamhaven, and at
+last the Russian naval officer turned grimly to Captain Ponsberry.</p>
+
+<p>"I have heard their story, and it will be unnecessary to make an
+inspection of your cargo, since they have told me of what it consists.
+In the name of Russia I claim this ship as a prize of war, and you and
+your crew must consider yourselves prisoners."</p>
+
+<h3 class="p4"><a name="13">CHAPTER XIII</a></h3>
+
+<h4>PRISONERS ON THE "POCASTRA"</h4>
+
+<p class="p2">Captain Ponsberry had feared the result ever since the
+unexpected appearance of Ostag Semmel, so he was not very much surprised
+when the Russian naval officer stated that he should consider the
+<i>Columbia</i> as a war prize and place those on board under arrest as
+prisoners of war.</p>
+
+<p>"This is a high-handed proceeding," said he, as calmly as possible,
+although his mind was in a whirl.</p>
+
+<p>"I do not think so," answered the Russian officer. "Do you submit or
+not?"</p>
+
+<p>"Since it would be useless to fight, we shall have to submit,"
+answered the master of the schooner. "But, remember, I shall hold you
+and the Russian Government responsible for all you do."</p>
+
+<p>"As you have said that before, there is no use of repeating it,
+Captain Ponsberry. We will take command of the vessel at once."</p>
+
+<p>"What are we going to do?" whispered Larry to Tom Grandon.</p>
+
+<p>"I don't know&mdash;follow the old man, I reckon," answered the first
+mate.</p>
+
+<p>"We shall place a prize crew on this ship," went on the Russian
+officer. "These men"&mdash;pointing to Semmel, Peterson, and
+Shamhaven&mdash;"can remain on board. The remainder of the crew and the
+officers, will be transferred to the <i>Pocastra</i>. I will give you a
+quarter of an hour in which to attend to your luggage. Please take no
+more along than is necessary."</p>
+
+<p>"This is certainly high-handed!" cried Larry.</p>
+
+<p>"So we've got to go over to that old coal box, eh?" grumbled Luke,
+when he heard the news. "It's hard luck, Larry."</p>
+
+<p>"You're right, Luke, but it can't be helped."</p>
+
+<p>"What will they do with us?"</p>
+
+<p>"I haven't the least idea."</p>
+
+<p>"Will they take us to Russia?"</p>
+
+<p>"I suppose so&mdash;or stow us away in one of those cold and dirty
+Siberian prisons until we can get Uncle Sam to make them release
+us."</p>
+
+<p>When it came time to depart from the <i>Columbia</i> Larry was
+allowed to take only a bundle of clothing along, and Grandon and the
+common sailors were treated no better. The captain was allowed a trunk
+and a suit case. In the meantime Semmel was questioned once more, and
+what he had to tell made the Russians look darkly at our friends.</p>
+
+<p>"He is pumping all sorts of falsehoods into them, I suppose," said
+Larry to Luke, and he was right. Semmel made it appear that Captain
+Ponsberry was really an agent of the Japanese Government and that he
+(Semmel) had done his best to gain possession of the ship wholly for the
+benefit of his own country.</p>
+
+<p>"If you really did this, it is very worthy of you," said one of the
+officers. "But we shall have to investigate before we accept your story
+in full." This was not so encouraging, but with it Ostag Semmel had to
+be content.</p>
+
+<p>Fearing that a Japanese warship might put in an appearance at any
+moment, the Russians lost no time in transferring the officers and men
+of the <i>Columbia</i> to the <i>Pocastra</i> and at the same time a
+prize crew of two officers and ten men were taken from the warship to
+the schooner. Then the sails of the <i>Columbia</i> were hoisted and off
+she set to the eastward, and the warship moved in the same
+direction.</p>
+
+<p>When placed aboard the <i>Pocastra</i> Captain Ponsberry was treated
+politely and given a small room of his own. But the mates and the
+ordinary seamen were not so fortunate. Grandon, Larry, and Luke Striker
+were hustled off to a prison pen on one deck of the auxiliary cruiser,
+and the others to another pen below, which was even worse.</p>
+
+<p>"This is certainly hard luck," said Larry, as he threw his bundle
+into a corner and sat down on an iron bench, while Grandon and Luke did
+the same. "And after we had almost reached Nagasaki, too!"</p>
+
+<p>"Well, there ain't no use to cry over spilt milk," came from Luke.
+"We're prisoners o' war, an' I reckon as how we have got to make the
+best o' it. Ain't the first time we've been in sech a fix."</p>
+
+<p>"That is true, Luke, but it doesn't help the matter any. I guess we
+have seen the last of the old <i>Columbia</i>."</p>
+
+<p>"I was afraid of this sort of thing happening ever since we left
+Manila," came from Grandon. "I told the old man to be careful,
+that&mdash;&mdash;"</p>
+
+<p>"Hush!" whispered Larry. "They may be listening&mdash;to make sure
+that they have caught the right parties."</p>
+
+<p>"True for you, Larry; I won't say another word about that. But it
+looks dismal, no two ways on't," and the first mate drew a mountainous
+sigh.</p>
+
+<p>The prison pen into which they had been placed was an iron structure,
+reaching from floor to ceiling, and was not over ten feet square. It had
+a solid back and the remaining three sides were built up of stout iron
+bars, only a couple of inches apart. There was a door which was doubly
+locked, the key being held by a petty officer who could speak broken
+English and who rejoiced in the simple name of Rosenvischpoff. For short
+Luke nicknamed him Rosey and this name stuck to him.</p>
+
+<p>"Doesn't look as if a fellow could break out of here very easily,"
+said Larry, after an inspection of their prison. "This is a regular bank
+vault."</p>
+
+<p>"Wouldn't do you any good to break out," returned Grandon. "As we are
+on the ocean, where would you go to?"</p>
+
+<p>"We might hide until the vessel made a landing."</p>
+
+<p>"Humph, and that would be in some Russian port, so you'd be just as
+bad off."</p>
+
+<p>"Well, I'm not trying to escape just now. I want to get the lay of
+the land first, and try to find out what they are going to do with
+us."</p>
+
+<p>From Rosenvischpoff they learned that the <i>Pocastra</i> was one of
+a large number of steamers of various Russian lines which had been
+lately pressed into the service of the national navy. She had been
+rushed through at one of the Russian navy yards and provided with a
+battery of four small and four large guns, none, however, over eight
+inches. She carried a crew of one hundred and eighty men, drafted
+principally from other warships. She had an advertised speed of twenty
+knots an hour but rarely made over seventeen or eighteen. She was old
+and her engines were constantly in need of repair, much to the disgust
+of Captain Titorsky, her commander.</p>
+
+<p>"Well, Rosey, how goes this war?" asked Luke, pleasantly, as the
+petty officer came around to give them something to eat.</p>
+
+<p>"Big fight all der dime," answered Rosenvischpoff. "Russians kill all
+der Japs&mdash;sink all der Jap ships, yes!"</p>
+
+<p>"You're winning right along, eh?"</p>
+
+<p>"Yes, Russians win&mdash;Japs no do noddings, no!" And the petty
+officer left the food on the bench and hurried away again.</p>
+
+<p>"Do you believe that?" asked Larry.</p>
+
+<p>"No, I don't," came from Grandon. "He told us that simply to scare
+us, or else he doesn't know the real truth."</p>
+
+<p>"Exactly what I think."</p>
+
+<p>"These Russians are a lot of blowers," growled Luke. "Just look at
+Semmel. He was forever tooting his horn, and yet he couldn't do much of
+anything."</p>
+
+<p>"He got us into trouble," said Larry, quickly.</p>
+
+<p>"That's true, but he had to have this warship with all on board to
+help him."</p>
+
+<p>The food which had been brought to them consisted of a big bowl of
+stew, with three spoons, and three chunks of black bread.</p>
+
+<p>"They are going to treat us to the best," said Grandon,
+sarcastically. He lifted one of the spoons and tasted the stew. "Phew,
+it's hot enough! Pepper, garlic, and hot water!"</p>
+
+<p>"Does beat all how these fureigners do love their garlic," grumbled
+Luke. "'Twas the same way with them Spaniards in the Philippines."</p>
+
+<p>"Garlic and grease," added Larry. "And this bread is hard enough to
+build a wall with," he continued. "However, we have got to eat or go
+hungry." And he partook of just enough to stay his stomach. Luke and
+Grandon were not so particular and despite their grumbling managed to
+make away with all that remained.</p>
+
+<p>They saw nothing of the captain, or of the sailors who had been taken
+below, and the time hung heavily on their hands. At night they were
+given three hammocks and these they slung from one side of the prison to
+the other and rested as well as could be expected. The Russian sailors
+often came to the pen to gaze at them, but they had been warned not to
+attempt to converse with the prisoners, so nothing was said.</p>
+
+<p>On the afternoon of the third day aboard of the <i>Pocastra</i>,
+those in the pen heard a loud shouting on deck, followed by a rush of
+feet. Larry, who was resting in the corner for the want of something
+better to do, leaped up.</p>
+
+<p>"Something is doing!" he cried to his companions.</p>
+
+<p>"Here comes Captain Ponsberry," ejaculated Tom Grandon.</p>
+
+<p>He was right, the captain was coming up in company with
+Rosenvischpoff and two sailors. The Russian petty officer opened the
+door of the pen and Captain Ponsberry was thrust inside. Then the door
+was locked as before.</p>
+
+<p>"How are you, boys?" cried the captain, cordially. "All well, I
+hope."</p>
+
+<p>"We are," answered Grandon. "And you?"</p>
+
+<p>"I'm well enough, but still angry to think that we lost the
+<i>Columbia</i>."</p>
+
+<p>"So are we angry," said Larry. "But we've got to stand it. What's
+that noise?"</p>
+
+<p>"They have sighted a Chinese junk, and I reckon they are going to
+treat her as they did our vessel," answered the captain.</p>
+
+<p>The noise on deck continued, followed by quarter of an hour of
+silence. Then came a shot, followed by a second and a third.</p>
+
+<p>"Another order to lay-to," said Larry. "Wonder if the Chinamen will
+give in as we did?"</p>
+
+<p>"They will if they are wise," said Grandon.</p>
+
+<p>But the Chinamen did not believe in surrendering thus easily. They
+were carrying rice for the Japanese army, and thought that this was
+known to the enemy. Consequently they did their best to sail away.</p>
+
+<p>Hardly had the craft started on a new course when the <i>Pocastra</i>
+opened a direct fire upon her. The noise below decks was deafening and
+fairly shook the iron pen in which our friends were confined.</p>
+
+<p>"Hullo, that sounds like real war!" cried Larry. "They mean business
+now."</p>
+
+<p>One broadside was followed by another, and the Chinese junk was raked
+from end to end with such a deadly fire that more than a sixth of the
+sailors and officers were killed. Then the captain flung a white flag to
+the breeze in token of surrender.</p>
+
+<p>"We have won!" cried those on the <i>Pocastra</i>, and it was not
+long before our friends understood. Small boats were put out, and
+presently half a dozen Chinese officers from the junk were brought on
+board as prisoners. A fire that had started on the prize ship was put
+out after some hard work; and then a temporary crew was put on board,
+and the junk followed in the wake of the old <i>Columbia</i>, with the
+warship keeping guard over both.</p>
+
+<h3 class="p4"><a name="14">CHAPTER XIV</a></h3>
+
+<h4>PROGRESS OF THE WAR</h4>
+
+<p class="p2">An hour after the capture of the Chinese junk one of the
+officers of the ill-fated craft was thrust into the prison pen with our
+friends.</p>
+
+<p>He was a small sallow-eyed Celestial rejoicing in the name of Won
+Lung, and it was soon learned that he could speak a little English, he
+having once paid a visit to San Francisco.</p>
+
+<p>"All go up spout!" said he, referring to his own ship. "T'ink we safe
+when Russian gunboat come, den all up spout!"</p>
+
+<p>"Did they sink your ship?" asked Captain Ponsberry.</p>
+
+<p>"No sink&mdash;shoot holes, back, front, side&mdash;all up spout. No
+fightee no more den&mdash;all up spout!" The latter was his pet phrase
+and he used it over and over again.</p>
+
+<p>"You were in the Japanese trade?"</p>
+
+<p>"Yes&mdash;carry rice. Now Russians got rice, got junk&mdash;all Won
+Lung's money gone up spout!" And the Celestial made an odd little
+grimace.</p>
+
+<p>"Well, they took my ship, too."</p>
+
+<p>"Big schooner your shipee?"</p>
+
+<p>"Yes."</p>
+
+<p>"Won Lung weep for you&mdash;all ship gone up spout, samee like Won
+Lung's ship gone up spout!"</p>
+
+<p>"Well, we haven't gone up the spout yet," put in Larry, with a laugh.
+"Let us thank fortune that we are alive and well."</p>
+
+<p>"Dat so&mdash;Won Lung lose fliends on junk&mdash;six, seven,
+ten&mdash;don't know how many yet," and the Chinese officer shook his
+head sadly. "Bad war, bad!"</p>
+
+<p>"Can you tell us how the war is going?" asked Tom Grandon. "These
+Russians say everything is a Russian victory."</p>
+
+<p>"Russians sayee dat?"</p>
+
+<p>"Yes&mdash;they pretend to say they have the Japs about beaten."</p>
+
+<p>At this Won Lung screwed up his eyes into mere slits.</p>
+
+<p>"Big lie dat. Japanese win everyt'ing allee timee. Russian warships
+gone up spout&mdash;Russian army run like&mdash;like&mdash;up spout!"</p>
+
+<p>After that Won Lung told them all he knew. It was hard to understand
+him, yet they gathered that there had been another sea fight in the
+vicinity of Port Arthur, in which the Russian navy had come off second
+best, and that the Japanese army that had landed in Korea had driven the
+enemy to the northwestward, over the Yalu River, and was now forcing
+them back upon Liao-Yang.</p>
+
+<p>"If this news about the army is true, Ben and Gilbert must be having
+a hot time of it," was Larry's comment. "I must say, I am mighty glad
+they are on the winning side."</p>
+
+<p>"Didn't I tell ye them Russians are a lot o' blowers?" came from
+Luke. "The truth ain't in 'em half the time."</p>
+
+<p>"Perhaps they do not get the correct news from the front," came from
+Captain Ponsberry. "The censors may keep the bad news back, for fear of
+disheartening the rest of the men in the army and navy."</p>
+
+<p>"They tell me the Russians are very strict about sending out news,"
+rejoined Larry.</p>
+
+<p>"It is true, Larry; no country on the globe is stricter. No telegram
+can be sent without it is inspected, and the newspapers cannot print a
+single scrap of news, or a single editorial, until after the press
+censor has passed upon it."</p>
+
+<p>"If that's the case, I don't wonder that some of the people want to
+be free."</p>
+
+<p>"Russia is more free to-day than she ever was before, and freedom is
+bound to come sooner or later&mdash;that is, I mean, not such freedom as
+we have in the United States, but such freedom as they have in England
+and Germany&mdash;where, at least, a man can call his soul his own."</p>
+
+<p>"It's a wonder the Russians will fight for their country, if they are
+so ground down."</p>
+
+<p>"They know nothing better, and besides, they are really patriotic. If
+the Czar would only treat them a little better, and give them a little
+more liberty, they would be the most faithful of subjects. But when a
+man can't do at all as he wants to do, and can't open his mouth about it
+either, he is apt to grow sullen and ugly."</p>
+
+<p>As day after day went by life on the Russian warship became almost
+unendurable for Larry and the others. They suffered greatly for the want
+of fresh air, and at last made a vigorous protest to the captain of the
+ship, when he happened to be passing the pen. As a result orders were
+given that they should be allowed three hours on deck each day, one in
+the morning and two after dinner.</p>
+
+<p>"This is a little like," said Larry, when coming on deck for the
+first time. "Oh, how good it feels to breathe fresh air once more!" And
+he filled his lungs to their fullest capacity.</p>
+
+<p>For their daily exercise Larry and Luke were chained together, and
+the pair inspected with great curiosity as much of the warship as was
+allowed.</p>
+
+<p>"It's not so very different from some of our own auxiliary cruisers,"
+said Larry. "But, after all, I like ours better."</p>
+
+<p>"That's right, lad; stick up fer your own country every trip."</p>
+
+<p>"Well, what do you say, Luke?"</p>
+
+<p>"I say I'd rather be on one of Uncle Sam's ships than on any other in
+the world."</p>
+
+<p>While allowed to roam around on deck, Larry often looked eagerly for
+the <i>Columbia</i>, but the schooner and the Chinese junk were too far
+off to be distinguished with the naked eye.</p>
+
+<p>"We'd give a good deal to be back on her deck, wouldn't we, Luke?"
+said he.</p>
+
+<p>"Don't mention it, lad; it makes me sick," grumbled the Yankee
+tar.</p>
+
+<p>"I wish I knew just what was being done on land, don't you? Perhaps
+this war will end soon, and then we'll be set free."</p>
+
+<p>"It won't end yet awhile, Larry, mark my words on that," answered
+Luke.</p>
+
+<p>The old Yankee sailor was right&mdash;the war was far from ended, and
+here it may be well to note briefly what was taking place on the sea
+between Russia and Japan, while the army of the Mikado was pushing
+through Manchuria in the direction of Liao-Yang.</p>
+
+<p>The loss of the great battleship <i>Petropavlovsk</i> has already
+been recorded in "Under the Mikado's Flag." This vessel was sunk by a
+mine in Port Arthur harbor, April 13, 1904, and carried down with her
+Admiral Makaroff and about five hundred officers and men. At the same
+time the battleship <i>Pobieda</i> was also injured by a mine.</p>
+
+<p>The loss of the admiral's flag-ship was a great blow to Russia, and
+while she was trying to recover, Port Arthur was vigorously shelled by
+the Japanese fleet, and many buildings were more or less damaged. Some
+warehouses were set on fire, but the local fire department, aided by the
+Russian garrison, succeeded in putting out the conflagration.</p>
+
+<p>While the Japanese fleet was hammering at the city and the ships from
+beyond the harbor, the Japanese army encircled Port Arthur on land,
+taking possession of every available hill beyond the Russian line of
+defenses. As a consequence, by the middle of May the city was in a
+complete state of siege, nearly all communication with the outside world
+being cut off.</p>
+
+<p>But now came a turn in affairs which, for a short while, made matters
+look favorable for Russia. While the fleet of Admiral Togo was
+patrolling the whole of the southeastern coast of Manchuria and
+protecting the Japanese transports which were pouring troops into the
+country, occurred a catastrophe as appalling as it was unexpected.</p>
+
+<p>On the same day, May 15, the magnificent battleship <i>Hatsuse</i>,
+of the Japanese navy, was blown up by mines and sunk, and the protected
+cruiser, <i>Yoshino</i>, also of Admiral Togo's fleet, collided in the
+fog with a sister ship, and was a total loss. It is estimated that by
+these two disasters seven hundred men were lost. Among the officers who
+met their fate were men of marked ability which Japan at this crisis
+could ill afford to lose.</p>
+
+<p>The loss of the <i>Hatsuse</i> is worth relating in detail. She had
+been along the coast during a heavy fog, but this had cleared off and
+the sun was shining brightly. Not an enemy was in sight, and all was
+quiet on the great battleship when, without warning, a terrific
+explosion was felt near the stern and a portion of the steering gear was
+damaged.</p>
+
+<p>"We have struck a mine!" cried some one on board, and without delay
+signals were hoisted for the other vessels in sight to stand by. The
+battleship was drifting and the locality was full of mines. It was a
+moment of terrible suspense. Then came another explosion, greater than
+the first, which ripped large holes through her heavy plates. At once
+the battleship began to fill, and presently she sank like a stone to the
+bottom of the sea. The other warships put out their small boats with all
+speed, and succeeded in rescuing about three hundred officers and men
+out of a total of nearly eight hundred. Among those lost were
+Rear-Admiral Nashiba and Captain Nakao, the commander of the
+warship.</p>
+
+<p>The <i>Yoshino</i> was lost while steaming slowly southward, after a
+night's vigil near the entrance to Port Arthur harbor. Other vessels of
+the blockading fleet were close by, so each ship had to advance with
+extreme caution. But the fog, instead of lifting, became thicker, and at
+a little before two o'clock in the afternoon the cruiser was rammed by
+the <i>Kasuga</i>, another vessel of the fleet. A large hole was torn in
+the hull of the <i>Yoshino</i>.</p>
+
+<p>"Out with the collision mats!" cried the commander of the cruiser,
+and the mats were brought out without delay and placed over the side.
+But the hole was too great to be stopped in that manner. Then the
+captain called the entire crew on deck, and ordered the small boats to
+be lowered, five on the starboard side and one on the port. Before the
+boats could be gotten away, the <i>Yoshino</i> listed heavily to
+starboard and went down, smashing the five small boats under her. The
+other boat managed to get away, with only a handful of jackies and a
+couple of officers. The captain remained on the bridge and went down
+with his ship. As soon as possible the <i>Kasuga</i> put out her boats
+and succeeded in rescuing about ninety men, out of a total of over two
+hundred and fifty.</p>
+
+<p>It was a great blow to Japan and the Russians were correspondingly
+elated. Feeling that Admiral Togo's grip on the sea was now weakened,
+the Russian squadron at Vladivostok sailed forth and did much damage to
+the shipping on the northern coast of Japan, sinking several merchantmen
+and taking a number of others as prizes. The Russian squadron also met
+the Japanese transport <i>Kinshiu Maru</i>, having on board the 37th
+regiment of Japanese infantry.</p>
+
+<p>"Surrender, or we will sink you!" signaled the Russian commander. The
+Japanese refused, and were given exactly an hour in which to think it
+over. As they still refused, a torpedo was discharged against the doomed
+ship. As she began to sink the Japanese soldiers opened fire with their
+rifles, and then the Russians answered with their machine guns, mowing
+down the Mikado's men by the score. But the Japanese were brave to the
+last, and sank beneath the waves with the cry of <i>Banzai</i>!
+(hurrah!) on their lips.</p>
+
+<p>It was an auxiliary cruiser of the Vladivostok squadron which had
+taken the <i>Columbia</i> and the Chinese junk as prizes of war. The
+captain of the cruiser was now looking for the rest of the squadron, but
+so far none of the warships had been sighted.</p>
+
+<p>"They must have returned to Vladivostok," he reasoned, and then
+turned in that direction with the <i>Pocastra</i>, never dreaming of
+what the near future held in store for himself, his ship, and his crew.</p>
+
+<h3 class="p4"><a name="15">CHAPTER XV</a></h3>
+
+<h4>A SHARP NAVAL BATTLE</h4>
+
+<p class="p2">So far the weather had been good, but following the
+conversation recorded in the last chapter there came up a dense fog, and
+for twenty-four hours the Russian warship did nothing but creep along in
+the gloom.</p>
+
+<p>During that time, for some unknown reason, Larry and the others were
+allowed greater freedom than before. Each had his hands chained behind
+him, but all were separate, which allowed each to roam around as he
+pleased.</p>
+
+<p>"This is better than being linked to somebody else," said the youth
+to his old sailor friend. "Not but that we got along well enough
+together," he added, hastily.</p>
+
+<p>"You're right&mdash;there wasn't no sense in joinin' us together,"
+answered Luke. "We can't git away if we want to."</p>
+
+<p>"We might, if we didn't have our hands chained, Luke."</p>
+
+<p>"How?"</p>
+
+<p>"If we all got together some night&mdash;providing we could keep out
+of the pen&mdash;and stole one of the small boats."</p>
+
+<p>"Easier said nor done. The guard would ketch ye an' shoot ye down
+like a dog."</p>
+
+<p>"Oh, I know there would be a great risk. But I hate to think of going
+to a Siberian prison, or aboard a Russian prison ship."</p>
+
+<p>"So do I, Larry. But even if we stole the boat and got away, where
+would we go to,&mdash;especially if we didn't have much provisions an'
+water?"</p>
+
+<p>Larry could not answer that question, since he did not know the
+location of the <i>Pocastra</i>. It might be that they were hundreds of
+miles from land. If so, to take to a small boat with a scarcity of water
+and provisions would certainly be foolhardy.</p>
+
+<p>The fog continued during the night, but swept away as if by magic
+about nine o'clock in the morning. At that time the prisoners had had
+their breakfast and Larry and Luke were between decks, looking at some
+gunners' assistants cleaning out one of the large guns.</p>
+
+<p>Suddenly came a call from the lookout, followed by half a dozen
+commands. As everything said was in Russian, our friends did not
+understand a word, but they soon realized that something unusual was in
+the air. A shrill whistle sounded out and drums began to beat to
+quarters.</p>
+
+<p>"I'll wager a new hat they have sighted a Japanese ship!" cried
+Larry, and scarcely had he spoken when there came a dull booming over
+the water.</p>
+
+<p>"Let us go to the deck an' see what's doing," returned Luke, and both
+started for the stairs. But scarcely had they appeared on the deck when
+they were ordered below again.</p>
+
+<p>Larry was right; a Japanese warship had been sighted, and this vessel
+had lost no time in discharging a signal gun to a sister ship only a few
+miles away.</p>
+
+<p>Hardly had the youth and his friend reached the lower deck once more
+than the Japanese cruiser opened fire on the Russian vessel. The latter
+retaliated, and the booming of cannon shook the <i>Pocastra</i> from
+stem to stern.</p>
+
+<p>"This is a fight for fair!" ejaculated Luke, with a broad smile on
+his face.</p>
+
+<p>"I hope the Japs win, Luke!"</p>
+
+<p>"So do I, lad. But where do we come in, that's what I want to
+know?"</p>
+
+<p>"If we could only drop overboard and swim to that other ship!"</p>
+
+<p>"No use of trying&mdash;some of the fellows in the tops would pick us
+off in no time. No, we've got to stay right where we are an' take what
+comes."</p>
+
+<p>"Where are the others?"</p>
+
+<p>They looked around, but could see nothing of Captain Ponsberry or Tom
+Grandon. They saw Cal Vincent run past, but he was out of sight before
+they could stop him.</p>
+
+<p>Suddenly a crash above them told that a solid shot had struck the
+upper works of the Russian cruiser. Then came another crash at the
+bow.</p>
+
+<p>"Those Japs know how to fire," came from the Yankee sailor. "Reckon
+as how they're going to do their best to blow this ship sky-high. I'd
+give 'most a dollar to be somewhere else just about now!" And he shook
+his head anxiously.</p>
+
+<p>The Russian gunners were working with a will, and so were their
+numerous assistants. The <i>Pocastra</i> was swung around, and now both
+ships were broadside to each other. The thunder of the guns was terrific
+and the smoke rolled around in all directions.</p>
+
+<p>"Puts me in mind o' the battle o' Manila Bay, eh?" remarked Luke, as
+he and Larry stood at a distance, watching the Russians work one of the
+guns.</p>
+
+<p>"You are right, Luke, only&mdash;&mdash;"</p>
+
+<p>Larry got no further, for at that moment came another crash on deck.
+The <i>Pocastra</i> shivered and heaved, and to those below it was as if
+she would surely sink.</p>
+
+<p>"They're pumping it into us, sure as you're born!" sang out the old
+Yankee tar. "Hullo, what's this?"</p>
+
+<p>There was a rush of several gunners across the deck. "Beware of that
+gun!" yelled one in Russian, and then a stampede followed.</p>
+
+<p>In the midst of the confusion came a fearful explosion from below. A
+portion of the flooring was ripped apart and one of the gunners was
+instantly killed and several wounded. A great volume of smoke rolled up,
+and splinters and bits of iron and steel flew in all directions.</p>
+
+<p>Both Larry and Luke were almost stunned by the explosion and for the
+moment could do nothing but clutch each other in terror. Both were
+struck by the flying splinters, but neither was seriously wounded. They
+staggered back and began to cough, for the dense smoke was
+strangling.</p>
+
+<p>"Must have been a torpedo&mdash;&mdash;" gasped Luke.</p>
+
+<p>"Or else a magazine!" spluttered Larry. "Let&mdash;let us
+get&mdash;get out of here.
+I'm&mdash;choking&mdash;to&mdash;to&mdash;death!"</p>
+
+<p>It was really a magazine which had exploded. This tore a good-sized
+hole in the <i>Pocastra's</i> side, in a spot impossible to get at in
+the confusion. In the meantime a solid eight-inch shell struck the
+Russian ship squarely in the stern, doing additional damage and killing
+and wounding two officers and nine men.</p>
+
+<p>Almost choked to death, Larry and Luke crawled to where the ladder
+ran to the deck. The Russian jackies and gunners were swarming up, along
+with all the prisoners.</p>
+
+<p>"Larry, are you safe?" came in the voice of Captain Ponsberry, and he
+loomed up, with Tom Grandon, Cal Vincent, and the Chinese petty officer
+beside him.</p>
+
+<p>"So far I am," answered Larry. "But I&mdash;I&mdash;must have air!"
+and he began to cough.</p>
+
+<p>The jam on the ladder was terrific, and in the midst of the
+<i>mêlée</i> a Russian gunner and the Chinese petty officer got into a
+quarrel. The gunner threw the Celestial down, but he bounced up like a
+ball, and in a twinkling the Russian received a blow in the stomach
+which sent him staggering back into the crowd and the deadly smoke.</p>
+
+<p>"No knock me up the spout!" sang out the Celestial. "Ship go down I
+go uppee!" And soon he was out on the upper deck.</p>
+
+<p>Fighting, surging, pushing, and yelling the Russians and our friends
+got to the deck at last. Captain Ponsberry had his coat literally ripped
+from his back, and Cal Vincent had an arm almost torn from its socket.
+For this he gave a Russian gunner a rap in the mouth which knocked loose
+several teeth. It was a case of each man for himself, and many fought
+like wild beasts.</p>
+
+<p>At last Larry found himself free of the crowd, with Luke still beside
+him. Captain Ponsberry and Cal Vincent were not far away, but between
+surged a great number of Russians. The <i>Pocastra</i> was listing
+heavily to port and had evidently taken a large quantity of water into
+her hull.</p>
+
+<p>Two Japanese warships were now at hand and both were firing upon the
+doomed Russian cruiser with deadly accuracy. From the fighting tops of
+the Mikado's ships came a perfect hail of small bullets which sent the
+Russians to the deck by the score. By this fire one of the
+<i>Columbia's</i> sailors was killed and Cal Vincent was seriously
+wounded. A bullet likewise grazed Luke Striker's thigh, drawing some
+blood, but the Yankee tar did not know of this until the conflict was at
+an end and he saw the crimson stain on his shoe top.</p>
+
+<p>At last the Russian captain saw that to fight further would be
+useless. The <i>Pocastra</i> was in danger of going down at any moment.
+The guns could no longer be used, and he ordered the colors lowered and
+put up a signal of surrender.</p>
+
+<p>A wild cheer came from the two Japanese warships when it was realized
+that the battle was won. "<i>Banzai! Banzai!</i>" rent the air over and
+over again. "Hurrah for the Mikado! Down with the Russians!"</p>
+
+<p>A little while after the fighting came to an end, several small boats
+put off from the two Japanese warships and half a dozen of the Mikado's
+naval officers presented themselves at the <i>Pocastra's</i> side. The
+Russian ship still listed heavily, but after the smoke below had cleared
+away it was ascertained that the damage done was not as great as had
+been imagined. One of the magazines which had been in danger of blowing
+up had been flooded, and the rush of sea water had likewise put out a
+fire that had started in the stern.</p>
+
+<p>As soon as order could be restored on board of the <i>Pocastra</i> a
+complete surrender was made to the Japanese, the Russian captain giving
+up his sword. Then a general conference was had lasting over an hour. At
+the end of that time, much to their surprise, the Americans were asked
+to go over to one of the Japanese warships.</p>
+
+<p>"We'll go, and glad of the chance," said Captain Ponsberry; and soon
+the transfer was made.</p>
+
+<h3 class="p4"><a name="16">CHAPTER XVI</a></h3>
+
+<h4>ABOARD A JAPANESE WARSHIP</h4>
+
+<p class="p2">"What a beauty of a ship!"</p>
+
+<p>Such was Larry's exclamation as he stepped aboard of the Japanese
+warship. The vessel was, like the Russian prize, an auxiliary cruiser
+and named the <i>Mimora Juri</i>. She was but three years old and had
+been used for passenger service between Japan and China. For such a
+small cruiser she carried an unusually heavy battery, and everything was
+shined up to the last degree,&mdash;the work having been undertaken
+directly after the battle was over. The <i>Mimora Juri</i> had suffered
+but little damage during the contest and only a handful of men had been
+killed and wounded.</p>
+
+<p>"This looks more like Uncle Sam's navy than anything I have seen
+yet," said Luke.</p>
+
+<p>"Well, I don't know that the decorations aboard our ships are quite
+so fine," returned the youth. "But then this isn't an ordinary fighting
+ship. Some of the auxiliary cruisers we used during the war with
+Spain&mdash;those that used to be trans-Atlantic steamers&mdash;were
+just as fine as this and finer."</p>
+
+<p>As soon as those from the <i>Columbia</i> reached the Japanese
+warship the wounded were taken in charge by the surgeons and placed in
+the sick bay, as the hospital on a naval vessel is called. This was also
+in the best of order, with nice, swinging cots, and appliances of the
+latest designs.</p>
+
+<p>As there were many things to be arranged between the two Japanese
+vessels and the Russian prize, our friends were not interviewed until
+late in the evening. In the meantime, some of the Russians were made
+prisoners, and a prize crew was placed aboard of the <i>Pocastra</i>.
+Then the two Japanese warships moved away, with the captured cruiser
+between them.</p>
+
+<p>"Those Russians must feel sick," was Larry's comment. "It's worse for
+them, in a way, than if their ship had gone down."</p>
+
+<p>"Well, we all thought she was sinking," returned Captain Ponsberry.
+"If she had sunk I reckon some of us wouldn't be here to tell the
+tale."</p>
+
+<p>When evening came, a guard who could speak a little English conducted
+Captain Ponsberry, Larry, and Tom Grandon to the commander's cabin. Here
+they were met by Captain Tonkaka, who, being a graduate of the Japanese
+naval school, could speak not only English but also several other
+foreign languages. It may be mentioned here that the Japanese naval
+academy of to-day is one of the foremost institutions of its kind in the
+world.</p>
+
+<p>"I will hear your story, Captain Ponsberry," said the Japanese
+captain, politely, as he motioned his visitors to be seated.</p>
+
+<p>In a plain, direct manner the master of the <i>Columbia</i> told his
+tale, starting from the time the schooner left Manila with a cargo
+intended for the Japanese Government. He told of the trouble with Semmel
+and of the mutiny, and then of the capture by the <i>Pocastra</i>.</p>
+
+<p>"You have assuredly been unfortunate," said Captain Tonkaka. "Have
+you any idea where your schooner is now?"</p>
+
+<p>"I have not, but I thought she must be close to the Russian
+ship&mdash;she and that Chinese junk, too. The <i>Pocastra</i> was
+taking them to Vladivostok as prizes."</p>
+
+<p>"Ah!" The Japanese captain mused for a moment. "I dare say you would
+like to gain back your ship?" he continued.</p>
+
+<p>"Indeed I would!" cried Captain Ponsberry. "I'd give a pretty dollar
+to do so!"</p>
+
+<p>"I shall interview the captain of the Russian warship again
+to-morrow. It may be that he will tell us where she is&mdash;although I
+doubt it."</p>
+
+<p>After this a few questions were put to Larry and Tom Grandon and both
+corroborated what Captain Ponsberry had said. They were also questioned
+concerning the treatment they had received while on the
+<i>Pocastra</i>.</p>
+
+<p>"You may be thankful that the treatment was no worse," said Captain
+Tonkaka. "Of late some of the Russians have treated their prisoners in a
+most brutal fashion."</p>
+
+<p>"We are thankful," replied the master of the <i>Columbia</i>.</p>
+
+<p>The majority of the staterooms aboard of the <i>Mimora Juri</i> were
+occupied by the officers of the cruiser, but one small room was turned
+over to Captain Ponsberry, and a larger apartment was turned over to Tom
+Grandon and Larry. At Larry's solicitation Luke Striker was allowed to
+"bunk in" with the first and second mates.</p>
+
+<p>"This 'ere ship is jest about next to a palace," was Luke's comment.
+"Ain't seen nothing so fancy in a long time."</p>
+
+<p>The Japanese warships were bound for the nearest naval station with
+their prize. They could readily have made eighteen knots an hour, but
+the crippled Russian cruiser could not make over ten, and so this was
+the rate of speed set for all three.</p>
+
+<p>The Americans were allowed the freedom of the ship and Larry and Luke
+spent many hours in inspecting the guns and other equipments, and in
+watching the Japanese jackies in the gun and cutlass drills, their
+physical exercises, and in their drills to fight fire and to lower the
+small boats. Everything on board ran as smoothly as clockwork, much to
+their delight.</p>
+
+<p>"I can tell you what, Luke!" cried Larry, enthusiastically, "this
+beats the Russians all hollow! I never saw anything so well done!"</p>
+
+<p>"Almost beats our own navy, doesn't it?"</p>
+
+<p>"Well, I don't know about that. But it is certainly just as good.
+That drill to fight fire is immense, and their physical exercises ought
+to make each man's muscles like iron."</p>
+
+<p>"They are a sturdy lot, lad, no two ways about that,&mdash;and they
+understand just how to keep themselves in the pink of condition." Luke
+rubbed his chin reflectively. "Do ye know what I have in mind to
+do?"</p>
+
+<p>"I think I can make a pretty good guess," came quickly from
+Larry.</p>
+
+<p>"Well?"</p>
+
+<p>"You're thinking that you'd like to join the Japanese navy, just to
+have a mix-up or two with the Russians."</p>
+
+<p>"You've struck the nail on the head, lad. And why not, seeing as how
+we are out here in fighting waters, and with no ship of our own to go
+aboard?"</p>
+
+<p>"Well, I feel a good bit that way myself. Ben is in the army, and so
+is Gilbert Pennington. If they can make a record for themselves why
+shouldn't I do the same? As it was I came close to joining the army with
+Ben."</p>
+
+<p>"So you told me before. But you're a born sailor, Larry, not a
+soldier."</p>
+
+<p>"I don't deny it. I'd rather be on board of a ship than on land any
+day."</p>
+
+<p>"Yes, to a fellow as gets used to the sea the land seems a strange
+place."</p>
+
+<p>From the Japanese on the warship who could speak English our friends
+learned much concerning the war. They were told that Admiral Togo's
+fleet was keeping a strict guard over the harbor approach to Port
+Arthur, and that a portion of the Japanese army was hemming in the city
+on the land side and had lately captured several hills of
+importance.</p>
+
+<p>From Captain Tonkaka the Americans obtained permission to station
+themselves in one of the fighting tops, and here they spent hour after
+hour, on the lookout for the <i>Columbia</i>. Captain Ponsberry was
+particularly anxious to find his vessel, and kept scanning the Japan Sea
+through a fine spyglass the Japanese captain loaned him.</p>
+
+<p>"If I can gain possession of that ship, I am going to fix Semmel and
+Peterson," said the master of the <i>Columbia</i>.</p>
+
+<p>"Both of them declared that they took possession of the ship for the
+sake of the Russian Government," said Larry. "That being the case, they
+should be treated as prisoners of war."</p>
+
+<p>"Exactly my idea, Larry."</p>
+
+<p>"Semmel is a thoroughly bad egg," came from Tom Grandon. "He will lie
+out of his troubles if he can possibly do so."</p>
+
+<p>"It will be a shame if we don't find the <i>Columbia</i> again," went
+on Larry. "Think of those rascals taking her to Vladivostok and getting
+their share of the prize money! It makes me sick!"</p>
+
+<p>"Captain Tonkaka tells me that other Japanese warships are in this
+vicinity," said Captain Ponsberry. "They may fall in with the schooner
+even if we don't. But what they will do with her, in that case, there is
+no telling. They might claim her as a prize also, and if they did, I'd
+have some trouble in getting my property back."</p>
+
+<p>What the Japanese captain had said was true. In order to counteract
+the doings of the Russian squadron which was raiding the northern and
+eastern coasts of Japan, the Mikado had sent out a flying squadron of
+six or seven vessels, all of which, though not large, had good sailing
+powers.</p>
+
+<p>Owing to the heavy mists, the flying squadron became separated, and
+two of the vessels fell in with the <i>Pocastra</i>, as already
+described. Of the other ships some proceeded up the coast to Korea and
+caught two Russian colliers loaded with coal and another ship carrying
+steel rails for the Manchuria railroad. The remainder of the squadron
+put further to sea, and on the fourth day out caught sight of two
+Russian steamers loaded with munitions of war. A chase ensued, lasting
+three days, and several shots were exchanged at long range. But a mist,
+coming up one night, put an end to the chase, and chagrined to think
+that the enemy had given them the slip after all, the Japanese turned
+back once more, to look for the other vessels of the flying squadron.</p>
+
+<h3 class="p4"><a name="17">CHAPTER XVII</a></h3>
+
+<h4>THE RETAKING OF THE "COLUMBIA"</h4>
+
+<p class="p2">"We are in for another storm!"</p>
+
+<p>It was Larry who made the remark. He was in one of the tops with
+Luke, gazing anxiously to the westward, where the black clouds were
+beginning to pile up.</p>
+
+<p>"Right you are, lad&mdash;and it's going to be a heavy one, unless I
+miss my guess."</p>
+
+<p>The storm broke half an hour later, and the wind and rain were so
+furious that our friends were glad to leave the top and go below. But
+some of the Japanese sailors did not appear to mind the lashing of the
+elements and remained on deck as if nothing out of the ordinary was
+occurring.</p>
+
+<p>"These chaps beat me!" said Larry. "They are certainly as tough as
+pine knots. I never saw their equal."</p>
+
+<p>"I'm beginning to think that the Japanese are a wonderful nation,"
+put in Tom Grandon, seriously. "I used to look at them as something like
+the Chinese. But there is a wide difference between them and the
+Chinks."</p>
+
+<p>"A Chinaman isn't in it alongside of a Japanese," came from Captain
+Ponsberry. "The Japanese are up-to-date and very progressive; the
+Chinese are about a hundred years behind the times."</p>
+
+<p>The storm continued for the best part of half a day. There was but
+little thunder and lightning, but the wind blew a perfect gale. Yet even
+the <i>Pocastra</i> did not seem to mind the wind, and all three of the
+warships proceeded on their way at only a slightly reduced rate of
+speed.</p>
+
+<p>"Such a gale as this will play havoc with the sailing vessels," said
+Larry. "I wonder how the old <i>Columbia</i> is making out?"</p>
+
+<p>"I was thinking that same," rejoined Captain Ponsberry. "To tell the
+truth, I'd rather have her go to the bottom than see her taken to a
+Russian port as a prize."</p>
+
+<p>When the storm cleared away, Larry was one of the first to go on
+deck, to get a whiff of "washed air," as he called it. The others
+followed.</p>
+
+<p>"I see a sail!" cried the youth, a moment later, and at that instant
+came a cry from the lookout. Far to the eastward was a sailing vessel
+flying a signal of distress.</p>
+
+<p>"She looks familiar to me!" ejaculated Captain Ponsberry, and ran to
+get Captain Tonkaka's glass. One glance through the instrument was
+enough.</p>
+
+<p>"The <i>Columbia</i>!"</p>
+
+<p>"Are you sure?" cried Larry.</p>
+
+<p>"She certainly is the <i>Columbia</i>," said Tom Grandon, after a
+look through the glass. "She has lost her fore topmast and part of her
+bowsprit."</p>
+
+<p>"And a part of the stern rail is gone," added Larry, after he too had
+used the glass. "Let us tell Captain Tonkaka," he added, starting to go
+below.</p>
+
+<p>The news that the <i>Columbia</i> was in sight was soon circulated
+throughout the ship, and Captain Tonkaka at once signaled to the other
+warships that he was going to her assistance. Then the <i>Mimora
+Juri</i> steamed away on her new course.</p>
+
+<p>As they drew closer to the schooner they could see that the storm had
+treated the gallant old ship roughly enough. Many of the sails were in
+ribbons, and not only the fore topmast but also half a dozen of the
+spars were gone. One end of the forecastle was stove in, and a part of
+the stern was a wreck.</p>
+
+<p>"This is the worst yet!" cried Larry. "They must have caught more of
+the gale than we did."</p>
+
+<p>"They didn't know how to handle her, that's the reason of it," came
+from Captain Ponsberry. "We have taken her through a worse blow than
+that; eh, Tom?"</p>
+
+<p>"I think so," answered the second mate.</p>
+
+<p>As soon as the Japanese warship was close enough a boat was lowered
+and an officer went aboard of the schooner, followed by several of his
+crew and Captain Ponsberry, Grandon, and Larry.</p>
+
+<p>The Russians having the schooner in charge were meek enough. As a
+matter of fact the gale had terrorized them, and all had imagined they
+were surely going to the bottom of the sea. They did not like it to find
+themselves in the hands of the enemy and were astonished when they
+learned that the <i>Pocastra</i> had been captured.</p>
+
+<p>"It was a fearful storm," said the Russian officer who was in charge.
+"Several times I fancied the masts would all go by the board. I shall
+never want another such experience. One man was washed overboard and
+several were badly hurt by the wrecking of the forecastle."</p>
+
+<p>"Were any of my former men injured?" asked Captain Ponsberry.</p>
+
+<p>"It was my fellow countryman, Ostag Semmel, who was swept overboard
+and drowned," answered the Russian officer.</p>
+
+<p>"Semmel!" ejaculated Larry. He drew a long breath and his hatred of
+the man died all in an instant. "Poor chap! That was rough on him!"</p>
+
+<p>"It certainly was rough," answered Captain Ponsberry. "And what of
+the others?"</p>
+
+<p>"Both Peterson and Shamhaven were hurt, but not seriously. They are
+below resting," was the answer.</p>
+
+<p>It was found that some of the seams of the schooner had opened but
+that no alarming quantity of water was running into the well. The
+Russians were asked to surrender as prisoners of war and this they did
+willingly, and were transferred to the Japanese warship. Then Captain
+Ponsberry was asked if he wished to take charge of the <i>Columbia</i>
+again.</p>
+
+<p>"Will a duck swim!" he cried. "Of course I want to take charge.
+Hasn't she always been my ship? And my crew will want to go with me, I
+know."</p>
+
+<p>"But the wreckage&mdash;&mdash;" began Captain Tonkaka.</p>
+
+<p>"I'll attend to that, sir,&mdash;don't you worry. Only give me back
+my ship, that's all I ask."</p>
+
+<p>"It shall be as you say, Captain Ponsberry. But when you get to
+Nagasaki you will have to settle matters with the Japanese Government.
+It is, all told, a rather peculiar case. In one way, she is now a
+Japanese prize of war, and in another way she is not."</p>
+
+<p>"I understand, and the courts will have to settle the tangle, sir.
+I'll do what is fair, and I know the Richmond Importing Company will do
+the same."</p>
+
+<p>"Then you can go aboard of the ship as soon as you please."</p>
+
+<p>"Thank you very much."</p>
+
+<p>Captain Ponsberry had returned to the warship for just this talk, and
+now he lost no time in getting back to the <i>Columbia</i>, taking with
+him all his crew, including Cal Vincent, who was just about able to get
+around once more.</p>
+
+<p>"Hurrah!" cried Larry, "this seems like home once more, doesn't
+it?"</p>
+
+<p>"That's what it does," answered Luke. "But there is plenty of work
+ahead, I can tell you that, lad."</p>
+
+<p>"I don't care&mdash;work will help to pass the time."</p>
+
+<p>When Peterson and Shamhaven saw Captain Ponsberry they did not know
+what to say. The loss of their leader, Semmel, had humbled them
+greatly.</p>
+
+<p>"I'm not going to say much to you, seeing as how both of you are
+hurt," said the master of the <i>Columbia</i>, briefly. "But understand,
+I want no nonsense from either of you."</p>
+
+<p>"I'll do all I can to assist you, captain," said Shamhaven, humbly.
+"All I want is another chance."</p>
+
+<p>"Which you'll not get from me," was the quick rejoinder. "I know you
+thoroughly, Shamhaven, and I am done with you. You and Peterson aided
+the Russians and you can now consider yourselves under arrest. When we
+get into port I'm going to hand you over to the Japanese
+authorities."</p>
+
+<p>Both of the culprits wanted to argue, but the captain would not
+listen. Their hurts were inspected and they were told that they would be
+allowed three days in which to recuperate, after which they would have
+to do their share of duty.</p>
+
+<p>"I don't like this," growled Shamhaven, after the interview was over.
+"Peterson, we are in it deeper than ever."</p>
+
+<p>"Dat is so," was the answer, with a scowl. "Vell, ve not put up mit
+him, hey? Maybe, ven we git near shore, we run avay, Shamhaven."</p>
+
+<p>"Yes, if we can get the chance. But I don't know where you are going
+to run to&mdash;especially if you haven't any money."</p>
+
+<p>"Ve git money."</p>
+
+<p>"From where?"</p>
+
+<p>"I ton't know dot yet, no, but ve git him, yes. Captain Ponsberry
+must haf some, and dot Larry Russell, too. Vonce I see Russell mit a
+money pelt vot haf some gold in him, yes."</p>
+
+<p>"A money belt with gold? You must be dreaming."</p>
+
+<p>"No, I see him mit mine two eyes. He count der gold. He haf more as
+dirty pieces."</p>
+
+<p>"That is worth remembering," answered Shamhaven. And he began to
+speculate upon what he could do in Japan if he was free and had a money
+belt full of gold.</p>
+
+<p>That Larry had a money belt was true. He had purchased it several
+years before, while on shore duty in the Philippines. He was a saving
+fellow and found the belt useful in which to place his wages and the
+money which he occasionally received from home. Strange as it may seem,
+the belt had not been taken away from him by the Russians, and it now
+contained nearly three hundred dollars. The money was mostly in
+gold,&mdash;for he had found that gold could be used no matter where he
+went.</p>
+
+<h3 class="p4"><a name="18">CHAPTER XVIII</a></h3>
+
+<h4>A CLEVER RUSE</h4>
+
+<p class="p2">As soon as Captain Ponsberry was in charge of the
+<i>Columbia</i> once more he set about without delay to put the schooner
+in proper condition for the run to Nagasaki. The broken-off foremast was
+allowed to remain as it was, but a temporary bowsprit was set into
+place, and the damage to the forecastle and to the stern repaired. A
+temporary rail was also nailed up, so that there might be no danger of
+anybody slipping overboard.</p>
+
+<p>In all this work the sailors and the ship's carpenter did their best,
+and the captain and his mates helped. Sails were also sewed up, or
+replaced, and inside of forty-eight hours the old <i>Columbia</i> was
+once more on her way. The water taken aboard was pumped out, and the
+pumps were kept going two hours each morning and two hours each
+afternoon.</p>
+
+<p>"She will do now," said the captain, after the heaviest of the work
+was over. "But when we reach Nagasaki I'll have to put her in the dock
+for regular repairs. I shouldn't dare to take her to Manila or to San
+Francisco in such a condition."</p>
+
+<p>"It will take a long time to have the repairs made in Japan," said
+Larry. "All the shipyards are busy on government work."</p>
+
+<p>"True, lad, but that cannot be helped. The law would not allow me to
+sign a crew with a ship that was not seaworthy."</p>
+
+<p>"Then we'll have a long lay-off when we reach Nagasaki."</p>
+
+<p>"Exactly, Larry. But I shan't keep you. If you want to go
+elsewhere&mdash;&mdash;"</p>
+
+<p>"Not on another sailing vessel, Captain Ponsberry. But you know how
+it is with Luke Striker and myself. Ever since we were in our own navy
+we have had a hankering after warships, and&mdash;&mdash;"</p>
+
+<p>"And you think of joining the Japanese navy?" put in the master of
+the schooner, quickly.</p>
+
+<p>"That's it. You know how I spoke of joining the army with Ben and
+Gilbert."</p>
+
+<p>"To be sure&mdash;and I told you I couldn't spare you."</p>
+
+<p>"But now, if you haven't any use for me any longer&mdash;&mdash;"</p>
+
+<p>"Why, Larry, if you want to fight for Japan, go ahead and fight!"
+ejaculated Captain Ponsberry. "I don't blame you. I'd fight myself if I
+was a younger man and hadn't any obligations on my shoulders. I suppose
+Ben is doing great things in the army and you'd like to match him in the
+navy, eh?"</p>
+
+<p>"If I join the navy I'll do my best."</p>
+
+<p>"Will Striker go with you?"</p>
+
+<p>"Oh, yes, Luke and I always go together, if we can. He was my chum
+when we fought under Dewey and he has been my chum ever since."</p>
+
+<p>"And a good fellow, too, Larry&mdash;a man with a heart of gold. If
+it wasn't that you and Tom Grandon were with me, I should have made him
+a mate long ago."</p>
+
+<p>"I don't doubt that, sir&mdash;and he is worthy of it." Larry paused
+for a moment. "Of course, I don't know if they want any of us in the
+navy."</p>
+
+<p>"Didn't you tell me before that they had several men you had met
+while under Dewey and some your brother Walter had met while fighting in
+Cuban waters?"</p>
+
+<p>"Yes, but that was some time ago."</p>
+
+<p>"If they took those chaps then it's likely they will take you
+now&mdash;unless, of course, they have all the men they want&mdash;which
+I doubt."</p>
+
+<p>"We shall not go as ordinary jackies. Ben got a commission as a
+captain, and Luke thinks he might go as a gunner and I might go as an
+assistant gunner. We occupied those positions before we left our
+navy."</p>
+
+<p>"Then I should certainly strike for the positions. They may need
+gunners even if they don't need common seamen," responded Captain
+Ponsberry.</p>
+
+<p>As fortune would have it, the run to Nagasaki was made without
+incident worthy of special mention. Once there was a scare on board, as
+the water in the well hole increased with alarming rapidity. But the new
+leak was discovered in time, and the ship's carpenter had little
+difficulty in repairing it. They also sighted a vessel they thought
+might be a Russian warship, but she proved instead to be a Japanese
+coastwise freighter, carrying lumber from one port to another on the
+northern coast of Japan.</p>
+
+<p>As the <i>Columbia</i> drew closer to Nagasaki both Peterson and
+Shamhaven grew more anxious over what was to become of them. Neither
+desired a term in a Japanese prison, and both wondered what sort of a
+charge Captain Ponsberry and the captain of the Japanese warship would
+prefer against them.</p>
+
+<p>So far Captain Ponsberry had allowed them their liberty, but through
+the talk of a couple of sailors they presently learned that they were to
+be cast into the ship's brig and placed under guard as soon as the
+schooner dropped anchor.</p>
+
+<p>"This looks black for us," said Shamhaven, moodily. "I wish we were
+out of it."</p>
+
+<p>"I haf a plan got, yes," answered Peterson.</p>
+
+<p>"To get away?"</p>
+
+<p>The other nodded.</p>
+
+<p>"Then let me hear the plan by all means, Peterson."</p>
+
+<p>"It vos&mdash;vot you call him&mdash;risky, yes. Maype ve get
+shot&mdash;you no like him, no?"</p>
+
+<p>"Of course I don't want to get shot. But what is your plan?"</p>
+
+<p>"So soon like de ship come up by der harbor we vatch our chances an'
+trop oferpoard, yes."</p>
+
+<p>"And swim ashore?"</p>
+
+<p>"Maype ve schwim by some udder poat, yes. Of ve got money we go to
+leetle poat&mdash;gif Jap mans money to take us avay, you see now?"</p>
+
+<p>"You mean to watch for some small Japanese boat&mdash;a bumboat, eh?
+And bribe the boatman to take us to some place of safety?"</p>
+
+<p>"You got him now, yes."</p>
+
+<p>"That's good enough if we can find the bumboat and get the money with
+which to do the bribing."</p>
+
+<p>"Captain Ponsberry got money&mdash;an' Russell he got money pelt,
+like I told you."</p>
+
+<p>"Oh, I haven't forgotten about that money belt," returned Shamhaven.
+"And I wouldn't mind taking it if I could get my hands on it. But
+Russell must wear it most of the time."</p>
+
+<p>"I t'ink he not put him on by der night dime, no."</p>
+
+<p>"What do you know about Captain Ponsberry's money?"</p>
+
+<p>"He got money in a leetle pag&mdash;I see him vonce."</p>
+
+<p>"How much do you think?"</p>
+
+<p>At this Peterson shrugged his shoulders.</p>
+
+<p>"No can tell dat&mdash;maype a thousand dollars."</p>
+
+<p>There was a pause, and Shamhaven drew a long breath.</p>
+
+<p>"One thing is certain," he resumed. "I don't intend to go to a
+Japanese prison, or an American prison either, if I can help it, and if
+we cut loose here in a strange country we are bound to need more or less
+money with which to get along. Without money a fellow can't do a thing
+in a strange country."</p>
+
+<p>"We git money&mdash;chust you vait," said Peterson.</p>
+
+<p>At last the <i>Columbia</i> came into sight of the shipping of
+Nagasaki. But it was now dark, and a heavy fog was hanging over the
+harbor, so it was impossible to make the proper landing before the next
+day. They came to anchor and the necessary lights were hung out.</p>
+
+<p>"This is our chance," said Shamhaven. "It is now or never!"</p>
+
+<p>He had heard that Peterson and himself were to be made close
+prisoners directly after supper. He watched his chance and when nobody
+was looking motioned his confederate to leave the forecastle and steal
+silently toward the stern of the ship. Each carried a block of wood, to
+which was attached a bit of iron, to make it sink from sight.</p>
+
+<p>"Now then!" whispered Shamhaven, and threw the block he carried
+overboard. It struck the water with a loud splash, and the block carried
+by Peterson immediately followed.</p>
+
+<p>"Hullo, what's that?" came in the voice of Tom Grandon. "Who threw
+something overboard?"</p>
+
+<p>"Sounded like somebody jumping into the water," replied Captain
+Ponsberry, who was on deck with the first mate.</p>
+
+<p>An examination was made, but in the fog and darkness nothing could be
+discovered.</p>
+
+<p>"It was mighty queer," was Grandon's comment. "Somebody must have
+done it."</p>
+
+<p>"Where are Shamhaven and Peterson?"</p>
+
+<p>"In the forecastle, I suppose. Do you think&mdash;&mdash;"</p>
+
+<p>"I don't know what to think. See if they are there."</p>
+
+<p>At once Tom Grandon ran off, and made a tour not only of the
+forecastle but also of the forward deck. He called the men's names
+several times, and others quickly joined in the hunt.</p>
+
+<p>"They are gone!" he ejaculated, running back to where Captain
+Ponsberry stood.</p>
+
+<p>"Gone? Then it must have been them jumping overboard that we
+heard!"</p>
+
+<p>"Like as not&mdash;and they are a good bit away from the schooner by
+this time."</p>
+
+<p>"Bring a lantern and we'll take a look around."</p>
+
+<p>A lantern was brought, and a few minutes later a small boat was
+lowered, manned by Luke and three other sailors. Captain Ponsberry went
+with them, and the searchers remained out the best part of an hour.</p>
+
+<p>"They've given us the slip clean and clear," declared the master of
+the <i>Columbia</i>, on returning. "It was a risky thing to undertake in
+such weather as this."</p>
+
+<p>"Yes, and for all we know they may be at the bottom of the harbor,"
+answered Tom Grandon.</p>
+
+<p>"Which place might be jest what they deserve," grumbled Luke Striker,
+as he helped to stow away the small boat once more.</p>
+
+<h3 class="p4"><a name="19">CHAPTER XIX</a></h3>
+
+<h4>THE DISAPPEARANCE OF THE ENEMY</h4>
+
+<p class="p2">As soon as Peterson and Shamhaven threw the blocks of wood
+overboard they darted for the companionway of the schooner and crept
+noiselessly down to the cabin.</p>
+
+<p>The apartment was deserted, and the swinging lamp over the center
+table was turned low. On the table rested several charts which Captain
+Ponsberry had been consulting before joining Tom Grandon on deck.</p>
+
+<p>It was Larry's watch below and he was improving the time by taking a
+much-needed nap. He lay on the berth in his stateroom, with the door
+wide open to admit the fresh air.</p>
+
+<p>"Make no noise!" whispered Shamhaven. "If we are discovered the jig
+is up with us."</p>
+
+<p>"Russell is here, yes?" came from Peterson.</p>
+
+<p>"Sh-sh! Yes&mdash;over in yonder stateroom."</p>
+
+<p>They closed the door leading to the companionway and then tiptoed
+their way to where Larry lay.</p>
+
+<p>"More than likely he keeps his money belt under his pillow when he
+sleeps," said Shamhaven. "Wait till I find out."</p>
+
+<p>He shoved his hand under the headrest with caution and presently his
+fingers came into contact with a strip of leather and chamois. He pulled
+on it gently, but it refused to budge.</p>
+
+<p>"Lift his head a little," he said, and Peterson started to do as
+requested. But the movement, gentle as it was, caused Larry to open his
+eyes.</p>
+
+<p>"Wha&mdash;what are you doing here?" stammered the young second mate,
+when, waiting for no more words, Peterson clapped a dirty hand over his
+mouth.</p>
+
+<p>"Keep still, you! If you no keep still I hit you good, yes!"</p>
+
+<p>"Confound the luck," muttered Shamhaven. "I didn't want him to know
+what we were up to."</p>
+
+<p>Larry began to struggle and with an effort threw aside the hand over
+his mouth.</p>
+
+<p>"Le&mdash;let up!" he spluttered. "I want you&mdash;&mdash;Help!"</p>
+
+<p>"Shut up!" cried Shamhaven, fiercely, and struck him a swinging blow
+in the temple. Another blow from Peterson followed, and then, with
+flashing lights darting through his brain, Larry lost consciousness.</p>
+
+<p>Both men bent over him to see if he would move. When he lay as still
+as if dead they looked at each other with satisfaction.</p>
+
+<p>"He won't bother us any more&mdash;at least, not for awhile," was
+Shamhaven's comment.</p>
+
+<p>"Quick, de money belt!" came from Peterson, and as he raised up
+Larry's head, Shamhaven secured it and stowed it away in the bosom of
+his shirt. "You no keep him!" he went on, in alarm, showing that he did
+not trust his companion in crime.</p>
+
+<p>"We'll divide up afterwards," said Shamhaven, briefly. "Now to locate
+the captain's little pile."</p>
+
+<p>Both tiptoed their way into Captain Ponsberry's stateroom. Here there
+was a small safe, with the door closed.</p>
+
+<p>"A safe, eh?" said Shamhaven. "Wonder if we can open it?"</p>
+
+<p>He knelt down and tried to work the combination lock. The safe was
+old and out of order and the captain had had the combination lock made
+as simple as possible in consequence. Soon there came a click, followed
+by another, and the bolts shot back.</p>
+
+<p>"Luck is with us!" cried Shamhaven.</p>
+
+<p>"Dare is de leetle pag," came from Peterson, and reaching into the
+safe he drew the article forth. There was a slip string at the top which
+he pulled apart.</p>
+
+<p>"Gold!" he cried. "See&mdash;dirty&mdash;forty bieces of gold!" And
+then he shut the bag again, and placed it into his own shirt bosom.</p>
+
+<p>"Remember, half of that is mine," came sharply from Shamhaven. He
+fancied there might be more in the bag than in the money belt.</p>
+
+<p>"Yes,&mdash;an' haf de money-pelt money ist mine, yes," returned
+Peterson.</p>
+
+<p>"Right you are, Peterson. Now to get away from the ship."</p>
+
+<p>"Let us lock Russell in de stateroom first."</p>
+
+<p>"A good idea!"</p>
+
+<p>The door was closed and locked. Larry still lay unconscious and there
+was no telling how soon he would come to his senses.</p>
+
+<p>They heard the tramping on the deck and the departure of the small
+boat. Now those in the boat came back and the search for the missing men
+came to an end.</p>
+
+<p>With the slyness of a pair of cats, the evildoers crept up the
+companionway once more. Nobody was in sight, and they crawled rather
+than walked to the rail of the schooner. Both were good swimmers and not
+afraid to trust themselves to reach some other shipping in the harbor.
+Yet as an extra precaution each provided himself with a
+life-preserver.</p>
+
+<p>"Are you ready, Peterson?"</p>
+
+<p>"Yes."</p>
+
+<p>"Then over we go."</p>
+
+<p>A small rope was handy, and lowering this, each slid along it into
+the waters of the harbor. Then they struck out swiftly but silently; and
+in a few minutes the fog and darkness hid them completely from view.</p>
+
+<p>It was the best part of an hour before Larry returned to his senses.
+His head ached as if ready to split open and for several minutes he
+could not remember where he was or what had occurred.</p>
+
+<p>"Oh, my head!" he groaned. "Oh!" And he turned over and tried to sit
+up, with the result that he pitched out on the floor of the stateroom.
+This aroused him and he got up as quickly as he could.</p>
+
+<p>"Those rascals attacked me!" he muttered. "They struck me over the
+head! I remember now! Oh, how my head spins,&mdash;just as if I was in a
+merry-go-round! I wonder&mdash;&mdash;"</p>
+
+<p>He dropped on the berth and snatched away the pillow. One glance was
+sufficient to show him how he had been robbed.</p>
+
+<p>"That's why they attacked me!" he cried. "Wonder where they are now?
+Perhaps they ran away from the ship!"</p>
+
+<p>Leaping up again he stepped to the door, and finding it locked, began
+to pound away lustily, at the same time yelling at the top of his lungs.
+In a few minutes this brought down Captain Ponsberry, followed by Luke,
+who had been told to come along, the captain fearing that something had
+gone wrong.</p>
+
+<p>"What's up here?" demanded Captain Ponsberry as he flung open the
+door.</p>
+
+<p>"Where are they?" came the counter-question from Larry.</p>
+
+<p>"They? Who?"</p>
+
+<p>"Peterson and Shamhaven?"</p>
+
+<p>"Gone&mdash;slid away in the fog."</p>
+
+<p>"They have robbed me!"</p>
+
+<p>"You don't say!" ejaculated the master of the <i>Columbia</i>. "You
+are sure?" he went on.</p>
+
+<p>"Yes. My money belt is gone. They came while I was asleep, and when I
+woke up both hit me,&mdash;and I don't know what happened after that. I
+just came to my senses and found myself locked in."</p>
+
+<p>"The villains!" burst in Luke. "Those chaps ought to be swung up to a
+yardarm!"</p>
+
+<p>The captain listened to Larry's story and then was prompted to take a
+look around the other staterooms. As a result he speedily discovered
+that the safe had been tampered with and that his own money was
+gone.</p>
+
+<p>"They are worse rascals than I thought them," said Captain Ponsberry,
+bitterly. "I am sorry that I did not make an example of them from the
+start."</p>
+
+<p>There was a good deal of speculation concerning what had become of
+Shamhaven and Peterson, and another search was instituted, lasting until
+the following day, but not a single trace of the evildoers could be
+found.</p>
+
+<p>"Well, I am out the whole of my savings," said Larry to Luke.</p>
+
+<p>"It's a shame, lad," replied the Yankee tar. "But if you need ready
+cash don't fail to draw on me. As long as I have a shot in the locker
+half on it is yours."</p>
+
+<p>"Thank you, Luke; I know you'd say that. You're the proper kind of a
+friend to have."</p>
+
+<p>"Avast, Larry, with your compliments. Wouldn't you do the same fer
+me?"</p>
+
+<p>"Indeed I would!"</p>
+
+<p>"Then it ain't worth talkin' about. Jest the same, I hope we run into
+them rascals some day; don't you?"</p>
+
+<p>"I do. But more than likely they'll give the <i>Columbia</i> and us a
+wide berth after this," returned Larry.</p>
+
+<h3 class="p4"><a name="20">CHAPTER XX</a></h3>
+
+<h4>LARRY BEFORE ADMIRAL TOGO</h4>
+
+<p class="p2">As soon as the <i>Columbia</i> could make the proper
+landing, Captain Ponsberry went ashore and reported his arrival to the
+authorities, and also reported the escape of Shamhaven and Peterson. The
+authorities had already heard of the capture of the <i>Columbia</i> from
+the Russians, and said that the schooner would have to remain at
+Nagasaki until the whole case could be adjusted. The Japanese were
+inclined to favor both the Richmond Importing Company and the owners of
+the vessel, so it was not likely that our friends would lose much in the
+end. In the meantime the <i>Columbia</i> could be put in a dry-dock and
+given the overhauling that she needed.</p>
+
+<p>"We shall do all we can to locate Shamhaven and Peterson and get back
+your money," said an official of the secret service department. But his
+hands were so full with other matters of greater importance that little
+attention was paid to the disappearance of the two rascals.</p>
+
+<p>"Well, this will tie me up at Nagasaki for some time to come," said
+Captain Ponsberry to Larry, on the third day after arriving at the
+Japanese port.</p>
+
+<p>"Which means, I suppose, that I can join the Japanese navy if I
+wish," returned the young second mate, quickly.</p>
+
+<p>"I don't want to force you to leave the ship, lad. But you
+said&mdash;&mdash;"</p>
+
+<p>"I know, Captain Ponsberry, and I am glad of the chance to get away.
+Luke and I have talked it over once more, and yesterday we met a gunner
+named Steve Colton&mdash;he served on the <i>Brooklyn</i> at the time
+Walter did. He is now a gun captain on board of Admiral Togo's flagship,
+and he is almost certain he can get us good positions. He says gunners
+and gunners' assistants are just now badly needed."</p>
+
+<p>"Then go by all means, Larry, and make even a bigger record for
+yourself than your brother Ben is making in the army. Perhaps, when this
+war is over, you'll come back to the old <i>Columbia</i>, eh?"</p>
+
+<p>"More than likely, and I guess Luke Striker will come, too."</p>
+
+<p>What Larry had said about meeting Steve Colton was true. As readers
+of a story of mine entitled "Fighting in Cuban Waters" know, Colton had
+been a gun captain under Commodore Schley, and as such had become fairly
+well acquainted with Walter Russell and had also heard of Larry, who was
+at that time serving under Admiral Dewey at Manila.</p>
+
+<p>A detail from Admiral Togo's flagship had been sent ashore at
+Nagasaki, and Larry and Luke, as they walked through the streets, had
+met several of these men. Hearing two of them speaking English they had
+halted the pair; and introductions had followed.</p>
+
+<p>"So you are Larry Russell," said Steve Colton. "Any relation to
+Walter Russell that once served on the U. S. Cruiser <i>Brooklyn</i>?"</p>
+
+<p>"Walter is my brother," replied Larry, quickly.</p>
+
+<p>"Oh, so you are the chap that was cast away in the Pacific and picked
+up by Admiral Dewey's flagship, eh?"</p>
+
+<p>"The same, and this is the friend who was with me, Luke Striker."</p>
+
+<p>"Glad to know ye both." Steve Colton shook hands. "This is my friend,
+Bob Stanford&mdash;he hails from San Francisco and is a gunner's mate
+with me. What are you doing in this corner of the earth?"</p>
+
+<p>A long talk followed, in which Larry and Luke told their story, and
+Steve Colton and his friend related how they had come to join the
+Japanese navy.</p>
+
+<p>"It's this way," said Colton. "I've got the fighting blood in my
+veins and it won't come out. As soon as this war broke out, I cut sticks
+from 'Frisco with Bob and we comes to Tokio. There I met another
+American who was in the navy here, and it wasn't two days before we were
+booked for Admiral Togo's flagship. We've been down to Port Arthur
+twice, and I reckon we'll go again before long."</p>
+
+<p>"Perhaps we'll go up to Vladivostok next time," came from Bob
+Stanford. "I've heard something of bombarding that Russian port."</p>
+
+<p>Colton and Stanford had a couple of hours to themselves and Larry and
+Luke invited them over to the <i>Columbia</i>. In return they were asked
+to come over to Admiral Togo's flagship, the gunners having the
+privilege of bringing their friends aboard during the brief stay in
+Nagasaki harbor.</p>
+
+<p>"You can come aboard to-morrow," said Steve Colton. "They have an
+inspection and drill, and you can see how they do it in the Japanese
+navy&mdash;not but what it's a good bit like it's done on Uncle Sam's
+warships."</p>
+
+<p>Larry and Luke were very willing to go aboard of the Japanese
+warship, and were taken out by Colton the next day, and introduced to
+several gunners and others who could speak a little English. They were
+also taken before the head gunner, who took them to the commander of the
+warship.</p>
+
+<p>"They both served under Admiral Dewey at Manila," said the head
+gunner, and this made the commander smile quietly as he shook hands and
+told them to make themselves at home.</p>
+
+<p>"Everything is as clean as a whistle," was Larry's comment, as they
+walked around the forward part of the warship and through the gun decks.
+"The Japs certainly know how to take care of things. Luke, just look at
+how the brasswork shines!"</p>
+
+<p>"That's the way it ought to be," was the Yankee tar's reply. "No
+slackness, an' I'm glad on it. I love a clean ship above all
+things."</p>
+
+<p>Steve Colton and Bob Stanford were enthusiastic over the gun they
+commanded and explained how it worked. It was certainly an effective
+weapon and Larry and Luke were thoroughly interested.</p>
+
+<p>"I could handle sech a gun myself," said Luke. "An' do some damage,
+too; eh, Larry?"</p>
+
+<p>"Anyway, I'd like to try it," returned the youth.</p>
+
+<p>Orders were now being issued for the inspection and drill, and
+presently nearly all on board of the flagship hurried to the main deck.
+Here the marines were drawn up in long lines, with the officers in their
+proper places. The sailors and gunners were also at hand, each togged
+out in his best, for inspection by an admiral on any warship means a
+great deal.</p>
+
+<p>Presently Admiral Togo appeared, followed by several other naval
+officers of lesser rank. He was in full dress, with many decorations on
+his breast, and carried his sword. He proved to be a man well along in
+years, with a round face, and small mustache and goatee.</p>
+
+<p>"He looks like a fighter!" whispered Larry.</p>
+
+<p>"True for you, lad," returned Luke. "An' I reckon he knows how to
+handle men."</p>
+
+<p>What our friends said about Admiral Togo was true. He was a fighter
+and a born leader of men. When the Naval Academy of Japan was
+inaugurated he was one of the first graduates, and he was sent by the
+government to complete his nautical education in England, where, during
+1873 and 1874, he served on the training ship <i>Worcester</i>, making a
+record for himself as a first-class pupil in every respect.</p>
+
+<p>On returning home Togo Heihachiro&mdash;to use his full
+name&mdash;found a great task confronting his people. They were becoming
+civilized as we term civilization and needed a modern navy. He set to
+work with vim and vigor, and then and there laid the foundation of that
+navy which is to-day known as one of the most effective in the world.</p>
+
+<p>The navy had scarcely come into existence when there came rumors of
+war with China. The rumors grew, and China became more and more hateful
+toward the Japanese. To the outside world it looked as if China, with
+her vast territory and her immense number of people, would swallow up
+the sons of Nippon bodily.</p>
+
+<p>At last it was discovered that China was transporting troops with
+which to begin the war. Togo waited for no instructions from his home
+government. He went at the Chinese with vigor. The war followed, and
+after a number of thrilling contests the Japanese were victorious, and
+Admiral Togo emerged from the struggle covered with glory.</p>
+
+<p>"He is the man to lead us to victory against the Russians!" was the
+cry throughout the navy, when war was declared between Russia and Japan,
+and how he sent his ships to Port Arthur and other places, and what
+effective work was done by them, has already been related. In the whole
+of the Japanese navy, to serve on the admiral's flagship, the
+<i>Mikasa</i>, was considered a great honor.</p>
+
+<p>The inspection and drill were exceedingly interesting to Larry and
+Luke, and they watched both with close attention. After it was over
+Admiral Togo addressed the men briefly and then turned to the commander
+of the ship.</p>
+
+<p>"See, he is pointing to us!" whispered Luke. "Hang me if I don't
+think he is talking about us to the captain!"</p>
+
+<p>"An officer is coming," replied Larry, and a moment later one of the
+admiral's staff came hurrying to them.</p>
+
+<p>"Are you the two Americans who served under Admiral Dewey at Manila?"
+questioned the staff officer.</p>
+
+<p>"We are," answered Larry.</p>
+
+<p>"Admiral Togo wishes you to come to him."</p>
+
+<p>"Oh, Luke, we are going to be presented to the admiral!" cried
+Larry.</p>
+
+<p>"Great pewter!" groaned the Yankee tar. "I didn't expect this nohow.
+But I don't care," he added, bracing up. "He ain't no bigger nor Dewey.
+Come along."</p>
+
+<p>He followed the staff officer and Larry did the same. They felt that
+the eyes of many of the sailors and marines were on them, and stepped
+out as firmly as possible. Coming up to the admiral, they took off their
+caps and saluted.</p>
+
+<p>Admiral Togo surveyed the two Americans with interest. He had heard
+how they had come to serve under Dewey at Manila and he smiled
+pleasantly as he held out his hand, first to Larry and then to Luke.</p>
+
+<p>"Let me give you a welcome, my men," said he. "I have been told your
+story. I hope this visit to my ship has interested you."</p>
+
+<p>"Very much, sir," answered Luke.</p>
+
+<p>"I liked the drill, sir," answered Larry, with a smile. "It was fine.
+And everything is so clean! Really, I don't think it could be
+cleaner!"</p>
+
+<p>At this Admiral Togo smiled again. "That is a compliment,&mdash;since
+it comes from one who has served in the American navy."</p>
+
+<p>He then asked them to remain where they were, while some of the men
+went through an exercise with their cutlasses. There was also a gun
+drill, and they were asked to show how they had handled a gun during the
+battle of Manila Bay.</p>
+
+<p>"You are well drilled, I can see that," said the admiral, on
+dismissing them. "They tell me you think of entering our navy. If you
+wish to do so I think likely we can find suitable openings for you."</p>
+
+<h3 class="p4"><a name="21">CHAPTER XXI</a></h3>
+
+<h4>LETTERS OF INTEREST</h4>
+
+<p class="p2">The enlistment of Larry and Luke Striker into the Japanese
+navy came sooner than anticipated. A new warship was being <ins
+title="Transcriber's Note: Original reads 'fittted'">fitted</ins> out at
+a harbor some forty miles from Nagasaki, and Steve Colton and Bob
+Stanford were transferred to this. Two new gun crews were badly needed
+on the new ship, and inside of forty-eight hours our friends had signed
+the muster roll and were put into training, under Colton. The positions
+occupied were those of gunner and gunner's mate.</p>
+
+<p>"Hurrah for Nippon!" cried Larry, enthusiastically. "Luke, after this
+we have got to learn to yell <i>Banzai!</i> in true Japanese style."</p>
+
+<p>"This gun is a beauty," replied the Yankee tar, as he looked the
+piece over. "I reckon as I can make her do considerable damage if I get
+the chance."</p>
+
+<p>"And I'll help all I can," said Larry. "Won't Ben and Gilbert be
+surprised when they hear of this?" he added.</p>
+
+<p>"They might know you'd do something of the sort."</p>
+
+<p>"That's so, too. By the way, I'm going up to the post-office to-day
+and see if there are any letters."</p>
+
+<p>Much to the satisfaction of our friends they found over a score of
+men on the warship who could speak English. Some, of course, could speak
+but little, yet they could make themselves understood. On the other
+hand, both Larry and Luke began to pick up the Japanese language
+remarkably fast.</p>
+
+<p>"If we keep at this for six months we'll be regular Japanese," said
+the youth. "It's not so hard as I thought it would be."</p>
+
+<p>They found the discipline on the warship very strict and were called
+on to "toe the mark" continually. Yet all the officers were as
+considerate as they were firm, so there was little of hardship.</p>
+
+<p>When Larry called at the post-office for letters he found two
+good-sized epistles awaiting him. One was from his brother Walter, and
+ran, in part, as follows:</p>
+
+<p class="blockquot">"There is nothing particularly new in this part of
+the globe. I am doing very well in my new business and it looks now as
+if I should make a big thing of it. I rather think I am more cut out for
+work on land than for life on shipboard, although I don't regret the
+time I spent in the navy.</p>
+
+<p class="blockquot">"Uncle Job is feeling very well these days and is
+building a new wing to the old house&mdash;going to put in a library of
+good books he tells me. He is as dear an old chap now as anybody would
+want for an uncle.</p>
+
+<p class="blockquot">"I suppose you will hear from Ben and Gilbert. I am
+expecting a letter every day. It's queer you didn't go with them, but I
+suppose the old <i>Columbia</i> with her crew suits you better."</p>
+
+<p>"I am glad everything is all right at home," thought Larry, as he
+finished reading the communication. "A new wing to the house, eh? Uncle
+Job must be spreading himself. Reckon he has found out there is
+something more to live for in this world than mere money."</p>
+
+<p>The second letter was from Ben, as he could tell by the handwriting.
+It had been on the way a long time and had been sent to half a dozen
+places, including Manila. There was a great deal about life in the
+Japanese army, and also a full description of the capture of Liao-Yang.
+Ben then continued:</p>
+
+<p class="blockquot">"We are now on guard a few miles outside of the
+city. Our camp stretches for many miles, and we are doing all in our
+power to strengthen our position. What the next move will be there is no
+telling. One report is, that our particular command will help to chase
+the Russians to Mukden, while another report has it that we are to march
+southward, to aid in the attempt to take Port Arthur.</p>
+
+<p class="blockquot">"I have already told you what trouble Gilbert had
+with that rascally Russian merchant, Ivan Snokoff, and with Snokoff's
+confederate, Captain Barusky, of the Russian army. Well, at Liao-Yang we
+found Snokoff disguised as a Chinaman, and Gilbert made the fellow pay
+over all that was coming to him for the Richmond Importing Company. In
+the attempt to capture Snokoff, Gilbert shot him in the leg. It was only
+a slight wound, but the Russian was as mad as a hornet, and he vowed he
+would get square some time. He is now in the hospital here, but they
+expect to let him leave in a few days. He really ought to be put under
+arrest, but as he has paid up the money he owed, there doesn't seem to
+be any way of holding him. It's out of the question to go to court with
+the case. I helped Gilbert to put Snokoff under guard, and he is as
+angry at me as he is at Gilbert. I don't know if he will dare to do
+anything or not, but both of us are keeping our eyes open."</p>
+
+<p>Larry read this letter twice before he stowed it away. He was always
+interested in war news and he thought the description of the great
+battle of Liao-Yang very realistic. He shook his curly head when he
+thought of Ivan Snokoff.</p>
+
+<p>"He must be an underhanded rascal if ever there was one," he mused.
+"And to think he disguised himself as a Chinaman! I'll wager Gilbert
+thought it a fine thing to expose him and make him pay up. But he and
+Ben had better look out, or Snokoff and that Captain Barusky may cause
+them a lot of trouble."</p>
+
+<p>Larry had an hour to himself, and he spent the time in answering both
+letters, telling briefly what had happened to him since the trip to
+Manila and how he and Luke were now in service on board of the Japanese
+warship <i>Shohirika</i>. He added that he liked the position of
+gunner's mate very much, and that he meant to make a record for himself
+if given the opportunity to do so. He also told about the doings of
+Shamhaven and Peterson, and said he hoped to bring them to justice,
+although he realized that looking for them was as bad as "looking for a
+pearl on the ocean bottom."</p>
+
+<p>The letters finished, he addressed and posted them, and then he and
+Luke took a short stroll through Nagasaki, past the many curious shops,
+and the fine residences. Some of the shop windows displayed flaring war
+pictures, done in glaring colors,&mdash;all telling of tremendous
+Japanese victories on land and sea.</p>
+
+<p>"They certainly believe in tooting their own horn," said Larry, with
+a laugh over one of the pictures. "Just see this one, Luke&mdash;one
+Japanese officer mowing down three Russians with his sword!"</p>
+
+<p>"They ain't no worse nor we had at home during the Spanish war, lad.
+I know one picture I see o' a Rough Rider riding down half a dozen
+Spanish soldiers. An' the truth o' the matter is, them Rough Riders
+didn't have no horses at all but fought on foot!"</p>
+
+<p>"You're right, Luke. We'll have to put all such pictures down as
+freaks of the artist's imagination. But I guess I know why some of them
+are put out&mdash;to draw the young fellows into the army and navy."</p>
+
+<p>"Right ye are. Some fellers seeing a picture like that want to march
+to glory right off,&mdash;an' so they go an' enlist. When it comes to
+hardtack an' black coffee&mdash;&mdash;"</p>
+
+<p>"Hold on, Luke. Remember you are in Japan. Here it is rice and
+tea."</p>
+
+<p>"So it is, Larry. Say, but I had to laugh yesterday, when I see some
+of them jackies on board o' our ship gettin' out their teapots with
+tea."</p>
+
+<p>"It did look funny. But they do the same thing in the army, so I have
+been told. They can make the Japanese soldier and sailor do everything
+as we do it but give up his tea."</p>
+
+<p>"Well, I reckon tea is better nor rum."</p>
+
+<p>"Certainly it is,&mdash;and if I were an officer I'd let them have
+all the tea they wanted&mdash;if they would fight any better for
+it."</p>
+
+<p>"Those Russian sailors and soldiers drink an awful lot of
+<i>vodka</i>. I should think they would try to stop that. A half-drunken
+sailor or soldier isn't of any account."</p>
+
+<p>"They are so used to having it, I've been told, that to stop it would
+bring on a regular mutiny. It's hard to break off using a thing when you
+are used to it."</p>
+
+<p>"Right ye are, lad; a habit if it ain't proper is something
+awful."</p>
+
+<p>All was bustle throughout Nagasaki, for several regiments of soldiers
+had come in, bound for some transports which were to take them to
+Manchuria. Banners were flying everywhere, and from a distance came the
+music of a band.</p>
+
+<p>"Wonder how soon we will leave," said Larry, when he and his old
+friend were returning to the warship. "Now that we have enlisted, I'd
+like to see some fighting."</p>
+
+<p>"Maybe we'll get more fighting than we want, lad. But I'd like to get
+into it myself," continued the Yankee gunner, with a grin.</p>
+
+<p>Two days more were spent at Nagasaki, and then, on a clear morning,
+the <i>Shohirika</i> left the harbor and steamed off in company with two
+sister ships. They were to join a squadron bound for the western coast
+of Korea, but where they were to go after that there was no telling.</p>
+
+<p>Captain Ponsberry came to see Larry and Luke off. "Take good care of
+yourselves," said the master of the <i>Columbia</i>. "An' teach them
+Russians the lesson they deserve."</p>
+
+<p>"We expect to do our duty," answered Larry.</p>
+
+<p>Life on the Japanese warship proved to be very much like life in the
+American navy. There were hours set apart for various drills and
+exercises. Each day they had to go through the movements of handling the
+gun, fighting with cutlasses, putting out a fire, and manning the small
+boats. They also had to keep their ditty bags and grass hammocks in good
+order, also their eating utensils, and each had to do his share of
+cleaning up. Twice a week the ship's surgeon examined each man, to see
+that he was perfectly healthy.</p>
+
+<p>"I like this keeping things clean," said Larry. "It is bound to make
+for good health."</p>
+
+<p>"They tell me that Japanese sailors and soldiers are among the
+healthiest in the world," answered Luke.</p>
+
+<p>In a few days the southern point of Korea was passed and the bow of
+the warship was pointed toward the eastern coast of Manchuria. They were
+now getting close to the battleground and the lookout was constantly
+watching for the appearance of the ships of the enemy.</p>
+
+<p>"We'll have a fight before very long&mdash;I can feel it in my
+bones," declared Larry. And he was right; but before telling of that
+contest, and what surprising results it led to, we shall have to tell of
+something else which occurred, to delight Larry exceedingly.</p>
+
+<h3 class="p4"><a name="22">CHAPTER XXII</a></h3>
+
+<h4>A MEETING AND A PLOT</h4>
+
+<p class="p2">"Some Japanese transports are coming up," said Larry, two
+days later. "Six of them, and they are crowded to the rails with
+soldiers."</p>
+
+<p>"I reckon we are to act as an escort to them," replied Luke. "They
+would need an escort, if they fell in with a Russian cruiser or
+two."</p>
+
+<p>The Japanese transports were bound for the coast of Manchuria, to
+land near the village of Petaka. Soon they fell in behind the
+<i>Shohirika</i>; and then those on the warship knew that they were
+going to go close to shore, if not to make an actual landing.</p>
+
+<p>A fog came up that night, which made the transports hold off. But the
+next day was as bright and clear as before, and about noon land was
+sighted to the westward. A patrol boat was sent ahead and came back
+stating that all was clear for a landing. Then the warships went closer
+and the transports followed.</p>
+
+<p>On the following day Larry found himself on shore&mdash;having been
+taken along by one of the officers of the ship to interview an English
+merchant who wished to sell some goods to the Japanese. The officer
+could speak some English, but wanted somebody along who could help him
+out in case he could not make himself clearly understood.</p>
+
+<p>The landing was at a small Chinese town which was partly in
+ashes&mdash;the Russians having tried to burn it down before leaving.
+There were a dozen shops, but all were closed and with the windows
+boarded up. Many of the Chinese had fled to the country beyond; and a
+Japanese regiment was on guard to preserve order and to keep the
+Chunchuses, (Chinese brigands) from looting the place.</p>
+
+<p>"This shows what war will do," thought Larry, as he walked along
+beside the Japanese naval officer. "I suppose some of the Chinese have
+lost all they possessed&mdash;and through no fault of their own
+either."</p>
+
+<p>The business with the English merchant was transacted quicker than
+anticipated, and, not caring to go back to his ship at once, the naval
+officer visited the camp of the Japanese regiment, taking Larry with
+him.</p>
+
+<p>"We expect another detachment here this afternoon," said one of the
+regimental commanders to the naval officer. "They are to escort a powder
+train through the mountains."</p>
+
+<p>A little while later the detachment came in on foot, looking somewhat
+tired and dusty from a long tramp through an exceedingly rough country.
+As the soldiers came to a halt in the public square of the seaport
+village, Larry uttered a cry of amazement:</p>
+
+<p>"Ben!"</p>
+
+<p>"Why, Larry, can it be you?" came in a tone of astonishment, and on
+the instant Ben Russell rushed forward and caught his brother by the
+hands. "I must be dreaming!"</p>
+
+<p>"I guess I'm dreaming myself!" said Larry, and gave his brother a
+warm hug. "This beats the Dutch! I thought you were at Liao-Yang. How
+are you and how did you get here?"</p>
+
+<p>"One question at a time, please," returned Ben, with a happy smile.
+"I'm pretty well, although I had a little dose of fever a couple of
+weeks ago. Our Japanese doctor fixed me up in double-quick time. Our
+command was ordered down here to look after a powder train. There was a
+report that either the Russians or the Chunchuses were going to try to
+capture it or blow it up. Now, how have you been, and what are you doing
+here? I thought the old <i>Columbia</i> was at Nagasaki."</p>
+
+<p>"You want to know as much as I do, Ben." There was a pause and both
+laughed merrily, they felt so happy. "I'm as sound as a fiddle. The
+<i>Columbia</i> is at Nagasaki and likely to stay there for some time.
+Allow me to introduce myself, Lawrence Russell, gunner's mate aboard of
+the Mikado's cruiser <i>Shohirika</i>. My head gunner is Luke Striker,
+Esquire."</p>
+
+<p>"Never!" burst from Ben. "Well, this certainly is news. So you and
+Luke enlisted? Have you had any fighting?"</p>
+
+<p>"Not exactly. But we have seen some rough times," answered Larry, and
+then, as soon as Ben could get away for a quiet half-hour, he related
+his story in detail, just as I have set it down in these pages.</p>
+
+<p>"You are assuredly a lucky chap, Larry, not to be in a Russian prison
+this minute," said his brother, after the young sailor had finished.</p>
+
+<p>"Perhaps I am lucky, Ben. But it wasn't much of luck to have that
+Shamhaven and Peterson walk off with my money belt."</p>
+
+<p>"That is so, but as the amount taken wasn't a fortune I shouldn't
+worry about it. I can let you have any money you need."</p>
+
+<p>"I don't need any, and, besides, Luke is acting as my banker. But now
+tell me about yourself."</p>
+
+<p>"There isn't very much to tell, outside of what I put down in that
+letter you received. As you know, Gilbert and I are both attached to
+this command of Major Okopa."</p>
+
+<p>"Where is Gilbert now?"</p>
+
+<p>"His company was to bring up the rear. They'll be here very shortly.
+Since the battle of Liao-Yang we have been on special duty, looking
+after the pack and powder trains, and have seen very little of fighting.
+We are reinforcing our lines daily, and I think the Russians must be
+doing the same. I expect some more heavy fighting soon, unless winter
+steps in and puts a stop to everything. The nights are already rather
+cool," added Ben.</p>
+
+<p>It was half an hour later that the company under Gilbert came in,
+having in their custody two Chinese bandits that had tried to steal four
+horses belonging to two Japanese army carts.</p>
+
+<p>"So it's really you, Larry!" cried the young Southerner, as he shook
+hands. "I'm mightily glad to see you and see you looking so well. I
+suppose Ben has told you all the news."</p>
+
+<p>"Yes, and Larry has been telling some too," put in Ben. "He has seen
+almost as much of the Russians as we have." And then Larry's story had
+to be told again.</p>
+
+<p>"I don't know where we shall go after we leave here," said the young
+sailor. "Are you going back to Liao-Yang?"</p>
+
+<p>"We don't know that either. Our orders are to escort the powder train
+wherever it may be sent," said Ben.</p>
+
+<p>For two days the Japanese warship remained in the harbor of the
+seaport village and during that time Larry managed to see quite a good
+deal of Ben and Gilbert. He wished he could take them on board of the
+cruiser, but this was not permitted.</p>
+
+<p>On the third day the <i>Shohirika</i> received orders from a dispatch
+boat which steamed into the harbor, and an hour later the anchors were
+hove apeak and she steamed away, carrying Larry and his old Yankee
+friend along. Ben and Gilbert stood on a dock watching her departure.
+They waved their handkerchiefs at Larry and he waved his own in
+return.</p>
+
+<p>"I wonder when I'll see Larry again," mused Ben. He felt rather sober
+at the parting from his younger brother.</p>
+
+<p>"Oh, you'll see him again before long," answered Gilbert, trying to
+be cheerful.</p>
+
+<p>"Maybe not. It all depends upon where that cruiser sails to. She may
+go half around the world."</p>
+
+<p>"More than likely she has been sent to take part in the bombardment
+of Port Arthur."</p>
+
+<p>"Do you really think we'll be sent to Port Arthur, Gilbert?"</p>
+
+<p>"It is not unlikely, Ben."</p>
+
+<p>The pair watched the cruiser fade away in the distance, and then
+returned to that part of the village in which Major Okopa's command had
+been located.</p>
+
+<p>"By the way," said Gilbert, as they hurried along. "There is one
+thing I forgot to tell you. Meeting Larry drove it completely out of my
+mind. On the way to this village we stopped at a place called Wikelipe,
+and there I met, whom do you suppose?"</p>
+
+<p>"I don't know, I'm sure."</p>
+
+<p>"That rascal Ivan Snokoff. He was at his same old
+tricks&mdash;selling things to the inhabitants at exorbitant prices.
+When he saw me he shook his fist at me and my men and then ran away and
+hid."</p>
+
+<p>"Why didn't you root him out, Gilbert?"</p>
+
+<p>"What good would it have done? Besides, I didn't have time. The fight
+with the brigands made us lose three hours. But do you know, I think
+Snokoff has it in for me."</p>
+
+<p>"Yes, and in for me, too," added Ben. "He hasn't forgotten how I
+brought along the guard that placed him under temporary arrest."</p>
+
+<p>There was no time to say more, for the command was to move in half an
+hour and both of the young captains had to round up their men for that
+purpose. The powder train was at rest outside of the village and the men
+were scattered here, there, and everywhere.</p>
+
+<p>Evening found the command to which Ben and Gilbert belonged ten miles
+on their way through the mountains. Only the officer in charge of the
+powder train knew the destination of the precious stores. The train
+consisted of eighteen carts, each pulled by four horses.</p>
+
+<p>Although none in Major Okopa's command knew it, the train was
+followed by a Chinaman named Kee Lung, who lived in Wikelipe, the place
+where Gilbert had seen Ivan Snokoff. Kee Lung was well known to Ivan
+Snokoff and had been asked by the rascally Russian to keep his eyes on
+Gilbert and on Ben and to report their movements. He had watched
+Gilbert's meeting with Ben and Larry and heard something of what was
+said and had thus managed to make out that two of the party were
+brothers.</p>
+
+<p>As the powder train approached Wikelipe, Kee Lung went ahead to find
+Ivan Snokoff. This was not difficult, as he knew exactly where the
+latter was hiding. A conference lasting an hour ensued.</p>
+
+<p>"Do as you have promised and you shall have fifty <i>yen</i>," said
+Ivan Snokoff.</p>
+
+<p>"You will not fail to pay?" queried Kee Lung.</p>
+
+<p>"By the heads of my ancestors I promise it," was the rascally
+Russian's answer.</p>
+
+<p>"'Tis enough. I shall do as I have promised," returned the Chinaman.
+And he bowed himself from Ivan Snokoff's presence. Left to himself, the
+rascally Russian rubbed his hands gleefully.</p>
+
+<p>"Ha, I trust he is successful!" he muttered to himself. "Once
+Pennington and Russell are in the power of us Russians I shall show them
+what it means to insult and degrade a Snokoff!"</p>
+
+<h3 class="p4"><a name="23">CHAPTER XXIII</a></h3>
+
+<h4>THE ATTACK IN THE DARK</h4>
+
+<p class="p2">Two days later Gilbert and Ben were seated in their tent
+talking about the meeting with Larry when one of the guards came in and
+saluted.</p>
+
+<p>"A messenger to see Captain Russell and Captain Pennington," said the
+guard.</p>
+
+<p>"Show him in," returned Ben, briefly, thinking it was a simple
+message about camp duties. He was rather surprised when a Chinaman
+entered, bowing low as he did so.</p>
+
+<p>"Dis Clabtain Lussell?" asked the newcomer.</p>
+
+<p>"That is my name."</p>
+
+<p>"Dis Clabtain Plennington?"</p>
+
+<p>"Yes," answered Gilbert.</p>
+
+<p>"Sailor man send Chung Wow," went on the Chinaman. "Sailor man want
+see bloth." He pointed to the two young captains. "Sailor man say he
+blother you." And now he pointed at Ben alone.</p>
+
+<p>"Said he was my brother?" cried the young captain.</p>
+
+<p>The messenger nodded. "Name allee same Larry Lussell."</p>
+
+<p>"Gracious me!" ejaculated Ben. "Gilbert, what can this mean? I
+thought Larry sailed away on that warship."</p>
+
+<p>"So did I. But she may be back in port."</p>
+
+<p>"Sailor man hurt." The Chinaman pointed to his side. "Sick&mdash;he
+shot&mdash;say you clome to-night."</p>
+
+<p>"Sick? shot?" repeated Ben, and a cold chill went down his backbone.
+"That is the worst yet. Where is he?"</p>
+
+<p>"Big walk down by the sea. Chung Wow show. But must pay&mdash;Chung
+Wow poor people."</p>
+
+<p>"Oh, I'll pay you," answered Ben, hurriedly. "Gilbert, do you think I
+can get away?"</p>
+
+<p>"Sailor man say bloth clome," put in the messenger.</p>
+
+<p>"Something is wrong, that is certain," came from Gilbert. He eyed the
+Chinaman closely. "There is no mistake about this?"</p>
+
+<p>At this Chung Wow shrugged his lean shoulders and looked blank.</p>
+
+<p>"No see mistakee. See sailor mans."</p>
+
+<p>"I guess he is all right," put in Ben. "Something has happened to
+poor Larry. I wonder if I can get away at once?"</p>
+
+<p>"Let us see the major about this."</p>
+
+<p>Ben hurried off and caught Major Okopa in his own tent. As the
+command was not to move until noon of the next day both readily obtained
+permission to absent themselves until that time.</p>
+
+<p>"But be careful," said the major. "This may be some Chinese
+trick."</p>
+
+<p>"We'll be on our guard," answered Ben.</p>
+
+<p>The Chinese messenger had come in on foot. He said he was hungry and
+was given something to eat. Then the three set off, the messenger
+carrying a knapsack filled with rations, and each of the young captains
+carrying his sword and his pistol. They tried to learn from Chung Wow
+how far they would have to travel, but the Chinaman either could not or
+would not inform them.</p>
+
+<p>"Perhaps it might have been as well to have taken a detachment of one
+company along," suggested Gilbert. "I must say, I don't like the looks
+of this." They were now a good mile away from camp, and in a location
+that appeared lonely enough.</p>
+
+<p>"Well, we are moving down to the seacoast," returned Ben. He was
+taking careful note of the direction they were pursuing.</p>
+
+<p>After that they journeyed along for a good two hours without saying
+much. They stepped along briskly, for Ben wanted to learn just what had
+happened to his brother. For all he knew to the contrary, Larry might be
+mortally wounded.</p>
+
+<p>Presently they came to a spot in the road where there were a number
+of dense trees. Chung Wow began to cough loudly.</p>
+
+<p>"What's the matter?" demanded Gilbert. For some reason he did not
+trust the Chinaman.</p>
+
+<p>"Slomthing fly in float," was the answer, and Chung Wow coughed
+again. Then he walked on, and they came behind him. But Gilbert drew his
+pistol and motioned for Ben to do the same.</p>
+
+<p>"I may be mistaken, but we may be walking into a trap," he
+whispered.</p>
+
+<p>"Why, Gilbert, I don't&mdash;&mdash;" began Ben, when without warning
+a heavy object dropped upon his head from the limb of one of the trees
+and bore him to the ground. Another object dropped on Gilbert, but he
+squirmed from under,&mdash;to find himself confronted by several
+Chunchuses. A cry went up, and a crashing was heard in the bushes back
+of the trees.</p>
+
+<p>"A trick, Ben, just as I suspected!" ejaculated the young Southerner,
+and he discharged his pistol point-blank at the Chinese bandit in front
+of him. This done he made a leap to one side, hurling over Chung Wow as
+he did so, and darted forward into some bushes. A shot was aimed at him,
+but did no injury, and he kept on, running as hard as he could.</p>
+
+<p>In the meantime Ben did his best to get up. But one man was on his
+shoulders and another had him by the legs, so to move was next to
+impossible. Then, as he continued to struggle, he received a heavy kick
+from a wooden shoe which stretched him out like a log.</p>
+
+<p>"He is out of the fight now," said one of the Chunchuses, as he bent
+over Ben. "Go after the other. Do not let him escape if you can help it.
+Americans are worth a good deal to us in these days!"</p>
+
+<p>Three of the brigands remained to guard Ben and the others made after
+Gilbert. But they could not catch the young Southerner, and after a long
+chase they came back.</p>
+
+<p>"He has gone back to his camp," said one of the Chunchuses to his
+chief. "He will have his friends about our ears very shortly."</p>
+
+<p>As soon as this news was received, Ben's hands and feet were bound,
+and four of the Chinamen caught him up as if he were a dead animal and
+hoisted him on their shoulders. Off they set at a dog-trot, with the
+remaining brigands around them.</p>
+
+<p>It was the jogging over the rough mountainous road which finally
+brought the young captain to his senses. At first he did not realize
+that he was on the move.</p>
+
+<p>"Gilbert!" he called faintly. "Gilbert!"</p>
+
+<p>Nobody answered him, and now he essayed to sit up. He could not budge
+and consequently began to struggle.</p>
+
+<p>"Be still!" cried one of the Chunchuses, in Chinese.</p>
+
+<p>"Where am I? What are you doing to me?" queried Ben.</p>
+
+<p>For answer he received a good shaking and was then dumped on the
+ground. His feet were liberated, and the chief of the Chinese brigands
+ordered him to move along, pointing the end of his sword at the prisoner
+as he did so.</p>
+
+<p>"Where is my friend?" asked Ben.</p>
+
+<p>"He is dead," said the chief, laconically.</p>
+
+<p>"Dead!" burst out the young captain. His heart seemed to become like
+a lump of lead. Gilbert, his own true chum, dead! It was too horrible to
+believe.</p>
+
+<p>"Yes, and you will be unless you walk on," added the chief of the
+Chunchuses.</p>
+
+<p>There was no help for it, and, bruised and bleeding, the young
+captain took up the march, with his enemies on all sides of him. The
+gait was a rapid one, and before they came to a halt once more he was
+all but exhausted.</p>
+
+<p>"Where are you taking me?" he asked.</p>
+
+<p>"Wait and see." The chief of the Chunchuses grinned wickedly. "I
+shall have to trouble you for your valuables," he went on, in his native
+tongue, and without further ado stripped Ben of his possessions,
+including his watch, money, ring, and sword.</p>
+
+<p>There was no use protesting, and therefore the young captain did not
+attempt it. He was marched along a marshy path, and presently came in
+sight of the ocean and a small bay, where two sailing ships and a small
+steamer lay at anchor.</p>
+
+<p>A shrill whistle sounded out, and this was answered by somebody on
+the steamer. Then a small boat put in to shore, carrying four sailors
+and an officer. As soon as the officer landed, he was called aside by
+the chief of the Chunchuses, and a conference lasting several minutes
+followed.</p>
+
+<p>"It shall be as you say, Ching Fee," said the officer, in Russian.
+"It is too bad you did not get the other, too. I know Ivan Snokoff, and
+Captain Barusky too, and there will be money in this. Yes, I'll take him
+on board at once. You had better watch out that the soldiers do not get
+after you."</p>
+
+<p>"Trust Ching Fee to take care of himself," said the chief of the
+Chunchuses.</p>
+
+<p>With scant ceremony Ben was conducted to the small boat and told to
+get in. He asked where they were going to take him, but could get no
+satisfaction. As soon as the steamer was reached, he was conducted to an
+empty stateroom and locked in.</p>
+
+<p>"This is the worst yet!" he muttered, as he sat down. "I suppose they
+intend to carry me miles and miles away. Poor Gilbert! I never thought
+he would be killed in such a fashion as this! What cutthroats these
+Chinese brigands are! It's a wonder they didn't kill me too! Can that
+story about Larry be true?"</p>
+
+<p>There was a little water in the stateroom, and as his hands had been
+released, Ben bathed his wounds and bound them up as best he could. He
+heard the steamer move away from the shore, and soon the steady pounding
+of the engines proved that she was forging ahead at her best rate of
+speed.</p>
+
+<p>He was a prisoner of the enemy, and what they were going to do with
+him was a question still to be answered.</p>
+
+<h3 class="p4"><a name="24">CHAPTER XXIV</a></h3>
+
+<h4>THE DEFENSE OF THE POWDER TRAIN</h4>
+
+<p class="p2">After firing on the Chinese brigands as already described,
+Gilbert plunged into the brushwood which was not over half a dozen yards
+distant. He heard the shots discharged at him in return, but fortunately
+every one went wide of its mark.</p>
+
+<p>Once in the brushwood he did not stop, but continued on his way for
+several rods. Then he paused, wondering if Ben was anywhere in the
+vicinity.</p>
+
+<p>"I hope they didn't kill him," he murmured. "What a trap that was,
+and how easily we walked into it!"</p>
+
+<p>He waited and listened, but nobody came near him. Then, with caution,
+he pushed ahead, until he gained once more the road leading back to the
+temporary camp occupied by the powder train and the detachment guarding
+it. Following this, he ran on at full speed until the welcome camp-fires
+greeted him.</p>
+
+<p>"Major Okopa, we have been attacked by Chunchuses!" he exclaimed, as
+he rushed up to the officer's quarters. And in a brief manner he
+explained the situation so far as he knew it.</p>
+
+<p>The Japanese major had taken a strong liking to Gilbert and Ben, and
+he lost no time in ordering out a company to round up the Chinese
+brigands if they could be located. It was Gilbert's own command and he
+was given permission to remain out the whole night and the next day if
+necessary.</p>
+
+<p>The young Southerner went at the task with vigor, for he realized
+that every moment was precious. He explained the situation to his men,
+and they set off at double-quick to where the attack had been made.</p>
+
+<p>As was to be expected, the spot was deserted. By torchlight they saw
+the evidences of the struggle which had taken place. In one spot was a
+pool of blood, left by the brigand whom Gilbert had shot in the
+shoulder.</p>
+
+<p>"They went off in this direction," said one of the soldiers, who was
+good at tracing footsteps. He pointed to a side road, and along this
+they ran, keeping eyes and ears on the alert, so as to avoid anything in
+the nature of a surprise.</p>
+
+<p>Two hours later the company found itself on the seashore. But
+Chunchuses and vessels were gone and to where it was impossible to find
+out. But on the beach Gilbert picked up an empty pocketbook which he
+knew was Ben's property.</p>
+
+<p>"They brought him here most likely," he said. "See, here are the
+marks of a rowboat, and of many feet. They have gone off on the
+water."</p>
+
+<p>"Then the hunt is at a standstill," returned his second in
+command.</p>
+
+<p>The young captain was unwilling to believe this, and the remainder of
+the night, and the next forenoon, were spent in an eager search after
+the enemy. But it was useless; and at last Gilbert, sick at heart,
+ordered his men to return to the camp.</p>
+
+<p>On the following day the powder train moved onward once more. The
+first lieutenant of Ben's company took command of the body, and Ben was
+marked "missing" on the roll.</p>
+
+<p>"It is certainly too bad, and I sympathize with you, Captain
+Pennington," said Major Okopa. "Captain Russell is a fine fellow."</p>
+
+<p>"It takes all the vigor out of me," replied Gilbert. "Ben and I were
+like two brothers."</p>
+
+<p>But Gilbert was given no time in which to grieve over Ben's
+disappearance. Two days later, the powder train was attacked by a
+detachment of the Russians, who seemed to spring out of the very ground.
+One of the wagons loaded with powder was blown to atoms, killing two
+horses and three soldiers.</p>
+
+<p>"<i>Banzai!</i>" cried the Japanese, and when the order was given
+they attacked the enemy with vigor. It was a hot fight, lasting half an
+hour, and the Russians were driven among some high hills, backed up by
+several mountains.</p>
+
+<p>As the powder train had to go through one of the mountain passes so
+close at hand, the soldiers were sent ahead, to clear the way of all
+Russians that might appear. This was dangerous work, for the enemy had
+the advantage of the higher position. But the Japanese were undaunted,
+and rushed up one slope after another with a vigor and animation that
+was surprising.</p>
+
+<p>"Can't hold them back, when once they get started," said Gilbert, to
+the major. "They are like our Southern bloodhounds, when once they
+strike the scent."</p>
+
+<p>"And that is the way to win victory," answered Major Okopa.</p>
+
+<p>Not long after this Gilbert found himself at the foot of a steep hill
+with his company. At the top of the hill were a number of great bowlders
+and behind these some of the Russians were in hiding, sending down a
+spiteful fire whenever the opportunity presented itself.</p>
+
+<p>"We must dislodge those fellows," said Major Okopa. "It is very
+dangerous work. Do you think you can accomplish it, Captain
+Pennington?"</p>
+
+<p>"I can try," answered Gilbert, modestly, and ordered his company
+forward. He turned them slightly to the left, for here a fringe of thin
+brushwood offered a shelter that was not great, but much better than
+none.</p>
+
+<p>"Major Okopa expects us to take this hill," he said, in the best
+Japanese he could muster. "Let us do our best!"</p>
+
+<p>"<i>Banzai!</i>" came the rallying cry from the men, and up the slope
+they rushed, with Gilbert at their side. Crack! crack! went the rifles
+of the Russians, and then, without warning, several shells were sent up.
+One man of Gilbert's company was killed and two wounded, but they did
+not waver. Passing the brushwood, they ran out boldly on the slope above
+them.</p>
+
+<p>Many of the rocks at the top of the hill were loose, and as the
+Japanese came closer, the enemy began to send them down in a shower
+which was highly dangerous to those below.</p>
+
+<p>"Beware of the stones!" cried Gilbert.</p>
+
+<p>He had hardly spoken when he saw that he would have to look after his
+own safety. The Russians were working over a rock that weighed several
+hundreds of pounds.</p>
+
+<p>All at once the mass broke loose. There was a yell of delight from
+above, and then the big bowlder came rolling straight for Gilbert. Had
+it touched him he must surely have been crushed to death.</p>
+
+<p>But the young Southerner was as cool as he was quick. Pausing to make
+certain which way the big stone was coming down, he made a quick leap in
+the opposite direction. Then the bowlder went bounding past him, to
+crash into some small trees at the bottom of the hill.</p>
+
+<p>"Are you hurt, captain?" asked his lieutenant.</p>
+
+<p>"No," answered Gilbert. Then he leaped to the front once more.
+"Come!" he cried. "<i>Banzai!</i> Forward for the Mikado!" And on the
+whole company went as before, firing rapidly as they did so. The
+Russians clung to the hilltop a few minutes longer, and then, as the
+first of the Japanese gained a footing there, they broke and fled in
+wild disorder down the other side of the hill, and into the woods to the
+northward. The Japanese pursued them for two hours but could not catch
+them, and at last the chase was abandoned. In this skirmish, called the
+battle of Po-yang-ling, the Japanese lost in killed and wounded four
+men, and the Russians seven. Three of the Czar's soldiers were also
+taken prisoners.</p>
+
+<p>After that the powder train had no more difficulty, and four days
+later reached its destination, which was the village of Fanshen, where
+the Japanese had established something of a base of supplies for that
+portion of the army which was moving southward to join in the siege of
+Port Arthur. At Fanshen, Major Okopa's command received orders to go
+into camp instead of returning to the vicinity of Liao-Yang.</p>
+
+<p>"This looks to me as if we were to be transferred to the army in the
+south," said the major, after communicating the news to Gilbert.</p>
+
+<p>"Well, I shouldn't mind helping to take Port Arthur," returned the
+young Southerner. "If you will remember, it was my treatment by the
+Russians at that place which caused me to take up arms against
+them."</p>
+
+<p>"So you said before, Captain Pennington. But do not imagine that the
+taking of Port Arthur will be easy. The Russians have fortified it in
+every possible manner."</p>
+
+<p>"Yes,&mdash;they were doing that before I came away from there."</p>
+
+<p>"For months they have been strengthening their fortifications, and
+getting in ammunition and supplies in secret. Their chain of forts
+extend, so I have been told, for twenty miles and more outside of the
+city, and being in a mountainous country, they will be hard to
+reduce."</p>
+
+<p>"Don't you think we can capture the place?" demanded Gilbert.</p>
+
+<p>"Capture it? Most assuredly, captain. But it will mean a great
+destruction of life," returned Major Okopa, gravely.</p>
+
+<p>What the major said about the Russians fortifying Port Arthur was
+true. Lieutenant-General Stoessel, the Russian commander at that place,
+had under him sixty thousand men, the very flower of the Russian army.
+On the side of the sea the town was fortified at a dozen points, only
+three of which had been thus far captured under the Japanese army led by
+General Nogi. To the northward and the westward were some twenty
+defenses, set among the mountains where they were next to impossible to
+reach.</p>
+
+<p>In a work of this kind, it is impossible to relate in detail all of
+the many battles fought over the possession of Port Arthur. The first
+assault was made in February by Admiral Togo's fleet, and the naval
+conflict was kept up for almost three months after that. In the meantime
+a Japanese army under General Oku landed at Pitsewo, and after several
+battles at Kinchow and Nanshan Hill, drove the Russians back to their
+mountain defenses and took possession of the railroad running to
+Liao-Yang and Mukden. Thus Port Arthur was cut off from almost all
+communication with the outside world.</p>
+
+<h3 class="p4"><a name="25">CHAPTER XXV</a></h3>
+
+<h4>BOMBARDING A PORT ARTHUR FORT</h4>
+
+<p class="p2">Larry felt very happy after having met Ben and Gilbert. He
+had been afraid he should find that his brother or his friend was
+wounded, even though no mention of such an occurrence had been made in
+the letter he had received. He knew from experience that Ben was in the
+habit of making light of things that went wrong.</p>
+
+<p>"I suppose it did your heart good to meet 'em both," said Luke, after
+the warship was on the way.</p>
+
+<p>"You're right, Luke; it was a regular touch of old times."</p>
+
+<p>"Wish I had seen 'em myself."</p>
+
+<p>"Both wanted to be remembered to you." Larry paused for a moment. "By
+the way, I wonder where we are bound now?"</p>
+
+<p>"Can't say as to that, lad&mdash;secret orders, I reckon," answered
+the old tar.</p>
+
+<p>The order to sail was evidently an important one, for scarcely was
+the <i>Shohirika</i> out of sight of land than all steam was crowded on.
+The lookouts were also doubled, and when night came the strictest watch
+possible was maintained.</p>
+
+<p>Yet, with it all, several days passed without anything out of the
+ordinary happening. Drills and exercises went on as before, and both
+Larry and Luke made themselves familiar with all parts of the warship.
+Both spent much time in familiarizing themselves with such orders as
+were given to them in Japanese, so that they might not be too "green,"
+as Larry termed it, if put to the test.</p>
+
+<p>During those days spent on shipboard matters concerning the great war
+were moving forward steadily. In the vicinity of Liao-Yang both the
+Japanese and the Russians made several movements to better their
+positions. This brought on a few skirmishes and one heavy battle, in
+which the losses were several hundreds on each side. There was also an
+advance on the outer forts of Port Arthur, and a fair-sized hill was
+captured by the Mikado's men, who, however held the place only at an
+enormous loss of life. In moving on the port the Japanese found they
+would have to do a great amount of tunneling and entrenching, all of
+which consumed time.</p>
+
+<p>On the ocean the two nations were equally active. Both took several
+prizes of war, and in an encounter with the Vladivostok squadron a
+Russian warship was hopelessly disabled and a Japanese cruiser was all
+but sunk. Another ship belonging to Admiral Togo's fleet struck a mine
+outside of Port Arthur and had to be sent back to Japan for repairs.</p>
+
+<p>So far the weather had been warm, but autumn was now at hand and
+before long the nights became cold and raw.</p>
+
+<p>"This war won't be finished this winter," said more than one. "We are
+in for another year of it, sure."</p>
+
+<p>The <i>Shohirika</i> had been summoned to join the fleet patrolling
+before Port Arthur. Two days before that station was reached they fell
+in with a sister ship which brought the news of an encounter with a
+Russian battleship carrying some troops from Siberia. Both warships had
+suffered and become separated in the darkness.</p>
+
+<p>"This war is certainly warming up," said Larry. "I hope we see some
+fighting before it is over."</p>
+
+<p>"Maybe we'll see more of it than you wish," said Luke, grimly.</p>
+
+<p>"Don't you worry&mdash;we'll see a whole lot," put in Steve Colton,
+who was sitting on a ditty chest, playing checkers with Bob Stanford.
+"Just wait till we get under Admiral Togo's eye&mdash;he'll make us be
+up and doing."</p>
+
+<p>The chance to see some of the war came the next day, when they were
+ordered to bombard one of the forts to the north of Port Arthur proper.
+As soon as they came within four miles of the fort they received a
+reception which was as warm as it was exciting.</p>
+
+<p>"Now, here is where we show what we can do!" cried Luke, as the orders
+came to begin firing, and the whole gun company jumped in to assist him.
+The magazines were opened up, the windlasses set to work, and soon the
+first real shell&mdash;not a mere blank for practicing&mdash;came up and
+was run into the gun. Then the breech-block was swung to and locked, the
+electric connection set, and Luke sighted the piece with care, after
+having first received the proper distance from the range-finders in the
+tops. As soon as the "sight" was "covered" the button was pressed, and
+<i>bang!</i> went the gun with a concussion that shook the whole ship.
+Other guns followed in rapid succession, until Larry had to stuff cotton
+in his ears to keep himself from becoming deaf. As soon as the gun was
+discharged, it was opened to let the gases out and then cleaned with wet
+swabs and flushed with running water to cool the barrel.</p>
+
+<p>The bombardment lasted for an hour, and during that time the fort was
+hit in a dozen places. Sand, dirt, and rocks flew in all directions, and
+once there came a flash which told of an explosion of a quantity of
+powder.</p>
+
+<p>"If we could only hit the magazine it would be good-by to that fort,"
+said Larry, but this was not to be.</p>
+
+<p>After the first few shots the fort had remained silent, but now, when
+the <i>Shohirika</i> was about to retire, the gunners opened up once
+more, and a rain of shot and shell flew all around the warship. One
+struck the bow of the vessel, tearing off a few feet of the forward deck
+and another entered the forward turret, killing one of the gunner's
+assistants.</p>
+
+<p>"We can be thankful we weren't in that turret," said Luke, when he
+received the latter news.</p>
+
+<p>"Yes, indeed!" murmured Larry, and could not repress a shiver. "I can
+tell you, it's mighty risky work after all!" he added, soberly.</p>
+
+<p>"Well, we've got one advantage over those fellows," put in Colton,
+after the firing had come to an end, and the warship was fast getting
+out of range. "We can run away, while they have got to stay right where
+they are."</p>
+
+<p>"Oh, they can run away too," said Larry.</p>
+
+<p>"Not unless they abandon their fort,&mdash;and that would be just as
+if we should abandon our ship."</p>
+
+<p>The work at the gun had been severe, and after the bombardment was
+over Larry was glad to clean up and take a rest. The perspiration,
+grime, and smoke had made him look like a negro, and he used up several
+buckets of water before he got himself into as cleanly a condition as
+was habitual with him. Luke also took a "scrubbing down," as he called
+it, and so did the others.</p>
+
+<p>What amazed Larry more than anything was the quietness of the
+Japanese sailors. Now that the bombardment was ended they said scarcely
+a word about it, but went on exactly as before.</p>
+
+<p>"They are the most matter-of-fact chaps I ever saw!" he declared. "I
+believe if the ship blew up they would say 'Very sorry' and swim away.
+Now on one of Uncle Sam's ships the men would be all woke up and out for
+a jollification. Ben says it's the same way in the army. If they get
+excited at all they always seem to be sorry for it afterwards!"</p>
+
+<p>"That's what ye call a characteristic o' the race, I reckon,"
+returned Luke. "They're taught to act that way from babyhood. It ain't
+polite nor high-toned to git excited. The only thing they kin yell is
+<i>Banzai!</i> an' they let thet out loud enough, goodness knows!"</p>
+
+<p>"I can't understand why we didn't keep at that fort," came from
+Colton. "I was just getting the range beautifully when orders came to
+shut down."</p>
+
+<p>"Well, there must be a reason for it, Steve," answered Luke.</p>
+
+<p>There was a reason for it. Admiral Togo had just received word that
+certain ships of the Port Arthur squadron were going to make an attempt
+to break out of the harbor, either that night or the next day.
+Consequently the <i>Shohirika</i> was needed further down the coast, and
+steamed away in that direction as rapidly as her somewhat limited supply
+of coal permitted.</p>
+
+<p>"I don't think the navy will ever find its way into Port Arthur
+harbor," said Larry, later on, after studying a map of that locality.
+"There are too many forts on the hills outside of the town. They could
+smash our ships to smithereens if we got too close."</p>
+
+<p>"Trust Admiral Togo to know what he is doing," answered Steve Colton.
+"He won't go too close. At the same time he ain't going to let the
+Russian ships get away any more than Schley and Sampson let Admiral
+Cervera get away from Santiago Harbor in Cuba."</p>
+
+<p>"It's the army that will make Port Arthur a hot place to live in,"
+came from Bob Stanford. "They can entrench and thus gain a
+little ground day by day, and as soon as they win some high point, like
+say 203-Meter Hill, it will be all up with General Stoessel, mark my
+words."</p>
+
+<p>The night to follow proved to be misty, and so cold that the majority
+of the sailors were glad to don their heavy peajackets. Fearing that the
+enemy would try to take advantage of the weather, Admiral Togo turned on
+all the searchlights his fleet possessed, and these were flashed in all
+directions.</p>
+
+<p>"False alarm," said Luke, after midnight had sounded out on the
+ship's bell. "Reckon the Russians don't dare to come out."</p>
+
+<p>But the old Yankee tar was mistaken. The enemy were on the alert, and
+at three o'clock, when the mist was extra heavy, the movement to steal
+out of Port Arthur harbor was begun, two torpedo destroyers taking the
+lead, and several cruisers following. This brought on a heavy sea-fight
+lasting far into the next day, and one which came close to cost Larry
+his life.</p>
+
+<h3 class="p4"><a name="26">CHAPTER XXVI</a></h3>
+
+<h4>BEN MEETS CAPTAIN BARUSKY</h4>
+
+<p class="p2">For several days poor Ben remained a prisoner aboard of
+the small steamer. During that time only two men came near him&mdash;an
+under officer and the sailor who supplied him with food and water.
+Neither would answer his questions, so he could not learn where he was
+being taken or what was to be done with him.</p>
+
+<p>One evening there was a slight commotion on the deck, and the course
+of the steamer was changed. Then came a blowing of steam whistles
+lasting several minutes. Finally the steamer came to a standstill.</p>
+
+<p>"You are to leave this vessel at once," said the under officer, as he
+opened the door of the young captain's temporary prison. "Come, we have
+no time to spare."</p>
+
+<p>"Where am I to go?" questioned Ben.</p>
+
+<p>"You will soon learn. Hurry!"</p>
+
+<p>There was no help for it, and soon Ben was on deck. He was made to
+enter a small boat and was thus transferred to another steamer&mdash;one
+which had formerly been in the East Indian trade but which was now
+acting as a Russian supply boat.</p>
+
+<p>"What a dirty craft!" was his mental comment, after having been
+thrust into a pen which was little better than a horse stall. The supply
+boat was loaded to its fullest capacity, so quarters for all on board
+were limited.</p>
+
+<p>Two days passed and he received food which was scarcely fit to eat.
+When he protested he was <ins title="Transcriber's Note: Original reads
+'threatended'">threatened</ins> with a flogging. The air was foul and he
+began to fear that he would become sick.</p>
+
+<p>"I won't be able to stand this much longer," he thought, dismally.
+"If they want to kill me why don't they do it at once and have done with
+it?"</p>
+
+<p>On the following morning a surprise awaited him. He heard two Russian
+officers pause in front of his pen and one said to the other:</p>
+
+<p>"Here is the prisoner, Captain Barusky."</p>
+
+<p>"Is it the fellow named Russell?" was the question from Captain
+Barusky, the rascal who had aided Ivan Snokoff to make so much trouble
+for Gilbert Pennington.</p>
+
+<p>"The same."</p>
+
+<p>"They did not capture his friend?"</p>
+
+<p>"No&mdash;in the struggle he slipped away."</p>
+
+<p>"I am sorry for that. We wanted Pennington more than we did this
+fellow. But I am glad we got at least one of them. As I understand it
+they work hand-in-glove with each other;" and then the two Russian
+officers passed on.</p>
+
+<p>Like a flash Ben realized the truth of the situation. His taking off
+had been a trap set by Snokoff and this Captain Barusky, who had hired
+the Chunchuses to help work out their plot. He was now in the hands of
+the enemy in more ways than one.</p>
+
+<p>"They won't treat me as an ordinary prisoner," he reasoned. "This
+Captain Barusky will make it as hard as possible for me&mdash;more
+especially so as Gilbert managed to escape his clutches. Well, I am glad
+Gilbert got away."</p>
+
+<p>Resolved to "take the bull by the horns," Ben asked the prison guard
+if he might speak to Captain Barusky.</p>
+
+<p>"I will see about it," answered the sailor, and went off to find out.
+On his return he stated that the captain would visit the pen some time
+during the day.</p>
+
+<p>The Russian officer came late in the afternoon, when nobody else was
+near the pen. There was a sarcastic look on his face when he gazed at
+the young captain.</p>
+
+<p>"So you want to talk to me," he said, abruptly.</p>
+
+<p>"I do, Captain Barusky. I want to know why this plot was laid against
+me."</p>
+
+<p>"I know of no plot. You are an American in the employ of the Japanese
+Government as a spy. Russia captures all the Japanese spies she
+can."</p>
+
+<p>"I am no spy."</p>
+
+<p>The Russian shrugged his shoulders. "That is what your friend,
+Captain Pennington, once told me, too. Yet as soon as he got out of Port
+Arthur he was made a captain in the Mikado's army."</p>
+
+<p>"He applied for the position because the Russians had mistreated him
+and because he loves active service."</p>
+
+<p>"Have it as you please, Russell; both of you are spies, and you will
+have to suffer as one."</p>
+
+<p>"Where are you taking me?"</p>
+
+<p>"Since you seem so anxious to know, I will tell you, for I do not
+think you will be able to take the news to the Japanese. This boat is
+carrying supplies to Port Arthur."</p>
+
+<p>"Port Arthur!"</p>
+
+<p>"That is what I said. When we arrive there you will be placed in one
+of the strongest of our prisons at the port. Do you not admire the
+prospect?"</p>
+
+<p>"Well, if you take me to Port Arthur, perhaps I shan't be a prisoner
+long," replied Ben, resolved to put on as bold a front as possible.</p>
+
+<p>"And why not?" demanded Captain Barusky, curiously.</p>
+
+<p>"Because our army and our navy are bound to capture the place."</p>
+
+<p>"Bah! The Japanese will never take Port Arthur. It is absurd to think
+of it."</p>
+
+<p>"It may not come right away&mdash;but it will come sooner or
+later."</p>
+
+<p>"Never! But if it should, you will not be there to enjoy our
+downfall. Remember that spies are tried, and if found guilty they are
+taken out and shot."</p>
+
+<p>"You cannot prove that I am a spy."</p>
+
+<p>"That remains to be seen."</p>
+
+<p>"If you bring me before the court I'll have something to say about
+your underhanded work with Ivan Snokoff. I can prove that he is a
+swindler and that you are his accomplice."</p>
+
+<p>"Ha! you threaten me!" roared Captain Barusky, in a rage. "Have a
+care! I come from a most respectable family and I have great
+influence."</p>
+
+<p>"Nevertheless, I think those who are higher in authority than
+yourself will listen to my story. The Russian army officers are as a
+rule gentlemen and strictly honest."</p>
+
+<p>"Which means to say that I am not a gentleman and not honest!"
+bellowed Captain Barusky. "That, for your opinion!" And reaching out he
+gave Ben a ringing box on the ear.</p>
+
+<p>It was the last straw. With no fresh air and no food fit to eat, the
+young captain was desperate, and leaping forward he struck at the
+Russian captain's nose. His fist went true, and as Barusky staggered
+back against the pen door the blood spurted from his nasal organ.</p>
+
+<p>"Don't you dare to hit me again!" panted Ben, standing before the
+Russian with both hands clenched. "Don't you dare&mdash;or you'll get
+the worst of it!"</p>
+
+<p>His manner made Captain Barusky cower back, and he glared at Ben with
+the ferocity of a wild beast. Then he called to the guard.</p>
+
+<p>"Run for aid, Petrovitch," he said. "The prisoner has attacked me. He
+is a beast, and must be chained up."</p>
+
+<p>The man addressed summoned three other sailors and the captain of the
+ship's guard. All came into the pen and forced Ben into a corner.</p>
+
+<p>"The Yankee dog!" said the captain of the guard. "To dare to strike a
+Russian officer! Bring the chains at once!"</p>
+
+<p>Chains were brought, and soon Ben was bound hands and feet, with
+links that weighed several pounds. Then a large staple was driven into
+one of the uprights of the pen and he was fastened to this with a
+padlock.</p>
+
+<p>"Now place him on half-rations," said Captain Barusky. "It is the
+only way to tame him." And then he hurried away to bathe his nose, which
+was swelling rapidly.</p>
+
+<p>If Ben had been miserable before he was doubly so now. The chains
+were cumbersome and cut into his flesh, and being fastened to the
+upright he could scarcely move a foot either way. To add to his misery
+the front of the pen was boarded over, so that what little light had
+been admitted to his prison was cut off.</p>
+
+<p>In this wretched condition he passed a full week. In that time
+Captain Barusky came to peep in at him three times, and on each occasion
+tried to say something to make him still more dispirited. The food was
+so bad he could not eat and the air often made his head ache as if it
+would crack open.</p>
+
+<p>"If this is a sample of Russian prison life it's a wonder all the
+prisoners don't go mad," he reasoned. "A few months of this would surely
+kill me."</p>
+
+<p>At the end of the week Ben heard firing at a distance. The supply
+boat was now trying to steal into Port Arthur and had been discovered by
+a Japanese patrol boat. The craft was struck twice and the prisoner
+below heard a wild commotion on the deck, as one of the funnels was
+carried away. But darkness favored the Russians, and inside of two hours
+the supply boat passed into Port Arthur harbor without sustaining
+further damage. She was then directed to a proper anchorage by the
+harbor master; and on the following day the transfer of her cargo to the
+storehouses on shore was begun.</p>
+
+<p>For several days longer Ben was kept on the boat. Then, one wet and
+cold morning, he was liberated and told to march on deck. From the
+vessel he was taken to a big stone building which was being used as one
+of the garrison quarters. Here he was given a scant hearing in the
+presence of Captain Barusky, who appeared against him.</p>
+
+<p>"We have no time to investigate your case at present, Captain
+Russell," said the officer who conducted the examination. "But from
+reports I should surmise that you are a dangerous young man. You must
+remain a prisoner." And then the young captain was taken away. Later on,
+he was marched a distance of half a mile and blindfolded. When the
+bandage was removed from his eyes, he found himself in an old stone
+building, dirty and neglected. He was taken to a small room, having a
+grated window, and thrust inside. Six other prisoners were put into the
+apartment with him, one man with a hacking cough, dreadful to hear. The
+door was closed and barred; and all were left to take care of themselves
+as best they could.</p>
+
+<h3 class="p4"><a name="27">CHAPTER XXVII</a></h3>
+
+<h4>A FIERCE BATTLE AT SEA</h4>
+
+<p class="p2">Larry was taking a nap when the call came to clear the
+ship for action. It had been discovered that the Russian fleet was
+trying to escape from Port Arthur harbor, and the news was flashed from
+vessel to vessel of Admiral Togo's fleet, and all were ordered to
+prevent the movement at any cost.</p>
+
+<p>"Now I reckon we are in fer it!" ejaculated Luke, as he and the youth
+rushed over to their gun. "Larry, it's in my mind we have some tall work
+cut out fer us this trip!"</p>
+
+<p>"Let it come&mdash;I am in just the humor for fighting!" cried Larry.
+"I hope we can smash them just as we smashed the Spanish ships in Manila
+Bay."</p>
+
+<p>Sailors and gunners were hurrying in all directions, and orders were
+coming in rapid succession. At first the Russian ships had turned in one
+direction, now they were turning in another, and, later still, they
+separated. A distant firing could already be heard, but where it came
+from those on the <i>Shohirika</i> could not tell.</p>
+
+<p>So far no ships of the enemy could be seen with the naked eye. The
+lookouts kept a close watch, and the flashlights continued to play all
+over the bosom of the rolling sea.</p>
+
+<p>It was almost daylight when a distant explosion was heard. A Russian
+torpedo boat had run into a mine and was so badly damaged that she sank
+inside of ten minutes, carrying a large part of her crew with her.</p>
+
+<p>This disaster proved a warning to the other Russian ships and they
+proceeded on their courses with added caution. The Japanese warships
+were equally on the alert, yet, just as the sun came up, one brushed
+against a mine and received such damage that she was practically put out
+of the contest.</p>
+
+<p>"There is one of the enemy's ships!" was the cry, as the mist swept
+away as if by magic and the sun came out strongly. "Now is our chance.
+<i>Banzai!</i>"</p>
+
+<p>"And there is another ship!" came a moment later, "and one of our own
+pounding her as if she was a witch!"</p>
+
+<p>Guns were now booming over the water constantly, and from the forts
+on shore came shots and shells in rapid succession. Soon the
+<i>Shohirika</i> was in the midst of the battle, and then Luke and Larry
+worked over the gun as never before, doing their full share towards
+disabling the ship that was trying to escape up the Manchurian
+coast.</p>
+
+<p>For over an hour the running fire kept up. Neither ship dared to put
+on full speed, for fear of running into a mine. Solid shot was hurled in
+all directions, and the <i>Shohirika</i> received one below the water
+line which for the moment looked as if it might sink the craft. But the
+ship's carpenter and his crew got at the leak immediately, driving in a
+wedge which quickly stopped the flow of water.</p>
+
+<p>It was hard, exhausting work between decks, and at the end of an hour
+Larry felt he must have some fresh air. Both he and Luke applied for
+permission to go on deck, and this permission was readily granted, for
+the guns on their side of the warship were not then in use.</p>
+
+<p>On the deck of the <i>Shohirika</i> they could see what this battle
+really meant. Dirt and debris were to be seen in many places, and half a
+dozen sailors and marines had been killed or wounded. Everybody was
+bathed in perspiration and grime, and some of those who worked the big
+guns were panting like dogs after a chase.</p>
+
+<p>"It's work, that's what it is," said Luke, running the perspiration
+from his begrimed forehead with his finger. "Ain't no child's play about
+it!"</p>
+
+<p>"And dangerous work at that," added Larry. He gave a look toward the
+enemy's ships. "I declare, Luke, I believe they are running back to Port
+Arthur harbor!"</p>
+
+<p>"I think the same, lad," responded the Yankee gunner. "Reckon they
+are findin' it is goin' to cost too much to get away. As soon as they
+get away from them land batteries we can pound 'em for keeps and they
+know it."</p>
+
+<p>"And get away from the mines. That's the worst with fighting around
+here&mdash;you don't know how soon you'll hit a mine and be blown
+up."</p>
+
+<p>"Oh, I reckon our captain is watching out fer them pesky things."</p>
+
+<p>Larry was interested in watching the sharpshooters and range-finders
+in the tops, and he walked across the deck to get a better look at them.
+Luke followed, and as he did so, one of the nearest of the Russian ships
+sent out a roaring broadside at the <i>Shohirika</i> which raked her
+fore and aft and sent another hole through her side, but this time above
+the water line where it did scant damage.</p>
+
+<p>"Gee Christopher!" began Luke, when he chanced to glance upward.
+"Larry, look out!" he screamed. "The top's coming down on ye!"</p>
+
+<p>Luke was right. One of the shots from the enemy had struck the
+foremast, above the fighting top, and it was crashing down, carrying a
+portion of the ship's flag with it. One end struck the gun turret, and
+then the wreckage hit Larry on the shoulder, hurling him on his
+back.</p>
+
+<p>The foremast was heavy and had it struck the youth before landing on
+the turret and the surrounding works it might have killed the young
+gunner's mate on the spot. As it was, Larry lay like a log where he had
+fallen and when Luke raised him up the old tar found him
+unconscious.</p>
+
+<p>"If he ain't got his shoulder broke then I miss my guess," muttered
+the Yankee gunner. "Larry! Larry! Can't ye speak to me?"</p>
+
+<p>"That was a nasty one," came from one of the officers of the deck.
+"Better carry him below." And then the officer gave orders to remove the
+wreckage and hoist the flag once more.</p>
+
+<p>With the unconscious youth in his arms, Luke hurried below and to the
+sick bay of the warship. Here the surgeon got to work immediately and
+examined Larry thoroughly.</p>
+
+<p>"No bones broken," he announced. "But the bruise is severe and he is
+suffering from shock. He will soon come to his senses."</p>
+
+<p>Luke had to return to his gun, for duty is duty in the navy,
+regardless of what is happening around one. It was true, the Russian
+warships were now doing their best to sneak back into Port Arthur harbor
+and Admiral Togo wanted to do all the damage possible before the forts
+made it impossible to follow them further. All of the warships' guns
+were worked to their utmost, and when the Russian vessels did get back
+they were so badly crippled that they were of small consequence for
+future fighting until undergoing repairs.</p>
+
+<p>When Larry opened his eyes again he found himself lying on a clean
+white cot in the ship's hospital with an attendant standing over him
+bathing his face.</p>
+
+<p>"Oh!" he murmured and stared around him. "Oh, my shoulder! That was a
+fearful crack I got!"</p>
+
+<p>The attendant did not understand, but smiled blandly and continued to
+bathe his face and also his head. Soon the full realization of what had
+happened came to the young gunner's mate. Then he asked about Luke.</p>
+
+<p>The fighting was at an end and presently Luke came to him, to find
+Larry sitting up in a chair.</p>
+
+<p>"I feel stiff and sore all over, Luke," said the youth. "It was just
+as if a house came down on me."</p>
+
+<p>"Thank fortune you wasn't killed, or didn't have your bones broken,"
+returned the Yankee gunner.</p>
+
+<p>"I am thankful. Were you hurt?"</p>
+
+<p>"Not in the least."</p>
+
+<p>"What about the fight?"</p>
+
+<p>"The Russians have sneaked back into the harbor like a lot of whipped
+dogs."</p>
+
+<p>"What is our ship doing?"</p>
+
+<p>"Putting up the coast. I don't know where we are going," answered
+Luke.</p>
+
+<p>Larry remained in the ship's hospital for three days and then resumed
+his duties as before. His shoulder still felt stiff and sore and lifting
+anything was a good deal of labor. But Luke favored him, so he got along
+very well.</p>
+
+<p>A week passed and the <i>Shohirika</i> remained at sea, moving in a
+wide circle, on the lookout for Russian warships or supply boats. But
+none were encountered, and then the cruiser was ordered to escort a
+transport filled with soldiers bound for the front.</p>
+
+<p>The transport landed at a point some miles north of Dalny and the
+troops went ashore without delay. They were bound for the railroad, and
+were to participate in the advance upon Port Arthur from that point.</p>
+
+<p>As the warship remained in the harbor several days, both Luke and
+Larry were allowed a short run on shore. They enjoyed this trip very
+much, until, much to their surprise, they learned that Major Okopa's
+command was in the vicinity. Then they hunted this up, to learn the sad
+news from Gilbert that Ben was missing.</p>
+
+<p>"Missing!" ejaculated Larry, in horror. "Taken by Chunchuses! Oh,
+Gilbert, this is dreadful!"</p>
+
+<p>"Well, I don't know as you feel any worse than I do, Larry," answered
+Gilbert. "It makes me wild to think of it."</p>
+
+<p>"But couldn't you find any trace of him at all?"</p>
+
+<p>"Not the slightest, although I think he was carried off in a
+boat."</p>
+
+<p>"But why should the Chinese brigands make him a prisoner?"</p>
+
+<p>"I'm sure I don't know, excepting to hold him for a ransom. But if
+they intended to do that it is likely we should have heard from them
+before this."</p>
+
+<p>The matter was discussed as long as Larry and Luke could remain on
+shore. But nothing came of it, and with a heavy heart the young gunner's
+mate returned to his place on the warship.</p>
+
+<h3 class="p4"><a name="28">CHAPTER XXVIII</a></h3>
+
+<h4>THE SIEGE OF PORT ARTHUR</h4>
+
+<p class="p2">After the fruitless effort to escape from Port Arthur
+harbor the Russian warships "bottled up" there remained where they were
+for a long time to come. Occasionally one or another attempted to run
+the blockade, but results were usually disastrous, and at last the risk
+became so great nothing more was done in that direction. The Japanese
+continued to put down mines and sank several boats loaded with stone in
+or near the winding channel, and this made getting in as hard as getting
+out&mdash;thus putting a stop to the arrival of more supply boats, such
+as brought Ben to the seaport.</p>
+
+<p>In the meantime the campaign on land was pushed forward with
+increased activity. The headquarters of the Japanese army investing Port
+Arthur was not far from the railroad, but the lines stretched many miles
+to the east and the west. Troops were hurried both from Japan and from
+the divisions near Liao-Yang, and heavy siege guns were mounted on every
+available hilltop. The Japanese were, at the start, at a great
+disadvantage&mdash;they could not see the enemy at which they were
+firing. Hills and mountains cut them off from every view of the port.
+But they kept hammering away, day after day, week after week, and month
+after month, gaining steadily, throwing up new intrenchments, digging
+new tunnels, and hauling their heavy guns forward to more advantageous
+positions. The labor was body racking and the sacrifice of life
+enormous. But the Mikado's soldiers did not appear to care. They had set
+out to capture Port Arthur and they were going to do it.</p>
+
+<p>For the foot-soldiers and for the cavalry there was at the start but
+little to do in the way of fighting. Most of the time was spent in
+digging trenches and tunnels, and in keeping out of the way of shells
+that whistled and screamed in all directions&mdash;shells weighing
+hundreds of pounds, which, when they struck, tore up the ground for
+yards around and smashed the rocks as if the latter were passing through
+a quartz crusher. Such is war of modern times, when carried on at a
+distance of miles.</p>
+
+<p>But as the months went by, and Japanese and Russians came closer to
+each other, hand-to-hand conflicts became numerous. The Russians
+contested every foot of the ground, fighting with a courage that was
+truly heroic, and sacrificing themselves freely for the Czar and the
+country they loved. The hand-to-hand conflicts became bloody in the
+extreme, thousands upon thousands being slaughtered between the rising
+and the setting of the sun.</p>
+
+<p>From the seacoast the command to which Gilbert was attached moved to
+a small place called Fugi Klan. Here they went into camp for several
+weeks and while there were joined by a number of other commands,
+including that containing those old soldiers of fortune, Dan Casey and
+Carl Stummer, who had served with Gilbert and Ben in Cuba and in the
+Philippines.</p>
+
+<p>"Py chiminy, of it ton't done mine heart goot to see you, cabtain!"
+exclaimed Carl Stummer, rushing up and giving Gilbert a handshake. "How
+you peen, annavay?"</p>
+
+<p>"First rate, Stummer. And how are you, Casey?"</p>
+
+<p>"Sure an' it's meself is as foine as a fiddle," answered the
+Irishman, with a broad grin on his freckled face. "It's a great war,
+ain't it now? Both soides is fightin' like a pair o' Kilkenny cats, so
+they are! An' where is me ould friend, Captain Russell?"</p>
+
+<p>"He was captured by Chunchuses."</p>
+
+<p>"No!" came from both Stummer and Casey, and then they poured in a
+volley of questions which were bewildering. Gilbert answered them as
+best he could.</p>
+
+<p>"Dot's der vorst ding vot I hear yet alretty!" said Carl Stummer,
+with a sad shake of his head. "I vish I got dem Chunchusers&mdash;or vot
+you call dem&mdash;here. I fix 'em, eh, Tan?"</p>
+
+<p>Dan Casey nodded vigorously. "Sure an' we'd be after puttin' a ball
+through ivery mother's son of 'em, so we would! Poor Ben Russell! I
+loiked him loike a brother!" And the honest Irish sharp-shooter heaved a
+long sigh.</p>
+
+<p>Both Casey and Stummer had been having easy times of it for several
+weeks, but now they were called upon to go forth with pick and shovel,
+to do their share of work in digging intrenchments. This was not so
+nice, but they went at the labor without a murmur.</p>
+
+<p>"Sure an' we might as well git into practice," observed Casey, as he
+started in with vigor. "Whin the war's over an' we git back to the
+States, it may be ourselves as will be workin' fer the corporation in
+New York or ilsewhere!"</p>
+
+<p>"Yah, udder puttin' town railroad dracks alretty in der Vest,"
+answered Carl Stummer. "Dot is," he added, "of I ton't got money enough
+to puy a farm."</p>
+
+<p>"'Tis a stock farm I'm wantin'," came from Casey. "Wid horses galore.
+There's money for ye, Carl!" And he went to work with added
+vigor&mdash;as if he expected to turn up the stock farm from the soil
+beneath him.</p>
+
+<p>To Gilbert, even though he occasionally saw Stummer and Casey, the
+days were very lonely. He missed Ben greatly, and each day wondered if
+he would ever see his old war chum again. Major Okopa saw this and did
+what he could to cheer up the young officer.</p>
+
+<p>"He may turn up before you realize it," said the major. "I don't
+think he was killed."</p>
+
+<p>"If he is alive, it is very strange that we do not hear from
+him."</p>
+
+<p>Two days later came a batch of letters into camp, written, or rather
+painted, for the most part, on thin Japanese paper. Among the
+communications were two for Gilbert, one from Captain Ponsberry
+concerning the <i>Columbia</i> and her cargo, and the other from a
+stranger in Pekin, China.</p>
+
+<p>"Who can be writing to me from Pekin, China?" mused the young
+captain, and began to read the communication with interest. It was from
+a Chinese merchant, and ran in part as follows:</p>
+
+<p class="blockquot">"You will be mystified to receive this from an
+utter stranger, but I deem it my duty, kind sir, to send this word to
+you.</p>
+
+<p class="blockquot">"Know, then, that one Ken Gow, a servant of my
+family, was in Port Arthur up to sixteen days ago&mdash;first a servant
+in an American family there, and next a prisoner in the vilest prison
+man ever saw, guarded by dogs of Russians unworthy to be used as door
+mats. Ken Gow is a faithful man, the flower of all my help.</p>
+
+<p class="blockquot">"It is needless to explain to you why my servant
+was thus ill-treated. But you must know that when in prison he met your
+great friend Captain Benjamin Russell, and it was the captain who saved
+Ken Gow from many hard blows from the other prisoners, who wanted not a
+Chinaman amongst them.</p>
+
+<p class="blockquot">"Ken Gow was grateful, even as I am grateful, and
+he promised to get word to you of this matter if the Russians granted
+him his liberty. Finding no fault in my servant he was, after a time,
+liberated, and watching his chance, left Port Arthur and came home.</p>
+
+<p class="blockquot">"Kind sir, he is grateful to Captain Russell and
+would do much for him if he could. Yet his most is to send this letter
+to you, telling you that Captain Russell is alive and held in a Port
+Arthur prison as a spy. One Russian hates him&mdash;his name, Captain
+Barusky,&mdash;and it would appear that this Russian is also your enemy,
+so beware of him.</p>
+
+<p class="blockquot">"I can tell no more. Ken Gow is sick from his
+treatment at the hands of the Russian dogs. Accept this miserable
+assurance of my eternal friendship, and esteem for one I know must be
+high and illustrious."</p>
+
+<p class="quotsig"><span class="smcap">"Cheng Mo."</span></p>
+
+<p>Gilbert read the letter several times and showed it to Major Okopa.
+It was written in true Chinese style, with a big Chinese seal attached,
+and was, beyond all doubt, genuine.</p>
+
+<p>"I can't understand one thing," said the young captain. "How did Ben
+get to Port Arthur?"</p>
+
+<p>"It may be that this Captain Barusky had him taken there, Captain
+Pennington."</p>
+
+<p>"I thought Captain Barusky was at Mukden."</p>
+
+<p>"The Russians have been taking in some troops at Port Arthur on the
+sly. Despite Admiral Togo's efforts, some supply boats and transports
+have passed his ships."</p>
+
+<p>"If Barusky is there he will do what he can to make Ben miserable. He
+is down on both of us&mdash;for he knows we are down on him and Ivan
+Snokoff."</p>
+
+<p>"Do you think Snokoff could have anything to do with this?"</p>
+
+<p>"I'm sure I don't know. Anything is possible. Snokoff would be glad
+to make trouble for Ben&mdash;since he helped me to make him settle up
+at Liao-Yang. Those Chunchuses tried to capture both of us."</p>
+
+<p>The matter was talked over for half an hour, but brought forth no
+satisfaction. To Gilbert's mind, being held by the Russians as a spy was
+as bad as being in the hands of the Chinese brigands.</p>
+
+<p>"I wish we could get into Port Arthur at once," he said, finally. "I
+shouldn't like anything better than to capture this Captain Barusky and
+liberate Ben."</p>
+
+<p>"We are bound to get into the port sooner or later," answered Major
+Okopa. "They are bringing up more siege guns every day. If the Russians
+won't give up we'll batter the whole town down over their heads."</p>
+
+<p>"Which will be a bad thing for Ben," rejoined Gilbert. "I don't want
+him killed in the attempt to rescue him."</p>
+
+<h3 class="p4"><a name="29">CHAPTER XXIX</a></h3>
+
+<h4>FROM ONE DIFFICULTY TO ANOTHER</h4>
+
+<p class="p2">"Where is this going to end?"</p>
+
+<p>It was Ben who asked himself the question, as he walked up and down
+the narrow cell in which he had been confined in the prison at Port
+Arthur.</p>
+
+<p>What had been written to Gilbert in the letter from Pekin had been
+substantially correct. Ben had aided Ken Gow in numerous ways, and for
+this the Chinaman had been extremely grateful and had promised to do all
+he could for the young captain should he manage to escape from the
+blockaded seaport. Then Ken Gow had disappeared one night, and that was
+the last Ben saw of him.</p>
+
+<p>Three days later a guard entered the prison and announced that the
+prisoners were to be transferred to other quarters. With his hands bound
+behind him, Ben was marched forth through a side street of Port Arthur,
+where stood an old building which had formerly been used as a market.
+Cells had been built in this structure, and into one of these he was
+thrust, the guard sarcastically telling him to make himself as
+comfortable as possible.</p>
+
+<p>The young captain was sick in both body and mind and fast reaching
+that point where one becomes desperate and fit for any deed of daring.
+More than once he was tempted to throw himself on the guard in an
+endeavor to overpower the fellow and escape. But he realized that if
+caught at this he would be immediately shot down.</p>
+
+<p>Day after day passed, and from outside the prisoner heard the dull
+booming of cannon. Occasionally a shell would explode close to the
+prison, causing a wild yell of alarm and a general rush by those
+outside. There were flags over the prisons and over the hospitals,
+showing what manner of places they were, but, as said before, the
+Japanese were at a loss to see what they were firing at, so many shots
+and shells went where they were not intended. These mishaps were what
+caused the report to circulate that the Mikado's men were not fighting
+according to the rules of modern warfare, but were doing their best to
+shatter the hospitals in which lay their own and the Russian
+wounded.</p>
+
+<p>It was a cold, raw day, with a touch of snow in the air, and Ben felt
+one of his desperate moods coming over him. His hands and feet were free
+and he peered forth from the one narrow window that the cell contained.
+All he could see beyond was a courtyard, surrounded by a stone wall.</p>
+
+<p>"I wish I was out there&mdash;I'd get over that wall somehow!" he
+muttered to himself.</p>
+
+<p>The cell window was not over fifteen or sixteen inches wide and twice
+that in height. The bars were of iron, but set in wooden frames but a
+few inches in thickness.</p>
+
+<p>"A fellow might smash out those bars with the bench end," he thought.
+"But after that what? I reckon the guard in the courtyard would shoot me
+on sight. I might try it at night."</p>
+
+<p>Still in a desperate mood, Ben picked up the bench, a solid affair
+several feet long. He made an imaginary lunge at the window bars with
+it.</p>
+
+<p>"I'll wager I could knock them out with one blow.
+They&mdash;&mdash;"</p>
+
+<p>Ben got no further, for at the moment a fearful explosion sounded
+somewhere overhead. The explosion was followed by a crash and a wild
+yell of alarm. A Japanese shell had struck the top of the building,
+tearing away fully a quarter of the roof and sending the bricks and
+timbers flying in all directions.</p>
+
+<p>"Now is my chance!" he muttered, and without stopping to think twice
+he rammed the window bars as hard as he could with the bench. A second
+and third blow followed, and down went the irons, carrying a portion of
+the window frame with them. Then through the opening leaped the young
+captain. As he landed in the courtyard, he picked up a small log of wood
+lying handy.</p>
+
+<p>A glance around told him that the guard was nowhere in sight, the
+Russian having run to the other side of the building to note the damage
+done by the shell. Log in hand, Ben leaped quickly across the courtyard
+and placed the bit of wood up against the wall. This gave him a footing,
+and in a twinkling he was on top of the wall.</p>
+
+<p>But though he acted quickly a guard from the prison building saw him
+and ran forth gun in hand.</p>
+
+<p>"Halt!" came the command, in Russian, and then, raising his weapon,
+the guard fired at Ben.</p>
+
+<p>The bullet whistled over the young captain's head, and without
+looking back to see who had fired it, he dropped on the other side of
+the wall. Then he sprinted up the street and around a corner.</p>
+
+<p>Ben knew not where to go, but his one thought was to put distance
+between himself and the prison, and he hurried on and on, until he came
+to a barn which stood open. Into this he darted, to find the building
+empty of occupants.</p>
+
+<p>The Japanese had begun a general bombardment of Port Arthur and shot
+and shells were flying in all directions. This being the case, the
+majority of the troops and the inhabitants were out of sight,&mdash;hid
+away in cellars and dugouts. Nobody paid any attention to him and he was
+thus given ample time in which to think matters over and decide upon his
+next movement.</p>
+
+<p>From the barn Ben moved to the building next door&mdash;which was a
+sort of dwelling and storehouse combined. Here, from the wide open
+doorway, he gazed at the scene of destruction before him. It was full of
+horror and made him shiver.</p>
+
+<p>"War is certainly a terrible thing," he thought. He saw some people
+running for their lives, and beheld one man go down struck in the back
+by a shell. Then he turned away to shut out the sight.</p>
+
+<p>In one room of the warehouse he found an old overcoat and a slouch
+hat, and lost no time in donning these, both as a disguise and to keep
+himself warm. Then he hunted around for something to eat, but could not
+find a mouthful.</p>
+
+<p>"I might have known there would be no food squandered," he told
+himself. "Didn't they say at the prison that they were slaughtering the
+horses just for the meat, and that butter and eggs were worth their
+weight in gold? I'll be lucky to get bread and soup&mdash;especially as
+I haven't a dollar with which to pay for a meal."</p>
+
+<p>Ben was about to leave the warehouse when he saw a file of Russian
+soldiers approaching. With the soldiers were two officers, and as they
+came closer he recognized one as Captain Barusky.</p>
+
+<p>"It was a bad thing to let that American escape," said the captain to
+the other officer. "If you catch sight of him, shoot him on the
+spot."</p>
+
+<p>"Which we shall do with pleasure," was the ready answer; and then
+officers and soldiers passed on.</p>
+
+<p>"I've got to keep out of sight, that's all there is to that,"
+reasoned Ben, grimly. "If they catch me again it's all up with me. I
+wonder if it would be possible to get out of Port Arthur? Gilbert got
+out, but things weren't half so closely guarded as they are now."</p>
+
+<p>Ben waited until nightfall before leaving the warehouse. Then,
+keeping a constant lookout for Russian soldiers, he sneaked along one
+street after another. Where to go he did not know, but he realized that
+he must have something to eat or he would starve.</p>
+
+<p>Presently he came to a small garden in the center of which was a
+neat-looking residence. On the doorplate was the name Nathan Chase.</p>
+
+<p>"Nathan Chase!" Ben cried, half aloud. "I wonder if that can be the
+gentleman Gilbert knew? If it is perhaps he will aid me."</p>
+
+<p>At first the young captain thought to ring the doorbell, but fearful
+of meeting the wrong person he resolved to investigate in a more private
+manner. The side windows of the residence were curtained, but the
+curtains were only partly down. Going to one of the windows he peered
+inside.</p>
+
+<p>In a neatly furnished sitting room sat a young lady and a Russian
+soldier. They were arguing about something&mdash;money matters as far as
+Ben could make out. The young lady did not wish to give the soldier the
+money and he insisted upon having it. While Ben gazed at the scene, the
+Russian soldier leaped up, grasped the young lady by the shoulders and
+shook her roughly.</p>
+
+<p>"Don't!" screamed the young lady, in English. "Let me go!"</p>
+
+<p>"I want the money!" answered the soldier, in his native tongue. He
+was a Cossack and of brutal features.</p>
+
+<p>The young lady was pretty and she was helpless, and this combination
+was more than the young captain could resist. Regardless of
+consequences, he shoved up the window and leaped inside the
+apartment.</p>
+
+<p>"Keep your hands off of that young lady!" he cried, and catching the
+Cossack by the shoulder he threw him backward. "Don't you know how to
+treat a lady when you meet her, you big brute?"</p>
+
+<p>The Cossack was startled, first because he had not expected the
+interruption and secondly because he had no business to be in the
+mansion. He gave one look at Ben and then rushed out into the hallway
+and left the premises with all possible speed.</p>
+
+<p>As soon as the Cossack was gone the young lady and Ben stared at each
+other. She started to speak, but stopped suddenly.</p>
+
+<p>"Excuse me for coming in as I did, but I thought it was necessary,"
+said the young captain. "I guess that fellow had no business here."</p>
+
+<p>"You are right, sir. Papa is away, and he wanted me to give him
+money. He must have known I was alone in the house."</p>
+
+<p>"Are you Miss Chase?"</p>
+
+<p>"I am. But you have the advantage of me."</p>
+
+<p>"I know it. I am Captain Benjamin Russell. Perhaps you know an old
+friend of mine, Gilbert Pennington. He knows your father, I
+believe."</p>
+
+<p>"Oh, yes, I have met Captain Pennington. They tell me he is now in
+the Japanese army."</p>
+
+<p>"He is." Ben paused and looked at the young lady keenly. "Miss Chase,
+can I trust you?" he asked, abruptly.</p>
+
+<p>"What do you mean?"</p>
+
+<p>"I will tell you," and in a few brief words he related his story, to
+which Grace Chase listened with close attention.</p>
+
+<p>"You were lucky to escape from that prison!" she cried, when he had
+finished. "To be sure I will assist you as far as I can. Papa is away on
+business, but I expect him back in two or three hours. We haven't much
+on hand to eat, but such as there is you are welcome to."</p>
+
+<p>"I'm hungry enough to eat anything," said Ben, with a little
+smile.</p>
+
+<p>"Then come with me to the dining room, Captain Russell, and I will
+prepare supper."</p>
+
+<p>"You haven't any servants now, I suppose?"</p>
+
+<p>"No; every one of them has deserted us."</p>
+
+<p>They entered the dining room, and the young lady asked Ben to close
+the shutters. While he was doing this she prepared such a meal as the
+larder of the house afforded. It was not much, but he did not complain,
+and he thanked her warmly for giving what he felt she could ill afford
+to set before him.</p>
+
+<p>The meal finished, they sat down to await the coming of Mr. Chase.
+While doing this Ben related some of his experiences in the army and the
+young lady told of the horrors of the siege.</p>
+
+<p>"One cannot understand it unless you are in the midst of it," she
+said. "Papa says business is at a standstill, the hospitals are filled
+with the sick and the wounded, and we are in constant dread that the
+next moment will be our last. The suspense is so great that in one or
+two cases the inhabitants have gone crazy."</p>
+
+<p>"I can well believe that, Miss Chase. During the war in the
+Philippines I saw&mdash;&mdash;"</p>
+
+<p>Ben paused, as a heavy footstep sounded on the porch of the
+residence. Other footsteps followed, and then came a loud knock on the
+door.</p>
+
+<p>"Open here!" demanded a voice in Russian. "Open, in the name of the
+Czar!"</p>
+
+<h3 class="p4"><a name="30">CHAPTER XXX</a></h3>
+
+<h4>A SURPRISE FOR LARRY</h4>
+
+<p class="p2">As the days passed, the watch upon Port Arthur from the
+sea became closer and closer. Admiral Togo gave strict orders that no
+ships should be allowed to enter or come from the harbor under any
+circumstances, and each commander of a warship was on his mettle,
+knowing full well that if he was derelict in his duty he would speedily
+hear from his superior in a manner far from pleasant.</p>
+
+<p>Blockading became something of a monotony to Larry and Luke, and
+after several weeks had passed both wished something would happen.</p>
+
+<p>"I'd rather put up with a stiff sea fight than this," declared the
+young gunner's mate.</p>
+
+<p>"Right ye are, lad," replied the old Yankee tar. "Ain't no use o'
+bein' ready for a tussle if it ain't comin'. As it now is, life in the
+navy ain't no more excitin' nor life on the old <i>Columbia</i>."</p>
+
+<p>During that time Larry received a letter from Captain Ponsberry,
+similar in contents to that sent to Gilbert. The Japanese Government had
+released the cargo of the schooner and then bought the same at a good
+round price. The ship had also been released, Captain Ponsberry having
+to pay a nominal sum for this action.</p>
+
+<p>"I think the captain is lucky to get off so easily," said Larry. "I
+suppose the Japanese Government might have scooped in everything."</p>
+
+<p>"Well, the Japs think it best to remain friendly to the United
+States," answered Luke, and it is likely that the old sailor was more
+than half right.</p>
+
+<p>Cold weather had come in earnest and work on deck was far from
+pleasant. Yet each man on the <i>Shohirika</i> had to do his full duty
+as before, and, be it said to their credit, not a sailor or marine did
+any shirking. Gun drills and various exercises were kept up
+constantly.</p>
+
+<p>One day the warship ran close to a big trading brig bound for
+Hong-Kong. As was the custom, the brig stopped to allow the commander of
+the <i>Shohirika</i> to make certain that she was not carrying
+contrabands of war for Russia or had no intentions of running the
+blockade.</p>
+
+<p>While this examination was going on, Larry and Luke chanced to come
+on deck, curious to have a look at the stranger.</p>
+
+<p>"About as big a brig as I ever see in these parts," was the Yankee
+tar's comment. "She must carry a whopping cargo."</p>
+
+<p>"Yes, and a lot of men to man her," answered Larry. "Think of
+hoisting and furling such sails as she carries!"</p>
+
+<p>The two vessels had come fairly close to each other, and our friends
+continued to survey the brig with interest. Then Larry gave a cry.</p>
+
+<p>"Oh, Luke, I wish I had a glass!"</p>
+
+<p>"Why?"</p>
+
+<p>"Unless I am mistaken, there is Shamhaven on the deck of that
+ship!"</p>
+
+<p>"No!"</p>
+
+<p>Larry pointed with his hand. "Doesn't that look like him?" he
+continued.</p>
+
+<p>"Keelhaul me, if I don't think you're right, lad. Wait, I'll get a
+glass an' make certain!"</p>
+
+<p>The old tar knew where he could borrow a glass, and in a minute more
+he returned, and both took a brief look through the instrument.</p>
+
+<p>"It is Shamhaven!" ejaculated Larry. "And look, there is Peterson
+coming from the fo'castle!"</p>
+
+<p>"That's so. What ye goin' to do about it?"</p>
+
+<p>"Tell the officer of the deck. They shan't get off with my money if I
+can help it."</p>
+
+<p>Rushing away, Larry soon acquainted the proper officer with what he
+had discovered&mdash;telling as much about the robbery as seemed
+necessary. The officer was interested, and, what was even more to the
+point, liked the young American.</p>
+
+<p>"Do you wish to go to yonder ship and confront the men?" he
+asked.</p>
+
+<p>"Try me and see!" answered Larry, excitedly. "I mean, yes, sir," he
+stammered. "And will you let Luke Striker go, too?"</p>
+
+<p>The officer agreed, and soon another small boat put off from the
+warship, and Larry and Luke, with the officer, were speedily landed on
+the deck of the brig.</p>
+
+<p>"You're a fine rascal, to rob me!" cried Larry, rushing up to
+Shamhaven. "And to rob Captain Ponsberry, too!"</p>
+
+<p>Shamhaven had not expected this encounter, and for the moment he was
+dumbstruck. He gazed from Larry to Luke as if they were ghosts.</p>
+
+<p>"I&mdash;I&mdash;who are you, anyway?" he stammered. "I don't know
+you," he added, striving to regain his composure.</p>
+
+<p>"Yes, you do know me, and you know Luke Striker, too," answered the
+young gunner's mate.</p>
+
+<p>"What does this mean?" asked the captain of the brig, while a number
+of others looked on with interest.</p>
+
+<p>"I'll tell you what it means, sir," said Larry, and did so. "He has
+got to give up my money belt and my money, and give up Captain
+Ponsberry's money, too."</p>
+
+<p>At this moment Peterson came up and was promptly collared by
+Luke.</p>
+
+<p>"Stop! Don't you vos touch me!" cried Peterson. "I ain't noddings
+done, no."</p>
+
+<p>"You helped Shamhaven to rob me," came from Larry.</p>
+
+<p>"No, he done it all alone! I no touch noddings!"</p>
+
+<p>"Oh, shut up!" roared Shamhaven, in disgust. "I never robbed anybody.
+If you lost your money Peterson must have taken it."</p>
+
+<p>A quarrel ensued between the evildoers, in the midst of which came a
+cry from the <i>Shohirika</i>.</p>
+
+<p>"An enemy is in sight!"</p>
+
+<p>At once all attention was turned to the warship. Scarcely a minute
+elapsed when a signal was displayed:</p>
+
+<p>"A battleship, and she is trying to escape up the coast!"</p>
+
+<p>"To the boats!" roared the Japanese officer on the deck of the brig.
+"To the boats at once! This investigation will have to be postponed. We
+shall expect you to remain as you are"&mdash;the latter words to the
+captain of the big brig.</p>
+
+<p>"As you will," was the smooth answer.</p>
+
+<p>A rush was made for the two small boats, Larry and Luke being hustled
+along with the crowd. Soon they put off for the warship, which was
+already preparing to follow the Russian battleship that had been
+seen.</p>
+
+<p>"I didn't get my money, after all," grumbled the youth. "But perhaps
+I'll get it later&mdash;if that ship of the enemy doesn't sink us," he
+added.</p>
+
+<p>As soon as they were on board of the <i>Shohirika</i> again, the
+cruiser started after the battleship. But the enemy had a good lead, and
+it was some time before the Japanese warship could command a full head
+of steam, which meant everything to her. Then, when steam was to be had
+in plenty, there came a breakdown in the engine room, causing a delay of
+twenty minutes.</p>
+
+<p>"We'll never catch her,&mdash;at least, not to-day," said Luke, and
+he was right. Darkness found the battleship still three miles away. Half
+a dozen shots were fired at her, but none took effect. Then night ended
+the pursuit.</p>
+
+<p>In the morning nothing was to be seen of the enemy and those on the
+Japanese warship were much depressed, for they had fancied that an
+encounter might add greatly to their laurels. But shortly before noon
+the lookout announced the approach of another ship.</p>
+
+<p>"A Russian cruiser!" was the cry.</p>
+
+<p>This was correct&mdash;the vessel was the auxiliary cruiser,
+<i>Pontomuk</i>, formerly a steamer in the Siberian trade. She was
+manned by a fierce and swarthy-looking body of sailors and marines, and
+carried a first and second battery of no mean proportions.</p>
+
+<p>"I'll wager we have got some work cut out for us now," said Larry,
+and he was right. Finding she could not run away from the
+<i>Shohirika</i> the Russian auxiliary cruiser came steaming up and let
+drive at close range,&mdash;a broadside that raked the Japanese warship
+from end to end with deadly effect. The <i>Shohirika</i> answered
+immediately, and both the steering wheel and the rudder were smashed on
+the enemy's ship.</p>
+
+<p>"Phew! but this is hot work!" panted Larry, as all those around the
+gun worked like Trojans.</p>
+
+<p>"An' it's going to be hotter!" ejaculated Luke. He sighted the piece
+with care. "There, Sally Jane, let her go!" And he pressed the electric
+button. <i>Bang!</i> went the gun with a roar that was deafening. Then
+the breech was thrown open and the smoke rolled out, filling the air
+with a smell that made them cough and sneeze. But nobody stopped work.
+In a trice the gun was cleaned and cooled and another shell pushed into
+place, and then the firing was repeated.</p>
+
+<p>"She's coming alongside!" was the announcement from on deck. "All
+hands to repel boarders!"</p>
+
+<p>"A hand-to-hand fight!" cried Larry, and scarcely had the words been
+uttered when there came a bump that hurled half the sailors flat. Up
+they sprang, and as order after order was delivered the marines and
+others ran for their guns and cutlasses, while the officers saw to it
+that their pistols were ready for use.</p>
+
+<p>A wild, maddening yell came from the deck of the Russian ship, as
+marines and sailors poured over the side. An answering <i>Banzai</i>
+issued from the Japanese, and they met the first onslaught with vigor.
+Then came a fierce tramping over the deck, as the two conflicting
+parties moved first to one side and then the other.</p>
+
+<p>"We are ordered up!" cried Larry, a few minutes later. "Here is where
+we have got to fight for it, Luke!"</p>
+
+<p>"Right you are, lad. Do your best, and trust to Heaven for the rest!"
+was the Yankee tar's reply. <ins title="Transcriber's Note: Original
+reads 'and'">And</ins> then, cutlasses in hand, both mounted to the
+deck, to engage in the fiercest hand-to-hand encounter either of them
+had ever experienced.</p>
+
+<h3 class="p4"><a name="31">CHAPTER XXXI</a></h3>
+
+<h4>A CALL TO REPEL BOARDERS</h4>
+
+<p class="p2">It was a battle royal from the start and for some time
+neither side had an advantage. Pistol shot was met by pistol shot, and a
+rifle gun placed on the upper deck of the Russian warship was balanced
+in execution by a similar gun mounted on the <i>Shohirika</i>. The
+slaughter created by both weapons was frightful, a dozen or more going
+down on either side each time a gun was discharged.</p>
+
+<p>When Larry and Luke came out on desk the spectacle was enough to make
+the blood of the youth run cold, and it was only his previous experience
+in warfare which rendered him capable of doing what he knew was his
+duty.</p>
+
+<p>"Charge on them!" came the cry in Japanese. "Kill them, or drive them
+back to their ship! <i>Banzai!</i>"</p>
+
+<p>"<i>Banzai! Banzai Nippon!</i>" was the yell. "Hurrah for Japan!"</p>
+
+<p>The Japanese had not expected a hand-to-hand fight and the closing in
+of the enemy aroused them as they had never been aroused before. For the
+first time Larry saw the sailors and marines awakened to their full
+fighting fury&mdash;a fury in which every Japanese scorns death and
+thinks that to die is glory for himself, his family, and his emperor.
+They leaped on the Russians with a ferocity that was appalling, and that
+first shock sent the Czar's men back to the deck from which they had
+come.</p>
+
+<p>But the Russians were likewise aroused, and with cheers and yells
+they came on once more, leaping over the bodies of those who had fallen,
+and meeting shot with shot and cutlass stroke with cutlass stroke.
+Officers and men fought side by side, and many went down to a common
+death.</p>
+
+<p>By instinct Larry and Luke kept close together, with the others from
+Luke's gun near at hand, and Steve Colton and Bob Stanford not far away.
+Each used his cutlass as best he could, warding off the blows of the
+enemy and dealing cuts whenever a chance appeared. Larry was glad that
+he had learned to use a cutlass so well, and soon found himself the
+match of almost any Russian who challenged him.</p>
+
+<p>The fighting was now spread over the decks of both vessels, which
+were hooked together tightly and pounding broadside at every swell of
+the ocean. To attempt to blow up either ship would have been fatal
+probably to both&mdash;one dragging down the other&mdash;so no such
+attempt was made.</p>
+
+<p>While the fighting was at its height, Larry suddenly found himself
+face to face with a Russian lieutenant of marines. The fellow had a
+pistol in his hand, and as Larry raised his cutlass to strike, he
+dropped the weapon on a level with the youth's head and pulled the
+trigger.</p>
+
+<p>Had the bullet sped as intended it is likely Larry would have been
+killed. But just as the trigger fell, Luke, who was at Larry's side,
+knocked the pistol to one side with his cutlass and the bullet merely
+grazed Larry's hair. Then Larry leaped forward and gave the Russian
+lieutenant a thrust in the side which put the fellow out of the fight
+instantly.</p>
+
+<p>For fully fifteen minutes the battle had now raged and it was growing
+hotter each instant. All of the available men on each ship were in the
+fray, and the cries and yells which resounded were deafening.</p>
+
+<p>"We certainly can't keep this fight up much longer!" panted Larry. He
+had a cut on his left hand and one in the shoulder, but kept on with
+dogged determination.</p>
+
+<p>"Well, we ain't goin' to surrender!" grunted Luke. "It's fight or
+die, I guess!" And he leaped forward once more.</p>
+
+<p>Two tall Russians were directly in front of the old Yankee gunner,
+and both fell upon him with their cutlasses at the same instant. Luke
+was capable of warding off the weapon of one, but he was no match for
+the pair, and it speedily looked as if they would surely kill him.</p>
+
+<p>"Back with ye!" he yelled, and swung his cutlass as rapidly as he
+could, but they crowded him still closer and then one made a thrust at
+his face and another at his body.</p>
+
+<p>It was at this critical moment that Larry, who had been engaged with
+somebody else, saw his old war chum's predicament. With a leap he gained
+Luke's side, and down came his cutlass with a sweeping blow on the wrist
+of one of the enemy. The Russian dropped his cutlass to the deck and
+staggered back, his hand almost severed from his arm. Then Luke slashed
+the other Russian across the cheek, and both of the enemy hurried back
+behind the other fighters.</p>
+
+<p>"Good fer you, Larry!" panted Luke, when he could speak. "They had me
+about cornered!"</p>
+
+<p>"These fellows certainly know how to put up a stiff fight."</p>
+
+<p>"You're wounded yourself. Better go below."</p>
+
+<p>"No, I'm going to see it out. Why don't you go down yourself?"</p>
+
+<p>"It ain't in me, thet's why," answered the old Yankee gunner.</p>
+
+<p>Again came a fierce onslaught from the Russians. But the Japanese now
+had another rifle gun in place, and sharpshooters were crowding the
+fighting tops. The latter picked off the Russian officers, and this
+created a momentary confusion. Then came a sudden order to unlock the
+two ships and this was done.</p>
+
+<p>"The Russian ship is going down!" was the yell, and the news proved
+true. An explosion below decks had torn a hole in the Russian warship's
+bottom and she began to sink rapidly.</p>
+
+<p>The scene was now indescribable. Both the Russians and the Japanese
+on the doomed vessel endeavored to reach the deck of the
+<i>Shohirika</i>. In this struggle the majority of the Russians received
+the worst of it, and fully fifty of them, including not a few wounded,
+remained on board when the doomed warship took her final plunge beneath
+the waters of the sea. Eighteen Japanese were likewise drowned,
+including two under officers.</p>
+
+<p>"Surrender, or we will drive you over the side!" was the command from
+the Japanese, and utterly disheartened by the loss of their ship, the
+Russians threw down their arms; and the fierce and bloody contest was at
+an end. The common sailors were driven forward and chained together or
+bound with ropes, and the officers were grouped near the stern, where a
+formal surrender was made by the captain of the lost ship giving up his
+sword. This formality over, the Japanese set to work at once, cleaning
+up the deck and caring for the wounded as well as the hospital
+accommodations of the <i>Shohirika</i> would permit.</p>
+
+<p>"I never wish to see another fight like that," was Larry's comment,
+when he had washed up and had his wounds dressed. "It was simply a
+slaughter!"</p>
+
+<p>"Right you are, lad," answered Luke. "An' I reckon I'm a-goin' to
+carry the scars o' it down to my grave." The old Yankee gunner had
+received several severe wounds, and he was glad enough to have Larry
+swing his hammock for him and lie down to rest.</p>
+
+<p>The battle over, the captain of the <i>Shohirika</i> sailed away, to
+look for the big brig once more and to report to the flagship of the
+fleet. But the brig had taken time by the forelock and left for parts
+unknown.</p>
+
+<p>"I suppose that is the last of Shamhaven and Peterson and my money,"
+said Larry, when this news reached him. "I wish we had met that brig a
+week ago."</p>
+
+<p>"Oh, it's possible we may see her again," said Luke, cheerfully. "But
+it gets me that she ran away, unless she had something to run for."</p>
+
+<p>"She must have been carrying some contraband of war, Luke."</p>
+
+<p>"It ain't unlikely, lad. Well, she's gone, an' it ain't no use to cry
+over spilt milk. When you write to Captain Ponsberry you can tell him ye
+saw them two rascals an' thet's all the good it did."</p>
+
+<p>"Do you know what I'm thinking?"</p>
+
+<p>"Well?"</p>
+
+<p>"I'm thinking that brig was bound for Port Arthur, and she'll slip
+into that port some dark and misty night."</p>
+
+<p>"It's a risky piece o' business. Either our ships or the mines are
+likely to blow her up."</p>
+
+<p>"That is true. But the Russians at the port must be getting
+desperate, and they'll most likely pay any kind of a price for supplies.
+A captain who ran the blockade successfully could make a fortune,"
+returned Larry.</p>
+
+<p>The young gunner's mate was right in his surmise. The big brig was a
+Russian vessel in disguise and loaded to her fullest capacity with
+supplies for the blockaded seaport. She had been fitted out at
+Vladivostok, but had taken a wide sea course, so as to pretend to have
+set sail from Nagasaki. Several Russian shipping merchants were
+interested in the venture, which was a private one, and among the number
+was Ivan Snokoff. From Captain Barusky, Snokoff had heard that fabulous
+prices could be obtained for needed commodities at Port Arthur, and he
+had invested nearly every <i>ruble</i> he possessed in the enterprise.
+If the vessel succeeded in reaching Port Arthur, Captain Barusky was to
+undertake the disposal of the goods shipped in Snokoff's name, and then
+the two were to divide the profits.</p>
+
+<p>The big brig had come close to being wrecked off the coast of Japan
+and during a gale had run down a fishing smack containing Shamhaven,
+Peterson, and two Japanese. One Japanese had been drowned, and the three
+others from the smack had been made to join the crew of the big brig.
+This was agreeable to Shamhaven and Peterson, who did not wish to remain
+near Nagasaki or at any place where Captain Ponsberry or Larry would be
+likely to discover them.</p>
+
+<h3 class="p4"><a name="32">CHAPTER XXXII</a></h3>
+
+<h4>FALL OF PORT ARTHUR&mdash;CONCLUSION</h4>
+
+<p class="p2">"Open, in the name of the Czar!"</p>
+
+<p>Such was the command which startled both Ben and Grace Chase, and for
+the moment each gazed at the other in horror, not knowing what to say or
+do.</p>
+
+<p>"I must get away from here!" whispered the young captain, but
+scarcely had he spoken when there came a crash, and the front door of
+the residence swung in. Then half a dozen Russians poured into the
+house.</p>
+
+<p>"There he is, as I suspected!" said one, an officer from the prison.
+"We'll see that you do not escape again," he added to Ben, grimly.</p>
+
+<p>In the midst of the excitement Nathan Chase arrived. But he could do
+nothing for the young captain, and was glad that he was left to protect
+his daughter.</p>
+
+<p>"We ought also to take her," said the prison official. "She did wrong
+to harbor this prisoner." And then, without further ado, Ben was marched
+back to the place from which he had escaped such a short while before.</p>
+
+<p>After that the time passed dismally enough for the young American.
+For having run away he was put on the most miserable fare the prison
+afforded, the food being often so vile he could not touch it. Whenever
+he attempted to protest he was met with kicks and blows.</p>
+
+<p>"They might as well kill me and be done with it," he thought. "Oh,
+how I wish the Japs would take the city and give me back my
+liberty!"</p>
+
+<p>In those days Port Arthur became a most uncomfortable place for all
+living there. The Japanese army was pressing forward steadily, and army
+and navy did everything possible to destroy the shipping in the harbor
+and make the various forts untenable. Shots and shells were hurled into
+the city at all hours of the day and night, until living there became
+worse than a nightmare. Among the soldiers scurvy became prevalent,
+until the hospitals could not accommodate the sick and the dying.
+Nothing was done to clean up the streets, and the rubbish lay many feet
+deep over the sidewalks. Practically all of the shops were closed, for
+they had next to nothing to sell. The main article of food was rice, and
+to cook this many old buildings had to be razed in order to procure
+necessary firewood. As winter approached the suffering of the poor
+became so intense that riots broke out and to maintain order not a few
+were shot down.</p>
+
+<p>Such was the condition in the city. Outside, to the northward, the
+fighting went on week after week. So many soldiers were killed upon both
+sides that to bury the dead became impossible, and thousands were left
+where they had fallen, to become the prey of vultures, or to putrefy and
+fill the locality with a stench that was as nauseating as it was deadly!
+Such are the horrors of modern warfare. The demands for universal peace
+cannot come any too quickly.</p>
+
+<p>In the advance on Port Arthur, Gilbert did his full share of the
+fighting. The Japanese were now struggling for the possession of what
+was known as 203-Meter Hill, a rocky elevation which was not fortified
+but which was in the direct line of Russian fire. The top of 203-Meter
+Hill commanded a fine view of Port Arthur and its harbor, and it was
+this view the Japanese needed, in order to make their shell fire most
+effective.</p>
+
+<p>The battle for 203-Meter Hill is one which will be long remembered.
+The Japanese fought with a desperation impossible to describe, and when
+the hill was captured, General Stoessel sent out nearly all his
+available men to retake it. But this could not be accomplished, and late
+in December the Japanese stormed the inner defenses of the Russian chain
+of forts, killing nearly all of the brave defenders who dared to oppose
+them. Then tons upon tons of shot and shell were sent into Port Arthur
+and over the harbor once again, until the locality became little short
+of an inferno. Nearly all the shipping was destroyed, and so many
+buildings were set on fire that to stem the conflagration became all but
+impossible. The end came on New Year's Day, 1905&mdash;ten months after
+the famous siege began. To hold out longer seemed impossible, and to
+avoid further carnage General Stoessel called a council of war and sent
+a message to General Nogi offering to capitulate.</p>
+
+<p>"Port Arthur has surrendered!" The news flew from one Japanese
+regiment to another, and soon the warships were sending the message from
+vessel to vessel. For once the Japanese showed their real feelings, and
+"<i>Banzai! Banzai!</i>" rent the air again and again. "Long life to the
+Mikado! Port Arthur is ours once more!"</p>
+
+<p>"It is a well-earned victory!" cried Larry, when he heard the
+news.</p>
+
+<p>"Yes, lad, and I trust it brings this bloody war to a close," came
+from Luke.</p>
+
+<p>"They say General Stoessel blew up the warships remaining in the
+harbor."</p>
+
+<p>"He couldn't have had many left," returned the old Yankee gunner.
+"The army and the navy have about battered everything to bits." And in
+this surmise Luke was correct.</p>
+
+<p>The fall of Port Arthur caused widespread consternation in Russia,
+while the people of Japan were correspondingly elated. Because of the
+gallant defense of the place, the Japanese made generous terms with
+those who had surrendered, much to the satisfaction of the world at
+large. Many had predicted a universal butchery, but nothing of the sort
+occurred, and the Russian sick and wounded were given every possible
+attention.</p>
+
+<p>After the fall of the port Larry was permitted to go ashore some
+miles above the town, and he managed to <ins title="Transcriber's Note:
+Original reads 'located'">locate</ins> Gilbert, and then learned for the
+first time that Ben was a prisoner in the captured place.</p>
+
+<p>"A prisoner!" he ejaculated. "Oh, Gilbert, we must find him and have
+him released!"</p>
+
+<p>"That is just what I have been thinking, but I don't know exactly how
+to go at it, Larry."</p>
+
+<p>"There ought to be some way of doing these things. We might interview
+one of the generals and&mdash;&mdash;Who is that coming this way?"</p>
+
+<p>"Why, it's Ben himself!" cried Gilbert.</p>
+
+<p>"Ben!" screamed Larry, and ran forward to meet his brother. Soon they
+were in each other's arms, and then Gilbert received an equally warm
+greeting.</p>
+
+<p>"We were released this morning," said Ben. "I can tell you I was
+mighty glad of it. I haven't had a meal fit to eat in weeks."</p>
+
+<p>"Well, you shall have the best our larder affords," said Gilbert.
+"My, but you're a sight for sore eyes!" he continued.</p>
+
+<p>"Don't say a word!" came from Larry. Two tears were glistening in his
+honest eyes. "It's almost too good to be true!"</p>
+
+<div class="center">* * * * *</div>
+
+<p>Here let me add a few words more and then bring to a close this tale
+of the naval and military adventures "At the Fall of Port Arthur."</p>
+
+<p>After the surrender of the city the army in that vicinity, and also
+the fleet near the harbor, had but little to do outside of caring for
+the sick and wounded and disposing of the thousands of prisoners. The
+Russian officers were allowed to go on parole and the prisoners were
+transported to Japan. Many of the mines in the harbor were taken up, so
+that ships might come and go in safety.</p>
+
+<p>Larry was anxious to learn what had become of Shamhaven and Peterson,
+and through the Japanese guards stationed in Port Arthur located the
+rascally sailors at a cheap boarding-house. Both were made prisoners,
+and Larry got back a portion of the money stolen from Captain Ponsberry
+and himself. It was learned that the big brig had been destroyed by the
+Japanese shell fire, so that Ivan Snokoff lost everything he placed in
+the venture.</p>
+
+<p>"Well, it served him right," said Gilbert, when he heard of this. "He
+is responsible for the time Ben spent in prison."</p>
+
+<p>What had become of Captain Barusky was at first a mystery. But at
+last it was learned that he had sneaked aboard of a transport filled
+with wounded soldiers and bound for Chefoo. He pretended to be wounded
+himself, and was given medical attention until the trick was discovered,
+when he was treated as a coward. As soon as Chefoo was reached he
+disappeared, and that was the last seen or heard of him for some
+time.</p>
+
+<p>"We are well rid of that fellow," said Ben. "I hope the Russians read
+him out of their army. He isn't fit to hold a commission."</p>
+
+<p>"What do you imagine will be the next move in this war?" questioned
+Gilbert.</p>
+
+<p>"It is hard to tell. I think they will try to take Mukden, for one
+thing."</p>
+
+<p>"Russia is going to send out more warships," put in Larry. "If they
+come this way, it may mean more fighting for me."</p>
+
+<p>"Well, I reckon you'll do your duty, if you are put to it," answered
+Gilbert, with a smile.</p>
+
+<p>"And so will you do yours," came from Larry.</p>
+
+<p>"We'll all try to do our duty," broke in Ben. "We didn't join the
+army and the navy to hang back. Just the same, I'd enjoy a bit of a rest
+just now."</p>
+
+<p>The others agreed that the rest would be beneficial all around. It
+was given to them; and here, for the present at least, we will leave
+them, wishing them the best of good luck in the future.</p>
+
+<p>&nbsp;</p>
+
+<hr class="c10" />
+
+<div class="tnote">
+<h4>Transcriber's Note:</h4>
+<p>Obvious punctuation errors were corrected.</p>
+<p>The remaining corrections made are indicated by dotted lines under
+the corrections. Scroll the mouse over the word and the original text
+will<ins title="Transcriber's Note: Original reads 'apprear'">
+appear</ins>.</p>
+</div>
+
+<p>&nbsp;</p>
+<p>&nbsp;</p>
+<hr class="full" />
+<p>***END OF THE PROJECT GUTENBERG EBOOK AT THE FALL OF PORT ARTHUR***</p>
+<p>******* This file should be named 33559-h.txt or 33559-h.zip *******</p>
+<p>This and all associated files of various formats will be found in:<br />
+<a href="http://www.gutenberg.org/dirs/3/3/5/5/33559">http://www.gutenberg.org/3/3/5/5/33559</a></p>
+<p>Updated editions will replace the previous one--the old editions
+will be renamed.</p>
+
+<p>Creating the works from public domain print editions means that no
+one owns a United States copyright in these works, so the Foundation
+(and you!) can copy and distribute it in the United States without
+permission and without paying copyright royalties. Special rules,
+set forth in the General Terms of Use part of this license, apply to
+copying and distributing Project Gutenberg-tm electronic works to
+protect the PROJECT GUTENBERG-tm concept and trademark. Project
+Gutenberg is a registered trademark, and may not be used if you
+charge for the eBooks, unless you receive specific permission. If you
+do not charge anything for copies of this eBook, complying with the
+rules is very easy. You may use this eBook for nearly any purpose
+such as creation of derivative works, reports, performances and
+research. They may be modified and printed and given away--you may do
+practically ANYTHING with public domain eBooks. Redistribution is
+subject to the trademark license, especially commercial
+redistribution.</p>
+
+
+
+<pre>
+*** START: FULL LICENSE ***
+
+THE FULL PROJECT GUTENBERG LICENSE
+PLEASE READ THIS BEFORE YOU DISTRIBUTE OR USE THIS WORK
+
+To protect the Project Gutenberg-tm mission of promoting the free
+distribution of electronic works, by using or distributing this work
+(or any other work associated in any way with the phrase "Project
+Gutenberg"), you agree to comply with all the terms of the Full Project
+Gutenberg-tm License (available with this file or online at
+<a href="http://www.gutenberg.org/license">http://www.gutenberg.org/license)</a>.
+
+
+Section 1. General Terms of Use and Redistributing Project Gutenberg-tm
+electronic works
+
+1.A. By reading or using any part of this Project Gutenberg-tm
+electronic work, you indicate that you have read, understand, agree to
+and accept all the terms of this license and intellectual property
+(trademark/copyright) agreement. If you do not agree to abide by all
+the terms of this agreement, you must cease using and return or destroy
+all copies of Project Gutenberg-tm electronic works in your possession.
+If you paid a fee for obtaining a copy of or access to a Project
+Gutenberg-tm electronic work and you do not agree to be bound by the
+terms of this agreement, you may obtain a refund from the person or
+entity to whom you paid the fee as set forth in paragraph 1.E.8.
+
+1.B. "Project Gutenberg" is a registered trademark. It may only be
+used on or associated in any way with an electronic work by people who
+agree to be bound by the terms of this agreement. There are a few
+things that you can do with most Project Gutenberg-tm electronic works
+even without complying with the full terms of this agreement. See
+paragraph 1.C below. There are a lot of things you can do with Project
+Gutenberg-tm electronic works if you follow the terms of this agreement
+and help preserve free future access to Project Gutenberg-tm electronic
+works. See paragraph 1.E below.
+
+1.C. The Project Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation ("the Foundation"
+or PGLAF), owns a compilation copyright in the collection of Project
+Gutenberg-tm electronic works. Nearly all the individual works in the
+collection are in the public domain in the United States. If an
+individual work is in the public domain in the United States and you are
+located in the United States, we do not claim a right to prevent you from
+copying, distributing, performing, displaying or creating derivative
+works based on the work as long as all references to Project Gutenberg
+are removed. Of course, we hope that you will support the Project
+Gutenberg-tm mission of promoting free access to electronic works by
+freely sharing Project Gutenberg-tm works in compliance with the terms of
+this agreement for keeping the Project Gutenberg-tm name associated with
+the work. You can easily comply with the terms of this agreement by
+keeping this work in the same format with its attached full Project
+Gutenberg-tm License when you share it without charge with others.
+
+1.D. The copyright laws of the place where you are located also govern
+what you can do with this work. Copyright laws in most countries are in
+a constant state of change. If you are outside the United States, check
+the laws of your country in addition to the terms of this agreement
+before downloading, copying, displaying, performing, distributing or
+creating derivative works based on this work or any other Project
+Gutenberg-tm work. The Foundation makes no representations concerning
+the copyright status of any work in any country outside the United
+States.
+
+1.E. Unless you have removed all references to Project Gutenberg:
+
+1.E.1. The following sentence, with active links to, or other immediate
+access to, the full Project Gutenberg-tm License must appear prominently
+whenever any copy of a Project Gutenberg-tm work (any work on which the
+phrase "Project Gutenberg" appears, or with which the phrase "Project
+Gutenberg" is associated) is accessed, displayed, performed, viewed,
+copied or distributed:
+
+This eBook is for the use of anyone anywhere at no cost and with
+almost no restrictions whatsoever. You may copy it, give it away or
+re-use it under the terms of the Project Gutenberg License included
+with this eBook or online at www.gutenberg.org
+
+1.E.2. If an individual Project Gutenberg-tm electronic work is derived
+from the public domain (does not contain a notice indicating that it is
+posted with permission of the copyright holder), the work can be copied
+and distributed to anyone in the United States without paying any fees
+or charges. If you are redistributing or providing access to a work
+with the phrase "Project Gutenberg" associated with or appearing on the
+work, you must comply either with the requirements of paragraphs 1.E.1
+through 1.E.7 or obtain permission for the use of the work and the
+Project Gutenberg-tm trademark as set forth in paragraphs 1.E.8 or
+1.E.9.
+
+1.E.3. If an individual Project Gutenberg-tm electronic work is posted
+with the permission of the copyright holder, your use and distribution
+must comply with both paragraphs 1.E.1 through 1.E.7 and any additional
+terms imposed by the copyright holder. Additional terms will be linked
+to the Project Gutenberg-tm License for all works posted with the
+permission of the copyright holder found at the beginning of this work.
+
+1.E.4. Do not unlink or detach or remove the full Project Gutenberg-tm
+License terms from this work, or any files containing a part of this
+work or any other work associated with Project Gutenberg-tm.
+
+1.E.5. Do not copy, display, perform, distribute or redistribute this
+electronic work, or any part of this electronic work, without
+prominently displaying the sentence set forth in paragraph 1.E.1 with
+active links or immediate access to the full terms of the Project
+Gutenberg-tm License.
+
+1.E.6. You may convert to and distribute this work in any binary,
+compressed, marked up, nonproprietary or proprietary form, including any
+word processing or hypertext form. However, if you provide access to or
+distribute copies of a Project Gutenberg-tm work in a format other than
+"Plain Vanilla ASCII" or other format used in the official version
+posted on the official Project Gutenberg-tm web site (www.gutenberg.org),
+you must, at no additional cost, fee or expense to the user, provide a
+copy, a means of exporting a copy, or a means of obtaining a copy upon
+request, of the work in its original "Plain Vanilla ASCII" or other
+form. Any alternate format must include the full Project Gutenberg-tm
+License as specified in paragraph 1.E.1.
+
+1.E.7. Do not charge a fee for access to, viewing, displaying,
+performing, copying or distributing any Project Gutenberg-tm works
+unless you comply with paragraph 1.E.8 or 1.E.9.
+
+1.E.8. You may charge a reasonable fee for copies of or providing
+access to or distributing Project Gutenberg-tm electronic works provided
+that
+
+- You pay a royalty fee of 20% of the gross profits you derive from
+ the use of Project Gutenberg-tm works calculated using the method
+ you already use to calculate your applicable taxes. The fee is
+ owed to the owner of the Project Gutenberg-tm trademark, but he
+ has agreed to donate royalties under this paragraph to the
+ Project Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation. Royalty payments
+ must be paid within 60 days following each date on which you
+ prepare (or are legally required to prepare) your periodic tax
+ returns. Royalty payments should be clearly marked as such and
+ sent to the Project Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation at the
+ address specified in Section 4, "Information about donations to
+ the Project Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation."
+
+- You provide a full refund of any money paid by a user who notifies
+ you in writing (or by e-mail) within 30 days of receipt that s/he
+ does not agree to the terms of the full Project Gutenberg-tm
+ License. You must require such a user to return or
+ destroy all copies of the works possessed in a physical medium
+ and discontinue all use of and all access to other copies of
+ Project Gutenberg-tm works.
+
+- You provide, in accordance with paragraph 1.F.3, a full refund of any
+ money paid for a work or a replacement copy, if a defect in the
+ electronic work is discovered and reported to you within 90 days
+ of receipt of the work.
+
+- You comply with all other terms of this agreement for free
+ distribution of Project Gutenberg-tm works.
+
+1.E.9. If you wish to charge a fee or distribute a Project Gutenberg-tm
+electronic work or group of works on different terms than are set
+forth in this agreement, you must obtain permission in writing from
+both the Project Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation and Michael
+Hart, the owner of the Project Gutenberg-tm trademark. Contact the
+Foundation as set forth in Section 3 below.
+
+1.F.
+
+1.F.1. Project Gutenberg volunteers and employees expend considerable
+effort to identify, do copyright research on, transcribe and proofread
+public domain works in creating the Project Gutenberg-tm
+collection. Despite these efforts, Project Gutenberg-tm electronic
+works, and the medium on which they may be stored, may contain
+"Defects," such as, but not limited to, incomplete, inaccurate or
+corrupt data, transcription errors, a copyright or other intellectual
+property infringement, a defective or damaged disk or other medium, a
+computer virus, or computer codes that damage or cannot be read by
+your equipment.
+
+1.F.2. LIMITED WARRANTY, DISCLAIMER OF DAMAGES - Except for the "Right
+of Replacement or Refund" described in paragraph 1.F.3, the Project
+Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation, the owner of the Project
+Gutenberg-tm trademark, and any other party distributing a Project
+Gutenberg-tm electronic work under this agreement, disclaim all
+liability to you for damages, costs and expenses, including legal
+fees. YOU AGREE THAT YOU HAVE NO REMEDIES FOR NEGLIGENCE, STRICT
+LIABILITY, BREACH OF WARRANTY OR BREACH OF CONTRACT EXCEPT THOSE
+PROVIDED IN PARAGRAPH 1.F.3. YOU AGREE THAT THE FOUNDATION, THE
+TRADEMARK OWNER, AND ANY DISTRIBUTOR UNDER THIS AGREEMENT WILL NOT BE
+LIABLE TO YOU FOR ACTUAL, DIRECT, INDIRECT, CONSEQUENTIAL, PUNITIVE OR
+INCIDENTAL DAMAGES EVEN IF YOU GIVE NOTICE OF THE POSSIBILITY OF SUCH
+DAMAGE.
+
+1.F.3. LIMITED RIGHT OF REPLACEMENT OR REFUND - If you discover a
+defect in this electronic work within 90 days of receiving it, you can
+receive a refund of the money (if any) you paid for it by sending a
+written explanation to the person you received the work from. If you
+received the work on a physical medium, you must return the medium with
+your written explanation. The person or entity that provided you with
+the defective work may elect to provide a replacement copy in lieu of a
+refund. If you received the work electronically, the person or entity
+providing it to you may choose to give you a second opportunity to
+receive the work electronically in lieu of a refund. If the second copy
+is also defective, you may demand a refund in writing without further
+opportunities to fix the problem.
+
+1.F.4. Except for the limited right of replacement or refund set forth
+in paragraph 1.F.3, this work is provided to you 'AS-IS,' WITH NO OTHER
+WARRANTIES OF ANY KIND, EXPRESS OR IMPLIED, INCLUDING BUT NOT LIMITED TO
+WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTIBILITY OR FITNESS FOR ANY PURPOSE.
+
+1.F.5. Some states do not allow disclaimers of certain implied
+warranties or the exclusion or limitation of certain types of damages.
+If any disclaimer or limitation set forth in this agreement violates the
+law of the state applicable to this agreement, the agreement shall be
+interpreted to make the maximum disclaimer or limitation permitted by
+the applicable state law. The invalidity or unenforceability of any
+provision of this agreement shall not void the remaining provisions.
+
+1.F.6. INDEMNITY - You agree to indemnify and hold the Foundation, the
+trademark owner, any agent or employee of the Foundation, anyone
+providing copies of Project Gutenberg-tm electronic works in accordance
+with this agreement, and any volunteers associated with the production,
+promotion and distribution of Project Gutenberg-tm electronic works,
+harmless from all liability, costs and expenses, including legal fees,
+that arise directly or indirectly from any of the following which you do
+or cause to occur: (a) distribution of this or any Project Gutenberg-tm
+work, (b) alteration, modification, or additions or deletions to any
+Project Gutenberg-tm work, and (c) any Defect you cause.
+
+
+Section 2. Information about the Mission of Project Gutenberg-tm
+
+Project Gutenberg-tm is synonymous with the free distribution of
+electronic works in formats readable by the widest variety of computers
+including obsolete, old, middle-aged and new computers. It exists
+because of the efforts of hundreds of volunteers and donations from
+people in all walks of life.
+
+Volunteers and financial support to provide volunteers with the
+assistance they need are critical to reaching Project Gutenberg-tm's
+goals and ensuring that the Project Gutenberg-tm collection will
+remain freely available for generations to come. In 2001, the Project
+Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation was created to provide a secure
+and permanent future for Project Gutenberg-tm and future generations.
+To learn more about the Project Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation
+and how your efforts and donations can help, see Sections 3 and 4
+and the Foundation web page at http://www.gutenberg.org/fundraising/pglaf.
+
+
+Section 3. Information about the Project Gutenberg Literary Archive
+Foundation
+
+The Project Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation is a non profit
+501(c)(3) educational corporation organized under the laws of the
+state of Mississippi and granted tax exempt status by the Internal
+Revenue Service. The Foundation's EIN or federal tax identification
+number is 64-6221541. Contributions to the Project Gutenberg
+Literary Archive Foundation are tax deductible to the full extent
+permitted by U.S. federal laws and your state's laws.
+
+The Foundation's principal office is located at 4557 Melan Dr. S.
+Fairbanks, AK, 99712., but its volunteers and employees are scattered
+throughout numerous locations. Its business office is located at
+809 North 1500 West, Salt Lake City, UT 84116, (801) 596-1887, email
+business@pglaf.org. Email contact links and up to date contact
+information can be found at the Foundation's web site and official
+page at http://www.gutenberg.org/about/contact
+
+For additional contact information:
+ Dr. Gregory B. Newby
+ Chief Executive and Director
+ gbnewby@pglaf.org
+
+Section 4. Information about Donations to the Project Gutenberg
+Literary Archive Foundation
+
+Project Gutenberg-tm depends upon and cannot survive without wide
+spread public support and donations to carry out its mission of
+increasing the number of public domain and licensed works that can be
+freely distributed in machine readable form accessible by the widest
+array of equipment including outdated equipment. Many small donations
+($1 to $5,000) are particularly important to maintaining tax exempt
+status with the IRS.
+
+The Foundation is committed to complying with the laws regulating
+charities and charitable donations in all 50 states of the United
+States. Compliance requirements are not uniform and it takes a
+considerable effort, much paperwork and many fees to meet and keep up
+with these requirements. We do not solicit donations in locations
+where we have not received written confirmation of compliance. To
+SEND DONATIONS or determine the status of compliance for any
+particular state visit http://www.gutenberg.org/fundraising/pglaf
+
+While we cannot and do not solicit contributions from states where we
+have not met the solicitation requirements, we know of no prohibition
+against accepting unsolicited donations from donors in such states who
+approach us with offers to donate.
+
+International donations are gratefully accepted, but we cannot make
+any statements concerning tax treatment of donations received from
+outside the United States. U.S. laws alone swamp our small staff.
+
+Please check the Project Gutenberg Web pages for current donation
+methods and addresses. Donations are accepted in a number of other
+ways including checks, online payments and credit card donations.
+To donate, please visit: http://www.gutenberg.org/fundraising/donate
+
+
+Section 5. General Information About Project Gutenberg-tm electronic
+works.
+
+Professor Michael S. Hart is the originator of the Project Gutenberg-tm
+concept of a library of electronic works that could be freely shared
+with anyone. For thirty years, he produced and distributed Project
+Gutenberg-tm eBooks with only a loose network of volunteer support.
+
+Project Gutenberg-tm eBooks are often created from several printed
+editions, all of which are confirmed as Public Domain in the U.S.
+unless a copyright notice is included. Thus, we do not necessarily
+keep eBooks in compliance with any particular paper edition.
+
+Each eBook is in a subdirectory of the same number as the eBook's
+eBook number, often in several formats including plain vanilla ASCII,
+compressed (zipped), HTML and others.
+
+Corrected EDITIONS of our eBooks replace the old file and take over
+the old filename and etext number. The replaced older file is renamed.
+VERSIONS based on separate sources are treated as new eBooks receiving
+new filenames and etext numbers.
+
+Most people start at our Web site which has the main PG search facility:
+
+<a href="http://www.gutenberg.org">http://www.gutenberg.org</a>
+
+This Web site includes information about Project Gutenberg-tm,
+including how to make donations to the Project Gutenberg Literary
+Archive Foundation, how to help produce our new eBooks, and how to
+subscribe to our email newsletter to hear about new eBooks.
+
+EBooks posted prior to November 2003, with eBook numbers BELOW #10000,
+are filed in directories based on their release date. If you want to
+download any of these eBooks directly, rather than using the regular
+search system you may utilize the following addresses and just
+download by the etext year.
+
+<a href="http://www.gutenberg.org/dirs/etext06/">http://www.gutenberg.org/dirs/etext06/</a>
+
+ (Or /etext 05, 04, 03, 02, 01, 00, 99,
+ 98, 97, 96, 95, 94, 93, 92, 92, 91 or 90)
+
+EBooks posted since November 2003, with etext numbers OVER #10000, are
+filed in a different way. The year of a release date is no longer part
+of the directory path. The path is based on the etext number (which is
+identical to the filename). The path to the file is made up of single
+digits corresponding to all but the last digit in the filename. For
+example an eBook of filename 10234 would be found at:
+
+http://www.gutenberg.org/dirs/1/0/2/3/10234
+
+or filename 24689 would be found at:
+http://www.gutenberg.org/dirs/2/4/6/8/24689
+
+An alternative method of locating eBooks:
+<a href="http://www.gutenberg.org/dirs/GUTINDEX.ALL">http://www.gutenberg.org/dirs/GUTINDEX.ALL</a>
+
+*** END: FULL LICENSE ***
+</pre>
+</body>
+</html>
diff --git a/33559-h/images/frontis1.jpg b/33559-h/images/frontis1.jpg
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..c6eaf5f
--- /dev/null
+++ b/33559-h/images/frontis1.jpg
Binary files differ
diff --git a/33559-h/images/logo2a.jpg b/33559-h/images/logo2a.jpg
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..bfec668
--- /dev/null
+++ b/33559-h/images/logo2a.jpg
Binary files differ
diff --git a/33559.txt b/33559.txt
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..3188f3d
--- /dev/null
+++ b/33559.txt
@@ -0,0 +1,7882 @@
+The Project Gutenberg eBook, At the Fall of Port Arthur, by Edward
+Stratemeyer, Illustrated by A. B. Shute
+
+
+This eBook is for the use of anyone anywhere at no cost and with
+almost no restrictions whatsoever. You may copy it, give it away or
+re-use it under the terms of the Project Gutenberg License included
+with this eBook or online at www.gutenberg.org
+
+
+
+
+
+Title: At the Fall of Port Arthur
+ Or, A Young American in the Japanese Navy
+
+
+Author: Edward Stratemeyer
+
+
+
+Release Date: August 28, 2010 [eBook #33559]
+
+Language: English
+
+Character set encoding: ISO-646-US (US-ASCII)
+
+
+***START OF THE PROJECT GUTENBERG EBOOK AT THE FALL OF PORT ARTHUR***
+
+
+E-text prepared by Carol Brown, Curtis Weyant, and the Project Gutenberg
+Online Distributed Proofreading Team (http://www.pgdp.net) from page
+images generously made available by Internet Archive/American Libraries
+(http://www.archive.org/details/americana)
+
+
+
+Note: Project Gutenberg also has an HTML version of this
+ file which includes the original illustration.
+ See 33559-h.htm or 33559-h.zip:
+ (http://www.gutenberg.org/files/33559/33559-h/33559-h.htm)
+ or
+ (http://www.gutenberg.org/files/33559/33559-h.zip)
+
+
+ Images of the original pages are available through
+ Internet Archive/American Libraries. See
+ http://www.archive.org/details/atfallofportarth00straiala
+
+
+
+
+
+Soldiers of Fortune Series
+
+AT THE FALL OF PORT ARTHUR
+
+Or
+
+A Young American in the Japanese Navy
+
+by
+
+EDWARD STRATEMEYER
+
+Author of "Under the Mikado's Flag," "On to Pekin," "Two Young
+Lumbermen," "Old Glory Series," "Colonial Series,"
+"Pan-American Series," etc.
+
+Illustrated by A. B. Shute
+
+
+[Illustration: "It is coming this way!" yelled Larry.----_Page 84._]
+
+
+
+
+
+
+
+[Illustration: Printer's logo]
+
+Boston:
+Lothrop, Lee & Shepard Co.
+1930
+
+Copyright, 1905, by Lothrop, Lee & Shepard Company
+
+All rights reserved
+
+AT THE FALL OF PORT ARTHUR
+
+Printed in U.S.A.
+
+
+
+
+ PREFACE
+
+
+"AT THE FALL OF PORT ARTHUR" is a complete tale in itself, but forms the
+third volume in a line issued under the general title of "Soldiers of
+Fortune Series."
+
+The story relates primarily the adventures of Larry Russell and his
+old-time sea chum, Luke Striker, already well known to the readers of my
+"Old Glory Series." Larry and Luke are aboard of their old ship, the
+_Columbia_, bound from Manila to Nagasaki, with a cargo designed for the
+Japanese Government. This is during the war between Russia and Japan,
+and when close to the Japanese coast the schooner is sighted by a
+Russian warship and made a prize of war.
+
+As prisoners both Larry and Luke see something of life in the Russian
+navy. When close to Vladivostok, the Russian warship falls in with
+several ships of the Japanese fleet, and after a thrilling sea-fight
+surrenders with her prize. This brings Larry and Luke before Admiral
+Togo, and as Larry's brother Ben, with their mutual friend, Gilbert
+Pennington, is already in the Japanese army, Larry enters the Japanese
+navy and Luke follows suit. The siege and bombardment of Port Arthur are
+at their height; and the particulars are given of many battles both on
+the sea and on land, leading up to the ultimate surrender of that brave
+Russian commander, General Stoessel, and the fall of the city. By this
+surrender the Japanese obtained many thousands of prisoners of war,
+hundreds of cannon, with large quantities of ammunition, and several
+scores of vessels, useful for either fighting purposes or as transports.
+Moreover, this victory placed the entire southern portion of Manchuria
+under Japanese control, giving the army untrammeled use of the railroad
+running from Port Arthur to Liao-Yang, a city on the road to Mukden,
+captured some time before, as already related in another volume of this
+series, entitled "Under the Mikado's Flag."
+
+As I have mentioned in a previous work, it is as yet impossible to state
+what the outcome of this terrific conflict will be. So far victory has
+perched largely upon the standard of Japan. The Russian navy has been
+practically shattered and its army fought to a standstill. The cost of
+the war has been tremendous to both countries. Countless thousands of
+lives have already been sacrificed. Would that peace were soon at hand!
+
+Again I thank my young friends for their appreciation of my former
+stories. May the present tale fulfill every reasonable expectation.
+
+ EDWARD STRATEMEYER.
+
+
+ CONTENTS
+
+
+ CHAPTER PAGE
+
+ I. LARRY AND HIS FRIENDS 1
+
+ II. A STORM ON THE PACIFIC 10
+
+ III. LARRY LEARNS SOMETHING 20
+
+ IV. THE RUSSIAN SAILOR'S PLOT 29
+
+ V. SIGNS OF A MUTINY 38
+
+ VI. THE FIGHT FOR THE SHIP 47
+
+ VII. THE MUTINEERS IN POSSESSION 56
+
+ VIII. TURNING THE TABLES 66
+
+ IX. CLOSE TO A WATERSPOUT 76
+
+ X. SOMETHING ABOUT WAR AND FIGHTING SHIPS 86
+
+ XI. AN ORDER TO LAY-TO 95
+
+ XII. TAKEN AS A PRIZE OF WAR 103
+
+ XIII. PRISONERS ON THE _Pocastra_ 113
+
+ XIV. PROGRESS OF THE WAR 122
+
+ XV. A SHARP NAVAL BATTLE 132
+
+ XVI. ABOARD A JAPANESE WARSHIP 140
+
+ XVII. THE RETAKING OF THE _Columbia_ 148
+
+ XVIII. A CLEVER RUSE 156
+
+ XIX. THE DISAPPEARANCE OF THE ENEMY 164
+
+ XX. LARRY BEFORE ADMIRAL TOGO 171
+
+ XXI. LETTERS OF INTEREST 180
+
+ XXII. A MEETING AND A PLOT 189
+
+ XXIII. THE ATTACK IN THE DARK 198
+
+ XXIV. THE DEFENSE OF THE POWDER TRAIN 206
+
+ XXV. BOMBARDING A PORT ARTHUR FORT 215
+
+ XXVI. BEN MEETS CAPTAIN BARUSKY 223
+
+ XXVII. A FIERCE BATTLE AT SEA 232
+
+ XXVIII. THE SIEGE OF PORT ARTHUR 240
+
+ XXIX. FROM ONE DIFFICULTY TO ANOTHER 248
+
+ XXX. A SURPRISE FOR LARRY 258
+
+ XXXI. A CALL TO REPEL BOARDERS 266
+
+ XXXII. FALL OF PORT ARTHUR--CONCLUSION 274
+
+
+AT THE FALL OF PORT ARTHUR
+
+
+AT THE FALL OF PORT
+ARTHUR
+
+
+
+
+CHAPTER I
+
+LARRY AND HIS FRIENDS
+
+
+"Unless I miss my guess, Luke, we are going to have a storm."
+
+"Jest what I was thinking, Larry. And when it comes I allow as how it
+will be putty heavy," replied Luke Striker, casting an eye to the
+westward, where a small dark cloud was beginning to show above the
+horizon.
+
+"Well, we can't expect fine weather all the time," went on Larry
+Russell, inspecting the cloud with equal interest. "We want some wind
+anyway," he added. "We are not making this return trip to Nagasaki
+nearly as fast as we made the trip to Manila."
+
+Luke Striker, a bronzed and weather-beaten Yankee sailor, rubbed his
+chin reflectively. "I was jest thinking o' the day I spied the old
+_Columbia_ in Manila harbor," he said, meditatively. "Tell ye, Larry,
+the sight 'most struck me dumb. 'The _Columbia_,' sez I to myself. An'
+then I thought I must be a-dreamin'. I wanted to find this ship ag'in in
+the worst way."
+
+"The ship certainly seems like a home to me, Luke--and I reckon she
+always will seem that way. I've traveled a good many miles in her, since
+I first struck her at Honolulu in the Hawaiian Islands," responded Larry
+Russell.
+
+"Yes--both of us have. But we never took no trip like this
+afore--carryin' a cargo for the Japanese Government, with that
+government at war with Russia." Luke Striker lowered his voice. "What's
+the outlook? Does the old man reckon to fall in with a Russian warship
+afore we can reach Nagasaki?"
+
+"Hush, Luke; you mustn't mention our cargo," came from Larry Russell,
+hastily.
+
+"I ain't mentionin' it to anybody but you."
+
+"Captain Ponsberry is in hopes that we shall not meet any Russian
+warships."
+
+"But what if we do?"
+
+"Then we shall have to show our heels as best we can."
+
+"A sailing vessel can't show much o' a pair o' heels to a man-o'-war."
+
+"That is true."
+
+"I suppose, if the _Columbia_ was overhauled by a Russian warship,
+they'd consider us a prize of war; wouldn't they?" continued the old
+Yankee sailor.
+
+"They would, unless Captain Ponsberry could get out of it in some way."
+
+"How do you think he might get out of it?"
+
+"Well, you must remember that our cargo doesn't belong to the Japanese
+Government yet. We are carrying it from Manila to Nagasaki for the
+Richmond Importing Company. The Russians would have to prove their case
+against us before they could claim the schooner as a legitimate prize of
+war."
+
+"I see. Well, I reckon as how them Russians would do 'most anything to
+square accounts with the Japs. So far, accordin' to my notions, they
+have been losin' ground right along in this war."
+
+"Yes, and they'll lose more before the Japs are through with 'em, Luke.
+But that storm is coming up fast," went on Larry Russell, with another
+examination of the black cloud. "I'll have to tell the captain. If we
+don't shorten sail it may do us some damage."
+
+With the last-mentioned remark Larry Russell walked aft, toward the
+companionway of the _Columbia_, a staunch three-masted schooner that
+hailed from Gloucester. He was second mate of the craft and as such it
+was now his duty to inform Captain Nat Ponsberry that a storm was
+approaching.
+
+To those of my young friends who have read "Under Dewey at Manila" and
+other volumes of the "Old Glory Series" Larry Russell needs no
+introduction. He was one of three brothers, who, left in the charge of a
+miserly step-uncle, had thought it best to go away from home and seek
+fortune in various parts of the globe. Larry had drifted to San
+Francisco and then to Honolulu, where he had fallen in with Captain Nat
+Ponsberry and the _Columbia_, as already mentioned. He, with his sailor
+friend, Luke Striker, had been cast away, and while adrift on the
+Pacific had been picked up by the Asiatic Squadron under Commodore
+(afterward Admiral) Dewey, to serve with honor during the memorable
+battle of Manila Bay.
+
+Since those days a great many things had occurred to the Russell boys.
+Ben, the oldest of the three, had served as a young volunteer in Cuba
+during the advance on Santiago, and as an officer with the army in the
+Philippines, and Walter, the third brother, had served in the navy in
+Cuban waters and elsewhere. In the meantime the miserly step-uncle had
+reformed, and now thought "his three boys," as he called them, "the best
+young fellers in all America, barrin' none!"
+
+Larry Russell was a natural sailor, and when his term in the navy came
+to an end he could not bear to think of giving up the sea. He heard that
+his old ship was bound for a trip to Japan and other ports, and at once
+communicated with Captain Ponsberry, with the result that he became
+second mate of the schooner, the first mate being, as of old, Tom
+Grandon, a personal friend of Captain Ponsberry.
+
+At this time Walter Russell had gone into business, and was doing
+remarkably well. But Ben was doing nothing, and Larry persuaded his
+oldest brother to come aboard the ship at Manila, for the trip to
+Nagasaki and Port Arthur. This was just at the outbreak of the war
+between Russia and Japan, but the brothers at that time knew nothing
+about the tremendous conflict so close at hand.
+
+The _Columbia_ was carrying a cargo for the Richmond Importing Company,
+represented in Japan and China by Gilbert Pennington, who had served
+with Ben Russell in our army in Cuba and the Philippines. From Manila
+Gilbert had gone to China, to fight the Boxers, as already described in
+"On to Pekin," the first volume of this "Soldiers of Fortune Series."
+With the end of the Boxer conflict, Lieutenant Pennington, as he had
+then become, turned from war to business, and soon made a number of
+business transactions which were highly gratifying to the company that
+he represented.
+
+When the _Columbia_ arrived at Nagasaki, Captain Ponsberry learned that
+the war had begun and that to get to Port Arthur--a Russian stronghold
+in Manchuria--was out of the question. While he was awaiting orders
+Gilbert Pennington appeared on the scene. Gilbert had had great
+difficulties in getting away from Port Arthur, having been suspected by
+the Russian officials of being a spy. He wished to know at once if the
+ship's cargo was safe.
+
+"As safe as when we left home," had been Captain Ponsberry's reply.
+
+"Good!" answered the young agent, and then he wished to know if anything
+had been done about selling the goods. Captain Ponsberry replied that he
+had been ordered to do nothing until he received word from Gilbert. This
+suited the young representative; and the upshot of the matter was that
+the cargo, instead of going to a Russian port, was sold to the Japanese
+Government at a price considerably above the ordinary market value.
+
+Gilbert Pennington was enthusiastic about joining the Japanese army for
+a campaign in Manchuria and he imparted a large share of this enthusiasm
+to Ben Russell. As a result both enlisted and became captains in a
+special command, under a Major Okopa, who could speak very good English.
+The part of the army to which they were assigned landed at Chinampo, in
+Korea, and in the second volume of this series, called "Under the
+Mikado's Flag," I related the particulars of the crossing of the Yalu
+River and of the many skirmishes and battles leading up to the terrific
+ten-days' contest before Liao Yang. During these fights Ben and Gilbert
+did their full duty as officers, and when the Russians retreated to the
+North both were well content to take a much-needed rest. But additional
+struggles were still in store for them, as will be learned in the pages
+which follow.
+
+At first Larry Russell had been inclined to follow his brother and his
+friend Gilbert into the Japanese army. But Captain Ponsberry did not
+wish to lose his services as a second mate, and when it was decided that
+the _Columbia_ should make a quick run to Manila and back, for another
+cargo for the Japanese Government, he made up his mind to stick to the
+ship.
+
+The run to Manila from Nagasaki was made without special incident, and,
+once at the main seaport of the Philippines, Captain Ponsberry lost no
+time in getting on board the cargo the Richmond Importing Company had
+ready for him. The cargo was a valuable one and it was calculated that
+if rightly sold it would yield the company a profit of five or six
+thousand dollars.
+
+"You have got to take care and not run into any Russian warship," said
+the agent of the company at Manila. "If you do you may have a whole lot
+of trouble in explaining matters to the Russian commander's
+satisfaction. I see by the reports that the Russians have already held
+up several English and South American ships."
+
+"I shall keep a sharp lookout for 'em," was Captain Ponsberry's reply.
+
+"And another thing, Captain," went on the agent, in a lower tone; "you
+want to watch your crew."
+
+"What do you mean?"
+
+"I don't like the looks of two or three of them. For all you know they
+may be more than willing to expose you--if you fall in with the
+Russians. Can you trust your first and second mates?"
+
+"I can! They are as honest as myself."
+
+"Then caution them to keep an eye on the hands. One of those fellows
+looks like a Russian to me--the chap with the heavy black beard."
+
+"You mean Semmel. He says he is a Pole and that he hates the Russians."
+
+"Humph! Well, I saw him talking to a lot of Russians night before last.
+And when they passed a Jap the whole crowd jeered at the little brown
+man."
+
+"Semmel, too?"
+
+"Yes."
+
+"Then I shall watch him," answered Captain Ponsberry, decidedly.
+
+"Do, but don't let him know it. Some of these foreign sailors are ugly
+when they find out they are being suspected."
+
+"Trust me to manage him," returned the commander of the _Columbia_; and
+there the talk on the subject came to an end.
+
+
+
+
+CHAPTER II
+
+A STORM ON THE PACIFIC
+
+
+Larry found Captain Ponsberry working over a chart on the cabin table,
+laying out the course of the ship. The commander of the _Columbia_ was a
+bluff, hearty individual and he and the young second mate thought a
+great deal of each other.
+
+"Well, what is it?" asked the captain, looking up quickly.
+
+"I came to report that a storm is coming up from the west," answered
+Larry.
+
+"Humph! I was afraid we'd catch it sooner or later. Is it close up yet?"
+
+"It's coming up pretty fast."
+
+Captain Ponsberry said no more, but threw down his parallel rulers and
+his pencil. Catching up his cap, he mounted to the deck, and the young
+second mate followed at his heels. The captain gave a long look to the
+westward and then a gaze around the remainder of the horizon.
+
+"Tell Cal Vincent to call all hands to shorten sail!" he called out to
+Larry. "Tell 'em to tumble up quick, too--thet storm ain't none too far
+off for comfort!"
+
+Larry passed the word to Cal Vincent, who was the boatswain of the
+_Columbia_, and soon the whistle piped up shrilly, and those who were
+below or in the forecastle, came on deck in a hurry. Already the wind
+was freshening, ruffling up the whitecaps in all directions. The sky,
+that had been so blue a short while before, became leaden, and the
+depths of the ocean took on a somber hue. The barometer indicated a
+great and immediate change.
+
+"Lay aloft there, men!" cried Captain Ponsberry. "Our sails are mostly
+new and we don't want them ripped up if we can help it. Skip along
+there, Peterson!" The latter words to a big sailor who was moving across
+the deck at a snail's pace.
+
+The sailor addressed, scowled. It was not his watch on deck and he hated
+to have his midday nap disturbed.
+
+"Got a nail in ma boot," he said.
+
+"Well, haul it out--after the sails are trimmed," returned the captain,
+and then turned to another hand: "Semmel, what's the matter with you?"
+This to the suspicious-looking sailor with the heavy black beard.
+
+"Nodding," grumbled Semmel, and turned away sulkily.
+
+"Then get a move on, or we may lose a stick as well as a sail," and
+there followed a perfect volley of orders in a tone that none of the
+sailors misunderstood. Up to the yards they crawled like so many
+monkeys, and soon the creaking of halyard blocks was heard, as the
+topsails came down. The jib and flying jib were also taken in, and a
+little later the main-course and the mizzen-course.
+
+"Reckon we can stand the fore-course for a little while longer," said
+Captain Ponsberry to Tom Grandon. "What do you think?"
+
+"We can, unless it comes quicker nor it is coming now," returned the
+first mate.
+
+"Well, keep an eye on the wind and reef her as soon as it begins to look
+nasty," said Captain Ponsberry, and returned to the cabin, to finish his
+nautical calculations.
+
+The _Columbia_ had left the last of the Philippines behind and was
+headed north through the China Sea toward the lower extremity of
+Formosa. She was not as new a ship as when Larry had first boarded her
+at Honolulu, for since that time she had seen half a dozen years of hard
+service. But Captain Ponsberry was a careful man and believed in making
+repairs as soon as they were needed, so there was small danger of her
+opening her seams or going to pieces even in the stiffest of blows. She
+leaked a little--the best of ships do that--but a short pumping every
+morning kept the water at the bottom of the well.
+
+As second mate, it was Larry's duty to see that everything on the deck
+was "ship-shape," and this was especially necessary when a storm was
+coming up. He made a tour of the ship, his keen eyes taking in every
+detail.
+
+As it happened, an hour before he had set the sailor Semmel to work
+stowing away some odds and ends of rope. He had supposed that this task
+was long since finished, but now he found the ropes scattered about as
+before.
+
+"See here, Semmel," he called out, "why didn't you stow away those ropes
+as I told you?"
+
+"Stow dem avay in a leetle vile," answered the sailor with the heavy
+beard.
+
+"You'll stow them away now," returned Larry, sharply. He did not at all
+fancy the manner of the hand he was addressing. "I told you to do it an
+hour ago. We don't want anything loose on deck when this storm hits us."
+
+"Vincent kicked de ropes out dare," growled Semmel. "I had nodding to do
+mit 'em."
+
+"That isn't here or there. I told you to stow them away, and I want you
+to do it. If you don't, I'll have to report you to the captain."
+
+"Oh, I do him!" grumbled Semmel, but he glared at Larry as if he wished
+to chew the young second mate up. "You put all dare vork on me, hey?" he
+added, after a pause.
+
+"You've got to do your share of it."
+
+"Humph!" Semmel seemed on the point of saying more, but shut his teeth
+and began to arrange the ropes in proper order. Larry watched him for a
+moment and then walked away. As soon as his back was turned the sailor
+shook his fist at the young second mate.
+
+"You vait!" he muttered. "Chust vait, you Jankee rat!"
+
+The sky kept growing darker, and soon came a puff of wind much heavier
+than any that had gone before. The _Columbia_ had been moving over the
+waves on an even keel, but now she gave a sudden lurch to starboard.
+
+"Reckon it's time to take them reefs in the fore-course," said Grandon to
+Larry, and soon the sailors were at work on the sheets, leaving just
+sufficient canvas up to make the schooner mind her helm. It was hard
+work, for the sudden gusts made the sail snap and crack like a whip.
+
+So far it had not rained a drop, but now came a sudden downpour, the
+drops "as big as hen's eggs," to use Luke Striker's manner of describing
+them. Then came a flash of lightning out of the western sky, followed by
+a rumble of thunder.
+
+"This is going to be an old-time storm," was Larry's comment, as he met
+Luke Striker near the forecastle. "I'll have to get my oilskin out."
+
+Luke already had his raincoat on and soon the young mate was similarly
+provided. Wind and rain were increasing, and presently there came a
+flash of lightning and a clap of thunder that made everybody jump. The
+thunder brought Captain Ponsberry to the deck in a hurry.
+
+"Did that hit us?" he questioned, looking around anxiously.
+
+"No, sir, but it was pretty close," replied Grandon.
+
+"Is everything secure?" went on the commander, to Larry.
+
+"Yes, sir."
+
+It was difficult to converse further, for the wind was now whistling
+through the rigging, driving the rain in sheets across the deck. All had
+to hold fast for fear of being swept overboard. On every side the sea
+was lashing itself into a foam and the waves were growing higher and
+higher. At one instant the _Columbia_ would seem to be riding on top of
+a mountain, the next she would sink down and down into the trough of the
+sea.
+
+"Well, Larry, how do you like this?" questioned Captain Ponsberry, as he
+took a position beside the second mate.
+
+"Oh, I don't mind it at all," was the cheery answer. "I used to mind the
+storms, but I've got used to them."
+
+"This isn't a plaything we are getting."
+
+"Oh, I know that--you can see it by the way the wind is driving us. But
+we are not near any land, are we?"
+
+"No."
+
+"Then we'll be sure to outride it. I feel I can bank on the old
+_Columbia_ for almost anything."
+
+At this Captain Ponsberry laid an affectionate hand on his second mate's
+shoulder.
+
+"Reckon you love the old craft about as well as I do," he said.
+
+"I don't know about that--you've been on board so many more years than
+myself. But to me she is a second home."
+
+"I see. Well, let us hope we get through with this trip in safety."
+
+"Don't you imagine we'll do it?" questioned Larry, quickly.
+
+"Certainly. But you must remember that we may have trouble if we fall in
+with any Russian warship." Captain Ponsberry lowered his voice. "Did you
+have trouble with Semmel?"
+
+"A little. I ordered him to coil up some ropes and he didn't obey me
+right away. But he stowed them away afterwards."
+
+Captain Ponsberry drew a long breath. "The more I see of that chap the
+less I like him."
+
+"I never liked him from the start," answered Larry, frankly. "But you'll
+have to give him credit for being a good all-round sailor."
+
+"There is no doubt but what he is that, Larry. But he has a bad eye."
+
+"What do you think he could do to harm us?"
+
+"Nothing--unless we fell in with a Russian warship. In that case, if he
+was a Russian sympathizer, he might expose the fact that while we are
+carrying a cargo for the Richmond Importing Company the goods are really
+meant for the Japanese Government."
+
+"Does he know that?"
+
+"I'm not sure, one way or the other. What I am afraid of is, that he may
+know a good bit more nor we suspect."
+
+"I see." The young second mate mused for a moment. "I'll tell you what
+I'd do, if I thought he was going to play me foul--and we fell in with a
+Russian warship. I'd clap him below decks, out of sight until the
+warship went on her way again."
+
+"That's easily said; but I can't make him a prisoner unless I can prove
+something against him."
+
+"You can lock him up if he is sulky and won't obey orders."
+
+"Yes, that is true. Still----Phew!"
+
+The captain broke off short, for a vivid streak of lightning flared all
+over the upper masts of the ship. The thunder-clap was as sharp as it
+was deafening, and for the moment all on board thought the _Columbia_
+had surely been struck. Then came a downpour which made even the boldest
+of the sailors seek shelter.
+
+"That was closer than I like," was Larry's comment, after it was
+ascertained that the ship was unharmed.
+
+"'Most knocked me overboard," came from Luke Striker. "Gosh! reckon my
+hair's singed," and he put up his hand and ran his fingers through his
+grayish locks. "Don't want another like thet nohow!"
+
+A few minutes later came another flash of lightning, but this was to the
+eastward, showing that the center of the storm had passed them. The wind
+was apparently going down, but the sea was as angry as ever and would be
+for hours to come.
+
+Luke had retired to the forecastle with several other sailors. Larry's
+watch on deck was also at an end, and he was just on the point of going
+below, when from the west came a curious humming sound which made the
+young second mate pause. The humming increased, and then of a sudden the
+_Columbia_ was caught in a hurricane blast that threw her far over on
+her side.
+
+"Help!" Larry heard, in the voice of Captain Ponsberry. "Somebody help
+me, quick, or I'll go overboard!"
+
+
+
+
+CHAPTER III
+
+LARRY LEARNS SOMETHING
+
+
+The accident which had happened to Captain Nat Ponsberry was certainly a
+curious one, although similar to that which once cost the life of a
+young officer in our navy.
+
+When the hurricane blast reached the _Columbia_, the captain was in the
+act of slipping on a lined raincoat,--a big affair, with long sleeves
+and an extra high collar. One arm was in the coat and the other was
+going down the sleeve when it caught in the lining. At that instant the
+shock threw the captain across the deck and almost over the railing. He
+caught at the railing with his free hand, but his other hand remained a
+prisoner in the coat sleeve, while the garment itself stuck in a bunch
+across his shoulders.
+
+"Help!" he roared again. He tried to pull himself up, and to free the
+hand in the sleeve, but found both impossible.
+
+Larry did not wait for a second cry for assistance. He knew the captain
+so well that he felt the officer would only call when in dire peril. He
+ran out on the slippery deck in double-quick order.
+
+"Hullo, where are you?" he yelled.
+
+"Here! Help!"
+
+The young second mate caught sight of the captain not a moment too soon.
+Another lurch of the _Columbia_ had thrown him completely over the rail,
+and there he clung with one hand, while the spray was flying all over
+him.
+
+Not waiting to count the possible cost, Larry slid rather than ran to
+the rail. Years before he had learned a trick which now stood him in
+good stead. He wound his legs around the under rail, catching the upper
+one with his left hand. Then he clutched Captain Ponsberry by the
+tangled-up arm.
+
+"On deck there!" he yelled. "Throw a rope this way, and hurry up about
+it!"
+
+"What's the trouble?" came from Tom Grandon, who had been in another
+part of the ship and had not heard the captain's cry.
+
+"The captain is almost overboard. Throw us a rope."
+
+Tom Grandon was quick to act. The rope came whizzing toward Larry, and
+in a twinkling he had it around his body and also around the captain.
+
+"Haul in!" he called, and Grandon and two sailors did so. Over the rail
+came Captain Ponsberry, still fighting to release the tangled-up arm. In
+a moment more all danger was past.
+
+"Well, how in the world did this happen?" questioned Grandon.
+
+"Tell ye--soon as I can git free o' this consarned coat!" spluttered
+Captain Ponsberry, and he gave the garment a jerk that ripped one of the
+sleeves completely in half. "Did ye ever see sech foolishness?" he
+added. And then he told how the lurch of the ship had carried him over
+the rail just when he could use but one hand. "After this I reckon I'll
+put on my coat afore I go on deck," he concluded.
+
+"It was a lucky thing that Larry heard you cry out," said the first
+mate. "I was at the wheel, helping Groot."
+
+"That's right, Tom." The captain turned to the youth. "Larry, you're a
+brave one, and always was. I ain't going to forget this!"
+
+"Oh, don't say anything about it," came from the young second mate,
+modestly. "I know you'd do as much for me, if I needed it."
+
+"Well, I would, an' there's my hand on it," cried Captain Ponsberry,
+heartily, and gave Larry a grip that made him wince.
+
+The storm kept up for the remainder of the day. But its worst fury was
+spent, and during the night the wind went down to nothing more than a
+stiff breeze, which was just what was wanted. All of the sails were
+again set; and the schooner resumed her course as before.
+
+Before leaving Manila Larry had purchased a number of newspapers printed
+in that city in English. So far he had had no chance to look the sheets
+over, but now came two days in which there was little to do, and he
+spent several hours in devouring the news, while he also let his friend
+Luke do some reading.
+
+"Tell ye what, this 'ere war between Russia and Japan is goin' to be a
+big thing," said Luke, after reading an account of the first fights on
+land and on sea. "It ain't goin' to be no such short affair as our
+little rumpus in Cuby."
+
+"You are right, Luke; this war is going to be a long and bitter one."
+
+"Who is goin' to win, do you think?"
+
+"I'm sure I don't know. Russia is a vast country, with millions of
+people and with an immense army and navy. I suppose she can put five
+times as many men in the field as Japan can."
+
+"But them Japs know how to fight."
+
+"Indeed they do--they have proved that already. And what is to their
+advantage, they are closer to Korea and Manchuria than Russia is. They
+can get on the fighting ground quicker,--which counts for a good deal."
+
+"How those Russians must have been astonished when the Japanese warships
+sailed into 'em at Port Arthur last February. I don't believe they were
+expecting an attack."
+
+"Hardly, for war had just been declared. But you wouldn't have caught
+Uncle Sam napping like that, Luke."
+
+"Right ye are, lad; it ain't his style. An' then to see how them Japs
+have been a-blowin' up the Russian warships ever since. They must have a
+fine navy."
+
+"Yes, and good gunners, too. I was told in Nagasaki that quite a few
+American gunners were on their ships--fellows who served under Dewey at
+Manila and under Sampson and Schley off Cuba."
+
+"I believe you, lad. When a feller gits it in his bones to fight on a
+warship there ain't no life on a merchantman goin' to satisfy him. Some
+jackies would rather fight nor eat--you know thet as well as I do."
+
+"Well, I shouldn't mind doing some fighting myself. You know I was on a
+stand about going with Ben and Gilbert Pennington."
+
+"Where do you reckon they are now?"
+
+"In Manchuria, I suppose, fighting as hard as they can. I thought I
+would get a letter from them before we left Manila, but nothing came."
+
+"I suppose the mails are all upset, on account of the war," put in Cal
+Vincent, who sat nearby, sewing a button on his shirt. "If you'll
+remember, Nagasaki was in a big state of excitement while we were there
+last."
+
+"Did they say anything about any Russian warships bein' in these parts?"
+questioned Luke.
+
+"No."
+
+"It would be strange if we did fall in with them."
+
+"Which puts me in mind," came from the boatswain, and then he gazed
+around to see if any other persons were near. "Semmel says he ain't no
+Russian, but it's dollars to doughnuts he is," he continued, in a
+lowered tone.
+
+"Have you discovered anything new?" demanded Larry.
+
+"Yes and no. Last night I overheard him and Peterson talking in a
+suspicious kind of a way. I didn't catch much, for they talked partly in
+English and partly in a foreign language. But I am sure they are
+favoring Russia, and Semmel said something about doing something to harm
+Japan."
+
+"I don't see how they could do anything on board of this ship," came
+from Luke.
+
+"You didn't hear anything definite?"
+
+"Can't say that I did," answered the boatswain.
+
+"We had better watch them closer than ever."
+
+"All right; I'll do my share," responded Vincent, and Luke Striker said
+the same.
+
+That very afternoon Larry had another quarrel with the sailor with the
+long beard. Semmel had a bucket of dirty water which he was carrying to
+the ship's side. As Larry passed he pretended to stub his toe and
+allowed some of the dirty water to flow over the young second mate's
+foot.
+
+"Semmel, what did you do that for?" cried Larry, indignantly.
+
+"Canno help dat," said the sailor. "I slip."
+
+"You did it on purpose!"
+
+"Oh, no!" And the sailor grinned wickedly.
+
+"I say you did. If you try anything like that again, I'll make it warm
+for you. Get a swab and clean the deck up at once!"
+
+As Semmel sauntered off, and while Larry was stamping the water from his
+shoe, Captain Ponsberry came up. He had seen the trick played from a
+distance.
+
+"What did you tell Semmel?" he questioned, sharply.
+
+"Told him to swab the deck up. I think he slopped the dirty water over
+me on purpose."
+
+"Just my idea of it. I'll tell him what I think of it." And striding
+after the bearded sailor Captain Ponsberry gave him a lecture not to be
+readily forgotten.
+
+"I won't have any of your dirty underhanded work aboard of my ship," he
+concluded. "Either you'll behave yourself, or I'll put you in irons."
+
+"In irons!" ejaculated Semmel, scowling viciously.
+
+"That is what I said and that is what I mean. Ever since you came on
+board you have been acting in this same dirty fashion and I want it
+stopped. Now swab up that deck, and see that you make a first-class job
+of it. For two pins I'd make you black Russell's shoes."
+
+"No black nobody's shoes," growled Semmel, but in such a low tone that
+Captain Ponsberry could not hear him. He cleaned the deck in his own
+ugly, independent manner, muttering imprecations against both Larry and
+the captain in the meantime.
+
+As a matter of fact, even though he had denied it to Captain Ponsberry
+and others, Ostag Semmel was really a Russian by birth, having been born
+and raised in the seaport of Kolaska. He had been drafted into the army,
+but not wishing to serve under a military rule which is unusually
+severe, he had run away to sea and become a sailor.
+
+Life on the ocean suited Semmel very well and he would have remained
+away from Russia had it not been for the fact that a rich uncle had died
+leaving him a property valued at two thousand dollars--a small fortune
+in the eyes of a man of this Russian's standing. He wished to go back to
+claim his inheritance, but feared to do so, for he knew that once on
+Russian soil he would be arrested for desertion, and might be sent to a
+military prison for a great number of years.
+
+From a friend in Manila he had heard of something which interested him
+greatly. This was the news that another deserter from the Russian army
+had been pardoned for his offense because he had taken home with him
+important news concerning the movements of a certain Japanese warship.
+
+"If I could only do as well," he told himself, over and over again, and
+then, when he signed articles for the _Columbia's_ trip, he listened
+eagerly to some talk he overheard about the ship's cargo. When he began
+to suspect the truth--that the cargo was meant for the Japanese
+Government--his eyes glistened cunningly.
+
+"If I can only let Russia know of this!" he reasoned. "All will go well
+with me. If I can only let Russia know!"
+
+
+
+
+CHAPTER IV
+
+THE RUSSIAN SAILOR'S PLOT
+
+
+Captain Ponsberry's stern manner made Ostag Semmel wild with hatred, and
+when he went back to the forecastle after swabbing up the deck he was in
+a fit mental condition for almost any dark deed.
+
+For a good half-hour he lay in his bunk in a corner, brooding over his
+ill-luck and wondering what he could do to revenge himself upon both the
+master of the schooner and Larry. Larry he especially disliked--the very
+open-heartedness of the young second mate made him long to do the lad
+harm.
+
+At the end of the half-hour another sailor came in. It was Carl
+Peterson, his close friend. Peterson was a burly tar who had visited
+nearly every quarter of the globe. He loved to drink and carouse, and
+was ever ready to lend a hand in any excitement that offered. There was
+a rumor that he had once led a mutiny on a Danish merchant vessel, but
+this he denied, laying the blame entirely on others.
+
+"Is that you, Peterson?" demanded Semmel, in his native tongue, for he
+knew that the other could speak Russian fluently.
+
+"Yes," came in a rough voice from Peterson. He gave a coarse laugh. "A
+fine job you made of it, to pour dirty water over Russell and then have
+to swab up the deck for it."
+
+"Who told you of that?"
+
+"Didn't I see it with my own eyes--and heard what the captain said,
+too."
+
+"Bah! It makes me sick!" growled Semmel. "I am sick of the ship--the
+crew--everything!"
+
+Peterson gave a short toss of his head, which was covered with a shock
+of fiery red hair. "What are you going to do about it? Even if the
+captain treats you like a dog, what shall you do, Ostag Semmel? He
+thinks we are all curs--door mats to wipe feet on!"
+
+"He shall find out that I am neither a dog nor a door mat!" muttered the
+bearded Russian. "By my right hand I promise you that!"
+
+"Talk is cheap--it takes wind to make the mill go," answered Peterson.
+To an outsider it would have been plain to see that he was leading
+Semmel on, in an endeavor to find out what was in his companion's mind.
+
+"It will not end in talk."
+
+"Bah! I have heard that before."
+
+"I have been thinking," went on Ostag Semmel, slowly. "Can I trust you?"
+
+"You know you can."
+
+"You do not love the captain--do not love that Russell?"
+
+"Do I act as if I did?"
+
+"Good! Now, how many on board of this ship?"
+
+"Fourteen men, counting in ourselves."
+
+"You count fairly. Fourteen, how many are our friends?"
+
+"Postnak and Conroy, at least."
+
+"Then we are four, so far. Now, what of Groot and Shamhaven and Jack
+Wilbur?"
+
+"Groot is a good fellow and a man who wishes to make money."
+
+"And Shamhaven will do almost anything for money--he once told me so. He
+took a sailor suit from a store in Manila without paying for it."
+
+"I know that too. The tailor was rich and didn't need the money," and
+Peterson gave another coarse laugh.
+
+"Then we are six--to stand up for our rights. And Jack Wilbur will make
+seven--just half the number on the ship."
+
+"How can we count that Wilbur in? He is a Yankee."
+
+"He is a weakling and we can manage him,--and I think we can manage some
+others, too--when we get that far."
+
+"How far do you mean?" demanded Peterson, although he knew about what
+was coming.
+
+"Is anybody else near here?"
+
+"No," and Peterson took a careful look around.
+
+"Supposing we seize the ship--in the name of the Russian Government?
+They have a Japanese cargo on board, the captain cannot deny it. We can
+take the ship, sail her to some Russian port, and win both prize money
+and glory. Is it not a grand scheme?"
+
+"Ha, that is fine!" Carl Peterson's eyes glowed voraciously. "Ostag, you
+are a man after my own heart! We might become rich!"
+
+"Then you like the plan?"
+
+"Yes--providing we can make it work. But it is a big undertaking. If we
+were caught we might swing from a yardarm for it."
+
+"We can make it work--I have another plan for that. I have thought it
+out completely. We can--but more later," and Ostag Semmel broke off
+abruptly, as several sailors entered the forecastle. A little later he
+began to complain in broken English to a sailor named Jack Wilbur that
+he was suffering from a severe stomach ache.
+
+"Sorry to hear on it," said Wilbur, who was a very mild foremast hand.
+"Anything I can do for you?"
+
+"I dink not," answered Semmel. "I dink de poor grub ve git mak me feel
+pad."
+
+"Didn't notice that the grub was poor," answered Wilbur.
+
+"Very poor--not so goot as py my las' ship," answered Semmel. "Some grub
+here not fit to eat."
+
+It was soon noised around that Semmel was not feeling well and that he
+had complained that the food dealt out at noontime had made him sick. As
+soon as Captain Ponsberry heard of this he went to interview Jeff, the
+colored cook, who, as of old, was singing gayly to himself among the
+pots and pans of the ship's galley.
+
+"Wasn't nuffin de mattah wid dat grub, Cap'n Ponsberry," exclaimed Jeff,
+after hearing what the commander of the ship had to say. "It was jess as
+good as we always has."
+
+"Was it thoroughly cooked?"
+
+"Yes, sah--I don't 'low nuffin to go from dis yere galley 'less it am
+well cooked."
+
+"Are your pots and kettles clean?"
+
+"Yes, sah--yo' can see fo' yourself, sah."
+
+The captain did see, and moreover he knew that Jeff was usually a
+careful and conscientious culinary artist who always gave the men the
+best his stock afforded.
+
+"Well, be careful of what you cook and how you cook it after this," said
+Captain Ponsberry.
+
+"Would yo' mind tellin' me, sah, who is kicking, sah?" asked Jeff,
+respectfully.
+
+"Semmel says he was made sick by what he ate."
+
+"Huh, dat scab!" grunted Jeff. "He ain't no 'count at all, he ain't!"
+And the cook turned away in disgust.
+
+"It looks to me as if Semmel was trying to make trouble all around,"
+said Tom Grandon, when he and the captain and Larry talked the matter
+over.
+
+"I never liked that man from the first time I clapped eyes on him," came
+from Larry. "He's a sneak--and worse."
+
+"I shall watch him pretty closely after this," said Captain Ponsberry.
+"One discontented fellow like him can upset the whole ship if he sets
+out to do it."
+
+"They can't complain of the grub," went on the first mate. "It's as good
+as on any merchantman, and better than the law requires."
+
+"I guess it was the deck-swabbing that gave him the stomach ache," said
+Larry, and this made the captain and Grandon smile.
+
+The next day when the sailors sat down to their dinner two or three of
+them sniffed suspiciously at the food they were eating.
+
+"This don't taste just right to me," said Shamhaven. "The meat tastes
+decayed."
+
+"And the vegetables ain't much better," put in Conroy,--a sturdy
+Irish-American, who was one of the best seamen on the schooner.
+
+"Dat dinner am fust-class," cried Jeff. "I ain't gwine to stand yere an'
+see you growlin' at it."
+
+"It certainly tastes a bit off, Jeff," put in Jack Wilbur. "Taste it
+yourself."
+
+The cook did so, and his face looked doubtful for a moment.
+
+"Guess dat needs a little salt an' pepper," he said, slowly. It did not
+taste nearly as good as he had anticipated.
+
+As there was nothing else to do, and they were hungry, the men ate the
+meal, grumbling to themselves as they did so. Luke said but little and
+ate sparingly, and his example was followed by Cal Vincent.
+
+The captain, Grandon, and Larry ate in the cabin and the dinner served
+to them was first-class in every particular.
+
+"Guess Jeff is spreading himself, just to show what he can do," remarked
+Larry to the first mate, after he had finished his repast.
+
+"It's very good, Larry," answered Tom Grandon.
+
+By the middle of the afternoon three of the men were complaining of
+feeling sick and all attributed their ailments to what they had eaten
+for dinner.
+
+"Ha! vat I tole you?" cried Semmel. "Didn't I say de grub vos pad? Not
+maybe you belief me, hey?"
+
+"I shan't stand for any more poor grub," came from Shamhaven. "If I
+can't get good stuff I'm going to the captain about it."
+
+The sickness of the hands worried Captain Ponsberry greatly and he
+opened up his medicine chest and gave them such remedies as he thought
+were best.
+
+At supper time Jeff was extra cautious in selecting and preparing the
+food. Nevertheless, the men who ate of it were suspicious and more than
+half the meal went to waste. The captain was very thoughtful, but said
+little or nothing.
+
+On the following day the wind died down utterly and it was exceedingly
+warm. With nothing to do, the majority of the hands gathered at the bow
+to talk of matters in general, and the food in particular. Semmel and
+Peterson were of the number, and both did all in their power to magnify
+the outrage, as they termed it.
+
+"Der captain don't haf any right to gif us such grub," said Semmel. "It
+vos against der law."
+
+"On some ships there would be a mutiny over this," added Peterson.
+
+Larry overheard a part of the conversation and it set him thinking. Luke
+Striker also grew suspicious.
+
+"Unless I am mistaken, this is some of Semmel's work," said Larry to the
+old tar. "He is doing his level best to make trouble on the ship."
+
+"Well, he better mind his business," grumbled Luke. "I don't reckon the
+captain will stand fer any underhanded work."
+
+Without appearing to do so, Larry continued to keep his eyes on Semmel,
+and about an hour before dinner he saw the bearded sailor approach the
+cook's galley and look inside. Jeff was below, getting a case of canned
+goods. With a swift movement, Semmel stepped into the galley, raised the
+lid of a big pot full of stew that was on the stove, and sprinkled
+something over the food. Then he hurried out and sneaked forward once
+more.
+
+"The rascal!" murmured Larry. "So this is his game. I wonder what he put
+into that pot?"
+
+For the moment the young second mate thought to confront Semmel and
+demand an explanation. Then he changed his mind and hurried for the
+cabin, to tell the news to Captain Ponsberry.
+
+
+
+
+CHAPTER V
+
+SIGNS OF A MUTINY
+
+
+"I've found out something important, Captain Ponsberry," said Larry, as
+he entered the cabin. "I now know what's the matter with the grub." To
+all salt-water sailors food is grub and nothing else.
+
+"Well, what is the matter with it?" questioned the master of the
+_Columbia_, quickly.
+
+"It's being doctored, that's what's the matter."
+
+"Doctored?"
+
+"Yes, sir,--doctored by Semmel, too."
+
+"Will you explain what you mean, Larry?" demanded the captain, intensely
+interested.
+
+"I just saw that rascal go into the cook's galley. Jeff wasn't there,
+and Semmel took the lid off of a big pot on the stove and sprinkled
+something inside."
+
+"What!" Captain Ponsberry leaped to his feet "Are you certain of this?"
+he demanded.
+
+"I am--for I saw it with my own eyes."
+
+"What was that stuff he put into the pot?"
+
+"I don't know."
+
+"Did he touch anything else?"
+
+"No. He was in a tremendous hurry and wasn't in the galley more than a
+minute at the most."
+
+"The scoundrel!" Captain Ponsberry clenched his fists. "Larry, you are
+positive you are making no mistake?"
+
+"I saw the thing done just as I told you. The stuff was in a bit of
+white paper. When he went forward he threw the paper overboard."
+
+"Did anybody else see this?"
+
+"I don't think so. But----"
+
+At that moment came a knock on the cabin door and Luke Striker appeared.
+
+"Excuse me, sir," he said, touching his cap. "But I've got something
+important to report."
+
+"What is it, Striker?"
+
+"I jess see that air Semmel go in and out o' the cook's galley."
+
+"That is just what I am reporting!" cried Larry. "Did you see what he
+did, Luke?"
+
+"No. He wasn't in there only a minit. It looked suspicious to me,
+though--with all hands gittin' sick from the grub."
+
+"This is all the evidence I want," said Captain Ponsberry. "We'll soon
+make an end of this. Larry, send Semmel to me."
+
+The young second mate left the cabin with Luke and both hurried toward
+the bow, where Semmel and Peterson were conversing in low tones.
+
+"The captain wants to see you at once," said Larry to the bearded
+sailor.
+
+His tone was so sharp it made Semmel start.
+
+"Vat he vants?" he queried.
+
+"Go and find out for yourself."
+
+"Maybe you git me in droubles, hey?" and the bearded sailor scowled.
+
+"I reckon as how you're gittin' yourself into trouble," drawled Luke,
+dryly.
+
+"You keep your mouf shut!" cried Semmel. "I no talk to you, no!"
+
+"The captain wants you to report; are you going to do so or not?"
+demanded Larry.
+
+"Sure I go," answered Semmel, with a toss of his head, and he slouched
+toward the stern. His manner was so aggressive that Larry picked up a
+belaying pin before following him.
+
+Captain Ponsberry had just appeared on deck. He had armed himself with a
+short club,--a sure sign to those who knew him that something unusual
+was in the wind. His face was stern and forbidding, and all hands
+gathered around to see what was the trouble.
+
+"Semmel, I want to have a talk with you," he said, in a loud voice, as
+the bearded sailor came up.
+
+To this the sailor nodded but did not answer.
+
+"I want to know what you were doing in the cook's galley a short while
+ago."
+
+"De cook's galley?" The sailor acted as if he was puzzled. "I no go by
+de galley, captain."
+
+"You were in the galley and you put something into the stew-pot. What
+was it?" thundered Captain Ponsberry. "Tell me the truth, or I may take
+it into my head to break every bone in your body!" And he shook his club
+in the sailor's face.
+
+"I put noddings in de pot," cried Semmel. "I no go in de galley--I no
+been in de galley two, tree days. It is a lie!"
+
+"I saw you go in," came from Luke.
+
+"And so did I," added Larry. "And I saw you sprinkle something into the
+pot."
+
+"What, did dat good-fo'-nuffin furiner put somet'ing in ma eatin'?"
+shrieked Jeff, who had come up. "Oh,--yo'--yo'----"
+
+"Never mind, Jeff, I'll attend to this," interrupted the captain.
+
+"Yes, sah, but dat monkey-faced----"
+
+"Never mind now--fall back there," added the captain, and the cook fell
+back, but shook his fist at Semmel.
+
+"I not in de galley," reiterated the bearded sailor. "Russell an'
+Striker no tell de truth."
+
+"It is true," cried Larry.
+
+"Thet's so, an' you can't squirm out o' it," broke in Luke. "I saw ye as
+plain as day."
+
+"I want to know what you put into that stew-pot?" continued Captain
+Ponsberry.
+
+"I no go near de galley. I----"
+
+"I know you went into the galley and I know you put something into the
+stew. For the last time I ask you, what was it?"
+
+For reply Ostag Semmel simply shrugged his shoulders.
+
+"Are you going to tell me the truth?"
+
+"I reckon the truth ain't in him," grumbled Luke, under his breath.
+
+"I say noddings more," came sourly from the bearded sailor.
+
+"Put that man in irons," commanded Captain Ponsberry, turning quickly to
+Larry and Grandon. "If he won't talk now, perhaps he'll talk after he
+has spent a day in the brig."
+
+"Vat! you put me in irons!" shrieked Semmel. "You no got right to do
+dat, no!"
+
+"Haven't I?" answered Captain Ponsberry, in a voice that cut like a
+whip. "I'd like to see anybody dispute over it. Larry, Tom, do as I
+command."
+
+"Yes, sir," answered Larry, and ran off to get a pair of handcuffs while
+Tom Grandon stationed himself beside Ostag Semmel, belaying pin in hand.
+
+"You no mak me a prisoner!" fumed the bearded sailor. "You got no
+right!"
+
+He continued to rave, saying that it was a plot against him, because he
+had been the first to complain about the vile food served to the hands;
+that he had not been near the galley and that the captain, Grandon, and
+Larry knew it. He even appealed to the other sailors to stand by him,
+and several came forward to argue with Captain Ponsberry. But the master
+of the schooner was obstinate and would not listen.
+
+"I know what I am doing, men," he said, quickly but firmly. "He is a
+scoundrel and a spell in the brig will do him good. After this I reckon
+you'll find the grub all right."
+
+"I no like--" began Peterson, once more.
+
+"You shut up, Peterson, or I'll put you in the brig with Semmel," cut in
+the captain, and Peterson fell back with the rest, but with a brow that
+was dark and distrustful.
+
+By this time Larry had returned with the handcuffs and despite the
+resistance he offered, Ostag Semmel was made a prisoner. Then the first
+and the second mates led him to the schooner's brig,--a narrow, V-shaped
+room in the bow of the boat, usually used for storing lanterns and oil.
+The smell in the closet--for it was nothing else--was far from pleasant,
+and a day in the brig usually made a prisoner repent and promise to do
+better.
+
+"I mak trouble for dis!" growled Semmel, as the door was closed and
+bolted on him. "I mak trouble, yes! You got no right to do dis, no!"
+
+"And you haven't any right to doctor the grub," answered Larry, and then
+he and Grandon walked away.
+
+"That fellow is a first-class villain, to my way of reasoning," was the
+first mate's comment. "I believe he'd do almost anything to get square
+for this."
+
+After Ostag Semmel had been placed in the brig Captain Ponsberry called
+all hands to him once more and related what Luke and Larry had seen. The
+stew was inspected, but nothing suspicious could be seen about it.
+
+"If any of you want to try that stew you may do so," said the captain.
+"Of course, if Semmel didn't touch it there can be nothing in it that
+can hurt you." But all, even to Peterson, declined to even taste the
+food. It was one thing to think Semmel innocent but quite another to run
+the risk of being made sick or poisoned. In the end the stew was dumped
+overboard and Jeff prepared an entirely new dinner for all hands.
+
+"You must keep close watch on all of the men," said the captain to Larry
+and Grandon, when quietness had been restored. "Semmel was the worst of
+the lot, but I do not like the way Peterson and one or two others are
+acting."
+
+"I don't see what they can do," answered Larry.
+
+"They might start a mutiny," came from the first mate.
+
+"Would they dare go as far as that?"
+
+"Sometimes sailors get strange notions, and the old Harry himself can't
+stop them," said Captain Ponsberry. "A thing that in itself doesn't
+amount to much will start them off, and they'll imagine that everything
+is going wrong. When I was a lad, on board the _Mary Eliza_, Captain
+Snapper, we had a mutiny just because the coffee wasn't right."
+
+"Yes, and I can remember that they had a mutiny on the old brig
+_Chesterfield_ because Captain Roe's wife brought a cross-eyed yellow
+cat on board," added Grandon. "Not a man would hoist a sail until that
+feline was put ashore. And when, two months later, the brig lost her
+foremast in a gale, the sailors said it was on account of that same cat,
+she having scratched the mast before she was taken away!"
+
+"Well, I hope we don't have a mutiny," said Larry. "I'd like to suggest
+something, Captain Ponsberry," he went on, to the master of the
+_Columbia_.
+
+"Fire ahead, Larry."
+
+"You know we can trust Luke Striker. Why not have him report just what
+the other hands are doing?"
+
+"That's an idea, and I will act on it. Yes, I'd trust Striker as quick
+as I'd trust you. If there is to be trouble we certainly want to know of
+it as soon as possible," concluded the captain.
+
+
+
+
+CHAPTER VI
+
+THE FIGHT FOR THE SHIP
+
+
+The day to follow was Sunday, and contrary to expectations, it passed
+quietly. As there was hardly any wind, the old _Columbia_ made slow
+progress, and the sailors had little or nothing to do. As was his usual
+habit, Larry read his Bible, and Captain Ponsberry held a short church
+service, which less than half the crew attended.
+
+"It's plain to see that the men are sulky," said Tom Grandon, towards
+evening. "We are certain to hear something from them shortly."
+
+Luke had been told to report anything unusual, but it was not until
+after dark that he sought out Captain Ponsberry.
+
+"I ain't got much to say," said the old tar. "But to my mind Peterson,
+Groot, and Shamhaven are doin' a powerful lot of confabbin'. More'n
+that, I saw Peterson cleaning up a pistol he's got."
+
+"Are any of the other hands armed?"
+
+"I ain't seen no other shootin'-irons," answered Luke.
+
+The captain had expected to interview Semmel once more, but found the
+fellow so surly he gave up the attempt. As the brig was so hot and
+uncomfortable, the master of the schooner had the door fixed so it could
+be left open several inches, with a chain at the bolt to keep it from
+going further.
+
+At four o'clock Monday morning Peterson came on duty, followed by
+Shamhaven and some others. All made their way to the bow and began to
+talk in a low but earnest fashion. Then Peterson went below, to where
+Semmel was still confined in the brig.
+
+"We are ready to move now," said he, in Russian. "What do you think?"
+
+"Let me out and I will show you what I think," growled Ostag Semmel.
+"The captain is a dog--and Grandon and Russell are dogs, too!"
+
+Peterson was prepared to unlock the chain which held the brig door and
+did so. Then he handed a pistol to the Russian.
+
+"The captain and Russell are in their staterooms," said Peterson. "Only
+Grandon is on deck, with Vincent and with the men we can trust to help
+us."
+
+"We can't trust Vincent."
+
+"I know that."
+
+"Where is Striker?"
+
+"Asleep in his berth."
+
+But on this score Carl Peterson was mistaken. Luke had pretended to go
+to sleep, but he was now in a corner on deck, watching with keen eyes
+all that was occurring. Presently he saw Semmel in company with Peterson
+hurry towards the bow, and he felt that the time for action had arrived.
+
+"Hi, Mr. Grandon!" he called out, running up to the first mate.
+
+"What is it, Striker?"
+
+"They've released Semmel and they are arming themselves."
+
+"You don't say!" Tom Grandon was stunned for the instant. "Tell the
+captain and Russell of this at once!"
+
+"Aye, aye, sir!"
+
+Rushing down the companionway, Luke entered the cabin and knocked on the
+door of Captain Ponsberry's stateroom.
+
+"Wake up, captain!" he called, loudly. "Wake up! There is going to be
+trouble putty quick, to my way o' thinkin'!"
+
+"What has gone wrong now?" demanded the master of the _Columbia_, as he
+hurried into his clothes and armed himself. "Where is Grandon?"
+
+"On deck; he sent me to tell you. They have set Semmel free and some of
+'em are arming themselves."
+
+"A mutiny!" roared Captain Ponsberry. "Striker, you'll stand by me, of
+course?"
+
+"That I will, sir--to the end."
+
+"Good. I know Vincent will do the same. Do you know anything about the
+others?"
+
+"I think you can count on Jeff the cook."
+
+"What of Wilbur?"
+
+"He's so weak-kneed I don't know what he'll do," answered Striker.
+
+By this time Larry was out of his stateroom. With his door ajar he had
+heard all that had been said.
+
+"Oh, Luke, do you think they'll try to seize the ship?" he gasped.
+
+"Don't know what they'll do. They're a plumb crazy lot," growled the old
+tar. "It was a mistake to take such fellers as Semmel and Peterson and
+Shamhaven aboard."
+
+"That is true, but when Devine and Larson got sick and went to the
+hospital at Manila I had to get somebody," answered Captain Ponsberry.
+He brought out several pistols. "Here, Larry, take one of these, and a
+cutlass, too, and you, Striker, can arm yourself likewise."
+
+There was no time to answer, for the master of the schooner was already
+striding through the cabin in the direction of the companionway. An
+instant later came a yell from the deck, followed by heavy footsteps and
+then the report of a pistol.
+
+"Drive dem to de cabin!" came in the voice of Semmel. "Drive dem along,
+kvick!" And then followed another yell and the sounds of half a dozen
+blows.
+
+"Below there!" came in Tom Grandon's voice. "Help! help!"
+
+"I'm coming!" called up Captain Ponsberry.
+
+"Don't you dare to step on deck, captain!" yelled down the voice of
+Shamhaven. "Don't you dare to do it!" And the sailor appeared, pistol in
+hand, at the top of the companionway.
+
+"Shamhaven, what does this mean?" demanded the master of the _Columbia_.
+
+"It means that we have taken possession of the ship, that's what it
+means," came from Groot.
+
+"Of you come up here, you maybe git killed," put in Ostag Semmel. "You
+stay down dare, you hear?" And then, as the captain started to mount the
+stairs, he threw down a belaying pin. In the semi-darkness the captain
+did not see the object, and it struck him on the top of the head,
+rendering him partly unconscious.
+
+Larry and Luke were close behind their leader and both were alarmed to
+see him go down, uttering a deep groan as he did so.
+
+"Is he killed?" questioned the young second mate.
+
+"I don't know," was the old tar's response. "Shall we go up?"
+
+"Keep back there!" was the call from above. "Put a step on those stairs
+and it will be the worse for you!"
+
+At that moment came a cry from Cal Vincent. The boatswain had been
+attacked from behind and was given no chance to defend himself. Then
+came a roar from Jeff, who came rushing toward the companionway as if
+all the demons of the deep were behind him.
+
+"Sabe me! sabe me!" he screamed. "Da is gwine to pirate de ship! Sabe
+me!" And then he came plunging down headlong, directly on top of Larry,
+Luke, and the prostrate captain.
+
+This unexpected coming of Jeff sent the young second mate and the old
+tar flat on Captain Ponsberry, and for the moment there was a struggle
+all around. In the meantime some sailors on the deck began to drag a
+heavy hatch toward the stairs. Soon this was placed in position, and
+then those below were virtually prisoners.
+
+"Oh my, sabe me!" groaned Jeff once more, as he managed to get on his
+feet in the cabin, followed by Larry and Luke. "Don't you let dem swing
+me from de yardarm!"
+
+"Jeff, where are Grandon and Vincent?" demanded Larry.
+
+"I dunno, sah--dead, I guess," answered the cook. "Oh, dis am de
+awfulest t'ing wot I eber heard tell ob!" he added, woefully, and wrung
+his hands.
+
+The lantern in the cabin was turned up and Larry gave his attention once
+more to Captain Ponsberry, who was now opening his eyes.
+
+"Oh, my head!" came with a shiver. "My head!"
+
+"I'm glad they didn't kill you," said Larry, kindly. "Luke, help me
+carry him into the cabin. We'll put him on the couch."
+
+This was done, and they did what they could to make the master of the
+schooner comfortable. But it was a good half-hour before Captain
+Ponsberry could sit up and do any rational thinking.
+
+On deck all had become suddenly quiet. Occasionally those below could
+hear a footstep near the companionway, showing that one or more of the
+mutineers were on guard. The hatch shut off the view on deck, and the
+windows in the ceiling of the cabin were also boarded over from the
+outside.
+
+"They have us like rats in a trap," said Larry, bitterly.
+
+"And for all we know Vincent and Grandon are both dead," returned Luke
+Striker, soberly. "I must say, lad, we seem to be in a bad way and no
+mistake."
+
+"Dey'll throw us overboard, I know dey will!" groaned Jeff, who was
+almost white with terror. "I neber see sech goin's-on in all ma life!"
+
+To fight the mutineers further was, just then, out of the question, and
+Larry turned his attention again to Captain Ponsberry. At last the
+captain seemed fully to comprehend what had occurred. He once more moved
+toward the companionway, pistol in hand.
+
+"You can't get out that way, sir," said Larry. "They have placed the
+fore hatch over the stairs."
+
+"And they are armed, too," put in Luke. "Be careful, sir, or they'll
+shoot you down."
+
+"And this on my own ship!" came bitterly from the master of the
+_Columbia_. "That is what I get for treating the dogs better than they
+deserve. Where are Grandon and Vincent?"
+
+"Either shot down or taken prisoners. They called for help, and that was
+the last we heard of them."
+
+"And are all the others in this dastardly plot?"
+
+"I reckon they are," answered Luke. "Them foreigners, Semmel an'
+Peterson, must have stirred 'em up powerfully."
+
+Still weak from the blow received, Captain Ponsberry sank down once more
+on the cabin couch. There was a lump as big as a walnut on the top of
+his head, and he had Jeff bathe it with water and then with witch-hazel,
+which made it a trifle more comfortable.
+
+A short while later came a sudden wild song from the deck of the
+schooner, followed by a clinking of glasses.
+
+"They are treating themselves to grog," said Luke. "I suppose, now they
+have the run of things, they'll drink all they want of the stuff."
+
+"More than likely," returned the captain. "Well, it is their turn just
+now--perhaps before long it will be my turn!" And he smiled
+significantly.
+
+
+
+
+CHAPTER VII
+
+THE MUTINEERS IN POSSESSION
+
+
+As my old readers know, both Captain Ponsberry and Luke Striker were
+Yankees to the backbone, and it galled them exceedingly to see the
+schooner in the hands of a number of mutineers, and especially
+foreigners.
+
+"We've got to git the ship back, no two ways on it," growled the old
+tar. "Captain, I'm willin' to fight to the end, if ye give the word."
+
+"And I'll fight, too," said Larry, promptly.
+
+"Don't you go fo' to fight dem rascallions!" whined Jeff. "Yo' will all
+be killed suah!"
+
+"I would like to know what has become of Grandon and Vincent," came from
+Captain Ponsberry. "As we stand now, we are but four to seven or eight.
+If we could get Grandon and Vincent to aid us we would be six against
+them."
+
+"Perhaps all the hands are not in the mutiny," suggested Larry. "Why not
+try to sound them?"
+
+"I was thinking of doing that."
+
+A little later Captain Ponsberry called up the companionway. At first
+nobody paid any attention to him, but presently the hatch was shoved
+aside a few inches and Ostag Semmel looked down. Behind him was
+Shamhaven.
+
+"Semmel, what does this mean?" asked the captain, as calmly as he could.
+
+"It means dat ve haf de ship," replied the Russian, with a grin.
+
+"You are carrying matters with a very high hand. Where are Grandon and
+Vincent?"
+
+"I not tell you dat."
+
+"We had a right to mutiny," said Shamhaven. "The grub wasn't fit to eat
+and was getting worse every day."
+
+"That's a tale gotten up for the occasion, Shamhaven, and you know it.
+Semmel doctored the food to make you dissatisfied."
+
+"Well, we don't think so," grumbled the sailor. "I don't think so, and
+Groot and the others don't either."
+
+"Has Jack Wilbur joined you?"
+
+"Certainly he has," was Shamhaven's ready reply, but his look belied his
+words.
+
+"Ve are all pount to stick togedder," said Semmel. "You might as vell
+gif up--der sooner der petter for you!"
+
+"I don't propose to give up, you rascal."
+
+"Ton't you call me a rascals, no!" shouted Ostag Semmel. "I vos now der
+captains, yes, do you hear? Captain Semmel!"
+
+"Bosh!" put in Luke Striker, in disgust. "Why ye ain't fit to be the
+skipper 'f a canal-boat!"
+
+"If you try to navigate the ship you'll sink her on the rocks," put in
+Larry.
+
+"You had better consider what you are doing, Shamhaven," went on the
+master of the _Columbia_. "Remember, if I regain possession of the
+schooner I can make it go hard with you."
+
+"You no get dare schooner again, not much!" came from Peterson, who had
+just come up, followed by Jack Wilbur.
+
+"Wilbur, are you in this?" demanded the captain. "If you are, I must
+confess I didn't think it of you."
+
+"I ain't goin' to eat poor grub," answered Wilbur, lamely.
+
+"The grub is all right and you know it. It was doctored up by Semmel,
+and I----"
+
+"You stop dat talk!" roared Semmel, and then he added: "Maybe you gif in
+after you are goot an' hungry, hey?"
+
+"What, do you want to starve us out?" cried Larry.
+
+"You see--chust vait!" answered the Russian, and with this the hatch was
+again put in place and the conference came to an end.
+
+Captain Ponsberry was fairly boiling with wrath, but even so he realized
+that prudence is often the better part of valor.
+
+"There is no use of trying a rush to the deck," he said. "Those rascals
+would surely shoot us down. Just now some of them are in the humor for
+anything."
+
+"Perhaps we can do something to-night," suggested Larry.
+
+"They talk about starving us out," said Luke. "Ain't there nothin' to
+eat here?"
+
+An inspection was made of the cabin pantry, which brought to light some
+preserves, some pickles, a pot of cheese, and a tin of fancy crackers.
+
+"About enough for one meal," said Captain Ponsberry, grimly.
+
+"And a pretty slim one at that," added Larry. "But I say, captain," he
+added, suddenly, "isn't there a door leading from the back of the pantry
+down into the hold?"
+
+"There was once--but I had it nailed up years ago, for we never used
+it."
+
+"If we can open that, we might get something from the hold."
+
+"Going to eat machinery?" demanded Luke.
+
+"No--canned goods, Luke; I know Jeff had some placed there, for he
+didn't have room in his store-room."
+
+"Dat am a fac'," put in the cook. "I'se got lots ob t'ings in dat dar
+hold."
+
+"Then that settles the starving question," said Captain Ponsberry. "I've
+got a small saw and a hammer down here somewhere. We can use them on the
+door."
+
+"And that gives me another idea," went on Larry. "The hatch covering
+over the companionway belongs to the fore hatch. If we can reach that
+opening from here, why can't we steal on deck when we get the chance and
+try to make the mutineers prisoners?"
+
+"Eureka!" shouted Luke. "That's the talk, Larry. Fer your years you've
+got a wonderfully long head on ye. We'll make 'em prisoners or chuck 'em
+overboard!"
+
+"The idea is worth considering," said the captain. "But we must be
+careful."
+
+A search was made and the hammer, small saw, and also a chisel were
+found. Then they cleaned out the pantry, took down several shelves, and
+thus uncovered the small door which had been nailed up.
+
+"Don't make any noise, or they'll suspect that we are up to something,"
+said Captain Ponsberry.
+
+"Let Jeff rattle some dishes," said Larry, and while he and Luke worked
+on the door, the cook began to handle the dishes in such a rough manner
+that several were broken. He also tried to sing a couple of verses of
+his favorite song, "My Gal Susannah!" but his voice was so shaky that
+the effort was, artistically, a failure, although it added to the noise,
+which was all that was desired.
+
+"They're pretty happy down there," said Wilbur to Shamhaven, as he
+listened to the sounds.
+
+"Oh, they're putting on a front," growled Shamhaven. "They'll sing a
+different tune when their stomachs are empty."
+
+"I don't know about this mutiny," went on the weak-kneed sailor,
+nervously.
+
+"Oh, it's all right and you needn't to worry, Wilbur. If we stick
+together we'll make a couple of thousand apiece out of this game."
+
+"But what shall we do if we fall in with a Russian warship?"
+
+"Semmel has that all fixed. He'll expose the captain and state that the
+_Columbia_ is carrying a cargo for the Japanese Government, and that he
+took possession in the name of the Czar. With this war on they won't ask
+too many questions so long as they can give the Japs a black eye."
+
+"I see. But supposing we fall in with a Japanese warship?"
+
+"Then Semmel is going to turn the command over to me and I'll tell them
+that the cargo was really meant for the Japanese Government but that
+Captain Ponsberry, just before we left Manila, sold out to the Russian
+agents and was going to Vladivostok. I'll add that we refused to go to
+the Russian port after signing for Nagasaki, and all of the men can back
+me up. That will put the captain and his friends in limbo and give us
+some prize money. Oh, we'll come out ahead, don't you worry," concluded
+Shamhaven, confidently.
+
+The day passed slowly and the mutineers held several meetings, to settle
+upon just what they were going to do. But all had been drinking more
+than was good for them and the conferences ended in nothing but talk.
+Semmel was the accepted leader, but it was plain to see that Shamhaven
+objected strongly to playing a secondary part, and Peterson also wanted
+a large "finger in the pie."
+
+As they worked with care, it was a good hour and a half before Larry and
+Luke managed to take down the door leading into the hold. Even when this
+was done they found on the other side several heavy cases of machinery
+almost impossible to budge.
+
+"We can pry those out of the way," said the captain.
+
+"A foot or so will do it," returned Larry. "Then I think I can crawl
+over the top."
+
+They continued the work, and a little later the young second mate was
+able to squeeze his way to the top of the cargo in that vicinity.
+
+"Be careful, Larry," warned the captain. "If a case should shift with
+the ship you might get a crushed leg. You had better take a candle
+along."
+
+"I will, sir."
+
+Luke was as anxious to get into the hold as the young second mate, and
+he too squeezed his tall, lank form through the opening. Guided by the
+faint light of the candle, they crawled over a number of cases of
+machinery and war goods until they drew close to the middle of the ship.
+
+"Here we are!" cried Larry, in a low voice, and pointed to some cases of
+canned goods. "Beans, corn, tomatoes, salt pork, condensed milk--we
+won't starve just yet, Luke."
+
+"An' here are some barrels o' flour," added the old tar. "No, they can't
+starve us nohow now."
+
+They had brought the chisel and hammer along, and with extra caution
+opened some of the cases. Taking with them all the goods they could
+carry, they returned to the cabin.
+
+"This is splendid!" cried Captain Ponsberry. "With this stuff on hand we
+can hold the cabin indefinitely."
+
+"How is I gwine to cook?" questioned Jeff.
+
+"Over the two lanterns, Jeff. It will be slow work, but our time is our
+own. Luckily there are pots and tins in the pantry."
+
+"All right, sah."
+
+"Of course, I am hoping that we shall not have to stay here long," went
+on the captain. "But it is best to be prepared."
+
+That those on deck might not see the cooking going on, one of the
+staterooms was cleaned out and Jeff went to work in this. In the
+meantime Semmel called down the companionway once more.
+
+"Are you gettin' hungry?" he asked.
+
+"Tell him yes," whispered Larry.
+
+"Why?" questioned the captain, in an equally low tone.
+
+"Then he'll think we are getting ready to come to terms and he won't
+watch us so closely."
+
+"I see." Captain Ponsberry raised his voice. "Yes, we are hungry," he
+called up. "What are you going to send us, something good?"
+
+"Ve send noddings. Maybe you talk business soon, hey?" continued the
+rascally Russian.
+
+"Perhaps."
+
+"How soon?"
+
+"Well, perhaps to-morrow morning."
+
+"Not before dot, hey?"
+
+"No."
+
+"All right den; you can go on an' starve so long!" growled Ostag Semmel,
+and went away. A moment later he met Shamhaven.
+
+"What did he say?" asked the latter, anxiously.
+
+"He comes to terms to-morrow!" answered the Russian, triumphantly.
+
+
+
+
+CHAPTER VIII
+
+TURNING THE TABLES
+
+
+The meal which Jeff prepared put all in the cabin in better humor, and
+as soon as it was over a council of war was held.
+
+It was decided to wait until darkness had set in, and then try to gain
+the deck of the ship by way of the fore hatch. In the meantime the door
+to the companionway was to be locked and barred, so that the mutineers
+could not attack them very well from that direction, should a running
+fight ensue.
+
+As Jeff would be of no use in a struggle he was delegated to remain in
+the cabin, to make as much noise as possible, singing and talking to
+himself, so that the mutineers might not suspect what was taking place.
+
+Each member of the party armed himself both with a pistol and a cutlass,
+and Larry led the way as before, candle in hand. It was easy for Luke to
+follow him, but rather difficult for the captain, who was more portly.
+
+"Reckon as how ye shouldn't have eaten so much, captain," chuckled the
+old tar, as he helped Captain Ponsberry through a particularly narrow
+place.
+
+"True, Striker," was the answer. "But you be careful that you don't slip
+into some slit between the cases and go out of sight."
+
+They soon gained the spot where the canned goods had been found. They
+had now to climb over some machinery that reached nearly to the top of
+the hold, and then over a varied collection of boxes and barrels and
+bags. On the bags lay some of the old sails of the ship and several
+coils of discarded rope.
+
+They were just approaching the open fore hatch when they saw a rope
+ladder let down. Instantly Larry uttered a warning and put out the
+light.
+
+"Somebody is coming down," he whispered.
+
+It was the sailor Wilbur, who had been sent to get some canned goods for
+cooking purposes. He came down the rope ladder with a lantern slung over
+one arm.
+
+"We'll make him a prisoner!" cried Captain Ponsberry. "And let us do it
+as quietly as we can, so as not to disturb those on deck."
+
+The others understood and crouched back in the darkness. Then, as Wilbur
+passed them, the captain caught him from the back and Larry clapped a
+hand over the fellow's mouth.
+
+"Oh!" spluttered Wilbur, but that was as far as he got.
+
+"Not a word! Not a sound, Wilbur!" said Captain Ponsberry, earnestly.
+
+The sailor understood, and being a craven at heart he almost collapsed.
+It was an easy matter to take one of the old ropes and tie his hands
+behind him. Then Captain Ponsberry confronted the mutineer, making a
+liberal exhibition of his pistol as he did so.
+
+"Wilbur, answer me truthfully," said the master of the _Columbia_. "Are
+you all in this mutiny or not? Don't speak above a whisper."
+
+"I ain't in it!" whined Wilbur. "They dragged me in, they did. I ain't
+kicking about grub, or nothing!"
+
+"Are all the others in it?"
+
+"Kind of, yes. Groot didn't care much to go in. Guess he wish he was out
+of it now."
+
+"What has become of Grandon and Vincent?"
+
+"Both of 'em are prisoners in the brig."
+
+"Are they wounded?"
+
+"Not much. Grandon had his thumb cut and Vincent got a kick in the back
+that lamed him."
+
+"Is anybody guarding them?"
+
+"I guess not. All of 'em have got to drinking again. Say, captain, let
+me out of this fix and I'll never go against you again, never,"
+continued Wilbur, earnestly.
+
+"We'll see about that later," was the grim reply.
+
+"Captain Ponsberry, I have a scheme," put in Larry, and he drew the
+master of the ship to one side. "Wilbur is about the same build as
+myself. Let me take his coat and cap and go on deck and down to the
+brig. If I can release Grandon and Vincent we'll be sure to knock out
+the mutiny in no time."
+
+"It's a dangerous game, Larry."
+
+"Oh, please let me do it!" pleaded the young second mate. The hazard was
+one which appealed to him strongly.
+
+The matter was talked over for a few minutes and it was decided to let
+Larry have his way. Wilbur was soon stripped of his coat and the young
+second mate donned the garment. Then he took the mutineer's cap and
+pulled it as far over his brow as possible and turned up the coat
+collar.
+
+"I'll leave the lantern here," he said, and a second later was mounting
+the rope ladder slowly and cautiously.
+
+With his head on a level with the deck Larry paused to reconnoiter the
+situation. He knew exactly how dangerous his mission was and that he was
+running the risk of being shot. But his life in our navy had made him
+bold, and seeing nobody in sight, he leaped out on deck, and hurried
+with all speed to the ladder leading to the brig. Soon he was in front
+of the barred door.
+
+"Grandon! Vincent!" he called, softly.
+
+"Hullo, who's that?" came in the voice of the first mate.
+
+"It is I, Larry. Is Vincent there?"
+
+"Yes. Where did you come from?"
+
+"The cabin." Larry unbarred the door. "Are you hurt?"
+
+"Not much. How are you?"
+
+"I am all right, and so are the captain and Luke Striker. They are in
+the hold, ready to come on deck. We have made Wilbur a prisoner."
+
+"Good enough," came from the boatswain. "The rascals! They ought all to
+walk the plank!" he added, vehemently.
+
+The two men had their hands tied behind them, but it was an easy matter
+for Larry to liberate them. Then each provided himself with a belaying
+pin, and all three of the party stole to the deck.
+
+From the forecastle and the cook's galley came loud talking, showing
+that the mutineers were making themselves at home. One man was trying to
+do some cooking.
+
+"What's keeping Wilbur so long?" he demanded of the others.
+
+Nobody knew, and one of the crowd, the sailor named Groot, volunteered
+to look the missing one up.
+
+"Let us follow him to the hatch," whispered Larry. "Perhaps we can make
+him a prisoner."
+
+"Right you are," answered Tom Grandon.
+
+With caution they came up behind the man, and just as Groot leaned over
+the open hatchway, they caught him tightly.
+
+"Keep silent, Groot!" said Grandon. "Keep silent, or we'll throw you
+overboard."
+
+"Stop!" roared the mutineer. "Help! hel----"
+
+He got no further, for raising his belaying pin, Vincent brought it down
+on the mutineer's head. Groot had been the one to lame the boatswain's
+back and the latter had not forgotten it. Over went the fellow and sank
+down as if dead.
+
+"Drop him into the hold," ordered Grandon, and this was done just as
+Captain Ponsberry and Luke Striker appeared at the foot of the rope
+ladder.
+
+"Another, eh?" said the master of the _Columbia_. "Good enough! How are
+you, Tom? How are you, Vincent?"
+
+"We're ready to fight 'em," answered the first mate. "Come on! They've
+got so much liquor aboard they can't do much to us!"
+
+"Be careful, I don't want anybody shot if it can be avoided," responded
+Captain Ponsberry.
+
+"I think it would be a good plan to dump them all into the hold," said
+Larry. "Then we could nail up that pantry door, put the hatch into
+place, and keep them at our mercy."
+
+"If the plan will work, it's a good one," answered the captain.
+
+One after another they came out on deck, leaving Wilbur and Groot in the
+hold. They found the mutineers equally divided between the galley and
+the forecastle. The only man in charge of the schooner was Conroy, who
+was at the wheel.
+
+As they advanced upon the forecastle they saw Semmel come out,
+accompanied by Peterson.
+
+"There are the ringleaders!" cried Captain Ponsberry, and rushing up to
+them he exclaimed: "Surrender, you rascals!" And he aimed his pistol,
+while the others also raised their weapons.
+
+The Russian and his companion were taken completely by surprise, and
+before they could draw any weapons of their own it was too late. Grandon
+tripped one up and fell upon him, and then Vincent and Larry tripped up
+the other. There was a brief scuffle, the exchange of several blows
+which did little damage, and in a trice Semmel and Peterson were thrown
+down into the hold bodily, and the ladder was hauled up out of their
+reach.
+
+"Put that hatch over the opening," cried Captain Ponsberry to Larry.
+"And then go into the cabin pantry and nail up that door. Be quick about
+it, or they may get out!"
+
+"Aye, aye, sir!" cried the young second mate, and ran off with all
+speed. The hatch was large and heavy, but the excitement lent him
+strength and he dragged it forward and threw it over the hatchway.
+
+"Stop dat!" roared Semmel, in a drunken voice, but Larry paid no
+attention. His next movement was toward the cabin.
+
+"Don't yo' tech me!" roared Jeff, in alarm. "Oh, it am yo'!" he added,
+as he recognized Larry. "How am de battle gwine?"
+
+"We've got 'em on the run--four are prisoners in the hold," was Larry's
+reply. "Get me that box of nails, Jeff--I must put that door back as it
+was!"
+
+"Yes, sah; yes, sah!" answered the cook, eagerly, and brought forth the
+nails in question. Then he helped to put the door into place, and held
+it while Larry nailed the barrier. The job was just completed when the
+young second mate heard voices from the hold.
+
+"Hi, dare, you let us out," came from Peterson. "Ve vill mak it right,
+yes!"
+
+"You keep quiet," ordered Larry, and would say no more. Against the door
+he and Jeff placed several trunks and boxes taken from the staterooms
+opening off of the cabin.
+
+During this time the party led by Captain Ponsberry had attacked the
+balance of the mutineers. There was a brief fight and Shamhaven got a
+cutlass cut on the knee. But then the men surrendered, and one after
+another was made to drop down into the hold, and the hatch was shut and
+battened down.
+
+The only man who was not thus made a prisoner was Conroy, who begged at
+once to be forgiven.
+
+"They got me to drink, captain," he pleaded. "I didn't know what I was
+doing. Forgive it, and I'll be the best man you ever had on board."
+
+"Can I depend upon you, Conroy?" asked Captain Ponsberry, sternly.
+
+"You can, sir--I give you my word on it."
+
+"You won't try to help the mutineers?"
+
+"No, sir; no, sir!"
+
+"Very well then, I'll try you. But, remember, if you try any dirty work
+it will go hard with you. Now tell me, was Wilbur in favor of this
+mutiny?"
+
+"No, sir, he was not. Semmel forced him into it."
+
+"What of the others. Who were the ringleaders?"
+
+"Semmel and Peterson and Shamhaven. The others didn't want to do
+anything but complain about the grub," answered Conroy, and then told
+the particulars of the mutiny from beginning to end.
+
+
+
+
+CHAPTER IX
+
+CLOSE TO A WATERSPOUT
+
+
+It was decided to leave the mutineers in the hold undisturbed until
+morning. This done, those who had been hurt in the scrimmage had their
+wounds attended to, and then Jeff was set to work to prepare a good meal
+for all the loyal party. The galley was in a state of disorder, but this
+counted for nothing, and Jeff soon had matters straightened out.
+
+After so much excitement nobody thought of retiring. Luke was stationed
+over the fore hatch, to give warning of any attempt on the part of the
+mutineers to regain their liberty. He was armed and he threatened to
+"blow the hull head off" of anybody who dared to show himself or make a
+noise. As a consequence the mutineers did nothing. Two made their way to
+the nailed-up door, but finding they could not open it, gave up the
+attempt as a bad job.
+
+As a punishment for his misdeeds Conroy was kept at the wheel during the
+whole of the night. He was willing enough to do the extra work if only
+the captain would forgive him for his actions. The master of the ship
+questioned him closely, and in the end reached the conclusion that only
+Semmel, Peterson, and Shamhaven were the leaders in the attempt to seize
+the ship and that the others had followed after them like so many sheep.
+
+"I am glad to hear this," he said to Grandon and Larry. "I think after I
+read them a strong lecture they'll behave themselves."
+
+"But we shall have to watch 'em closely," said the first mate.
+
+"What will you do with Semmel, Peterson, and Shamhaven?" asked Larry.
+
+"Put them in irons and keep them there until the end of the trip. When
+we reach Nagasaki they can take their choice of leaving or of being
+kicked off the ship. If they raise a row I'll hand them over to the
+authorities."
+
+"You ought to have them locked up."
+
+"True, lad; but with this war on hand the courts won't want to bother
+with such a case."
+
+It was not until nine o'clock in the morning that Captain Ponsberry had
+the forward hatch raised once more. Those below were almost dying for
+fresh air and water.
+
+"I want Wilbur to come up," he said.
+
+"Can't we have some water?" demanded Shamhaven.
+
+"Yes, if you'll behave yourselves," was the short answer.
+
+There was a babble of voices, but the master of the ship paid no
+attention. Each man who had been thrown below was unarmed, so there was
+no danger of any shooting. Presently Wilbur came up the rope ladder
+thrown to him, looking sheepish enough.
+
+"What have you to say for yourself?" demanded the captain, when Wilbur
+threw himself on his knees.
+
+"Don't count it against me, cap'!" he groaned. "I didn't want to go into
+it, I tell you! I didn't want to go in!"
+
+"If I forgive you, will you give me your word to behave yourself?"
+
+"Yes, sir!"
+
+"You won't do any more underhanded work?"
+
+"You can shoot me if I do, captain."
+
+"Very well; I'll remember that. Now go forward and help put the ship in
+good order. Larry, set him to work, and see that he does just what you
+tell him." And Wilbur went off, with the young second mate following,
+thanking his stars that he had not been swung to the yardarm, for mutiny
+on the high seas is a capital offense.
+
+One by one the mutineers were allowed to come on deck, until only
+Semmel, Peterson, and Shamhaven remained below. Those to come up pleaded
+to be forgiven and promised to obey orders in the future and let the
+captain run the ship to suit himself.
+
+During the night, Groot had had a bitter quarrel with Semmel, and the
+Russian appeared presently with a black eye and two of his front teeth
+loose. He was promptly put in irons, and the handcuffing of Peterson and
+Shamhaven followed.
+
+"I have allowed the other men their liberty because you three led them
+into this affair," said Captain Ponsberry to the trio of rascals. "I
+intend to keep you in irons until the end of the trip."
+
+At this there was a loud complaint, and the three made all manner of
+protestations, but the master of the _Columbia_ was obdurate, and at
+last threatened to throw them into the hold again. This quieted them for
+the time being, and after being given a square meal and a drink of
+water, they were marched off to the brig, which was cleaned of
+everything else for their accommodation.
+
+Fortunately for the _Columbia_ the weather remained fair, so that the
+loss of the prisoners was not felt when it came to handling the
+schooner. Those who had mutinied were only too glad to get back into
+Captain Ponsberry's good graces and they did whatever was required with
+an alacrity which was as astonishing as it was gratifying. They ate
+whatever was set before them, and soon reached the conclusion that the
+food was really better than they deserved.
+
+"We were fools to follow Semmel," said Wilbur; and Conroy and some
+others fully agreed with him.
+
+But though it now looked as if the men could be trusted, Captain
+Ponsberry determined to keep his eyes on them. Vincent was placed at the
+head of one watch and Luke at the head of the other, so that, with one
+or the other of the mates, the deck was always guarded by at least two
+persons that could be depended upon.
+
+The captain had hoped for favorable breezes following the heavy storm,
+but these did not come, and day after day passed with the old _Columbia_
+making slow progress toward Nagasaki. Formosa was passed during a bit of
+thick weather, so that nothing was seen of that island. Then the sun
+came out again, hotter than ever, so that Larry was glad to keep in the
+shade as much as possible.
+
+"It's not so exciting as it was a few days ago," remarked Luke to Larry
+one day, when both were seated in the shade of the forecastle.
+
+"I am glad that mutiny is at an end," answered Larry. "It's a great
+wonder that somebody wasn't killed or seriously wounded."
+
+"The men didn't have their hearts in the rumpus, thet's why, Larry. If
+they had really meant business--well, I reckon some of us wouldn't be
+here now to tell the tale."
+
+"I think Semmel meant business."
+
+"Yes, he's a heap sight worse nor any o' the others."
+
+"It was a mistake to take him on board. I tell you, a captain can't be
+too careful who he puts in his forecastle."
+
+"Well, you know the reason--those other hands gettin' sick at Manila.
+But I can tell you, I'd rather have a crew of Americans any day."
+
+"They are hard to get."
+
+"True fer you." The old Yankee tar heaved a sigh. "The old days are
+gone, sure enough. My! my! what times we used to have, when we'd go out,
+every man a-knowin' every other man on the ship, an' all about him, too!
+Then it was like a big family settin' sail. Now, if you go on a new ship
+ye don't know nobody an' nobody knows nobody else."
+
+"I guess you expect to live and die a sailor, don't you, Luke?"
+
+"Don't know but what I do, unless somebody leaves me money enough to
+live like a millionaire," and the old tar grinned.
+
+Day after day passed and the _Columbia_ kept on her course, making as
+straight a passage for Nagasaki as possible. One day there would be a
+fair breeze and the next a dead calm.
+
+"This is unusual weather for this quarter of the globe," said Captain
+Ponsberry to Larry. "Like as not it will end in another hurricane."
+
+"In that case what will you do, release Semmel and the others?"
+
+"I may release Peterson and Shamhaven, but not Semmel, for he was the
+real ringleader."
+
+There were strong signs of a storm in the air that night, but they
+brought forth nothing, and on the following morning the sun came up as
+full and bright as before. The breeze came by fits and starts, from
+first one direction and then another, and the man at the wheel had all
+he could do to keep the schooner to her course. Sails were shifted half
+a dozen times, but without making any improvement.
+
+"The weather is certainly queer," said Grandon. "Puts me in mind of the
+time I was caught in a tidal wave in the South Seas. Before the wave
+struck us we had just such cuttings-up."
+
+"I trust we don't strike a tidal wave," answered Larry. "If it was high
+enough it might swamp us."
+
+"True; but when you're on the deep blue sea, lad, you've got to take
+whatever comes," replied the first mate, solemnly.
+
+Dinner was a quiet affair for all on board, and shortly after the repast
+Larry went to the forward deck, to have another chat with Luke. While
+the two were talking they were joined by Captain Ponsberry; and soon the
+three were conversing about old times once more.
+
+"Do you remember the swim we once took in the Pacific?" said Larry to
+Luke. "The time the sawfish smashed the boat and came after us?"
+
+"Reckon I do," was the Yankee tar's response. "We had a lively swim fer
+it, didn't we?"
+
+"And the time we visited the island and you turned the turtles?" went on
+Larry. "And do you remember that snake that chased us into the water?"
+
+"I do, Larry. Tell you what, we've had our share of adventures. When
+Admiral Dewey----What is it, captain?"
+
+Luke broke off short and looked at Captain Ponsberry inquiringly. The
+master of the _Columbia_ was gazing over the port bow in an earnest,
+puzzled fashion.
+
+"Do you see that little black cloud, Striker?"
+
+"I do, sir!" And now Luke became all attention and so did Larry. "Kind
+o' funny lookin', ain't it?"
+
+"It is odd," answered the captain. "Do you see how it seems to be
+dancing around in the sky?"
+
+"Is it a cloud?" questioned Larry. "If so, I never saw its like before."
+
+"I'll take a look at it through my glass," went on the captain, and sent
+a sailor for the article.
+
+The cloud came swiftly closer and they heard a most unusual roaring and
+hissing. Then of a sudden the cloud seemed to dip down into the sea.
+When it came up, the waters of the ocean followed, and there loomed up
+before those on the ship a waterspout ten or fifteen feet thick.
+
+"A waterspout!" cried half a dozen in concert.
+
+"And a mighty powerful one, too," said the captain. "I trust it don't
+come this way."
+
+"It is coming this way!" yelled Larry. "Look! look!"
+
+The young second mate was right, the waterspout appeared to be headed
+directly for the schooner. But then it shot off to the westward,
+churning the water into a foam behind it.
+
+"It's going away," murmured Luke, when once more the waterspout made a
+curve and then shot directly toward them. It was off the port bow and
+less than a hundred feet away. It looked as if the old _Columbia_ was
+surely doomed!
+
+
+
+
+CHAPTER X
+
+SOMETHING ABOUT WAR AND FIGHTING SHIPS
+
+
+"It's going to strike the ship!"
+
+"It will cut us to pieces!"
+
+"Throw the schooner over on the other tack!"
+
+These and several other cries rang out on the deck of the _Columbia_.
+All felt their hearts come up into their throats as the roaring,
+swirling mass of water came closer and closer, until the spray drenched
+them completely. The ocean was churned into a white foam and the wind
+seemed to suck and blow in all directions at once.
+
+But, just as it looked as if the schooner would be buried beneath a
+veritable mountain of water, the waterspout took another curve and slid
+away, along the side of the ship and off the stern. The man at the wheel
+came close to being carried overboard by the deluge he received and the
+_Columbia_ bobbed up and down like a cork. But in another moment the
+waterspout was an eighth of a mile distant.
+
+"What a--a narrow escape," faltered Larry, when he felt able to speak.
+"I thought we were bound for the bottom sure!"
+
+"Thet's the closest I ever was to any waterspout," came from Luke, as he
+wiped his wet brow. "Reckon we can thank Providence we ain't in Davy
+Jones' locker this minit!"
+
+Captain Ponsberry did not say much, but kept his eyes fixed on the
+waterspout, which was making fantastic curves across the bosom of the
+Pacific. At times it was close by and then it would go half a mile or
+more away. It was a fascinating scene, full of dread, and gave more than
+one onlooker a chill down his backbone.
+
+"I wish it would go away completely," went on Larry.
+
+But this was not to be. The waterspout kept within sight for a good
+half-hour, although it did not come near them again. At last it grew
+less and less, off to the southwestward, and finally vanished
+altogether. The glass was used in that direction, but nothing save a
+clear horizon could be located.
+
+"We are clear of it at last," said Captain Ponsberry, and breathed a
+long sigh of relief.
+
+"Waterspouts are mighty dangerous things," said Grandon, after the scare
+was over. "When I was on board of the brig _Ben Franklin_ we ran into a
+spout off the coast of Brazil, and it knocked off the bow and the
+forward rail and nearly sank us."
+
+"I met one once, off the coast of Cuba," said the captain. "That went
+ashore and tore up the trees like so many weeds for a hundred feet
+around. A waterspout is nothing to be fooled with, I can tell you."
+
+On the day following the appearance of the waterspout the weather
+changed. There was a slight storm and then a stiff breeze sprang up
+which was cheering to all on board. Every stitch of canvas on the
+_Columbia_ was spread and the schooner bowled along right merrily.
+
+"I'd like to know how this war is going on, and how Ben and Gilbert are
+faring," said Larry to Captain Ponsberry. "A whole lot may have happened
+since we left Manila."
+
+"Well, you'll probably get word from your brother when you reach
+Nagasaki, lad; and we'll get word from Captain Pennington, too."
+
+"I hope neither of them has been wounded."
+
+"So do I; but when one goes to the front he has got to put up with the
+fortunes of war. Being a soldier of fortune, as it is called, is no baby
+business."
+
+"Do you suppose the Japs are continuing to bombard Port Arthur?"
+
+"More than likely--if the place hasn't fallen into their hands. They
+want to make sure of their footing in lower Manchuria, and they can
+never do that so long as the Russians hold a single seaport down there."
+
+"I suppose Russia has a pretty good-sized navy as well as an army?"
+
+"Yes, Larry, one of the largest navies in the world. But their fighting
+ships are no better than the ships of Japan. You see, the Japanese navy
+is not near as old as the navy of Russia. Almost all of the ships are of
+the up-to-date types. Most of them have been built since the war between
+Japan and China in 1894 and 1895."
+
+"That would make them only about ten years old."
+
+"Exactly, and I've been told that some of the ships in the Russian navy
+are twenty and thirty years old. More than this, all of the Japanese
+guns are of the latest pattern--just as they are on our new warships."
+
+"I'd like to go aboard of a Japanese warship," cried the young second
+mate, enthusiastically.
+
+"Want to see if it's as good as it was aboard of the _Olympia_, eh?"
+
+"Yes, sir. Of course the _Olympia_ was old, especially alongside of the
+_Brooklyn_, on which my brother Walter served in Cuban waters, but even
+so she was a bang-up fighting machine. If she hadn't been she wouldn't
+have done her share in sinking that Spanish fleet in Manila Bay."
+
+"Well, you may have a chance to go aboard of a Japanese ship while we
+stop at Nagasaki. There must be a number of them at that port, coaling
+up and taking war supplies aboard."
+
+"How long do you think it will be before we reach that port?"
+
+"That will depend entirely upon the wind, as you know. If we get just
+what we need we may reach there inside of four or five days," answered
+Captain Ponsberry.
+
+As Peterson and Shamhaven were now behaving themselves they were allowed
+to come out of the brig and do some work on the deck every morning and
+afternoon. Both begged the captain to forgive them, but the master of
+the _Columbia_ would promise nothing.
+
+"You went into this with your eyes wide open," he said. "Now you can
+line up and take your medicine."
+
+Semmel was exceedingly bitter at not being allowed his liberty for at
+least a few hours a day and said he would denounce the captain at the
+first opportunity. But Captain Ponsberry soon cut him short.
+
+"You keep a civil tongue in your head," he said, sternly. "Unless you
+do, I'll put you down on hard-tack and water." And thereupon Semmel
+became sullenly silent.
+
+Towards evening of the day upon which Larry had the conversation about
+warships with Captain Ponsberry a Chinese junk, heavily laden with
+grass-covered boxes, was passed. Nobody on board could speak English, so
+the hail that was sent over the water brought no results.
+
+"We are getting closer to the coast shipping," said the master of the
+_Columbia_. "I suppose we'll meet quite a few vessels from now on."
+
+During the night an unexpected gale came up and the schooner was blown
+far out of her course. The gale came from the westward, so the vessel
+was blown to the east.
+
+"This will make the trip a day or two longer," grumbled Grandon, after
+the gale had spent itself.
+
+"Yes, but as we didn't lose a spar or a rag of canvas we can be thankful
+that it is no worse," responded Larry, who was always ready to look on
+the bright side.
+
+The gale subsided after a blow of twenty-four hours and then the bow of
+the _Columbia_ was once more set towards her destination. Only a few
+knots had been covered when the lookout reported a vessel in sight.
+
+"It's a steamer!" cried Larry, for the smoke from the craft's funnels
+was plainly to be seen.
+
+"Maybe she's a warship," returned Tom Grandon, who was beside him. "If
+so, I hope she's a Japanese."
+
+The steamer was coming along at a good rate of speed and soon they made
+her out to be a British vessel. She was a "tramp," that is, a vessel
+going from port to port, picking up whatever cargo can be found.
+
+"Ahoy, there!" cried Captain Ponsberry, as the tramp slowed up. "What
+ship is that?"
+
+"The _Lord Duffield_," was the answer. "What ship is that?"
+
+"The _Columbia_."
+
+"Where are you bound?"
+
+"For Nagasaki. And you?"
+
+"For Hong-Kong."
+
+A little more talk followed, and the captain of the _Lord Duffield_
+vouchsafed the information that he had sighted a Russian warship the day
+before.
+
+"A warship!" murmured Larry.
+
+"Which way was she bound?" asked Captain Ponsberry, anxiously.
+
+"I can't tell you. She stopped us and asked a few questions and then
+slipped away in the darkness."
+
+"What warship was she?"
+
+"The _Pocastra_, from Vladivostok. I think she used to be in the
+merchant service and was built over for the navy."
+
+The captain of the British steamer could give no further information,
+and so resumed his course, and the master of the _Columbia_ did
+likewise.
+
+"Ain't very nice news, is it?" said Tom Grandon.
+
+"It's very unpleasant news," returned Captain Ponsberry, with a shrug of
+his shoulders.
+
+"What are you going to do about it?"
+
+"What can we do, Tom? Trust to luck that we get into Nagasaki harbor, or
+some other port, in safety."
+
+"We'll have to keep a sharp lookout for anything that looks like a
+warship, unless, of course, she flies a Japanese flag."
+
+Word was passed around to those who could be trusted, and all day long
+one of the mates and a foremast hand were kept on the lookout, taking
+turns at looking through the best glass the schooner possessed.
+
+"This is almost as exciting as being in a war," said Larry, when he was
+on duty with Luke. "Don't you know how we looked for the Spanish ships?"
+
+"Yes, lad; but if we sight a Russian warship it will be small fighting
+we'll do, to my way of thinking."
+
+"Oh, we won't be able to fight at all. We'll simply have to rely on our
+wits to keep us out of being gobbled up as a prize of war," responded
+the young second mate.
+
+
+
+
+CHAPTER XI
+
+AN ORDER TO LAY-TO
+
+
+When taking on his cargo at Manila, Captain Ponsberry had considered the
+possibility of being captured by a Russian warship, and had talked the
+matter over with the agents of the Richmond Importing Company and with a
+Japanese official who was doing business on the sly in the Philippines.
+
+The Japanese Government was willing to pay for the cargo, whether it was
+delivered or not--presuming it was "gobbled up" by the Russians, but was
+not willing to pay for the ship if the vessel was taken as a prize of
+war.
+
+"That is a risk you must take yourself," said the Japanese official. "We
+are willing to pay a high price for the cargo--we cannot do more." And
+so the risk--so far as the schooner went--was divided equally between
+the Richmond Importing Company and Captain Ponsberry and the other
+owners of the _Columbia_.
+
+As nearly the captain's whole wealth was tied up in his share of the
+schooner, he was naturally anxious to make a safe trip, and he often
+came on deck to aid the lookouts in watching for the possible appearance
+of an enemy.
+
+"If you see the least thing that looks suspicious, tell me at once," was
+his order, and it was strictly obeyed. As a consequence they ran away
+from two steamers that afternoon and another steamer the next
+morning--all too far off to show exactly what they were.
+
+"This isn't bringing us much nearer to port," said Larry to Cal Vincent,
+who was using the glass at the time. "I don't believe we have made a
+dozen knots since yesterday."
+
+"Well, the old man is a bit nervous," responded the boatswain, in a low
+voice. "And I don't blame him. It's no small matter to lose your craft
+and be thrown into prison in the bargain."
+
+"Would they dare to throw us into prison?"
+
+"To be sure,--if they could prove that we were aiding the Japs."
+
+"Well, they'll have hard work proving that."
+
+An hour went by and it began to grow misty. Then came a call from the
+bow.
+
+"Sail in sight!"
+
+"What is it?" demanded the captain instantly.
+
+"A big steamer o' some sort."
+
+Captain Ponsberry ran forward and took the glass. For fully two minutes
+he did not speak and then he drew a long breath and put down the glass.
+
+"I'm afraid she's a warship," he exclaimed, and his voice sounded
+unnatural.
+
+"A warship!" echoed Larry. "Will you let me look?"
+
+He did so, and it was not long before he could make out the approaching
+craft quite clearly.
+
+"Well?" demanded Grandon, who knew that Larry's eyes were unusually
+strong.
+
+"I reckon the captain is right."
+
+"A warship?"
+
+"Yes, not a very large affair, but still a warship. I shouldn't be
+surprised if she was the converted vessel the _Lord Duffield_ sighted."
+
+"Just what I think," put in Captain Ponsberry. "We've got to do our best
+to show her a clean pair of heels."
+
+"The mist may help us to run away," suggested Grandon.
+
+"Let us hope so."
+
+Necessary orders were given, and soon the _Columbia_ swung around on
+another tack, so that she had the large vessel on her starboard quarter.
+But this movement was evidently noted by the stranger, and the latter
+headed directly for the schooner once more.
+
+"She is after us, that is positive," said Captain Ponsberry.
+
+"There is a bank of mist over to the northward," returned Larry. "Why
+not run into that?"
+
+"Well spoken, lad; we'll do it, and as soon as the mist hides us we can
+go over on the other tack and throw her off the scent."
+
+The mist the young second mate had mentioned was nearly a quarter of a
+mile away and it was a question whether they could reach it before the
+stranger came up. But fortune favored those on the schooner. The mist
+rolled toward them, and in less than two minutes they were hidden as
+completely as could be desired.
+
+"Now to get entirely out of the way," exclaimed Captain Ponsberry, and
+lost not a moment in having the sails shifted and a new course set.
+Through the mist they heard the other vessel steaming around noisily and
+did their best to keep as far away as possible from the sound.
+
+All during that evening and the night to follow the _Columbia_ kept to
+her new course. This was taking her away from Nagasaki, but this could
+not be helped. The captain said if it became absolutely necessary he
+would run into some other Japanese port.
+
+When daybreak came the mist was as thick as ever. But there were signs
+that it would not last much longer, and by nine o'clock the sun was
+struggling to come through the clouds. Nearly everybody was on deck, for
+they realized that a fatal moment might be at hand.
+
+"There she is!"
+
+The cry came from half a dozen throats simultaneously. There, on the
+port bow, loomed up the stranger, not an eighth of a mile away. That she
+was a warship there was no longer any doubt, for her forward guns were
+plainly to be seen.
+
+"We're caught now!" muttered Tom Grandon.
+
+"Not yet!" cried the captain, and gave orders to throw the _Columbia_
+over on a new course. But scarcely had this movement been made when
+there was a puff of smoke from the warship, a report, and a shot flew in
+front of the schooner's bow.
+
+"There's our order to lay-to!" ejaculated Larry. "Whoever she is, she
+means business."
+
+As the _Columbia_ did not stop, another shot was fired, this time just
+grazing the bow. Seeing there was no help for it, Captain Ponsberry gave
+the necessary orders, and down came one sail after another.
+
+As this was done the warship swung around and then those on the schooner
+saw that she flew the flag of Russia.
+
+"A Russian warship!" ejaculated half a dozen.
+
+"This looks to me as if the jig was up," murmured Tom Grandon.
+
+As quickly as it could be done, Captain Ponsberry assembled his men on
+deck.
+
+"Men," he said, briefly, "the officers on board of that warship wish to
+find out what they can about us. If you are asked questions say nothing
+more than that you shipped for the voyage to Nagasaki and San Francisco,
+and that you know nothing about the cargo. Do you understand?"
+
+"Aye, aye, sir," came from those who were listening.
+
+"I must depend upon you to help save the ship. If the _Columbia_ is
+suspected of being in the employ of the Japanese Government, or of
+carrying a cargo for that nation, she will be taken as a prize of war
+and we'll go to a Russian prison most likely."
+
+"I don't want to go to no Russian prison!" cried out Wilbur, his face
+turning pale. "I ain't done nothing wrong!"
+
+"Then keep your tongue from wagging too much, Wilbur," answered the
+master of the schooner, grimly.
+
+"There ain't no use o' fighting, is there?" asked Groot.
+
+"Fighting?" came from Tom Grandon. "What could the old _Columbia_ do
+against a man-o'-war? Why, they'd blow us sky high in no time!"
+
+"No, there is absolutely no use of attempting to fight," answered
+Captain Ponsberry. "Our only hope lays in convincing them that they have
+no right to stop us."
+
+The hands were dismissed and sent forward, and Captain Ponsberry hurried
+below, to burn certain papers and secrete others. This was in accordance
+with the orders received from the agents of the Richmond Importing
+Company at Manila.
+
+In the meantime the Russian warship had come to a stop in mid-ocean and
+now a small boat was lowered, containing a small crew, a coxswain, and a
+Russian naval officer. At the same time a signal was hoisted which meant
+that the officer was coming on board of the schooner.
+
+"Unless I miss my guess, this looks rather black for us," said Larry, to
+Tom Grandon.
+
+"I agree with you, Larry," responded the first mate. "But we've got to
+take our medicine, no matter how bitter it is."
+
+"If only that mist had held on to-day! We might have slipped by that
+warship nicely."
+
+"I only hope the old man fixes up his papers so that he can show a clean
+bill of health," went on Grandon. "You see, if they can't actually prove
+something against us, they won't dare to touch us. They know what Old
+Glory means, and Russia has no desire just now to get into trouble with
+Uncle Sam."
+
+"The worst of it is, our cargo may look too suspicious to them. Under
+ordinary circumstances they know that the _Columbia_ wouldn't be
+carrying such a line of goods in these waters."
+
+"That's true, too."
+
+"Besides that, they may have had an agent at Nagasaki and at Manila
+spying on us. They may know just what is being done. The Czar's
+followers are mighty slick, I can tell you."
+
+Captain Ponsberry now came on deck and gave quick orders that the
+sailors should be lined up, to receive the visitor in a befitting
+manner.
+
+"A little goose grease may help," he drawled, with a knowing glance at
+Grandon and Larry.
+
+The foremast hands did not know much about lining up, but took the
+places assigned to them, on the forward deck. Over the side a rope
+ladder was thrown, and then Captain Ponsberry, Tom Grandon, and Larry
+awaited the arrival of the Russian naval officer with keen interest.
+
+
+
+
+CHAPTER XII
+
+TAKEN AS A PRIZE OF WAR
+
+
+Slowly but surely the small boat came closer to the schooner. She rode
+the long swells of the Pacific with full grace, and Larry could not help
+but admire the long, sturdy strokes of the jackies, as they bent to
+their task.
+
+"I don't know but that they can handle a small boat as well as our own
+jackies," said Larry.
+
+"Why shouldn't they? Russian naval training ought to be first-class,"
+answered Tom Grandon. "They have been at it longer than Uncle Sam."
+
+"True, but that doesn't always count. Spain had been at it longer than
+we had, too, but when it came to war we beat her in double-quick order."
+
+As the small boat came closer they saw that the jackies were mostly men
+of middle age. But the coxswain was younger and so was the naval
+officer, who was gazing rather anxiously toward the schooner, as if
+wondering what the result of his mission would be.
+
+"Wonder if that chap can talk English?" queried the first mate. "If he
+can't the old man will be up a tree, for none of us can talk Russian."
+
+"I reckon Peterson and Semmel can talk it," answered Larry. "But we
+don't want either of those rascals to open his mouth."
+
+At last the small boat came up alongside of the _Columbia_. It was no
+easy matter to catch the rope ladder without getting bumped, but it was
+successfully accomplished, and then the Russian officer lost no time in
+coming on board. He at once saluted, and Captain Ponsberry and his mates
+did the same, and the sailors in the background did likewise.
+
+"What ship is this?" asked the Russian naval officer, after a few
+necessary formalities were at an end.
+
+"The American schooner _Columbia_," answered Captain Ponsberry.
+
+"Would you mind telling me for what port you are bound?" went on the
+naval officer, who could speak fairly good English.
+
+"We are bound for San Francisco, with a stopover at Nagasaki."
+
+"Ah! What sort of a cargo are you carrying to Nagasaki?"
+
+"One belonging to the firm for which the _Columbia_ is in commission."
+
+"The name of the firm, please?"
+
+"The Richmond Importing Company."
+
+"Ah!" said the naval officer again, and looked slightly displeased. As
+it happened he had a brother in the army at Port Arthur, and had heard
+of the doings of Gilbert Pennington at that place, and of how the young
+American had accused certain Russians of trying to cheat the company he
+represented.
+
+"What warship do you come from?" demanded Captain Ponsberry, feeling
+that he had an equal right to ask questions.
+
+"The auxiliary cruiser, _Pocastra_, of the Russian navy," answered the
+naval officer, politely.
+
+"And where are you bound?" went on Captain Ponsberry, bluntly.
+
+"That, sir, is a question only our commander, Captain Titorsky, can
+answer."
+
+"It's queer you are steaming around in Japanese waters."
+
+"Perhaps so." The Russian naval officer smiled in a knowing way.
+"Captain Ponsberry, I am sorry, but I think I shall have to inspect your
+papers."
+
+Captain Ponsberry drew himself up, resolved to put on as bold a front as
+possible.
+
+"This is an American ship, sir."
+
+"Granted, but I have my orders," returned the naval officer, coldly.
+
+"If I refuse to let you inspect the papers?"
+
+The young Russian officer shrugged his shoulders.
+
+"We shall be under the painful necessity of compelling you to show
+them."
+
+"You threaten me--an American captain!"
+
+"There is no help for it--I am simply obeying orders. We inspect all
+ships that we find in this vicinity."
+
+"Do you know I can make you pay dearly for this outrage?"
+
+"You cannot call it an outrage. You are in Japanese waters, Japan and
+Russia are at war. You knew that before you came into these waters. Am I
+to see the papers or not?"
+
+The commander of the _Columbia_ knew that the Russian naval officer
+spoke the truth. Yet he made one more effort.
+
+"Very well; I will show my papers, but I shall insist upon you signing a
+paper that your ship held us up."
+
+"You can send the paper to my ship for such a signature from my
+captain," said the Russian, evasively.
+
+By this time four of the jackies of the small boat had come on board.
+All were armed and they lined up at the rail, close to the rope ladder.
+They were good-natured sailors and grinned broadly at the hands on the
+_Columbia_. Not one could speak a word of English, so conversation with
+them was impossible.
+
+Captain Ponsberry led the way to the cabin of the _Columbia_ and the
+young Russian officer followed. Getting out such papers as had been
+prepared for the occasion, the master of the schooner passed them over.
+
+"These are correct so far as they go," said the Russian, after an
+examination lasting ten minutes had been made. "But----" he paused. "You
+have no further papers?"
+
+"Those are my papers, sir," answered Captain Ponsberry, briefly.
+
+"Then I will look at a specified list of your cargo."
+
+"I haven't such a list," was the answer, which was true, as the list had
+been burnt up just a short while before.
+
+At this statement the young Russian frowned. "Every ship carries such a
+list."
+
+"Still, I haven't any."
+
+"In that case, I shall have to order an inspection of the cargo."
+
+"Sir, you are going too far!" said Captain Ponsberry, sternly, yet he
+knew he had no right to expect anything else.
+
+"If I am going too far, I am able to take the consequences," returned
+the Russian, who was acting strictly under orders.
+
+"Very well, sir; you can look the cargo over," answered Captain
+Ponsberry. "But I shall hold Russia accountable for the outrage."
+
+The Russian naval officer bowed and hastened up to the deck. He spoke in
+his native tongue to one of the jackies who carried several small flags
+under his arm. At once the Jackie began to wig-wag to the warship for
+further instructions.
+
+"Search the ship," came back the order, and in a few minutes more
+another small boat left the side of the _Pocastra_, containing an
+officer and a crew of eight.
+
+"We are in for it now, that is certain," observed Larry. "They are not
+going to let us go until they are sure we are O. K."
+
+The second boat was soon alongside of the schooner, and the officer in
+charge and four men came up on the deck and joined the other Russians
+already there. An earnest conversation was held between the two
+officers.
+
+"We'll take a general look at the cargo," said the one who had just
+arrived. "It will not do to go too far--in case we find everything as it
+should be. We want no trouble with the Yankee government."
+
+Captain Ponsberry was asked to have the mizzen hatch opened, and this
+work was done by Luke Striker and several others. Then two of the
+Russian sailors were sent below, and one of the officers went along.
+
+In the meantime, Peterson, unknown to anybody on board, had slipped off
+to the brig. Here he found Ostag Semmel in solitary confinement.
+
+"Semmel, a Russian warship is close at hand," he said, hurriedly. "An
+officer and some men have just boarded us."
+
+"Release me, Peterson!" returned the Russian sailor. "Release me and I
+will show Captain Ponsberry what I can do!"
+
+"You will not get me into trouble?" questioned Peterson, anxiously.
+
+"No. Quick--I am sure we can make money out of this."
+
+With an iron bar, Peterson pried off the lock which had been put on the
+door of the brig, and drew back the bolt. Then Semmel came out of his
+prison, with his hands linked together.
+
+As he was making his way to the stern deck Larry caught sight of him.
+
+"Stop!" he called out, in alarm, realizing what Semmel might do. "Stop,
+Semmel!" and he ran to capture the rascal.
+
+"Get out da vay!" roared the Russian and aimed a blow at Larry's head.
+But the young second mate dodged and then caught the Russian by the
+legs, hurling him flat on his breast. But now Peterson came behind and
+gave Larry a vicious kick in the side, which made the youth let go his
+hold.
+
+"What's the row there?" called out Captain Ponsberry, and looked much
+disturbed to see the escaped prisoner. "Put him back where he came
+from!"
+
+"Help!" yelled Semmel, in Russian. "Help, in the name of the Czar! I am
+a Russian subject! This ship is in the employ of the Japanese
+Government!"
+
+"He speaks the truth!" called out Peterson, also in Russian. "Help us
+and protect us and we will prove it!" And he ran forward to where the
+Russian officer on deck was standing.
+
+"You are Russians?" asked the officer, quickly.
+
+"We are."
+
+"Then I shall certainly assist you." He raised his voice. "Let that man
+go!" And he pointed at Semmel, now surrounded by Larry, Luke, and Cal
+Vincent.
+
+The latter words were uttered in English, so all of our friends
+understood them. The two sailors looked inquiringly at the young second
+mate.
+
+"He is nothing but a mutineer," said Larry. "We locked him up for it. He
+ought to have been strung up on the yardarm," he added, bitterly.
+
+By this time Captain Ponsberry was on the scene, and those who had gone
+below were summoned on deck once more. The captain glared at Semmel, who
+lost no time in shrinking behind the Russian officers for protection.
+
+"I can prove the cargo on this ship belongs to the Japanese Government,"
+said Ostag Semmel. "My friend can prove it, too," he added, pointing to
+Peterson. "It is true we tried to seize the ship--to take her to
+Vladivostok, or some other Russian port, as a prize."
+
+"This is assuredly interesting," said the leading Russian officer. "Tell
+me your tale in full."
+
+Despite Captain Ponsberry's protests Semmel told his story in his own
+way, and Peterson corroborated it in every detail. Then Shamhaven,
+thinking to curry favor, came forward.
+
+"They tell the strict truth," he said. "I worked with them. We did what
+we could for the benefit of the Russian Government. Every bit of cargo
+on this ship belongs to the Japanese Government and was to be taken
+ashore at Nagasaki. The last cargo of the _Columbia_ was also sold at
+Nagasaki to the Japanese Government."
+
+"When was this?"
+
+"About two months ago."
+
+More questions were put to Semmel, Peterson, and Shamhaven, and at last
+the Russian naval officer turned grimly to Captain Ponsberry.
+
+"I have heard their story, and it will be unnecessary to make an
+inspection of your cargo, since they have told me of what it consists.
+In the name of Russia I claim this ship as a prize of war, and you and
+your crew must consider yourselves prisoners."
+
+
+
+
+CHAPTER XIII
+
+PRISONERS ON THE "POCASTRA"
+
+
+Captain Ponsberry had feared the result ever since the unexpected
+appearance of Ostag Semmel, so he was not very much surprised when the
+Russian naval officer stated that he should consider the _Columbia_ as a
+war prize and place those on board under arrest as prisoners of war.
+
+"This is a high-handed proceeding," said he, as calmly as possible,
+although his mind was in a whirl.
+
+"I do not think so," answered the Russian officer. "Do you submit or
+not?"
+
+"Since it would be useless to fight, we shall have to submit," answered
+the master of the schooner. "But, remember, I shall hold you and the
+Russian Government responsible for all you do."
+
+"As you have said that before, there is no use of repeating it, Captain
+Ponsberry. We will take command of the vessel at once."
+
+"What are we going to do?" whispered Larry to Tom Grandon.
+
+"I don't know--follow the old man, I reckon," answered the first mate.
+
+"We shall place a prize crew on this ship," went on the Russian officer.
+"These men"--pointing to Semmel, Peterson, and Shamhaven--"can remain on
+board. The remainder of the crew and the officers, will be transferred
+to the _Pocastra_. I will give you a quarter of an hour in which to
+attend to your luggage. Please take no more along than is necessary."
+
+"This is certainly high-handed!" cried Larry.
+
+"So we've got to go over to that old coal box, eh?" grumbled Luke, when
+he heard the news. "It's hard luck, Larry."
+
+"You're right, Luke, but it can't be helped."
+
+"What will they do with us?"
+
+"I haven't the least idea."
+
+"Will they take us to Russia?"
+
+"I suppose so--or stow us away in one of those cold and dirty Siberian
+prisons until we can get Uncle Sam to make them release us."
+
+When it came time to depart from the _Columbia_ Larry was allowed to
+take only a bundle of clothing along, and Grandon and the common sailors
+were treated no better. The captain was allowed a trunk and a suit case.
+In the meantime Semmel was questioned once more, and what he had to tell
+made the Russians look darkly at our friends.
+
+"He is pumping all sorts of falsehoods into them, I suppose," said Larry
+to Luke, and he was right. Semmel made it appear that Captain Ponsberry
+was really an agent of the Japanese Government and that he (Semmel) had
+done his best to gain possession of the ship wholly for the benefit of
+his own country.
+
+"If you really did this, it is very worthy of you," said one of the
+officers. "But we shall have to investigate before we accept your story
+in full." This was not so encouraging, but with it Ostag Semmel had to
+be content.
+
+Fearing that a Japanese warship might put in an appearance at any
+moment, the Russians lost no time in transferring the officers and men
+of the _Columbia_ to the _Pocastra_ and at the same time a prize crew of
+two officers and ten men were taken from the warship to the schooner.
+Then the sails of the _Columbia_ were hoisted and off she set to the
+eastward, and the warship moved in the same direction.
+
+When placed aboard the _Pocastra_ Captain Ponsberry was treated politely
+and given a small room of his own. But the mates and the ordinary seamen
+were not so fortunate. Grandon, Larry, and Luke Striker were hustled off
+to a prison pen on one deck of the auxiliary cruiser, and the others to
+another pen below, which was even worse.
+
+"This is certainly hard luck," said Larry, as he threw his bundle into a
+corner and sat down on an iron bench, while Grandon and Luke did the
+same. "And after we had almost reached Nagasaki, too!"
+
+"Well, there ain't no use to cry over spilt milk," came from Luke.
+"We're prisoners o' war, an' I reckon as how we have got to make the
+best o' it. Ain't the first time we've been in sech a fix."
+
+"That is true, Luke, but it doesn't help the matter any. I guess we have
+seen the last of the old _Columbia_."
+
+"I was afraid of this sort of thing happening ever since we left
+Manila," came from Grandon. "I told the old man to be careful, that----"
+
+"Hush!" whispered Larry. "They may be listening--to make sure that they
+have caught the right parties."
+
+"True for you, Larry; I won't say another word about that. But it looks
+dismal, no two ways on't," and the first mate drew a mountainous sigh.
+
+The prison pen into which they had been placed was an iron structure,
+reaching from floor to ceiling, and was not over ten feet square. It had
+a solid back and the remaining three sides were built up of stout iron
+bars, only a couple of inches apart. There was a door which was doubly
+locked, the key being held by a petty officer who could speak broken
+English and who rejoiced in the simple name of Rosenvischpoff. For short
+Luke nicknamed him Rosey and this name stuck to him.
+
+"Doesn't look as if a fellow could break out of here very easily," said
+Larry, after an inspection of their prison. "This is a regular bank
+vault."
+
+"Wouldn't do you any good to break out," returned Grandon. "As we are on
+the ocean, where would you go to?"
+
+"We might hide until the vessel made a landing."
+
+"Humph, and that would be in some Russian port, so you'd be just as bad
+off."
+
+"Well, I'm not trying to escape just now. I want to get the lay of the
+land first, and try to find out what they are going to do with us."
+
+From Rosenvischpoff they learned that the _Pocastra_ was one of a large
+number of steamers of various Russian lines which had been lately
+pressed into the service of the national navy. She had been rushed
+through at one of the Russian navy yards and provided with a battery of
+four small and four large guns, none, however, over eight inches. She
+carried a crew of one hundred and eighty men, drafted principally from
+other warships. She had an advertised speed of twenty knots an hour but
+rarely made over seventeen or eighteen. She was old and her engines were
+constantly in need of repair, much to the disgust of Captain Titorsky,
+her commander.
+
+"Well, Rosey, how goes this war?" asked Luke, pleasantly, as the petty
+officer came around to give them something to eat.
+
+"Big fight all der dime," answered Rosenvischpoff. "Russians kill all
+der Japs--sink all der Jap ships, yes!"
+
+"You're winning right along, eh?"
+
+"Yes, Russians win--Japs no do noddings, no!" And the petty officer left
+the food on the bench and hurried away again.
+
+"Do you believe that?" asked Larry.
+
+"No, I don't," came from Grandon. "He told us that simply to scare us,
+or else he doesn't know the real truth."
+
+"Exactly what I think."
+
+"These Russians are a lot of blowers," growled Luke. "Just look at
+Semmel. He was forever tooting his horn, and yet he couldn't do much of
+anything."
+
+"He got us into trouble," said Larry, quickly.
+
+"That's true, but he had to have this warship with all on board to help
+him."
+
+The food which had been brought to them consisted of a big bowl of stew,
+with three spoons, and three chunks of black bread.
+
+"They are going to treat us to the best," said Grandon, sarcastically.
+He lifted one of the spoons and tasted the stew. "Phew, it's hot enough!
+Pepper, garlic, and hot water!"
+
+"Does beat all how these fureigners do love their garlic," grumbled
+Luke. "'Twas the same way with them Spaniards in the Philippines."
+
+"Garlic and grease," added Larry. "And this bread is hard enough to
+build a wall with," he continued. "However, we have got to eat or go
+hungry." And he partook of just enough to stay his stomach. Luke and
+Grandon were not so particular and despite their grumbling managed to
+make away with all that remained.
+
+They saw nothing of the captain, or of the sailors who had been taken
+below, and the time hung heavily on their hands. At night they were
+given three hammocks and these they slung from one side of the prison to
+the other and rested as well as could be expected. The Russian sailors
+often came to the pen to gaze at them, but they had been warned not to
+attempt to converse with the prisoners, so nothing was said.
+
+On the afternoon of the third day aboard of the _Pocastra_, those in the
+pen heard a loud shouting on deck, followed by a rush of feet. Larry,
+who was resting in the corner for the want of something better to do,
+leaped up.
+
+"Something is doing!" he cried to his companions.
+
+"Here comes Captain Ponsberry," ejaculated Tom Grandon.
+
+He was right, the captain was coming up in company with Rosenvischpoff
+and two sailors. The Russian petty officer opened the door of the pen
+and Captain Ponsberry was thrust inside. Then the door was locked as
+before.
+
+"How are you, boys?" cried the captain, cordially. "All well, I hope."
+
+"We are," answered Grandon. "And you?"
+
+"I'm well enough, but still angry to think that we lost the _Columbia_."
+
+"So are we angry," said Larry. "But we've got to stand it. What's that
+noise?"
+
+"They have sighted a Chinese junk, and I reckon they are going to treat
+her as they did our vessel," answered the captain.
+
+The noise on deck continued, followed by quarter of an hour of silence.
+Then came a shot, followed by a second and a third.
+
+"Another order to lay-to," said Larry. "Wonder if the Chinamen will give
+in as we did?"
+
+"They will if they are wise," said Grandon.
+
+But the Chinamen did not believe in surrendering thus easily. They were
+carrying rice for the Japanese army, and thought that this was known to
+the enemy. Consequently they did their best to sail away.
+
+Hardly had the craft started on a new course when the _Pocastra_ opened
+a direct fire upon her. The noise below decks was deafening and fairly
+shook the iron pen in which our friends were confined.
+
+"Hullo, that sounds like real war!" cried Larry. "They mean business
+now."
+
+One broadside was followed by another, and the Chinese junk was raked
+from end to end with such a deadly fire that more than a sixth of the
+sailors and officers were killed. Then the captain flung a white flag to
+the breeze in token of surrender.
+
+"We have won!" cried those on the _Pocastra_, and it was not long before
+our friends understood. Small boats were put out, and presently half a
+dozen Chinese officers from the junk were brought on board as prisoners.
+A fire that had started on the prize ship was put out after some hard
+work; and then a temporary crew was put on board, and the junk followed
+in the wake of the old _Columbia_, with the warship keeping guard over
+both.
+
+
+
+
+CHAPTER XIV
+
+PROGRESS OF THE WAR
+
+
+An hour after the capture of the Chinese junk one of the officers of the
+ill-fated craft was thrust into the prison pen with our friends.
+
+He was a small sallow-eyed Celestial rejoicing in the name of Won Lung,
+and it was soon learned that he could speak a little English, he having
+once paid a visit to San Francisco.
+
+"All go up spout!" said he, referring to his own ship. "T'ink we safe
+when Russian gunboat come, den all up spout!"
+
+"Did they sink your ship?" asked Captain Ponsberry.
+
+"No sink--shoot holes, back, front, side--all up spout. No fightee no
+more den--all up spout!" The latter was his pet phrase and he used it
+over and over again.
+
+"You were in the Japanese trade?"
+
+"Yes--carry rice. Now Russians got rice, got junk--all Won Lung's money
+gone up spout!" And the Celestial made an odd little grimace.
+
+"Well, they took my ship, too."
+
+"Big schooner your shipee?"
+
+"Yes."
+
+"Won Lung weep for you--all ship gone up spout, samee like Won Lung's
+ship gone up spout!"
+
+"Well, we haven't gone up the spout yet," put in Larry, with a laugh.
+"Let us thank fortune that we are alive and well."
+
+"Dat so--Won Lung lose fliends on junk--six, seven, ten--don't know how
+many yet," and the Chinese officer shook his head sadly. "Bad war, bad!"
+
+"Can you tell us how the war is going?" asked Tom Grandon. "These
+Russians say everything is a Russian victory."
+
+"Russians sayee dat?"
+
+"Yes--they pretend to say they have the Japs about beaten."
+
+At this Won Lung screwed up his eyes into mere slits.
+
+"Big lie dat. Japanese win everyt'ing allee timee. Russian warships gone
+up spout--Russian army run like--like--up spout!"
+
+After that Won Lung told them all he knew. It was hard to understand
+him, yet they gathered that there had been another sea fight in the
+vicinity of Port Arthur, in which the Russian navy had come off second
+best, and that the Japanese army that had landed in Korea had driven the
+enemy to the northwestward, over the Yalu River, and was now forcing
+them back upon Liao-Yang.
+
+"If this news about the army is true, Ben and Gilbert must be having a
+hot time of it," was Larry's comment. "I must say, I am mighty glad they
+are on the winning side."
+
+"Didn't I tell ye them Russians are a lot o' blowers?" came from Luke.
+"The truth ain't in 'em half the time."
+
+"Perhaps they do not get the correct news from the front," came from
+Captain Ponsberry. "The censors may keep the bad news back, for fear of
+disheartening the rest of the men in the army and navy."
+
+"They tell me the Russians are very strict about sending out news,"
+rejoined Larry.
+
+"It is true, Larry; no country on the globe is stricter. No telegram can
+be sent without it is inspected, and the newspapers cannot print a
+single scrap of news, or a single editorial, until after the press
+censor has passed upon it."
+
+"If that's the case, I don't wonder that some of the people want to be
+free."
+
+"Russia is more free to-day than she ever was before, and freedom is
+bound to come sooner or later--that is, I mean, not such freedom as we
+have in the United States, but such freedom as they have in England and
+Germany--where, at least, a man can call his soul his own."
+
+"It's a wonder the Russians will fight for their country, if they are so
+ground down."
+
+"They know nothing better, and besides, they are really patriotic. If
+the Czar would only treat them a little better, and give them a little
+more liberty, they would be the most faithful of subjects. But when a
+man can't do at all as he wants to do, and can't open his mouth about it
+either, he is apt to grow sullen and ugly."
+
+As day after day went by life on the Russian warship became almost
+unendurable for Larry and the others. They suffered greatly for the want
+of fresh air, and at last made a vigorous protest to the captain of the
+ship, when he happened to be passing the pen. As a result orders were
+given that they should be allowed three hours on deck each day, one in
+the morning and two after dinner.
+
+"This is a little like," said Larry, when coming on deck for the first
+time. "Oh, how good it feels to breathe fresh air once more!" And he
+filled his lungs to their fullest capacity.
+
+For their daily exercise Larry and Luke were chained together, and the
+pair inspected with great curiosity as much of the warship as was
+allowed.
+
+"It's not so very different from some of our own auxiliary cruisers,"
+said Larry. "But, after all, I like ours better."
+
+"That's right, lad; stick up fer your own country every trip."
+
+"Well, what do you say, Luke?"
+
+"I say I'd rather be on one of Uncle Sam's ships than on any other in
+the world."
+
+While allowed to roam around on deck, Larry often looked eagerly for the
+_Columbia_, but the schooner and the Chinese junk were too far off to be
+distinguished with the naked eye.
+
+"We'd give a good deal to be back on her deck, wouldn't we, Luke?" said
+he.
+
+"Don't mention it, lad; it makes me sick," grumbled the Yankee tar.
+
+"I wish I knew just what was being done on land, don't you? Perhaps this
+war will end soon, and then we'll be set free."
+
+"It won't end yet awhile, Larry, mark my words on that," answered Luke.
+
+The old Yankee sailor was right--the war was far from ended, and here it
+may be well to note briefly what was taking place on the sea between
+Russia and Japan, while the army of the Mikado was pushing through
+Manchuria in the direction of Liao-Yang.
+
+The loss of the great battleship _Petropavlovsk_ has already been
+recorded in "Under the Mikado's Flag." This vessel was sunk by a mine in
+Port Arthur harbor, April 13, 1904, and carried down with her Admiral
+Makaroff and about five hundred officers and men. At the same time the
+battleship _Pobieda_ was also injured by a mine.
+
+The loss of the admiral's flag-ship was a great blow to Russia, and
+while she was trying to recover, Port Arthur was vigorously shelled by
+the Japanese fleet, and many buildings were more or less damaged. Some
+warehouses were set on fire, but the local fire department, aided by the
+Russian garrison, succeeded in putting out the conflagration.
+
+While the Japanese fleet was hammering at the city and the ships from
+beyond the harbor, the Japanese army encircled Port Arthur on land,
+taking possession of every available hill beyond the Russian line of
+defenses. As a consequence, by the middle of May the city was in a
+complete state of siege, nearly all communication with the outside world
+being cut off.
+
+But now came a turn in affairs which, for a short while, made matters
+look favorable for Russia. While the fleet of Admiral Togo was
+patrolling the whole of the southeastern coast of Manchuria and
+protecting the Japanese transports which were pouring troops into the
+country, occurred a catastrophe as appalling as it was unexpected.
+
+On the same day, May 15, the magnificent battleship _Hatsuse_, of the
+Japanese navy, was blown up by mines and sunk, and the protected
+cruiser, _Yoshino_, also of Admiral Togo's fleet, collided in the fog
+with a sister ship, and was a total loss. It is estimated that by these
+two disasters seven hundred men were lost. Among the officers who met
+their fate were men of marked ability which Japan at this crisis could
+ill afford to lose.
+
+The loss of the _Hatsuse_ is worth relating in detail. She had been
+along the coast during a heavy fog, but this had cleared off and the sun
+was shining brightly. Not an enemy was in sight, and all was quiet on
+the great battleship when, without warning, a terrific explosion was
+felt near the stern and a portion of the steering gear was damaged.
+
+"We have struck a mine!" cried some one on board, and without delay
+signals were hoisted for the other vessels in sight to stand by. The
+battleship was drifting and the locality was full of mines. It was a
+moment of terrible suspense. Then came another explosion, greater than
+the first, which ripped large holes through her heavy plates. At once
+the battleship began to fill, and presently she sank like a stone to the
+bottom of the sea. The other warships put out their small boats with all
+speed, and succeeded in rescuing about three hundred officers and men
+out of a total of nearly eight hundred. Among those lost were
+Rear-Admiral Nashiba and Captain Nakao, the commander of the warship.
+
+The _Yoshino_ was lost while steaming slowly southward, after a night's
+vigil near the entrance to Port Arthur harbor. Other vessels of the
+blockading fleet were close by, so each ship had to advance with extreme
+caution. But the fog, instead of lifting, became thicker, and at a
+little before two o'clock in the afternoon the cruiser was rammed by the
+_Kasuga_, another vessel of the fleet. A large hole was torn in the hull
+of the _Yoshino_.
+
+"Out with the collision mats!" cried the commander of the cruiser, and
+the mats were brought out without delay and placed over the side. But
+the hole was too great to be stopped in that manner. Then the captain
+called the entire crew on deck, and ordered the small boats to be
+lowered, five on the starboard side and one on the port. Before the
+boats could be gotten away, the _Yoshino_ listed heavily to starboard
+and went down, smashing the five small boats under her. The other boat
+managed to get away, with only a handful of jackies and a couple of
+officers. The captain remained on the bridge and went down with his
+ship. As soon as possible the _Kasuga_ put out her boats and succeeded
+in rescuing about ninety men, out of a total of over two hundred and
+fifty.
+
+It was a great blow to Japan and the Russians were correspondingly
+elated. Feeling that Admiral Togo's grip on the sea was now weakened,
+the Russian squadron at Vladivostok sailed forth and did much damage to
+the shipping on the northern coast of Japan, sinking several merchantmen
+and taking a number of others as prizes. The Russian squadron also met
+the Japanese transport _Kinshiu Maru_, having on board the 37th regiment
+of Japanese infantry.
+
+"Surrender, or we will sink you!" signaled the Russian commander. The
+Japanese refused, and were given exactly an hour in which to think it
+over. As they still refused, a torpedo was discharged against the doomed
+ship. As she began to sink the Japanese soldiers opened fire with their
+rifles, and then the Russians answered with their machine guns, mowing
+down the Mikado's men by the score. But the Japanese were brave to the
+last, and sank beneath the waves with the cry of _Banzai_! (hurrah!) on
+their lips.
+
+It was an auxiliary cruiser of the Vladivostok squadron which had taken
+the _Columbia_ and the Chinese junk as prizes of war. The captain of the
+cruiser was now looking for the rest of the squadron, but so far none of
+the warships had been sighted.
+
+"They must have returned to Vladivostok," he reasoned, and then turned
+in that direction with the _Pocastra_, never dreaming of what the near
+future held in store for himself, his ship, and his crew.
+
+
+
+
+CHAPTER XV
+
+A SHARP NAVAL BATTLE
+
+
+So far the weather had been good, but following the conversation
+recorded in the last chapter there came up a dense fog, and for
+twenty-four hours the Russian warship did nothing but creep along in the
+gloom.
+
+During that time, for some unknown reason, Larry and the others were
+allowed greater freedom than before. Each had his hands chained behind
+him, but all were separate, which allowed each to roam around as he
+pleased.
+
+"This is better than being linked to somebody else," said the youth to
+his old sailor friend. "Not but that we got along well enough together,"
+he added, hastily.
+
+"You're right--there wasn't no sense in joinin' us together," answered
+Luke. "We can't git away if we want to."
+
+"We might, if we didn't have our hands chained, Luke."
+
+"How?"
+
+"If we all got together some night--providing we could keep out of the
+pen--and stole one of the small boats."
+
+"Easier said nor done. The guard would ketch ye an' shoot ye down like a
+dog."
+
+"Oh, I know there would be a great risk. But I hate to think of going to
+a Siberian prison, or aboard a Russian prison ship."
+
+"So do I, Larry. But even if we stole the boat and got away, where would
+we go to,--especially if we didn't have much provisions an' water?"
+
+Larry could not answer that question, since he did not know the location
+of the _Pocastra_. It might be that they were hundreds of miles from
+land. If so, to take to a small boat with a scarcity of water and
+provisions would certainly be foolhardy.
+
+The fog continued during the night, but swept away as if by magic about
+nine o'clock in the morning. At that time the prisoners had had their
+breakfast and Larry and Luke were between decks, looking at some
+gunners' assistants cleaning out one of the large guns.
+
+Suddenly came a call from the lookout, followed by half a dozen
+commands. As everything said was in Russian, our friends did not
+understand a word, but they soon realized that something unusual was in
+the air. A shrill whistle sounded out and drums began to beat to
+quarters.
+
+"I'll wager a new hat they have sighted a Japanese ship!" cried Larry,
+and scarcely had he spoken when there came a dull booming over the
+water.
+
+"Let us go to the deck an' see what's doing," returned Luke, and both
+started for the stairs. But scarcely had they appeared on the deck when
+they were ordered below again.
+
+Larry was right; a Japanese warship had been sighted, and this vessel
+had lost no time in discharging a signal gun to a sister ship only a few
+miles away.
+
+Hardly had the youth and his friend reached the lower deck once more
+than the Japanese cruiser opened fire on the Russian vessel. The latter
+retaliated, and the booming of cannon shook the _Pocastra_ from stem to
+stern.
+
+"This is a fight for fair!" ejaculated Luke, with a broad smile on his
+face.
+
+"I hope the Japs win, Luke!"
+
+"So do I, lad. But where do we come in, that's what I want to know?"
+
+"If we could only drop overboard and swim to that other ship!"
+
+"No use of trying--some of the fellows in the tops would pick us off in
+no time. No, we've got to stay right where we are an' take what comes."
+
+"Where are the others?"
+
+They looked around, but could see nothing of Captain Ponsberry or Tom
+Grandon. They saw Cal Vincent run past, but he was out of sight before
+they could stop him.
+
+Suddenly a crash above them told that a solid shot had struck the upper
+works of the Russian cruiser. Then came another crash at the bow.
+
+"Those Japs know how to fire," came from the Yankee sailor. "Reckon as
+how they're going to do their best to blow this ship sky-high. I'd give
+'most a dollar to be somewhere else just about now!" And he shook his
+head anxiously.
+
+The Russian gunners were working with a will, and so were their numerous
+assistants. The _Pocastra_ was swung around, and now both ships were
+broadside to each other. The thunder of the guns was terrific and the
+smoke rolled around in all directions.
+
+"Puts me in mind o' the battle o' Manila Bay, eh?" remarked Luke, as he
+and Larry stood at a distance, watching the Russians work one of the
+guns.
+
+"You are right, Luke, only----"
+
+Larry got no further, for at that moment came another crash on deck. The
+_Pocastra_ shivered and heaved, and to those below it was as if she
+would surely sink.
+
+"They're pumping it into us, sure as you're born!" sang out the old
+Yankee tar. "Hullo, what's this?"
+
+There was a rush of several gunners across the deck. "Beware of that
+gun!" yelled one in Russian, and then a stampede followed.
+
+In the midst of the confusion came a fearful explosion from below. A
+portion of the flooring was ripped apart and one of the gunners was
+instantly killed and several wounded. A great volume of smoke rolled up,
+and splinters and bits of iron and steel flew in all directions.
+
+Both Larry and Luke were almost stunned by the explosion and for the
+moment could do nothing but clutch each other in terror. Both were
+struck by the flying splinters, but neither was seriously wounded. They
+staggered back and began to cough, for the dense smoke was strangling.
+
+"Must have been a torpedo----" gasped Luke.
+
+"Or else a magazine!" spluttered Larry. "Let--let us get--get out of
+here. I'm--choking--to--to--death!"
+
+It was really a magazine which had exploded. This tore a good-sized hole
+in the _Pocastra's_ side, in a spot impossible to get at in the
+confusion. In the meantime a solid eight-inch shell struck the Russian
+ship squarely in the stern, doing additional damage and killing and
+wounding two officers and nine men.
+
+Almost choked to death, Larry and Luke crawled to where the ladder ran
+to the deck. The Russian jackies and gunners were swarming up, along
+with all the prisoners.
+
+"Larry, are you safe?" came in the voice of Captain Ponsberry, and he
+loomed up, with Tom Grandon, Cal Vincent, and the Chinese petty officer
+beside him.
+
+"So far I am," answered Larry. "But I--I--must have air!" and he began
+to cough.
+
+The jam on the ladder was terrific, and in the midst of the _melee_ a
+Russian gunner and the Chinese petty officer got into a quarrel. The
+gunner threw the Celestial down, but he bounced up like a ball, and in a
+twinkling the Russian received a blow in the stomach which sent him
+staggering back into the crowd and the deadly smoke.
+
+"No knock me up the spout!" sang out the Celestial. "Ship go down I go
+uppee!" And soon he was out on the upper deck.
+
+Fighting, surging, pushing, and yelling the Russians and our friends got
+to the deck at last. Captain Ponsberry had his coat literally ripped
+from his back, and Cal Vincent had an arm almost torn from its socket.
+For this he gave a Russian gunner a rap in the mouth which knocked loose
+several teeth. It was a case of each man for himself, and many fought
+like wild beasts.
+
+At last Larry found himself free of the crowd, with Luke still beside
+him. Captain Ponsberry and Cal Vincent were not far away, but between
+surged a great number of Russians. The _Pocastra_ was listing heavily to
+port and had evidently taken a large quantity of water into her hull.
+
+Two Japanese warships were now at hand and both were firing upon the
+doomed Russian cruiser with deadly accuracy. From the fighting tops of
+the Mikado's ships came a perfect hail of small bullets which sent the
+Russians to the deck by the score. By this fire one of the _Columbia's_
+sailors was killed and Cal Vincent was seriously wounded. A bullet
+likewise grazed Luke Striker's thigh, drawing some blood, but the Yankee
+tar did not know of this until the conflict was at an end and he saw the
+crimson stain on his shoe top.
+
+At last the Russian captain saw that to fight further would be useless.
+The _Pocastra_ was in danger of going down at any moment. The guns could
+no longer be used, and he ordered the colors lowered and put up a signal
+of surrender.
+
+A wild cheer came from the two Japanese warships when it was realized
+that the battle was won. "_Banzai! Banzai!_" rent the air over and over
+again. "Hurrah for the Mikado! Down with the Russians!"
+
+A little while after the fighting came to an end, several small boats
+put off from the two Japanese warships and half a dozen of the Mikado's
+naval officers presented themselves at the _Pocastra's_ side. The
+Russian ship still listed heavily, but after the smoke below had cleared
+away it was ascertained that the damage done was not as great as had
+been imagined. One of the magazines which had been in danger of blowing
+up had been flooded, and the rush of sea water had likewise put out a
+fire that had started in the stern.
+
+As soon as order could be restored on board of the _Pocastra_ a complete
+surrender was made to the Japanese, the Russian captain giving up his
+sword. Then a general conference was had lasting over an hour. At the
+end of that time, much to their surprise, the Americans were asked to go
+over to one of the Japanese warships.
+
+"We'll go, and glad of the chance," said Captain Ponsberry; and soon the
+transfer was made.
+
+
+
+
+CHAPTER XVI
+
+ABOARD A JAPANESE WARSHIP
+
+
+"What a beauty of a ship!"
+
+Such was Larry's exclamation as he stepped aboard of the Japanese
+warship. The vessel was, like the Russian prize, an auxiliary cruiser
+and named the _Mimora Juri_. She was but three years old and had been
+used for passenger service between Japan and China. For such a small
+cruiser she carried an unusually heavy battery, and everything was
+shined up to the last degree,--the work having been undertaken directly
+after the battle was over. The _Mimora Juri_ had suffered but little
+damage during the contest and only a handful of men had been killed and
+wounded.
+
+"This looks more like Uncle Sam's navy than anything I have seen yet,"
+said Luke.
+
+"Well, I don't know that the decorations aboard our ships are quite so
+fine," returned the youth. "But then this isn't an ordinary fighting
+ship. Some of the auxiliary cruisers we used during the war with
+Spain--those that used to be trans-Atlantic steamers--were just as fine
+as this and finer."
+
+As soon as those from the _Columbia_ reached the Japanese warship the
+wounded were taken in charge by the surgeons and placed in the sick bay,
+as the hospital on a naval vessel is called. This was also in the best
+of order, with nice, swinging cots, and appliances of the latest
+designs.
+
+As there were many things to be arranged between the two Japanese
+vessels and the Russian prize, our friends were not interviewed until
+late in the evening. In the meantime, some of the Russians were made
+prisoners, and a prize crew was placed aboard of the _Pocastra_. Then
+the two Japanese warships moved away, with the captured cruiser between
+them.
+
+"Those Russians must feel sick," was Larry's comment. "It's worse for
+them, in a way, than if their ship had gone down."
+
+"Well, we all thought she was sinking," returned Captain Ponsberry. "If
+she had sunk I reckon some of us wouldn't be here to tell the tale."
+
+When evening came, a guard who could speak a little English conducted
+Captain Ponsberry, Larry, and Tom Grandon to the commander's cabin. Here
+they were met by Captain Tonkaka, who, being a graduate of the Japanese
+naval school, could speak not only English but also several other
+foreign languages. It may be mentioned here that the Japanese naval
+academy of to-day is one of the foremost institutions of its kind in the
+world.
+
+"I will hear your story, Captain Ponsberry," said the Japanese captain,
+politely, as he motioned his visitors to be seated.
+
+In a plain, direct manner the master of the _Columbia_ told his tale,
+starting from the time the schooner left Manila with a cargo intended
+for the Japanese Government. He told of the trouble with Semmel and of
+the mutiny, and then of the capture by the _Pocastra_.
+
+"You have assuredly been unfortunate," said Captain Tonkaka. "Have you
+any idea where your schooner is now?"
+
+"I have not, but I thought she must be close to the Russian ship--she
+and that Chinese junk, too. The _Pocastra_ was taking them to
+Vladivostok as prizes."
+
+"Ah!" The Japanese captain mused for a moment. "I dare say you would
+like to gain back your ship?" he continued.
+
+"Indeed I would!" cried Captain Ponsberry. "I'd give a pretty dollar to
+do so!"
+
+"I shall interview the captain of the Russian warship again to-morrow.
+It may be that he will tell us where she is--although I doubt it."
+
+After this a few questions were put to Larry and Tom Grandon and both
+corroborated what Captain Ponsberry had said. They were also questioned
+concerning the treatment they had received while on the _Pocastra_.
+
+"You may be thankful that the treatment was no worse," said Captain
+Tonkaka. "Of late some of the Russians have treated their prisoners in a
+most brutal fashion."
+
+"We are thankful," replied the master of the _Columbia_.
+
+The majority of the staterooms aboard of the _Mimora Juri_ were occupied
+by the officers of the cruiser, but one small room was turned over to
+Captain Ponsberry, and a larger apartment was turned over to Tom Grandon
+and Larry. At Larry's solicitation Luke Striker was allowed to "bunk in"
+with the first and second mates.
+
+"This 'ere ship is jest about next to a palace," was Luke's comment.
+"Ain't seen nothing so fancy in a long time."
+
+The Japanese warships were bound for the nearest naval station with
+their prize. They could readily have made eighteen knots an hour, but
+the crippled Russian cruiser could not make over ten, and so this was
+the rate of speed set for all three.
+
+The Americans were allowed the freedom of the ship and Larry and Luke
+spent many hours in inspecting the guns and other equipments, and in
+watching the Japanese jackies in the gun and cutlass drills, their
+physical exercises, and in their drills to fight fire and to lower the
+small boats. Everything on board ran as smoothly as clockwork, much to
+their delight.
+
+"I can tell you what, Luke!" cried Larry, enthusiastically, "this beats
+the Russians all hollow! I never saw anything so well done!"
+
+"Almost beats our own navy, doesn't it?"
+
+"Well, I don't know about that. But it is certainly just as good. That
+drill to fight fire is immense, and their physical exercises ought to
+make each man's muscles like iron."
+
+"They are a sturdy lot, lad, no two ways about that,--and they
+understand just how to keep themselves in the pink of condition." Luke
+rubbed his chin reflectively. "Do ye know what I have in mind to do?"
+
+"I think I can make a pretty good guess," came quickly from Larry.
+
+"Well?"
+
+"You're thinking that you'd like to join the Japanese navy, just to have
+a mix-up or two with the Russians."
+
+"You've struck the nail on the head, lad. And why not, seeing as how we
+are out here in fighting waters, and with no ship of our own to go
+aboard?"
+
+"Well, I feel a good bit that way myself. Ben is in the army, and so is
+Gilbert Pennington. If they can make a record for themselves why
+shouldn't I do the same? As it was I came close to joining the army with
+Ben."
+
+"So you told me before. But you're a born sailor, Larry, not a soldier."
+
+"I don't deny it. I'd rather be on board of a ship than on land any
+day."
+
+"Yes, to a fellow as gets used to the sea the land seems a strange
+place."
+
+From the Japanese on the warship who could speak English our friends
+learned much concerning the war. They were told that Admiral Togo's
+fleet was keeping a strict guard over the harbor approach to Port
+Arthur, and that a portion of the Japanese army was hemming in the city
+on the land side and had lately captured several hills of importance.
+
+From Captain Tonkaka the Americans obtained permission to station
+themselves in one of the fighting tops, and here they spent hour after
+hour, on the lookout for the _Columbia_. Captain Ponsberry was
+particularly anxious to find his vessel, and kept scanning the Japan Sea
+through a fine spyglass the Japanese captain loaned him.
+
+"If I can gain possession of that ship, I am going to fix Semmel and
+Peterson," said the master of the _Columbia_.
+
+"Both of them declared that they took possession of the ship for the
+sake of the Russian Government," said Larry. "That being the case, they
+should be treated as prisoners of war."
+
+"Exactly my idea, Larry."
+
+"Semmel is a thoroughly bad egg," came from Tom Grandon. "He will lie
+out of his troubles if he can possibly do so."
+
+"It will be a shame if we don't find the _Columbia_ again," went on
+Larry. "Think of those rascals taking her to Vladivostok and getting
+their share of the prize money! It makes me sick!"
+
+"Captain Tonkaka tells me that other Japanese warships are in this
+vicinity," said Captain Ponsberry. "They may fall in with the schooner
+even if we don't. But what they will do with her, in that case, there is
+no telling. They might claim her as a prize also, and if they did, I'd
+have some trouble in getting my property back."
+
+What the Japanese captain had said was true. In order to counteract the
+doings of the Russian squadron which was raiding the northern and
+eastern coasts of Japan, the Mikado had sent out a flying squadron of
+six or seven vessels, all of which, though not large, had good sailing
+powers.
+
+Owing to the heavy mists, the flying squadron became separated, and two
+of the vessels fell in with the _Pocastra_, as already described. Of the
+other ships some proceeded up the coast to Korea and caught two Russian
+colliers loaded with coal and another ship carrying steel rails for the
+Manchuria railroad. The remainder of the squadron put further to sea,
+and on the fourth day out caught sight of two Russian steamers loaded
+with munitions of war. A chase ensued, lasting three days, and several
+shots were exchanged at long range. But a mist, coming up one night, put
+an end to the chase, and chagrined to think that the enemy had given
+them the slip after all, the Japanese turned back once more, to look for
+the other vessels of the flying squadron.
+
+
+
+
+CHAPTER XVII
+
+THE RETAKING OF THE "COLUMBIA"
+
+
+"We are in for another storm!"
+
+It was Larry who made the remark. He was in one of the tops with Luke,
+gazing anxiously to the westward, where the black clouds were beginning
+to pile up.
+
+"Right you are, lad--and it's going to be a heavy one, unless I miss my
+guess."
+
+The storm broke half an hour later, and the wind and rain were so
+furious that our friends were glad to leave the top and go below. But
+some of the Japanese sailors did not appear to mind the lashing of the
+elements and remained on deck as if nothing out of the ordinary was
+occurring.
+
+"These chaps beat me!" said Larry. "They are certainly as tough as pine
+knots. I never saw their equal."
+
+"I'm beginning to think that the Japanese are a wonderful nation," put
+in Tom Grandon, seriously. "I used to look at them as something like the
+Chinese. But there is a wide difference between them and the Chinks."
+
+"A Chinaman isn't in it alongside of a Japanese," came from Captain
+Ponsberry. "The Japanese are up-to-date and very progressive; the
+Chinese are about a hundred years behind the times."
+
+The storm continued for the best part of half a day. There was but
+little thunder and lightning, but the wind blew a perfect gale. Yet even
+the _Pocastra_ did not seem to mind the wind, and all three of the
+warships proceeded on their way at only a slightly reduced rate of
+speed.
+
+"Such a gale as this will play havoc with the sailing vessels," said
+Larry. "I wonder how the old _Columbia_ is making out?"
+
+"I was thinking that same," rejoined Captain Ponsberry. "To tell the
+truth, I'd rather have her go to the bottom than see her taken to a
+Russian port as a prize."
+
+When the storm cleared away, Larry was one of the first to go on deck,
+to get a whiff of "washed air," as he called it. The others followed.
+
+"I see a sail!" cried the youth, a moment later, and at that instant
+came a cry from the lookout. Far to the eastward was a sailing vessel
+flying a signal of distress.
+
+"She looks familiar to me!" ejaculated Captain Ponsberry, and ran to get
+Captain Tonkaka's glass. One glance through the instrument was enough.
+
+"The _Columbia_!"
+
+"Are you sure?" cried Larry.
+
+"She certainly is the _Columbia_," said Tom Grandon, after a look
+through the glass. "She has lost her fore topmast and part of her
+bowsprit."
+
+"And a part of the stern rail is gone," added Larry, after he too had
+used the glass. "Let us tell Captain Tonkaka," he added, starting to go
+below.
+
+The news that the _Columbia_ was in sight was soon circulated throughout
+the ship, and Captain Tonkaka at once signaled to the other warships
+that he was going to her assistance. Then the _Mimora Juri_ steamed away
+on her new course.
+
+As they drew closer to the schooner they could see that the storm had
+treated the gallant old ship roughly enough. Many of the sails were in
+ribbons, and not only the fore topmast but also half a dozen of the
+spars were gone. One end of the forecastle was stove in, and a part of
+the stern was a wreck.
+
+"This is the worst yet!" cried Larry. "They must have caught more of the
+gale than we did."
+
+"They didn't know how to handle her, that's the reason of it," came from
+Captain Ponsberry. "We have taken her through a worse blow than that;
+eh, Tom?"
+
+"I think so," answered the second mate.
+
+As soon as the Japanese warship was close enough a boat was lowered and
+an officer went aboard of the schooner, followed by several of his crew
+and Captain Ponsberry, Grandon, and Larry.
+
+The Russians having the schooner in charge were meek enough. As a matter
+of fact the gale had terrorized them, and all had imagined they were
+surely going to the bottom of the sea. They did not like it to find
+themselves in the hands of the enemy and were astonished when they
+learned that the _Pocastra_ had been captured.
+
+"It was a fearful storm," said the Russian officer who was in charge.
+"Several times I fancied the masts would all go by the board. I shall
+never want another such experience. One man was washed overboard and
+several were badly hurt by the wrecking of the forecastle."
+
+"Were any of my former men injured?" asked Captain Ponsberry.
+
+"It was my fellow countryman, Ostag Semmel, who was swept overboard and
+drowned," answered the Russian officer.
+
+"Semmel!" ejaculated Larry. He drew a long breath and his hatred of the
+man died all in an instant. "Poor chap! That was rough on him!"
+
+"It certainly was rough," answered Captain Ponsberry. "And what of the
+others?"
+
+"Both Peterson and Shamhaven were hurt, but not seriously. They are
+below resting," was the answer.
+
+It was found that some of the seams of the schooner had opened but that
+no alarming quantity of water was running into the well. The Russians
+were asked to surrender as prisoners of war and this they did willingly,
+and were transferred to the Japanese warship. Then Captain Ponsberry was
+asked if he wished to take charge of the _Columbia_ again.
+
+"Will a duck swim!" he cried. "Of course I want to take charge. Hasn't
+she always been my ship? And my crew will want to go with me, I know."
+
+"But the wreckage----" began Captain Tonkaka.
+
+"I'll attend to that, sir,--don't you worry. Only give me back my ship,
+that's all I ask."
+
+"It shall be as you say, Captain Ponsberry. But when you get to Nagasaki
+you will have to settle matters with the Japanese Government. It is, all
+told, a rather peculiar case. In one way, she is now a Japanese prize of
+war, and in another way she is not."
+
+"I understand, and the courts will have to settle the tangle, sir. I'll
+do what is fair, and I know the Richmond Importing Company will do the
+same."
+
+"Then you can go aboard of the ship as soon as you please."
+
+"Thank you very much."
+
+Captain Ponsberry had returned to the warship for just this talk, and
+now he lost no time in getting back to the _Columbia_, taking with him
+all his crew, including Cal Vincent, who was just about able to get
+around once more.
+
+"Hurrah!" cried Larry, "this seems like home once more, doesn't it?"
+
+"That's what it does," answered Luke. "But there is plenty of work
+ahead, I can tell you that, lad."
+
+"I don't care--work will help to pass the time."
+
+When Peterson and Shamhaven saw Captain Ponsberry they did not know what
+to say. The loss of their leader, Semmel, had humbled them greatly.
+
+"I'm not going to say much to you, seeing as how both of you are hurt,"
+said the master of the _Columbia_, briefly. "But understand, I want no
+nonsense from either of you."
+
+"I'll do all I can to assist you, captain," said Shamhaven, humbly. "All
+I want is another chance."
+
+"Which you'll not get from me," was the quick rejoinder. "I know you
+thoroughly, Shamhaven, and I am done with you. You and Peterson aided
+the Russians and you can now consider yourselves under arrest. When we
+get into port I'm going to hand you over to the Japanese authorities."
+
+Both of the culprits wanted to argue, but the captain would not listen.
+Their hurts were inspected and they were told that they would be allowed
+three days in which to recuperate, after which they would have to do
+their share of duty.
+
+"I don't like this," growled Shamhaven, after the interview was over.
+"Peterson, we are in it deeper than ever."
+
+"Dat is so," was the answer, with a scowl. "Vell, ve not put up mit him,
+hey? Maybe, ven we git near shore, we run avay, Shamhaven."
+
+"Yes, if we can get the chance. But I don't know where you are going to
+run to--especially if you haven't any money."
+
+"Ve git money."
+
+"From where?"
+
+"I ton't know dot yet, no, but ve git him, yes. Captain Ponsberry must
+haf some, and dot Larry Russell, too. Vonce I see Russell mit a money
+pelt vot haf some gold in him, yes."
+
+"A money belt with gold? You must be dreaming."
+
+"No, I see him mit mine two eyes. He count der gold. He haf more as
+dirty pieces."
+
+"That is worth remembering," answered Shamhaven. And he began to
+speculate upon what he could do in Japan if he was free and had a money
+belt full of gold.
+
+That Larry had a money belt was true. He had purchased it several years
+before, while on shore duty in the Philippines. He was a saving fellow
+and found the belt useful in which to place his wages and the money
+which he occasionally received from home. Strange as it may seem, the
+belt had not been taken away from him by the Russians, and it now
+contained nearly three hundred dollars. The money was mostly in
+gold,--for he had found that gold could be used no matter where he went.
+
+
+
+
+CHAPTER XVIII
+
+A CLEVER RUSE
+
+
+As soon as Captain Ponsberry was in charge of the _Columbia_ once more
+he set about without delay to put the schooner in proper condition for
+the run to Nagasaki. The broken-off foremast was allowed to remain as it
+was, but a temporary bowsprit was set into place, and the damage to the
+forecastle and to the stern repaired. A temporary rail was also nailed
+up, so that there might be no danger of anybody slipping overboard.
+
+In all this work the sailors and the ship's carpenter did their best,
+and the captain and his mates helped. Sails were also sewed up, or
+replaced, and inside of forty-eight hours the old _Columbia_ was once
+more on her way. The water taken aboard was pumped out, and the pumps
+were kept going two hours each morning and two hours each afternoon.
+
+"She will do now," said the captain, after the heaviest of the work was
+over. "But when we reach Nagasaki I'll have to put her in the dock for
+regular repairs. I shouldn't dare to take her to Manila or to San
+Francisco in such a condition."
+
+"It will take a long time to have the repairs made in Japan," said
+Larry. "All the shipyards are busy on government work."
+
+"True, lad, but that cannot be helped. The law would not allow me to
+sign a crew with a ship that was not seaworthy."
+
+"Then we'll have a long lay-off when we reach Nagasaki."
+
+"Exactly, Larry. But I shan't keep you. If you want to go elsewhere----"
+
+"Not on another sailing vessel, Captain Ponsberry. But you know how it
+is with Luke Striker and myself. Ever since we were in our own navy we
+have had a hankering after warships, and----"
+
+"And you think of joining the Japanese navy?" put in the master of the
+schooner, quickly.
+
+"That's it. You know how I spoke of joining the army with Ben and
+Gilbert."
+
+"To be sure--and I told you I couldn't spare you."
+
+"But now, if you haven't any use for me any longer----"
+
+"Why, Larry, if you want to fight for Japan, go ahead and fight!"
+ejaculated Captain Ponsberry. "I don't blame you. I'd fight myself if I
+was a younger man and hadn't any obligations on my shoulders. I suppose
+Ben is doing great things in the army and you'd like to match him in the
+navy, eh?"
+
+"If I join the navy I'll do my best."
+
+"Will Striker go with you?"
+
+"Oh, yes, Luke and I always go together, if we can. He was my chum when
+we fought under Dewey and he has been my chum ever since."
+
+"And a good fellow, too, Larry--a man with a heart of gold. If it wasn't
+that you and Tom Grandon were with me, I should have made him a mate
+long ago."
+
+"I don't doubt that, sir--and he is worthy of it." Larry paused for a
+moment. "Of course, I don't know if they want any of us in the navy."
+
+"Didn't you tell me before that they had several men you had met while
+under Dewey and some your brother Walter had met while fighting in Cuban
+waters?"
+
+"Yes, but that was some time ago."
+
+"If they took those chaps then it's likely they will take you
+now--unless, of course, they have all the men they want--which I doubt."
+
+"We shall not go as ordinary jackies. Ben got a commission as a captain,
+and Luke thinks he might go as a gunner and I might go as an assistant
+gunner. We occupied those positions before we left our navy."
+
+"Then I should certainly strike for the positions. They may need gunners
+even if they don't need common seamen," responded Captain Ponsberry.
+
+As fortune would have it, the run to Nagasaki was made without incident
+worthy of special mention. Once there was a scare on board, as the water
+in the well hole increased with alarming rapidity. But the new leak was
+discovered in time, and the ship's carpenter had little difficulty in
+repairing it. They also sighted a vessel they thought might be a Russian
+warship, but she proved instead to be a Japanese coastwise freighter,
+carrying lumber from one port to another on the northern coast of Japan.
+
+As the _Columbia_ drew closer to Nagasaki both Peterson and Shamhaven
+grew more anxious over what was to become of them. Neither desired a
+term in a Japanese prison, and both wondered what sort of a charge
+Captain Ponsberry and the captain of the Japanese warship would prefer
+against them.
+
+So far Captain Ponsberry had allowed them their liberty, but through the
+talk of a couple of sailors they presently learned that they were to be
+cast into the ship's brig and placed under guard as soon as the schooner
+dropped anchor.
+
+"This looks black for us," said Shamhaven, moodily. "I wish we were out
+of it."
+
+"I haf a plan got, yes," answered Peterson.
+
+"To get away?"
+
+The other nodded.
+
+"Then let me hear the plan by all means, Peterson."
+
+"It vos--vot you call him--risky, yes. Maype ve get shot--you no like
+him, no?"
+
+"Of course I don't want to get shot. But what is your plan?"
+
+"So soon like de ship come up by der harbor we vatch our chances an'
+trop oferpoard, yes."
+
+"And swim ashore?"
+
+"Maype ve schwim by some udder poat, yes. Of ve got money we go to
+leetle poat--gif Jap mans money to take us avay, you see now?"
+
+"You mean to watch for some small Japanese boat--a bumboat, eh? And
+bribe the boatman to take us to some place of safety?"
+
+"You got him now, yes."
+
+"That's good enough if we can find the bumboat and get the money with
+which to do the bribing."
+
+"Captain Ponsberry got money--an' Russell he got money pelt, like I told
+you."
+
+"Oh, I haven't forgotten about that money belt," returned Shamhaven.
+"And I wouldn't mind taking it if I could get my hands on it. But
+Russell must wear it most of the time."
+
+"I t'ink he not put him on by der night dime, no."
+
+"What do you know about Captain Ponsberry's money?"
+
+"He got money in a leetle pag--I see him vonce."
+
+"How much do you think?"
+
+At this Peterson shrugged his shoulders.
+
+"No can tell dat--maype a thousand dollars."
+
+There was a pause, and Shamhaven drew a long breath.
+
+"One thing is certain," he resumed. "I don't intend to go to a Japanese
+prison, or an American prison either, if I can help it, and if we cut
+loose here in a strange country we are bound to need more or less money
+with which to get along. Without money a fellow can't do a thing in a
+strange country."
+
+"We git money--chust you vait," said Peterson.
+
+At last the _Columbia_ came into sight of the shipping of Nagasaki. But
+it was now dark, and a heavy fog was hanging over the harbor, so it was
+impossible to make the proper landing before the next day. They came to
+anchor and the necessary lights were hung out.
+
+"This is our chance," said Shamhaven. "It is now or never!"
+
+He had heard that Peterson and himself were to be made close prisoners
+directly after supper. He watched his chance and when nobody was looking
+motioned his confederate to leave the forecastle and steal silently
+toward the stern of the ship. Each carried a block of wood, to which was
+attached a bit of iron, to make it sink from sight.
+
+"Now then!" whispered Shamhaven, and threw the block he carried
+overboard. It struck the water with a loud splash, and the block carried
+by Peterson immediately followed.
+
+"Hullo, what's that?" came in the voice of Tom Grandon. "Who threw
+something overboard?"
+
+"Sounded like somebody jumping into the water," replied Captain
+Ponsberry, who was on deck with the first mate.
+
+An examination was made, but in the fog and darkness nothing could be
+discovered.
+
+"It was mighty queer," was Grandon's comment. "Somebody must have done
+it."
+
+"Where are Shamhaven and Peterson?"
+
+"In the forecastle, I suppose. Do you think----"
+
+"I don't know what to think. See if they are there."
+
+At once Tom Grandon ran off, and made a tour not only of the forecastle
+but also of the forward deck. He called the men's names several times,
+and others quickly joined in the hunt.
+
+"They are gone!" he ejaculated, running back to where Captain Ponsberry
+stood.
+
+"Gone? Then it must have been them jumping overboard that we heard!"
+
+"Like as not--and they are a good bit away from the schooner by this
+time."
+
+"Bring a lantern and we'll take a look around."
+
+A lantern was brought, and a few minutes later a small boat was lowered,
+manned by Luke and three other sailors. Captain Ponsberry went with
+them, and the searchers remained out the best part of an hour.
+
+"They've given us the slip clean and clear," declared the master of the
+_Columbia_, on returning. "It was a risky thing to undertake in such
+weather as this."
+
+"Yes, and for all we know they may be at the bottom of the harbor,"
+answered Tom Grandon.
+
+"Which place might be jest what they deserve," grumbled Luke Striker, as
+he helped to stow away the small boat once more.
+
+
+
+
+CHAPTER XIX
+
+THE DISAPPEARANCE OF THE ENEMY
+
+
+As soon as Peterson and Shamhaven threw the blocks of wood overboard
+they darted for the companionway of the schooner and crept noiselessly
+down to the cabin.
+
+The apartment was deserted, and the swinging lamp over the center table
+was turned low. On the table rested several charts which Captain
+Ponsberry had been consulting before joining Tom Grandon on deck.
+
+It was Larry's watch below and he was improving the time by taking a
+much-needed nap. He lay on the berth in his stateroom, with the door
+wide open to admit the fresh air.
+
+"Make no noise!" whispered Shamhaven. "If we are discovered the jig is
+up with us."
+
+"Russell is here, yes?" came from Peterson.
+
+"Sh-sh! Yes--over in yonder stateroom."
+
+They closed the door leading to the companionway and then tiptoed their
+way to where Larry lay.
+
+"More than likely he keeps his money belt under his pillow when he
+sleeps," said Shamhaven. "Wait till I find out."
+
+He shoved his hand under the headrest with caution and presently his
+fingers came into contact with a strip of leather and chamois. He pulled
+on it gently, but it refused to budge.
+
+"Lift his head a little," he said, and Peterson started to do as
+requested. But the movement, gentle as it was, caused Larry to open his
+eyes.
+
+"Wha--what are you doing here?" stammered the young second mate, when,
+waiting for no more words, Peterson clapped a dirty hand over his mouth.
+
+"Keep still, you! If you no keep still I hit you good, yes!"
+
+"Confound the luck," muttered Shamhaven. "I didn't want him to know what
+we were up to."
+
+Larry began to struggle and with an effort threw aside the hand over his
+mouth.
+
+"Le--let up!" he spluttered. "I want you----Help!"
+
+"Shut up!" cried Shamhaven, fiercely, and struck him a swinging blow in
+the temple. Another blow from Peterson followed, and then, with flashing
+lights darting through his brain, Larry lost consciousness.
+
+Both men bent over him to see if he would move. When he lay as still as
+if dead they looked at each other with satisfaction.
+
+"He won't bother us any more--at least, not for awhile," was Shamhaven's
+comment.
+
+"Quick, de money belt!" came from Peterson, and as he raised up Larry's
+head, Shamhaven secured it and stowed it away in the bosom of his shirt.
+"You no keep him!" he went on, in alarm, showing that he did not trust
+his companion in crime.
+
+"We'll divide up afterwards," said Shamhaven, briefly. "Now to locate
+the captain's little pile."
+
+Both tiptoed their way into Captain Ponsberry's stateroom. Here there
+was a small safe, with the door closed.
+
+"A safe, eh?" said Shamhaven. "Wonder if we can open it?"
+
+He knelt down and tried to work the combination lock. The safe was old
+and out of order and the captain had had the combination lock made as
+simple as possible in consequence. Soon there came a click, followed by
+another, and the bolts shot back.
+
+"Luck is with us!" cried Shamhaven.
+
+"Dare is de leetle pag," came from Peterson, and reaching into the safe
+he drew the article forth. There was a slip string at the top which he
+pulled apart.
+
+"Gold!" he cried. "See--dirty--forty bieces of gold!" And then he shut
+the bag again, and placed it into his own shirt bosom.
+
+"Remember, half of that is mine," came sharply from Shamhaven. He
+fancied there might be more in the bag than in the money belt.
+
+"Yes,--an' haf de money-pelt money ist mine, yes," returned Peterson.
+
+"Right you are, Peterson. Now to get away from the ship."
+
+"Let us lock Russell in de stateroom first."
+
+"A good idea!"
+
+The door was closed and locked. Larry still lay unconscious and there
+was no telling how soon he would come to his senses.
+
+They heard the tramping on the deck and the departure of the small boat.
+Now those in the boat came back and the search for the missing men came
+to an end.
+
+With the slyness of a pair of cats, the evildoers crept up the
+companionway once more. Nobody was in sight, and they crawled rather
+than walked to the rail of the schooner. Both were good swimmers and not
+afraid to trust themselves to reach some other shipping in the harbor.
+Yet as an extra precaution each provided himself with a life-preserver.
+
+"Are you ready, Peterson?"
+
+"Yes."
+
+"Then over we go."
+
+A small rope was handy, and lowering this, each slid along it into the
+waters of the harbor. Then they struck out swiftly but silently; and in
+a few minutes the fog and darkness hid them completely from view.
+
+It was the best part of an hour before Larry returned to his senses. His
+head ached as if ready to split open and for several minutes he could
+not remember where he was or what had occurred.
+
+"Oh, my head!" he groaned. "Oh!" And he turned over and tried to sit up,
+with the result that he pitched out on the floor of the stateroom. This
+aroused him and he got up as quickly as he could.
+
+"Those rascals attacked me!" he muttered. "They struck me over the head!
+I remember now! Oh, how my head spins,--just as if I was in a
+merry-go-round! I wonder----"
+
+He dropped on the berth and snatched away the pillow. One glance was
+sufficient to show him how he had been robbed.
+
+"That's why they attacked me!" he cried. "Wonder where they are now?
+Perhaps they ran away from the ship!"
+
+Leaping up again he stepped to the door, and finding it locked, began to
+pound away lustily, at the same time yelling at the top of his lungs. In
+a few minutes this brought down Captain Ponsberry, followed by Luke, who
+had been told to come along, the captain fearing that something had gone
+wrong.
+
+"What's up here?" demanded Captain Ponsberry as he flung open the door.
+
+"Where are they?" came the counter-question from Larry.
+
+"They? Who?"
+
+"Peterson and Shamhaven?"
+
+"Gone--slid away in the fog."
+
+"They have robbed me!"
+
+"You don't say!" ejaculated the master of the _Columbia_. "You are
+sure?" he went on.
+
+"Yes. My money belt is gone. They came while I was asleep, and when I
+woke up both hit me,--and I don't know what happened after that. I just
+came to my senses and found myself locked in."
+
+"The villains!" burst in Luke. "Those chaps ought to be swung up to a
+yardarm!"
+
+The captain listened to Larry's story and then was prompted to take a
+look around the other staterooms. As a result he speedily discovered
+that the safe had been tampered with and that his own money was gone.
+
+"They are worse rascals than I thought them," said Captain Ponsberry,
+bitterly. "I am sorry that I did not make an example of them from the
+start."
+
+There was a good deal of speculation concerning what had become of
+Shamhaven and Peterson, and another search was instituted, lasting until
+the following day, but not a single trace of the evildoers could be
+found.
+
+"Well, I am out the whole of my savings," said Larry to Luke.
+
+"It's a shame, lad," replied the Yankee tar. "But if you need ready cash
+don't fail to draw on me. As long as I have a shot in the locker half on
+it is yours."
+
+"Thank you, Luke; I know you'd say that. You're the proper kind of a
+friend to have."
+
+"Avast, Larry, with your compliments. Wouldn't you do the same fer me?"
+
+"Indeed I would!"
+
+"Then it ain't worth talkin' about. Jest the same, I hope we run into
+them rascals some day; don't you?"
+
+"I do. But more than likely they'll give the _Columbia_ and us a wide
+berth after this," returned Larry.
+
+
+
+
+CHAPTER XX
+
+LARRY BEFORE ADMIRAL TOGO
+
+
+As soon as the _Columbia_ could make the proper landing, Captain
+Ponsberry went ashore and reported his arrival to the authorities, and
+also reported the escape of Shamhaven and Peterson. The authorities had
+already heard of the capture of the _Columbia_ from the Russians, and
+said that the schooner would have to remain at Nagasaki until the whole
+case could be adjusted. The Japanese were inclined to favor both the
+Richmond Importing Company and the owners of the vessel, so it was not
+likely that our friends would lose much in the end. In the meantime the
+_Columbia_ could be put in a dry-dock and given the overhauling that she
+needed.
+
+"We shall do all we can to locate Shamhaven and Peterson and get back
+your money," said an official of the secret service department. But his
+hands were so full with other matters of greater importance that little
+attention was paid to the disappearance of the two rascals.
+
+"Well, this will tie me up at Nagasaki for some time to come," said
+Captain Ponsberry to Larry, on the third day after arriving at the
+Japanese port.
+
+"Which means, I suppose, that I can join the Japanese navy if I wish,"
+returned the young second mate, quickly.
+
+"I don't want to force you to leave the ship, lad. But you said----"
+
+"I know, Captain Ponsberry, and I am glad of the chance to get away.
+Luke and I have talked it over once more, and yesterday we met a gunner
+named Steve Colton--he served on the _Brooklyn_ at the time Walter did.
+He is now a gun captain on board of Admiral Togo's flagship, and he is
+almost certain he can get us good positions. He says gunners and
+gunners' assistants are just now badly needed."
+
+"Then go by all means, Larry, and make even a bigger record for yourself
+than your brother Ben is making in the army. Perhaps, when this war is
+over, you'll come back to the old _Columbia_, eh?"
+
+"More than likely, and I guess Luke Striker will come, too."
+
+What Larry had said about meeting Steve Colton was true. As readers of a
+story of mine entitled "Fighting in Cuban Waters" know, Colton had been
+a gun captain under Commodore Schley, and as such had become fairly well
+acquainted with Walter Russell and had also heard of Larry, who was at
+that time serving under Admiral Dewey at Manila.
+
+A detail from Admiral Togo's flagship had been sent ashore at Nagasaki,
+and Larry and Luke, as they walked through the streets, had met several
+of these men. Hearing two of them speaking English they had halted the
+pair; and introductions had followed.
+
+"So you are Larry Russell," said Steve Colton. "Any relation to Walter
+Russell that once served on the U. S. Cruiser _Brooklyn_?"
+
+"Walter is my brother," replied Larry, quickly.
+
+"Oh, so you are the chap that was cast away in the Pacific and picked up
+by Admiral Dewey's flagship, eh?"
+
+"The same, and this is the friend who was with me, Luke Striker."
+
+"Glad to know ye both." Steve Colton shook hands. "This is my friend,
+Bob Stanford--he hails from San Francisco and is a gunner's mate with
+me. What are you doing in this corner of the earth?"
+
+A long talk followed, in which Larry and Luke told their story, and
+Steve Colton and his friend related how they had come to join the
+Japanese navy.
+
+"It's this way," said Colton. "I've got the fighting blood in my veins
+and it won't come out. As soon as this war broke out, I cut sticks from
+'Frisco with Bob and we comes to Tokio. There I met another American who
+was in the navy here, and it wasn't two days before we were booked for
+Admiral Togo's flagship. We've been down to Port Arthur twice, and I
+reckon we'll go again before long."
+
+"Perhaps we'll go up to Vladivostok next time," came from Bob Stanford.
+"I've heard something of bombarding that Russian port."
+
+Colton and Stanford had a couple of hours to themselves and Larry and
+Luke invited them over to the _Columbia_. In return they were asked to
+come over to Admiral Togo's flagship, the gunners having the privilege
+of bringing their friends aboard during the brief stay in Nagasaki
+harbor.
+
+"You can come aboard to-morrow," said Steve Colton. "They have an
+inspection and drill, and you can see how they do it in the Japanese
+navy--not but what it's a good bit like it's done on Uncle Sam's
+warships."
+
+Larry and Luke were very willing to go aboard of the Japanese warship,
+and were taken out by Colton the next day, and introduced to several
+gunners and others who could speak a little English. They were also
+taken before the head gunner, who took them to the commander of the
+warship.
+
+"They both served under Admiral Dewey at Manila," said the head gunner,
+and this made the commander smile quietly as he shook hands and told
+them to make themselves at home.
+
+"Everything is as clean as a whistle," was Larry's comment, as they
+walked around the forward part of the warship and through the gun decks.
+"The Japs certainly know how to take care of things. Luke, just look at
+how the brasswork shines!"
+
+"That's the way it ought to be," was the Yankee tar's reply. "No
+slackness, an' I'm glad on it. I love a clean ship above all things."
+
+Steve Colton and Bob Stanford were enthusiastic over the gun they
+commanded and explained how it worked. It was certainly an effective
+weapon and Larry and Luke were thoroughly interested.
+
+"I could handle sech a gun myself," said Luke. "An' do some damage, too;
+eh, Larry?"
+
+"Anyway, I'd like to try it," returned the youth.
+
+Orders were now being issued for the inspection and drill, and presently
+nearly all on board of the flagship hurried to the main deck. Here the
+marines were drawn up in long lines, with the officers in their proper
+places. The sailors and gunners were also at hand, each togged out in
+his best, for inspection by an admiral on any warship means a great
+deal.
+
+Presently Admiral Togo appeared, followed by several other naval
+officers of lesser rank. He was in full dress, with many decorations on
+his breast, and carried his sword. He proved to be a man well along in
+years, with a round face, and small mustache and goatee.
+
+"He looks like a fighter!" whispered Larry.
+
+"True for you, lad," returned Luke. "An' I reckon he knows how to handle
+men."
+
+What our friends said about Admiral Togo was true. He was a fighter and
+a born leader of men. When the Naval Academy of Japan was inaugurated he
+was one of the first graduates, and he was sent by the government to
+complete his nautical education in England, where, during 1873 and 1874,
+he served on the training ship _Worcester_, making a record for himself
+as a first-class pupil in every respect.
+
+On returning home Togo Heihachiro--to use his full name--found a great
+task confronting his people. They were becoming civilized as we term
+civilization and needed a modern navy. He set to work with vim and
+vigor, and then and there laid the foundation of that navy which is
+to-day known as one of the most effective in the world.
+
+The navy had scarcely come into existence when there came rumors of war
+with China. The rumors grew, and China became more and more hateful
+toward the Japanese. To the outside world it looked as if China, with
+her vast territory and her immense number of people, would swallow up
+the sons of Nippon bodily.
+
+At last it was discovered that China was transporting troops with which
+to begin the war. Togo waited for no instructions from his home
+government. He went at the Chinese with vigor. The war followed, and
+after a number of thrilling contests the Japanese were victorious, and
+Admiral Togo emerged from the struggle covered with glory.
+
+"He is the man to lead us to victory against the Russians!" was the cry
+throughout the navy, when war was declared between Russia and Japan, and
+how he sent his ships to Port Arthur and other places, and what
+effective work was done by them, has already been related. In the whole
+of the Japanese navy, to serve on the admiral's flagship, the _Mikasa_,
+was considered a great honor.
+
+The inspection and drill were exceedingly interesting to Larry and Luke,
+and they watched both with close attention. After it was over Admiral
+Togo addressed the men briefly and then turned to the commander of the
+ship.
+
+"See, he is pointing to us!" whispered Luke. "Hang me if I don't think
+he is talking about us to the captain!"
+
+"An officer is coming," replied Larry, and a moment later one of the
+admiral's staff came hurrying to them.
+
+"Are you the two Americans who served under Admiral Dewey at Manila?"
+questioned the staff officer.
+
+"We are," answered Larry.
+
+"Admiral Togo wishes you to come to him."
+
+"Oh, Luke, we are going to be presented to the admiral!" cried Larry.
+
+"Great pewter!" groaned the Yankee tar. "I didn't expect this nohow. But
+I don't care," he added, bracing up. "He ain't no bigger nor Dewey. Come
+along."
+
+He followed the staff officer and Larry did the same. They felt that the
+eyes of many of the sailors and marines were on them, and stepped out as
+firmly as possible. Coming up to the admiral, they took off their caps
+and saluted.
+
+Admiral Togo surveyed the two Americans with interest. He had heard how
+they had come to serve under Dewey at Manila and he smiled pleasantly as
+he held out his hand, first to Larry and then to Luke.
+
+"Let me give you a welcome, my men," said he. "I have been told your
+story. I hope this visit to my ship has interested you."
+
+"Very much, sir," answered Luke.
+
+"I liked the drill, sir," answered Larry, with a smile. "It was fine.
+And everything is so clean! Really, I don't think it could be cleaner!"
+
+At this Admiral Togo smiled again. "That is a compliment,--since it
+comes from one who has served in the American navy."
+
+He then asked them to remain where they were, while some of the men went
+through an exercise with their cutlasses. There was also a gun drill,
+and they were asked to show how they had handled a gun during the battle
+of Manila Bay.
+
+"You are well drilled, I can see that," said the admiral, on dismissing
+them. "They tell me you think of entering our navy. If you wish to do so
+I think likely we can find suitable openings for you."
+
+
+
+
+CHAPTER XXI
+
+LETTERS OF INTEREST
+
+
+The enlistment of Larry and Luke Striker into the Japanese navy came
+sooner than anticipated. A new warship was being fitted out at a harbor
+some forty miles from Nagasaki, and Steve Colton and Bob Stanford were
+transferred to this. Two new gun crews were badly needed on the new
+ship, and inside of forty-eight hours our friends had signed the muster
+roll and were put into training, under Colton. The positions occupied
+were those of gunner and gunner's mate.
+
+"Hurrah for Nippon!" cried Larry, enthusiastically. "Luke, after this we
+have got to learn to yell _Banzai!_ in true Japanese style."
+
+"This gun is a beauty," replied the Yankee tar, as he looked the piece
+over. "I reckon as I can make her do considerable damage if I get the
+chance."
+
+"And I'll help all I can," said Larry. "Won't Ben and Gilbert be
+surprised when they hear of this?" he added.
+
+"They might know you'd do something of the sort."
+
+"That's so, too. By the way, I'm going up to the post-office to-day and
+see if there are any letters."
+
+Much to the satisfaction of our friends they found over a score of men
+on the warship who could speak English. Some, of course, could speak but
+little, yet they could make themselves understood. On the other hand,
+both Larry and Luke began to pick up the Japanese language remarkably
+fast.
+
+"If we keep at this for six months we'll be regular Japanese," said the
+youth. "It's not so hard as I thought it would be."
+
+They found the discipline on the warship very strict and were called on
+to "toe the mark" continually. Yet all the officers were as considerate
+as they were firm, so there was little of hardship.
+
+When Larry called at the post-office for letters he found two good-sized
+epistles awaiting him. One was from his brother Walter, and ran, in
+part, as follows:
+
+ "There is nothing particularly new in this part of the
+ globe. I am doing very well in my new business and it looks
+ now as if I should make a big thing of it. I rather think I
+ am more cut out for work on land than for life on shipboard,
+ although I don't regret the time I spent in the navy.
+
+ "Uncle Job is feeling very well these days and is building a
+ new wing to the old house--going to put in a library of good
+ books he tells me. He is as dear an old chap now as anybody
+ would want for an uncle.
+
+ "I suppose you will hear from Ben and Gilbert. I am
+ expecting a letter every day. It's queer you didn't go with
+ them, but I suppose the old _Columbia_ with her crew suits
+ you better."
+
+"I am glad everything is all right at home," thought Larry, as he
+finished reading the communication. "A new wing to the house, eh? Uncle
+Job must be spreading himself. Reckon he has found out there is
+something more to live for in this world than mere money."
+
+The second letter was from Ben, as he could tell by the handwriting. It
+had been on the way a long time and had been sent to half a dozen
+places, including Manila. There was a great deal about life in the
+Japanese army, and also a full description of the capture of Liao-Yang.
+Ben then continued:
+
+ "We are now on guard a few miles outside of the city. Our
+ camp stretches for many miles, and we are doing all in our
+ power to strengthen our position. What the next move will be
+ there is no telling. One report is, that our particular
+ command will help to chase the Russians to Mukden, while
+ another report has it that we are to march southward, to aid
+ in the attempt to take Port Arthur.
+
+ "I have already told you what trouble Gilbert had with that
+ rascally Russian merchant, Ivan Snokoff, and with Snokoff's
+ confederate, Captain Barusky, of the Russian army. Well, at
+ Liao-Yang we found Snokoff disguised as a Chinaman, and
+ Gilbert made the fellow pay over all that was coming to him
+ for the Richmond Importing Company. In the attempt to
+ capture Snokoff, Gilbert shot him in the leg. It was only a
+ slight wound, but the Russian was as mad as a hornet, and he
+ vowed he would get square some time. He is now in the
+ hospital here, but they expect to let him leave in a few
+ days. He really ought to be put under arrest, but as he has
+ paid up the money he owed, there doesn't seem to be any way
+ of holding him. It's out of the question to go to court with
+ the case. I helped Gilbert to put Snokoff under guard, and
+ he is as angry at me as he is at Gilbert. I don't know if he
+ will dare to do anything or not, but both of us are keeping
+ our eyes open."
+
+Larry read this letter twice before he stowed it away. He was always
+interested in war news and he thought the description of the great
+battle of Liao-Yang very realistic. He shook his curly head when he
+thought of Ivan Snokoff.
+
+"He must be an underhanded rascal if ever there was one," he mused. "And
+to think he disguised himself as a Chinaman! I'll wager Gilbert thought
+it a fine thing to expose him and make him pay up. But he and Ben had
+better look out, or Snokoff and that Captain Barusky may cause them a
+lot of trouble."
+
+Larry had an hour to himself, and he spent the time in answering both
+letters, telling briefly what had happened to him since the trip to
+Manila and how he and Luke were now in service on board of the Japanese
+warship _Shohirika_. He added that he liked the position of gunner's
+mate very much, and that he meant to make a record for himself if given
+the opportunity to do so. He also told about the doings of Shamhaven and
+Peterson, and said he hoped to bring them to justice, although he
+realized that looking for them was as bad as "looking for a pearl on the
+ocean bottom."
+
+The letters finished, he addressed and posted them, and then he and Luke
+took a short stroll through Nagasaki, past the many curious shops, and
+the fine residences. Some of the shop windows displayed flaring war
+pictures, done in glaring colors,--all telling of tremendous Japanese
+victories on land and sea.
+
+"They certainly believe in tooting their own horn," said Larry, with a
+laugh over one of the pictures. "Just see this one, Luke--one Japanese
+officer mowing down three Russians with his sword!"
+
+"They ain't no worse nor we had at home during the Spanish war, lad. I
+know one picture I see o' a Rough Rider riding down half a dozen Spanish
+soldiers. An' the truth o' the matter is, them Rough Riders didn't have
+no horses at all but fought on foot!"
+
+"You're right, Luke. We'll have to put all such pictures down as freaks
+of the artist's imagination. But I guess I know why some of them are put
+out--to draw the young fellows into the army and navy."
+
+"Right ye are. Some fellers seeing a picture like that want to march to
+glory right off,--an' so they go an' enlist. When it comes to hardtack
+an' black coffee----"
+
+"Hold on, Luke. Remember you are in Japan. Here it is rice and tea."
+
+"So it is, Larry. Say, but I had to laugh yesterday, when I see some of
+them jackies on board o' our ship gettin' out their teapots with tea."
+
+"It did look funny. But they do the same thing in the army, so I have
+been told. They can make the Japanese soldier and sailor do everything
+as we do it but give up his tea."
+
+"Well, I reckon tea is better nor rum."
+
+"Certainly it is,--and if I were an officer I'd let them have all the
+tea they wanted--if they would fight any better for it."
+
+"Those Russian sailors and soldiers drink an awful lot of _vodka_. I
+should think they would try to stop that. A half-drunken sailor or
+soldier isn't of any account."
+
+"They are so used to having it, I've been told, that to stop it would
+bring on a regular mutiny. It's hard to break off using a thing when you
+are used to it."
+
+"Right ye are, lad; a habit if it ain't proper is something awful."
+
+All was bustle throughout Nagasaki, for several regiments of soldiers
+had come in, bound for some transports which were to take them to
+Manchuria. Banners were flying everywhere, and from a distance came the
+music of a band.
+
+"Wonder how soon we will leave," said Larry, when he and his old friend
+were returning to the warship. "Now that we have enlisted, I'd like to
+see some fighting."
+
+"Maybe we'll get more fighting than we want, lad. But I'd like to get
+into it myself," continued the Yankee gunner, with a grin.
+
+Two days more were spent at Nagasaki, and then, on a clear morning, the
+_Shohirika_ left the harbor and steamed off in company with two sister
+ships. They were to join a squadron bound for the western coast of
+Korea, but where they were to go after that there was no telling.
+
+Captain Ponsberry came to see Larry and Luke off. "Take good care of
+yourselves," said the master of the _Columbia_. "An' teach them Russians
+the lesson they deserve."
+
+"We expect to do our duty," answered Larry.
+
+Life on the Japanese warship proved to be very much like life in the
+American navy. There were hours set apart for various drills and
+exercises. Each day they had to go through the movements of handling the
+gun, fighting with cutlasses, putting out a fire, and manning the small
+boats. They also had to keep their ditty bags and grass hammocks in good
+order, also their eating utensils, and each had to do his share of
+cleaning up. Twice a week the ship's surgeon examined each man, to see
+that he was perfectly healthy.
+
+"I like this keeping things clean," said Larry. "It is bound to make for
+good health."
+
+"They tell me that Japanese sailors and soldiers are among the
+healthiest in the world," answered Luke.
+
+In a few days the southern point of Korea was passed and the bow of the
+warship was pointed toward the eastern coast of Manchuria. They were now
+getting close to the battleground and the lookout was constantly
+watching for the appearance of the ships of the enemy.
+
+"We'll have a fight before very long--I can feel it in my bones,"
+declared Larry. And he was right; but before telling of that contest,
+and what surprising results it led to, we shall have to tell of
+something else which occurred, to delight Larry exceedingly.
+
+
+
+
+CHAPTER XXII
+
+A MEETING AND A PLOT
+
+
+"Some Japanese transports are coming up," said Larry, two days later.
+"Six of them, and they are crowded to the rails with soldiers."
+
+"I reckon we are to act as an escort to them," replied Luke. "They would
+need an escort, if they fell in with a Russian cruiser or two."
+
+The Japanese transports were bound for the coast of Manchuria, to land
+near the village of Petaka. Soon they fell in behind the _Shohirika_;
+and then those on the warship knew that they were going to go close to
+shore, if not to make an actual landing.
+
+A fog came up that night, which made the transports hold off. But the
+next day was as bright and clear as before, and about noon land was
+sighted to the westward. A patrol boat was sent ahead and came back
+stating that all was clear for a landing. Then the warships went closer
+and the transports followed.
+
+On the following day Larry found himself on shore--having been taken
+along by one of the officers of the ship to interview an English
+merchant who wished to sell some goods to the Japanese. The officer
+could speak some English, but wanted somebody along who could help him
+out in case he could not make himself clearly understood.
+
+The landing was at a small Chinese town which was partly in ashes--the
+Russians having tried to burn it down before leaving. There were a dozen
+shops, but all were closed and with the windows boarded up. Many of the
+Chinese had fled to the country beyond; and a Japanese regiment was on
+guard to preserve order and to keep the Chunchuses, (Chinese brigands)
+from looting the place.
+
+"This shows what war will do," thought Larry, as he walked along beside
+the Japanese naval officer. "I suppose some of the Chinese have lost all
+they possessed--and through no fault of their own either."
+
+The business with the English merchant was transacted quicker than
+anticipated, and, not caring to go back to his ship at once, the naval
+officer visited the camp of the Japanese regiment, taking Larry with
+him.
+
+"We expect another detachment here this afternoon," said one of the
+regimental commanders to the naval officer. "They are to escort a powder
+train through the mountains."
+
+A little while later the detachment came in on foot, looking somewhat
+tired and dusty from a long tramp through an exceedingly rough country.
+As the soldiers came to a halt in the public square of the seaport
+village, Larry uttered a cry of amazement:
+
+"Ben!"
+
+"Why, Larry, can it be you?" came in a tone of astonishment, and on the
+instant Ben Russell rushed forward and caught his brother by the hands.
+"I must be dreaming!"
+
+"I guess I'm dreaming myself!" said Larry, and gave his brother a warm
+hug. "This beats the Dutch! I thought you were at Liao-Yang. How are you
+and how did you get here?"
+
+"One question at a time, please," returned Ben, with a happy smile. "I'm
+pretty well, although I had a little dose of fever a couple of weeks
+ago. Our Japanese doctor fixed me up in double-quick time. Our command
+was ordered down here to look after a powder train. There was a report
+that either the Russians or the Chunchuses were going to try to capture
+it or blow it up. Now, how have you been, and what are you doing here? I
+thought the old _Columbia_ was at Nagasaki."
+
+"You want to know as much as I do, Ben." There was a pause and both
+laughed merrily, they felt so happy. "I'm as sound as a fiddle. The
+_Columbia_ is at Nagasaki and likely to stay there for some time. Allow
+me to introduce myself, Lawrence Russell, gunner's mate aboard of the
+Mikado's cruiser _Shohirika_. My head gunner is Luke Striker, Esquire."
+
+"Never!" burst from Ben. "Well, this certainly is news. So you and Luke
+enlisted? Have you had any fighting?"
+
+"Not exactly. But we have seen some rough times," answered Larry, and
+then, as soon as Ben could get away for a quiet half-hour, he related
+his story in detail, just as I have set it down in these pages.
+
+"You are assuredly a lucky chap, Larry, not to be in a Russian prison
+this minute," said his brother, after the young sailor had finished.
+
+"Perhaps I am lucky, Ben. But it wasn't much of luck to have that
+Shamhaven and Peterson walk off with my money belt."
+
+"That is so, but as the amount taken wasn't a fortune I shouldn't worry
+about it. I can let you have any money you need."
+
+"I don't need any, and, besides, Luke is acting as my banker. But now
+tell me about yourself."
+
+"There isn't very much to tell, outside of what I put down in that
+letter you received. As you know, Gilbert and I are both attached to
+this command of Major Okopa."
+
+"Where is Gilbert now?"
+
+"His company was to bring up the rear. They'll be here very shortly.
+Since the battle of Liao-Yang we have been on special duty, looking
+after the pack and powder trains, and have seen very little of fighting.
+We are reinforcing our lines daily, and I think the Russians must be
+doing the same. I expect some more heavy fighting soon, unless winter
+steps in and puts a stop to everything. The nights are already rather
+cool," added Ben.
+
+It was half an hour later that the company under Gilbert came in, having
+in their custody two Chinese bandits that had tried to steal four horses
+belonging to two Japanese army carts.
+
+"So it's really you, Larry!" cried the young Southerner, as he shook
+hands. "I'm mightily glad to see you and see you looking so well. I
+suppose Ben has told you all the news."
+
+"Yes, and Larry has been telling some too," put in Ben. "He has seen
+almost as much of the Russians as we have." And then Larry's story had
+to be told again.
+
+"I don't know where we shall go after we leave here," said the young
+sailor. "Are you going back to Liao-Yang?"
+
+"We don't know that either. Our orders are to escort the powder train
+wherever it may be sent," said Ben.
+
+For two days the Japanese warship remained in the harbor of the seaport
+village and during that time Larry managed to see quite a good deal of
+Ben and Gilbert. He wished he could take them on board of the cruiser,
+but this was not permitted.
+
+On the third day the _Shohirika_ received orders from a dispatch boat
+which steamed into the harbor, and an hour later the anchors were hove
+apeak and she steamed away, carrying Larry and his old Yankee friend
+along. Ben and Gilbert stood on a dock watching her departure. They
+waved their handkerchiefs at Larry and he waved his own in return.
+
+"I wonder when I'll see Larry again," mused Ben. He felt rather sober at
+the parting from his younger brother.
+
+"Oh, you'll see him again before long," answered Gilbert, trying to be
+cheerful.
+
+"Maybe not. It all depends upon where that cruiser sails to. She may go
+half around the world."
+
+"More than likely she has been sent to take part in the bombardment of
+Port Arthur."
+
+"Do you really think we'll be sent to Port Arthur, Gilbert?"
+
+"It is not unlikely, Ben."
+
+The pair watched the cruiser fade away in the distance, and then
+returned to that part of the village in which Major Okopa's command had
+been located.
+
+"By the way," said Gilbert, as they hurried along. "There is one thing I
+forgot to tell you. Meeting Larry drove it completely out of my mind. On
+the way to this village we stopped at a place called Wikelipe, and there
+I met, whom do you suppose?"
+
+"I don't know, I'm sure."
+
+"That rascal Ivan Snokoff. He was at his same old tricks--selling things
+to the inhabitants at exorbitant prices. When he saw me he shook his
+fist at me and my men and then ran away and hid."
+
+"Why didn't you root him out, Gilbert?"
+
+"What good would it have done? Besides, I didn't have time. The fight
+with the brigands made us lose three hours. But do you know, I think
+Snokoff has it in for me."
+
+"Yes, and in for me, too," added Ben. "He hasn't forgotten how I brought
+along the guard that placed him under temporary arrest."
+
+There was no time to say more, for the command was to move in half an
+hour and both of the young captains had to round up their men for that
+purpose. The powder train was at rest outside of the village and the men
+were scattered here, there, and everywhere.
+
+Evening found the command to which Ben and Gilbert belonged ten miles on
+their way through the mountains. Only the officer in charge of the
+powder train knew the destination of the precious stores. The train
+consisted of eighteen carts, each pulled by four horses.
+
+Although none in Major Okopa's command knew it, the train was followed
+by a Chinaman named Kee Lung, who lived in Wikelipe, the place where
+Gilbert had seen Ivan Snokoff. Kee Lung was well known to Ivan Snokoff
+and had been asked by the rascally Russian to keep his eyes on Gilbert
+and on Ben and to report their movements. He had watched Gilbert's
+meeting with Ben and Larry and heard something of what was said and had
+thus managed to make out that two of the party were brothers.
+
+As the powder train approached Wikelipe, Kee Lung went ahead to find
+Ivan Snokoff. This was not difficult, as he knew exactly where the
+latter was hiding. A conference lasting an hour ensued.
+
+"Do as you have promised and you shall have fifty _yen_," said Ivan
+Snokoff.
+
+"You will not fail to pay?" queried Kee Lung.
+
+"By the heads of my ancestors I promise it," was the rascally Russian's
+answer.
+
+"'Tis enough. I shall do as I have promised," returned the Chinaman. And
+he bowed himself from Ivan Snokoff's presence. Left to himself, the
+rascally Russian rubbed his hands gleefully.
+
+"Ha, I trust he is successful!" he muttered to himself. "Once Pennington
+and Russell are in the power of us Russians I shall show them what it
+means to insult and degrade a Snokoff!"
+
+
+
+
+CHAPTER XXIII
+
+THE ATTACK IN THE DARK
+
+
+Two days later Gilbert and Ben were seated in their tent talking about
+the meeting with Larry when one of the guards came in and saluted.
+
+"A messenger to see Captain Russell and Captain Pennington," said the
+guard.
+
+"Show him in," returned Ben, briefly, thinking it was a simple message
+about camp duties. He was rather surprised when a Chinaman entered,
+bowing low as he did so.
+
+"Dis Clabtain Lussell?" asked the newcomer.
+
+"That is my name."
+
+"Dis Clabtain Plennington?"
+
+"Yes," answered Gilbert.
+
+"Sailor man send Chung Wow," went on the Chinaman. "Sailor man want see
+bloth." He pointed to the two young captains. "Sailor man say he blother
+you." And now he pointed at Ben alone.
+
+"Said he was my brother?" cried the young captain.
+
+The messenger nodded. "Name allee same Larry Lussell."
+
+"Gracious me!" ejaculated Ben. "Gilbert, what can this mean? I thought
+Larry sailed away on that warship."
+
+"So did I. But she may be back in port."
+
+"Sailor man hurt." The Chinaman pointed to his side. "Sick--he shot--say
+you clome to-night."
+
+"Sick? shot?" repeated Ben, and a cold chill went down his backbone.
+"That is the worst yet. Where is he?"
+
+"Big walk down by the sea. Chung Wow show. But must pay--Chung Wow poor
+people."
+
+"Oh, I'll pay you," answered Ben, hurriedly. "Gilbert, do you think I
+can get away?"
+
+"Sailor man say bloth clome," put in the messenger.
+
+"Something is wrong, that is certain," came from Gilbert. He eyed the
+Chinaman closely. "There is no mistake about this?"
+
+At this Chung Wow shrugged his lean shoulders and looked blank.
+
+"No see mistakee. See sailor mans."
+
+"I guess he is all right," put in Ben. "Something has happened to poor
+Larry. I wonder if I can get away at once?"
+
+"Let us see the major about this."
+
+Ben hurried off and caught Major Okopa in his own tent. As the command
+was not to move until noon of the next day both readily obtained
+permission to absent themselves until that time.
+
+"But be careful," said the major. "This may be some Chinese trick."
+
+"We'll be on our guard," answered Ben.
+
+The Chinese messenger had come in on foot. He said he was hungry and was
+given something to eat. Then the three set off, the messenger carrying a
+knapsack filled with rations, and each of the young captains carrying
+his sword and his pistol. They tried to learn from Chung Wow how far
+they would have to travel, but the Chinaman either could not or would
+not inform them.
+
+"Perhaps it might have been as well to have taken a detachment of one
+company along," suggested Gilbert. "I must say, I don't like the looks
+of this." They were now a good mile away from camp, and in a location
+that appeared lonely enough.
+
+"Well, we are moving down to the seacoast," returned Ben. He was taking
+careful note of the direction they were pursuing.
+
+After that they journeyed along for a good two hours without saying
+much. They stepped along briskly, for Ben wanted to learn just what had
+happened to his brother. For all he knew to the contrary, Larry might be
+mortally wounded.
+
+Presently they came to a spot in the road where there were a number of
+dense trees. Chung Wow began to cough loudly.
+
+"What's the matter?" demanded Gilbert. For some reason he did not trust
+the Chinaman.
+
+"Slomthing fly in float," was the answer, and Chung Wow coughed again.
+Then he walked on, and they came behind him. But Gilbert drew his pistol
+and motioned for Ben to do the same.
+
+"I may be mistaken, but we may be walking into a trap," he whispered.
+
+"Why, Gilbert, I don't----" began Ben, when without warning a heavy
+object dropped upon his head from the limb of one of the trees and bore
+him to the ground. Another object dropped on Gilbert, but he squirmed
+from under,--to find himself confronted by several Chunchuses. A cry
+went up, and a crashing was heard in the bushes back of the trees.
+
+"A trick, Ben, just as I suspected!" ejaculated the young Southerner,
+and he discharged his pistol point-blank at the Chinese bandit in front
+of him. This done he made a leap to one side, hurling over Chung Wow as
+he did so, and darted forward into some bushes. A shot was aimed at him,
+but did no injury, and he kept on, running as hard as he could.
+
+In the meantime Ben did his best to get up. But one man was on his
+shoulders and another had him by the legs, so to move was next to
+impossible. Then, as he continued to struggle, he received a heavy kick
+from a wooden shoe which stretched him out like a log.
+
+"He is out of the fight now," said one of the Chunchuses, as he bent
+over Ben. "Go after the other. Do not let him escape if you can help it.
+Americans are worth a good deal to us in these days!"
+
+Three of the brigands remained to guard Ben and the others made after
+Gilbert. But they could not catch the young Southerner, and after a long
+chase they came back.
+
+"He has gone back to his camp," said one of the Chunchuses to his chief.
+"He will have his friends about our ears very shortly."
+
+As soon as this news was received, Ben's hands and feet were bound, and
+four of the Chinamen caught him up as if he were a dead animal and
+hoisted him on their shoulders. Off they set at a dog-trot, with the
+remaining brigands around them.
+
+It was the jogging over the rough mountainous road which finally brought
+the young captain to his senses. At first he did not realize that he was
+on the move.
+
+"Gilbert!" he called faintly. "Gilbert!"
+
+Nobody answered him, and now he essayed to sit up. He could not budge
+and consequently began to struggle.
+
+"Be still!" cried one of the Chunchuses, in Chinese.
+
+"Where am I? What are you doing to me?" queried Ben.
+
+For answer he received a good shaking and was then dumped on the ground.
+His feet were liberated, and the chief of the Chinese brigands ordered
+him to move along, pointing the end of his sword at the prisoner as he
+did so.
+
+"Where is my friend?" asked Ben.
+
+"He is dead," said the chief, laconically.
+
+"Dead!" burst out the young captain. His heart seemed to become like a
+lump of lead. Gilbert, his own true chum, dead! It was too horrible to
+believe.
+
+"Yes, and you will be unless you walk on," added the chief of the
+Chunchuses.
+
+There was no help for it, and, bruised and bleeding, the young captain
+took up the march, with his enemies on all sides of him. The gait was a
+rapid one, and before they came to a halt once more he was all but
+exhausted.
+
+"Where are you taking me?" he asked.
+
+"Wait and see." The chief of the Chunchuses grinned wickedly. "I shall
+have to trouble you for your valuables," he went on, in his native
+tongue, and without further ado stripped Ben of his possessions,
+including his watch, money, ring, and sword.
+
+There was no use protesting, and therefore the young captain did not
+attempt it. He was marched along a marshy path, and presently came in
+sight of the ocean and a small bay, where two sailing ships and a small
+steamer lay at anchor.
+
+A shrill whistle sounded out, and this was answered by somebody on the
+steamer. Then a small boat put in to shore, carrying four sailors and an
+officer. As soon as the officer landed, he was called aside by the chief
+of the Chunchuses, and a conference lasting several minutes followed.
+
+"It shall be as you say, Ching Fee," said the officer, in Russian. "It
+is too bad you did not get the other, too. I know Ivan Snokoff, and
+Captain Barusky too, and there will be money in this. Yes, I'll take him
+on board at once. You had better watch out that the soldiers do not get
+after you."
+
+"Trust Ching Fee to take care of himself," said the chief of the
+Chunchuses.
+
+With scant ceremony Ben was conducted to the small boat and told to get
+in. He asked where they were going to take him, but could get no
+satisfaction. As soon as the steamer was reached, he was conducted to an
+empty stateroom and locked in.
+
+"This is the worst yet!" he muttered, as he sat down. "I suppose they
+intend to carry me miles and miles away. Poor Gilbert! I never thought
+he would be killed in such a fashion as this! What cutthroats these
+Chinese brigands are! It's a wonder they didn't kill me too! Can that
+story about Larry be true?"
+
+There was a little water in the stateroom, and as his hands had been
+released, Ben bathed his wounds and bound them up as best he could. He
+heard the steamer move away from the shore, and soon the steady pounding
+of the engines proved that she was forging ahead at her best rate of
+speed.
+
+He was a prisoner of the enemy, and what they were going to do with him
+was a question still to be answered.
+
+
+
+
+CHAPTER XXIV
+
+THE DEFENSE OF THE POWDER TRAIN
+
+
+After firing on the Chinese brigands as already described, Gilbert
+plunged into the brushwood which was not over half a dozen yards
+distant. He heard the shots discharged at him in return, but fortunately
+every one went wide of its mark.
+
+Once in the brushwood he did not stop, but continued on his way for
+several rods. Then he paused, wondering if Ben was anywhere in the
+vicinity.
+
+"I hope they didn't kill him," he murmured. "What a trap that was, and
+how easily we walked into it!"
+
+He waited and listened, but nobody came near him. Then, with caution, he
+pushed ahead, until he gained once more the road leading back to the
+temporary camp occupied by the powder train and the detachment guarding
+it. Following this, he ran on at full speed until the welcome camp-fires
+greeted him.
+
+"Major Okopa, we have been attacked by Chunchuses!" he exclaimed, as he
+rushed up to the officer's quarters. And in a brief manner he explained
+the situation so far as he knew it.
+
+The Japanese major had taken a strong liking to Gilbert and Ben, and he
+lost no time in ordering out a company to round up the Chinese brigands
+if they could be located. It was Gilbert's own command and he was given
+permission to remain out the whole night and the next day if necessary.
+
+The young Southerner went at the task with vigor, for he realized that
+every moment was precious. He explained the situation to his men, and
+they set off at double-quick to where the attack had been made.
+
+As was to be expected, the spot was deserted. By torchlight they saw the
+evidences of the struggle which had taken place. In one spot was a pool
+of blood, left by the brigand whom Gilbert had shot in the shoulder.
+
+"They went off in this direction," said one of the soldiers, who was
+good at tracing footsteps. He pointed to a side road, and along this
+they ran, keeping eyes and ears on the alert, so as to avoid anything in
+the nature of a surprise.
+
+Two hours later the company found itself on the seashore. But Chunchuses
+and vessels were gone and to where it was impossible to find out. But on
+the beach Gilbert picked up an empty pocketbook which he knew was Ben's
+property.
+
+"They brought him here most likely," he said. "See, here are the marks
+of a rowboat, and of many feet. They have gone off on the water."
+
+"Then the hunt is at a standstill," returned his second in command.
+
+The young captain was unwilling to believe this, and the remainder of
+the night, and the next forenoon, were spent in an eager search after
+the enemy. But it was useless; and at last Gilbert, sick at heart,
+ordered his men to return to the camp.
+
+On the following day the powder train moved onward once more. The first
+lieutenant of Ben's company took command of the body, and Ben was marked
+"missing" on the roll.
+
+"It is certainly too bad, and I sympathize with you, Captain
+Pennington," said Major Okopa. "Captain Russell is a fine fellow."
+
+"It takes all the vigor out of me," replied Gilbert. "Ben and I were
+like two brothers."
+
+But Gilbert was given no time in which to grieve over Ben's
+disappearance. Two days later, the powder train was attacked by a
+detachment of the Russians, who seemed to spring out of the very ground.
+One of the wagons loaded with powder was blown to atoms, killing two
+horses and three soldiers.
+
+"_Banzai!_" cried the Japanese, and when the order was given they
+attacked the enemy with vigor. It was a hot fight, lasting half an hour,
+and the Russians were driven among some high hills, backed up by several
+mountains.
+
+As the powder train had to go through one of the mountain passes so
+close at hand, the soldiers were sent ahead, to clear the way of all
+Russians that might appear. This was dangerous work, for the enemy had
+the advantage of the higher position. But the Japanese were undaunted,
+and rushed up one slope after another with a vigor and animation that
+was surprising.
+
+"Can't hold them back, when once they get started," said Gilbert, to the
+major. "They are like our Southern bloodhounds, when once they strike
+the scent."
+
+"And that is the way to win victory," answered Major Okopa.
+
+Not long after this Gilbert found himself at the foot of a steep hill
+with his company. At the top of the hill were a number of great bowlders
+and behind these some of the Russians were in hiding, sending down a
+spiteful fire whenever the opportunity presented itself.
+
+"We must dislodge those fellows," said Major Okopa. "It is very
+dangerous work. Do you think you can accomplish it, Captain Pennington?"
+
+"I can try," answered Gilbert, modestly, and ordered his company
+forward. He turned them slightly to the left, for here a fringe of thin
+brushwood offered a shelter that was not great, but much better than
+none.
+
+"Major Okopa expects us to take this hill," he said, in the best
+Japanese he could muster. "Let us do our best!"
+
+"_Banzai!_" came the rallying cry from the men, and up the slope they
+rushed, with Gilbert at their side. Crack! crack! went the rifles of the
+Russians, and then, without warning, several shells were sent up. One
+man of Gilbert's company was killed and two wounded, but they did not
+waver. Passing the brushwood, they ran out boldly on the slope above
+them.
+
+Many of the rocks at the top of the hill were loose, and as the Japanese
+came closer, the enemy began to send them down in a shower which was
+highly dangerous to those below.
+
+"Beware of the stones!" cried Gilbert.
+
+He had hardly spoken when he saw that he would have to look after his
+own safety. The Russians were working over a rock that weighed several
+hundreds of pounds.
+
+All at once the mass broke loose. There was a yell of delight from
+above, and then the big bowlder came rolling straight for Gilbert. Had
+it touched him he must surely have been crushed to death.
+
+But the young Southerner was as cool as he was quick. Pausing to make
+certain which way the big stone was coming down, he made a quick leap in
+the opposite direction. Then the bowlder went bounding past him, to
+crash into some small trees at the bottom of the hill.
+
+"Are you hurt, captain?" asked his lieutenant.
+
+"No," answered Gilbert. Then he leaped to the front once more. "Come!"
+he cried. "_Banzai!_ Forward for the Mikado!" And on the whole company
+went as before, firing rapidly as they did so. The Russians clung to the
+hilltop a few minutes longer, and then, as the first of the Japanese
+gained a footing there, they broke and fled in wild disorder down the
+other side of the hill, and into the woods to the northward. The
+Japanese pursued them for two hours but could not catch them, and at
+last the chase was abandoned. In this skirmish, called the battle of
+Po-yang-ling, the Japanese lost in killed and wounded four men, and the
+Russians seven. Three of the Czar's soldiers were also taken prisoners.
+
+After that the powder train had no more difficulty, and four days later
+reached its destination, which was the village of Fanshen, where the
+Japanese had established something of a base of supplies for that
+portion of the army which was moving southward to join in the siege of
+Port Arthur. At Fanshen, Major Okopa's command received orders to go
+into camp instead of returning to the vicinity of Liao-Yang.
+
+"This looks to me as if we were to be transferred to the army in the
+south," said the major, after communicating the news to Gilbert.
+
+"Well, I shouldn't mind helping to take Port Arthur," returned the young
+Southerner. "If you will remember, it was my treatment by the Russians
+at that place which caused me to take up arms against them."
+
+"So you said before, Captain Pennington. But do not imagine that the
+taking of Port Arthur will be easy. The Russians have fortified it in
+every possible manner."
+
+"Yes,--they were doing that before I came away from there."
+
+"For months they have been strengthening their fortifications, and
+getting in ammunition and supplies in secret. Their chain of forts
+extend, so I have been told, for twenty miles and more outside of the
+city, and being in a mountainous country, they will be hard to reduce."
+
+"Don't you think we can capture the place?" demanded Gilbert.
+
+"Capture it? Most assuredly, captain. But it will mean a great
+destruction of life," returned Major Okopa, gravely.
+
+What the major said about the Russians fortifying Port Arthur was true.
+Lieutenant-General Stoessel, the Russian commander at that place, had
+under him sixty thousand men, the very flower of the Russian army. On
+the side of the sea the town was fortified at a dozen points, only three
+of which had been thus far captured under the Japanese army led by
+General Nogi. To the northward and the westward were some twenty
+defenses, set among the mountains where they were next to impossible to
+reach.
+
+In a work of this kind, it is impossible to relate in detail all of the
+many battles fought over the possession of Port Arthur. The first
+assault was made in February by Admiral Togo's fleet, and the naval
+conflict was kept up for almost three months after that. In the meantime
+a Japanese army under General Oku landed at Pitsewo, and after several
+battles at Kinchow and Nanshan Hill, drove the Russians back to their
+mountain defenses and took possession of the railroad running to
+Liao-Yang and Mukden. Thus Port Arthur was cut off from almost all
+communication with the outside world.
+
+
+
+
+CHAPTER XXV
+
+BOMBARDING A PORT ARTHUR FORT
+
+
+Larry felt very happy after having met Ben and Gilbert. He had been
+afraid he should find that his brother or his friend was wounded, even
+though no mention of such an occurrence had been made in the letter he
+had received. He knew from experience that Ben was in the habit of
+making light of things that went wrong.
+
+"I suppose it did your heart good to meet 'em both," said Luke, after
+the warship was on the way.
+
+"You're right, Luke; it was a regular touch of old times."
+
+"Wish I had seen 'em myself."
+
+"Both wanted to be remembered to you." Larry paused for a moment. "By
+the way, I wonder where we are bound now?"
+
+"Can't say as to that, lad--secret orders, I reckon," answered the old
+tar.
+
+The order to sail was evidently an important one, for scarcely was the
+_Shohirika_ out of sight of land than all steam was crowded on. The
+lookouts were also doubled, and when night came the strictest watch
+possible was maintained.
+
+Yet, with it all, several days passed without anything out of the
+ordinary happening. Drills and exercises went on as before, and both
+Larry and Luke made themselves familiar with all parts of the warship.
+Both spent much time in familiarizing themselves with such orders as
+were given to them in Japanese, so that they might not be too "green,"
+as Larry termed it, if put to the test.
+
+During those days spent on shipboard matters concerning the great war
+were moving forward steadily. In the vicinity of Liao-Yang both the
+Japanese and the Russians made several movements to better their
+positions. This brought on a few skirmishes and one heavy battle, in
+which the losses were several hundreds on each side. There was also an
+advance on the outer forts of Port Arthur, and a fair-sized hill was
+captured by the Mikado's men, who, however held the place only at an
+enormous loss of life. In moving on the port the Japanese found they
+would have to do a great amount of tunneling and entrenching, all of
+which consumed time.
+
+On the ocean the two nations were equally active. Both took several
+prizes of war, and in an encounter with the Vladivostok squadron a
+Russian warship was hopelessly disabled and a Japanese cruiser was all
+but sunk. Another ship belonging to Admiral Togo's fleet struck a mine
+outside of Port Arthur and had to be sent back to Japan for repairs.
+
+So far the weather had been warm, but autumn was now at hand and before
+long the nights became cold and raw.
+
+"This war won't be finished this winter," said more than one. "We are in
+for another year of it, sure."
+
+The _Shohirika_ had been summoned to join the fleet patrolling before
+Port Arthur. Two days before that station was reached they fell in with
+a sister ship which brought the news of an encounter with a Russian
+battleship carrying some troops from Siberia. Both warships had suffered
+and become separated in the darkness.
+
+"This war is certainly warming up," said Larry. "I hope we see some
+fighting before it is over."
+
+"Maybe we'll see more of it than you wish," said Luke, grimly.
+
+"Don't you worry--we'll see a whole lot," put in Steve Colton, who was
+sitting on a ditty chest, playing checkers with Bob Stanford. "Just wait
+till we get under Admiral Togo's eye--he'll make us be up and doing."
+
+The chance to see some of the war came the next day, when they were
+ordered to bombard one of the forts to the north of Port Arthur proper.
+As soon as they came within four miles of the fort they received a
+reception which was as warm as it was exciting.
+
+"Now, here is where we show what we can do!" cried Luke, as the orders
+came to begin firing, and the whole gun company jumped in to assist him.
+The magazines were opened up, the windlasses set to work, and soon the
+first real shell--not a mere blank for practicing--came up and was run
+into the gun. Then the breech-block was swung to and locked, the
+electric connection set, and Luke sighted the piece with care, after
+having first received the proper distance from the range-finders in the
+tops. As soon as the "sight" was "covered" the button was pressed, and
+_bang!_ went the gun with a concussion that shook the whole ship. Other
+guns followed in rapid succession, until Larry had to stuff cotton in
+his ears to keep himself from becoming deaf. As soon as the gun was
+discharged, it was opened to let the gases out and then cleaned with wet
+swabs and flushed with running water to cool the barrel.
+
+The bombardment lasted for an hour, and during that time the fort was
+hit in a dozen places. Sand, dirt, and rocks flew in all directions, and
+once there came a flash which told of an explosion of a quantity of
+powder.
+
+"If we could only hit the magazine it would be good-by to that fort,"
+said Larry, but this was not to be.
+
+After the first few shots the fort had remained silent, but now, when
+the _Shohirika_ was about to retire, the gunners opened up once more,
+and a rain of shot and shell flew all around the warship. One struck the
+bow of the vessel, tearing off a few feet of the forward deck and
+another entered the forward turret, killing one of the gunner's
+assistants.
+
+"We can be thankful we weren't in that turret," said Luke, when he
+received the latter news.
+
+"Yes, indeed!" murmured Larry, and could not repress a shiver. "I can
+tell you, it's mighty risky work after all!" he added, soberly.
+
+"Well, we've got one advantage over those fellows," put in Colton, after
+the firing had come to an end, and the warship was fast getting out of
+range. "We can run away, while they have got to stay right where they
+are."
+
+"Oh, they can run away too," said Larry.
+
+"Not unless they abandon their fort,--and that would be just as if we
+should abandon our ship."
+
+The work at the gun had been severe, and after the bombardment was over
+Larry was glad to clean up and take a rest. The perspiration, grime, and
+smoke had made him look like a negro, and he used up several buckets of
+water before he got himself into as cleanly a condition as was habitual
+with him. Luke also took a "scrubbing down," as he called it, and so did
+the others.
+
+What amazed Larry more than anything was the quietness of the Japanese
+sailors. Now that the bombardment was ended they said scarcely a word
+about it, but went on exactly as before.
+
+"They are the most matter-of-fact chaps I ever saw!" he declared. "I
+believe if the ship blew up they would say 'Very sorry' and swim away.
+Now on one of Uncle Sam's ships the men would be all woke up and out for
+a jollification. Ben says it's the same way in the army. If they get
+excited at all they always seem to be sorry for it afterwards!"
+
+"That's what ye call a characteristic o' the race, I reckon," returned
+Luke. "They're taught to act that way from babyhood. It ain't polite nor
+high-toned to git excited. The only thing they kin yell is _Banzai!_ an'
+they let thet out loud enough, goodness knows!"
+
+"I can't understand why we didn't keep at that fort," came from Colton.
+"I was just getting the range beautifully when orders came to shut
+down."
+
+"Well, there must be a reason for it, Steve," answered Luke.
+
+There was a reason for it. Admiral Togo had just received word that
+certain ships of the Port Arthur squadron were going to make an attempt
+to break out of the harbor, either that night or the next day.
+Consequently the _Shohirika_ was needed further down the coast, and
+steamed away in that direction as rapidly as her somewhat limited supply
+of coal permitted.
+
+"I don't think the navy will ever find its way into Port Arthur harbor,"
+said Larry, later on, after studying a map of that locality. "There are
+too many forts on the hills outside of the town. They could smash our
+ships to smithereens if we got too close."
+
+"Trust Admiral Togo to know what he is doing," answered Steve Colton.
+"He won't go too close. At the same time he ain't going to let the
+Russian ships get away any more than Schley and Sampson let Admiral
+Cervera get away from Santiago Harbor in Cuba."
+
+"It's the army that will make Port Arthur a hot place to live in," came
+from Bob Stanford. "They can entrench and thus gain a little ground day
+by day, and as soon as they win some high point, like say 203-Meter
+Hill, it will be all up with General Stoessel, mark my words."
+
+The night to follow proved to be misty, and so cold that the majority of
+the sailors were glad to don their heavy peajackets. Fearing that the
+enemy would try to take advantage of the weather, Admiral Togo turned on
+all the searchlights his fleet possessed, and these were flashed in all
+directions.
+
+"False alarm," said Luke, after midnight had sounded out on the ship's
+bell. "Reckon the Russians don't dare to come out."
+
+But the old Yankee tar was mistaken. The enemy were on the alert, and at
+three o'clock, when the mist was extra heavy, the movement to steal out
+of Port Arthur harbor was begun, two torpedo destroyers taking the lead,
+and several cruisers following. This brought on a heavy sea-fight
+lasting far into the next day, and one which came close to cost Larry
+his life.
+
+
+
+
+CHAPTER XXVI
+
+BEN MEETS CAPTAIN BARUSKY
+
+
+For several days poor Ben remained a prisoner aboard of the small
+steamer. During that time only two men came near him--an under officer
+and the sailor who supplied him with food and water. Neither would
+answer his questions, so he could not learn where he was being taken or
+what was to be done with him.
+
+One evening there was a slight commotion on the deck, and the course of
+the steamer was changed. Then came a blowing of steam whistles lasting
+several minutes. Finally the steamer came to a standstill.
+
+"You are to leave this vessel at once," said the under officer, as he
+opened the door of the young captain's temporary prison. "Come, we have
+no time to spare."
+
+"Where am I to go?" questioned Ben.
+
+"You will soon learn. Hurry!"
+
+There was no help for it, and soon Ben was on deck. He was made to enter
+a small boat and was thus transferred to another steamer--one which had
+formerly been in the East Indian trade but which was now acting as a
+Russian supply boat.
+
+"What a dirty craft!" was his mental comment, after having been thrust
+into a pen which was little better than a horse stall. The supply boat
+was loaded to its fullest capacity, so quarters for all on board were
+limited.
+
+Two days passed and he received food which was scarcely fit to eat. When
+he protested he was threatened with a flogging. The air was foul and he
+began to fear that he would become sick.
+
+"I won't be able to stand this much longer," he thought, dismally. "If
+they want to kill me why don't they do it at once and have done with
+it?"
+
+On the following morning a surprise awaited him. He heard two Russian
+officers pause in front of his pen and one said to the other:
+
+"Here is the prisoner, Captain Barusky."
+
+"Is it the fellow named Russell?" was the question from Captain Barusky,
+the rascal who had aided Ivan Snokoff to make so much trouble for
+Gilbert Pennington.
+
+"The same."
+
+"They did not capture his friend?"
+
+"No--in the struggle he slipped away."
+
+"I am sorry for that. We wanted Pennington more than we did this fellow.
+But I am glad we got at least one of them. As I understand it they work
+hand-in-glove with each other;" and then the two Russian officers passed
+on.
+
+Like a flash Ben realized the truth of the situation. His taking off had
+been a trap set by Snokoff and this Captain Barusky, who had hired the
+Chunchuses to help work out their plot. He was now in the hands of the
+enemy in more ways than one.
+
+"They won't treat me as an ordinary prisoner," he reasoned. "This
+Captain Barusky will make it as hard as possible for me--more especially
+so as Gilbert managed to escape his clutches. Well, I am glad Gilbert
+got away."
+
+Resolved to "take the bull by the horns," Ben asked the prison guard if
+he might speak to Captain Barusky.
+
+"I will see about it," answered the sailor, and went off to find out. On
+his return he stated that the captain would visit the pen some time
+during the day.
+
+The Russian officer came late in the afternoon, when nobody else was
+near the pen. There was a sarcastic look on his face when he gazed at
+the young captain.
+
+"So you want to talk to me," he said, abruptly.
+
+"I do, Captain Barusky. I want to know why this plot was laid against
+me."
+
+"I know of no plot. You are an American in the employ of the Japanese
+Government as a spy. Russia captures all the Japanese spies she can."
+
+"I am no spy."
+
+The Russian shrugged his shoulders. "That is what your friend, Captain
+Pennington, once told me, too. Yet as soon as he got out of Port Arthur
+he was made a captain in the Mikado's army."
+
+"He applied for the position because the Russians had mistreated him and
+because he loves active service."
+
+"Have it as you please, Russell; both of you are spies, and you will
+have to suffer as one."
+
+"Where are you taking me?"
+
+"Since you seem so anxious to know, I will tell you, for I do not think
+you will be able to take the news to the Japanese. This boat is carrying
+supplies to Port Arthur."
+
+"Port Arthur!"
+
+"That is what I said. When we arrive there you will be placed in one of
+the strongest of our prisons at the port. Do you not admire the
+prospect?"
+
+"Well, if you take me to Port Arthur, perhaps I shan't be a prisoner
+long," replied Ben, resolved to put on as bold a front as possible.
+
+"And why not?" demanded Captain Barusky, curiously.
+
+"Because our army and our navy are bound to capture the place."
+
+"Bah! The Japanese will never take Port Arthur. It is absurd to think of
+it."
+
+"It may not come right away--but it will come sooner or later."
+
+"Never! But if it should, you will not be there to enjoy our downfall.
+Remember that spies are tried, and if found guilty they are taken out
+and shot."
+
+"You cannot prove that I am a spy."
+
+"That remains to be seen."
+
+"If you bring me before the court I'll have something to say about your
+underhanded work with Ivan Snokoff. I can prove that he is a swindler
+and that you are his accomplice."
+
+"Ha! you threaten me!" roared Captain Barusky, in a rage. "Have a care!
+I come from a most respectable family and I have great influence."
+
+"Nevertheless, I think those who are higher in authority than yourself
+will listen to my story. The Russian army officers are as a rule
+gentlemen and strictly honest."
+
+"Which means to say that I am not a gentleman and not honest!" bellowed
+Captain Barusky. "That, for your opinion!" And reaching out he gave Ben
+a ringing box on the ear.
+
+It was the last straw. With no fresh air and no food fit to eat, the
+young captain was desperate, and leaping forward he struck at the
+Russian captain's nose. His fist went true, and as Barusky staggered
+back against the pen door the blood spurted from his nasal organ.
+
+"Don't you dare to hit me again!" panted Ben, standing before the
+Russian with both hands clenched. "Don't you dare--or you'll get the
+worst of it!"
+
+His manner made Captain Barusky cower back, and he glared at Ben with
+the ferocity of a wild beast. Then he called to the guard.
+
+"Run for aid, Petrovitch," he said. "The prisoner has attacked me. He is
+a beast, and must be chained up."
+
+The man addressed summoned three other sailors and the captain of the
+ship's guard. All came into the pen and forced Ben into a corner.
+
+"The Yankee dog!" said the captain of the guard. "To dare to strike a
+Russian officer! Bring the chains at once!"
+
+Chains were brought, and soon Ben was bound hands and feet, with links
+that weighed several pounds. Then a large staple was driven into one of
+the uprights of the pen and he was fastened to this with a padlock.
+
+"Now place him on half-rations," said Captain Barusky. "It is the only
+way to tame him." And then he hurried away to bathe his nose, which was
+swelling rapidly.
+
+If Ben had been miserable before he was doubly so now. The chains were
+cumbersome and cut into his flesh, and being fastened to the upright he
+could scarcely move a foot either way. To add to his misery the front of
+the pen was boarded over, so that what little light had been admitted to
+his prison was cut off.
+
+In this wretched condition he passed a full week. In that time Captain
+Barusky came to peep in at him three times, and on each occasion tried
+to say something to make him still more dispirited. The food was so bad
+he could not eat and the air often made his head ache as if it would
+crack open.
+
+"If this is a sample of Russian prison life it's a wonder all the
+prisoners don't go mad," he reasoned. "A few months of this would surely
+kill me."
+
+At the end of the week Ben heard firing at a distance. The supply boat
+was now trying to steal into Port Arthur and had been discovered by a
+Japanese patrol boat. The craft was struck twice and the prisoner below
+heard a wild commotion on the deck, as one of the funnels was carried
+away. But darkness favored the Russians, and inside of two hours the
+supply boat passed into Port Arthur harbor without sustaining further
+damage. She was then directed to a proper anchorage by the harbor
+master; and on the following day the transfer of her cargo to the
+storehouses on shore was begun.
+
+For several days longer Ben was kept on the boat. Then, one wet and cold
+morning, he was liberated and told to march on deck. From the vessel he
+was taken to a big stone building which was being used as one of the
+garrison quarters. Here he was given a scant hearing in the presence of
+Captain Barusky, who appeared against him.
+
+"We have no time to investigate your case at present, Captain Russell,"
+said the officer who conducted the examination. "But from reports I
+should surmise that you are a dangerous young man. You must remain a
+prisoner." And then the young captain was taken away. Later on, he was
+marched a distance of half a mile and blindfolded. When the bandage was
+removed from his eyes, he found himself in an old stone building, dirty
+and neglected. He was taken to a small room, having a grated window, and
+thrust inside. Six other prisoners were put into the apartment with him,
+one man with a hacking cough, dreadful to hear. The door was closed and
+barred; and all were left to take care of themselves as best they could.
+
+
+
+
+CHAPTER XXVII
+
+A FIERCE BATTLE AT SEA
+
+
+Larry was taking a nap when the call came to clear the ship for action.
+It had been discovered that the Russian fleet was trying to escape from
+Port Arthur harbor, and the news was flashed from vessel to vessel of
+Admiral Togo's fleet, and all were ordered to prevent the movement at
+any cost.
+
+"Now I reckon we are in fer it!" ejaculated Luke, as he and the youth
+rushed over to their gun. "Larry, it's in my mind we have some tall work
+cut out fer us this trip!"
+
+"Let it come--I am in just the humor for fighting!" cried Larry. "I hope
+we can smash them just as we smashed the Spanish ships in Manila Bay."
+
+Sailors and gunners were hurrying in all directions, and orders were
+coming in rapid succession. At first the Russian ships had turned in one
+direction, now they were turning in another, and, later still, they
+separated. A distant firing could already be heard, but where it came
+from those on the _Shohirika_ could not tell.
+
+So far no ships of the enemy could be seen with the naked eye. The
+lookouts kept a close watch, and the flashlights continued to play all
+over the bosom of the rolling sea.
+
+It was almost daylight when a distant explosion was heard. A Russian
+torpedo boat had run into a mine and was so badly damaged that she sank
+inside of ten minutes, carrying a large part of her crew with her.
+
+This disaster proved a warning to the other Russian ships and they
+proceeded on their courses with added caution. The Japanese warships
+were equally on the alert, yet, just as the sun came up, one brushed
+against a mine and received such damage that she was practically put out
+of the contest.
+
+"There is one of the enemy's ships!" was the cry, as the mist swept away
+as if by magic and the sun came out strongly. "Now is our chance.
+_Banzai!_"
+
+"And there is another ship!" came a moment later, "and one of our own
+pounding her as if she was a witch!"
+
+Guns were now booming over the water constantly, and from the forts on
+shore came shots and shells in rapid succession. Soon the _Shohirika_
+was in the midst of the battle, and then Luke and Larry worked over the
+gun as never before, doing their full share towards disabling the ship
+that was trying to escape up the Manchurian coast.
+
+For over an hour the running fire kept up. Neither ship dared to put on
+full speed, for fear of running into a mine. Solid shot was hurled in
+all directions, and the _Shohirika_ received one below the water line
+which for the moment looked as if it might sink the craft. But the
+ship's carpenter and his crew got at the leak immediately, driving in a
+wedge which quickly stopped the flow of water.
+
+It was hard, exhausting work between decks, and at the end of an hour
+Larry felt he must have some fresh air. Both he and Luke applied for
+permission to go on deck, and this permission was readily granted, for
+the guns on their side of the warship were not then in use.
+
+On the deck of the _Shohirika_ they could see what this battle really
+meant. Dirt and debris were to be seen in many places, and half a dozen
+sailors and marines had been killed or wounded. Everybody was bathed in
+perspiration and grime, and some of those who worked the big guns were
+panting like dogs after a chase.
+
+"It's work, that's what it is," said Luke, running the perspiration from
+his begrimed forehead with his finger. "Ain't no child's play about it!"
+
+"And dangerous work at that," added Larry. He gave a look toward the
+enemy's ships. "I declare, Luke, I believe they are running back to Port
+Arthur harbor!"
+
+"I think the same, lad," responded the Yankee gunner. "Reckon they are
+findin' it is goin' to cost too much to get away. As soon as they get
+away from them land batteries we can pound 'em for keeps and they know
+it."
+
+"And get away from the mines. That's the worst with fighting around
+here--you don't know how soon you'll hit a mine and be blown up."
+
+"Oh, I reckon our captain is watching out fer them pesky things."
+
+Larry was interested in watching the sharpshooters and range-finders in
+the tops, and he walked across the deck to get a better look at them.
+Luke followed, and as he did so, one of the nearest of the Russian ships
+sent out a roaring broadside at the _Shohirika_ which raked her fore and
+aft and sent another hole through her side, but this time above the
+water line where it did scant damage.
+
+"Gee Christopher!" began Luke, when he chanced to glance upward. "Larry,
+look out!" he screamed. "The top's coming down on ye!"
+
+Luke was right. One of the shots from the enemy had struck the foremast,
+above the fighting top, and it was crashing down, carrying a portion of
+the ship's flag with it. One end struck the gun turret, and then the
+wreckage hit Larry on the shoulder, hurling him on his back.
+
+The foremast was heavy and had it struck the youth before landing on the
+turret and the surrounding works it might have killed the young gunner's
+mate on the spot. As it was, Larry lay like a log where he had fallen
+and when Luke raised him up the old tar found him unconscious.
+
+"If he ain't got his shoulder broke then I miss my guess," muttered the
+Yankee gunner. "Larry! Larry! Can't ye speak to me?"
+
+"That was a nasty one," came from one of the officers of the deck.
+"Better carry him below." And then the officer gave orders to remove the
+wreckage and hoist the flag once more.
+
+With the unconscious youth in his arms, Luke hurried below and to the
+sick bay of the warship. Here the surgeon got to work immediately and
+examined Larry thoroughly.
+
+"No bones broken," he announced. "But the bruise is severe and he is
+suffering from shock. He will soon come to his senses."
+
+Luke had to return to his gun, for duty is duty in the navy, regardless
+of what is happening around one. It was true, the Russian warships were
+now doing their best to sneak back into Port Arthur harbor and Admiral
+Togo wanted to do all the damage possible before the forts made it
+impossible to follow them further. All of the warships' guns were worked
+to their utmost, and when the Russian vessels did get back they were so
+badly crippled that they were of small consequence for future fighting
+until undergoing repairs.
+
+When Larry opened his eyes again he found himself lying on a clean white
+cot in the ship's hospital with an attendant standing over him bathing
+his face.
+
+"Oh!" he murmured and stared around him. "Oh, my shoulder! That was a
+fearful crack I got!"
+
+The attendant did not understand, but smiled blandly and continued to
+bathe his face and also his head. Soon the full realization of what had
+happened came to the young gunner's mate. Then he asked about Luke.
+
+The fighting was at an end and presently Luke came to him, to find Larry
+sitting up in a chair.
+
+"I feel stiff and sore all over, Luke," said the youth. "It was just as
+if a house came down on me."
+
+"Thank fortune you wasn't killed, or didn't have your bones broken,"
+returned the Yankee gunner.
+
+"I am thankful. Were you hurt?"
+
+"Not in the least."
+
+"What about the fight?"
+
+"The Russians have sneaked back into the harbor like a lot of whipped
+dogs."
+
+"What is our ship doing?"
+
+"Putting up the coast. I don't know where we are going," answered Luke.
+
+Larry remained in the ship's hospital for three days and then resumed
+his duties as before. His shoulder still felt stiff and sore and lifting
+anything was a good deal of labor. But Luke favored him, so he got along
+very well.
+
+A week passed and the _Shohirika_ remained at sea, moving in a wide
+circle, on the lookout for Russian warships or supply boats. But none
+were encountered, and then the cruiser was ordered to escort a transport
+filled with soldiers bound for the front.
+
+The transport landed at a point some miles north of Dalny and the troops
+went ashore without delay. They were bound for the railroad, and were to
+participate in the advance upon Port Arthur from that point.
+
+As the warship remained in the harbor several days, both Luke and Larry
+were allowed a short run on shore. They enjoyed this trip very much,
+until, much to their surprise, they learned that Major Okopa's command
+was in the vicinity. Then they hunted this up, to learn the sad news
+from Gilbert that Ben was missing.
+
+"Missing!" ejaculated Larry, in horror. "Taken by Chunchuses! Oh,
+Gilbert, this is dreadful!"
+
+"Well, I don't know as you feel any worse than I do, Larry," answered
+Gilbert. "It makes me wild to think of it."
+
+"But couldn't you find any trace of him at all?"
+
+"Not the slightest, although I think he was carried off in a boat."
+
+"But why should the Chinese brigands make him a prisoner?"
+
+"I'm sure I don't know, excepting to hold him for a ransom. But if they
+intended to do that it is likely we should have heard from them before
+this."
+
+The matter was discussed as long as Larry and Luke could remain on
+shore. But nothing came of it, and with a heavy heart the young gunner's
+mate returned to his place on the warship.
+
+
+
+
+CHAPTER XXVIII
+
+THE SIEGE OF PORT ARTHUR
+
+
+After the fruitless effort to escape from Port Arthur harbor the Russian
+warships "bottled up" there remained where they were for a long time to
+come. Occasionally one or another attempted to run the blockade, but
+results were usually disastrous, and at last the risk became so great
+nothing more was done in that direction. The Japanese continued to put
+down mines and sank several boats loaded with stone in or near the
+winding channel, and this made getting in as hard as getting out--thus
+putting a stop to the arrival of more supply boats, such as brought Ben
+to the seaport.
+
+In the meantime the campaign on land was pushed forward with increased
+activity. The headquarters of the Japanese army investing Port Arthur
+was not far from the railroad, but the lines stretched many miles to the
+east and the west. Troops were hurried both from Japan and from the
+divisions near Liao-Yang, and heavy siege guns were mounted on every
+available hilltop. The Japanese were, at the start, at a great
+disadvantage--they could not see the enemy at which they were firing.
+Hills and mountains cut them off from every view of the port. But they
+kept hammering away, day after day, week after week, and month after
+month, gaining steadily, throwing up new intrenchments, digging new
+tunnels, and hauling their heavy guns forward to more advantageous
+positions. The labor was body racking and the sacrifice of life
+enormous. But the Mikado's soldiers did not appear to care. They had set
+out to capture Port Arthur and they were going to do it.
+
+For the foot-soldiers and for the cavalry there was at the start but
+little to do in the way of fighting. Most of the time was spent in
+digging trenches and tunnels, and in keeping out of the way of shells
+that whistled and screamed in all directions--shells weighing hundreds
+of pounds, which, when they struck, tore up the ground for yards around
+and smashed the rocks as if the latter were passing through a quartz
+crusher. Such is war of modern times, when carried on at a distance of
+miles.
+
+But as the months went by, and Japanese and Russians came closer to each
+other, hand-to-hand conflicts became numerous. The Russians contested
+every foot of the ground, fighting with a courage that was truly heroic,
+and sacrificing themselves freely for the Czar and the country they
+loved. The hand-to-hand conflicts became bloody in the extreme,
+thousands upon thousands being slaughtered between the rising and the
+setting of the sun.
+
+From the seacoast the command to which Gilbert was attached moved to a
+small place called Fugi Klan. Here they went into camp for several weeks
+and while there were joined by a number of other commands, including
+that containing those old soldiers of fortune, Dan Casey and Carl
+Stummer, who had served with Gilbert and Ben in Cuba and in the
+Philippines.
+
+"Py chiminy, of it ton't done mine heart goot to see you, cabtain!"
+exclaimed Carl Stummer, rushing up and giving Gilbert a handshake. "How
+you peen, annavay?"
+
+"First rate, Stummer. And how are you, Casey?"
+
+"Sure an' it's meself is as foine as a fiddle," answered the Irishman,
+with a broad grin on his freckled face. "It's a great war, ain't it now?
+Both soides is fightin' like a pair o' Kilkenny cats, so they are! An'
+where is me ould friend, Captain Russell?"
+
+"He was captured by Chunchuses."
+
+"No!" came from both Stummer and Casey, and then they poured in a volley
+of questions which were bewildering. Gilbert answered them as best he
+could.
+
+"Dot's der vorst ding vot I hear yet alretty!" said Carl Stummer, with a
+sad shake of his head. "I vish I got dem Chunchusers--or vot you call
+dem--here. I fix 'em, eh, Tan?"
+
+Dan Casey nodded vigorously. "Sure an' we'd be after puttin' a ball
+through ivery mother's son of 'em, so we would! Poor Ben Russell! I
+loiked him loike a brother!" And the honest Irish sharp-shooter heaved a
+long sigh.
+
+Both Casey and Stummer had been having easy times of it for several
+weeks, but now they were called upon to go forth with pick and shovel,
+to do their share of work in digging intrenchments. This was not so
+nice, but they went at the labor without a murmur.
+
+"Sure an' we might as well git into practice," observed Casey, as he
+started in with vigor. "Whin the war's over an' we git back to the
+States, it may be ourselves as will be workin' fer the corporation in
+New York or ilsewhere!"
+
+"Yah, udder puttin' town railroad dracks alretty in der Vest," answered
+Carl Stummer. "Dot is," he added, "of I ton't got money enough to puy a
+farm."
+
+"'Tis a stock farm I'm wantin'," came from Casey. "Wid horses galore.
+There's money for ye, Carl!" And he went to work with added vigor--as if
+he expected to turn up the stock farm from the soil beneath him.
+
+To Gilbert, even though he occasionally saw Stummer and Casey, the days
+were very lonely. He missed Ben greatly, and each day wondered if he
+would ever see his old war chum again. Major Okopa saw this and did what
+he could to cheer up the young officer.
+
+"He may turn up before you realize it," said the major. "I don't think
+he was killed."
+
+"If he is alive, it is very strange that we do not hear from him."
+
+Two days later came a batch of letters into camp, written, or rather
+painted, for the most part, on thin Japanese paper. Among the
+communications were two for Gilbert, one from Captain Ponsberry
+concerning the _Columbia_ and her cargo, and the other from a stranger
+in Pekin, China.
+
+"Who can be writing to me from Pekin, China?" mused the young captain,
+and began to read the communication with interest. It was from a Chinese
+merchant, and ran in part as follows:
+
+ "You will be mystified to receive this from an utter
+ stranger, but I deem it my duty, kind sir, to send this word
+ to you.
+
+ "Know, then, that one Ken Gow, a servant of my family, was
+ in Port Arthur up to sixteen days ago--first a servant in an
+ American family there, and next a prisoner in the vilest
+ prison man ever saw, guarded by dogs of Russians unworthy to
+ be used as door mats. Ken Gow is a faithful man, the flower
+ of all my help.
+
+ "It is needless to explain to you why my servant was thus
+ ill-treated. But you must know that when in prison he met
+ your great friend Captain Benjamin Russell, and it was the
+ captain who saved Ken Gow from many hard blows from the
+ other prisoners, who wanted not a Chinaman amongst them.
+
+ "Ken Gow was grateful, even as I am grateful, and he
+ promised to get word to you of this matter if the Russians
+ granted him his liberty. Finding no fault in my servant he
+ was, after a time, liberated, and watching his chance, left
+ Port Arthur and came home.
+
+ "Kind sir, he is grateful to Captain Russell and would do
+ much for him if he could. Yet his most is to send this
+ letter to you, telling you that Captain Russell is alive and
+ held in a Port Arthur prison as a spy. One Russian hates
+ him--his name, Captain Barusky,--and it would appear that
+ this Russian is also your enemy, so beware of him.
+
+ "I can tell no more. Ken Gow is sick from his treatment at
+ the hands of the Russian dogs. Accept this miserable
+ assurance of my eternal friendship, and esteem for one I
+ know must be high and illustrious."
+
+ "CHENG MO."
+
+Gilbert read the letter several times and showed it to Major Okopa. It
+was written in true Chinese style, with a big Chinese seal attached, and
+was, beyond all doubt, genuine.
+
+"I can't understand one thing," said the young captain. "How did Ben get
+to Port Arthur?"
+
+"It may be that this Captain Barusky had him taken there, Captain
+Pennington."
+
+"I thought Captain Barusky was at Mukden."
+
+"The Russians have been taking in some troops at Port Arthur on the sly.
+Despite Admiral Togo's efforts, some supply boats and transports have
+passed his ships."
+
+"If Barusky is there he will do what he can to make Ben miserable. He is
+down on both of us--for he knows we are down on him and Ivan Snokoff."
+
+"Do you think Snokoff could have anything to do with this?"
+
+"I'm sure I don't know. Anything is possible. Snokoff would be glad to
+make trouble for Ben--since he helped me to make him settle up at
+Liao-Yang. Those Chunchuses tried to capture both of us."
+
+The matter was talked over for half an hour, but brought forth no
+satisfaction. To Gilbert's mind, being held by the Russians as a spy was
+as bad as being in the hands of the Chinese brigands.
+
+"I wish we could get into Port Arthur at once," he said, finally. "I
+shouldn't like anything better than to capture this Captain Barusky and
+liberate Ben."
+
+"We are bound to get into the port sooner or later," answered Major
+Okopa. "They are bringing up more siege guns every day. If the Russians
+won't give up we'll batter the whole town down over their heads."
+
+"Which will be a bad thing for Ben," rejoined Gilbert. "I don't want him
+killed in the attempt to rescue him."
+
+
+
+
+CHAPTER XXIX
+
+FROM ONE DIFFICULTY TO ANOTHER
+
+
+"Where is this going to end?"
+
+It was Ben who asked himself the question, as he walked up and down the
+narrow cell in which he had been confined in the prison at Port Arthur.
+
+What had been written to Gilbert in the letter from Pekin had been
+substantially correct. Ben had aided Ken Gow in numerous ways, and for
+this the Chinaman had been extremely grateful and had promised to do all
+he could for the young captain should he manage to escape from the
+blockaded seaport. Then Ken Gow had disappeared one night, and that was
+the last Ben saw of him.
+
+Three days later a guard entered the prison and announced that the
+prisoners were to be transferred to other quarters. With his hands bound
+behind him, Ben was marched forth through a side street of Port Arthur,
+where stood an old building which had formerly been used as a market.
+Cells had been built in this structure, and into one of these he was
+thrust, the guard sarcastically telling him to make himself as
+comfortable as possible.
+
+The young captain was sick in both body and mind and fast reaching that
+point where one becomes desperate and fit for any deed of daring. More
+than once he was tempted to throw himself on the guard in an endeavor to
+overpower the fellow and escape. But he realized that if caught at this
+he would be immediately shot down.
+
+Day after day passed, and from outside the prisoner heard the dull
+booming of cannon. Occasionally a shell would explode close to the
+prison, causing a wild yell of alarm and a general rush by those
+outside. There were flags over the prisons and over the hospitals,
+showing what manner of places they were, but, as said before, the
+Japanese were at a loss to see what they were firing at, so many shots
+and shells went where they were not intended. These mishaps were what
+caused the report to circulate that the Mikado's men were not fighting
+according to the rules of modern warfare, but were doing their best to
+shatter the hospitals in which lay their own and the Russian wounded.
+
+It was a cold, raw day, with a touch of snow in the air, and Ben felt
+one of his desperate moods coming over him. His hands and feet were free
+and he peered forth from the one narrow window that the cell contained.
+All he could see beyond was a courtyard, surrounded by a stone wall.
+
+"I wish I was out there--I'd get over that wall somehow!" he muttered to
+himself.
+
+The cell window was not over fifteen or sixteen inches wide and twice
+that in height. The bars were of iron, but set in wooden frames but a
+few inches in thickness.
+
+"A fellow might smash out those bars with the bench end," he thought.
+"But after that what? I reckon the guard in the courtyard would shoot me
+on sight. I might try it at night."
+
+Still in a desperate mood, Ben picked up the bench, a solid affair
+several feet long. He made an imaginary lunge at the window bars with
+it.
+
+"I'll wager I could knock them out with one blow. They----"
+
+Ben got no further, for at the moment a fearful explosion sounded
+somewhere overhead. The explosion was followed by a crash and a wild
+yell of alarm. A Japanese shell had struck the top of the building,
+tearing away fully a quarter of the roof and sending the bricks and
+timbers flying in all directions.
+
+"Now is my chance!" he muttered, and without stopping to think twice he
+rammed the window bars as hard as he could with the bench. A second and
+third blow followed, and down went the irons, carrying a portion of the
+window frame with them. Then through the opening leaped the young
+captain. As he landed in the courtyard, he picked up a small log of wood
+lying handy.
+
+A glance around told him that the guard was nowhere in sight, the
+Russian having run to the other side of the building to note the damage
+done by the shell. Log in hand, Ben leaped quickly across the courtyard
+and placed the bit of wood up against the wall. This gave him a footing,
+and in a twinkling he was on top of the wall.
+
+But though he acted quickly a guard from the prison building saw him and
+ran forth gun in hand.
+
+"Halt!" came the command, in Russian, and then, raising his weapon, the
+guard fired at Ben.
+
+The bullet whistled over the young captain's head, and without looking
+back to see who had fired it, he dropped on the other side of the wall.
+Then he sprinted up the street and around a corner.
+
+Ben knew not where to go, but his one thought was to put distance
+between himself and the prison, and he hurried on and on, until he came
+to a barn which stood open. Into this he darted, to find the building
+empty of occupants.
+
+The Japanese had begun a general bombardment of Port Arthur and shot and
+shells were flying in all directions. This being the case, the majority
+of the troops and the inhabitants were out of sight,--hid away in
+cellars and dugouts. Nobody paid any attention to him and he was thus
+given ample time in which to think matters over and decide upon his next
+movement.
+
+From the barn Ben moved to the building next door--which was a sort of
+dwelling and storehouse combined. Here, from the wide open doorway, he
+gazed at the scene of destruction before him. It was full of horror and
+made him shiver.
+
+"War is certainly a terrible thing," he thought. He saw some people
+running for their lives, and beheld one man go down struck in the back
+by a shell. Then he turned away to shut out the sight.
+
+In one room of the warehouse he found an old overcoat and a slouch hat,
+and lost no time in donning these, both as a disguise and to keep
+himself warm. Then he hunted around for something to eat, but could not
+find a mouthful.
+
+"I might have known there would be no food squandered," he told himself.
+"Didn't they say at the prison that they were slaughtering the horses
+just for the meat, and that butter and eggs were worth their weight in
+gold? I'll be lucky to get bread and soup--especially as I haven't a
+dollar with which to pay for a meal."
+
+Ben was about to leave the warehouse when he saw a file of Russian
+soldiers approaching. With the soldiers were two officers, and as they
+came closer he recognized one as Captain Barusky.
+
+"It was a bad thing to let that American escape," said the captain to
+the other officer. "If you catch sight of him, shoot him on the spot."
+
+"Which we shall do with pleasure," was the ready answer; and then
+officers and soldiers passed on.
+
+"I've got to keep out of sight, that's all there is to that," reasoned
+Ben, grimly. "If they catch me again it's all up with me. I wonder if it
+would be possible to get out of Port Arthur? Gilbert got out, but things
+weren't half so closely guarded as they are now."
+
+Ben waited until nightfall before leaving the warehouse. Then, keeping a
+constant lookout for Russian soldiers, he sneaked along one street after
+another. Where to go he did not know, but he realized that he must have
+something to eat or he would starve.
+
+Presently he came to a small garden in the center of which was a
+neat-looking residence. On the doorplate was the name Nathan Chase.
+
+"Nathan Chase!" Ben cried, half aloud. "I wonder if that can be the
+gentleman Gilbert knew? If it is perhaps he will aid me."
+
+At first the young captain thought to ring the doorbell, but fearful of
+meeting the wrong person he resolved to investigate in a more private
+manner. The side windows of the residence were curtained, but the
+curtains were only partly down. Going to one of the windows he peered
+inside.
+
+In a neatly furnished sitting room sat a young lady and a Russian
+soldier. They were arguing about something--money matters as far as Ben
+could make out. The young lady did not wish to give the soldier the
+money and he insisted upon having it. While Ben gazed at the scene, the
+Russian soldier leaped up, grasped the young lady by the shoulders and
+shook her roughly.
+
+"Don't!" screamed the young lady, in English. "Let me go!"
+
+"I want the money!" answered the soldier, in his native tongue. He was a
+Cossack and of brutal features.
+
+The young lady was pretty and she was helpless, and this combination was
+more than the young captain could resist. Regardless of consequences, he
+shoved up the window and leaped inside the apartment.
+
+"Keep your hands off of that young lady!" he cried, and catching the
+Cossack by the shoulder he threw him backward. "Don't you know how to
+treat a lady when you meet her, you big brute?"
+
+The Cossack was startled, first because he had not expected the
+interruption and secondly because he had no business to be in the
+mansion. He gave one look at Ben and then rushed out into the hallway
+and left the premises with all possible speed.
+
+As soon as the Cossack was gone the young lady and Ben stared at each
+other. She started to speak, but stopped suddenly.
+
+"Excuse me for coming in as I did, but I thought it was necessary," said
+the young captain. "I guess that fellow had no business here."
+
+"You are right, sir. Papa is away, and he wanted me to give him money.
+He must have known I was alone in the house."
+
+"Are you Miss Chase?"
+
+"I am. But you have the advantage of me."
+
+"I know it. I am Captain Benjamin Russell. Perhaps you know an old
+friend of mine, Gilbert Pennington. He knows your father, I believe."
+
+"Oh, yes, I have met Captain Pennington. They tell me he is now in the
+Japanese army."
+
+"He is." Ben paused and looked at the young lady keenly. "Miss Chase,
+can I trust you?" he asked, abruptly.
+
+"What do you mean?"
+
+"I will tell you," and in a few brief words he related his story, to
+which Grace Chase listened with close attention.
+
+"You were lucky to escape from that prison!" she cried, when he had
+finished. "To be sure I will assist you as far as I can. Papa is away on
+business, but I expect him back in two or three hours. We haven't much
+on hand to eat, but such as there is you are welcome to."
+
+"I'm hungry enough to eat anything," said Ben, with a little smile.
+
+"Then come with me to the dining room, Captain Russell, and I will
+prepare supper."
+
+"You haven't any servants now, I suppose?"
+
+"No; every one of them has deserted us."
+
+They entered the dining room, and the young lady asked Ben to close the
+shutters. While he was doing this she prepared such a meal as the larder
+of the house afforded. It was not much, but he did not complain, and he
+thanked her warmly for giving what he felt she could ill afford to set
+before him.
+
+The meal finished, they sat down to await the coming of Mr. Chase. While
+doing this Ben related some of his experiences in the army and the young
+lady told of the horrors of the siege.
+
+"One cannot understand it unless you are in the midst of it," she said.
+"Papa says business is at a standstill, the hospitals are filled with
+the sick and the wounded, and we are in constant dread that the next
+moment will be our last. The suspense is so great that in one or two
+cases the inhabitants have gone crazy."
+
+"I can well believe that, Miss Chase. During the war in the Philippines
+I saw----"
+
+Ben paused, as a heavy footstep sounded on the porch of the residence.
+Other footsteps followed, and then came a loud knock on the door.
+
+"Open here!" demanded a voice in Russian. "Open, in the name of the
+Czar!"
+
+
+
+
+CHAPTER XXX
+
+A SURPRISE FOR LARRY
+
+
+As the days passed, the watch upon Port Arthur from the sea became
+closer and closer. Admiral Togo gave strict orders that no ships should
+be allowed to enter or come from the harbor under any circumstances, and
+each commander of a warship was on his mettle, knowing full well that if
+he was derelict in his duty he would speedily hear from his superior in
+a manner far from pleasant.
+
+Blockading became something of a monotony to Larry and Luke, and after
+several weeks had passed both wished something would happen.
+
+"I'd rather put up with a stiff sea fight than this," declared the young
+gunner's mate.
+
+"Right ye are, lad," replied the old Yankee tar. "Ain't no use o' bein'
+ready for a tussle if it ain't comin'. As it now is, life in the navy
+ain't no more excitin' nor life on the old _Columbia_."
+
+During that time Larry received a letter from Captain Ponsberry, similar
+in contents to that sent to Gilbert. The Japanese Government had
+released the cargo of the schooner and then bought the same at a good
+round price. The ship had also been released, Captain Ponsberry having
+to pay a nominal sum for this action.
+
+"I think the captain is lucky to get off so easily," said Larry. "I
+suppose the Japanese Government might have scooped in everything."
+
+"Well, the Japs think it best to remain friendly to the United States,"
+answered Luke, and it is likely that the old sailor was more than half
+right.
+
+Cold weather had come in earnest and work on deck was far from pleasant.
+Yet each man on the _Shohirika_ had to do his full duty as before, and,
+be it said to their credit, not a sailor or marine did any shirking. Gun
+drills and various exercises were kept up constantly.
+
+One day the warship ran close to a big trading brig bound for Hong-Kong.
+As was the custom, the brig stopped to allow the commander of the
+_Shohirika_ to make certain that she was not carrying contrabands of war
+for Russia or had no intentions of running the blockade.
+
+While this examination was going on, Larry and Luke chanced to come on
+deck, curious to have a look at the stranger.
+
+"About as big a brig as I ever see in these parts," was the Yankee tar's
+comment. "She must carry a whopping cargo."
+
+"Yes, and a lot of men to man her," answered Larry. "Think of hoisting
+and furling such sails as she carries!"
+
+The two vessels had come fairly close to each other, and our friends
+continued to survey the brig with interest. Then Larry gave a cry.
+
+"Oh, Luke, I wish I had a glass!"
+
+"Why?"
+
+"Unless I am mistaken, there is Shamhaven on the deck of that ship!"
+
+"No!"
+
+Larry pointed with his hand. "Doesn't that look like him?" he continued.
+
+"Keelhaul me, if I don't think you're right, lad. Wait, I'll get a glass
+an' make certain!"
+
+The old tar knew where he could borrow a glass, and in a minute more he
+returned, and both took a brief look through the instrument.
+
+"It is Shamhaven!" ejaculated Larry. "And look, there is Peterson coming
+from the fo'castle!"
+
+"That's so. What ye goin' to do about it?"
+
+"Tell the officer of the deck. They shan't get off with my money if I
+can help it."
+
+Rushing away, Larry soon acquainted the proper officer with what he had
+discovered--telling as much about the robbery as seemed necessary. The
+officer was interested, and, what was even more to the point, liked the
+young American.
+
+"Do you wish to go to yonder ship and confront the men?" he asked.
+
+"Try me and see!" answered Larry, excitedly. "I mean, yes, sir," he
+stammered. "And will you let Luke Striker go, too?"
+
+The officer agreed, and soon another small boat put off from the
+warship, and Larry and Luke, with the officer, were speedily landed on
+the deck of the brig.
+
+"You're a fine rascal, to rob me!" cried Larry, rushing up to Shamhaven.
+"And to rob Captain Ponsberry, too!"
+
+Shamhaven had not expected this encounter, and for the moment he was
+dumbstruck. He gazed from Larry to Luke as if they were ghosts.
+
+"I--I--who are you, anyway?" he stammered. "I don't know you," he added,
+striving to regain his composure.
+
+"Yes, you do know me, and you know Luke Striker, too," answered the
+young gunner's mate.
+
+"What does this mean?" asked the captain of the brig, while a number of
+others looked on with interest.
+
+"I'll tell you what it means, sir," said Larry, and did so. "He has got
+to give up my money belt and my money, and give up Captain Ponsberry's
+money, too."
+
+At this moment Peterson came up and was promptly collared by Luke.
+
+"Stop! Don't you vos touch me!" cried Peterson. "I ain't noddings done,
+no."
+
+"You helped Shamhaven to rob me," came from Larry.
+
+"No, he done it all alone! I no touch noddings!"
+
+"Oh, shut up!" roared Shamhaven, in disgust. "I never robbed anybody. If
+you lost your money Peterson must have taken it."
+
+A quarrel ensued between the evildoers, in the midst of which came a cry
+from the _Shohirika_.
+
+"An enemy is in sight!"
+
+At once all attention was turned to the warship. Scarcely a minute
+elapsed when a signal was displayed:
+
+"A battleship, and she is trying to escape up the coast!"
+
+"To the boats!" roared the Japanese officer on the deck of the brig. "To
+the boats at once! This investigation will have to be postponed. We
+shall expect you to remain as you are"--the latter words to the captain
+of the big brig.
+
+"As you will," was the smooth answer.
+
+A rush was made for the two small boats, Larry and Luke being hustled
+along with the crowd. Soon they put off for the warship, which was
+already preparing to follow the Russian battleship that had been seen.
+
+"I didn't get my money, after all," grumbled the youth. "But perhaps
+I'll get it later--if that ship of the enemy doesn't sink us," he added.
+
+As soon as they were on board of the _Shohirika_ again, the cruiser
+started after the battleship. But the enemy had a good lead, and it was
+some time before the Japanese warship could command a full head of
+steam, which meant everything to her. Then, when steam was to be had in
+plenty, there came a breakdown in the engine room, causing a delay of
+twenty minutes.
+
+"We'll never catch her,--at least, not to-day," said Luke, and he was
+right. Darkness found the battleship still three miles away. Half a
+dozen shots were fired at her, but none took effect. Then night ended
+the pursuit.
+
+In the morning nothing was to be seen of the enemy and those on the
+Japanese warship were much depressed, for they had fancied that an
+encounter might add greatly to their laurels. But shortly before noon
+the lookout announced the approach of another ship.
+
+"A Russian cruiser!" was the cry.
+
+This was correct--the vessel was the auxiliary cruiser, _Pontomuk_,
+formerly a steamer in the Siberian trade. She was manned by a fierce and
+swarthy-looking body of sailors and marines, and carried a first and
+second battery of no mean proportions.
+
+"I'll wager we have got some work cut out for us now," said Larry, and
+he was right. Finding she could not run away from the _Shohirika_ the
+Russian auxiliary cruiser came steaming up and let drive at close
+range,--a broadside that raked the Japanese warship from end to end with
+deadly effect. The _Shohirika_ answered immediately, and both the
+steering wheel and the rudder were smashed on the enemy's ship.
+
+"Phew! but this is hot work!" panted Larry, as all those around the gun
+worked like Trojans.
+
+"An' it's going to be hotter!" ejaculated Luke. He sighted the piece
+with care. "There, Sally Jane, let her go!" And he pressed the electric
+button. _Bang!_ went the gun with a roar that was deafening. Then the
+breech was thrown open and the smoke rolled out, filling the air with a
+smell that made them cough and sneeze. But nobody stopped work. In a
+trice the gun was cleaned and cooled and another shell pushed into
+place, and then the firing was repeated.
+
+"She's coming alongside!" was the announcement from on deck. "All hands
+to repel boarders!"
+
+"A hand-to-hand fight!" cried Larry, and scarcely had the words been
+uttered when there came a bump that hurled half the sailors flat. Up
+they sprang, and as order after order was delivered the marines and
+others ran for their guns and cutlasses, while the officers saw to it
+that their pistols were ready for use.
+
+A wild, maddening yell came from the deck of the Russian ship, as
+marines and sailors poured over the side. An answering _Banzai_ issued
+from the Japanese, and they met the first onslaught with vigor. Then
+came a fierce tramping over the deck, as the two conflicting parties
+moved first to one side and then the other.
+
+"We are ordered up!" cried Larry, a few minutes later. "Here is where we
+have got to fight for it, Luke!"
+
+"Right you are, lad. Do your best, and trust to Heaven for the rest!"
+was the Yankee tar's reply. And then, cutlasses in hand, both mounted to
+the deck, to engage in the fiercest hand-to-hand encounter either of
+them had ever experienced.
+
+
+
+
+CHAPTER XXXI
+
+A CALL TO REPEL BOARDERS
+
+
+It was a battle royal from the start and for some time neither side had
+an advantage. Pistol shot was met by pistol shot, and a rifle gun placed
+on the upper deck of the Russian warship was balanced in execution by a
+similar gun mounted on the _Shohirika_. The slaughter created by both
+weapons was frightful, a dozen or more going down on either side each
+time a gun was discharged.
+
+When Larry and Luke came out on desk the spectacle was enough to make
+the blood of the youth run cold, and it was only his previous experience
+in warfare which rendered him capable of doing what he knew was his
+duty.
+
+"Charge on them!" came the cry in Japanese. "Kill them, or drive them
+back to their ship! _Banzai!_"
+
+"_Banzai! Banzai Nippon!_" was the yell. "Hurrah for Japan!"
+
+The Japanese had not expected a hand-to-hand fight and the closing in of
+the enemy aroused them as they had never been aroused before. For the
+first time Larry saw the sailors and marines awakened to their full
+fighting fury--a fury in which every Japanese scorns death and thinks
+that to die is glory for himself, his family, and his emperor. They
+leaped on the Russians with a ferocity that was appalling, and that
+first shock sent the Czar's men back to the deck from which they had
+come.
+
+But the Russians were likewise aroused, and with cheers and yells they
+came on once more, leaping over the bodies of those who had fallen, and
+meeting shot with shot and cutlass stroke with cutlass stroke. Officers
+and men fought side by side, and many went down to a common death.
+
+By instinct Larry and Luke kept close together, with the others from
+Luke's gun near at hand, and Steve Colton and Bob Stanford not far away.
+Each used his cutlass as best he could, warding off the blows of the
+enemy and dealing cuts whenever a chance appeared. Larry was glad that
+he had learned to use a cutlass so well, and soon found himself the
+match of almost any Russian who challenged him.
+
+The fighting was now spread over the decks of both vessels, which were
+hooked together tightly and pounding broadside at every swell of the
+ocean. To attempt to blow up either ship would have been fatal probably
+to both--one dragging down the other--so no such attempt was made.
+
+While the fighting was at its height, Larry suddenly found himself face
+to face with a Russian lieutenant of marines. The fellow had a pistol in
+his hand, and as Larry raised his cutlass to strike, he dropped the
+weapon on a level with the youth's head and pulled the trigger.
+
+Had the bullet sped as intended it is likely Larry would have been
+killed. But just as the trigger fell, Luke, who was at Larry's side,
+knocked the pistol to one side with his cutlass and the bullet merely
+grazed Larry's hair. Then Larry leaped forward and gave the Russian
+lieutenant a thrust in the side which put the fellow out of the fight
+instantly.
+
+For fully fifteen minutes the battle had now raged and it was growing
+hotter each instant. All of the available men on each ship were in the
+fray, and the cries and yells which resounded were deafening.
+
+"We certainly can't keep this fight up much longer!" panted Larry. He
+had a cut on his left hand and one in the shoulder, but kept on with
+dogged determination.
+
+"Well, we ain't goin' to surrender!" grunted Luke. "It's fight or die, I
+guess!" And he leaped forward once more.
+
+Two tall Russians were directly in front of the old Yankee gunner, and
+both fell upon him with their cutlasses at the same instant. Luke was
+capable of warding off the weapon of one, but he was no match for the
+pair, and it speedily looked as if they would surely kill him.
+
+"Back with ye!" he yelled, and swung his cutlass as rapidly as he could,
+but they crowded him still closer and then one made a thrust at his face
+and another at his body.
+
+It was at this critical moment that Larry, who had been engaged with
+somebody else, saw his old war chum's predicament. With a leap he gained
+Luke's side, and down came his cutlass with a sweeping blow on the wrist
+of one of the enemy. The Russian dropped his cutlass to the deck and
+staggered back, his hand almost severed from his arm. Then Luke slashed
+the other Russian across the cheek, and both of the enemy hurried back
+behind the other fighters.
+
+"Good fer you, Larry!" panted Luke, when he could speak. "They had me
+about cornered!"
+
+"These fellows certainly know how to put up a stiff fight."
+
+"You're wounded yourself. Better go below."
+
+"No, I'm going to see it out. Why don't you go down yourself?"
+
+"It ain't in me, thet's why," answered the old Yankee gunner.
+
+Again came a fierce onslaught from the Russians. But the Japanese now
+had another rifle gun in place, and sharpshooters were crowding the
+fighting tops. The latter picked off the Russian officers, and this
+created a momentary confusion. Then came a sudden order to unlock the
+two ships and this was done.
+
+"The Russian ship is going down!" was the yell, and the news proved
+true. An explosion below decks had torn a hole in the Russian warship's
+bottom and she began to sink rapidly.
+
+The scene was now indescribable. Both the Russians and the Japanese on
+the doomed vessel endeavored to reach the deck of the _Shohirika_. In
+this struggle the majority of the Russians received the worst of it, and
+fully fifty of them, including not a few wounded, remained on board when
+the doomed warship took her final plunge beneath the waters of the sea.
+Eighteen Japanese were likewise drowned, including two under officers.
+
+"Surrender, or we will drive you over the side!" was the command from
+the Japanese, and utterly disheartened by the loss of their ship, the
+Russians threw down their arms; and the fierce and bloody contest was at
+an end. The common sailors were driven forward and chained together or
+bound with ropes, and the officers were grouped near the stern, where a
+formal surrender was made by the captain of the lost ship giving up his
+sword. This formality over, the Japanese set to work at once, cleaning
+up the deck and caring for the wounded as well as the hospital
+accommodations of the _Shohirika_ would permit.
+
+"I never wish to see another fight like that," was Larry's comment, when
+he had washed up and had his wounds dressed. "It was simply a
+slaughter!"
+
+"Right you are, lad," answered Luke. "An' I reckon I'm a-goin' to carry
+the scars o' it down to my grave." The old Yankee gunner had received
+several severe wounds, and he was glad enough to have Larry swing his
+hammock for him and lie down to rest.
+
+The battle over, the captain of the _Shohirika_ sailed away, to look for
+the big brig once more and to report to the flagship of the fleet. But
+the brig had taken time by the forelock and left for parts unknown.
+
+"I suppose that is the last of Shamhaven and Peterson and my money,"
+said Larry, when this news reached him. "I wish we had met that brig a
+week ago."
+
+"Oh, it's possible we may see her again," said Luke, cheerfully. "But it
+gets me that she ran away, unless she had something to run for."
+
+"She must have been carrying some contraband of war, Luke."
+
+"It ain't unlikely, lad. Well, she's gone, an' it ain't no use to cry
+over spilt milk. When you write to Captain Ponsberry you can tell him ye
+saw them two rascals an' thet's all the good it did."
+
+"Do you know what I'm thinking?"
+
+"Well?"
+
+"I'm thinking that brig was bound for Port Arthur, and she'll slip into
+that port some dark and misty night."
+
+"It's a risky piece o' business. Either our ships or the mines are
+likely to blow her up."
+
+"That is true. But the Russians at the port must be getting desperate,
+and they'll most likely pay any kind of a price for supplies. A captain
+who ran the blockade successfully could make a fortune," returned Larry.
+
+The young gunner's mate was right in his surmise. The big brig was a
+Russian vessel in disguise and loaded to her fullest capacity with
+supplies for the blockaded seaport. She had been fitted out at
+Vladivostok, but had taken a wide sea course, so as to pretend to have
+set sail from Nagasaki. Several Russian shipping merchants were
+interested in the venture, which was a private one, and among the number
+was Ivan Snokoff. From Captain Barusky, Snokoff had heard that fabulous
+prices could be obtained for needed commodities at Port Arthur, and he
+had invested nearly every _ruble_ he possessed in the enterprise. If the
+vessel succeeded in reaching Port Arthur, Captain Barusky was to
+undertake the disposal of the goods shipped in Snokoff's name, and then
+the two were to divide the profits.
+
+The big brig had come close to being wrecked off the coast of Japan and
+during a gale had run down a fishing smack containing Shamhaven,
+Peterson, and two Japanese. One Japanese had been drowned, and the three
+others from the smack had been made to join the crew of the big brig.
+This was agreeable to Shamhaven and Peterson, who did not wish to remain
+near Nagasaki or at any place where Captain Ponsberry or Larry would be
+likely to discover them.
+
+
+
+
+CHAPTER XXXII
+
+FALL OF PORT ARTHUR--CONCLUSION
+
+
+"Open, in the name of the Czar!"
+
+Such was the command which startled both Ben and Grace Chase, and for
+the moment each gazed at the other in horror, not knowing what to say or
+do.
+
+"I must get away from here!" whispered the young captain, but scarcely
+had he spoken when there came a crash, and the front door of the
+residence swung in. Then half a dozen Russians poured into the house.
+
+"There he is, as I suspected!" said one, an officer from the prison.
+"We'll see that you do not escape again," he added to Ben, grimly.
+
+In the midst of the excitement Nathan Chase arrived. But he could do
+nothing for the young captain, and was glad that he was left to protect
+his daughter.
+
+"We ought also to take her," said the prison official. "She did wrong to
+harbor this prisoner." And then, without further ado, Ben was marched
+back to the place from which he had escaped such a short while before.
+
+After that the time passed dismally enough for the young American. For
+having run away he was put on the most miserable fare the prison
+afforded, the food being often so vile he could not touch it. Whenever
+he attempted to protest he was met with kicks and blows.
+
+"They might as well kill me and be done with it," he thought. "Oh, how I
+wish the Japs would take the city and give me back my liberty!"
+
+In those days Port Arthur became a most uncomfortable place for all
+living there. The Japanese army was pressing forward steadily, and army
+and navy did everything possible to destroy the shipping in the harbor
+and make the various forts untenable. Shots and shells were hurled into
+the city at all hours of the day and night, until living there became
+worse than a nightmare. Among the soldiers scurvy became prevalent,
+until the hospitals could not accommodate the sick and the dying.
+Nothing was done to clean up the streets, and the rubbish lay many feet
+deep over the sidewalks. Practically all of the shops were closed, for
+they had next to nothing to sell. The main article of food was rice, and
+to cook this many old buildings had to be razed in order to procure
+necessary firewood. As winter approached the suffering of the poor
+became so intense that riots broke out and to maintain order not a few
+were shot down.
+
+Such was the condition in the city. Outside, to the northward, the
+fighting went on week after week. So many soldiers were killed upon both
+sides that to bury the dead became impossible, and thousands were left
+where they had fallen, to become the prey of vultures, or to putrefy and
+fill the locality with a stench that was as nauseating as it was deadly!
+Such are the horrors of modern warfare. The demands for universal peace
+cannot come any too quickly.
+
+In the advance on Port Arthur, Gilbert did his full share of the
+fighting. The Japanese were now struggling for the possession of what
+was known as 203-Meter Hill, a rocky elevation which was not fortified
+but which was in the direct line of Russian fire. The top of 203-Meter
+Hill commanded a fine view of Port Arthur and its harbor, and it was
+this view the Japanese needed, in order to make their shell fire most
+effective.
+
+The battle for 203-Meter Hill is one which will be long remembered. The
+Japanese fought with a desperation impossible to describe, and when the
+hill was captured, General Stoessel sent out nearly all his available
+men to retake it. But this could not be accomplished, and late in
+December the Japanese stormed the inner defenses of the Russian chain of
+forts, killing nearly all of the brave defenders who dared to oppose
+them. Then tons upon tons of shot and shell were sent into Port Arthur
+and over the harbor once again, until the locality became little short
+of an inferno. Nearly all the shipping was destroyed, and so many
+buildings were set on fire that to stem the conflagration became all but
+impossible. The end came on New Year's Day, 1905--ten months after the
+famous siege began. To hold out longer seemed impossible, and to avoid
+further carnage General Stoessel called a council of war and sent a
+message to General Nogi offering to capitulate.
+
+"Port Arthur has surrendered!" The news flew from one Japanese regiment
+to another, and soon the warships were sending the message from vessel
+to vessel. For once the Japanese showed their real feelings, and "_Banzai!
+Banzai!_" rent the air again and again. "Long life to the Mikado! Port
+Arthur is ours once more!"
+
+"It is a well-earned victory!" cried Larry, when he heard the news.
+
+"Yes, lad, and I trust it brings this bloody war to a close," came from
+Luke.
+
+"They say General Stoessel blew up the warships remaining in the
+harbor."
+
+"He couldn't have had many left," returned the old Yankee gunner. "The
+army and the navy have about battered everything to bits." And in this
+surmise Luke was correct.
+
+The fall of Port Arthur caused widespread consternation in Russia, while
+the people of Japan were correspondingly elated. Because of the gallant
+defense of the place, the Japanese made generous terms with those who
+had surrendered, much to the satisfaction of the world at large. Many
+had predicted a universal butchery, but nothing of the sort occurred,
+and the Russian sick and wounded were given every possible attention.
+
+After the fall of the port Larry was permitted to go ashore some miles
+above the town, and he managed to locate Gilbert, and then learned for
+the first time that Ben was a prisoner in the captured place.
+
+"A prisoner!" he ejaculated. "Oh, Gilbert, we must find him and have him
+released!"
+
+"That is just what I have been thinking, but I don't know exactly how to
+go at it, Larry."
+
+"There ought to be some way of doing these things. We might interview
+one of the generals and----Who is that coming this way?"
+
+"Why, it's Ben himself!" cried Gilbert.
+
+"Ben!" screamed Larry, and ran forward to meet his brother. Soon they
+were in each other's arms, and then Gilbert received an equally warm
+greeting.
+
+"We were released this morning," said Ben. "I can tell you I was mighty
+glad of it. I haven't had a meal fit to eat in weeks."
+
+"Well, you shall have the best our larder affords," said Gilbert. "My,
+but you're a sight for sore eyes!" he continued.
+
+"Don't say a word!" came from Larry. Two tears were glistening in his
+honest eyes. "It's almost too good to be true!"
+
+* * * * *
+
+Here let me add a few words more and then bring to a close this tale of
+the naval and military adventures "At the Fall of Port Arthur."
+
+After the surrender of the city the army in that vicinity, and also the
+fleet near the harbor, had but little to do outside of caring for the
+sick and wounded and disposing of the thousands of prisoners. The
+Russian officers were allowed to go on parole and the prisoners were
+transported to Japan. Many of the mines in the harbor were taken up, so
+that ships might come and go in safety.
+
+Larry was anxious to learn what had become of Shamhaven and Peterson,
+and through the Japanese guards stationed in Port Arthur located the
+rascally sailors at a cheap boarding-house. Both were made prisoners,
+and Larry got back a portion of the money stolen from Captain Ponsberry
+and himself. It was learned that the big brig had been destroyed by the
+Japanese shell fire, so that Ivan Snokoff lost everything he placed in
+the venture.
+
+"Well, it served him right," said Gilbert, when he heard of this. "He is
+responsible for the time Ben spent in prison."
+
+What had become of Captain Barusky was at first a mystery. But at last
+it was learned that he had sneaked aboard of a transport filled with
+wounded soldiers and bound for Chefoo. He pretended to be wounded
+himself, and was given medical attention until the trick was discovered,
+when he was treated as a coward. As soon as Chefoo was reached he
+disappeared, and that was the last seen or heard of him for some time.
+
+"We are well rid of that fellow," said Ben. "I hope the Russians read
+him out of their army. He isn't fit to hold a commission."
+
+"What do you imagine will be the next move in this war?" questioned
+Gilbert.
+
+"It is hard to tell. I think they will try to take Mukden, for one
+thing."
+
+"Russia is going to send out more warships," put in Larry. "If they come
+this way, it may mean more fighting for me."
+
+"Well, I reckon you'll do your duty, if you are put to it," answered
+Gilbert, with a smile.
+
+"And so will you do yours," came from Larry.
+
+"We'll all try to do our duty," broke in Ben. "We didn't join the army
+and the navy to hang back. Just the same, I'd enjoy a bit of a rest just
+now."
+
+The others agreed that the rest would be beneficial all around. It was
+given to them; and here, for the present at least, we will leave them,
+wishing them the best of good luck in the future.
+
+
+
+
+* * * * *
+
+
+
+
+Transcriber's note:
+
+Obvious punctuation errors were corrected.
+
+Additional corrections:
+ CH X: Changed "on" to "of" ...I reckon some of us...
+ CH XII: Changed "he" to "be" ...but this could not be helped...
+ CH XXII: Deleted "t" from "fittted" ...warship was being fitted...
+ CH XXVII: Changed 'threatended' to 'threatened' ...he was threatened
+ with a flogging...
+ CH XXXII: Capitalized 'And' beginning of sentence: ...the Yankee tar's
+ reply. And then, cutlasses in hand,...
+ Added comma: ...just as the trigger fell,...
+ Changed 'located' to 'locate' ...he managed to locate Gilbert...
+
+
+
+***END OF THE PROJECT GUTENBERG EBOOK AT THE FALL OF PORT ARTHUR***
+
+
+******* This file should be named 33559.txt or 33559.zip *******
+
+
+This and all associated files of various formats will be found in:
+http://www.gutenberg.org/dirs/3/3/5/5/33559
+
+
+
+Updated editions will replace the previous one--the old editions
+will be renamed.
+
+Creating the works from public domain print editions means that no
+one owns a United States copyright in these works, so the Foundation
+(and you!) can copy and distribute it in the United States without
+permission and without paying copyright royalties. Special rules,
+set forth in the General Terms of Use part of this license, apply to
+copying and distributing Project Gutenberg-tm electronic works to
+protect the PROJECT GUTENBERG-tm concept and trademark. Project
+Gutenberg is a registered trademark, and may not be used if you
+charge for the eBooks, unless you receive specific permission. If you
+do not charge anything for copies of this eBook, complying with the
+rules is very easy. You may use this eBook for nearly any purpose
+such as creation of derivative works, reports, performances and
+research. They may be modified and printed and given away--you may do
+practically ANYTHING with public domain eBooks. Redistribution is
+subject to the trademark license, especially commercial
+redistribution.
+
+
+
+*** START: FULL LICENSE ***
+
+THE FULL PROJECT GUTENBERG LICENSE
+PLEASE READ THIS BEFORE YOU DISTRIBUTE OR USE THIS WORK
+
+To protect the Project Gutenberg-tm mission of promoting the free
+distribution of electronic works, by using or distributing this work
+(or any other work associated in any way with the phrase "Project
+Gutenberg"), you agree to comply with all the terms of the Full Project
+Gutenberg-tm License (available with this file or online at
+http://www.gutenberg.org/license).
+
+
+Section 1. General Terms of Use and Redistributing Project Gutenberg-tm
+electronic works
+
+1.A. By reading or using any part of this Project Gutenberg-tm
+electronic work, you indicate that you have read, understand, agree to
+and accept all the terms of this license and intellectual property
+(trademark/copyright) agreement. If you do not agree to abide by all
+the terms of this agreement, you must cease using and return or destroy
+all copies of Project Gutenberg-tm electronic works in your possession.
+If you paid a fee for obtaining a copy of or access to a Project
+Gutenberg-tm electronic work and you do not agree to be bound by the
+terms of this agreement, you may obtain a refund from the person or
+entity to whom you paid the fee as set forth in paragraph 1.E.8.
+
+1.B. "Project Gutenberg" is a registered trademark. It may only be
+used on or associated in any way with an electronic work by people who
+agree to be bound by the terms of this agreement. There are a few
+things that you can do with most Project Gutenberg-tm electronic works
+even without complying with the full terms of this agreement. See
+paragraph 1.C below. There are a lot of things you can do with Project
+Gutenberg-tm electronic works if you follow the terms of this agreement
+and help preserve free future access to Project Gutenberg-tm electronic
+works. See paragraph 1.E below.
+
+1.C. The Project Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation ("the Foundation"
+or PGLAF), owns a compilation copyright in the collection of Project
+Gutenberg-tm electronic works. Nearly all the individual works in the
+collection are in the public domain in the United States. If an
+individual work is in the public domain in the United States and you are
+located in the United States, we do not claim a right to prevent you from
+copying, distributing, performing, displaying or creating derivative
+works based on the work as long as all references to Project Gutenberg
+are removed. Of course, we hope that you will support the Project
+Gutenberg-tm mission of promoting free access to electronic works by
+freely sharing Project Gutenberg-tm works in compliance with the terms of
+this agreement for keeping the Project Gutenberg-tm name associated with
+the work. You can easily comply with the terms of this agreement by
+keeping this work in the same format with its attached full Project
+Gutenberg-tm License when you share it without charge with others.
+
+1.D. The copyright laws of the place where you are located also govern
+what you can do with this work. Copyright laws in most countries are in
+a constant state of change. If you are outside the United States, check
+the laws of your country in addition to the terms of this agreement
+before downloading, copying, displaying, performing, distributing or
+creating derivative works based on this work or any other Project
+Gutenberg-tm work. The Foundation makes no representations concerning
+the copyright status of any work in any country outside the United
+States.
+
+1.E. Unless you have removed all references to Project Gutenberg:
+
+1.E.1. The following sentence, with active links to, or other immediate
+access to, the full Project Gutenberg-tm License must appear prominently
+whenever any copy of a Project Gutenberg-tm work (any work on which the
+phrase "Project Gutenberg" appears, or with which the phrase "Project
+Gutenberg" is associated) is accessed, displayed, performed, viewed,
+copied or distributed:
+
+This eBook is for the use of anyone anywhere at no cost and with
+almost no restrictions whatsoever. You may copy it, give it away or
+re-use it under the terms of the Project Gutenberg License included
+with this eBook or online at www.gutenberg.org
+
+1.E.2. If an individual Project Gutenberg-tm electronic work is derived
+from the public domain (does not contain a notice indicating that it is
+posted with permission of the copyright holder), the work can be copied
+and distributed to anyone in the United States without paying any fees
+or charges. If you are redistributing or providing access to a work
+with the phrase "Project Gutenberg" associated with or appearing on the
+work, you must comply either with the requirements of paragraphs 1.E.1
+through 1.E.7 or obtain permission for the use of the work and the
+Project Gutenberg-tm trademark as set forth in paragraphs 1.E.8 or
+1.E.9.
+
+1.E.3. If an individual Project Gutenberg-tm electronic work is posted
+with the permission of the copyright holder, your use and distribution
+must comply with both paragraphs 1.E.1 through 1.E.7 and any additional
+terms imposed by the copyright holder. Additional terms will be linked
+to the Project Gutenberg-tm License for all works posted with the
+permission of the copyright holder found at the beginning of this work.
+
+1.E.4. Do not unlink or detach or remove the full Project Gutenberg-tm
+License terms from this work, or any files containing a part of this
+work or any other work associated with Project Gutenberg-tm.
+
+1.E.5. Do not copy, display, perform, distribute or redistribute this
+electronic work, or any part of this electronic work, without
+prominently displaying the sentence set forth in paragraph 1.E.1 with
+active links or immediate access to the full terms of the Project
+Gutenberg-tm License.
+
+1.E.6. You may convert to and distribute this work in any binary,
+compressed, marked up, nonproprietary or proprietary form, including any
+word processing or hypertext form. However, if you provide access to or
+distribute copies of a Project Gutenberg-tm work in a format other than
+"Plain Vanilla ASCII" or other format used in the official version
+posted on the official Project Gutenberg-tm web site (www.gutenberg.org),
+you must, at no additional cost, fee or expense to the user, provide a
+copy, a means of exporting a copy, or a means of obtaining a copy upon
+request, of the work in its original "Plain Vanilla ASCII" or other
+form. Any alternate format must include the full Project Gutenberg-tm
+License as specified in paragraph 1.E.1.
+
+1.E.7. Do not charge a fee for access to, viewing, displaying,
+performing, copying or distributing any Project Gutenberg-tm works
+unless you comply with paragraph 1.E.8 or 1.E.9.
+
+1.E.8. You may charge a reasonable fee for copies of or providing
+access to or distributing Project Gutenberg-tm electronic works provided
+that
+
+- You pay a royalty fee of 20% of the gross profits you derive from
+ the use of Project Gutenberg-tm works calculated using the method
+ you already use to calculate your applicable taxes. The fee is
+ owed to the owner of the Project Gutenberg-tm trademark, but he
+ has agreed to donate royalties under this paragraph to the
+ Project Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation. Royalty payments
+ must be paid within 60 days following each date on which you
+ prepare (or are legally required to prepare) your periodic tax
+ returns. Royalty payments should be clearly marked as such and
+ sent to the Project Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation at the
+ address specified in Section 4, "Information about donations to
+ the Project Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation."
+
+- You provide a full refund of any money paid by a user who notifies
+ you in writing (or by e-mail) within 30 days of receipt that s/he
+ does not agree to the terms of the full Project Gutenberg-tm
+ License. You must require such a user to return or
+ destroy all copies of the works possessed in a physical medium
+ and discontinue all use of and all access to other copies of
+ Project Gutenberg-tm works.
+
+- You provide, in accordance with paragraph 1.F.3, a full refund of any
+ money paid for a work or a replacement copy, if a defect in the
+ electronic work is discovered and reported to you within 90 days
+ of receipt of the work.
+
+- You comply with all other terms of this agreement for free
+ distribution of Project Gutenberg-tm works.
+
+1.E.9. If you wish to charge a fee or distribute a Project Gutenberg-tm
+electronic work or group of works on different terms than are set
+forth in this agreement, you must obtain permission in writing from
+both the Project Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation and Michael
+Hart, the owner of the Project Gutenberg-tm trademark. Contact the
+Foundation as set forth in Section 3 below.
+
+1.F.
+
+1.F.1. Project Gutenberg volunteers and employees expend considerable
+effort to identify, do copyright research on, transcribe and proofread
+public domain works in creating the Project Gutenberg-tm
+collection. Despite these efforts, Project Gutenberg-tm electronic
+works, and the medium on which they may be stored, may contain
+"Defects," such as, but not limited to, incomplete, inaccurate or
+corrupt data, transcription errors, a copyright or other intellectual
+property infringement, a defective or damaged disk or other medium, a
+computer virus, or computer codes that damage or cannot be read by
+your equipment.
+
+1.F.2. LIMITED WARRANTY, DISCLAIMER OF DAMAGES - Except for the "Right
+of Replacement or Refund" described in paragraph 1.F.3, the Project
+Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation, the owner of the Project
+Gutenberg-tm trademark, and any other party distributing a Project
+Gutenberg-tm electronic work under this agreement, disclaim all
+liability to you for damages, costs and expenses, including legal
+fees. YOU AGREE THAT YOU HAVE NO REMEDIES FOR NEGLIGENCE, STRICT
+LIABILITY, BREACH OF WARRANTY OR BREACH OF CONTRACT EXCEPT THOSE
+PROVIDED IN PARAGRAPH 1.F.3. YOU AGREE THAT THE FOUNDATION, THE
+TRADEMARK OWNER, AND ANY DISTRIBUTOR UNDER THIS AGREEMENT WILL NOT BE
+LIABLE TO YOU FOR ACTUAL, DIRECT, INDIRECT, CONSEQUENTIAL, PUNITIVE OR
+INCIDENTAL DAMAGES EVEN IF YOU GIVE NOTICE OF THE POSSIBILITY OF SUCH
+DAMAGE.
+
+1.F.3. LIMITED RIGHT OF REPLACEMENT OR REFUND - If you discover a
+defect in this electronic work within 90 days of receiving it, you can
+receive a refund of the money (if any) you paid for it by sending a
+written explanation to the person you received the work from. If you
+received the work on a physical medium, you must return the medium with
+your written explanation. The person or entity that provided you with
+the defective work may elect to provide a replacement copy in lieu of a
+refund. If you received the work electronically, the person or entity
+providing it to you may choose to give you a second opportunity to
+receive the work electronically in lieu of a refund. If the second copy
+is also defective, you may demand a refund in writing without further
+opportunities to fix the problem.
+
+1.F.4. Except for the limited right of replacement or refund set forth
+in paragraph 1.F.3, this work is provided to you 'AS-IS', WITH NO OTHER
+WARRANTIES OF ANY KIND, EXPRESS OR IMPLIED, INCLUDING BUT NOT LIMITED TO
+WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTIBILITY OR FITNESS FOR ANY PURPOSE.
+
+1.F.5. Some states do not allow disclaimers of certain implied
+warranties or the exclusion or limitation of certain types of damages.
+If any disclaimer or limitation set forth in this agreement violates the
+law of the state applicable to this agreement, the agreement shall be
+interpreted to make the maximum disclaimer or limitation permitted by
+the applicable state law. The invalidity or unenforceability of any
+provision of this agreement shall not void the remaining provisions.
+
+1.F.6. INDEMNITY - You agree to indemnify and hold the Foundation, the
+trademark owner, any agent or employee of the Foundation, anyone
+providing copies of Project Gutenberg-tm electronic works in accordance
+with this agreement, and any volunteers associated with the production,
+promotion and distribution of Project Gutenberg-tm electronic works,
+harmless from all liability, costs and expenses, including legal fees,
+that arise directly or indirectly from any of the following which you do
+or cause to occur: (a) distribution of this or any Project Gutenberg-tm
+work, (b) alteration, modification, or additions or deletions to any
+Project Gutenberg-tm work, and (c) any Defect you cause.
+
+
+Section 2. Information about the Mission of Project Gutenberg-tm
+
+Project Gutenberg-tm is synonymous with the free distribution of
+electronic works in formats readable by the widest variety of computers
+including obsolete, old, middle-aged and new computers. It exists
+because of the efforts of hundreds of volunteers and donations from
+people in all walks of life.
+
+Volunteers and financial support to provide volunteers with the
+assistance they need are critical to reaching Project Gutenberg-tm's
+goals and ensuring that the Project Gutenberg-tm collection will
+remain freely available for generations to come. In 2001, the Project
+Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation was created to provide a secure
+and permanent future for Project Gutenberg-tm and future generations.
+To learn more about the Project Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation
+and how your efforts and donations can help, see Sections 3 and 4
+and the Foundation web page at http://www.gutenberg.org/fundraising/pglaf.
+
+
+Section 3. Information about the Project Gutenberg Literary Archive
+Foundation
+
+The Project Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation is a non profit
+501(c)(3) educational corporation organized under the laws of the
+state of Mississippi and granted tax exempt status by the Internal
+Revenue Service. The Foundation's EIN or federal tax identification
+number is 64-6221541. Contributions to the Project Gutenberg
+Literary Archive Foundation are tax deductible to the full extent
+permitted by U.S. federal laws and your state's laws.
+
+The Foundation's principal office is located at 4557 Melan Dr. S.
+Fairbanks, AK, 99712., but its volunteers and employees are scattered
+throughout numerous locations. Its business office is located at
+809 North 1500 West, Salt Lake City, UT 84116, (801) 596-1887, email
+business@pglaf.org. Email contact links and up to date contact
+information can be found at the Foundation's web site and official
+page at http://www.gutenberg.org/about/contact
+
+For additional contact information:
+ Dr. Gregory B. Newby
+ Chief Executive and Director
+ gbnewby@pglaf.org
+
+Section 4. Information about Donations to the Project Gutenberg
+Literary Archive Foundation
+
+Project Gutenberg-tm depends upon and cannot survive without wide
+spread public support and donations to carry out its mission of
+increasing the number of public domain and licensed works that can be
+freely distributed in machine readable form accessible by the widest
+array of equipment including outdated equipment. Many small donations
+($1 to $5,000) are particularly important to maintaining tax exempt
+status with the IRS.
+
+The Foundation is committed to complying with the laws regulating
+charities and charitable donations in all 50 states of the United
+States. Compliance requirements are not uniform and it takes a
+considerable effort, much paperwork and many fees to meet and keep up
+with these requirements. We do not solicit donations in locations
+where we have not received written confirmation of compliance. To
+SEND DONATIONS or determine the status of compliance for any
+particular state visit http://www.gutenberg.org/fundraising/donate
+
+While we cannot and do not solicit contributions from states where we
+have not met the solicitation requirements, we know of no prohibition
+against accepting unsolicited donations from donors in such states who
+approach us with offers to donate.
+
+International donations are gratefully accepted, but we cannot make
+any statements concerning tax treatment of donations received from
+outside the United States. U.S. laws alone swamp our small staff.
+
+Please check the Project Gutenberg Web pages for current donation
+methods and addresses. Donations are accepted in a number of other
+ways including checks, online payments and credit card donations.
+To donate, please visit:
+http://www.gutenberg.org/fundraising/donate
+
+
+Section 5. General Information About Project Gutenberg-tm electronic
+works.
+
+Professor Michael S. Hart is the originator of the Project Gutenberg-tm
+concept of a library of electronic works that could be freely shared
+with anyone. For thirty years, he produced and distributed Project
+Gutenberg-tm eBooks with only a loose network of volunteer support.
+
+Project Gutenberg-tm eBooks are often created from several printed
+editions, all of which are confirmed as Public Domain in the U.S.
+unless a copyright notice is included. Thus, we do not necessarily
+keep eBooks in compliance with any particular paper edition.
+
+Most people start at our Web site which has the main PG search facility:
+
+ http://www.gutenberg.org
+
+This Web site includes information about Project Gutenberg-tm,
+including how to make donations to the Project Gutenberg Literary
+Archive Foundation, how to help produce our new eBooks, and how to
+subscribe to our email newsletter to hear about new eBooks.
+
diff --git a/33559.zip b/33559.zip
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..71e346f
--- /dev/null
+++ b/33559.zip
Binary files differ
diff --git a/LICENSE.txt b/LICENSE.txt
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..6312041
--- /dev/null
+++ b/LICENSE.txt
@@ -0,0 +1,11 @@
+This eBook, including all associated images, markup, improvements,
+metadata, and any other content or labor, has been confirmed to be
+in the PUBLIC DOMAIN IN THE UNITED STATES.
+
+Procedures for determining public domain status are described in
+the "Copyright How-To" at https://www.gutenberg.org.
+
+No investigation has been made concerning possible copyrights in
+jurisdictions other than the United States. Anyone seeking to utilize
+this eBook outside of the United States should confirm copyright
+status under the laws that apply to them.
diff --git a/README.md b/README.md
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..d523bce
--- /dev/null
+++ b/README.md
@@ -0,0 +1,2 @@
+Project Gutenberg (https://www.gutenberg.org) public repository for
+eBook #33559 (https://www.gutenberg.org/ebooks/33559)